Commonwealth of Australia Explanatory Memoranda

[Index] [Search] [Download] [Bill] [Help]


TAX LAWS AMENDMENT (TAXATION OF FINANCIAL ARRANGEMENTS) BILL 2008


2008




               THE PARLIAMENT OF THE COMMONWEALTH OF AUSTRALIA











                          HOUSE OF REPRESENTATIVES











      TAX LAWS AMENDMENT (TAXATION OF FINANCIAL ARRANGEMENTS) BILL 2008














                           EXPLANATORY MEMORANDUM














                     (Circulated by the authority of the
                      Treasurer, the Hon Wayne Swan MP)






Table of contents


Glossary    1


General outline and financial impact    3


Chapter 1    Background and framework   5


Chapter 2    Definition of 'financial arrangement' 27


Chapter 3    Tax treatment of gains and losses from financial arrangements
              95


Chapter 4    The compounding accruals and realisation methods 129


Chapter 5    Elective Subdivisions:  common requirements 203


Chapter 6    The elective fair value method  225


Chapter 7    The elective foreign exchange retranslation method     239


Chapter 8    The elective hedging financial arrangements method     261


Chapter 9    The elective financial reports method 299


Chapter 10   Balancing adjustment on disposing of financial arrangements
              315


Chapter 11   Interaction and consequential amendments (other than
              consolidation) 341


Chapter 12   Consolidation interactions 387


Chapter 13   Commencement, transitional and implementation issues   409


Chapter 14   Case studies    425


Chapter 15   Regulation impact statement     463


Index 485



Glossary

         The following abbreviations and acronyms are used throughout this
         explanatory memorandum.

|Abbreviation         |Definition                   |
|AAS 25               |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AAS 25 Financial    |
|                     |Reporting by Superannuation  |
|                     |Plans                        |
|AASB 7               |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 7 Financial    |
|                     |Instruments:  Disclosures    |
|AASB 101             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 101            |
|                     |Presentation of Financial    |
|                     |Statements                   |
|AASB 108             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 108 Accounting |
|                     |Policies, Changes in         |
|                     |Accounting Estimates and     |
|                     |Errors                       |
|AASB 112             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 112 Income     |
|                     |Taxes                        |
|AASB 117             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 117 Leases     |
|AASB 118             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 118 Revenue    |
|AASB 121             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 121 The Effects|
|                     |of Changes in Foreign        |
|                     |Exchange Rates               |
|AASB 127             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 127            |
|                     |Consolidated and Separate    |
|                     |Financial Statements         |
|AASB 132             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 132 Financial  |
|                     |Instruments:  Disclosure and |
|                     |Presentation                 |
|AASB 137             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 137 Provisions,|
|                     |Contingent Liabilities and   |
|                     |Contingent Assets            |
|AASB 139             |Australian Accounting        |
|                     |Standard AASB 139 Financial  |
|                     |Instruments:  Recognition and|
|                     |Measurement                  |
|ADI                  |authorised deposit-taking    |
|                     |institution                  |
|ASIC                 |Australian Securities and    |
|                     |Investments Commission       |
|ASX                  |Australian Securities        |
|                     |Exchange                     |
|ATO                  |Australian Taxation Office   |
|CGT                  |capital gains tax            |
|Commissioner         |Commissioner of Taxation     |
|CPI                  |consumer price index         |
|ITAA 1936            |Income Tax Assessment Act    |
|                     |1936                         |
|ITAA 1997            |Income Tax Assessment Act    |
|                     |1997                         |
|MEC group            |multiple entry consolidated  |
|                     |group                        |
|NBTS (TOFA) Act 2003 |New Business Tax System      |
|                     |(Taxation of Financial       |
|                     |Arrangements) Act 2003       |
|PAYG                 |pay as you go                |
|Ralph Report         |Review of Business Taxation: |
|                     |A Tax System Redesigned      |
|Ralph Review         |Review of Business Taxation  |
|retranslation method |elective foreign exchange    |
|                     |retranslation method         |
|TAA 1953             |Taxation Administration Act  |
|                     |1953                         |
|the Act              |the ITAA 1936 and ITAA 1997  |
|TOFA                 |taxation of financial        |
|                     |arrangements                 |
|US                   |United States of America     |

General outline and financial impact

Taxation of financial arrangements


         This Bill amends the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997 by inserting
         Division 230.  Division 230 defines 'financial arrangement' and
         sets out the methods under which gains and losses from financial
         arrangements will be brought to account for tax purposes.  These
         methods - accruals, realisation, fair value, retranslation, hedging
         and financial reports - determine the tax-timing treatments of all
         financial arrangements covered by Division 230.  This Bill
         establishes criteria that determine how different financial
         arrangements are assigned to, and treated under, the different tax-
         timing methods.  The Bill also effectively removes the
         capital/revenue distinction for most financial arrangements by
         treating the gains and losses on revenue account, except where
         specific rules apply.


         Date of effect:  These amendments will apply to income years
         commencing on or after 1 July 2010, unless a taxpayer elects to
         apply the amendments to income years commencing on or after 1 July
         2009.


         Proposal announced:  This proposal was announced in the then
         Treasurer's Press Release No. 074 of 11 November 1999, the then
         Minister for Revenue and Assistant Treasurer's Press Release No.
         002 of 5 August 2004 and the Treasurer's Media Releases No. 53 and
         No. 54 of 13 May 2008.  Other announcements accompanied the release
         of exposure drafts of this legislation - the then Minister for
         Revenue and Assistant Treasurer's Press Release No. 107 of
         16 December 2005, the then Minister for Revenue and Assistant
         Treasurer's Press Release No. 001 of 3 January 2007 and the
         Assistant Treasurer and Minister for Competition Policy and
         Consumer Affairs' Media Release No. 082 of 1 October 2008.


         Financial impact:  The revenue impact of this measure is
         unquantifiable.


         Compliance cost impact:  Division 230 will lower ongoing compliance
         costs by providing greater coherency, clarity and certainty, using
         financial accounting concepts from relevant financial accounting
         standards, basing tax treatments on functional purposes, and
         removing uncertainties about relevant tax-timing treatments.








      1. Chapter 1
Background and framework

Outline of chapter


      2. Division 230 contains new rules for the taxation treatment of
         financial arrangements.


      3. This chapter:


                . explains why reform of the taxation of financial
                  arrangements (TOFA) is necessary;


                . explains the framework of Division 230; and


                . provides an outline of how the Division applies.


Context of amendments


Why is the existing law inadequate?


      4. Over recent decades the development of new financial arrangements
         to provide finance and allocate risk has had broad ranging impacts
         on the operation of capital markets.  The income tax law has not
         kept pace with this financial innovation.


      5. Where the tax law has been amended to address new product
         developments, the amendments have been largely in response to
         specific pressures and have tended to be of a limited, ad hoc and
         piecemeal nature.  What has been lacking is an overarching
         framework which seeks to systematically address the functional
         purposes of different financial arrangements and the ways in which
         they are used.  As a consequence, current tax laws, which have
         continued to rely significantly on legal form, represent an
         increasingly complex amalgam of both general and specific
         provisions.


      6. Under the current law, accruals rules, which spread gains and
         losses from financial arrangements over time, have been narrowly
         focused.  Outside their purview, tax treatments do not adequately
         take into account the time value of money or provide for an
         appropriate allocation of economic income over time.


      7. Current tax laws have resulted in tax-based timing and character
         mismatches and lack the tax design architecture needed to
         facilitate efficient hedging activity and market-making.  In a
         number of areas, gaps have appeared in the law, determinacy has
         been lacking, tax anomalies and distortions have emerged,
         neutrality has not been achieved, and uncertainty has developed
         about the appropriate treatment of some basic financial
         arrangements.  The current tax law does not adequately address the
         tax-timing treatment of emerging hybrid instruments, or newer
         structured products, including those with both fixed and contingent
         returns.  As a consequence, the existing tax system impacts
         adversely on pricing, risk management and allocative efficiency.


      8. The current income tax law has often placed greater emphasis on the
         form rather than the substance of financial arrangements.  This has
         resulted in inconsistencies in the tax treatment of transactions
         with similar economic substance which has impeded commercial
         decision-making, created difficulties in addressing financial
         innovation, and facilitated tax deferral and tax arbitrage.


Division 230 and earlier reforms to the taxation of financial arrangements


      9. Building on earlier consultative papers and extensive
         consultations, recommended reforms to TOFA were set out in the
         Review of Business Taxation:  A Tax System Redesigned (July 1999).
         Division 230 represents the combined third and fourth stages of
         TOFA reforms emanating from the previous government's in-principle
         support for those earlier TOFA recommendations.


     10. In 2001, in conjunction with the introduction of thin
         capitalisation measures and in response to the failure of the legal
         form-based tax system to cope with the creation of new financing
         products, growing mischaracterisation of debt and equity interests
         and general uncertainty over appropriate tax treatments, the
         previous government introduced Division 974 of the Income Tax
         Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997).


     11. Division 974 of the ITAA 1997 reformed the debt/equity tax
         borderline and represented Stage 1 of the TOFA reforms.  Under that
         reform, the test for distinguishing debt interests from equity
         interests focuses on a single organising principle - debt is
         evident where an issuer has an effective obligation to return to
         the investor an amount at least equal to the amount invested.


     12. In 2003, in response to uncertainty over the taxation of foreign
         currency gains and losses, the previous government introduced
         Division 775 and Subdivisions 960-C and 960-D of the ITAA 1997.
         Those amendments addressed anomalies and provided certainty as to
         how foreign currency gains and losses are brought to account for
         tax purposes.  At the same time, reforms aimed at removing the
         taxing point at conversion or exchange of certain financial
         instruments were introduced in sections 26BB and 70B of the Income
         Tax Assessment Act 1936 (ITAA 1936).  Together, these reforms
         represented Stage 2 of the TOFA reforms.


     13. Division 230 contains provisions which cover both the tax treatment
         of hedges (Stage 3) and tax-timing treatments in respect of
         arrangements other than hedges (Stage 4).  The provisions address:


                . the final stages of the TOFA reforms recommended by the
                  Review of Business Taxation (Ralph Review);


                . the previous government's announcement in the 2005-06
                  Budget to extend the tax-timing hedge treatment for hedges
                  of commodities - proposed by the Ralph Review - to hedging
                  transactions generally; and


                . the addition of tax status hedge rules which provide for
                  matching of the tax classification or status (capital,
                  revenue, assessable, exempt, non-assessable non-exempt) of
                  the gain or loss from the hedging financial arrangement
                  with the tax classification or status of the underlying.


Objectives of Division 230


     14. The two overarching objectives underpinning Division 230 are
         greater efficiency and the lowering of compliance costs.


     15. Greater efficiency, in this context, means minimising the extent to
         which the taxation of financial arrangements (by providing
         inappropriate impediments or stimulation) distorts a taxpayer's
         trading, financing, investment, pricing, risk taking and risk
         management decisions.  Such distortions impact adversely on the
         allocation of investment activity both within the financial sector
         and between the financial and non-financial sectors and also reduce
         the general efficiency, effectiveness and competitiveness of
         capital markets.  Removing such distortions involves the
         development of an enhanced and more comprehensive and coherent tax
         law framework.


     16. Greater efficiency will result from:


                . providing tax treatments that cover all financial
                  arrangements coherently and consistently;


                . closer alignment of tax and commercial recognition of
                  gains and losses from financial arrangements;


                . facilitating the appropriate allocation over time of the
                  gains and losses from financial arrangements for tax
                  purposes;


                . general recognition of gains and losses on revenue
                  account;


                . reducing tax-timing and tax-status mismatches;


                . increasing reliance on economic substance over legal form;
                  and


                . reducing opportunities for tax deferral and tax arbitrage.


     17. The lowering of compliance costs necessarily involves greater
         regard being given to the commercial context within which financial
         arrangements are traded and exchanged.  Lower compliance costs are
         achieved through:


                . reliance on the gains and losses required to be included
                  in commercial financial reports as the basis for taxation
                  where appropriate;


                . otherwise incorporating the concepts and methods used in
                  financial accounting standards, where appropriate, as the
                  basis for tax treatments;


                . reducing complexity and taxpayer uncertainty while
                  increasing clarity of the law; and


                . increasing alignment of tax treatments with the functional
                  purposes that commercial parties have when entering
                  particular financial arrangements.


     18. The Division 230 tax framework explicitly takes into account a
         number of Australian accounting standards.  These standards reflect
         the adoption of the international financial reporting standards in
         Australia, with effect from 1 January 2005.  However, Division 230
         does not mandate that taxpayers use accounting standards as the
         basis for taxation.  Such an approach could impose unfair
         compliance costs on certain taxpayers and could also lead to
         volatility in tax liabilities.  Volatility in taxation could arise,
         for instance, from mandatory application of fair value treatment.
         Rather, the closer alignment with accounting standards and taxation
         is achieved through two basic mechanisms.  The first involves a
         specific election to rely on gains and losses determined by
         relevant accounting standards for tax purposes where certain
         specified requirements are met.  Outside the operation of that
         specific election, Division 230 achieves, through the operation of
         a range of other provisions, a substantial level of consistency
         with the concepts and treatments used in accounting standards.
         This close alignment is most evident in respect of the methods used
         for accruals purposes and the concepts, methods and measurements
         available under the fair value election, the retranslation election
         and the hedging election.


     19. In developing this framework, particular regard was given to the
         following Australian versions of the international accounting
         standards: Australian Accounting Standard AASB 132 Financial
         Instruments:  Disclosure and Presentation (AASB 132) and Australian
         Accounting Standard AASB 139 Financial Instruments:  Recognition
         and Measurement (AASB 139).  The framework also takes into account
         other accounting standards such as Australian Accounting Standard
         AASB 7 Financial Instruments:  Disclosures (AASB 7), Australian
         Accounting Standard AASB 101 Presentation of Financial Statements
         (AASB 101), Australian Accounting Standard AASB 118 Revenue (AASB
         118), Australian Accounting Standard AASB 121 The Effects of
         Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates (AASB 121), Australian Accounting
         Standard AASB 127 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements
         (AASB 127) and Australian Accounting Standard AASB  137 Provisions,
         Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets (AASB 137).


Summary of new law


     20. This legislation is built on a principle-based framework for the
         taxation of gains and losses from financial arrangements.  Gains
         from financial arrangements are assessable and losses are
         deductible.  A set of principles and rules within the framework
         tells taxpayers how to work out gains and losses each income year.


     21. The legislation generally applies to all 'financial arrangements'
         as defined in Subdivision 230-A or included by the additional
         operation of Subdivision 230-J.  However, certain financial
         arrangements are effectively subject to an exception under
         Subdivision 230-H.


     22. Division 230 provides a range of elective methods for determining
         gains and losses, including the elective fair value method, the
         elective retranslation method, the elective hedging method and the
         elective financial reports method.  Where these elective methods
         are not, or cannot be, adopted the tax treatment defaults to either
         the accruals or realisation method.


     23. This legislation does not apply to:


                . financial arrangements of individuals except where the
                  arrangement is a qualifying security and its remaining
                  life after acquisition is more than 12 months or where the
                  taxpayer elects to have Division 230 apply to all of its
                  financial arrangements;


                . financial arrangements of superannuation funds (both
                  regulated and self managed), approved deposit funds,
                  pooled superannuation funds or an entity that is a managed
                  investment scheme for the purposes of the Corporations
                  Act 2001 where the value of the entity's assets are less
                  than $100 million except where the arrangement is a
                  qualifying security and its remaining life after
                  acquisition is more than 12 months or where the taxpayer
                  elects to have Division 230 apply to all of its financial
                  arrangements;


                . financial arrangements of authorised deposit-taking
                  institutions (ADIs), securitisation vehicles and financial
                  sector entities with an aggregated annual turnover of less
                  than $20 million per year except where the arrangement is
                  a qualifying security and its remaining life after
                  acquisition is more than 12 months or where the taxpayer
                  elects to have Division 230 apply to all of its financial
                  arrangements; or


                . financial arrangements of other entities:


                  - with an aggregated annual turnover of less than
                    $100 million;


                  - where the value of the entity's financial assets are
                    less than $100 million; and


                  - where the value of the entity's assets is less than
                    $300 million,


                except where the arrangement is a qualifying security and
                its remaining life after acquisition is more than 12 months
                or where the taxpayer elects to have Division 230 apply to
                all of its financial arrangements.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|The new law contains a  |No comprehensive set of |
|comprehensive set of    |provisions exists for   |
|principles and rules for|the taxation of         |
|the tax-timing and      |financial arrangements. |
|character treatment of  |Comprehensive hedging   |
|gains and losses from   |rules and a general     |
|financial arrangements. |retranslation treatment |
|                        |do not exist.  There is |
|There are six tax       |no fair value tax       |
|methods:                |treatment in the current|
|elective reliance on    |law except in the       |
|financial reports;      |trading stock provisions|
|elective fair value;    |which have limited      |
|elective retranslation; |application.  Rules of  |
|elective hedging;       |an ad hoc and relatively|
|accruals; and           |limited nature apply to |
|realisation.            |certain specific        |
|There is a general      |financial arrangements, |
|balancing adjustment for|namely to:              |
|when an entity ceases to|accrue gains and losses |
|have a financial        |of discounted and       |
|arrangement.            |deferred interest       |
|Generally gains are     |securities;             |
|assessable and losses   |assess gains and losses |
|are deductible.         |on the disposal of      |
|Not all taxpayers will  |'traditional securities'|
|be subject to Division  |such as bonds and       |
|230.                    |debentures;             |
|                        |allow a deduction for   |
|                        |bad debts in certain    |
|                        |circumstances;          |
|                        |reflect gains from the  |
|                        |forgiveness of          |
|                        |commercial debts; and   |
|                        |assess gains and losses |
|                        |from foreign currency   |
|                        |transactions.           |


Detailed explanation of new law


Approach to tax reforms for financial arrangements


     24. Achieving the optimal set of tax reforms for financial arrangements
         requires the balancing of the objectives of greater efficiency and
         lower compliance costs with rules to ensure the integrity of the
         tax system within a complex financial environment.  This part of
         the chapter discusses the manner in which the reforms to tax
         treatments have been approached with these factors in mind.


     25. The Division 230 framework more closely aligns the recognition of
         gains and losses on financial arrangements with commercial norms.


     26. Regard to that commercial context is given effect by:


                . incorporating financial accounting concepts and methods
                  and hedging rules into the framework;


                . providing an election to rely on financial reports;


                . incorporating some flexibility in the tax-timing
                  treatments for financial arrangements; and


                . placing many financial arrangements on revenue account.


         Financial accounting concepts and methods


     27. The default approach for Division 230 is accruals treatment of
         gains and losses.  Where gains or losses are not sufficiently
         certain a realisation basis is used.  In addition, Division 230
         incorporates four elective tax methods:  an election to rely on
         financial reports, elective fair value, elective retranslation and
         elective hedging.  The fair value, retranslation, hedging and the
         financial reports methodologies are not recognised, to any
         significant extent, under the current income tax law.  Their
         adoption as part of these reforms reflects the different methods
         found in financial accounting standards and practice.  That is, the
         so-called 'mixed model' approach in financial accounting is an
         inherent feature of the Division 230 framework.


     28. The mixed model approach in turn reflects alternative functional
         applications and the different ways in which financial arrangements
         are used for commercial purposes (ie, trading, investing/financing
         and hedging).


     29. While financial accounting standards may provide important
         information for investors, they may not be an appropriate basis for
         taxation.  The reason for this is that the standards aim to give
         investors information upon which they can make financial decisions,
         including making assessments about the stewardship of the entity in
         question during a particular accounting period.


     30. Financial accounting standards covering the measurement of gains
         and losses from financial arrangements have adopted fair value
         accounting as a default treatment to better reflect commercial
         realities and to expose the potential risks in using derivatives.
         The mandatory use of the fair value treatment in a tax context
         could result in taxpayers being required to pay tax on large,
         unsystematic, unrealised gains which do not eventuate, potentially
         causing cash flow difficulties.


     31. However, allowing taxpayers to access fair value tax treatment
         through an elective regime may facilitate price-making in relation
         to market-making portfolios of financial arrangements typically
         held by financial institutions.  It could also provide overall
         compliance cost savings for taxpayers who prepare financial reports
         in accordance with the new financial accounting standards.


     32. Division 230 provides an elective regime for the recognition of
         gains and losses on a fair value basis for income tax purposes in
         respect of those financial arrangements which are fair valued
         through the profit or loss statement.  Chapter 6 explains the
         operation of this election.


     33. Similarly, Division 230 allows elective tax treatment for
         retranslation and hedging (see Chapters 7 and 8 respectively).


     34. This legislation also includes an election for taxpayers to rely on
         their financial reports for taxation purposes in respect of their
         financial arrangements, subject to specified conditions (see
         Chapter 9).


     35. Appropriate safeguards are required to ensure that the use of the
         elective regimes does not lead to adverse selection opportunities
         or other inappropriate tax outcomes.  The safeguards are explained
         in the relevant chapters of this explanatory memorandum.  Chapter 5
         discusses the general requirements common to all elective
         Subdivisions.  Additional specific requirements relevant to each
         election are outlined in the specific chapters (ie, Chapters 6 to
         9) covering the elective tax treatments.


         Flexibility in tax-timing treatments


     36. Substantial flexibility exists in the application of tax-timing
         methods.  For example:


                . there is no prescriptive basis for valuation under the
                  fair value and retranslation tax elections, other than the
                  proper application of the financial accounting standard on
                  which these elections are based;


                . if the compounding accruals basis is required for a
                  financial arrangement, any compounding interval that is
                  not longer than 12 months can be used.  A reasonable
                  approximation of this basis may also be adopted.  The
                  effective interest method used in accounting standards is
                  generally permissible; and


                . there is flexibility as to the allocation period under the
                  hedging method, provided certain safeguards are met.


     37. To prevent this flexibility from being exploited for income tax
         purposes, the legislative framework requires that a particular
         manner of allocating gains and losses has to be applied
         consistently.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-80]


     38. Reliance on broad, clearly enunciated principles where appropriate,
         rather than highly prescriptive rules, should provide greater
         stability to the tax framework, allowing it to better cope with
         financial innovation and the flexibility of financial arrangements
         themselves.


         Placing many financial arrangements on revenue account


     39. With some exceptions, gains and losses from financial arrangements
         are generally to be taxed on revenue account (see Chapter 3 for
         more detail) [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-15].  This removes
         the complex capital/revenue distinction for many financial
         arrangements.


         The legislative approach


     40. Division 230 tells a taxpayer how to work out the amount of gain or
         loss in an income year using the following steps:


                . identify a financial arrangement (step 1);


                . determine whether an exclusion from the Division applies
                  to gains and losses from the financial arrangement (step
                  2);


                . determine which tax method will apply to the financial
                  arrangement and, using relevant tax-timing treatments,
                  work out the gains and losses from the financial
                  arrangement for each income year (step 3); and


                . determine whether the gains or losses from the financial
                  arrangement are assessable or deductible (step 4).


Identification of a financial arrangement


     41. A financial arrangement is the core unit upon which a tax liability
         is determined under Division 230.


     42. Subdivision 230-A provides the test for determining whether an
         arrangement is a financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, section
         230-45].  In this context an arrangement consists of all the rights
         and obligations (including contingent rights or obligations
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-85]), that are appropriately
         considered to be part of the same arrangement.  Section 230-55 sets
         out the factors to be considered when determining what rights or
         obligations comprise an arrangement or two or more separate
         arrangements [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-55].  Importantly,
         whether there is one or more arrangements takes into account normal
         commercial understandings.


     43. Under this test, relevant rights and obligations under an
         arrangement comprise a financial arrangement to the extent they are
         'cash settlable' legal or equitable rights or obligations to
         receive or provide financial benefits, or combinations thereof, and
         the arrangement does not consist of any other subsisting non-
         insignificant rights or obligations [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-5(1) and 230-45(1)].  The meaning of the term 'cash
         settlable', and its relationship to money or money equivalence, and
         to intentions, purposes and commercial practices, is defined by
         this test, and explained in Chapter 2 [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-45(2)].


     44. Some common examples of financial arrangements are:


                . debt-type arrangements, including loans, bonds, promissory
                  notes and debentures; and


                . risk-shifting derivatives, including swaps, forwards and
                  options.


     45. An equity interest (such as an ordinary share) is also a financial
         arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-5(2)(b) and section
         230-50], but not all tax-timing methods will apply to equity
         interests (for instance, an equity interest will not be subject to
         the accruals or realisation tax-timing methods) [Schedule 1, item
         1, paragraph 230-40(4)(e)].


     46. A simple delayed settlement is a financial arrangement, where the
         payment occurs some time after the relevant thing is delivered.
         This is because from the time of delivery the only subsisting
         rights and obligations under such an arrangement are cash
         settlable.  However, where the period between delivery and the time
         for payment is 12 months or less, gains and losses from the
         financial arrangement are excluded from Division 230 [Schedule 1,
         item 1, section 230-450].  More complex financial arrangements
         include hybrid financial arrangements.


     47. Arrangements which are not 'financial arrangements' under the
         definition include arrangements for the purchase of property
         (except property that is itself a financial arrangement), goods or
         services and arrangements, where payment is made on entering into
         the arrangement but delivery of the property, goods or services is
         deferred (usually referred to as prepayments).  This is because
         such arrangements have non-insignificant non-cash settlable rights
         and obligations throughout the life of the arrangement.  This fact,
         together with the exclusion for deferred payments of less than 12
         months (discussed above), means that most construction contracts,
         contracts for the provision of services and arrangements known as
         farm-out arrangements will generally be excluded from the operation
         of Division 230.


     48. A number of things that do not satisfy the definition of 'financial
         arrangement' are specifically included in the scope of Division 230
         by virtue of Subdivision 230-J.  These are:


                . foreign currency;


                . non-equity shares; and


                . commodities and offsetting commodity contracts held by
                  traders.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision 230-J]


     49. Chapter 2 explains what arrangements meet the definition of a
         'financial arrangement' or are otherwise treated as financial
         arrangements.


Determine whether an exclusion applies to the arrangement


     50. A number of financial arrangements have gains and losses from them
         excluded from the provisions of Division 230.  The main categories
         of excluded arrangements are:


                . financial arrangements held by individuals that are not
                  qualifying securities, and qualifying securities held by
                  individuals which have a remaining life at the time of
                  acquisition of 12 months or less [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-5(2)(a) and section 230-455];


                . financial arrangements held by entities whose business is
                  essentially financial in nature with less than $100
                  million in assets or $20 million aggregated annual
                  turnover;


                . or other entities (other than individuals) with:


                  - less than $100 million aggregated annual turnover;


                  - less than $100 million in financial assets; and


                  - less than $300 million in assets;


                . which are not qualifying securities, and qualifying
                  securities held by such entities which have a remaining
                  life at the time of acquisition of 12 months or less
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-5(2)(a) and section 230-
                  455];


                . short-term financial arrangements where a non-monetary
                  amount (property, goods or services) is involved [Schedule
                  1, item 1, section 230-450]; and


                . gains on the forgiveness of commercial debts [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, section 230-470].


     51. Other particular arrangements have gains and losses excluded from
         the Division to the extent to which they arise from specific rights
         and obligations that are leasing or licensing arrangements over
         real and intellectual property, certain interests in partnerships
         or trusts, certain insurance policies, certain rights or
         obligations under a workers' compensation scheme, certain
         guarantees or indemnities, personal arrangements and personal
         injury, certain superannuation and pension income arrangements,
         interests in a controlled foreign company, interests in a foreign
         investment fund, retirement village residence and services
         contracts, arrangements under which residential care or flexible
         care is provided, proceeds from certain 'earn-out' business sales,
         arrangements to which Division 16L of the ITAA 1936 applies,
         arrangements to which section 121EK of the ITAA 1936 applies, a
         right to receive (or obligation to provide) a farm management
         deposit where the taxpayer is the owner of that deposit and
         interests in forestry-managed investment schemes which are
         deductible under Division 394 of the ITAA 1997.  The list of
         specific exclusions may be added to by regulation.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, section 230-460 and subsections 230-475(3) and (4)]


     52. If an arrangement is excluded, other provisions of the tax law may
         apply to the arrangement.


     53. Chapter 2 explains what financial arrangements have their gains and
         losses excluded from Division 230.


Apply the appropriate tax method to work out the gain or loss for the
income year


     54. One or more of the following tax methods applies to every financial
         arrangement that is subject to Division 230:


                . Non-elective methods:


                  - compounding accruals [Schedule 1, item 1,
                    Subdivision 230-B];


                  - realisation [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision 230-B];
                    and/or


                  - balancing adjustment [Schedule 1, item 1,
                    Subdivision 230-G];


                and/or;


                . Elective methods:


                  - elective fair value [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision 230-
                    C];


                  - elective retranslation [Schedule 1, item 1,
                    Subdivision 230-D];


                  - elective hedging [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision 230-
                    E]; and


                  - elective financial reports [Schedule 1, item 1,
                    Subdivision 230-F].


     55. Use of any of the elective methods requires that the taxpayer have
         financial reports prepared and audited in accordance with relevant
         financial accounting and auditing standards.


         Diagram 1:  Hierarchy of tax treatments (excluding balancing
         adjustments)






















































     56. As well as the above tax methods, a balancing adjustment is
         generally required to be calculated when a taxpayer ceases to have
         a financial arrangement, or transfers part of a financial
         arrangement to someone else [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision 230-
         G].  A separate balancing adjustment may also arise where an
         election ceases to apply to a financial arrangement [Schedule 1,
         item 1, sections 230-245, 230-290 and 230-430].


     57. The tax methods determine the basis for calculating what amounts
         are assessable or deductible in each income year.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, section 230-40]


         Elective fair value method


     58. The elective fair value method allocates gains and losses from a
         financial arrangement to each income year in accordance with
         changes in the fair value.  If elected, the method applies to all
         financial arrangements acquired in the income year in which the
         election is made, or in a later income year, that are classified or
         designated as at fair value through profit or loss for the purposes
         of relevant accounting standards, where they are reported in
         financial reports prepared and audited in accordance with relevant
         accounting and auditing standards.  This method is elective, but
         once a taxpayer elects to apply it to arrangements reported in its
         financial reports, the election generally applies to those
         arrangements for all future income years.  An election will cease
         to apply to a financial arrangement where relevant criteria are no
         longer satisfied [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision 230-C].  A
         balancing adjustment must be made if the fair value election ceases
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-245].


     59. Chapter 6 explains the fair value method in more detail.


         Elective foreign exchange retranslation method


     60. The elective retranslation method allocates gains and losses from
         changes in the value of foreign currency to the income year in
         which the change occurs.  The elective foreign exchange
         retranslation method may apply to:


                . all relevant arrangements that are, subject to
                  retranslation treatment under a relevant accounting
                  standard, are reported in a relevant financial report
                  prepared and audited in accordance with relevant
                  accounting and auditing standards [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  Subdivision 230-D], and which are acquired in the year in
                  which the election is made or later years; or


                . designated qualifying foreign exchange accounts [Schedule
                  1, item 1, Subdivision 230-D].


     61. The effect of applying this Subdivision is that, for tax-timing
         purposes, the taxpayer will generally recognise gains and losses
         from the foreign currency component independently of gains and
         losses from the rest of the arrangement.  Accordingly, this method
         may apply in addition to other tax-timing methods.


     62. The foreign exchange retranslation method only applies where the
         taxpayer elects to apply it.


     63. An entity can make a foreign currency retranslation election in
         respect of a qualifying foreign exchange account after it starts to
         have the account.  In such cases, a balancing adjustment is
         required to bring to account any unrealised foreign currency gains
         or losses on the account.  Like the fair value election, the
         foreign exchange retranslation election will cease to apply where
         relevant criteria are no longer satisfied and a balancing
         adjustment will be necessary when the foreign currency
         retranslation election ceases to have effect [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-290].  It should be noted that the balancing adjustment
         in relation to the cessation of the foreign currency retranslation
         election captures only the foreign currency component of the
         relevant financial arrangement.


     64. Chapter 7 explains the elective foreign exchange retranslation
         method in detail.  For taxpayers subject to Division 230, foreign
         currency denominated arrangements excluded from the operation of
         Division 230 can be retranslated under the retranslation provisions
         in Division 775 of the ITAA 1997.


         Elective hedging method


     65. The elective hedging method allocates gains and losses from a
         hedging financial arrangement on a basis that corresponds with the
         gains and losses from the relevant hedged item.  The hedging rules
         provide for both tax-timing and tax classification (ie, capital,
         revenue, assessable, exempt, non-assessable non-exempt) matching.
         The scope of the hedging treatment is determined by the coverage of
         'hedging financial arrangements' defined for accounting standards
         purposes but can include certain other financial arrangements.  To
         use the elective hedging method the taxpayer must have financial
         reports prepared and audited in accordance with relevant financial
         accounting and auditing standards [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision
         230-E], and must meet certain other requirements, including record-
         keeping and hedge effectiveness criteria.


     66. The balancing adjustment required under Subdivision 230-G is not
         required in relation to a financial arrangement that is covered by
         the hedging financial arrangement election.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-440(2)]


     67. Chapter 8 explains the elective hedging method in detail.


         Election to rely on financial reports


     68. The election to rely on financial reports determines gains and
         losses from financial arrangements by reference to relevant
         accounting standards.  This election effectively aligns the tax
         treatment of relevant arrangements to the accounting treatment.


     69. To make this election the taxpayer needs to have financial reports
         which are prepared and audited in accordance with relevant
         accounting and auditing standards.  Other requirements include that
         the relevant auditor's report must be unqualified, and meeting
         certain standards in relation to accounting systems and controls.


     70. Further, the election can only apply to a financial arrangement if
         it is reasonably expected that the difference between the amount of
         the overall gain or loss (and its allocation over time derived from
         using the accounting reports) and that which would be determined
         under the other provisions of Division 230 would reasonably be
         expected not to be substantial.  [Schedule 1, item 1, Subdivision
         230-F]


     71. A balancing adjustment is required when the election to rely on
         financial reports ceases to apply.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section
         230-430]


     72. Chapter 9 explains the financial reports election in detail.


         Compounding accruals and realisation methods


     73. All financial arrangements within the scope of Division 230 (after
         taking into account any exceptions or additions) will have gains
         and losses worked out using the accruals or realisation methods
         unless:


                . an elective method applies to the arrangement.  However,
                  in the case of the elective foreign currency retranslation
                  method (where that method applies to determine the foreign
                  currency gain or loss from the arrangement) the accruals
                  or realisation treatment may still apply to determine the
                  non-foreign currency gain or loss component of the
                  financial arrangement; or


                . the arrangement is an equity interest or is a right to
                  receive or an obligation to provide an equity interest and
                  that right or obligation is not 'cash settlable'.


         Compounding accruals method


     74. The compounding accruals method allocates gains and losses from a
         financial arrangement to income years according to an implicit rate
         of return.  This rate of return is commercially known as the
         'internal rate of return' or the 'effective interest rate'.  The
         compounding accruals method applies when an overall, or a
         particular, gain or loss from a financial arrangement is
         sufficiently certain.  An amount or value is 'sufficiently certain'
         if it is 'fixed or determinable with reasonable accuracy'.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-100, 230-105, 230-115 and 230-
         135]


     75. Where material changes are made to terms or conditions or
         circumstances that affect arrangements, taxpayers are required to
         make fresh assessments of gains and losses subject to accruals
         treatment.  In certain circumstances they may need to re-estimate
         relevant gains and losses.  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-185
         and 230-190]


     76. These are special accruals rules in respect of premiums, discounts
         and fees associated with certain financial arrangements where the
         arrangements are part of a portfolio of similar financial
         arrangements where the net amount of the premium, discount of fees
         is not significant.  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-150, 230-160
         and 230-165]


     77. A running balancing adjustment is made to correct for any
         underestimation or overestimation resulting from application of the
         accruals method.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-175]


     78. Chapter 4 explains the compounding accruals method in more detail.


         Realisation method


     79. The realisation method allocates gains and losses to income years
         when they occur, which will generally be when the relevant
         financial benefit representing the gain or loss is due to be
         provided or received, as the case may be.  This method applies to
         the extent that the compounding accruals method or the elective
         methods do not apply.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-40(4)
         and 230-100(5) and section 230-180]


     80. Chapter 4 explains the realisation method in more detail.


Available choices among the tax treatments


     81. Gains and losses a taxpayer makes when they cease to hold a
         financial arrangement (including if they transfer part of a
         financial arrangement) other than a hedging financial arrangement
         are recognised using the balancing adjustment provisions, and not
         under any of the other methods (see Chapter 10).  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-40(1), Subdivision 230-G]


     82. However, while a taxpayer holds a financial arrangement, gains and
         losses they make from that arrangement can be calculated under the
         accruals or realisation methods or any of the elective methods
         (subject to the relevant criteria being satisfied).  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-40(1)]


     83. Amongst the elective methods, the elective hedging method, to the
         extent that it is applicable, takes priority over the other
         elective methods.  Subject to this, if an election to rely on
         financial reports is made, gains and losses from all relevant
         financial arrangements are determined using this method.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsections 230-40(2) and (7)]


     84. Where the fair value treatment applies to the whole of a financial
         arrangement, the taxpayer does not have to consider other tax-
         timing methods (except to the extent to which the elective hedging
         method or the election to rely on financial reports applies to the
         financial arrangement).  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-40(5)]


     85. However, if the fair value treatment applies to only a part of a
         financial arrangement then the other part is deemed to be a
         separate financial arrangement and must be subject to another tax-
         timing treatment.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-235]


     86. The foreign exchange retranslation method may apply to determine
         the foreign currency component of gains or losses from a financial
         arrangement only if none of the other elective methods apply to
         that arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-40(6)].  If
         the retranslation method and other elective methods do not apply,
         the foreign currency gain or loss may be taxed on a realisation
         basis.


     87. If the financial arrangement is subject to one of the elective
         methods (other than the retranslation method), the accruals and
         realisation methods will not apply.  Where the foreign exchange
         retranslation method applies to the financial arrangement, the
         accruals or realisation methods will also apply to determine any
         gains or losses from the financial arrangement, to the extent they
         are not attributable to currency exchange movements.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-40(4)]


     88. Neither the accruals, realisation, nor retranslation methods will
         apply to a financial arrangement that is an equity interest, or to
         other 'equity' financial arrangements within the meaning of
         subsection 230-50(2).  The hedging method will only apply to a
         financial arrangement that is an equity interest if it is a foreign
         currency hedge and is issued by the taxpayer.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-40(4)(e) and sections 230-270 and 230-330]


     89. Finally, the realisation method will apply to a gain or loss from a
         financial arrangement only where the accruals method does not
         apply.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-100(5)]


If the year is the final holding year, work out any gain or loss from
ceasing to have the financial arrangement


     90. In the last year that a taxpayer holds a financial arrangement, the
         taxpayer needs to work out the gain or loss it makes from ceasing
         to hold the financial arrangement.  This is to ensure that the
         total gain assessable, or the total loss deductible, on the
         arrangement reflects the actual gain or loss [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-435 and subsection 230-40(1)].  Chapter 10 addresses
         the treatment of gains and losses from ceasing to hold a financial
         arrangement.


Integrity rules


         Consistency


     91. Gains and losses must be worked out consistently for each financial
         arrangement through time.  This means that the methods used should
         be used consistently both from year to year for a particular
         financial arrangement (subject to a particular method ceasing to
         apply, for example where the requirements for its application are
         no longer met), and where the taxpayer is entitled to choose to
         apply a method in a particular manner they must use the same manner
         for all financial arrangements that are of a similar nature.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-80]


         Value shifting


     92. Broadly, the value shifting rules prevent inappropriate tax
         consequences where, under a scheme, value is shifted from equity or
         loan interests.  Gains which are reduced, or losses which are
         increased, in this manner are to be disregarded under Division 230
         in determining tax outcomes for financial arrangements.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, section 230-520]


         Arm's length rules


     93. Broadly, Division 230 will incorporate arm's length rules that are
         consistent with those that apply to arrangements not covered by the
         Division.  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-510 and 230-515]


Application and transitional provisions


     94. The rules will apply to financial arrangements acquired on or after
         the first day of the first income year starting on or after 1 July
         2010.  A taxpayer may also elect to apply the rules to financial
         arrangements acquired on or after the first day of the first income
         year starting on or after 1 July 2009.


     95. A taxpayer may elect to apply the rules contained in Division 230
         to existing arrangements (ie, to those financial arrangements which
         the taxpayer acquired before the start of the first applicable
         income year but still held at that time).  Such an election may
         give rise to an amount in the nature of a transitional 'balancing
         adjustment' if the amount taken into account under the ITAA 1936
         and the ITAA 1997 prior to the application of Division 230 differs
         from the amount that would have been taken into account under
         Division 230 if it had applied from the commencement of the
         arrangement.  There are also special transitional balancing
         adjustment rules for arrangements subject to Subdivision 775-F (see
         Chapters 7 and 13).  The transitional balancing adjustment is to be
         spread over the first applicable income year and the next three
         income years [Schedule 1, Part 3, items 102 to 105].  The election
         to apply Division 230 to existing arrangements does not extend to
         the alignment of tax classification treatment for gains and losses
         from hedging financial arrangements under Subdivision 230-E where
         the taxpayer first started to hold the arrangement prior to the
         commencement of Division 230 [Schedule 1, Part 3, subitem 104(10)].
          Chapter 13 explains the application and transitional provisions in
         more detail.



Chapter 2
Definition of 'financial arrangement'

Outline of chapter


     96. Division 230 uses the term 'financial arrangement' as the item to
         which taxation applies.  Gains and losses in relation to a
         financial arrangement are taken into account in determining taxable
         income.


     97. This chapter sets out:


                . the meaning and scope of the term 'financial arrangement';


                . which financial arrangements are specifically excluded
                  from the operation of Division 230; and


                . the additional operation of Division 230 to certain
                  things.


Overview of the definition of 'financial arrangement'


     98. A Division 230 financial arrangement is an arrangement where the
         rights and obligations under that arrangement are cash settlable.


     99. Besides financial arrangements, Division 230 will also apply to
         certain arrangements that are not financial arrangements but have
         very similar characteristics.  For example, foreign currency and
         non-equity shares.


    100. However, the gains and losses from certain financial arrangements,
         such as some short term arrangements arising out of the provision
         of goods or services, and arrangements held by individuals and
         small business, where there is no significant deferral of gains,
         will generally not be subject to tax under Division 230.


    101. Often, the time to determine whether an arrangement is a financial
         arrangement will be at the time the arrangement comes into
         existence or commences to be held.  However, Division 230 also
         provides for testing throughout the life of arrangements.


Cash settlable rights and obligations


    102. In the context of Division 230, obligations and rights are cash
         settlable where they may be settled by money or money equivalent.


    103. Basically, money is cash or a unit of Australian currency.  A money
         equivalent typically sounds in money and has a liquidity that is
         similar to that of cash.  Examples of money equivalent include
         bonds and loans.


    104. However, an arrangement will not be a financial arrangement if the
         cash settlable rights and obligations are insignificant compared to
         other rights and obligations under the arrangement or if the cash
         settlable rights and obligations no longer exist.


Additional operation of Division 230


    105. Division 230 extends to certain assets and contracts that would not
         ordinarily come within the definition of a Division 230 financial
         arrangement.  While these assets and contracts may not be cash
         settlable financial arrangements, they share some of the key
         characteristics of such arrangements, for example because of their
         money-like nature or the way they are dealt with by relevant
         parties to the arrangement.


    106. The additional operation of Division 230 applies to:


                . equity interests;


                . foreign currency;


                . non-equity shares in companies; and


                . certain commodities and offsetting commodity contracts.


    107. Equity interests that are financial arrangements are only subject
         to either the elective fair value method or the election to rely on
         financial reports and in limited circumstances the elective tax
         hedge method.


Specifically excepted gains and losses of certain financial arrangements


    108. Division 230 does not apply to certain gains or losses made from a
         financial arrangement for compliance cost or other policy reasons.
         Such arrangements include:


                . short term arrangements where amounts that are not money
                  for example, short term trade credit; and either:


                  - a financial arrangement that is given in exchange for
                    property or services;


                  - an arrangement where there is 12 months or less delay in
                    payment after receipt of property or services;


                  - arrangement is not a cash settlable financial
                    arrangement;


                  - arrangement is not a derivative financial arrangement;
                    or


                  - a fair value election does not apply to the arrangement;
                    or


                . arrangements held by individuals and entities that satisfy
                  the threshold tests where there is no significant deferral
                  of tax.


    109. There are also exceptions for various rights and/or obligations
         including those in respect of:


                . leasing arrangements;


                . an asset to which Division 250 of the Income Tax
                  Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997) applies;


                . interests in partnerships and trust;


                . life insurance policies;


                . general insurance policies;


                . certain worker's compensation arrangements;


                . certain guarantees and indemnities;


                . personal arrangements and personal injury:


                  - personal services;


                  - deceased estates;


                  - gifts under deed;


                  - personal injury; or


                  - injury to reputation;


                . superannuation and pension income;


                . interests in a foreign investment fund, foreign life
                  policy or a controlled foreign company;


                . proceeds from certain business sales including 'earn-
                  outs';


                . infrastructure borrowings;


                . farm management deposits;


                . deemed interest payments to owners of offshore banking
                  units;


                . forestry managed investment schemes;


                . ceasing to hold financial arrangements in certain
                  circumstances;


                . forgiveness of commercial debts; or


                . franked distributions.


    110. Gains and losses from certain financial arrangements are excluded
         from Division 230 for the avoidance of doubt.  They include
         retirement village residence contracts, retirement village services
         contracts and provision of residential or flexible care.


Context of amendments


What is a financial arrangement?


    111. Financial innovation has created an endless variety of arrangements
         under which finance is provided or risk is shifted.  The
         characteristics of such arrangements can mean that arrangements
         similar in form can vary significantly in terms of the risks and
         benefits involved, or that there is very little difference in
         substance notwithstanding that the form and the name given to the
         two are quite different.


    112. Traditionally the income tax law has tended to place emphasis on
         the legal form of the arrangement to determine its tax treatment.
         This is not sustainable in the face of modern financial innovation.
          More recently, specific areas of income tax law have been designed
         so that tax treatments better reflect the economic and commercial
         characteristics of arrangements:  see, for example, the debt/equity
         rules in Division 974 of the ITAA 1997.


    113. Reflecting this trend - and the need to minimise the distortionary
         tax treatment that can arise under the current tax law in respect
         of economically similar financial arrangements - development of a
         set of principles to establish the definitional scope of financing
         and risk shifting arrangements for the purposes of Division 230 has
         taken into account the common economic substance underpinning all
         such arrangements.  As well, account has been taken of the need to
         align tax (to the greatest extent possible) with the commercial
         recognition of gains and losses from financial arrangements.
         Centred on these foundations the general and broadly applicable
         definition of a 'financial arrangement' adopted in Division 230 is
         intended to enhance tax neutrality, consistency and the functional
         effectiveness of the tax system.


    114. A possible approach to the definition of 'financial arrangement'
         would be to rely on the relevant definitions in financial
         accounting standards.  For example, the scope of Australian
         Accounting Standard AASB 132 Financial Instruments:  Disclosure and
         Presentation (AASB 132) is governed by the definition of the term
         'financial instrument' which, in turn, is based on definitions of
         the terms 'financial asset' and 'financial liability'.  For
         measurement purposes, Australian Accounting Standard AASB 139
         Financial Instruments:  Recognition and Measurement (AASB 139)
         adopts the same meaning of 'financial instrument' as used in AASB
         132.


    115. The Division 230 definition of 'financial arrangement' draws on and
         closely corresponds with the definitions in these accounting
         standards.  A complete alignment was not considered appropriate
         after consideration was given to a range of factors including those
         set out in the paragraphs below.


    116. The AASB 132 definition of 'financial instrument' was developed in
         a different context to that relevant to the tax law.  First, that
         standard is but one of a number of interrelated standards that form
         a broader financial accounting framework.  These accounting
         standards have different purposes to the income tax system.


    117. Second, the approach of AASB 132 and AASB 139 to the question of
         scope appears to be based on rights and obligations under
         individual contracts.  However, the provision of finance and risk-
         shifting can occur through arrangements that comprise one or more
         contracts (eg, stapled securities) and by way of rights and
         obligations that are not necessarily founded on contract.


    118. Third, not all entities subject to Division 230 would be required
         to prepare financial accounts which classify arrangements based on
         the definitions in AASB 139.  If the scope of the Division was
         based on the scope of particular financial accounting standards,
         these entities would need to understand, or obtain advice on, the
         scope of relevant financial accounting standards, including changes
         to these standards and their interpretation, merely for income tax
         purposes.  Such entities may view such compliance as burdensome and
         unfair.


    119. Against this background, the definition of 'financial arrangement'
         for the purposes of Division 230 is cast in terms of what
         fundamental and common elements, in principle, characterise both
         the provision of finance and the shifting or allocation of risk.
         In this regard, key common elements of all financial arrangements
         are the right to receive, or obligation to provide, a financial
         benefit (irrespective of whether the value or existence of the
         right or obligation is contingent on some event or other thing)
         which is:


                . monetary in nature;


                . non-monetary in nature and may be settled by money or a
                  money equivalent; or


                . in substance and effect monetary in nature.


    120. Collectively, these rights and obligations are described in
         Division 230 as 'cash settlable'.


    121. Limiting the definition of financial arrangement solely to formal
         (legal) rights to receive, or obligations to provide, financial
         benefits of a monetary nature would not facilitate tax neutrality
         and consistency, or enable the taxation of certain transactions to
         be aligned with commercial outcomes.  In particular, this could
         occur where the right to receive, or the obligation to provide, a
         financial benefit is of a non-monetary nature but having regard to
         factors such as the pricing, terms and conditions of the
         arrangement, business practices, the intention of the parties, or
         the nature of the activities relating to the arrangement, those
         rights and obligations will be likely settled in monetary terms.
         This is why the cash settlable rights and obligations relevant for
         Division 230 purposes include those which are in substance or
         effect monetary in nature.


    122. Because the definition of 'financial arrangement' in Division 230
         is based on characteristics common to all financial arrangements it
         will cope better with future financial innovation than would a
         definition based on legal form or on lists of arrangements.  In
         that sense the definition is considered to be appropriately
         comprehensive and durable.


Additions and exceptions


    123. Equity interests, including rights to receive, and obligations to
         provide, equity interests, are specifically brought into the scope
         of Division 230 as a separate category of financial arrangement.
         However, gains and losses made from these 'equity' financial
         arrangements will be subject to Division 230 only in limited
         circumstances.


    124. In addition to the general definition for financial arrangements
         and 'equity' financial arrangements, specific inclusion provisions
         exist to ensure that arrangements which can operate in a similar
         way to these defined financial arrangements are bought within the
         scope of Division 230 - specifically, foreign currency, non-equity
         shares and commodities and offsetting commodity contracts in
         certain circumstances.


    125. Division 230 also provides for various exceptions which exclude
         gains and losses made from particular financial arrangements from
         being subject to Division 230.  For example, there are
         circumstances in which an arrangement that conceptually comes
         within the scope of the definition of financial arrangement is
         covered by another specific area of the income tax law, and there
         are policy reasons for it to continue to be so covered.  In such
         cases, gains and losses from the arrangement are specifically
         excluded from being dealt with under Division 230.


    126. In addition, there are compliance and administrative reasons for
         excluding other types of arrangements from treatment under Division
         230.  Those arrangements are also the subject of either a general
         or specific exclusion.


    127. The scope of Division 230 should therefore be considered by looking
         at what, by definition, is a financial arrangement together with
         the exclusions and the additional operation of the Division.


    128. The Board of Tax's 'review of foreign source income anti-tax
         deferral rules' is currently considering the operation of the tax
         law in relation to interests held in controlled foreign companies
         as well as foreign investment funds and non-resident trusts more
         widely.  Consequently, how Division 230 should apply in relation to
         interests in these entities will receive further consideration in
         the light of outcomes of that review.


Unit of taxation


    129. The definition of 'financial arrangement' is important because it
         determines the unit of taxation in respect of which gains and
         losses are recognised under Division 230.  That is, the applicable
         tax-timing methods apply in relation to a defined financial
         arrangement (and to those arising from the additional operation of
         this Division) to determine the gains and losses that will be
         subject to Division 230 (excluding financial arrangements from
         which the gains and losses are covered by an exception).


    130. A financial arrangement is an arrangement which at the relevant
         time satisfies the definition of financial arrangement under
         Division 230.


    131. Typically, an arrangement will be constituted by a contract.
         Generally, this would be the case for ordinary financial
         instruments, common hybrid instruments and derivatives.  However,
         the concept of arrangement as used in Division 230 recognises that
         a contractual basis may be insufficient to reflect the substance of
         an arrangement in all circumstances.  It is recognised that modern
         arrangements can be put together in very complex ways and that
         their substance may be different from their form.


    132. To deal with the various forms in which relevant arrangements may
         take, what rights and obligations constitute the relevant
         arrangement for Division 230 purposes (ie, the arrangement to be
         tested to determine whether it is or is not a financial
         arrangement), is based on various factors.  These factors go to the
         substance of these rights and obligations and the facts and
         circumstances surrounding them.


Summary of new law


    133. A financial arrangement is defined as a cash settlable right to
         receive, or obligation to provide, a financial benefit, or a
         combination of such rights and obligations (irrespective of whether
         the value or existence of the right or obligation is contingent on
         some event or other thing) which exist under an arrangement.  An
         exception will apply where, under the same arrangement, there are
         other rights and obligations that are not insignificant (ie, the
         cash settlable rights and/or obligations otherwise comprising the
         financial arrangement must be the only rights and/or obligations of
         any significance subsisting under the arrangement before a
         financial arrangement will arise).


    134. A right to receive a financial benefit or an obligation to provide
         a financial benefit will be cash settlable where the financial
         benefit is broadly:


                . money or a money equivalent; or


                . non-monetary, but the right or obligation to that
                  financial benefit is in substance and effect expected to
                  be dealt with in a manner that results in receiving or
                  paying money or a money equivalent, when regard is given
                  to factors such as:


                  - the taxpayer's intended way of settling the right or
                    obligation;


                  - the practice by which the taxpayer settles similar
                    rights and/or obligations;


                  - the taxpayer's dealings with respect to the rights or
                    obligations or similar rights and/or obligations; or


                  - the liquidity of the financial benefit, or the ability
                    to cash settle the right or obligation, where the
                    financial benefit is to be provided or received other
                    than as part of the taxpayer's expected purchase, sale
                    or usage requirements.


    135. Division 230 does not generally apply to gains and losses from
         arrangements that do not satisfy this definition of a financial
         arrangement.  However, equity interests (and certain rights and
         obligations to equity interests that are not otherwise financial
         arrangements) are a separate category of a financial arrangement
         that will have gains and losses dealt with under Division 230 in
         limited circumstances.  In addition, specific inclusion provisions
         exist to ensure that arrangements which can operate in a similar
         way to these types of financial arrangements are bought within the
         scope of Division 230.


    136. Division 230 also provides for various exceptions which take gains
         and losses from certain financial arrangements outside the scope of
         the Division.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|The definition of       |There is no             |
|'financial arrangement' |comprehensive definition|
|is based on rights to   |of financial            |
|receive, or obligations |arrangement, which      |
|to pay, financial       |creates gaps,           |
|benefits that are cash  |distortions and         |
|settlable.              |anomalies in tax        |
|Specific additions      |treatments.             |
|include certain         |                        |
|arrangements that have a|                        |
|similar effect or       |                        |
|operation to these      |                        |
|financial arrangements. |                        |
|Some financial          |Certain types and       |
|arrangements have their |classes of financial    |
|gains and losses        |arrangements are not    |
|excluded from the       |specifically addressed. |
|operation of Division   |                        |
|230 for compliance,     |                        |
|administrative or other |                        |
|policy reasons.         |                        |
|Arrangements comprising |Arrangements are        |
|a number of different   |generally treated based |
|rights and obligations  |on legal form.          |
|are generally determined|                        |
|on a stand-alone        |                        |
|contractual basis where |                        |
|the form of the contract|                        |
|is consistent with its  |                        |
|substance.              |                        |
|The ability to cope with|It is inadequate to deal|
|financial innovation is |with financial          |
|increased.              |innovation.             |


Detailed explanation of new law


    137. Whether or not a particular arrangement is a financial arrangement
         will depend on whether or not it satisfies:


                . the principal financial arrangement definition dealing
                  with cash settlable rights and obligations to financial
                  benefits (a cash settlable financial arrangement); or


                . the secondary financial arrangement definition dealing
                  with equity interests and rights and obligations to equity
                  interests (an equity financial arrangement).


         An entity can have rights to receive financial benefits and/or
         obligations to provide financial benefits.  Accordingly, an entity
         can be either a holder of a financial arrangement that is an asset
         or an issuer of a financial arrangement that is a liability.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-45 and 230-50]


The arrangement that is being tested


    138. Before it can be decided whether either of the tests for a
         financial arrangement are satisfied, the particular arrangement
         being tested must be determined.


    139. An arrangement, as defined in the ITAA 1997, is a broad concept.
         It includes any arrangement, agreement, understanding, promise or
         undertaking, whether express or implied.  Moreover, it does not
         need to be enforceable, or intended to be enforceable, by legal
         proceedings.


    140. Division 230 modifies this broad notion of an arrangement,
         providing guidance as to which specific rights and obligations will
         make up the relevant arrangement to be tested for the purposes of
         the Division.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-55(4)]


    141. Arrangements can be constructed in very flexible ways.  However,
         for straightforward situations, an arrangement will often be
         contract based.  So too for Division 230 purposes, a contract will
         often define the boundaries of a relevant arrangement.  This is
         where the form of the contract is consistent with its substance.


    142. The various rights and obligations subsisting under a contract will
         typically constitute the relevant arrangement for the purposes of
         Division 230.  That is, the contract is typically viewed on a
         'stand-alone' basis.  In this context, the contract is neither
         aggregated with another contract (or contracts), nor disaggregated
         into component parts, when determining the relevant arrangement to
         be considered under Division 230.


    143. On this basis, all cash flows under an instrument will typically
         form part of the one arrangement and will not be disaggregated to
         represent separate arrangements.  For example, in the usual case, a
         right to receive dividends will form part of a share instrument,
         and an obligation to pay interest will form part of a loan
         agreement.


    144. However, in certain cases, the form of the contract may be
         inconsistent with the economic or commercial substance of an
         arrangement.  This could arise where, for instance, one or more
         rights and obligations under separate formal contracts (whether or
         not they come into existence at the same time) are intended to give
         rise to a single arrangement (such as the case with a stapled
         security).  Division 230 is directed at reflecting the commercial
         and economic substance of arrangements; 'commercial' in this sense
         refers to non-tax factors driving the way in which the particular
         arrangement is structured.


    145. Which rights and/or obligations comprise the relevant arrangement
         for Division 230 purposes is a question of fact and degree.  To
         determine whether a number of rights and/or obligations arise under
         one or more arrangements, regard is to be given to the:


                . nature of those rights and/or obligations, when considered
                  separately and in combination (including having regard to
                  the substance and character of the rights and/or
                  obligations);


                . terms and conditions of the rights and/or obligations,
                  including those relating to any payment or other
                  consideration for them, both when considered separately
                  and when considered in combination (including having
                  regard to the legal terms of the rights and/or obligations
                  in their economic context, including those relating to the
                  amount and timing of the consideration to be paid or
                  received, and the pricing of those rights and/or
                  obligations relative to what would otherwise be expected
                  of such rights and/or obligations, when considered
                  separately and together);


                . circumstances surrounding the creation of those rights
                  and/or obligations and their proposed exercise or
                  performance, (including what can reasonably be seen as the
                  purposes of one or more of the parties involved), when the
                  rights and/or obligations are considered separately and
                  when considered in combination (also taking into account
                  the context in which the rights and/or obligations were
                  created and are anticipated to cease, when consideration
                  is given to one or more of the relevant parties'
                  intentions);


                . whether the rights and/or obligations can be dealt with
                  separately or whether they must be dealt with together
                  (eg, the separate interests that comprise a stapled
                  security cannot be separately dealt with);


                . normal commercial understandings and practices in relation
                  to the rights and/or obligations when considered
                  separately and when considered in combination, including
                  whether commercially they are regarded as separate things
                  or as a group or a series that forms a whole (a comparison
                  with similar or typical commercial arrangements may help
                  determine the commercial understanding of the relevant
                  rights and/or obligations under consideration); and


                . objects of Division 230 (and so having regard to
                  minimising the extent to which the tax treatment of
                  relevant arrangements distorts commercial decision making,
                  more closely aligning the tax and commercial treatment of
                  relevant arrangements, and minimising compliance costs).


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-55(4)]


      1. : Loan and hedge


                Oz Co borrows in pounds sterling from Bank Co.  To hedge its
                exposure to pounds sterling, Oz Co also enters a cross
                currency swap.  Without this exposure being hedged, Bank Co
                would not lend to Oz Co in pounds sterling.


                The fact that the swap and the borrowing may not have been
                entered into without the other, is not sufficient for them
                to comprise one arrangement.  A consideration of the
                following factors:


              . the nature of the loan and the swap, and the rights and
                obligations which comprise them, differ;


              . the loan and the swap are not contractually bound together
                (ie, amongst other things the termination of one will not
                automatically lead to the termination of the other, such
                that their creation and performance times may differ);


              . the payment terms and conditions, including the
                counterparties and relevant dates may differ;


              . the commercial effect of the loan or the swap can be, and is
                typically, understood without reference to the other;


              . commercially the loan and the swap are regarded as separate
                arrangements, and each can be defeased or assigned to a
                third party separately; and


              . treating the loan and swap as separate arrangements would
                not defeat the objects of the Division,


                reveals that for the purpose of Division 230 the loan and
                the swap should be treated as separate arrangements, each of
                which may be assessed to determine whether or not it is a
                financial arrangement subject to the Division (subsection
                230-55(4)).


                Later in this chapter, in Example 2.17, consideration is
                given to whether Oz Co's hedge and loan are, when considered
                separately, financial arrangements.


     2. : Convertible note


                Hamish Co holds a convertible note that pays coupon payments
                at a floating rate over the life of the note.  At maturity
                of the note, Hamish Co has the option to convert the note
                and receive ordinary shares of the issuing company.  If
                Hamish Co chooses not to take this option, it will receive a
                return of its original investment in the note on maturity
                instead of the note converting into ordinary shares.


                Hamish Co does not have the sole or dominant purpose of
                entering into the convertible note to receive the shares.


                Economically, Hamish Co's convertible note represents one
                arrangement that comprises both a fixed income security
                (similar to a bond) and an equity derivative embedded in the
                security (the option to convert).


                However, in light of the fact that:


              . normal commercial practice is for the holder of a
                convertible note to deal with the note as one arrangement;


              . packaged as a note the various components of the convertible
                note have the nature of them being only one arrangement;


              . the terms and conditions indicate the arrangement, whilst
                having the same effect as its separate components, must be
                dealt with together and contain no provision for separate
                assignment of the various embedded rights and obligations;


              . the rights and obligations under the notes were created
                under the one arrangement and at the same time, and are
                proposed to extinguish together on maturity;


              . it would be reasonable to assume that Hamish Co intends to
                deal with its rights and obligations under the note together
                and not separately.  Arguably, commercial understandings
                would suggest that where taxpayers intend on dealing with a
                fixed income security and an equity derivative separately,
                they would be more inclined to enter into an arrangement
                that comprises an equity linked debt security with equity
                warrants, which is economically similar to a convertible
                note with the exception that normal commercial understanding
                is that the equity warrants are detachable and may be dealt
                with separately; and


              . the objectives of more closely aligning tax and commercial
                treatment of relevant arrangements,


                Hamish Co's rights and obligations under the convertible
                note will be taken to comprise one arrangement
                (subsection 230-55(4)).


                Whether or not Hamish Co's convertible note arrangement is a
                financial arrangement is considered later in this chapter,
                in Example 2.17.


     3. : CPI index-linked bond


                At the end of the 2012 income year High Hope Co, a company
                with an aggregated turnover of $3 billion, purchases a five-
                year index-linked bond with a face value of A$100 from the
                issuer, XYZ Co, for its face value (A$100).  The index-
                linked bond pays coupons calculated by reference to
                movements in the United States of America (US) consumer
                price index (CPI).  Specifically, the index-linked bond pays
                annual coupons of 7 per cent of the face value of the bond,
                adjusted upwards or downwards according to the percentage
                movement on the US CPI.  If the percentage movement in the
                CPI in the relevant period falls below the initial set
                percentage, no coupon will be paid in that period.  The bond
                contains no separate or detachable option.  The bond will
                pay A$100 on redemption (at the end of the 2017 income
                year).


                Based on history the US CPI is expected to increase by 2 per
                cent per annum over the relevant five-year period.


                Having regard to the features of High Hope Co's CPI indexed-
                linked bond and the circumstances surrounding this
                arrangement, it will be treated as a single arrangement for
                the purposes of Division 230, having regard to the fact that
                (see subsection 230-55(4)):


              . the rights and obligations under the CPI index-linked bond
                are dealt with together as one arrangement;


              . the terms and conditions reflect those of a common
                commercial arrangement that is commercially treated as a
                single arrangement;


              . normal commercial practice is to view CPI index-linked bonds
                as one arrangement, and High Hope Co's bond is consistent
                with other such bonds commonly available; and


              . treating High Hope Co's bond as such would be consistent
                with the objects of the Division.


                Whether or not High Hope Co's CPI index-linked bond, as a
                single arrangement, is a financial arrangement, is set out
                later in this chapter, in Example 2.17.


                For similar reasons to those listed in relation to High Hope
                Co's CPI indexed-linked bond, typical equity linked bonds,
                where the coupon return is based on the movement in an
                equity interest or basket of equity interests, would also
                constitute the one arrangement.


                However, other arrangements where a return based on a share
                or index movement is artificially or unusually attached to
                what would otherwise be a stand-alone arrangement may not,
                having regard to the factors set out in subsection 230-
                55(4), be treated as being the one arrangement for the
                purposes of Division 230.

     4. : Two arrangements under the one contract
                LA Co enters into a contract to purchase an office building
                from Vendor Co.  LA Co also arranges to acquire a
                significant amount of office furniture from Vendor Co.  Both
                the building and the office furniture are delivered at the
                same time, but Vendor Co agrees to defer payment of the
                building for two years.  The office furniture is paid for at
                the time of delivery.  While this transaction may have been
                structured under the one contract, the purchase of
                the office building and the purchase of the furniture,
                taking into account the following factors, are treated as
                separate arrangements (see subsection 230-55(4)):

              . The payment terms and timeline for performance of each, are
                significantly different.


              . They can be commercially understood separately, and could be
                negotiated separately.


              . Having regard to the objects of the Division, and the fact
                that accounting would treat the deferred arrangement
                differently to that which was paid for on delivery, each
                purchase should be treated as a separate arrangement.

                Therefore, the contract entered into by LA Co represents two
                separate arrangements.  Each of these arrangements will have
                to be separately tested to determine whether it is a
                financial arrangement as defined within the Division.  For a
                discussion on whether or not LA Co's arrangements are
                financial arrangements, see Example 2.17.
     5. : Sale and repurchase agreement
                A typical cash-based sale and repurchase agreement involves
                the sale of a cash-based security (such as a bond or bank
                bill) and a simultaneous agreement to buy it, or
                substantially the same security, back at an agreed future
                date for an agreed price (which may be the sale price plus a
                lender's return).  The combined sale and repurchase
                arrangement is often referred to as a 'repo'.
                In terms of subsection 230-55(4):

              . The nature of the rights and/or obligations under the repo
                are such that the sale of the security would not be entered
                into without entering into the repurchase agreement.


              . The terms and conditions of the repo suggest that, in
                substance, it is one arrangement.


              . The parties to a repo would ordinarily view the sale and
                repurchase rights and/or obligations together, and intend
                that they be considered together.


              . It would be unlikely for the sale rights and/or obligations
                to be dealt with separately to the repurchase rights and/or
                obligations.


              . Normal commercial understandings and practices are that the
                sale and repurchase rights and/or obligations would be
                viewed as being integrally related to each other.  For
                example, AASB 139 would consider them in combination and not
                de-recognise the security because the seller retains
                substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership (see
                paragraph AG51(b) of AASB 139).


              . Treatment of the repo as an arrangement under subsection 230-
                55(4) is consistent with the substance of the situation and,
                accordingly, with the objects of Division 230.


                In the circumstances, typical repos would constitute one
                arrangement for the purposes of Division 230.


         Right or obligation to more than one financial benefit


    146. A right to receive two or more financial benefits, or an obligation
         to provide two or more financial benefits, is taken for the purpose
         of Division 230 to be two or more separate rights, or two or more
         separate obligations, respectively.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-55(1) and (2)]


     1. : Interest bearing bank account


                Retailer Pty Ltd opens a current account with Bank Ltd on 1
                July 2013.  Under the terms of the account, Retailer Pty Ltd
                may make deposits and withdrawals at any time, provided it
                does not overdraw the account.  Interest is calculated daily
                (on the minimum daily balance) and payable on 30 June each
                year.  If the account is closed, interest calculated up
                until the date it is closed becomes payable at that time.
                The interest rate is set in advance and can change at any
                time at Bank Ltd's discretion.


                A bank account is a single debt existing between the
                customer and the banker in their respective capacities as
                creditor and debtor (Foley v Hill [1843-1860] All ER 16).
                The right to receive the balance of the bank account is
                therefore taken to be the one right.  However, that right is
                in relation to each dollar that comprises the balance of the
                account.  Each dollar is a relevant financial benefit.
                Hence, for the purposes of the Division, Retailer Pty Ltd is
                taken to have a separate right to receive each dollar that
                comprises the balance of the account (subsection 230-55(1)).


                Having regard to the features of Retailer Pty Ltd's bank
                account and the circumstances surrounding this arrangement,
                it will be treated as a single arrangement for the purposes
                of Division 230, having regard to the fact that (see
                subsection 230-55(4)):


              . the rights and obligations under the bank account are dealt
                with together as one arrangement;


              . the terms and conditions reflect those of a common
                commercial arrangement that is commercially treated as a
                single arrangement;


              . normal commercial practice is to view the bank account as
                one arrangement, and Retailer Pty Ltd's bank account is
                consistent with other such accounts that are commonly
                available; and


              . treating Retailer Pty Ltd's bank account as such would be
                consistent with the objects of Division 230.


                As explained in Example 2.17, Retailer Pty Ltd's bank
                account with Bank Ltd is a cash settlable financial
                arrangement.


         Is the relevant arrangement subject to Division 230?


    147. The relevant arrangement for Division 230 purposes, determined
         using the principles set out above, must meet the definition of a
         'financial arrangement' before it will be subject to Division 230.
         As mentioned above, whether or not the relevant arrangement is a
         financial arrangement will depend on whether or not it satisfies:


                . the principal 'financial arrangement' definition dealing
                  with cash settlable rights and obligations to financial
                  benefits (a cash settlable financial arrangement); or


                . the secondary 'financial arrangement' definition dealing
                  with equity interests and rights and obligations to equity
                  interests (an equity financial arrangement).


         [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-45 and 230-50]


Cash settlable financial arrangement


         Background


    148. In a commercial context, arrangements commonly identified as
         'financial instruments', 'financial transactions', 'financial
         assets' and 'financial liabilities' include:


                . debt instruments such as bonds, loans, bills of exchange
                  and promissory notes, whether Australian dollar or foreign
                  currency denominated; and


                . derivatives such as options, forwards and swaps.


    149. A factor that is common to all of the above - and to equivalent
         arrangements - is that a party to the arrangement has either a
         right to receive, or an obligation to provide, cash or something
         equivalent to cash or some combination thereof.


    150. The rights and obligations embodied in such arrangements represent
         a promise by one party to the arrangement to provide something of
         economic value that is money or a money equivalent and a
         corresponding right of another party to receive something of
         economic value that is money or a money equivalent.  Financially
         and economically, the value embodied in these commercial
         arrangements is based on the time value of money and risk.


    151. In other situations, even though the rights and obligations
         associated with an arrangement are in respect of a non-monetary
         item, it is possible that the way in which the arrangement is
         settled or dealt with will have the same effect as the provision or
         receipt of a financial benefit that is in respect of money or a
         money equivalent.


    152. For example, taxpayers holding rights or obligations to financial
         benefits that are non-monetary, may, through business practices,
         settle these rights or obligations with money, a money equivalent
         or by transfer or entry into another financial arrangement
         (monetary financial benefits).  In other cases, taxpayers may by
         intention settle non-monetary rights and obligations in a way that
         result in the receipt or payment of monetary financial benefits.
         Even without this practice or intention, a non-monetary right or
         obligation that is able to be settled in monetary financial
         benefits may have the same effect as a monetary right or obligation
         if the taxpayer did not have the sole or dominant purpose of
         receiving or providing that non-monetary thing as part of its
         expected purchase, sale or usage requirements in the ordinary
         course of business.


    153. In other circumstances taxpayers may enter into arrangements giving
         rise to highly liquid non-monetary rights and obligations which are
         readily convertible to money or a money equivalent, and which are
         not entered into for the purpose of their ordinary business
         dealings or usage.


    154. There will also be circumstances where a taxpayer might carry on,
         for profit, a business as dealer or trader in the rights and
         obligations in respect of financial benefits of a non-monetary
         nature.  An example of such a dealer would be one who deals in
         rights to commodities with the objective of profiting from
         differences in the buy and sell margins from holding offsetting
         positions, or through short-term strategies seeking to exploit
         fluctuations in the price of the rights to the commodity.


    155. The arrangements described above, in substance and effect have
         identical consequences to those of monetary arrangements - that is,
         they, through the conduct of the parties, give rise to rights and
         obligations to provide financial benefits that are monetary in
         nature.  The concept of a cash settlable financial arrangement, as
         set out in section 230-45, seeks to bring within the scope of the
         Division those arrangements that in commercial and economic terms
         reflect these attributes.


         What is a cash settlable financial arrangement?


    156. An entity has a cash settlable financial arrangement where, under
         an arrangement:


                . the entity has one or more cash settlable legal or
                  equitable rights to receive, and/or obligations to
                  provide, a financial benefit; and


                . in comparison to these rights and/or obligations, the
                  entity does not also have one or more non-insignificant
                  rights and/or obligations that:


                  - are not cash settlable; and/or


                  - are not rights to receive, or obligations to provide, a
                    financial benefit.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-45(1)]


    157. If the entity meets these conditions at any time, looking only at
         the entity's subsisting rights and obligations under an
         arrangement, then at that time, by definition, the entity will have
         a financial arrangement that consists (only) of any of its cash
         settlable legal or equitable rights to receive, and obligations to
         provide, a financial benefit under that arrangement (however, see
         paragraph 2.63).  In including only cash settlable rights and
         obligations, the financial arrangement as defined may be narrower
         than the arrangement being tested, which is determined under the
         principles in section 230-55.


         Additional rights and obligations or financial benefits may be
         taken into account


    158. The financial arrangement as defined will only comprise the cash
         settlable rights to receive, and obligations to provide, financial
         benefits under the arrangement.  Often, whether the cash settlable
         rights or obligations to financial benefits are received or
         provided under the particular financial arrangement can be
         determined by reference to the contractual terms of the
         arrangement.  Although, the concept of what is the arrangement can
         be modified by the application of subsection 230-55(4).  This is
         determined on a case by case basis.  However, for the purpose of
         working out any gain or loss from that financial arrangement,
         financial benefits the taxpayer receives or provides (or has a
         right or obligation to do so) which play an integral role in
         determining whether a gain or loss is made from the financial
         arrangement, are also taken to be relevant rights and obligations
         under that financial arrangement.  These rules ensure that an
         appropriate cost or amount of proceeds is allocated to the cash
         settlable financial arrangement.  These rules operate only for the
         purpose of assisting in working out any gain or loss from the
         financial arrangement and are not intended to broaden what
         constitutes the financial arrangement as determined under
         section 230-45 or 230-50.  The rules are described in more detail
         in Chapter 3.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-60]


         Relevant rights and obligations


    159. It is critical to the definition of a 'cash settlable' financial
         arrangement that there be one or more cash settlable rights to
         receive, or obligations to provide, a financial benefit.  The term
         financial benefit as defined in the ITAA 1997 means anything of
         economic value.  Economic value encapsulates money, money
         equivalent and non-monetary items.


    160. A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, a financial
         benefit for the purposes of Division 230 will exist irrespective of
         whether the value or existence of the right or obligation to the
         financial benefit is contingent on some event or other thing.  For
         example, a party that issues an option assumes an obligation to
         provide a financial benefit, notwithstanding that the value or
         existence of the obligation is contingent on the exercise of the
         option.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-85]


    161. In addition to being in respect of a financial benefit, it is
         fundamental to the definition of a 'cash settlable' financial
         arrangement that the relevant rights and obligations be cash
         settlable.  The general limitation of the scope of cash settlable
         financial arrangements to cash settlable rights to receive, or
         obligations to provide, financial benefits supports the relatively
         close correspondence between tax and commercial outcomes to
         financial arrangements.


    162. Because a right or obligation may be settled or dealt with in a way
         that makes it cash settlable, whether or not a particular right or
         obligation is a cash settlable right or obligation must be
         determined from the relevant taxpayer's perspective.  That is, the
         question of whether or not an arrangement is a cash settlable
         financial arrangement is a relative question, needing to be
         determined separately from the viewpoint of each relevant taxpayer.
          This means that a particular taxpayer may have a cash settlable
         financial arrangement, but the relevant counterparty's
         corresponding rights and obligations under that arrangement may or
         may not amount to a cash settlable financial arrangement from their
         perspective.


Definition of cash settlable


    163. Cash settlable rights and obligations naturally include those
         rights and obligations to the receipt or payment of money or a
         money equivalent.  However, limiting cash settlable rights and
         obligations to only monetary rights and obligations would not
         appropriately reflect the circumstances where 'cash-like' rights
         and obligations are dealt with in the same way as monetary rights
         and obligations, as discussed in the background above.
         Accordingly, cash settlable rights and obligations include all of
         the following.


         Money or a money equivalent


    164. For the purpose of the definition of 'cash settlable', a right to
         receive money, or an obligation to provide money, is taken to be a
         'cash settlable' right or obligation.  In addition, the definition
         of 'cash settlable' rights and obligations includes a right to
         receive, or an obligation to provide, a money equivalent.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(a)]


    165. A money equivalent for the purposes of Division 230 is defined as:


                . a right to receive money, or something that is a money
                  equivalent; and


                . a cash settlable financial arrangement.


         [Schedule 1, item 21, subsection 995-1(1)]


    166. Because of this definition of 'money equivalent', a cash settlable
         right or obligation includes a right to receive, or obligation to
         provide, a financial arrangement which itself meets the test for a
         cash settlable financial arrangement, in addition to a right to
         receive, or obligation to provide, a right to such a financial
         arrangement, or a right to receive money.


    167. Money in its simplest form is a unit of Australian currency.  An
         item that is a money equivalent will typically have a degree of
         proximity to cash.  Some examples would include bonds, loans and
         other forms of financial accommodation.


     1. :   Option to settle by money equivalent: satisfaction of a debt by
        the issue of a bond


                Oil Co has an outstanding loan owing to Grease Co of
                $100,000 which is due on 20 June 2012.  Under the terms of
                the loan Oil Co is entitled to issue a five-year zero-coupon
                bond with a face value of $150,000 in satisfaction of that
                loan obligation.


                Oil Co's option to settle its obligation under the loan by
                the provision of the bond is a contingent obligation to
                provide a bond (contingent in the sense that it is subject
                to Oil Co choosing to settle the loan through the provision
                of the bond instead of satisfying its loan obligation by the
                provision of money).


                The five-year bond is both a right to receive money (being
                the right to receive its $150,000 face, or redemption,
                value) and is itself a cash settlable financial arrangement
                (in that it consists only of cash settlable rights to
                receive, and/or obligations to provide, financial benefits).
                 As such, Oil Co's contingent obligation to provide the bond
                satisfies both limbs of the definition of 'money
                equivalent'.


                Oil Co therefore has an arrangement consisting of its
                contingent, cash settlable, obligation to provide Grease Co
                with $100,000 (being its loan obligation) and its
                contingent, cash settlable, obligation to provide Grease Co
                with a money equivalent (being its contingent option to
                provide the bond in satisfaction of this loan obligation).
                (Note that the settlement of either one of these
                obligations, being alternative obligations, would
                effectively be a settlement of that obligation and an
                extinguishment of the alternative obligation.)


                Example 2.17 explains that these obligations satisfy the
                definition of a 'cash settlable financial arrangement'.


     2. :  Value of a monetary item determined by a non-monetary amount


                Kramer Co enters into an agreement with Diamond Co under
                which Kramer Co receives $10,000, in consideration for
                assuming an obligation to pay Diamond Co a cash amount in
                five years time, determined by a formula that is based on a
                commodity value.


                The fact that Kramer Co's obligation to pay a monetary
                amount is calculated by reference to a change in a non-
                monetary variable does not prevent it from being a cash
                settlable obligation to provide a financial benefit
                (specifically, it is an obligation to pay money).


                Whether or not Kramer Co's arrangement is a cash settlable
                financial arrangement is discussed in Example 2.17.


         Non-monetary financial benefits


    168. In certain situations, even though the rights and obligations
         associated with an arrangement are in respect of a non-monetary
         item, it is possible that the way in which the arrangement is
         settled or dealt with will have the same effect as the provision or
         receipt of a financial benefit that is money or a money equivalent.
          For example, in some cases, taxpayers holding rights or
         obligations to financial benefits that are non-monetary, may intend
         to settle, or have a practice of settling, these rights or
         obligations with money, a money equivalent or by cessation of, or
         entry into, another cash settlable financial arrangement.  These
         types of rights and obligations, amongst others having a similar
         effect, are captured within the definition of 'cash settlable' as
         follows.


         Intention to settle with money or money equivalent, or by starting
         or ceasing to have another financial arrangement (monetary items)


    169. Where a taxpayer has an obligation to provide a non-monetary
         financial benefit that they intend to settle by the provision of
         money, a money equivalent, or by the starting or ceasing to have
         another cash settlable financial arrangement (the provision of
         'monetary items'), that obligation will be taken to be cash
         settlable.  The test of the taxpayer's intention is an objective
         one, and confirms the economic substance of such an arrangement.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(c)]


    170. Likewise, a right to receive a non-monetary financial benefit that
         the taxpayer intends to satisfy by the receipt of money, a money
         equivalent, or by starting or ceasing to have another cash
         settlable financial arrangement (the receipt of 'monetary items')
         will be treated as being a cash settlable right to receive a
         financial benefit.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(b)]


    171. In a general sense, the provision of a monetary item as explained
         above also encapsulates set-off of monetary rights and obligations
         or the waiving of a present right to receive money or a money
         equivalent.  Similarly, the receipt of a monetary item will include
         the extinguishment of a present obligation to provide a monetary
         item and a relevant set-off.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-
         45(2)(b) and (c)]


    172. What is meant by satisfy or settle also takes its commercial
         meaning, so there must in substance be a satisfaction or settlement
         of the relevant right or obligation as such.  For example, a
         penalty for non-performance may in substance settle an obligation
         to deliver or a right to receive a non-monetary thing, if the
         amount of the penalty is based on changes in the price of that non-
         monetary thing.  However, a fixed penalty for such non-performance
         will often not amount to settlement of the relevant right or
         obligation (see Example 2.10).


         Practice of settling with monetary items


    173. Where a taxpayer has an obligation to provide a non-monetary
         financial benefit, but they have a practice of settling similar
         obligations by the provision of a monetary item, the obligation
         will be taken to be a cash settlable financial benefit.  Likewise,
         a right to receive a non-monetary financial benefit will be taken
         to be cash settlable where the taxpayer has a practice of settling
         similar rights by the receipt of a monetary item.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(d)]


     1. :  Practice to settle futures contract by cash payment (set-off)


                Ore Co usually enters into nickel futures contracts with the
                Metals Exchange, whereby Ore Co will agree to sell a set
                quantity of nickel for an agreed price.  The contracts
                require delivery of the underlying commodity.  However, the
                practice as between Ore Co and the Metals Exchange is to
                settle these contracts by cash payment equal to the
                difference between the agreed price for that quantity of
                nickel and the prevailing market price for that nickel at
                the exchange date.


                Ore Co currently has a futures contract with the Metals
                Exchange under which it has an obligation to provide two
                tonnes of nickel at $40,000 per tonne for delivery in six
                months time.  Were the market value of the nickel to be
                $45,000 per tonne at the settlement date, Ore Co's prior
                practice with similar contracts would suggest that it will
                pay the Metals Exchange $10,000 rather than providing the
                nickel (in full satisfaction of both its obligation to
                provide nickel worth $90,000 and its right to receive
                $80,000 from the Metals Exchange).  Likewise, were the
                market price of nickel to fall to $35,000 per tonne, Ore
                Co's previous practice with its nickel futures contracts
                would suggest that it will receive $10,000 from the Metals
                Exchange (in full satisfaction of both its obligation to
                provide the nickel worth $70,000 and its right to receive
                $80,000 from the Metals Exchange).


                Ore Co in fact intends to satisfy this particular contract
                through the delivery of the nickel.  Nonetheless, because
                Ore Co has a practice of settling similar obligations by the
                provision of money or a money equivalent (including where
                relevant by the extinguishment of its right to otherwise
                receive a greater sum from the Metals Exchange, where the
                prevailing market price is less than the agreed price), its
                obligation to provide the nickel is taken to be cash
                settlable.


                Example 2.17 explains that Ore Co's arrangement is a cash
                settlable financial arrangement.


     2. :  Take-or-pay penalty clause


                Kanga Co, a deep sea mining company, enters into a take-or-
                pay arrangement to supply natural gas on a monthly basis to
                Roo Co, a fuel processing company, over a period of four
                years.  Under the arrangement, Roo Co is required to pay a
                penalty for any delivery it refuses to accept below a set
                threshold.  As Roo Co's demand for natural gas varies widely
                from month to month in line with demand for its fuel
                products, it is not uncommon for the penalty to be invoked.


                The penalty is based on a fixed fee determined at the
                commencement of the arrangement (indexed by the CPI
                annually), multiplied by the difference between the volume
                of natural gas delivered and the specified threshold.


                Under this arrangement, Roo Co has a right to receive
                natural gas on a monthly basis and an obligation to provide
                payment on delivery of the natural gas, as well as a
                contingent obligation to provide an amount of money as a
                penalty for non-receipt, if non-receipt occurs because it
                refuses to accept at least the threshold amount.


                The payment of the penalty, in the event that Roo Co
                requires delivery of a volume of natural gas below the
                specified monthly threshold, is a fixed fee arrangement that
                is not dependent on the actual market price of the
                underlying item at the time it is to be supplied.  In these
                circumstances, the payment of the penalty does not amount to
                a dealing of a non-monetary nature in Roo Co's right to
                receive the non-monetary thing, being a volume of natural
                gas that it had agreed to take.


                Notwithstanding Roo Co's history of having such a penalty
                clause exercised against it, payments under such penalty
                clauses are not in satisfaction or settlement of a right to
                receive a non-monetary thing.  Accordingly, no part of its
                right to receive the non-monetary thing (the natural gas)
                under this arrangement is a cash settlable right.


                Whether or not Roo Co's take-or-pay arrangement is a cash
                settlable financial arrangement is discussed in Example
                2.17.


         Dealing for profit from a dealer's margin and/or short-term price
         fluctuations


    174. There will be circumstances where a taxpayer might carry on a
         business as a dealer or trader in rights to receive, or obligations
         to provide, non-monetary financial benefits for profit.  An example
         of such a dealer would be one who deals in rights to receive
         commodities with the objective of profiting from differences in the
         buy and sell margins from holding offsetting positions, or through
         short-term strategies seeking to exploit fluctuations in price of
         the commodity (and thus in the value of the rights and/or
         obligations).


    175. Where a taxpayer 'deals' with a right to receive, or an obligation
         to provide, a non-monetary financial benefit, or with similar
         rights or obligations, for the purpose of:


                . generating a profit from short-term changes in price;
                  and/or


                . the purpose of generating a profit from a dealer's margin,


         the right or obligation will be taken to be cash settlable.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(e)]


    176. Note that the relevant dealing, for the purpose of this aspect of
         the definition of 'cash settlable', must be with the relevant
         rights and obligations themselves, and not in respect of the
         particular non-monetary financial benefits that the taxpayer has
         the right to receive, or obligation to provide.  This means, for
         example, that a dealing by a taxpayer with a physical item of
         trading stock it has a right to receive, or a taxpayer's dealings
         in items of trading stock similar to that which it has a right to
         receive, would not be relevant dealings for the purpose of this
         aspect of the definition of cash settlable.


    177. A taxpayer may 'deal' with rights or obligations in a relevant
         sense where, for example:


                . the taxpayer deals with the non-monetary right or
                  obligation, or similar rights and obligations, on a short-
                  term basis with the purpose of taking advantage of price
                  fluctuations;


                . the taxpayer frequently deals with similar non-monetary
                  rights or obligations for short-term price fluctuation
                  gains or dealer's margins; or


                . the taxpayer acquires the rights or obligations, or
                  similar rights or obligations, and offsets the resulting
                  risk by entering into offsetting arrangements that provide
                  the taxpayer with a profit margin.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, note to subsection 230-45(2)]


         Highly liquid rights and/or obligations readily convertible into
         money or money equivalent


    178. Where the relevant financial benefit the taxpayer has a right to
         receive, or an obligation to provide, under the arrangement is:


                . readily convertible into an amount of money or a money
                  equivalent; and


                . there is a market for the financial benefit that has a
                  high degree of liquidity, (a 'liquid financial benefit');
                  and


                . either:


                  - the taxpayer had a purpose of liquidating or converting
                    the financial benefit into money or a money equivalent
                    (purpose of converting); or


                  - the amount of money or money equivalent the financial
                    benefit is convertible into is a set amount or is not
                    subject to a substantial risk of changes in value
                    (set value),


         the right to receive, or obligation to provide, the liquid
         financial benefit will be economically equivalent to a right to
         receive or obligation to provide cash (or a money equivalent).
         Such a right or obligation will therefore be taken to be a cash
         settlable right or obligation.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         45(2)(f) and subsection 230-45(3)]


    179. A financial benefit will be readily convertible into money or a
         money equivalent and be subject to a highly liquid market if, for
         example, the financial benefit is a security or commodity traded in
         an active market or if it is an amount of foreign currency that is
         readily convertible into the functional currency of the taxpayer.
         A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, a financial
         benefit that is a publicly traded security for which the market is
         not very active will still be readily convertible to cash and
         subject to a highly liquid market if the number of shares or other
         units of the security the right or obligation is for, is small
         relative to the daily transaction volume for that security.  A
         right to receive, or an obligation to provide, that same security
         would not be so readily convertible if the number of shares or
         units the right or obligation is for is large relative to the daily
         transaction volume for that security.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraphs 230-45(3)(a) and (b)]


         Purpose of converting


    180. Where the taxpayer does not intend to deal with such a liquid
         financial benefit as part of its ordinary business requirements,
         but rather intends to liquidate or convert the financial benefit
         into money or a money equivalent, it is appropriate that it be
         treated in a similar manner as a right to receive money or a money
         equivalent.  However, where the taxpayer intends to provide or
         receive such a financial benefit as part of its ordinary business
         requirements (in the sense that the taxpayer plans to deal with the
         financial benefit as a non-monetary item and not as a substitute
         for money), it will not be treated as being like money despite it
         being readily convertible to cash.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subparagraph 230-45(3)(c)(ii)]


         Set value


    181. The exception to this ordinary course of business exclusion will
         occur where the value of the highly liquid thing is predetermined.
         That is, the value the taxpayer has a right to receive or an
         obligation to provide, as represented by the thing that is readily
         convertible into money or a money equivalent, is either known or
         not subject to a substantial risk of change in value.  In this
         situation, the highly liquid non-monetary thing is a proxy for that
         value of money or a money equivalent.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subparagraph 230-45(3)(c)(i)]


     1. : Right to receive shares


                Henry Group Ltd enters into a forward contract under which
                it will acquire 10,000 Kaye Co shares in 18 months for
                $200,000.  Henry Group Ltd has an obligation to make a large
                cash payment in 18 months time under a separate arrangement,
                and has entered into this forward contract with the view
                that the value of Kaye Co shares will increase at a higher
                rate than other prevailing investment options.  Henry Group
                Ltd is not acquiring these shares as part of its ordinary
                course of business, and irrespective of their value in 18
                months time intends to dispose of the Kaye Co shares as soon
                as they are delivered, due to its cash requirements at that
                time.


                Henry Group Ltd does not have an intention, practice or
                ability to settle this contract anyway other than through
                delivery of the shares.  Henry Group Ltd does not deal with
                its rights under this forward contract.  Nor does Henry
                Group Ltd deal with any of its similar rights to receive
                shares (under other arrangements) in order to generate a
                profit from short-term price movements or from a dealer's
                margin.


                Kaye Co shares are listed on a national stock exchange and
                subject to high trading volumes.  That is, they are subject
                to a highly liquid market, and are readily convertible into
                money or a money equivalent.


                Henry Group Ltd's right to receive 10,000 Kaye Co shares,
                from the time Henry Group Ltd starts to have this right
                under its arrangement, is a cash settlable right.  This is
                because it is a right to receive a financial benefit that is
                readily convertible into money, and that is subject to a
                highly liquid market, that Henry Group Ltd intends to
                convert into money by disposing of it.  In determining
                whether this is a cash settlable financial arrangement,
                because Henry Group Ltd intends to convert the Kaye Co
                shares and this is not part of the ordinary course of its
                business, it is not relevant that the precise value of the
                financial benefit owed by Kaye Co to Henry Group Ltd, in the
                form of 10,000 shares, is unknown (paragraph 230-45(2)(f)
                and subparagraph 230-45(3)(c)(ii)).


                Example 2.17 explains that Henry Group Ltd's arrangement
                under the forward contract is a cash settlable financial
                arrangement.


                Note that on these facts if Henry Group Ltd did not intend
                to dispose of the Kaye Co shares but instead intended to
                hold them for a reasonable time, its right to receive these
                shares under the arrangement would not be a cash settlable
                right.  This is because their value between the time Henry
                Group Ltd acquired the right and when it will be satisfied
                is not set, and will be subject to a substantial risk of
                changes in value.  However, had Henry Group Ltd instead
                contracted to acquire $200,000 worth of Kaye Co shares,
                determined at the time of delivery, the right would still be
                cash settlable (paragraph 230-45(2)(f) and subparagraph 230-
                45(3)(c)(i)).


         The ability to settle a non-monetary right and/or obligation with a
         monetary item, where the non-monetary item is not part of the
         expected purchase sale or usage requirements


    182. Where a taxpayer has a right to receive, or an obligation to
         provide, a non-monetary financial benefit that it is able to settle
         by the receipt or provision of a monetary item, the right or
         obligation will be taken to be cash settlable if the taxpayer does
         not have the sole or dominant purpose of entering into the
         arrangement to receive or provide the relevant non-monetary
         financial benefit as part of its expected purchase, sale or usage
         requirements.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(g)]


    183. For example, where a non-monetary financial benefit may be provided
         in satisfaction of a right under an arrangement, but the taxpayer
         is able to instead receive a monetary payment in satisfaction of
         that right, and the taxpayer is indifferent as to what it receives,
         the right will be a cash settlable right.  The test of the
         taxpayer's intention is an objective one.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-45(2)(g)]


     1. : An obligation is not cash settlable merely due to an ability to
        cash settle


                On 1 June 2011, Cereal Co enters into a forward contract
                with Corn Co-operative to deliver on 20 June 2012, 200
                bushels of corn for $10,000.  Under the terms of the forward
                contract, Cereal Co has the choice of delivering 200 bushels
                of corn or settling the forward contract by the payment of
                an amount of cash (referable to the value of corn).


                Under this forward contract, Cereal Co therefore has a
                contingent obligation to provide a non-monetary financial
                benefit (200 bushels of corn) and an alternative contingent
                obligation to pay an amount of money.


                Cereal Co does not intend to settle its forward contract in
                cash, nor does it have the practice of settling similar
                arrangements other than by delivering the corn.  Cereal Co
                is not a dealer in rights or obligations such as those under
                this forward contract.


                The contract was entered into as part of Cereal Co's
                expected sale requirements, and thus despite being able to
                be settled by a monetary payment, Cereal Co's obligation to
                provide 200 bushels of corn is not cash settlable.  This
                obligation is not insignificant in comparison with Corn Co's
                other rights and obligations under the forward contract.


                For the reasons given in Example 2.17, Cereal Co's
                arrangement is therefore not a cash settlable financial
                arrangement.


     2. : Damages or compensation payments


                Commercial Textiles Co enters into a contract to purchase a
                new warehouse.  This is not in the ordinary course of its
                business of manufacturing.  Under the arrangement Commercial
                Textiles Co has a right to receive the warehouse, and a
                corresponding obligation to pay the contract price for it.


                The terms of the agreement also provide that should the
                vendor default on the agreement, it will pay Commercial
                Textiles Co a cash payment in full satisfaction of its
                rights and obligations under the agreement.  Because of the
                specific terms, this has the effect that Commercial Textiles
                Co's right to receive the warehouse under the agreement is
                able to, in the appropriate circumstances, be settled by a
                payment of money.


                Because Commercial Textile Co entered into the agreement
                with the purpose of acquiring the warehouse as part of its
                expected purchase and usage requirements (albeit not part of
                its ordinary requirements), its right to receive the
                warehouse will not be deemed to be cash settlable.  This is
                despite the ability for this right, in certain
                circumstances, to be satisfied by the vendor paying a money
                amount.  Accordingly, the only cash settlable rights and/or
                obligations under this arrangement is Commercial Textile
                Co's obligation to pay the contract price, and its
                contingent right to receive a cash payment from the vendor
                in the event of default.  Its right to receive the warehouse
                under the arrangement is not cash settlable within the
                meaning of subsection 230-45(2).


                As explained in Example 2.17, this has the effect that
                Commercial Textile Co's arrangement is not a cash settlable
                financial arrangement.


    184. A right or obligation having a value limited by a set amount of
         money, or referable to a set amount of money, will not necessarily
         be a cash settlable right or obligation.


     1. : Consumer loyalty points and gift certificates


                Yvonne is an individual who, due to the particular financial
                arrangements relevant to her business, has elected to have
                her gains and losses from financial arrangements be subject
                to Division 230 under subsection 230-455(7)).


                In addition to her main business transactions, Yvonne is
                awarded points as part of a consumer loyalty program ('the
                program') of which she is a member.  Under the terms of the
                program, and subject to certain eligibility requirements and
                thresholds, she is entitled to redeem these points for
                various products and services, or gift certificates with a
                prescribed cash face value, exchangeable by her for goods
                and services.  As her points have an economic value, Yvonne
                therefore has a right to receive financial benefits under
                the program.


                This right is not money or a money equivalent.  Yvonne does
                not have the practice, intention or ability to settle her
                right to receive financial benefits under the program by
                receiving money, a money equivalent, or by starting or
                ceasing to have another financial arrangement.  Yvonne
                cannot deal in her right to receive financial benefits under
                the program (or under any gift certificate she acquires).
                The financial benefits she has a right to receive, including
                to the gift certificates with a set cash face value, are not
                readily convertible into money or a money equivalent, nor
                are subject to a liquid market.


                Yvonne's rights under the program, and under any gift
                certificates acquired, are not cash settlable and, as
                explained in Example 2.17, therefore do not constitute a
                cash settlable financial arrangement.


Exception to the test for a cash settlable financial arrangement


    185. An arrangement (as determined under section 230-55) may consist of
         both cash settlable and non-cash settlable rights and obligations.
         The arrangement will only be a cash settlable financial arrangement
         at a time when:


                . compared to the cash settlable rights to receive financial
                  benefits under the arrangement and the cash settlable
                  obligations to provide financial benefits under the
                  arrangement:


                  - any non-cash settlable rights and obligations under the
                    arrangement are insignificant; and


                  - any rights to receive or obligations to provide
                    something that is not a financial benefit are
                    insignificant; or


                . any non-cash settlable rights and obligations under the
                  arrangement, or rights and obligations to things other
                  than financial benefits, that are not insignificant when
                  compared to the cash settlable rights and obligations to
                  financial benefits, have ceased.  In this case, the only
                  subsisting rights and obligations under the arrangement
                  that are not insignificant must be cash settlable rights
                  to receive and/or obligations to provide, financial
                  benefits.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-45(1)(d) to (f)]


    186. This further demonstrates that whether or not an arrangement is a
         financial arrangement may change over time.  At the point in time
         when the only rights and obligations remaining under an arrangement
         are cash settlable rights and/or obligations to receive or provide
         financial benefits, the arrangement will be a cash settlable
         financial arrangement, which is comprised of those cash settlable
         rights and obligations.  Note further that for the purpose of
         working out any gain or loss from the cash settlable financial
         arrangement, other financial benefits which play an integral role
         in determining whether a gain or loss is made from the financial
         arrangement, are also taken to be relevant rights and obligations
         under that financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-45(1) and section 230-60]


    187. An arrangement such as this will not be precluded from being a cash
         settlable financial arrangement merely because the arrangement also
         consists of other rights and obligations that are insignificant
         when compared to those cash settlable rights and obligations
         comprising the financial arrangement.  However, during any period
         any other, non-cash settlable, rights or obligations under the
         arrangement subsist and are not insignificant when compared to the
         cash settlable rights and/or obligations to financial benefits
         under the arrangement, the arrangement will not be a cash settlable
         financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-
         45(1)(d) to (f)]


    188. The intent of this exception is to ensure that arrangements that
         predominantly relate to transactions that involve one side of the
         arrangement being of a monetary nature and the other side being non-
         monetary are excluded from the definition of a 'financial
         arrangement'.


     1. : No financial arrangement where there is an outstanding non-
        monetary benefit


                Bill Co enters into an agreement on 1 July 2011 to sell land
                to Jim Co for $100,000.  At the time of the agreement, Bill
                Co has a right to receive a financial benefit of a monetary
                nature (ie, $100,000) and an obligation to provide a non-
                monetary benefit (title to the land).  As Bill Co's
                obligation to provide the land is not insignificant when
                compared to its right to receive payment from Jim Co, the
                entire arrangement will not constitute a financial
                arrangement.


                The arrangement may later become a financial arrangement if,
                after delivery of the land, payment to Bill Co remains
                outstanding.  If payment remains outstanding after the land
                is delivered, the only subsisting rights and/or obligations
                under the arrangement will be Bill Co's (cash settlable)
                right to receive payment from Jim Co.  Note further, though,
                that if payment is due within 12 months of delivery of the
                land, Division 230 will not apply to Bill Co's gains and
                losses from this financial arrangement.


    189. What is or is not an insignificant right or obligation to provide a
         financial benefit of a non-monetary nature is to be determined by
         the facts and circumstances of each case, the purpose of the
         arrangement, the intention of the parties to the arrangement and
         the objects of Division 230.


    190. The effect of this exception to the definition of a 'cash settlable
         financial arrangement' is that many arrangements for the supply of
         property or goods or services will not, be cash settlable financial
         arrangements.  Most prepayments for property or goods or services
         (other than the situations where the property or goods or services
         are themselves cash settlable) are excluded.  However, as
         illustrated in Example 2.15, this exclusion will not extend to
         periods after the obligation to provide, or right to receive,
         property or services has been satisfied, and the cash settlable
         amount to be paid or received as consideration remains outstanding.
          As such, the definition of a cash settlable financial arrangement
         will extend to deferred settlement arrangements where property or
         services that the taxpayer had a non-cash settlable right or
         obligation to receive or provide has been delivered, and only the
         payment remains outstanding.  However, gains and losses from these
         deferred settlement arrangements where the relevant property or
         services are not money or a money equivalent will not be subject to
         Division 230 unless payment is deferred in excess of 12 months
         after receipt or delivery of that property or services.


Testing time for the existence of a financial arrangement


    191. Generally, it will be necessary to classify a set of rights or
         obligations as a financial arrangement or a non-financial
         arrangement at the time that arrangement comes into existence or
         commences to be held.


    192. Some rights and/or obligations under an arrangement can start or
         cease to be held at times different to other rights and/or
         obligations under the arrangement.  This can occur even where there
         is no new agreement between a party to the arrangement and another
         party (either the counterparty or a third party).  Over the term of
         an arrangement, as illustrated above, there may be a point in time
         where a financial benefit of a monetary nature and financial
         benefit of a non-monetary nature co-exist, but at a later point in
         time only the monetary or non-monetary financial benefits exist.


    193. As discussed above, such outcomes can result in an arrangement not
         being a cash settlable financial arrangement at a particular time
         but becoming a cash settlable financial arrangement at another
         time.  As a result, when an arrangement moves from having some non-
         cash settlable rights and/or obligations that are not insignificant
         (whether or not there are also cash settlable rights and/or
         obligations) to effectively having only cash settlable rights
         and/or obligations, or vice versa, there is a need to re-assess
         whether the arrangement (even where there is no new agreement
         between parties to the arrangement) is a financial arrangement.


     1. : Financial arrangement - deferred payment


                Steam Co enters into an arrangement with Big Co to acquire a
                train for $1 million.  Steam Co's obligation to pay for the
                train is a cash settlable obligation to provide a financial
                benefit, and its right to receive the train from Big Co is
                not cash settlable.


                Scenario 1:  The train is delivered and payment is made at
                the same time.


                Under this scenario, there is no financial arrangement as
                under the arrangement there is, until the time of
                settlement, a non-insignificant non-cash settlable right,
                and after settlement there are no subsisting rights or
                obligations under the arrangement.


                Scenario 2:  The terms of the agreement are such that the
                train will be delivered to Steam Co immediately, but payment
                will be deferred for 18 months.


                Under this Scenario, there is a financial arrangement
                immediately after delivery of the train (which is at the
                date of contract) as, at this time, the only subsisting
                rights and obligations under the arrangement are cash
                settlable.


                Scenario 3:  The terms of the agreement are such that the
                train will be delivered to Steam Co after 12 months, and
                payment will be deferred for 18 months (ie, six months after
                delivery of the train).


                Under this Scenario, there is also a financial arrangement
                immediately after delivery of the train, which in this case
                is 12 months after the date of the contract.  Until this
                time, the arrangement includes a non-insignificant non-cash
                settlable right (being the right to receive delivery of the
                train).  After the time at which the train is delivered, the
                only subsisting rights and/or obligations under the
                arrangement are cash settlable (the obligation to pay for
                the train), and thus from this time the arrangement is a
                financial arrangement.  However, because the time between
                delivery of the train and the date that payment is due is
                less than 12 months, any gains and losses from this
                financial arrangement will not be subject to Division 230
                (refer to discussion on exemptions from Division 230 for
                certain financial arrangements).


                Scenario 4:  Under the terms of the arrangement, the train
                must be delivered in 12 months time and payment is to be
                made at that time.  However Steam Co and Big Co agree to
                defer payment for three years after delivery.


                Similarly to above, until delivery of the train there is no
                financial arrangement, as the arrangement includes a
                subsisting right that is not cash settlable, and is not
                insignificant in relation to the other rights and
                obligations under the arrangement (the right to receive the
                train).  After delivery, by agreement, the only rights
                and/or obligations that remain are those of a monetary
                nature.  At this time, a financial arrangement will come
                into existence.  Because the time between delivery of the
                train and the date that payment is due is more than 12
                months, any gains and losses from this financial arrangement
                will be subject to Division 230.


     2. :  Cash settlable financial arrangements under earlier examples


                Continuation of Example 2.1 - Loan and hedge (cash settlable
                financial arrangement)


                Oz Co's loan and cross-currency swap would both be cash
                settlable financial arrangements, as from inception both
                arrangements consist only of cash settlable rights and
                obligations to receive or provide financial benefits.


                Continuation of Example 2.2 - Convertible note (cash
                settlable financial arrangement)


                Hamish Co's convertible note is a cash settlable financial
                arrangement.  This is because under this arrangement Hamish
                has the right to receive cash coupon payments, and the
                ability to redeem the note upon maturity by receiving a
                payment of money, and Hamish Co did not have the sole or
                dominant purpose when entering into the arrangement of
                receiving the shares on conversion instead (subsection 230-
                45(1) and paragraph 230-45(2)(g)).


                If Hamish Co's convertible note is also an equity interest,
                it will  satisfy the definition of an 'equity financial
                arrangement'  (see subsection 230-50(1)), and therefore will
                only be subject to a limited operation of Division 230
                (refer to discussion on the limited operation of Division
                230 to 'equity financial arrangements').


                Continuation of Example 2.3 - CPI index-linked bond (cash
                settlable financial arrangement)


                The rights and obligations under High Hope Co's index-linked
                bond (being the right to receive the coupon payments, as
                adjusted for the index movement) and the right to receive
                the face value of the bond on maturity) are all cash
                settlable and so the arrangement is a cash settlable
                financial arrangement (section 230-45).


                Continuation of Example 2.4 - Two arrangements under the one
                contract (only one cash settlable financial arrangement)


                In this example, LA Co has an arrangement to purchase an
                office building which is paid for two years after delivery,
                and an arrangement to purchase office furniture paid for at
                the time of delivery.


                The office furniture arrangement is not a financial
                arrangement at any time as, at all times under the
                arrangement, LA Co's subsisting rights and obligations
                include a significant non-cash settlable right to receive
                furniture (section 230-45).


                The office building arrangement will become a financial
                arrangement after delivery of the office building, as from
                this time the only rights and/or obligations subsisting
                under the arrangement is LA Co's cash settlable obligation
                to pay Vendor Co for the building (section 230-45).


                Continuation of Example 2.6 - Interest bearing bank account
                (cash settlable financial arrangement)


                Retailer Pty Ltd's rights and obligations under its current
                account held with Bank Ltd consist entirely of its rights to
                receive financial benefits totalling the amount standing to
                the credit of its account, as explained in Example 2.6.


                Each right to receive a dollar of the balance of the account
                (the financial benefit) is a 'cash settlable' right to a
                financial benefit because the benefit is money (paragraph
                230-45(2)(a)).


                Retailer Pty Ltd's rights under its bank account therefore
                comprise a cash settlable financial arrangement (section 230-
                45).


                Continuation of Example 2.7 - Option to settle by money
                equivalent: satisfaction of a debt by the issue of a bond
                (cash settlable financial arrangement)


                Oil Co's loan to Grease Co is a cash settlable financial
                arrangement consisting of its contingent obligation to
                provide Grease Co with $100,000 and its contingent cash
                settlable obligation to provide Grease Co with the bond
                (section 230-45).


                Continuation of Example 2.8 - Value of a monetary item
                determined by a non-monetary amount (cash settlable
                financial arrangement)


                Kramer Co's agreement with Diamond Co is a cash settlable
                financial arrangement, as from its inception all of Kramer
                Co's rights and obligations under this agreement are cash
                settlable and in respect of financial benefits (section 230-
                45).


                Continuation of Example 2.9 - Practice to settle futures
                contract by cash payment (cash settlable financial
                arrangement)


                Ore Co's futures contract with the Metals Exchange is a cash
                settlable financial arrangement consisting of its right to
                receive a set payment from the Metals Exchange, and its cash
                settlable obligation to provide nickel to the Metal's
                Exchange.  Ore Co has no rights or obligations under this
                arrangement that are not cash settlable (section 230-45).


                Continuation of Example 2.10 - Take or pay arrangement (not
                a cash settlable financial arrangement)


                Roo Co's agreement with Kanga Co is to receive natural gas
                in exchange for making a payment for the gas.  As explained
                in Example 2.10, no part of Roo Co's right to receive
                natural gas is cash settlable.  Because this right is not
                insignificant when compared to Roo Co's other rights and
                obligations under the arrangement, its take-or-pay
                arrangement with Kanga Co is not a cash settlable financial
                arrangement (paragraphs 230-45(1)(d) to (f)).


                Continuation of Example 2.11 - Right to receive shares
                (cash settlable financial arrangement)


                Henry Group Ltd's rights and obligations under its forward
                contract comprise a right to receive 10,000 shares in Kaye
                Co, and an obligation to pay $200,000.  For the reasons
                given in Example 2.11, Henry Group Ltd's right to receive
                10,000 Kaye Co shares is a cash settlable right.


                Henry Group Ltd's arrangement under the forward contract
                will therefore be a cash settlable financial arrangement,
                within the meaning of section 230-45, comprised by its cash
                settlable right to receive 10,000 Kaye Co shares and its
                cash settlable obligation to pay $200,000.  Henry Group Ltd
                has no rights or obligations under this arrangement that are
                not cash settlable (section 230-45).


                If Henry Group Co's right to receive Kaye Co shares was not
                cash settlable, its forward contract would not be a cash
                settlable financial arrangement as its right to receive Kaye
                Co shares is not insignificant when compared to Henry Group
                Ltd's other rights and obligations under the arrangement
                (paragraphs 230-45(1)(d) to (f)).


                Continuation of Example 2.12 - Obligation is not cash
                settlable merely due to an ability to cash settle (not a
                cash settlable financial arrangement)


                Cereal Co's forward contract with Corn Co-operative is not a
                cash settlable financial arrangement despite having a cash
                settlable right to receive $10,000 and an option to settle
                its obligation to provide corn with a cash payment (a cash
                settlable obligation).  Cereal Co's forward contract is not
                a cash settlable financial arrangement because Cereal Co may
                also settle its obligation under the contract by providing
                corn.  This alternative obligation, despite being able to be
                settled in cash, is not a cash settlable obligation due to
                Cereal Co's purpose at the time of entering into the
                arrangement as explained in Example 2.12.  Therefore, for
                the duration of the arrangement, Cereal Co has a non-
                insignificant non-cash settlable obligation to provide
                200 bushels of Corn, in addition to its other rights and
                obligations under the arrangement which are cash settlable.




                Accordingly, as Cereal Co has a non-insignificant non-cash
                settlable obligation for the duration of its arrangement,
                its arrangement with Corn Co-operative is not a cash
                settlable financial arrangement (section 230-45).


                Continuation of Example 2.13 - Damages or compensation
                payments (not a cash settlable financial arrangement)


                Commercial Textile Co's right to receive the warehouse is
                not, for the reasons given in Example 2.13, a cash settlable
                right.  Because this non-cash settlable right to receive the
                warehouse is not insignificant in comparison to Commercial
                Textile Co's other rights and obligations under the
                arrangement, its warehouse purchase arrangement is not a
                cash settlable financial arrangement within the meaning of
                section 230-45.


                Continuation of Example 2.14 - Consumer loyalty points and
                gift certificates (not a cash settlable financial
                arrangement)


                Because Yvonne has no cash settable rights or obligations
                under her arrangement as described, that arrangement is not
                a cash settlable financial arrangement.


Equity interest is a financial arrangement


         Equity interest financial arrangements


    194. An 'equity interest', as defined in the ITAA 1997, is also a
         financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-50(1)]


    195. An equity interest has the meaning given by Subdivision 974-C of
         the ITAA 1997 in the case of a company (contained within
         Division 974 of the ITAA 1997 dealing with debt and equity
         interests), and by section 820-930 of the ITAA 1997 in the case of
         a partnership or trust (contained within Subdivision 820-J of the
         ITAA 1997, dealing with equity interests in a trust or partnership
         under the thin capitalisation rules).  [Schedule 1, item 7,
         subsection 820-930(1)]


    196. Once determined under these other provisions of the ITAA 1997, an
         equity interest in its entirety will constitute a relevant
         financial arrangement under subsection 230-50(1).  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-50(1)]


    197. An equity interest will comprise a financial arrangement under
         subsection 230-50(1), even if it comprises an arrangement that
         fails to satisfy the definition of a financial arrangement under
         section 230-45.  Such an arrangement, being an equity interest or
         part of an equity interest, will be subject to the limited scope of
         Division 230 that applies to equity financial arrangements.


         Financial arrangements consisting of a right or obligation to an
         equity interest


    198. A right or obligation to receive or provide an equity interest, or
         a combination of such rights and/or obligations will also be an
         equity financial arrangement, if such a right, obligation or
         combination does not already meet the definition of a cash
         settlable financial arrangement in section 230-45.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-50(2)]


    199. Likewise, a right or obligation to receive or provide such a
         financial arrangement (or a combination of these rights and/or
         obligations, whether or not together with other rights and/or
         obligations to other equity interests) will also be a financial
         arrangement if it is not already a cash settlable financial
         arrangement (or part of a cash settlable financial arrangement)
         under subsection 230-45(1).  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         50(2)(b)]


    200. For these types of equity financial arrangements, the financial
         arrangement is constituted by the relevant right, obligation or
         combination explained above.  However, for the purpose of working
         out any gain or loss from equity financial arrangements, other
         financial benefits which play an integral role in determining
         whether a gain or loss is made from the financial arrangement, are
         also taken to be relevant rights and obligations under that
         financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-50(2)
         and section 230-60]


         Limited scope of Division 230 to equity financial arrangements


    201. Equity financial arrangements as explained above will be 'financial
         arrangements' as defined in Division 230.  However, they will not
         be subject to all of the provisions of Division 230 that apply to
         cash settlable financial arrangements.  As a general rule, other
         areas of the income tax law - such as the capital gains, imputation
         and general income provisions - largely provide an adequate basis
         for recognising the gains and losses, including dividends, from
         equity interests.


    202. Specifically, an equity financial arrangement will not be subject
         to:


                . Subdivision 230-B, which contains the accruals and
                  realisation methods for calculating gains and losses from
                  financial arrangements [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-
                  5(2)(b) and 230-40(4)(e)];


                . a foreign exchange retranslation election in
                  Subdivision 230-D [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
                  270(1), paragraph 230-5(2)(b))]; or


                . a hedging financial arrangement election in
                  Subdivision 230-E, except to the extent it is a foreign
                  currency hedge issued by the taxpayer (as explained in
                  Chapter 8) [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-300(7) and
                  (8) and 230-330(1), paragraph 230-5(2)(b)].


    203. In addition, an equity financial arrangement will only be subject
         to a fair value election under Subdivision 230-C (where the
         taxpayer has made such an election) and/or the election to rely on
         financial reports in Subdivision 230-F (where the taxpayer has made
         such an election) and/or, in very limited circumstances, the
         hedging financial arrangement election under Subdivision 230-E
         (where the taxpayer has made such an election) if:


                . the taxpayer is required by the accounting standards (or
                  comparable foreign standards) to classify or designate the
                  equity financial arrangement as at fair value through
                  profit or loss; and


                . where the financial arrangement is an equity interest, the
                  taxpayer is not the issuer of that interest (except where
                  the equity financial arrangement is a foreign currency
                  hedge under subsections 230-300(7) and (8).


         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-220(1)(c) and 230-410(1)(d),
         subsections 230-225(1), 230-300(7) and (8) and 230-415(1)]


    204. Finally, an equity financial arrangement will only be subject to
         the balancing adjustment in Subdivision 230-G if it is otherwise
         subject to either the fair value election or the election to rely
         on financial reports, as explained above.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-440(1)]


    205. The fair value election and the election to rely on financial
         reports are explained in more detail in Chapters 6 and 9.


Additional operation of Division 230


    206. The application of Subdivision 230-J extends the operation of
         Division 230 to arrangements that would not otherwise satisfy the
         definition of a financial arrangement.  The extended operation of
         Division 230 applies to:


                . foreign currency [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
                  530(1)];


                . non-equity shares in companies [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-530(2)];


                . certain commodities held by traders for the purposes of
                  dealing, and fair valued through profit or loss for
                  accounting purposes [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
                  530(3)]; and


                . offsetting commodity contracts that are entered into for
                  the purpose of dealing in a commodity through the
                  performance of offsetting contracts, and fair valued
                  through profit or loss for accounting purposes [Schedule
                  1, item 1, subsection 230-530(4)],


         as though these assets were a right that constituted a financial
         arrangement or, with respect to offsetting commodity contracts, the
         contracts were a financial arrangement.


    207. The extended operation of the Division to these assets and
         offsetting contracts is directed at ensuring that these
         arrangements are not inappropriately excluded from the scope of
         Division 230.  While they may not be cash settlable financial
         arrangements, they share some of the characteristics of such
         arrangements, for example because of the money-like nature of the
         way in which they are dealt with by the relevant party to the
         arrangement.


    208. These specific inclusion provisions operate to treat:


                . foreign currency as a right that constituted a financial
                  arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-530(1)];


                . a non-equity share in a company as if the share were a
                  right that constituted a financial arrangement.  A non-
                  equity share is defined in subsection 6(1) of the Income
                  Tax Assessment Act 1936 (ITAA 1936) as a legal form share
                  that is not an equity interest in the company.  A share
                  will not be an equity interest if it is characterised as,
                  or forms part of a larger interest that is characterised
                  as, a debt interest under Subdivision 974-B of the ITAA
                  1997 [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-530(2)]; and


                . a commodity as if the commodity were a right that
                  comprised a financial arrangement where all of the
                  following are satisfied [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
                  230-530(3)]:


                  - it is held by a taxpayer who trades or deals in that
                    commodity, and who holds the relevant commodity for the
                    purposes of dealing in the commodity;


                  - that taxpayer also trades or deals in financial
                    arrangements whose value changes in response to the
                    price or value of that commodity;


                  - the taxpayer has made a fair value election
                    (see Chapter 6) or an election to rely on financial
                    reports (see Chapter 9); and


                  - the commodity is an asset that the taxpayer is required
                    to designate or classify as at fair value through profit
                    or loss in its financial reports, in accordance with the
                    Australian Accounting Standards (or comparable foreign
                    accounting standards if the Australian standards do not
                    apply).


    209. Division 230 also applies to a contract to which a taxpayer is a
         party as if the contract were a financial arrangement if:


                . the taxpayer has a right to receive or an obligation to
                  provide a commodity under the contract;


                . the taxpayer has a practice of dealing in the commodity
                  using offsetting contracts of that nature;


                . the taxpayer does not have, as their sole or dominant
                  reason for entering into the contract, the purpose of
                  receiving or delivery the commodity as part of the
                  taxpayer's expected purchase, sale or usage requirements;


                . the fair value method or the financial reports method
                  applies to financial arrangements that a taxpayer starts
                  to have when they enter into the contract; and


                . the contract is an asset or liability that the taxpayer is
                  required by accounting standards or comparable foreign
                  accounting standards to classify or designate in their
                  financial reports as at fair value through profit or loss.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-530(4)]


Specific disaggregation provisions


    210. Once a financial arrangement has been determined, there are
         specific disaggregation provisions in Division 230 that apply in
         particular circumstances, which may operate to split the financial
         arrangement into two financial arrangements.  An example of this is
         where an entity elects fair value tax treatment and has hybrid
         financial arrangements in respect of which the host and derivative
         components have dissimilar economic characteristics and risks (see
         Chapter 6 for further details).  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-
         235]


Exceptions for certain financial arrangements


    211. Division 230 will not apply to the gains and losses of a number of
         other financial arrangements.  While these financial arrangements
         meet the essential characteristics of the definition of a financial
         arrangement, there are administrative, compliance or other policy
         reasons for effectively excluding them from Division 230.


         Short-term arrangements where non-monetary amounts are involved


    212. Division 230 will not apply to gains and losses arising from
         certain short-term financial arrangements.  A key feature of
         financing is where one party to an arrangement performs its part in
         advance of another party.  However, where the delay in performance
         is relatively short it could be said that the financing component
         is usually subservient to the purpose of providing goods or
         services.  For compliance and administrative reasons, Division 230
         will not apply to the gains and losses that arise from financial
         arrangements which satisfy all of the items listed below.


         Financial arrangement consideration for property or services


    213. The financial benefits the taxpayer is to provide (or receive)
         under the financial arrangement are consideration for property
         (including goods) or services:


                . that the taxpayer has acquired from (or provided to)
                  another person; and


                . that is not money or a money equivalent.

         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-450(b)]


         No more than 12 months delay in payment


    214. The period from the time the taxpayer acquired (or provided) the
         property or services (or a substantial proportion of them), until
         the time the taxpayer is to provide (or receive) the consideration
         (or a substantial proportion of it), is not more than 12 months.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-450(c)]


         The arrangement is not a derivative financial arrangement


    215. The financial arrangement is not a derivative financial arrangement
         for any income year [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-450(d)].
         Derivative financial arrangements are arrangements that:


                . change in value in response to a change in a specified
                  variable or variables; and


                . require little or no net investment, in that the net
                  investment is smaller than that required for other types
                  of financial arrangements, besides other derivative
                  financial arrangements, that would be expected to have
                  similar results to changes in market factors.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-350(1)]


         The fair value election does not apply


    216. The fair value election does not apply to the financial arrangement
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-450(e)].  For a discussion of
         the fair value election, see Chapter 6.


     1. :  Short-term trade credits


                Manufacturer Co sells widgets (which are not money or a
                money equivalent) to Retailer Co on 90-day terms.  That is,
                Retailer Co has 90 days after delivery of the widgets to pay
                for them.  Manufacturer Co does not recognise gains and
                losses from these contracts on the basis of fair value
                through profit or loss under AASB 139.


                For the 90-day period, it could be said that Manufacturer Co
                is financing Retailer Co's purchase of the widgets.  During
                this period Manufacturer Co's only subsisting rights and
                obligations under these contracts is its right to receive
                payment for the widgets.  From the time of delivery,
                Manufacturer Co therefore has a cash settlable financial
                arrangement (under section 230-45).


                However, the period between delivery of the widgets and the
                time for payment is not more than 12 months.  As the
                contracts are not subject to a fair value election, the
                gains or losses arising from these financial arrangements
                will be disregarded for Division 230 purposes (pursuant to
                section 230-450).


     2. :  Continuation of Example 2.11 - forward contract over shares


                In Example 2.11, Henry Group Ltd entered into a forward
                contract under which it will acquire 10,000 Kaye Co shares
                in 18 months for consideration of $200,000.  As explained in
                Example 2.17, Henry Group Ltd's arrangement under the
                forward contract is a cash settlable financial arrangement.




                On settlement of this contract, Henry Group Ltd receives
                property (Kaye Co shares) and is obliged to make payment
                immediately (ie, there is no delay, so that the period
                between acquisition of the property, and the time Kaye Co is
                to provide the $200,000 consideration, is not more than 12
                months).


                Notwithstanding that Henry Group Ltd's right to receive the
                shares is a cash settlable right (as explained in Example
                2.11), the shares are not money or a money equivalent as
                defined.


                Accordingly, assuming Henry Group Ltd has not made a fair
                value election that could apply to this arrangement, it will
                be subject to the exception for short-term arrangements
                where non-monetary amounts are involved, unless it is a
                derivative financial arrangement (section 230-450).


                Henry Group Ltd's financial arrangement is its rights and
                obligations under the forward contract, which is a forward
                purchase of shares.  The value of this arrangement changes
                over time in response to changes in the value of Kaye Co
                shares.  Henry Group Ltd would have either paid a premium of
                an amount less than the value of 10,000 Kaye Co shares at
                that time, or received a premium of less than this amount,
                or paid or received nothing at the time of entering into the
                forward contract.  This will be considerably less than the
                amount Henry Group Ltd would have otherwise had to pay at
                the time of entry into the forward contract were it to have
                purchased those shares at that time.  Further, the shares
                would be expected to have similar responses to changes in
                market factors as the forward contract.


                Henry Group Ltd's financial arrangement constituted by its
                cash settlable rights and obligations under the forward
                contract is therefore a derivative financial arrangement,
                and not subject to this exception for short-term
                arrangements where non-monetary amounts are involved
                (paragraph 230-450(d) and subsection 230-350(1)).


    217. Where an arrangement otherwise satisfies the requirements for the
         exception for short-term arrangements where non-monetary amounts
         are involved, but the deferral of payment from the time the
         property or services is received or provided is more than 12
         months, Division 230 will apply to the financial arrangement
         constituted by the 'deferred settlement' or trade credit
         arrangement.  (See Chapters 3 and 11 for an explanation of how
         Division 230 interacts with the other provisions of the ITAA 1997
         or the ITAA 1936 that may apply to the relevant property or
         services in these cases.)


         Entities that satisfy relevant threshold test where there is no
         significant deferral


    218. For compliance cost reasons, gains and losses from financial
         arrangements of individuals and those entities that satisfy the
         relevant threshold test will not be subject to Division 230, except
         to the extent that:


                . the financial arrangement is a qualifying security with a
                  remaining term of more than 12 months at the time the
                  taxpayer started to have it; or


                . the taxpayer has made an election to have Division 230
                  apply to all their financial arrangements, and the
                  taxpayer started to have the financial arrangement in or
                  after the year of making that election.


    219. To have gains and losses from financial arrangements subject to
         this exception, the taxpayer must be :


                . an individual;


                . a superannuation entity (within the meaning of section 10
                  of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993), a
                  managed investment scheme (within the meaning of the
                  Corporations Act 2001) or an entity with a similar status
                  to such a scheme under a *foreign law relating to
                  corporate regulation with assets of less than $100
                  million;


                . an authorised deposit-taking institution, securitisation
                  vehicle or entity which is required to register under the
                  Financial Sector (Collection of Data) Act 2001, (or would
                  be required to so register if the entity were a
                  corporation) with an aggregated turnover of less than $20
                  million (hereafter referred to as financial entities); or


                . any other entity whose:


                  - aggregated turnover is less than $100 million; and


                  - financial assets are worth less than $100 million; and


                  - assets (including both financial and non-financial
                    assets) are worth less than $300 million.


         [Schedule 1, Part 1, section 230-455]


    220. The following paragraphs elaborate on the meaning of the threshold
         tests as they apply to particular entities.


         Superannuation entities and managed investment schemes


    221. Superannuation funds or managed investment schemes or similar
         entities are required to apply a threshold test based on the value
         of assets reported in their financial statements in accordance with
         Australian Accounting Standard 25 Financial Reporting by
         Superannuation Plans (AAS 25).


    222. To have gains and losses from financial arrangements subject to
         this exception, the entity must:


                . be a superannuation entity (within the meaning of section
                  10 of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993);
                  or


                . be a managed investment scheme (or similar entity under a
                  foreign law related to corporate regulation); and


                . hold assets with a total value of less than $100 million,
                  determined in accordance with AAS 25, other relevant
                  accounting standards or commercially accepted valuation
                  principles.


    223. For the purpose of this exception, the timing of the assets test is
         specified, and may vary for different entities.  An entity
         determines whether or not it meets this assets test for a
         particular income year (the relevant income year) for the purpose
         of this exception based on:


                . its assets as reported at years end in the immediately
                  preceding income year, (worked out at the end of that
                  income year); or


                . where the entity only came into existence during the
                  particular income year, the value of its assets is worked
                  out at the end of that relevant income year.


         [Schedule 1, Part 1, subparagraph 230-455(1)(a)(ii), paragraph 230-
         455(1)(b), subsection 230-455(2)]


         Financial entities


    224. Financial entities are required to apply a threshold test based on
         that entity's aggregated turnover as defined in Division 328 of the
         ITAA 1997.


    225. To have gains and losses from financial arrangements subject to
         this exception, the entity must:


                . be a financial entity (see above for entities included in
                  this category); and


                . have aggregated turnover of less than $20 million worked
                  out under Division 328 of the ITAA 1997.


         [Schedule 1, Part 1, subparagraph 230-455(1)(a)(iii), paragraph 230-
         455(1)(c), subsection 230-455(3)]


         What is an entity's aggregated turnover?


    226. 'Aggregated turnover' is defined in section 328-115 of the
         ITAA 1997, and for the purpose of this Division 230 test it carries
         the same meaning.  In summary, an entity's aggregated turnover is
         based on the ordinary income the entity derives for an income year
         in the ordinary course of carrying on a business plus the sum of
         the relevant annual turnovers (adjusted in particular
         circumstances) of the entity, its connected entities and
         affiliates.


    227. This definition also ensures that where an entity does not carry on
         a business for an entire income year, its aggregated turnover is
         worked out using a reasonable estimate of what it would be if that
         entity carried on business for the whole of the relevant income
         year.


         Timing for the application of the aggregated turnover test


    228. For the purpose of this exception, the timing of the relevant
         turnover test is specified, and may vary for different entities.
         An entity determines whether or not it meets this turnover test for
         a particular income year (the relevant income year) for the purpose
         of this exception based on:


                . its turnover in the immediately preceding income year,
                  (worked out at the end of that income year); or


                . where the entity only came into existence during the
                  particular income year, its turnover as worked out at the
                  end of that relevant income year.


         [Schedule 1, Part 1, section 230-455]


         Other entities


    229. All other entities of a type that have not been discussed above
         (and are not individuals) are required to apply a threshold test
         based on their aggregated turnover, financial assets they hold, and
         all assets they hold (including both financial and non-financial
         assets).


    230. To have gains and losses from financial arrangements subject to
         this exception, the entity must:


                . not be an entity of the kind discussed above (and not be
                  an individual);


                . have aggregated turnover of less than $100 million worked
                  out under Division 328 of the ITAA 1997 (see above for a
                  discussion on the meaning of aggregated turnover);


                . hold financial assets with a total value of less than
                  $100 million, determined in accordance with AAS 25, other
                  relevant accounting standards or commercially accepted
                  valuation principles; and


                . hold assets (including both financial and non-financial
                  assets) with a total value of less than $100 million,
                  determined in accordance with AAS 25, other relevant
                  accounting standards or commercially accepted valuation
                  principles.


         [Schedule 1, Part 1, section 230-455]


         Timing for the application of the threshold tests


    231. For the purpose of this exception, the timing of the relevant
         turnover test is specified, and may vary for different entities.
         An entity determines whether or not it meets this threshold test
         for a particular (the relevant income year) for the purpose of this
         exception based on:


                . it meeting the threshold in the immediately preceding
                  income year, (worked out at the end of that income year);
                  or


                . where the entity only came into existence during the
                  particular income year, it meeting the threshold test as
                  worked out at the end of that relevant income year.


         [Schedule 1, Part 1, section 230-455]


         Qualifying securities of more than 12 months


    232. Gains and losses from a financial arrangement of an individual or
         entity falling below the relevant threshold test may still be
         subject to Division 230 where that arrangement is a 'qualifying
         security' within the meaning of Division 16E of the ITAA 1936.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-455(1)(e)]


    233. Broadly, a 'qualifying security' is a security which, at the time
         of issue, is reasonably likely to result in the sum of the payments
         (excluding periodic interest as defined in subsection 159GP(6) of
         the ITAA 1936) exceeding the statutorily established formula in
         subsection 159GP(1) of the ITAA 1936.


    234. Where an individual or entity falling below the relevant threshold
         test starts to have a qualifying security, and it is otherwise a
         financial arrangement that would be subject to Division 230, its
         gains and losses will not be excluded from the Division under
         section 230-455, where that security has more than 12 months
         remaining of its term at the time when the taxpayer starts to have
         the qualifying security.  That is, these qualifying securities will
         have gains and losses on them subject to Division 230.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, paragraph 230-455(1)(e)]


         Irrevocable election to have Division 230 apply to all financial
         assets and liabilities


    235. Taxpayers may make an election to have Division 230 apply to all
         their gains and losses from their financial arrangements.  The
         election once made is irrevocable and applies to all financial
         arrangements a taxpayer acquires, or otherwise starts to have (such
         as a financial arrangement the taxpayer creates), in the income
         year in which the election is made and for subsequent income years.
          [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-455(6) to (8)]


    236. Entities (other than individuals) who become subject to
         Division 230 in respect of all of their gains and losses from
         financial arrangements will continue to have Division 230 apply
         notwithstanding that the entities turnover or assets may fall below
         the thresholds set out in subsections 230-455(2), (3) or (4)
         [Schedule 1, Part 1, subsection 230-455(9)].  Where this happens,
         Division 230 will continue to apply to all of that entities
         existing and new financial arrangements.  The object of this
         provision is to ensure that, once the entity becomes subject to
         Division 230, it does not have to continually test whether Division
         230 continues to apply to its financial arrangements.  In addition,
         it will ensure that entities whose turnover or assets fluctuate
         above or below the relevant thresholds over time are not exposed to
         balancing adjustment and other consequences that otherwise arise as
         a consequence of having financial arrangements subject to Division
         230 one year and not the next.


         Exceptions for various rights and/or obligations


    237. Division 230 does not apply to a taxpayer's gains and losses from a
         financial arrangement for an income year to the extent that the
         rights and/or obligations under that arrangement are subject to any
         of the following exceptions.


         Leasing or property arrangement


    238. Most leasing arrangements will not be cash settlable financial
         arrangements, as under the arrangement the taxpayer will have not
         insignificant non-cash settlable rights or obligations (the
         lessee's right to use the relevant thing being leased, and the
         lessor's obligation to allow, and be deprived of, such use).
         However, to the extent that particular leasing arrangements do
         satisfy the definition of a financial arrangement, the leasing or
         property exception will apply to a right or obligation arising
         under:


                . a luxury car lease under Division 42A of Schedule 2E to
                  the ITAA 1936 [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  460(2)(a)];


                . sale and loan arrangements to which Division 240 of the
                  ITAA 1997 applies [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  460(2)(b)];


                . an arrangement dealing with assets put to tax preferred
                  use to which Division 250 of the ITAA 1997 applies
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-460(2)(c)]; or


                . an arrangement that:


                  - is a licence to use; or


                  - in substance or effect, depends on the use of a specific
                    asset, and gives a right to control the use of that
                    specific asset, where that asset is,


                  goods or a personal chattel (other than money or a money
                  equivalent, real property, or intellectual property
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-460(2)(d) and (e)].


    239. A luxury car lease within the meaning of Division 42A of Schedule
         2E to the ITAA 1936 excludes hire purchase agreements and short-
         term hiring arrangements.  The leases that are subject to this
         Division are treated as a notional sale (generally for the cost of
         the vehicle) and a loan transaction.  The Division contains
         specific rules to determine the finance charge under this notional
         loan, and how the notional loan is to be treated for tax purposes.
         Division 230 will not disturb the tax treatment of arrangements
         subject to Division 42A of Schedule 2E.


    240. Division 240 of the ITAA 1997 operates to recharacterise some
         arrangements (such as hire purchase agreements) as a sale of
         property, combined with a loan, by the notional seller to the
         notional buyer, to finance the purchase price.  Amongst other
         things, this Division determines the notional interest on this
         notional loan, and how it is treated for tax purposes.  Division
         230 will not disturb the tax treatment of arrangements subject to
         Division 240.


    241. Division 250 of the ITAA 1997 operates to deny or reduce certain
         capital allowance deductions that would otherwise be available in
         relation to an arrangement that relates to an asset where the asset
         is put to a tax-preferred use.  For Division 250 to apply to an
         asset, the taxpayer does not have a predominant economic interest
         in the asset at the test time and:


                . the asset must be put to a tax-preferred use;


                . the arrangement period for the preferred use is greater
                  than 12 months;


                . the financial benefits in relation to the preferred use
                  will be provided to the taxpayer by a tax-preferred end-
                  user, or a tax-preferred entity, or a non-resident;


                . there will be an entitlement to a capital allowance
                  deduction for the decline in value of the asset or for
                  expenditure in relation to the asset; and


                . the taxpayer lacks a predominant economic interest in the
                  asset at the time.


           Where Division 250 applies to an arrangement in relation to an
           asset, the arrangement is treated as a loan and Division 230
           will not disturb the tax treatment of that arrangement.


    242. The fourth category under this exclusion broadly covers licences
         and leases over goods (other than money or a money equivalent),
         real property, and intellectual property.


    243. Goods, personal chattels, real and intellectual property take their
         ordinary meaning, and so in a broad sense cover personal property
         (other than money or a money equivalent), land, and interests in
         land and rights in respect of creative and intellectual effort
         including copyright, registered designs, patents and trademarks.


         Interest in a partnership or trust


    244. A right carried by an interest in a partnership or trust (or a
         corresponding obligation) will be subject to an exception if there
         is only one class of interest in the partnership or trust, or the
         interest is an equity interest in the partnership or trust, or the
         right or obligation relating to a trust is managed by a funds
         manager, custodian or 'responsible entity' of a registered scheme
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-460(3)].  The reference to an
         equity interest in the context of a partnership or trust takes its
         meaning from section 820-930 of the ITAA 1997.


    245. What is meant by the reference to a funds manager and a custodian
         takes on its ordinary commercial meaning.  A responsible entity of
         a registered scheme draws its meaning from the Corporations Law.
         It is the company named in the Australian Securities and
         Investments Commission's record of the scheme's registration as the
         responsible entity or temporary responsible entity of a managed
         investment scheme registered under section 601EB of the
         Corporations Act 2001.  In a general sense, a managed investment
         scheme as defined under the Corporations Act 2001 covers (subject
         to certain exceptions) a scheme where the contribution made by
         members to acquire interests in the scheme are pooled and used to
         produce benefits for members, where the members do not have day-to-
         day control of the operation of the scheme (see section 9 of the
         Corporations Act 2001).


    246. The exception for multi-class trusts that are managed by a funds
         manager or custodian promotes competitive neutrality, avoiding the
         unnecessary creation of multiple single class trusts that are
         managed by the same funds manager, custodian or responsible entity.
          [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-460(3)(c)]


    247. Where a right carried by such an interest in a partnership or trust
         as explained above (or a corresponding obligation) is a right (or
         obligation) under a financial arrangement that is subject to either
         a fair value election or an election to rely on financial reports,
         this exception for certain interests in a partnership or trust will
         not apply to that right (or obligation).  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-460(4)]


         Certain insurance policies


    248. A right or obligation under a life insurance policy or a general
         insurance policy is subject to an exception from Division 230.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-460(5) and (6)]


    249. The exception for certain insurance policies applies to both the
         issuer and the holder of an insurance policy.  Accordingly, the
         exception can apply to a life insurance company, a general
         insurance company, certain life insurance policyholders and certain
         general insurance policyholders.


    250. Subject to certain exclusions applying to holders of policies, the
         exceptions ensure that Division 230 does not apply to rights and
         obligations under life insurance policies and general insurance
         policies.  These rights and obligations may also be taken into
         account under the insurance taxation rules in Division 320 of the
         ITAA 1997, Division 321 of Schedule 2J to the ITAA 1936 and
         Division 15 of Part III of the ITAA 1936.  To this extent, the
         exceptions have the effect of preventing the application of both
         Division 230 and the specific insurance provisions to an excepted
         policy right or obligation.


    251. The exception, preventing Division 230 from applying, does not
         extend to investments (other than investments by way of a policy
         covered by the exceptions) that support the policy liabilities of
         the insurance company.


         Exception for life insurance policies


    252. A right or obligation under a life insurance policy is subject to
         an exception.  This exception ensures that Division 230 does not
         apply to rights and obligations under those life insurance policies
         that are subject to taxation under Division 320 of the ITAA 1997.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-460(5)].


    253. The exception does not apply to a life insurance policy if the
         policy is an annuity that is a qualifying security and the entity
         is not a life insurance company (as defined by the ITAA 1997) that
         is the insurer.  Therefore, the holder of such a security would not
         be eligible for the exception.


    254. However, from the holder's perspective, the exception will apply in
         respect of an annuity if it is an 'ineligible annuity' within the
         meaning of Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 (as these annuities are
         not qualifying securities).


    255. A life insurance policy is defined in subsection 995-1(1) of the
         ITAA 1997 to have the meaning given to the expression 'life policy'
         in the Life Insurance Act 1995, but includes:


                . a contract made in the course of carrying on business that
                  is life insurance business because of a declaration in
                  force under section 12A or 12B of the Life Insurance
                  Act 1995; and


                . a sinking fund policy within the meaning of the Life
                  Insurance Act 1995.


     1. :  A life insurance policy that is subject to exception


                Bianca is an individual who has elected under subsection 230-
                455(7) to have all of her gains and losses from financial
                arrangements that are not otherwise excepted, subject to
                Division 230.  She holds an endowment life insurance policy
                issued to her by a life insurance company in her own right.
                As a result of the application of subsection 230-460(5),
                Division 230 will not apply to any gain or loss that Bianca
                makes under the policy.


         Exception for general insurance policies


    256. A right or obligation under a general insurance policy is subject
         to an exception, except where the policy is a derivative financial
         arrangement and the taxpayer is not a general insurance company as
         defined by the ITAA 1997.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         460(6)]


    257. This exception ensures that Division 230 does not apply to rights
         and obligations under those general insurance policies that are
         subject to taxation under Division 321 of Schedule 2J to the ITAA
         1936.


    258. A general insurance policy is defined in subsection 995-1(1) of the
         ITAA 1997 to mean a policy of insurance that is not a life
         insurance policy or an annuity instrument.  The term 'policy of
         insurance' is not defined and therefore takes its ordinary meaning.
          It may include a policy of reinsurance.  Examples of general
         insurance policies include fire, theft, injury, accidental damage,
         negligence, storm and professional indemnity insurance.


    259. The activities of a general insurance company can be split into
         underwriting and investment activities.  As previously stated,
         investment activities involving financial arrangements will
         generally be subject to Division 230.  The underwriting activities
         of a general insurance company (to the extent that they would
         otherwise be subject to Division 230) will usually be the subject
         of this exception and would therefore be excluded from the
         operation of Division 230.


         Certain workers' compensation arrangements


    260. A right or obligation in relation to an outstanding claims
         liability for certain workers' compensation liabilities is subject
         to an exception.  This exception ensures that Division 230 does not
         apply to rights or obligations arising under these workers'
         compensation liabilities that are subject to the taxation treatment
         set out under Division 323 of Schedule 2J to the ITAA 1936.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-460(7)]


    261. Division 323 of Schedule 2J to the ITAA 1936 specifies the taxation
         treatment of outstanding claims liabilities for workers'
         compensation liabilities of companies that are not required by law
         to insure, and do not insure, against liability for such claims
         ('self insurers').


         Certain guarantees and indemnities


    262. A right or obligation under a guarantee or indemnity will be
         subject to an exception unless:


                . the financial arrangement is the subject of a fair value
                  election, or an election to rely on financial reports (see
                  Chapters 6 and 9) [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  460(8)(a)];


                . the financial arrangement is a derivative financial
                  arrangement for any income year [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-460(8)(b)]; or


                . the actual guarantee or indemnity is itself given in
                  relation to another financial arrangement [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, paragraph 230-460(8)(c)].


    263. What is meant by a 'guarantee' or an 'indemnity' takes on its
         ordinary meaning to include a promise to answer for the debt or
         default of another, or to make good a loss suffered through a third
         party.


     1. :  Cash settlable guarantee


                On 1 September 2012 Gez Co enters into an arrangement to
                acquire a fleet of cars for use in its business.  Both
                delivery of the vehicles and payment occurs on 1 October
                2012.  Under the arrangement, from the date of delivery, Gez
                Co continues to have a subsisting right to be indemnified
                against the cost of repairing a specified range of potential
                faults that may arise in the vehicles, for a period of three
                years.


                Gez Co is an entity with a relevant aggregated turnover in
                excess of $100 million, that has not made any elections
                under Division 230.


                As the contingent right to receive a payment under this
                indemnity clause in the arrangement is a cash-settlable
                right under paragraph 230-45(2)(a), and it is the only
                subsisting right or obligation Gez Co has under its fleet
                purchase arrangement, from the time of delivery of the fleet
                cars, Gez Co has a cash settlable financial arrangement.


                However, the only right under Gez Co's arrangement is a
                right under an indemnity, that is not a derivative financial
                arrangement and that is not subject to a relevant election
                under Division 230.  Further, it is not an indemnity in
                relation to a financial arrangement (as the obligation of
                Gez Co to pay the cost of repairing the potential faults it
                is being indemnified for, does not itself arise under a
                financial arrangement).


                As such, any gains or losses Gez Co makes from its financial
                arrangement constituted by its rights under the indemnity
                will not be subject to Division 230.


    264. An example of where this exception would not apply is where a
         guarantee is provided in respect of a loan agreement.  As the loan
         agreement is itself a financial arrangement, the guarantee would be
         subject to Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         460(8)(c)]


         Personal arrangements and personal injury


    265. Certain personal arrangements and arrangements in respect of
         personal injuries will not have their gains and losses subject to
         Division 230.  Specifically, rights and obligations under a
         financial arrangement are the subject of an exception in the
         following circumstances.


         Personal services


    266. A right to receive consideration, or an obligation to provide
         consideration, for the provision of personal services is the
         subject of an exception [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         460(9)(a)].  Personal services are broadly the provision of
         personal effort, labour or skill of an individual.


         Deceased estates


    267. A right, or an obligation, that arises from the administration of a
         deceased estate is the subject of an exception [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-460(9)(b)].  Rights and obligations arising from the
         administration of a deceased estate include those arising under a
         will as well as those arising through common law or legislatively,
         such as in the case of an intestate estate.


         Gifts under deed


    268. A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, a gift under a
         deed, is the subject of an exception.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-460(9)(c)]


         Maintenance amounts


    269. A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, a financial
         benefit by way of maintenance:


                . to an individual who is a spouse or former spouse of the
                  person liable to provide the financial benefit;


                . to, or for the benefit of, an individual who is a child
                  (or who was a child), of the person liable to provide the
                  financial benefit; or


                . to, or for the benefit of, an individual who is a child
                  (or who was a child) of a spouse or former spouse of the
                  person liable to provide the financial benefit,


         is the subject of an exception.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         460(9)(d)]


    270. In this context, maintenance refers to a financial benefit paid to,
         or for the relevant individual, to assist in that individual's
         support.  A right to receive or an obligation to provide a
         financial benefit by way of maintenance may include periodic
         payments, lump sum payments, and/or a transfer of property.


         Personal injury


    271. A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, a financial
         benefit in relation to personal injury to an individual is the
         subject of an exception [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         460(9)(e)].  Personal injury includes any injury or disease
         sustained to an individual's person.


    272. Where a taxpayer has a right to receive, or an obligation to
         provide, a financial benefit in relation to personal injury of an
         individual, the exception will apply even if:


                . the personal injury is in the form of a wrong to the
                  individual or an illness of the individual; and/or


                . the person to whom the financial benefit is provided is
                  not the individual who was injured.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-460(10)]


         Injury to reputation


    273. A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, a financial
         benefit in relation to an injury to an individual's reputation is
         the subject of an exception [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         460(9)(f)].  Such rights or obligations may arise, for example,
         from defamation actions.


         Superannuation and pension income


    274. A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, financial benefits
         will be subject to an exception if that right or obligation arises
         from a person's membership of a superannuation or pension scheme.
         This may include the right of a dependant of a member to receive
         financial benefits (or the corresponding obligation to provide
         financial benefits to that dependant).  It may also include the
         right or obligation arising from an interest in a complying or non-
         complying superannuation fund, a pooled superannuation trust, an
         approved deposit fund or a retirement savings account.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsection 230-460(11)]


    275. This exception ensures that Division 230 does not apply to rights
         and obligations that arise under certain superannuation or pension
         schemes and that where relevant the primacy of other provisions
         (such as those contained in Division 295 of the ITAA 1997) in
         respect of those rights and obligations are preserved.


         An interest in a foreign investment fund, foreign life policy or a
         controlled foreign company


    276. Division 230 does not apply to gains and losses from a financial
         arrangement for any income year to the extent that the rights
         and/or obligations under the arrangement arise under an interest in
         a foreign investment fund or an interest in a foreign life
         assurance policy (both as defined in Part XI of the ITAA 1936).
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-460(12)]


    277. An interest in a foreign investment fund includes an interest in a
         foreign company or foreign trust.  An interest in a foreign company
         includes an interest in a company that is a controlled foreign
         company.  Therefore, the exception covers not only an interest in a
         foreign company to which Part XI of the ITAA 1936 applies, but also
         includes an interest in a foreign company to which the controlled
         foreign company rules in Part X of the ITAA 1936 applies.


    278. These relevant interests in foreign investment funds and controlled
         foreign companies are in a broad sense akin to equity interests.
         Division 230 only has a limited operation in respect of financial
         arrangements that are equity interests.  This exception for
         relevant interests in foreign investment funds and controlled
         foreign companies ensures that they are not given an inappropriate
         treatment under Division 230.


         Proceeds from certain business sales


    279. A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, financial benefits
         arising from the direct or indirect sale of business, including
         those rights or obligations arising from the sale of shares in a
         company (or interests in a trust) that operates the business, may
         be the subject of an exception.  These rights and obligations will
         only be the subject of this exception where the amounts or the
         values of the financial benefits to be received or provided are
         contingent on the economic performance of the business after the
         sale.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-460(13)]


    280. This exception applies to exclude arrangements commonly known as
         'earn-outs'.


    281. For the purposes of Division 230, a right to receive one or more
         financial benefits is treated as being two separate rights (see
         Chapter 3) [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-55(1)].  This means
         that if an earn-out arrangement includes a right to receive a fixed
         amount, plus a right to receive an amount that is contingent on the
         economic performance of a business that has been sold, the latter
         right will itself be subject to this exception.  Division 230 can
         continue to apply to the arrangement to the extent that any rights
         or obligations (including the right to receive a fixed amount) are
         not subject to this (or any other) exception.


         Infrastructure borrowings


    282. Division 16L of the ITAA 1936 broadly provides tax concessions for
         infrastructure borrowings in respect of which a certificate has
         been issued by the Development Allowance Authority.  Whilst no new
         certificates have been issued in the last 10 years, existing
         arrangements in respect of previously issued certificates can be
         traded or novated, so can start to become new arrangements in the
         hands of different taxpayers.


    283. Generally speaking, one of the outcomes of Division 16L of the ITAA
         1936 is that interest derived from infrastructure borrowings is tax
         exempt, whilst any interest incurred by an investor on funds
         borrowed for the purpose of investing in infrastructure borrowings
         may be deductible as if the interest derived from infrastructure
         borrowings were not exempt.


    284. Often arrangements under which an investor may borrow to invest in
         infrastructure borrowings are packaged together with the
         infrastructure bond itself, such that under Division 230 it may be
         considered to be the one arrangement.  Such an arrangement may (due
         to certainty of cash flows) have an overall gain for the purposes
         of Subdivision 230-B (the accrual rules).  However, this gain
         (which should essentially be exempt) may have been calculated by
         taking into account outgoings that would otherwise be deductible.


    285. As Division 16L of the ITAA 1936 has ceased to have effect for any
         new infrastructure arrangements, its treatment of infrastructure
         borrowings only continues to have residual application.  It
         nevertheless continues to have application to relevant arrangements
         which are excluded from Division 230.


    286. Note also that Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 is only excluded from
         applying during the first 15 years of an infrastructure borrowing.
         After this time it may start to have application.  Division 16E
         will continue to apply to those arrangements that are subject to
         Division 16L of the ITAA 1936, as appropriate.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-460(14)]


         Farm management deposits


    287. A right to receive, or obligation to provide, financial benefits
         arising under a farm management deposit (within the meaning of
         Schedule 2G to the ITAA 1936) is the subject of an exception,
         provided the right or obligation is held by the owner of the farm
         management deposit.  This exception therefore does not apply to a
         financial institution with whom the farm management deposit is
         held.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-460(15)]


    288. Broadly speaking, a farm management deposit is an account held with
         a financial institution which enables the relevant primary producer
         owner to deduct amounts deposited into such an account in the year
         of deposit, while requiring that amounts when repaid be included in
         assessable income.  In this way, farm management deposits are tax-
         linked, financial risk management tools, designed to allow primary
         producers to set aside income from profitable years for subsequent
         'draw-down' in low-income years.


    289. It is not intended that Division 230 disturb the tax treatment of
         farm management deposits, which is the reason for this exception.


         Rights and obligations to which section 121EK  of the ITAA 1936
         applies


    290. In certain circumstances, the owner of an offshore banking unit
         will be deemed to have received a payment in the nature of
         interest.  The deemed interest is assessable income in the hands of
         the owner of the offshore banking unit.  An exception has been
         included in Division 230 so that a right or obligation that gives
         rise to a deemed interest payment is not a financial arrangement to
         which Division 230 applies.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         460(16)]


         Forestry managed investment schemes


    291. Division 394 of the ITAA 1997 broadly provides that initial
         investors in forestry managed investment schemes (forestry schemes)
         will receive a tax deduction equal to 100 per cent of their
         contributions and subsequent investors will receive a tax deduction
         for their ongoing contributions to forestry schemes, provided that
         at least 70 per cent of the scheme manager's expenditure under the
         scheme is expenditure attributable to establishing, tending and
         felling trees for harvesting (direct forestry expenditure).


    292. Subsection 394-15(3) of the ITAA 1997 defines a forestry interest
         in a forestry managed investment scheme to be a right to benefits
         produced by the scheme (whether the right is actual, prospective or
         contingent and whether it is enforceable or not).  A right to
         receive, or obligation to provide, financial benefits arising under
         a forestry interest in a forestry managed investment scheme would
         ordinarily be a financial arrangement as it constitutes a cash
         settlable right to receive, or obligation to provide, such
         benefits.  An exception from Division 230 has been inserted for
         situations where the investor can claim deductions under section
         394-10 of the ITAA 1997.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         460(17)]


         Regulation-making power for exceptions


    293. Subsection 230-460(18) contains a regulation-making power to enable
         regulations to be made that specify a right or obligation as being
         the subject of an exception.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         460(18)]


         Ceasing to hold financial arrangements in certain circumstances


    294. Section 230-465 broadly operates to prevent losses from being
         allowed as revenue losses under Division 230 as a result of the
         disposal (including partial disposal) or redemption (including
         partial redemption) of a financial arrangement, where it can be
         objectively concluded that a reason for the disposal or redemption
         was an apprehension or belief that the issuer, or other parties to
         the arrangement, would likely be unable or unwilling to discharge
         their obligations to make payments under the financial arrangement.




    295. Section 230-465 applies if:


                . a taxpayer ceases to have a financial arrangement (or part
                  of a financial arrangement);


                . the taxpayer makes a loss, in the context of Division 230
                  (see Chapter 3) from ceasing to have the financial
                  arrangement (or relevant part);


                . if the financial arrangement is a marketable security
                  within the meaning of section 70B of the ITAA 1936:


                  - the taxpayer did not acquire the marketable security in
                    the ordinary course of trading on a securities market
                    and at the time of acquisition the taxpayer did not have
                    the ability to acquire an identical financial
                    arrangement in the ordinary course of trading on a
                    securities market;


                  - the taxpayer did not dispose of the marketable security
                    arrangement in the course of trading on a securities
                    market; and


                . it would be concluded that the taxpayer ceased to have the
                  financial arrangement (whether a marketable security or
                  not) wholly or partly because there was an apprehension or
                  belief that the other party or other parties to the
                  financial arrangement were, or would be likely to be,
                  unable or unwilling to discharge all their liabilities to
                  pay amounts under the financial arrangement.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-465(1)]


    296. Subsection 70B(7) of the ITAA 1936 defines a marketable security as
         a traditional security (within the meaning of subsection 26BB(2) of
         the ITAA 1936) that is either a stock, bond, debenture, certificate
         of entitlement, bill of exchange, promissory note or other
         security.


    297. In determining whether the taxpayer has ceased to have a financial
         arrangement because there was an apprehension or belief that the
         other party would be unable or unwilling to disclose its
         liabilities, regard is to be had to:


                . the financial position of the other party or parties to
                  the arrangement;


                . the perceptions of the financial position of the other
                  party or parties; and


                . other relevant matters.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-465(3)]


    298. Where section 230-465 applies to a financial arrangement, a
         deduction is not allowable under Division 230 in respect of the
         amount of the loss that is a loss of capital or of a capital
         nature.  However, this loss may still be treated as a capital loss
         under the capital gains tax provisions of the ITAA 1997.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsection 230-465(2)]


         Forgiveness of commercial debts


    299. To ensure that relevant gains made from the release, waiver or
         extinguishment of a debt under a financial arrangement continue to
         be subject to the commercial debt forgiveness provisions as set out
         in Subdivision 245-B of Schedule 2C to the ITAA 1936, Division 230
         provides that where a taxpayer makes a gain from a financial
         arrangement from the forgiveness of a debt in accordance with the
         commercial debt forgiveness provisions, that gain is decreased by:


                . the debt's net forgiven amount.  This is in accordance
                  with paragraph 245-85(2)(a) of Schedule 2C to the
                  ITAA 1936 where section 245-90 of the ITAA 1936 - dealing
                  with agreements to forgo capital losses or revenue
                  deductions - does not apply; or


                . the debt's provisional net forgiven amount.  This is in
                  accordance with paragraph 245-85(2)(b) - where section 245-
                  90 applies.

         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-470]

         Exceptions by way of clarification only

    300. For the avoidance of doubt, Division 230 does not apply to a
         taxpayer's gains and losses from a financial arrangement for any
         income year to the extent that the taxpayer's rights and/or
         obligations are a right or obligation arising under a retirement
         village residence contract, a retirement village services contract
         or an arrangement under which residential care or flexible care is
         provided.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-475(3)]

    301. The reason why this exception is only for the avoidance of doubt is
         that it is expected that these arrangements will include non-
         insignificant non-cash settlable rights and obligations for their
         duration, and therefore be prevented from being cash settlable
         financial arrangements under subsection 230-45(1).


         Retirement village residence contracts

    302. A right or obligation arising under a 'retirement village residence
         contract' is the subject of an exception.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-475(3)(a)]


    303. A retirement village residence contract is a contract that gives
         rise to a right to occupy 'residential premises' in a 'retirement
         village' [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-475(4)(a)].  These
         terms take their meaning from section 195-1 of the A New Tax System
         (Goods and Services) Act 1999.  That definition provides that a
         residential premises in a retirement village exists if:

                . the premises are occupied by one or more persons as a main
                  residence;
                . accommodation in the premises is intended to be for
                  persons who are at least 55 years old, or who are a
                  certain age that is more than 55 years; and
                . the premises include communal facilities for use by the
                  residents of the premises;

         but excludes:

                . premises used, or intended to be used, for the provision
                  of residential care (within the meaning of the Aged Care
                  Act 1997) by an approved provider (within the meaning of
                  that Act); and
                . 'commercial residential premises' as defined in
                  section 195-1 of the A New Tax System (Goods and Services)
                  Act 1999.

         Retirement village services contracts


    304. A right or obligation arising under a 'retirement village services
         contract' is the subject of an exception [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-475(1), paragraph 230-475(3)(b)].  A retirement
         village services contract is a contract under which a retirement
         village resident is provided with general or personal services in
         the retirement village [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         475(4)(b)].


         Provision of residential or flexible care


    305. A right or obligation arising under an arrangement under which
         residential care or flexible care is provided is the subject of an
         exception.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-475(1),
         paragraph 230-475(3)(c)].  This exception is intended to exclude
         gains and losses from rights or obligations arising under an
         accommodation bond style arrangement arising from residential or
         flexible care.


    306. 'Residential care' is defined to have the same meaning as in
         section 41-3 of the Aged Care Act 1997, while 'flexible care' is
         defined under section 49-3 of the Aged Care Act 1997.  Residential
         care covers personal and/or nursing care provided to individuals in
         residential care facilities, but does not cover such care when it
         is provided via a hospital, personal residence, psychiatric
         facility or a non-aged care facility.  Flexible care refers to
         alternative care provided in the same setting as residential care.


         Exception for gains in the form of franked distributions


    307. Division 230 does not apply to gains to the extent they are gains
         in the form of a franked distribution or a right to receive a
         franked distribution.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-480]








    308. Chapter 3
Tax treatment of gains and losses from financial arrangements

Outline of chapter


    309. This chapter explains:


                . why Division 230 recognises gains and losses rather than,
                  for example, receipts and outgoings;


                . the revenue character of those gains and losses;


                . the elements of a gain or loss; and


                . which gains and losses are disregarded.


Overview of taxation of financial arrangements gains and losses


    310. This overview summarises the tax treatment of gains and losses from
         financial arrangements.


    311. Gains and losses from financial arrangements are important for the
         purposes of Division 230 because the tax treatment of financial
         arrangements depends on gains and losses made from them and not,
         for example, on receipts and outgoings.  Thus, a taxpayer subject
         to Division 230 may be required to include a gain in their
         assessable income and may be allowed a deduction for a loss where
         it is made in deriving or producing assessable income or in
         carrying on business for the purpose of deriving assessable income.


    312. This means that a net amount, for example, the money received (the
         proceeds) minus the money provided (the cost) under a financial
         arrangement may be included as assessable income when that net
         amount is a gain and claimed as an allowable deduction when that
         net amount is a loss.


    313. Basically, the cost of a financial arrangement will be the total of
         the financial benefits provided, or to be provided, to acquire such
         an arrangement.  Conversely, the proceeds from a financial
         arrangement will be the total of the financial benefits received
         from having such an arrangement including those at maturity of the
         arrangement or the disposal of the arrangement.


    314. There are special rules that ensure that where a financial
         arrangement is received as consideration or provided as
         consideration for the provision of a thing (eg, this could be
         trading stock or a capital gains tax (CGT) asset) the thing is
         taken to have been received or provided for its market value.
         These special rules are intended to provide an appropriate value
         for determining the tax consequences of transactions relating to
         the thing under provisions of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936
         (ITAA 1936) and the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997)
         (including Division 230).


    315. Division 230 will not apply to all gains and losses from financial
         arrangements.  In particular, Division 230 will not apply to gains
         and losses in respect of financial arrangements that are not
         subject to Division 230 nor to the gains and losses of financial
         arrangements held by taxpayers that are not subject to Division
         230.


    316. Some of these specific exceptions are to put it beyond doubt that
         Division 230 will not apply to those financial arrangements while
         others have been included to ensure that Division 230 does not
         apply to taxpayers with relatively simple tax affairs for reasons
         of compliance costs, or for other administrative or policy reasons.


    317. Division 230 will not contain a definition of a 'gain' or a 'loss'.
          However, as a general rule a 'gain' or a 'loss' from a financial
         arrangement may be calculated as follows:


                . Step 1 - calculate the money received from a financial
                  arrangement including that received at maturity or upon
                  disposal.


                . Step 2 - calculate the cost of the financial arrangement
                  including those expenses at maturity or upon disposal.


                . Step 3 - deduct the amount at step 2 from the amount at
                  step 1.


    318. There will be a gain from a financial arrangement if the amount at
         step 3 is positive.  On the other hand, there will be a loss from a
         financial arrangement if the amount at step 3 is negative.


    319. Division 230 will contain rules for determining the amount at step
         2 and allocating it to the amount in step 1 so as to ensure that
         the appropriate amount of gain or loss is subject to Division 230.


    320. The amount of this gain or loss that is assessable or deductible in
         a particular income tax year will be determined by the tax-timing
         treatment (accruals/realisation, fair value, hedging, retranslation
         or financial reports) and the balancing adjustment, where
         applicable, that applies to a particular financial arrangement.


    321. Some losses made from a Division 230 financial arrangement are not
         deductible.  Examples are losses made to the extent they are in
         gaining or producing exempt income or non-assessable non-exempt
         income.  Other non-deductible losses are those of a private or
         domestic in nature.  These losses are not deductible for any income
         tax purposes.


    322. A gain made from a Division 230 financial arrangement will continue
         to be exempt income or non-assessable non-exempt income to the
         extent the gain would have been exempt income or non-assessable non-
         exempt income by a provision outside Division 230 on the assumption
         Division 230 was not enacted.  Also, a gain made on a Division 230
         financial arrangement will be exempt income if, instead, the gain
         had been a loss and the loss would have been made gaining or
         producing exempt income.  A similar rule is provided in respect of
         gains that are to be treated as non-assessable non-exempt income.
         For example, if a taxpayer subject to Division 230 makes a loss on
         a financial arrangement where the arrangement was entered into in
         gaining or producing exempt income, that loss would not be
         deductible;  paragraph 230-30(3)(a).  Therefore, to provide
         symmetry, if a taxpayer had made a gain from a financial
         arrangement, such as a forward contract, as part of an activity
         that produces exempt income, and instead had that gain had been a
         loss that would have been denied deductibility under paragraph 230-
         30(3)(a), the gain is taken to be exempt income: paragraph 230-
         30(2)(a).


    323. Finally, Division 230 will not apply to gains in the form of
         franked distributions or rights to franked distributions.  This
         allows the existing tax law to apply in respect of such franked
         distributions.  Also, Division 230 does not apply to gains that are
         of a private and domestic nature made from a financial arrangement.


    324. Under Division 230 the general rule is that gains and losses from
         financial arrangements will be on revenue account.  This treatment
         will simplify the law by removing the need to determine the revenue
         or capital nature of such gains and losses.


    325. Division 230 will contain anti-overlap rules to ensure that gains
         and losses from financial arrangements are not double-counted for
         income tax purposes.  However, these rules will not prevent
         Division 230 gains and losses being used to calculate other amounts
         for income tax purposes.  For instance, such amounts may be used in
         calculating thresholds where appropriate.


Context of amendments


Gains and losses from financial arrangements


    326. Under current income tax law, the taxation of financial
         arrangements is based on an amalgam of provisions, including the
         ordinary income provision (section 6-5 of the ITAA 1997), the
         general deduction provision (section 8-1 of the ITAA 1997) and
         various specific provisions.


    327. The application of the ordinary income and general deduction
         provisions to financial arrangements may not always produce
         appropriate results.  Because of the complexity in the structure of
         many financial arrangements, greater clarity, consistency and
         coherency can be obtained by only recognising gains and losses from
         relevant financial arrangements for income tax purposes.


    328. The concept of gain or loss connotes the appropriate offsetting of
         the cost (broadly, financial benefits provided under the financial
         arrangement) against proceeds (broadly, financial benefits received
         under the financial arrangement).  However, in recognising that a
         gain or loss is a net concept, it is important to note that:


                . the gain or loss may be recognised despite not all
                  offsetting amounts being fully known (eg, a gain or loss
                  will be recognised under the accruals method if it is
                  known with sufficient certainty to be of at least a
                  certain amount);


                . whilst an overall gain or loss will often be able to be
                  determined for a financial arrangement as a whole, more
                  than one gain or loss may be made from a financial
                  arrangement;


                . a mere receipt of a financial benefit or payment of a
                  financial benefit may itself represent a gain or loss if
                  no offsetting financial benefits are reasonably
                  attributable to that particular receipt or payment;


                . a payment need not be received in order to make a gain
                  (eg, the receipt of a financial benefit includes the
                  reduction or saving of an amount of a liability);


                . gains and losses can be made from holding a financial
                  arrangement, as well as on the cessation or disposal of
                  that financial arrangement; and


                . the gain or loss is to be calculated in nominal, rather
                  than present value, terms.  Therefore, in determining the
                  gain or loss from the financial arrangement, the financial
                  benefits to be received or provided under the arrangement
                  should be taken into account at the value they have at the
                  time they are received or provided, and should not be
                  discounted to their present values when a taxpayer first
                  starts to have the arrangement.


      1. :  Gain or loss from an option


                A typical option requires the payment of a premium at the
                time the arrangement is entered into.


                However, the mere payment of the premium does not represent
                a loss for the purchaser of the option (the option holder).
                While the premium is an outgoing of the option holder, it is
                an outgoing which is reasonably attributable to any
                financial benefits that may be received under the option
                agreement.  Likewise, the mere receipt of the option premium
                does not yet produce a gain for the issuer of the option.


                That is, the gain or loss on a typical option is calculated
                by offsetting the cost or proceeds represented by the
                premium against the net amounts, if any, received or paid
                from disposal or exercise of that option.


                For example, as part of its speculative activities, U-mine
                Co acquires an option to purchase US$100,000 in 18 months
                time for a set amount of Australian dollars, by paying a
                A$2,000 option premium.  U-mine Co will not make a gain or
                loss from its option arrangement until its rights under the
                option agreement cease (eg, through being disposed of,
                exercised or expiring).  Note, however, that some of the tax-
                timing methods in Division 230 may apply to calculate a gain
                or a loss from the arrangement before this time.


Character of gains and losses from financial arrangements


    329. If the tax framework in Division 230 did not clarify that gains and
         losses from financial arrangements are to be on revenue account
         unless subject to a specific rule, existing tests and factors would
         need to be considered in determining the character of gains and
         losses from a particular financial arrangement.  The
         revenue/capital distinction in the income tax law is often a very
         difficult distinction to make, relying on factors such as purpose,
         the degree of periodicity, and the circumstances in which the
         relevant amount is found in the hands of the particular taxpayer.
         Determining the character of the gains and losses against factors
         such as these can be very demanding and complex and the outcome may
         be uncertain.


    330. In this regard, certainty as to the character of some gains and
         losses from financial arrangements has been provided by a number of
         existing specific provisions.  Specifically, revenue treatment has
         been provided by:


                . sections 26BB and 70B of the ITAA 1936, in relation to the
                  disposal of traditional securities;


                . Division 3B of Part III of the ITAA 1936, in relation to
                  foreign currency gains and losses; and


                . Division 775 of the ITAA 1997, in relation to foreign
                  currency denominated arrangements (with limited
                  exceptions).


    331. Complexity will be further reduced by removing the capital/revenue
         distinction in respect of financial arrangements by taxing all
         gains and losses on revenue account under Division 230.  An
         exception to the requirement that a gain or loss from a financial
         arrangement will always be on revenue account is contained within
         the hedging financial arrangements election, and is applicable to
         certain hedging financial arrangements.  Under this exception, the
         tax characterisation of a hedging financial arrangement may be
         based on the characterisation already given to the hedged item
         under the taxation law, and to that extent will not of itself
         increase complexity to any significant extent.


    332. In addition, any gains and losses to which Division 230 expressly
         does not apply (such as through an exception as set out in
         Subdivision 230-H as explained in Chapter 2) will fall for
         consideration under the existing tax law.  This means their tax
         treatment, including their character, is to be determined by any
         residual operation of the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997.


Nexus test for losses


    333. To be deductible, the current income tax law requires a sufficient
         nexus between losses and the gaining or producing of assessable
         income.  This concept is preserved under Division 230.


Summary of new law


    334. Unless otherwise specified, gains and losses from financial
         arrangements are on revenue account.  Unless specifically provided
         for:


                . gains from financial arrangements are included in
                  assessable income; and


                . losses from financial arrangements made in gaining or
                  producing assessable income, or necessarily made in
                  carrying on a business for the purpose of gaining or
                  producing such income, are deductible.


    335. Losses from financial arrangements made in gaining or producing
         exempt or non-assessable non-exempt income are not deductible.
         Gains made from financial arrangements will be exempt income or non-
         assessable non-exempt income to the extent that they reflect
         amounts that would be treated or would reasonably be expected to be
         treated as exempt or non-assessable non-exempt income under a
         provision outside Division 230 if Division 230 were not enacted.
         Division 230 does not apply to gains to the extent they are gains
         in the form of a franked distribution or a right to receive a
         franked distribution.


    336. Losses made from borrowings used for private or domestic purposes
         or by individuals from derivative financial arrangements held or
         used for private or domestic purposes are not deductible while
         Division 230 does not apply to gains made from such borrowings.


    337. Gains and losses from financial arrangements are recognised only
         once for tax purposes.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|Unless subject to       |There is lack of clarity|
|specified exemption, or |as to whether the basis |
|as provided for under   |for taxation is gains   |
|the hedging financial   |and losses made under an|
|arrangement method, all |arrangement, or receipts|
|gains and losses from   |and outgoings, or some  |
|financial arrangements  |combination thereof.    |
|are on revenue account. |There is a complex      |
|Unless subject to       |mixture of revenue and  |
|specified exemption, all|capital account         |
|gains from financial    |treatment for gains and |
|arrangements are        |losses from many        |
|assessable.             |financial arrangements, |
|Unless subject to       |often involving         |
|specified exemption, all|uncertainty as to       |
|losses from financial   |appropriate treatment.  |
|arrangements made in    |Gains and losses on     |
|deriving assessable     |disposal of liabilities |
|income are deductible.  |are not systematically  |
|                        |addressed.              |


Detailed explanation of new law


Determining the gain or loss from a financial arrangement


    338. The various tax-timing methods available under
         Division 230, discussed in detail in later chapters of this
         explanatory memorandum, are used to determine the timing and
         quantum of gains and losses made from a financial arrangement.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-40]


    339. Unless otherwise specified, the gain or loss recognised over the
         life of the financial arrangement is the total gain or loss.  In
         some cases, recognition of the total gain or loss may come about
         through a combination of provisions in Division 230 (eg, the
         compounding accruals method in Subdivision 230-B and the balancing
         adjustment required when the taxpayer ceases to have a financial
         arrangement in Subdivision 230-G).  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-40]


    340. The concept of gain or loss connotes the appropriate offsetting of
         the cost (financial benefits provided or to be provided, or rights
         to financial benefits forgone under the financial arrangement)
         against proceeds (financial benefits received or to be received, or
         obligations to pay financial benefits saved under the financial
         arrangement).  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-70 and 230-75]


    341. In recognising that a gain or loss is a net concept, it is
         important to note that the gain or loss is generally determined by
         making a reasonable allocation of:


                . the costs of the financial arrangement (financial benefits
                  provided or to be provided, either under the financial
                  arrangement or which are integral to the calculation of a
                  gain or loss from the arrangement); and


                . the proceeds from the financial arrangement (financial
                  benefits received or to be received, either under the
                  financial arrangement or which are integral to the
                  calculation of a gain or loss from the arrangement or the
                  amount of such gain or loss).


         [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-60, 230-70 and 230-75]


         Costs and proceeds of a financial arrangement


    342. The costs of, and proceeds from, the financial arrangement
         naturally include financial benefits provided and/or received in
         satisfaction of the obligations and/or rights that comprise the
         relevant financial arrangement.  These will be financial benefits
         received and/or provided under the relevant financial arrangement.


    343. Notably, the costs of, and proceeds from, the financial arrangement
         also include financial benefits in addition to those financial
         benefits provided or received under the financial arrangement.
         Specifically, the costs of, and proceeds from, the financial
         arrangement will also include other financial benefits received or
         provided (or those which the taxpayer is entitled to receive or
         obliged to provide) that play an integral role in determining
         whether the taxpayer will make a gain or loss (or a gain or loss of
         a particular amount) from the financial arrangement.


    344. For this purpose, a financial benefit received or provided (or a
         financial benefit which the taxpayer is entitled to receive or
         obliged to provide) will be integral to determining whether the
         taxpayer will make a relevant gain or loss from the financial
         arrangement if it is an essential part of determining that gain or
         loss or the amount of such a gain or loss.  What is considered
         essential or integral will be determined by the nature or purpose
         of the financial benefit that is taken to be provided or received
         under the financial arrangement.  The quantum of the particular
         financial benefit in this respect is not determinative as to
         whether it is considered 'integral'.  For example an application
         fee paid on a home loan provided by a bank may be 'integral' to
         determining whether the bank makes a gain or loss from the home
         loan even though it would be a much smaller amount than the
         interest income that is to be received by the bank from the
         borrower.


    345. Such integral financial benefits may include the costs incurred to
         acquire the financial arrangement (including, for example, any
         application or processing charges, in addition to the specific
         consideration for the relevant rights and obligations under the
         arrangement) and amounts received on transfer or cessation of all
         or part of the financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section
         230-60]


      1. :  Continuation of Example 2.16, scenario 2


                In this scenario, Steam Co has a financial arrangement
                consisting entirely of its obligation to pay $1 million to
                Big Co, which it started to have as consideration for, and
                at the time of, receiving delivery of the train from Big Co.




                The proceeds Steam Co receives (the train that was
                delivered) for starting to have this obligation, is integral
                to the calculation of the gain or loss that is made from its
                financial arrangement constituted by Steam Co's outstanding
                obligation.  Accordingly, the train (valued at the time it
                is received by Steam Co), is a financial benefit that
                Steam Co is taken to have had the right to receive under its
                financial arrangement, broadly for the purpose of
                determining any gains and losses Steam Co makes from that
                arrangement (subsection 230-60(2)).


                Note, however, the amount taken to have been provided for
                the train for the purposes of this Act (eg, determining a
                deduction for a depreciating unit) may be affected by
                section 230-505.  Section 230-505 will treat the amount of
                the benefit provided for the train as the market value of
                the train at the time it was acquired.


    346. More generally, what is considered to be integral or essential to
         determining whether the taxpayer makes a relevant gain or loss from
         the financial arrangement can be determined by commercially
         accepted principles and the relevant facts and circumstances of
         each arrangement.  However, the costs of, or proceeds from, the
         financial arrangement, where they are integral to the calculation
         of a gain or loss from the arrangement, need not necessarily be
         provided or received from parties to the particular financial
         arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-60]


    347. It is possible that a financial benefit could be considered
         integral to more than one financial arrangement.  An example would
         be where a fixed and indivisible fee is to be provided to acquire
         either one or more financial arrangements.  In this circumstance,
         it will be necessary to apportion on a reasonable basis the actual
         amount of the financial benefit between the financial arrangements.
          This will ensure that the gain and loss from each financial
         arrangement reflects the proper apportionment of the financial
         benefit.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-65]


    348. Also a financial benefit may be provided or received as
         consideration for starting or ceasing to have one or more things
         which themselves are not financial arrangements.  Where this occurs
         the amount of financial benefit needs to be apportioned, between
         the financial arrangement and other things on a reasonable basis.
         This means that only that part of the amount of the financial
         benefit that plays an integral role to the financial arrangement is
         taken to be received or provided under the arrangement.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, section 230-65]


     1. :  Financial benefit provided as consideration for a financial
        arrangement and services


                Deb Co enters into an arrangement where it agrees to provide
                a train worth $1 million in return for a bond worth $700,000
                and services worth $300,000.  The financial benefits
                provided, the train, is integral to determining Deb Co's
                gain or loss from the bond.  Section 230-65 therefore
                applies for the purpose of Division 230 causing the
                $1 million financial benefit provided to be apportioned and
                the services on a reasonable basis.  Therefore, Deb Co is
                taken to have provided $700,000 worth of financial benefits
                under the financial arrangement to acquire the bond.


    349. The above paragraphs have outlined the basic case of how the cost
         and proceeds from a financial arrangement are determined.  It can
         be seen that the gain or loss from a cash settlable financial
         arrangement can therefore be determined by comparing:


                . the financial benefits provided, or to be provided, as
                  consideration for (or that are integral to) obtaining a
                  cash settlable right to receive a financial benefit, with
                  the financial benefits received, or to be received, as
                  consideration for (or that are integral to) the
                  satisfaction or other cessation of that right; and


                . the financial benefits received, or to be received, as
                  consideration for (or that are integral to) assuming a
                  cash settlable obligation to provide a financial benefit,
                  with the financial benefits provided, or to be provided,
                  in consideration for (or that are integral to) the
                  satisfaction or other cessation of that obligation.


         Cost or proceeds where a financial arrangement starts or ceases to
         be held as consideration for providing or acquiring something else


    350. As mentioned in paragraph 3.37, the costs or proceeds of a
         financial arrangement include financial benefits provided or
         received in satisfaction of the obligations or rights comprising
         the financial arrangement.  If a financial arrangement is started
         or ceased as consideration for the provision or acquisition of
         something else (whether money or not) the financial benefits may
         include that thing but, if they do not, section 230-60 would
         operate to deem the thing (the something else) to be provided or
         received under the financial arrangement.  The costs of, or
         proceeds from, a financial arrangement that started or ceased to be
         held as consideration for providing or acquiring something is (or
         includes) the market value of the relevant thing when it is
         provided or acquired.


      1. :  Cost of widgets


                White Co manufactures widgets.  The cost to White Co of
                manufacturing each widget is $80, and they retail for their
                market value of $90.  White Co enters into a deferred
                payment arrangement to sell a widget to Black Co for $100,
                to be paid in 18 months.  The cost to White Co of the
                financial arrangement represented by the deferred payment
                arrangement is the market value of the widget provided $90,
                rather than the cost to it of the widget ($80).


    351. The primary function of section 230-505 is to provide appropriate
         interaction between the provisions of Division 230 and the other
         provisions of the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997 (including Division
         230 if the thing is also a financial arrangement) where a financial
         arrangement (or part of a financial arrangement) whose gains and
         losses are subject to Division 230 is provided or received as
         consideration for a thing.  In a broad sense, the provision ensures
         that the amount of the benefit taken to be obtained or provided for
         the thing is, for the purposes of this Act, the market value of the
         thing at the time it is provided or acquired.  This will result in
         symmetry between the cost or proceeds of the financial arrangement
         started or ceased and the amount for which the thing is taken to
         have been acquired or disposed of.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-505]


    352. Section 230-505 will not apply where gains and losses from the
         relevant financial arrangement which is consideration for the thing
         are not subject to Division 230.  For example, where a taxpayer
         provides an asset to another party as consideration for a right to
         receive a payment of money from that party in the future (a cash
         settlable financial arrangement), in circumstances where gains and
         losses from that right are not subject to Division 230 (eg, under
         section 230-455 because of the taxpayer's traits, or under section
         230-450 because of the period for which the right will be
         outstanding), section 230-505 will have no application in resetting
         the amount taken to have been received for that asset for tax
         purposes.  Section 230-505 only applies in respect of dealings with
         financial arrangements that are themselves dealt with under
         Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-505(1)]


    353. The impact of the operation of section 230-505 upon the tax
         treatment of a thing for which a relevant financial arrangement is
         consideration is discussed in detail in Chapter 11.


    354. Section 230-505 ensures that there is symmetry between the cost or
         proceeds of the financial arrangement and the acquisition or
         disposal consideration for the thing.  In other words, section 230-
         505 ensures symmetry between the following two amounts for tax
         purposes:


                . the cost or proceeds of the financial arrangement that is
                  either started or ceased as consideration for the thing
                  acquired or provided under the relevant transaction (these
                  costs or proceeds are used to determine the amount of the
                  gain or loss on the financial arrangement); and


                . the amount for which the thing is taken to have been
                  acquired or disposed of (eg, the cost base of, or capital
                  proceeds for, a CGT asset, used to determine the amount of
                  the capital gain or loss on that asset).


     355. This symmetry is required to ensure that, where both Division 230
          and another provision of the income tax law apply to a particular
          transaction, there is no overlap or gap between the operation of
          the Division and the operation of that other provision.  Symmetry
          is also required to ensure that, where Division 230 applies to a
          financial arrangement whose acquisition or disposal is part of
          another financial arrangement also taxed under Division 230, each
          financial arrangement is (separately and cumulatively with the
          other financial arrangement) treated appropriately: see the
          discussion below under the heading Things that are financial
          arrangements.


     356. The effect of section 230-505 is that, for all income tax
          purposes, the cost of the financial arrangement is taken to be the
          market value of the thing provided.  Similarly, the proceeds of
          the financial arrangement is taken to be the market value of the
          thing acquired.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-505(2)]


       1. :  Sale of a CGT asset for a bond


                Saint Co purchased a factory in 2000 for $1.1 million.


                In April 2011 it sells the factory to Moore Co in exchange
                for receiving a five-year zero coupon bond, with a face
                value of $3 million.  At the date of sale, Saint Co's
                factory has an estimated market value of $2.5 million.
                Assume that any gain on sale of the factory would be subject
                to CGT.


                The bond is a cash settlable financial arrangement.


                In terms of subsection 230-505(1), Saint Co starts to have
                the bond (a Division 230 financial arrangement) as
                consideration for providing the factory.


                Because of the operation of section 230-505, for the
                purposes of the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997, the proceeds
                Saint Co receives for the sale of the factory will be taken
                to be the market value of the factory, that is, $2.5 million
                (subsection 230-505(2)).


                As a result the difference between Saint Co's cost of the
                factory ($1.1 million) and the market value of the factory
                that was received ($2.5 million) will be taken into account
                under Parts 3-1 and 3-3 of the ITAA 1997 (a $1.4 million
                capital gain).  In accordance with the general principles
                for determining the cost of a financial arrangement, the
                market value of the factory (financial benefit provided)
                would be included as the cost of the financial arrangement
                (the bond).  As a result the difference between the market
                value of the factory ($2.5 million) and the proceeds Saint
                Co receives from the bond on redemption ($3 million), that
                is, a $500,000 gain, will be taken into account under
                Division 230.


    357. In the example above, section 230-505 has ensured symmetry between
         the proceeds received for the sale of the factory and the cost of
         the financial arrangement such that the appropriate amount is
         recognised for the purposes of CGT and Division 230.


      1. :  Deferred settlement


                Bill Co had an agreement to sell land to Jim Co for $100,000
                and agreed to allow Jim Co 18 months from the settlement
                date to pay.


                In the hands of Bill Co, the land (a CGT asset), is held on
                capital account with CGT tax treatment.


                At the settlement date, the market value of the land is
                $87,000.


                Bill Co will start to have a financial arrangement on the
                settlement date consisting of its cash settlable right to
                receive $100,000 from Jim Co (section 230-45).  The
                financial benefit provided under the financial arrangement
                is the land, whose value is $87,000 (subsection 230-60(1)).


                For the purpose of calculating a capital gain or loss on
                disposal of the land, Bill Co is taken to have received
                capital proceeds from disposal of the land equal to the
                market value of the land, being $87,000 (subsection 230-
                505(2)).


                Assuming the cost base of the land is $50,000, Bill Co will
                make a $37,000 capital gain.  Given that the cost of the
                financial arrangement (being the market value of the land)
                is $87,000 and the proceeds of the financial arrangement are
                $100,000, Bill Co will make a $13,000 gain on the financial
                arrangement.


                In the absence of the rule in section 230-505, assuming the
                whole of the deferred settlement amount is included as
                capital proceeds, the capital gain would have been $50,000
                ($100,000 capital proceeds less $50,000 cost base) in
                addition to the $13,000 gain made on the financial
                arrangement.  As a result, section 230-505 will ensure there
                is no duplication of gains or losses in respect of the
                transaction for all tax purposes.


         Things that are financial arrangements


    358. Section 230-505 will apply where the relevant thing that starts, or
         ceases, to be held as consideration for starting or ceasing to have
         all or part of a financial arrangement is also a financial
         arrangement.  The effect of section 230-505 is to treat this
         financial arrangement (which is the relevant thing for the purposes
         of the section) as having been dealt with for its market value.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-505(2)]


      1. :  Exchange of bonds under a forward contract


                On 1 July 2010 Money Co enters into a forward contract with
                Option Co to exchange its Bond A for Options Co's Bond B on
                30 June 2012 (the date on which the exchange takes place).
                At the time of exchange, Bond A has a market value of $100
                and Bond B has a market value of $110.  Assume that Money Co
                acquired Bond A for $80 and Bond B has a face value of $130
                with maturity at 30 June 2013.


                In this bond swap there are three financial arrangements:
                the two financial arrangements being exchanged as
                consideration for each other, and an overarching financial
                arrangement, being the forward contract (a financial
                arrangement under section 230-45).  Each bond is also a
                thing for whose acquisition or disposal the relevant part of
                the forward contract (ie, the obligation to deliver, or
                right to receive, the other bond) is started as
                consideration.  (Alternatively, the consideration for each
                bond is the bond for which it is exchanged:  in other words,
                starting to hold the other bond is the consideration for the
                provision of the bonds as things to which section 230-505
                applies.)  Because Division 230 applies to the overarching
                financial arrangement, the exclusion in subsection 230-
                505(3) does not apply.  Therefore, subsection 230-505(2)
                ensures that the amount of the proceeds received by Money Co
                for disposing of Bond A is its $100 market value (which is
                also the cost provided by Option Co for acquiring Bond A)
                while the cost provided by Money Co for acquiring Bond B is
                taken to be its $110 market value (which would also be the
                proceeds by Option Co for disposing of Bond B).


                When the exchange occurs two balancing adjustment events
                arise for Money Co:


                1 - Rights/obligations under the forward contract ceases


              . The general financial arrangement cost and proceeds
                principles apply to determine the gains or losses made from
                the forward contract ceasing.


              . Financial benefit provided:  Bond A with market value of
                $100.


              . Financial benefit received:  Bond B with market value of
                $110.


              . Division 230 gain under section 230-445:  $10.


                2 - Bond A is transferred


              . Financial benefit provided:  $80.


              . Financial benefit received:  $100 (deemed amount under
                section 230-505).


              . Division 230 gain under section 230-445:  $20.


              . At 30 June 2012 Money Co has a total Division 230 gain of
                $30.


                Assuming that Money Co holds Bond B until 30 June 2013 when
                Bond B matures, a balancing adjustment event will arise:


              . Financial benefit provided:  $110 (deemed amount under
                section 230-505).


              . Financial benefit received:  $130.


              . Division 230 gain under section 230-445:  $20.


              . At 30 June 2013 Money Co has a Division 230 gain of $20.


                Overall, Money Co has made a Division 230 gain of $50.  This
                matches the economic outcome because Money Co provided $80
                (for Bond A) and received $130 (on maturity of Bond B).


    359. The following example shows the symmetry between the proceeds
         received for Bond A (paragraph 230-505(2)(a)) and the cost of the
         forward contract being the financial benefits provided in
         satisfaction of the obligation under the forward contract.
         Similarly the example shows the symmetry between the cost of Bond B
         (paragraph 230-505(2)(b)) and the proceeds received under the
         forward contract being the financial benefits received in
         satisfaction of the right to receive $120.


      1. :  Forward sale of a bond


                 On 1 July 2010 Share Co enters into a forward contract with
                 Delta Co to sell its Bond A for $120 on 30 June 2012.  At
                 the time of the sale, Bond A has a market value of $130.
                 Share Co acquired Bond A for $100.


                 For the purposes of applying Divisions 230 to Share Co,
                 there are two financial arrangements being the forward
                 contract and Bond A.


                 Forward contract financial arrangement


                 For the purposes of determining Share Co's gain or loss on
                 the forward contract, Division 230 picks up the financial
                 benefits provided and received in satisfaction of the
                 obligation and right under the forward contract.  In this
                 example, the financial benefits provided and received are
                 Bond A and $120 respectively.  The value of these financial
                 benefits is determined by the general financial arrangement
                 cost and proceeds principles.  Therefore Share Co will make
                 a $10 loss on the forward contract comprising the financial
                 benefits provided (being the market value of the bond at
                 the time it was provided) and the financial benefit
                 received (being $120).


                 Bond financial arrangement


                 Section 230-505 applies to Bond A as a thing because Share
                 Co starts to have part of the forward contract (the right
                 to receive $120) as consideration for providing Bond A
                 (subsection 230-505(1)).  Share Co will be taken to have
                 obtained an amount for providing Bond A equal to the market
                 value of Bond A at the time it is provided (ie, $130)
                 (subsection 230-505(2)).  Therefore Share Co makes a $30
                 gain on Bond A.


                 Overall, Share Co has made a net gain of $20.  This gain is
                 consistent with the economic substance of the two financial
                 arrangements.  That is, Share Co provided $100 for
                 acquiring Bond A and received $120 for ceasing to hold Bond
                 A.


          Where an overarching financial arrangement is not a Division 230
          financial arrangement


     360. The purpose of section 230-505 is to ensure appropriate
          interactions through symmetry between the cost and proceeds of
          both the relevant thing and the financial arrangement started or
          ceased as consideration.  A thing for the purposes of section 230-
          505 may be a financial arrangement whose gains and losses are the
          subject of Division 230.  The value of this thing may not be
          reflected in either the cost of, or the proceeds from, an
          overarching arrangement that is itself a financial arrangement
          whose gains and losses are the subject of Division 230.  In such a
          case, no symmetrical outcome is required and section 230-505 is
          prevented from applying to the thing.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
          subsection 230-505(3)]


       1. :  Exchange of shares


                On 1 July 2010 Finance Co enters into an arrangement with
                Business Co to exchange its Share A with Business Co's Share
                B on 30 June 2012.  Finance Co fair values both Share A and
                Share B, but not the agreement (the overarching financial
                arrangement).


                Both Share A and Share B are financial arrangements to which
                Division 230 applies pursuant to subsection 230-50(1).
                However, the exchange contract is not a Division 230
                financial arrangement because it is not fair valued nor
                subject to the financial reports election (and the shares
                are not cash settlable).  In other words, the overarching
                financial arrangement is not subject to Division 230.


                Here there is no overarching financial arrangement to which
                section 230-505 needs to apply to ensure appropriate
                interaction between the arrangements.  Therefore, subsection
                230-505(3) operates to prevent the application of subsection
                230-505(2) to Share A and Share B.  Instead the ordinary
                cost and proceeds rules in the income tax law will apply so
                that, absent unusual features of the arrangement, the value
                of Share B will constitute the proceeds for the disposal of
                Share A, and vice versa.


    361. Sometimes a financial arrangement may be started or ceased not as
         consideration (in a direct or contractual sense) for a thing, but
         nevertheless in circumstances where it is necessary to provide
         symmetry between the cost/proceeds of both the financial
         arrangement and the thing.  If section 230-505 is not triggered in
         such circumstances, the gains or losses that arise under other
         provisions of the Act in relation to the thing may duplicate the
         gains or losses generated from the financial arrangement.


    362. An example of this type of situation is an entity acquiring a right
         to do something (which is the 'thing' for section 230-505 purposes)
         as consideration for a payment (deductible under section 8-1 of the
         ITAA 1997) and that payment obligation being subsequently satisfied
         by the issue of a financial arrangement.  Although the financial
         arrangement is issued as consideration for satisfaction of the
         payment (or the extinguishment of an obligation) there is a clear
         causal connection between the acquisition of the thing and the
         issue of the financial arrangement.  This is because the payment is
         consideration for the thing and this payment is satisfied by the
         issue of the financial arrangement.  In terms of the substance or
         effect, the financial arrangement is issued in exchange for the
         acquisition of the thing.


    363. Subsection 230-505(8) applies to ensure that, in this situation,
         the deduction available for the payment and the gain or loss
         available under Division 230 properly reflects the economic gain or
         loss on the total transaction.  In this example, the benefit deemed
         to have been provided for the thing (the deductible payment) will
         be taken by subsection 230-505(2) to be the market value of the
         thing at the time it is acquired.  Subsection 230-505(8) requires a
         determination of what, in effect, the entity acquiring the thing
         starts or ceases to have the financial arrangement for.


         Allocation of costs to proceeds


    364. As mentioned above, the determination of a gain or a loss from a
         financial arrangement involves an allocation of the cost of that
         arrangement to any proceeds taken to be from that arrangement (or,
         more specifically, an allocation of the financial benefits taken to
         be received and provided under that financial arrangement).  Where
         there is more than one gain or loss made from the financial
         arrangement over its lifetime (eg, where an overall gain or loss
         cannot be determined from the financial arrangement at its
         inception, but there are several particular gains and losses made
         from the arrangement over its lifetime (see Chapter 4)) it is
         particularly important that the financial benefits provided, or to
         be provided, under the financial arrangement are appropriately
         allocated to the relevant financial benefits received, or to be
         received, under that financial arrangement.


    365. The attribution of the costs of the financial arrangement to the
         proceeds from the financial arrangement is reasonable only if it
         reflects appropriate and commercially accepted valuation
         techniques.  The cost and proceeds allocation, in reflecting such
         techniques, must properly take into account:


                . the nature of the rights and obligations under the
                  financial arrangement;


                . the risks associated with each of the rights, obligations
                  and financial benefits under the arrangement; and


                . the time value of money.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-70(3) and 230-75(3)]


    366. Requiring that the attribution of cost and proceeds reflect
         valuation principles that take into account the time value of money
         does not mean that the value of the financial benefits used to
         determine the overall gain or loss from the arrangement can be
         discounted.  Rather, a relevant cost amount is to be appropriately
         spread, taking into account the time value of money, when being
         allocated in its entirety to relevant proceed amounts.  It does not
         go so far as to say that the cost and proceeds (and the
         corresponding calculation of gain or loss) can be discounted to
         present value.  The calculation of the gain or loss from the
         financial arrangement is specifically to be conducted in nominal
         (and not present value) terms.  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-
         70 and 230-75]


    367. Importantly, this requires that the value of the relevant financial
         benefit must be determined as at the time when it is (or is to be)
         received or provided.


      1. :  Valuing financial benefits integral to gain or loss


                Under an arrangement, Cat Co receives $100 from Dog Co, in
                return for assuming an obligation to pay Dog Co $150 in
                three years time.  Cat Co has a financial arrangement
                consisting of its cash settlable obligation to pay $150.  At
                the time of assuming this obligation, Cat Co's obligation to
                pay Dog Co has a present value of $100.


                From the start of the arrangement, Cat Co's obligation is
                not valued in present value terms but is taken for the
                purposes of Division 230 to be an obligation to pay $150.


                As the proceeds for assuming this obligation are integral to
                calculating Cat Co's gain or loss from the financial
                arrangement, Cat Co is taken to have received the $100
                financial benefit it received in relation to this
                arrangement, under the arrangement (section 230-60).


                At the time of entering the arrangement, then, Cat Co is
                sufficiently certain that it will make a $50 loss
                (calculated in nominal terms) from the arrangement.


                However, after one year, Cat Co novates its obligation to
                Bird Co, in return for providing a bond to Bird Co.  The
                value of both the outstanding obligation and the bond at the
                time of novation is $130.  The bond is due to mature several
                years after the time of novation, for its face value of
                $200.


                Being integral to calculating the gain or loss Cat Co makes
                on its financial arrangement, Cat Co is taken to have
                provided the bond under its financial arrangement with Dog
                Co.  It does not matter that Cat Co provided the bond to an
                entity (Bird Co) that is a third party to its arrangement
                with Dog Co (subsection 230-60(1)).


                The financial benefit that Cat Co in fact provides (the
                bond) is taken to be $130.  This is the value of the
                financial benefits that Cat Co, at the time it provides
                them, has given to Bird Co and therefore the amount taken to
                have been provided by Cat Co under the arrangement pursuant
                to section 230-60.  Subsection 230-75(1) makes it clear that
                it is the gain or loss, and not the individual financial
                benefits that are in fact provided or in fact received, that
                must be calculated in nominal terms.  It would be an anomaly
                if Cat Co were taken to have provided $200 to extinguish its
                obligation to Dog Co.


                Cat Co will therefore make a $30 loss from its financial
                arrangement rather than its expected $50 loss.


                The requirement that the gain or loss must be calculated in
                nominal terms is designed to ensure that the outcome is not
                that Cat Co makes no loss from the arrangement.  Without
                such a requirement, it may be argued that, as the present
                value of Cat Co's obligation to pay $150 under the financial
                arrangement was, when it was incurred, only $100, no gain or
                loss is made as Cat Co also received $100 under the
                arrangement.  Such an approach is not permissible under
                sections 230-70 and 230-75.


    368. Example 3.10 illustrates that if a financial benefit received or
         provided under an arrangement is, for example, an asset that itself
         consists of a series of future cash flows, the financial benefit
         being the asset is to be taken into account in determining a gain
         or loss from the financial arrangement at its market value when
         received or provided.  The cash flows it represents are not amounts
         provided under the relevant financial arrangement, or that are
         integral to calculating the gain or loss from the relevant
         financial arrangement.  The requirement that a gain or loss from
         the financial arrangement be calculated in nominal terms does not
         go so far as to suggest that where the financial benefit provided
         under the arrangement is such an asset, its value must be
         represented by the dollar sum of its expected cash flows.


    369. If a right to a financial benefit is received in the form of an
         obligation being waived, or an obligation to provide a financial
         benefit is provided in the form of waiving a right to receive a
         financial benefit from someone else, the amount of those financial
         benefits is taken to be the market value of the debt waived, as
         determined at the time of the waiver.


    370. The following example provides an illustration of the valuation
         rule where a financial benefit is received or provided in the form
         of a waiver.


      1. :  Value of a financial benefit in the form of a waiver


                LA Co has an outstanding debt owing to AH Co of $200 which
                is to be paid in two years time.  The debt has a current
                market value of $150.  At the same time it holds a bond (a
                separate financial arrangement) issued by AH Co that has a
                market value of $150 (and face value of $250).  In an
                agreement between the parties LA Co agrees to waive its
                right to receive payment under the bond in full satisfaction
                of the amounts it owes on the outstanding debt of $200.


                In determining any gain or loss on the extinguishment of the
                debt owed by LA Co, it will be taken to have provided a
                financial benefit (being the waiving of its right to receive
                payment on the bond of $250 in the future) which is equal to
                the market value of the bond at the time of the waiver (see
                note at end of subsection 230-60(2)).  The valuation rule
                will ensure that LA Co takes into account the market value
                of the waived bond ($150) and not its nominal value ($250)
                when calculating the gain or loss it makes on the
                extinguishment of the debt.


         Allocation of cost and proceeds may also occur within a particular
         tax-timing method


    371. Under some of the tax-timing methods, the allocation of costs and
         proceeds is required for determining particular gains and losses
         from a financial arrangement over the period for which it is held.
         Note that other tax-timing methods have their own methodology for
         determining gains and losses from the financial arrangement over
         this period.  It is therefore critical to refer to the relevant tax-
         timing method to determine the timing and quantum of relevant gains
         and losses from a financial arrangement.


         A special rule for interest for particular gains and losses, and
         realised gains and losses


    372. As mentioned above, many of the tax-timing methods have their own
         methodology for determining what is the gain or loss that is made
         from a financial arrangement, and under these methods, together
         with the balancing adjustment in Subdivision 230-G where relevant,
         the entire gain or loss from the financial arrangement will be
         brought to account under Division 230.  However, the methodologies
         in Subdivision 230-B (accruals and realisation methods) will
         largely rely on the core provisions in Subdivision 230-A to
         determine what is the relevant gain or loss in the appropriate
         circumstance.  The allocation of financial benefits received, to
         those provided in order to determine the quantum of the relevant
         gain or loss, will be particularly important where there is more
         than one gain or loss from the financial arrangement.  In an
         accruals and realisation sense, this will be relevant for
         determining particular gains and losses, and in determining gains
         and losses made under the realisation method.


    373. When a financial benefit is received or provided as an interest
         receipt or payment (or where it is in the nature of interest or can
         reasonably be regarded as a substitute for interest or are returns
         in the form of dividends paid or provided on a debt interest) it is
         intended that this financial benefit (or cash flow) itself be a
         gain or a loss.  These cash flows under the current law are
         typically treated on a gross basis.  It is therefore intended that
         in a broad sense the current treatment of these cash flows not be
         disturbed in these circumstances.  Special rules are contained in
         sections 230-70 and 230-75 to clarify this point.  These rules
         provide that no costs (or proceeds) are allocated to the receipt
         (or payment) of interest (or an amount in the nature of, or in
         substitution for, interest or are returns in the form of dividends
         paid or provided on a debt interest) when determining the relevant
         gain or loss on such a receipt (or payment).  Under these rules,
         which apply only in calculating a particular gain or loss under the
         accruals methodology, or a gain or loss that occurs under the
         realisation method, the receipt of an amount of, in the nature of,
         or in substitution for, interest, will represent a gain in its
         entirety.  Likewise, the payment of an amount that is interest,
         interest in nature, or in substitution for interest, will be a loss
         made under a financial arrangement in its entirety for the purpose
         of these methods.  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-70 and 230-75]


    374. As these rules only apply for the purpose of determining a
         particular gain or loss under the accruals methodology or for
         determining a gain or loss that occurs under the realisation
         method, they will not apply, for example, to prohibit a cost being
         attributed to an interest income stream disposed of, or proceeds
         being allocated to interest obligations that are assigned, novated
         or that otherwise cease.  When a financial arrangement ceases, or
         is partially transferred, any financial benefits reasonably
         attributable to a right or obligation to an amount in the nature of
         interest under that arrangement continues to be appropriately
         allocated.  This ensures that an appropriate gain or loss can be
         calculated upon the cessation or relevant partial disposal of a
         financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-70, 230-
         75, 230-200 and 230-445]


    375. In addition, the acquisition of an interest stream of itself will
         not invoke these rules so as to deny that income stream from having
         any cost.  This is because in the hands of the acquirer, the
         'interest' income is a series of cash flows that it has simply
         acquired.  Not being connected with any loan, provision of credit
         or borrowing of the relevant taxpayer, these payments in isolation
         are not interest, interest in nature, or in substitution for
         interest.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-70]


General rule for the taxation of gains and losses made from financial
arrangements


    376. Under Division 230, gains from financial arrangements are
         assessable income unless otherwise specified.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-15(1)]


    377. Gains from financial arrangements included in assessable income
         pursuant to subsection 230-15(1) will still retain their character
         as either statutory or ordinary income (see note 2 to subsection 6-
         10(2) of the ITAA 1997).  Apart from some specific rules for
         determining a gain or loss on a financial arrangement where there
         is a change of residence during an income year (see Chapter 11),
         Division 230 does not disturb the general rules relating to foreign
         residents contained within Division 6 of the ITAA 1997.  The
         structure of that Division (and, in particular, subsections 6-5(3)
         and 6-10(5) of the ITAA 1997) ensures that foreign residents are
         only taxed on their gains from financial arrangements that have an
         Australian source.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-15(7)]


    378. Under Division 230, losses from financial arrangements are
         deductible to the extent that they are made in gaining or producing
         assessable income or are necessarily made in carrying on a business
         for the purpose of gaining or producing assessable income, unless
         otherwise specified.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-15(2)]


    379. This rule reflects the current general deduction rule in section 8-
         1 of the ITAA 1997 with the exception that it generally does not
         deny deductions for a loss of a capital nature.  This is consistent
         with an object of Division 230, which is to generally ignore
         distinctions between capital and revenue.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subparagraph 230-10(b)(ii)]


         Dividends paid on debt interests


    380. As noted above, the rule in subsection 230-15(2) reflects the
         current general deduction rule in section 8-1 of the ITAA 1997 - in
         particular the 'nexus' aspects of section 8-1.  Hence, the case law
         in respect of the nexus aspects would also apply in determining
         whether losses made from a financial arrangement will satisfy the
         test for deductibility in subsection 230-15(2).  Given the nexus
         requirements, deductions may not be allowable where a loss is made
         from interests (including debt/equity hybrids) that satisfy the
         debt test under Division 974 of the ITAA 1997 (eg, an interest that
         would be an equity interest but for the fact that it satisfies the
         debt test, such as a mandatory redeemable preference share) where
         the loss represents the application of income derived (ie, a post-
         derivation outlay).  Such outlays may be dividends paid in respect
         of the relevant interest (see Commissioner of Taxation v Boulder
         Perseverance (1937) 58 CLR 223).


    381. Further, although the rule in subsection 230-15(2) generally will
         not deny deductions for losses of a capital nature (which may
         otherwise have denied deductibility for dividends paid on debt
         interests because they could be said to be of a capital nature),
         there is case law that suggests that such dividend payments are not
         made for the purpose of gaining or producing assessable income (see
         Macquarie Finance Limited v Commissioner of Taxation [2005] FCAFC
         205).  Rather, these dividend payments may be said to be outgoings
         relevant to the raising of permanent additional capital.  This
         means that such payments, which are themselves the losses made on
         financial arrangements that are debt interests, could be prevented
         from deductibility under subsection 230-15(2) because it could be
         said that they were not made in gaining or producing assessable
         income or necessarily made in carrying on a business for the
         purpose of gaining or producing assessable income.


    382. In respect of section 8-1 of the ITAA 1997, in order to address
         these issues, section 25-85 of the ITAA 1997 specifically provides
         for deductibility in respect of dividends (subject to certain
         restrictions).  Section 25-85 will not apply to financial benefits
         paid or received in respect of financial arrangements that are debt
         interests due to the operation of the anti-overlap rule in section
         230-25 (which is explained further below).  However, the effect of
         section 25-85 is reflected in subsections 230-15(4) to (6).  That
         is, if the financial arrangement is a debt interest (as determined
         under Division 974 of the ITAA 1997), the loss made at the time a
         dividend is paid on that debt interest is not denied deductibility
         merely because the financial benefit (ie, the dividend) is
         contingent on the economic performance of the taxpayer or a
         connected entity of the taxpayer; or that the dividend is
         considered to secure a permanent or enduring benefit for the
         taxpayer.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-15(4)]


    383. As a revenue safeguard it is necessary to prevent excessive
         deductible payments on debt/equity hybrids that satisfy the debt
         test.  The same risk to the revenue identified in respect of
         section 25-85 of the ITAA 1997 exists under Division 230 - that is,
         that a company could distribute its profits as deductible payments
         in lieu of frankable dividends by making the distribution in
         respect of a hybrid that has been artificially characterised as
         debt.  The artificiality of the characterisation would be indicated
         by a return on the interest considerably in excess of the interest
         payable on an equivalent interest without any equity component
         (ie, straight debt).  The deduction allowable in these
         circumstances is capped by reference to the rate of return on an
         equivalent straight debt interest, increased by a margin to
         recognise the premium paid for the increased risk of non-payment
         because of the contingency.  That rate of return is referred to as
         the 'benchmark rate of return', and the margin is 150 basis points
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-15(5)].  The margin may be
         increased or decreased by reference to regulations made under
         subsection 25-85(6) of the ITAA 1997 [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-15(6)].


Gains and losses relating to exempt and non-assessable non-exempt income


         Gains


    384. To the extent that a gain made from a financial arrangement is
         reflected by an amount which a provision in the income tax law
         outside Division 230 would have considered as exempt income or non-
         assessable non-exempt income, if Division 230 were not enacted, the
         gain, or that part of the gain, will maintain its status as either
         exempt income or non-assessable non-exempt income (as the case may
         be).  The gain will also be either exempt income or non-assessable
         non-exempt income to the extent that, if it had instead been a
         loss, the loss would have been denied deductibility on the basis it
         would have been made in gaining or producing exempt income or non-
         assessable non-exempt income.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-30]




         Losses


    385. A Division 230 loss from a financial arrangement will not be
         deductible if it is made in gaining or producing exempt income or
         non-assessable non-exempt income.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-30(3)]


    386. An exception to this general rule is losses from financial
         arrangements made by Australian entities in deriving foreign source
         income that is non-assessable non-exempt under section 23AI, 23AJ
         or 23AK of the ITAA 1936, where the loss is a cost in relation to a
         debt interest covered by paragraph (a) of the definition of 'debt
         deduction' in subsection 820-40(1) of the ITAA 1997 (the 'thin
         capitalisation' provisions) [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         15(3)].  This treatment maintains the current treatment of such
         costs under section 25-90 of the ITAA 1997.


Gains and losses of a private or domestic nature


    387. Under Division 230, losses from certain financial arrangements
         having a private or domestic purpose will not be deductible.
         Division 230 will not apply to gains from such arrangements that
         are private or domestic in nature.


    388. The specific arrangements subject to this exclusion are:


                . a borrowing or provision of credit under an arrangement
                  where the taxpayer is the borrower, or is provided with
                  the credit, to the extent that the borrowing or provision
                  of credit is used for private or domestic purposes; and


                . derivative financial arrangements of individuals, to the
                  extent they are held or used for private or domestic
                  purposes.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-35]


         Private or domestic borrowings


    389. A loss made from an arrangement under which finance is raised by
         the taxpayer (ie, where the taxpayer has borrowed funds or has been
         provided with credit) will not be deductible to the extent the
         finance is used for a private or domestic purpose.  Division 230
         will not apply to gains made from such an arrangement.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-35]


    390. The intended operation of this exception is to exclude gains and
         losses from assessable Division 230 gains or deductible Division
         230 losses where they are made in respect of borrowings and other
         forms of raising finance used to fund private or domestic
         arrangements.  It does not include an arrangement under which the
         taxpayer is the provider, rather than the recipient, of the
         finance.


    391. A borrowing is broadly defined in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA
         1997 to cover any form of borrowing, whether secured or unsecured.
         The provision of credit is a similarly broad concept, entailing a
         financial contribution to the taxpayer in respect of which the
         taxpayer pays a return.


    392. In determining whether borrowed funds, or credit provided, have
         been used for a private or domestic purpose, it is important to
         consider all the relevant circumstances and features of the
         particular arrangement, in addition to the taxpayer's intention.


      1. :  A loss made where finance is raised for a private purpose


                Hoa's Haulage, a truck importing business, is conducted by
                Hoa as a sole trader.


                As an individual, Division 230 does not apply to Hoa's gains
                and losses from financial arrangements on a mandatory basis
                (section 230-455).  However, Hoa makes an election to have
                all financial arrangements subjected to Division 230
                (subsection 230-455(7)).


                After making this election, Hoa then borrows $50,000.
                $30,000 of the borrowed funds are to acquire a second-hand
                prime-mover truck as part of the trading stock of
                Hoa's Haulage, and the remaining $20,000 funds Hoa's
                personal overseas travels.


                The interest payments Hoa makes on repayment of the loan are
                losses made from a financial arrangement (see Chapter 2).
                However, 40 per cent of the losses made relate to a
                borrowing that was used for a private purpose.  Accordingly,
                despite being losses made from a financial arrangement to
                which Division 230 applies, 40 per cent of Hoa's interest
                payments will be denied deductibility under section 230-35.


                (Note that it is not necessary for Hoa to make a subsection
                230-455(7) election in order to obtain a deduction for the
                cost of that part of the borrowed funds used to acquire the
                prime-mover truck under other provisions of the Act.)


         Derivatives held for private or domestic purposes


    393. Division 230 will not apply to a gain made by an individual from a
         derivative financial arrangement, to the extent that it is held or
         used for private or domestic purposes.  Losses from such an
         arrangement will not be deductible.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section
         230-35]


    394. Whilst individuals will not be compulsorily subject to Division 230
         except in relation to their qualifying securities, they may elect
         to have all of their financial arrangements subject to the Division
         (see Chapter 2).  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-455(7)]


    395. Derivative financial arrangements are financial arrangements that:


                . change in value in response to a change in a specified
                  variable or variables; and


                . require little or no net investment, in that the net
                  investment is smaller than that required for other types
                  of financial arrangements, except other derivative
                  financial arrangements, that would be expected to have
                  similar results to changes in market factors (see Chapter
                  8).


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-350(1)]


    396. Where a derivative financial arrangement (such as an interest rate
         option) is used or held by an individual for private or domestic
         purposes (eg, to hedge the risk associated with a private
         underlying transaction), any gain or loss made on it will in effect
         be disregarded under Division 230.


Gains and losses to which Division 230 does not apply


    397. Division 230 will not apply to gains from financial arrangements to
         the extent that they are in the form of a franked distribution, or
         a right to a franked distribution, whether received directly by the
         taxpayer or indirectly through a partnership or trust.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-480]


    398. Division 230 will also not apply to certain gains and losses from
         specified financial arrangements or where specific provisions
         operate to reduce gains and losses from particular financial
         arrangements.  [Schedule 1, item 1, note to subsections 230-15(1)
         and (2)]


    399. These specified exceptions to the general scope of the Division
         have the effect of limiting the application of the general taxing
         provisions in section 230-15.  They are discussed in detail in
         Chapter 2.


Gains and losses from financial arrangements generally on revenue account


    400. As the above paragraphs have illustrated, by being generally
         assessable or deductible, gains and losses from financial
         arrangements are typically taxed on revenue account under Division
         230.


    401. Under existing legislation, not only are there questions of fact
         and law in determining the appropriate character of gains and
         losses, but also potentially difficult apportionment issues because
         gains and losses can be attributable to both periodic and non-
         periodic cash flows.


    402. Putting all gains and losses on revenue account, other than where
         an exception or exclusion applies, simplifies the determination of
         the tax treatment.  It is also consistent with the operation of
         some existing tax provisions relating to financial arrangements
         (eg, see the provisions listed in paragraph 3.22).


    403. However, a different character may be attributed to the gains and
         losses from a financial arrangement that is a hedging financial
         arrangement, if the hedging financial arrangement method is applied
         to take account of those gains and losses from a financial
         arrangement.  Under this method, the gain or loss from the hedging
         financial arrangement will in most instances be aligned with the
         tax treatment of the underlying hedged item.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-310]


    404. If the hedging financial arrangement method specifically provides
         that a gain or loss on a hedging financial arrangement is to be
         dealt with in a particular way (whether or not by providing that it
         be on capital account), this takes priority over the treatment
         provided for in the general rule for the taxation of gains and
         losses from financial arrangements.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-300(1) and 230-310(3), section 230-40]


    405. For a more comprehensive discussion of the hedging financial
         arrangement method (including what are hedging financial
         arrangements and hedged items), refer to Chapter 8.


    406. Financial arrangements which have their gains and losses
         specifically excluded from the operation of Division 230 may also
         be taxed on capital account.


Anti-overlap rule

    407. Sections 230-20 and 230-25 contain rules to ensure that:
                . a gain or loss from a financial arrangement that is, or
                  will be, taken into account under Division 230; and
                . any associated financial benefits making up the
                  calculation of that gain or loss,
         are not taken into account more than once under Division 230, and
         are not included in assessable income or allowable as a deduction
         under a provision of the ITAA 1936 or the ITAA 1997 outside of
         Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-20 and 230-25]
    408. These anti-overlap rules ensure that:
                . gains and losses from financial arrangements are
                  recognised only once for tax purposes;
                . to the extent that a gain or loss from a financial
                  arrangement is, or will be, assessable or deductible under
                  Division 230, or dealt with under the hedging rules, this
                  takes priority over other provisions of the ITAA 1936 or
                  the ITAA 1997; and
                . to the extent to which Division 230 does not deal with a
                  gain or loss from a financial arrangement the other
                  provisions of the ITAA 1936 or the ITAA 1997 will have
                  residual operation unless otherwise specified (ie,
                  Division 230 does not represent an exclusive code for the
                  taxation of gains and losses from financial arrangements).

         [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-20 and 230-25, item 76, section
         118-27]


    409. The operation of the anti-overlap rules in sections 230-20 and 230-
         25 require that if a gain or loss from a financial arrangement is,
         or is to be, included in assessable income or allowable as a
         deduction under Division 230, or dealt with in accordance with
         subsection 230-310(4) (which, as explained in Chapter 8, sets out
         particular tax classifications for gains and losses from certain
         hedging financial arrangements), then no part of that gain or loss
         can be:


                . included in assessable income;


                . allowable as a deduction; or


                . dealt with in accordance with subsection 230-310(4),


         again under Division 230, or under any other provision of the ITAA
         1936 or the ITAA 1997, in any income year.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-20]


    410. For example, this means for foreign residents that where a hedged
         item is ordinary or statutory income from an Australian source the
         hedge gain or loss will be subject to tax in Australia.  On the
         other hand, where a hedged item is ordinary or statutory income
         from a non-Australian source, the hedge gain or loss will not be
         subject to tax in Australia.


    411. In addition, no part of the amount or value of any financial
         benefits taken into account in determining an assessable gain or
         deductible loss under Division 230, or a gain or loss dealt with in
         accordance with subsection 230-310(4), can be either included in
         assessable income or allowable as a deduction under any other
         provision of the ITAA 1936 or the ITAA 1997 in any income year.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-25(2)]


         Relevance for other parts of the Act


    412. The intention of the anti-overlap rule is to ensure that gains and
         losses from financial arrangements (including any component parts
         of such gains and losses) are only recognised once for tax
         purposes.  It is not intended to restrict the other workings of the
         ITAA 1936 or the ITAA 1997.  In this regard, the anti-overlap rule
         does not prevent such gains and losses (or any financial benefits
         taken into account in determining them) from being used to work out
         other tax-relevant amounts, as long as no part of any gain or loss
         from a financial arrangement is dealt with more than once.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-20(2)]


    413. Further, the rules do not prevent the application of the provisions
         of Division 13 of Part III of the ITAA 1936 to financial
         arrangements and/or their financial benefits where they are, or are
         used as consideration for, the supply of property or services in
         cross-border transactions/dealings.  In the relevant circumstances,
         the Commissioner may adjust the amount of the consideration (if
         any) given or received to an arm's length amount.  Such an
         adjustment might be made to the amount of a financial benefit
         provided or received under a financial arrangement.  If an
         adjustment is made, the adjusted amount would then be used to
         determine the amount of a gain or loss that would be brought
         to account under Division 230.  Section 230-15 remains the only
         provision under which the gain is assessable or the loss is
         deductible or, if relevant, the arm's length gain or loss remains
         to be dealt with by subsection 230-310(4).


         Financial arrangements used as consideration in other dealings


    414. In keeping with this intention, the anti-overlap rule does not go
         so far as to provide that where a taxpayer is taken to have
         received or provided a financial benefit as the cost or proceeds
         for a particular financial arrangement, that a financial benefit of
         an equal value cannot be assessable or deductible elsewhere.  For
         instance, in Example 3.6, Bill Co is taken to have received capital
         proceeds on disposal of its land equal to the market value of the
         financial arrangement it starts to have.  Bill Co is also taken to
         have started to have that financial arrangement by providing an
         amount of that same value.  In this example, even though the values
         are the same, they are in respect of different financial benefits
         (one being the financial benefit received for the land and the
         other being the financial benefit provided for starting to have the
         financial arrangement).  Section 230-25 clarifies this point for
         the avoidance of doubt.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-25]


         Bad debts


    415. Where a financial arrangement arises in respect of the provision of
         goods, services or other property on deferred payment terms (and
         section 230-450, dealing with certain short-term arrangements, does
         not apply), a special rule is required to allow a deduction under
         section 25-35 of the ITAA 1997 if the relevant debt that arises on
         provision of those goods, services or other property goes bad.
         This is because, despite the amount taken to have been received for
         the provision of such property or services being a different
         financial benefit from that taken to have been provided for
         starting to have the financial arrangement, in these circumstances,
         the debt that arises at the time the goods, services or other
         property is provided is in fact satisfied by the acquisition of the
         financial arrangement.

    416. The value that is included in assessable income in respect of the
         provision of the goods, services or other property is determined
         under section 230-505.  For the special rule to apply, the
         financial benefit (as determined under section 230-505) must have
         been brought to account as assessable income under a provision
         outside of Division 230 [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         25(3)(a)].  Where this amount is written-off as a bad debt by the
         taxpayer, a deduction for the value of the financial benefit the
         taxpayer is taken to have provided to acquire the financial
         arrangement is to be claimed under section 25-35 of the ITAA 1997
         (subject to the relevant restrictions in that section) [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-25(3)].
    417. If a gain has been included in the taxpayer's assessable income
         under Division 230, and an amount that includes or represents that
         gain has been written off as a bad debt, specific provisions in
         Subdivision 230-B will apply to recognise a loss under Division 230
         to the extent of the gain previously brought to account.
    418. Further, if the taxpayer ceases to have the relevant financial
         arrangement (eg, by disposing of the debt to a third party), after
         it has written-off the relevant debt as bad and claimed the
         deduction available under section 25-35 of the ITAA 1997, the
         balancing adjustment under Subdivision 230-G is adjusted to take
         this previously claimed deduction into account.  Therefore, in
         calculating an amount of a gain or loss on the relevant ceased
         financial arrangement, the amount of any deduction that has been
         claimed under section 25-35 is to be taken into account under step
         1(b) in the method statement in section 230-445 (see Chapter 10)
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-445(7)].  This rule is
         consistent with the underlying policy in sections 230-20 and 230-
         25:  that amounts are not to be included in assessable income or
         allowable as a deduction more than once under the ITAA 1936 or the
         ITAA 1997.

         Exempt income

    419. Subsection 6-20(2) of the ITAA 1997 provides that amounts
         of ordinary income that are excluded from being assessable income,
         are exempt income.  However, merely because a provision in Division
         230 prevents a gain or part of a gain from being assessable under
         Division 230 (in order to avoid that gain or part of that gain from
         being included in assessable income more than once under the tax
         law) the carving out of the gain from being assessable under
         Division 230 does not of itself cause the gain to be exempt income.
          This is because the gain, while not included in assessable income
         under Division 230, is ultimately included in assessable income
         under another provision of the tax law.  Subsections 230-20(5) and
         230-25(4) put it beyond doubt that such a gain excluded from being
         assessable under Division 230 is not exempt income merely because
         of that exclusion.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-20(5) and
         230-25(4)]

         Threshold calculations

    420. By only requiring that gains and losses from financial arrangements
         (or any financial benefits taken into account in determining them)
         not be taken into account more than once in working out a
         taxpayer's taxable income, the anti-overlap rules do not prevent
         these amounts from being included in other calculations.

Chapter 4
The compounding accruals and realisation methods

Outline of chapter


   421. This chapter explains:


                . the rationale for compounding accruals and realisation tax
                  treatment;


                . what compounding accruals and realisation are;


                . the basis for determining when taxpayers apply the
                  compounding accruals or the realisation method to a
                  financial arrangement;


                . the manner in which the compounding accruals and
                  realisation methods are applied;


                . when a re-assessment of the compounding accruals or
                  realisation method should apply to a gain or loss arising
                  from a financial arrangement; and


                . the application of the re-estimation and running balancing
                  adjustment provisions.


Overview of compounding accruals and realisation methods


   422. The compounding accruals and realisation methods are the default
        methods of taxation under Division 230.  These tax-timing methods
        will apply to those financial arrangements that are not subject to
        any of the elective tax-timing methods.  The compounding accruals
        tax-timing method ('accruals method') will apply where there is a
        sufficiently certain overall gain or loss or a sufficiently certain
        particular gain or loss in respect of a financial arrangement.  If
        there is neither a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss nor a
        sufficiently certain particular gain or loss in respect of a
        financial arrangement then it will be subject to the realisation
        tax-timing method ('realisation method').


   423. An example of a sufficiently certain particular gain is where a
        contingency under an interest rate swap becomes settled, that is,
        it becomes certain that a payment is to be made that will give rise
        to a certain gain.


   424. If neither a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss nor a
        sufficiently certain particular gain or loss arises in respect of a
        financial arrangement, the gains and losses in respect of that
        financial arrangement will be calculated using the realisation
        method.


Accruals method


   425. There are two circumstances which require the spreading of gains
        and losses under the accruals method.  The first applies where
        there is a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss.  The second
        applies where there is a sufficiently certain particular gain or
        loss.


   426. A sufficiently certain overall gain will only arise where the
        sufficiently certain financial benefits that the taxpayer is to
        receive exceed the cost of the financial arrangement, that is, the
        sufficiently certain financial benefits that a taxpayer is to
        provide (or vice versa for an overall loss), measured in nominal
        terms.


   427. When a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss does not arise in
        respect of a financial arrangement, the accruals method will apply
        if there is a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss under
        that financial arrangement in respect of a particular financial
        benefit or financial benefits, measured in nominal terms.


   428. A sufficiently certain particular gain or loss arises from a
        financial benefit that the taxpayer is to receive or provide under
        the arrangement, if it is sufficiently certain at a particular time
        before that financial benefit is to be received or provided that
        the taxpayer will make that gain or loss.


   429. The accruals method is intended to bring to account sufficiently
        certain overall gains or losses and sufficiently certain particular
        gains or losses to prevent inappropriate tax deferral in relation
        to the recognition of that gain or loss.


         Way in which gains and losses are to be spread


   430. The core method for spreading sufficiently certain gains or losses
        uses compounding accruals.  This is conceptually identical to the
        'effective interest rate' method required by Australian Accounting
        Standard AASB 139 Financial Instruments:  Recognition and
        Measurement  (AASB 139) in so far as they both reflect the concept
        of interest on interest.  The 'effective interest rate' method is a
        method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial instrument
        and of allocating the interest income or interest expense over the
        relevant time period (usually the term of the financial
        instrument).  It is also the same as the internal rate of return.


   431. There are specific rules in the accruals method with respect to
        certain gains or losses from fees and costs ('portfolio fees') and
        premiums and discounts ('portfolio premium/discount') arising from
        a financial arrangement that are part of a portfolio of similar
        financial arrangements.  If eligible, a taxpayer can make an
        irrevocable election to spread the portfolio fees and portfolio
        premium/discount over a period that equals the expected life of the
        portfolio of which the financial arrangement is a part.


         Spreading using other methods


   432. It is possible to use another type of accruals for sufficiently
        certain gains or losses but the outcome under the alternative
        method (such as straight line spreading) must approximate the
        outcome under compounding accruals.


The realisation method


   433. The realisation method brings to account gains or losses in the
        income year in which the gain or loss occurs.  Generally, a gain or
        loss occurs when the last of the financial benefits is provided or
        is to be provided, that is, when the gain or loss comes home to the
        taxpayer.


Reassessment of application of accruals or realisation method


   434. A taxpayer is only required to reassess whether the accruals or
        realisation method is appropriately applied to a gain or loss where
        there is a material change in the terms and conditions of the
        arrangement, or the circumstances affecting the arrangement.
        Whether a change is a material change depends on the facts and
        circumstances of the relevant arrangement.


Re-estimation of accrued gain or loss


   435. Generally, for many financial arrangements, the accruals method
        will apply to the relevant gain or loss for the term of the
        financial arrangement.  However, it may be necessary to re-estimate
        the accrued gain or loss during the term of the financial
        arrangement.  An example is where circumstances change such that
        certain financial benefits are no longer contingent which changes
        the amount of the gain or loss that is sufficiently certain.


   436. It will be necessary to re-estimate a gain or loss from a financial
        arrangement if:


                . the compounding accruals method applies to that gain or
                  loss; and


                . there is a material change to the circumstances that
                  affect the estimate in respect of an amount or value of a
                  financial benefit or the timing of the provision of a
                  financial benefit.


Running balancing adjustments


   437. Running balancing adjustments are needed because the accruals
        method applies to estimated cash flows which may differ from the
        actual cash flows.  The running balancing adjustments are to ensure
        that the correct amount of gain or loss is subject to tax over the
        life of the financial arrangement.


   438. When a financial benefit is received or provided (or the time comes
        for the financial benefit to be received or provided), a balancing
        adjustment may be required.  A running balancing adjustment is the
        difference between the estimated value of a financial benefit and
        the amount that a taxpayer receives or provides.  The running
        balancing adjustment may be included in assessable income if the
        estimated value of the financial benefit is less than the actual
        financial benefit or may be allowed as a deduction if the estimated
        value of the financial benefit exceeds the actual financial
        benefit.


Context of amendments


   439. Under the current law, the scope of accruals tax treatment has
        broadened through legislative and judicial developments over recent
        decades.  However, the current accruals system is incomplete and
        has not adapted sufficiently to be able to deal effectively with
        the rapid pace of financial innovation.  The application of the
        accruals method under Division 230 will further broaden the scope
        of accruals tax treatment.  This further broadening mainly reflects
        the need to modernise the tax treatment of financial arrangements
        in order for it to appropriately apply to newer, innovative
        financial arrangements and also for it to operate in a generally
        consistent manner for both traditional arrangements and hybrid
        financial arrangements.


   440. The realisation tax treatment has provided a basic treatment that
        applies when no other tax-timing treatment is appropriate.  This
        role for realisation treatment is to remain essentially unchanged.


   441. In general, the setting of the borderline between the realisation
        regime and the accruals regime in Division 230 takes into account
        the need to prevent manipulation and tax deferral, and the need to
        avoid the early and premature taxation of significant, unsystematic
        gains and losses that may not be realised.


What is accruals?


   442. Compounding accruals in the context of the taxation of financial
        arrangements refers to the allocation or spreading of gains or
        losses over time, where the gain or loss is calculated by reference
        to known or estimated future amounts (represented by the financial
        benefits under the arrangement) and on the assumption that the
        entity will continue to have the arrangement for its remaining
        term.


   443. Compounding accruals, in this sense, is in contrast to the concept
        of fair value, which calculates the gain or loss in each period by
        effectively assuming that the entity ceases to have the financial
        arrangement, which it holds, at the end of each income period and
        starts to have it at the beginning of the next period.  This
        distinction between compounding accruals and fair value is
        important because it means that the volatility which can arise when
        gains and losses are accounted for on a fair value basis can be
        smoothed by spreading (using the compounding accruals method) the
        estimated gains or losses over a number of income periods.


   444. This smoothing means that - relative to the outcomes from the fair
        value tax method - taxpayers will generally not be required to pay
        tax on unsystematic gains that may not be realised.  The likelihood
        of this happening is further reduced by the principle which governs
        the circumstances in which the accruals method should apply.  In
        principle, it should apply to spread estimated gains and losses
        that are sufficiently certain.  The gains and losses that are so
        spread are then the subject of taxation.


   445. The period over which the sufficiently certain gains or losses are
        intended to be spread is the period to which the gains or losses
        relate.  The intended basis of allocation of the relevant gain or
        loss under this accruals (spreading) principle reflects the
        financial concept of interest on interest, or compound interest.
        For the purpose of Division 230, this form of accrual is referred
        to as 'compounding accruals'.


   446. Insofar as they both incorporate the concept of interest on
        interest 'compounding accruals' allocation methodology is
        conceptually identical to the 'effective interest method' adopted
        by AASB 139 - that is, the financial accounting accruals
        methodology used to allocate gains and losses from loans,
        receivables, and held-to-maturity investments.


Why is compounding accruals important?


   447. A compounding accruals principle is important for income tax
        purposes for two reasons.  First, it moves tax outcomes closer to
        commercial (accounting) outcomes with attendant opportunities to
        reduce compliance costs.  Second, and related to the first, it
        reduces tax deferral and tax arbitrage opportunities.


   448. If the tax system relied only on a realisation tax method to tax
        all financial arrangements, opportunities would be created for
        taxpayers to delay the taxation of gains, and to bring forward
        losses and related tax deductions.  This would undermine the
        revenue base and, over time, result in a distorted and inefficient
        allocation of investments and resources.


   449. Compounding accruals methods generally recognise sufficiently
        certain (known or estimated) future gains and losses over the life
        of a financial arrangement.  Such gains and losses, which are
        sufficiently certain to occur, can be subject to taxation on a
        compounding accruals (spreading) basis, rather than at realisation
        and will be brought to account under the compounding accruals
        method without significant unexpected, and potentially adverse, tax-
        based cash flow impacts on the taxpayer.


When does accruals treatment apply under the current income tax law?


   450. Under the current income tax law, the main specific accruals rule
        is found in Division 16E of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment
        Act 1936 (ITAA 1936).  As discussed below, Division 16E is limited
        in scope and is quite prescriptive in its operation.


   451. Apart from Division 16E of the ITAA 1936, the question of whether
        accruals or realisation applies to a particular financial
        arrangement largely depends on the operation of the ordinary income
        and general deduction provisions in sections 6-5 and 8-1 of the
        Income Tax Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997) respectively.  For
        income, the issue turns on when the income is 'derived' and, for
        deductions, the issue turns on when a loss or outgoing is
        'incurred'.


   452. Whilst there is some authority for losses or outgoings to be
        incurred on an accruals basis in certain situations, there is very
        little clarity on whether, for example, interest or discount income
        is subject to accruals or realisation tax treatment.  However,
        under Taxation Ruling TR 93/27, the Commissioner of Taxation has
        ruled that the interest income and expense of a financial
        institution may be brought to account on an accruals basis.


         Division 16E of the ITAA 1936


   453. Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 was introduced into the tax law in
        1984 to remove the then existing distortions and tax deferral
        opportunities arising out of long term (more than 12 months)
        discounted and deferred interest securities.  Before the
        introduction of Division 16E, a taxpayer (eg, a financial
        institution) could issue long term debt instruments, which deferred
        payment of interest until maturity, but could claim a deduction for
        interest on an accruals basis.  However, a non-financial
        institution that held those instruments did not have to pay tax on
        the interest until the cash was received at maturity.  The purpose
        of Division 16E was to remove such tax deferral opportunities by
        bringing the interest to tax on an accruals basis.


   454. In general, Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 applies to qualifying
        securities where the non-periodic (ie, deferred) receipts are
        reasonably likely to exceed the payment needed to acquire the
        security.  In broad terms, Division 16E spreads discount and
        deferred interest income to the holder, and corresponding expense
        to the issuer, of the security on a semi-annual compounding basis.


   455. Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 has a relatively narrow scope.  Where
        Division 16E does not apply, the tax-timing treatment of discount
        income and discount expense remains uncertain.  There are gaps in
        the application of Division 16E - for instance in the case of
        premiums and market discounts that arise after issuance when the
        security is not a qualifying security.


   456. There is general uncertainty over whether, and if so how, accruals
        tax treatment applies to various financial arrangements, including
        swaps, other derivatives, and hybrid arrangements.


   457. The incomplete coverage of Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 creates
        complexity, anomalies and opportunities for tax deferral, avoidance
        and manipulation.


What is realisation?


   458. Realisation tax treatment has been a common and traditional basis
        for recognising gains and losses from financial arrangements under
        the current law.


   459. The realisation method applies in Division 230 to bring to account
        gains or losses in the income year in which the gain or loss
        occurs.  Generally, a gain or loss occurs when the last of the
        financial benefits that are taken into account in calculating the
        relevant gain or loss is provided or is to be provided - that is
        when the gain or loss comes home to the taxpayer.  Hence, if a gain
        or loss under a financial arrangement is subject to the realisation
        method, and a number of financial benefits are to be provided under
        the arrangement, there may be a number of separate gains or losses
        brought to account under that method at different points in time.


   460. The application of the realisation method is distinguished from
        circumstances where the taxpayer must apply the balancing
        adjustment provisions in Subdivision 230-G.  The balancing
        adjustment applies where the taxpayer ceases to have all of their
        rights or obligations under an arrangement or where the taxpayer
        transfers some or all of their rights and obligations under the
        arrangement - that is when the financial arrangement is disposed of
        or partly disposed of.  The realisation method generally applies
        where particular rights or obligations come to an end through
        performance of those rights or obligations.  Chapter 10 discusses
        the consequences of disposing of financial arrangements.


   461. It is possible for both the compounding accruals method and the
        realisation method to apply to gains or losses arising from a
        single financial arrangement.  This may occur because some of the
        financial benefits under the financial arrangement are sufficiently
        certain and others are not.  The sufficiently certain financial
        benefits may give rise to either an overall, or a particular, gain
        or loss that will be subject to the compounding accruals method and
        the remaining financial benefits that are not sufficiently certain
        in regards to occurrence or as to at least some of the amount will,
        at the appropriate time, give rise to a gain or loss that is
        brought to account under the realisation method.


Summary of new law


   462. Division 230 provides for a number of methods that can be applied
        to determine when gains or losses that a taxpayer makes from a
        financial arrangement should be brought to account for tax
        purposes.  Where none of the elections available under Division 230
        have been made, the compounding accruals method or the realisation
        method will apply.


   463. The assessment of whether compounding accruals tax treatment is
        appropriate or not for any particular financial arrangement is to
        be based on an objective evaluation of the relevant considerations.
         In particular, regard must be had to the terms and conditions of
        the financial arrangement, accepted pricing and valuation
        techniques and the economic, or commercial, substance or effect of
        the financial arrangement.


The compounding accruals method


   464. Under Subdivision 230-B, a taxpayer must apply the compounding
        accruals tax-timing method to a gain, or loss, from a financial
        arrangement when there is sufficient certainty that such a gain, or
        loss, will occur.  The gain or loss may either be a gain or loss in
        respect of the entire financial arrangement (a 'sufficiently
        certain overall gain or loss') or a gain or loss made in respect of
        particular financial benefits (a 'sufficiently certain particular
        gain or loss').


   465. The sufficiently certain overall gain or loss is determined by
        reference to the difference between the sum of all known and
        expected outlays (payments) and all known and expected inflows
        (receipts).  These inflows and outflows are represented by the
        financial benefits to be received and provided under the relevant
        financial arrangement.  A sufficiently certain overall gain will
        only arise if expected inflows under an arrangement will exceed all
        known and expected outlays such that there will be a gain of at
        least a specific amount.  The converse is true for a sufficiently
        certain overall loss.


   466. A sufficiently certain particular gain or loss can also arise under
        a financial arrangement in respect of a particular financial
        benefit or particular financial benefits.  Such a gain or loss may
        arise where:


                . it is sufficiently certain at the time when the taxpayer
                  starts to have the arrangement, but before the taxpayer is
                  to receive or provide the financial benefit or benefits;
                  or


                . it becomes sufficiently certain after the time the
                  taxpayer starts to have the arrangement, but before the
                  taxpayer is to receive or provide the financial benefit.


   467. If there is a material change to circumstances, or to terms and
        conditions, adjustments may be required to be made to the amount of
        the gain or loss that is accrued during the term of the financial
        arrangement.  Such material changes may also affect whether the
        compounding accruals method will continue to apply to a gain or
        loss, or if the realisation method becomes more appropriate.


   468. Individuals and entities (other than an individual) which fall
        below the threshold test in section 230-455, will only be subject
        to Division 230 in respect of a financial arrangement that has a
        term of more than 12 months and is a 'qualifying security', within
        the meaning of that term in Division 16E of the ITAA 1936.
        However, such taxpayers can make an election for Division 230 to
        apply to all of their financial arrangements (see Chapter 2).


   469. The spreading of the sufficiently certain gain or loss for tax
        purposes is done using a compounding accruals method, or a method
        whose results approximate those obtained using the prescribed
        method.


   470. If the compounding accruals method does not apply to a financial
        arrangement, or to some of the financial benefits under the
        financial arrangement because the gain or loss in respect of those
        benefits is not sufficiently certain, then the realisation method
        applies to bring to account those gains or losses arising from that
        financial arrangement or part thereof.


The realisation method


   471. A gain or loss from a financial arrangement is brought to account
        under the realisation method in Subdivision 230-B when no other tax-
        timing method is appropriate and:


                . when a financial benefit is received or provided under the
                  financial arrangement; or


                . if a financial benefit is not received or provided at the
                  time it is due, when the time comes for that financial
                  benefit to be received or provided under the financial
                  arrangement.


   472. The gain or loss recognised under the realisation method is the
        difference between the amount received or provided, or the amount
        which is to be received or provided, and the cost of the financial
        arrangement which is attributable to that financial benefit.  The
        general approach under Division 230 to determining whether
        realisation tax-timing treatment for a gain or loss is appropriate,
        and the basis of applying the realisation tax-timing treatment, is
        largely unchanged from the existing law (to the extent that the
        existing law operates in respect of gains and losses rather than
        receipts and outgoings).  That is, the realisation tax-timing
        treatment applies where other tax-timing treatments are
        inappropriate.  Gains and losses that are subject to the
        realisation method are recognised in the income year in which the
        time comes for the last of the financial benefits which are taken
        into account in calculating the gain or loss received or provided -
        or the income year in which the financial benefit is actually
        received or provided (that is, the time at which the gain or loss
        occurs for Division 230 purposes).








         Accruals Diagram 1:
         Application (Part 1)


                This diagram provides an overview of how to determine
                whether the compounding accruals or realisation methods
                should apply to a gain or loss made under a financial
                arrangement.






































      Accruals Diagram 1:
Application (Part 2)













































Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|If one of the elective  |To use an accruals      |
|tax-timing methods does |method under Division   |
|not apply to a financial|16E of the ITAA 1936 a  |
|arrangement, the        |'qualifying security'   |
|compounding accruals tax|requires an 'eligible   |
|treatment will apply if |return'.                |
|the financial           |An 'eligible return' on |
|arrangement has a       |a security is, at the   |
|sufficiently certain    |time of the security's  |
|gain or loss.  The      |issue, either known (in |
|sufficiently certain    |the case of a fixed     |
|gain or loss may include|return security) or the |
|both periodic (such as  |payments to be made -   |
|interest-like amounts)  |other than periodic     |
|and non-periodic amounts|interest - to the holder|
|(such as discounts or   |are reasonably likely   |
|premiums).              |(in the case of a       |
|A method that           |variable return         |
|approximates the results|security) to exceed the |
|of the compounding      |issue price of the      |
|accruals method can be  |security.               |
|used.                   |Other requirements of a |
|                        |qualifying security are |
|                        |that it must have a term|
|                        |which is longer than one|
|                        |year and, in the case of|
|                        |a fixed return security,|
|                        |an eligible return of   |
|                        |more than 1.5 per cent  |
|                        |per year.               |
|An election can be made |No equivalent rule.     |
|to spread portfolio fees|                        |
|or a portfolio          |                        |
|premium/discount arising|                        |
|from financial          |                        |
|arrangements which are  |                        |
|part of a portfolio of  |                        |
|similar financial       |                        |
|arrangements, over a    |                        |
|period that equals the  |                        |
|expected life of the    |                        |
|portfolio.  The election|                        |
|is irrevocable.         |                        |
|The realisation         |The realisation         |
|tax-timing treatment    |treatment applies where |
|applies where other     |an accruals treatment   |
|basic tax-timing        |does not apply.         |
|treatments (compounding |                        |
|accruals, elective fair |                        |
|value, elective         |                        |
|retranslation and       |                        |
|elective use of         |                        |
|financial reports) will |                        |
|not apply.  It will     |                        |
|apply in those          |                        |
|circumstances to the    |                        |
|extent to which the     |                        |
|hedging election does   |                        |
|not apply.              |                        |


Detailed explanation of new law


   473. The main object of the accruals and realisation methods is to
        properly recognise gains or losses from financial arrangements by
        allocating such gains or losses to appropriate periods of time
        [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-95(a)].  The compounding
        accruals method provided for in Subdivision 230-B is also intended
        to reflect commercial accounting concepts, so as to reduce
        compliance costs for taxpayers [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
        95(b)].


   474. The compounding accruals method is also intended to minimise tax
        deferral, which could occur under a realisation method [Schedule 1,
        item 1, paragraph 230-95(c)].  This is reflected in the main object
        of Subdivision 230-B, as proper allocation of gains and losses to
        the periods to which they relate also reduces tax deferral.


   475. The question of whether accruals or realisation treatment is
        applicable to a financial arrangement is determined by the nature
        of the terms, conditions, pricing and valuation techniques used;
        the nature of the financial benefits under the arrangement; and
        whether there is sufficient certainty in respect of the gain or
        loss.


Application of the accruals and realisation methods to individuals and
certain entities


   476. Generally, Division 230 does not apply to the financial arrangement
        gains or losses of individuals, or to entities that satisfy the
        relevant threshold tests in section 230-445, unless an election to
        have the Division apply has been made [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-455(7)].  However, if such an individual or an
        entity which has not made an election under subsection 230-455(7)
        has a financial arrangement that is a 'qualifying security' within
        the meaning of Division 16E of the ITAA 1936, and that security has
        a remaining term after acquisition of more than 12 months, the
        accruals method under Division 230 may apply to that financial
        arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-455(1)].  The
        application of Division 230 to individuals and to entities that
        satisfy the threshold test is further discussed in Chapter 2.


   477. Where such an entity has a qualifying security that is a financial
        arrangement, the accruals method will apply to bring to account the
        gain or loss from the qualifying security only where the gain or
        loss satisfies the conditions for being a sufficiently certain
        overall gain or loss [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-105(1)].
        The compounding accruals method will not apply to a sufficiently
        certain particular gain or loss from a financial arrangement held
        by such an entity [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-100(4)].


   478. The exclusion of individuals and those relevant entities from the
        sufficiently certain particular gain or loss provisions is intended
        to provide a compliance cost saving in respect of such instruments.
         The requirement to have to attribute particular financial benefits
        that are provided, or that are expected to be provided (outlays),
        to those that are received, or that are expected to be received
        (inflows), is avoided by the application of the sufficiently
        certain overall gain or loss concept.  A sufficiently certain
        overall gain can only arise where the sufficiently certain
        financial benefits that are to be received exceed the sufficiently
        certain financial benefits that are to be provided (or vice versa
        for a loss) [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-105(1)].  Hence,
        under the overall gain or loss concept, all of the 'cost' of the
        financial benefits that are to be provided under the financial
        arrangement will be automatically attributed to those sufficiently
        certain financial benefits that are to be received at the start of
        the arrangement.


   479. In cases where there is a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss
        under a qualifying security held by taxpayers which would not
        otherwise be subject to Division 230, and there are one or more
        financial benefits that become sufficiently certain after the start
        of the qualifying security, the realisation method will apply to
        gains or losses arising from those financial benefits.
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-100(5)]


   480. However, if the individual, or the entity that satisfies the
        threshold test, makes an election under subsection 230-455(7) to
        have Division 230 apply to its financial arrangements, then the
        compounding accruals method may apply to particular gains or losses
        made under the relevant qualifying security.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        paragraph 230-100(4)(c)]


When to use the compounding accruals method?


   481. If an entity does not opt for one of the elective tax-timing
        methods in Division 230 to apply to its relevant financial
        arrangements, or the entity does make such a choice but no elective
        method applies to a particular financial arrangement, the default
        tax-timing method will be either the compounding accruals or
        realisation method, or a combination of these methods, which will
        be applied to bring to account gains or losses made from the
        particular financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-40(4)].  The compounding accruals method applies
        where there is a sufficiently certain gain or loss from the
        financial arrangement.  A gain or loss arising from a financial
        arrangement will be sufficiently certain if the financial benefits
        used to calculate that gain or loss are themselves sufficiently
        certain (see paragraphs 4.97 to 4.117).


   482. If the financial arrangement is denominated in a foreign currency,
        and a retranslation election has been made by the taxpayer, the
        accruals or realisation tax treatments may still apply to the gain
        or loss to the extent that it is not subject to the retranslation
        election.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(b)]


   483. If the hedging financial arrangement method applies to a financial
        arrangement, and that arrangement is a foreign currency hedge that
        is a 'debt interest' (as defined in Division 974 of the ITAA 1997),
        only the gain or loss that is attributable to movements in currency
        exchange rates, in respect of the outstanding balance in relation
        to the debt interest, is brought to account under the hedging
        financial arrangement election [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-
        300(7) and (8)].  The gain or loss that may arise from the foreign
        currency hedge, other than that specified under the hedging rules
        and absent any other elections under Division 230, would then be
        subject to the accruals or realisation methods as appropriate
        [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(c)].


         Sufficiently certain gain and loss - an overview


   484. For the purposes of the accruals provisions, gains and losses which
        arise from financial arrangements may be an overall gain or loss or
        a particular gain or loss.  That gain or loss is calculated with
        reference to sufficiently certain financial benefits which are to
        be received and provided under the financial arrangement.


   485. Financial arrangements may incorporate financial benefits that are
        paid or received on a periodic and/or non-periodic basis.  Most
        commonly, but not always, financial benefits are represented by
        cash inflows (for rights to receive) and cash outflows (for
        obligations to pay).  For example, an annual interest payment on a
        bond would be a financial benefit that would be paid on a periodic
        basis.  A non-periodic financial benefit would be represented by
        the end payment (return) of an initial outlay when a bond reaches
        full term, or by a partial return of the initial outlay.  Hybrid
        financial arrangements may also comprise both periodic and non-
        periodic financial benefits - a convertible note, or an equity-
        linked bond, usually incorporates both periodic and non-periodic
        payments.  If financial benefits are periodic, generally, subject
        to the facts and circumstances of each case, such benefits could be
        reasonably expected to be paid or received.


   486. Both periodic and non-periodic financial benefits may be fixed in
        terms of amount and the time at which they will be paid or received
        (ie, they are completely certain) or they may be sufficiently
        certain, or they may not be sufficiently certain.  Consequently,
        within the one financial arrangement there may be a mixture of
        different financial benefits some of which are sufficiently certain
        and some of which are not.


   487. An overall gain or loss is that gain or loss generated by the
        entire financial arrangement.  An overall gain, which is determined
        at inception, can only arise where all of the sufficiently certain
        financial benefits that are to be received will exceed the total of
        all of the sufficiently certain financial benefits that are to be
        provided (or vice versa for a loss).  Hence, generally, an overall
        gain or loss will be calculated with reference to all of the
        financial benefits under the arrangement because those financial
        benefits are sufficiently certain at the start of the arrangement.
        There may be circumstances where an overall gain (or loss) arises
        from a financial arrangement, despite some of the financial
        benefits under the arrangement being not sufficiently certain.  An
        example of this is where the total magnitude of an overall gain or
        loss may be unknown at inception, because of the existence of a
        contingent payment within the arrangement, but it may be known that
        an overall gain or loss of at least a specific amount will be made.
         This amount would be subject to the accruals method [Schedule 1,
        item 1, subsection 230-105(1)].  The compounding accruals method
        will apply to spread the sufficiently certain overall gain or loss
        over the life of the arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-130(1)].


   488. The concept of an overall gain or loss of at least a particular
        amount is important in the accruals provisions for two reasons:


                . first, it is intended that where an overall gain or loss
                  of at least a specific amount would be made from a
                  financial arrangement, and that financial arrangement has
                  an embedded option, none of the cost of the arrangement
                  should be attributed to that embedded option; and


                . second, the overall gain or loss concept is intended to
                  deliver compliance cost savings by not requiring taxpayers
                  to apply complex calculations to attribute the cost of the
                  financial arrangement to expected financial benefits where
                  it is clear that a gain or loss of at least a specific
                  amount will be made from the financial arrangement.


   489. A particular gain or loss is that gain or loss generated from a
        particular event under the arrangement (eg, the payment of a
        periodic return).  As such, there could be several particular gains
        or losses arising under the one financial arrangement.  For some
        financial arrangements (eg, hybrids) which may involve a mixture of
        both 'sufficiently certain' and 'not sufficiently certain'
        financial benefits, it may not be possible to determine at
        inception the expected overall gain or loss.  It may, however, be
        possible to estimate a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss
        that will be made from such arrangements in advance of the time at
        which the relevant financial benefits will be received or provided.
         Those particular gains or losses would then be subject to
        compounding accruals treatment.  Those periodic payments that may
        not become known in advance of payment or receipt with sufficient
        certainty will give rise to gains or losses that will be subject to
        realisation tax treatment.


   490. The particular gain or loss concept encapsulates one of the key
        objects of the accruals methodology - that is, gains or losses are
        to be recognised as they become sufficiently certain and are to be
        attributed to the period to which that particular gain or loss
        relates [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-95(a)].  By recognising
        gains and losses in this manner, inappropriate deferral of gains
        and bringing forward of losses is avoided.


         Sufficiently certain overall gain and loss


   491. A taxpayer must allocate a gain or loss from a financial
        arrangement using the compounding accruals method when there is
        sufficient certainty, at the time the taxpayer starts to have the
        arrangement, that the taxpayer will make an overall gain or loss
        under the arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-100(2)].
        An overall gain will only arise where the sufficiently certain
        financial benefits that the taxpayer is to receive exceed the cost
        of the financial arrangement, that is, the sufficiently certain
        financial benefits that a taxpayer is to provide (or vice versa for
        an overall loss) [Schedule 1, item 1, note to paragraph 230-
        100(2)(b)].


   492. In this sense, the overall gain or loss necessarily requires that
        the entire 'cost' (ie, the financial benefits that have been or are
        to be provided) of the financial arrangement be attributed to those
        sufficiently certain financial benefits that are to be received.
        This will be the case despite the fact that economically some of
        that cost may be attributable to other financial benefits that are
        not sufficiently certain at the start of the arrangement.
        [Schedule 1, item 1, note to subsection 230-105(1)]


   493. In calculating the sufficiently certain overall gain or loss it
        must be assumed that the taxpayer will have the financial
        arrangement for the rest of its life [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph
        230-105(2)(a)].  Generally, the life of a financial arrangement is
        dictated by the period between the time the arrangement is created
        or acquired and its maturity date.  This could also be referred to
        as the 'estimated life' of the arrangement.  If, for example, a
        financial arrangement has no defined maturity date (eg, because it
        may last in perpetuity) then the life of the arrangement is taken
        to span the period into perpetuity.  This assumption is important
        because, as was noted above, an overall gain or loss is generally
        generated from the entire arrangement.


   494. The accruals provisions dealing with overall gains and losses are
        modified in circumstances where the financial arrangement that
        gives rise to the overall gain or loss is part of a portfolio of
        similar financial arrangements.  In order to access portfolio
        treatment the taxpayer will need to make an irrevocable election
        and meet certain eligibility requirements.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        sections 230-150 and 230-155].  Where an irrevocable election is
        made, the portfolio fees from and the portfolio premium/discount on
        the financial arrangement are spread over the expected life of the
        portfolio rather than under the general accruals rules for overall
        gains and losses  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-160(3) to
        (5) and 230-165(3) to (5)].  The portfolio treatment of fees and
        premiums/discounts is discussed in detail in paragraphs 4.153 to
        4.167.


   495. If there is a financial benefit that may reduce or eliminate an
        otherwise sufficiently certain overall gain or overall loss, it may
        be the case that it cannot be concluded with sufficient certainty
        that there will be an overall gain or overall loss of at least a
        particular amount [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-105(2)(b)].
        The overall gain or loss must be of at least a specific amount
        because it would be inappropriate to have a taxpayer accrue an
        amount of a gain or loss where there is insufficient certainty that
        it will be realised.  If there is a sufficient risk that a
        financial benefit, that is itself not sufficiently certain at the
        start of the arrangement, may in fact reduce an amount of a gain or
        decrease an amount of a loss (such that part of the estimated gain
        or loss would never have been made), then it would be inappropriate
        to require an accrual of the otherwise sufficiently certain overall
        unrealised gain or unrealised loss.  (At the same time, there may
        be a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss, as discussed in
        paragraphs 4.82 to 4.85.)


   496. However, there may still be a sufficiently certain overall gain or
        loss which should be subject to the accruals method, despite the
        fact that there may be some financial benefits that are not
        sufficiently certain.  Of particular relevance is the situation
        where the effect of those financial benefits which are not
        sufficiently certain will be to increase the amount of the
        sufficiently certain overall gain or loss.  This is because, in
        such situations, there is sufficient certainty that the estimated
        overall gain or overall loss will be made, and the uncertainty
        generated by the financial benefit that is not sufficiently certain
        relates to whether the estimated gain or estimated loss will in
        fact be more than the specific amount of the overall gain or loss
        of at least a certain amount.  In these circumstances, the accruals
        method is applied to the estimated overall gain or overall loss
        that is known with sufficient certainty at the start of the
        arrangement.  In other situations, the financial benefits that are
        not sufficiently certain may be such that the likelihood of them
        reducing or eliminating an otherwise sufficiently certain overall
        gain or loss is artificial or 'immaterially remote'.


   497. Once the contingency is resolved, in respect of those financial
        benefits which are not sufficiently certain at the start of the
        arrangement (as they become sufficiently certain), one of two
        outcomes may arise.  First, the effect of those benefits becoming
        sufficiently certain may affect the amount of the previously
        estimated overall gain or loss so that a fresh determination of the
        overall gain or loss is required.  If this is the case, then the
        implications of such an event are covered by the re-estimation
        provisions (see paragraphs 4.174 to 4.206).


   498. Alternatively, the financial benefits that become sufficiently
        certain may themselves give rise to a gain or loss, separate to the
        estimated overall gain or overall loss.  If the financial benefits
        give rise to a separate gain or loss, that gain or loss may be
        either:


                . accrued as a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss
                  (where the financial benefit becomes sufficiently certain
                  before it is received or provided) [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-100(3)]; or


                . brought to account under the realisation method (where the
                  uncertainty surrounding the financial benefit is resolved
                  at the time it is received or paid, or the time comes for
                  it to be received or paid) [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
                  230-100(5)].


   499. Broadly, arrangements which have the following characteristics may
        give rise to a sufficiently certain overall gain (for the holder)
        or overall loss (for the issuer):


                . periodic returns under the arrangement are determined and
                  set in advance of the period to which they relate and are
                  paid in arrears;


                . the initial outlay will be returned at maturity; and


                . if there are cash flows (financial benefits) that are not
                  known at the start of the arrangement, those cash flows
                  will not have the effect of reducing the estimated overall
                  gain or loss.


   500. Often periodic returns are calculated with reference to a variable
        (such as an interest rate) or the rate of change of a variable
        (such as the consumer price index (CPI)).  This feature, which can
        affect the quantum of financial benefits arising under a financial
        arrangement, will not of itself affect whether there is an overall
        gain or overall loss from the arrangement.  This is because in
        calculating the relevant gain or loss on a financial arrangement,
        the taxpayer is required to assume that the variable or the rate of
        change of the variable affecting the quantum of the financial
        benefit will remain constant for the period of the arrangement
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-115(4) and (5)].  In this
        sense, the fact that the variable or the rate of change of the
        variable may vary, and hence may practically affect the amount of
        the gain or loss, is overcome by the required assumption.  Any
        discrepancy between the assumed variable rate and the actual
        variable rate, provided the difference is insignificant, will be
        brought to account under the running balancing adjustment mechanism
        (see paragraphs 4.170 to 4.173).


   501. Example 4.3 provides further guidance on when an overall gain or
        loss may arise.


         Sufficiently certain particular gain or loss


   502. The compounding accruals method will also apply to a particular
        gain or loss that arises from a financial benefit that the taxpayer
        is to receive or provide under the arrangement, if it is
        sufficiently certain at a particular time before that financial
        benefit is to be received or provided that the taxpayer will make
        that gain or loss [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-100(3)].  The
        accruals method is intended to apply to bring to account
        sufficiently certain particular gains or losses so that there is no
        inappropriate deferral in relation to the recognition of that
        particular gain or loss [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-95(a)
        and (c)].


   503. A sufficiently certain particular gain or loss arises where it is
        sufficiently certain at a particular time that a gain or loss of a
        particular amount, or at least a particular amount, will be made
        when:


                . the taxpayer receives a particular financial benefit or
                  one of the taxpayer's rights ceases under the arrangement
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-110(1)(c)]; or


                . the taxpayer provides a particular financial benefit or
                  one of the taxpayer's obligations ceases under the
                  arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-110(1)(d)].


         That is, the occurrence of one of the events listed above may give
         rise to a gain or loss.  To calculate that gain or loss, which is a
         net concept for these purposes, there must be an offsetting of
         costs with proceeds.  Depending on the circumstances, some part of
         the financial benefits the taxpayer has provided under the
         arrangement may be said to be reasonably attributable to the
         financial benefits that the taxpayer is to receive.  This principle
         is encapsulated in sections 230-70 and 230-75 (about apportionment
         of financial benefits on receipt or payment of particular financial
         benefits), which will apply to calculate the amount of a
         sufficiently certain particular gain or loss [Schedule 1, item 1,
         note to subsection 230-110(2)].  Such apportionment must take into
         account the nature of the rights and obligations, risks associated
         with each of the rights, obligations and financial benefits and the
         time value of money (for further discussion see Chapter 3).


   504. In order for the accruals method to apply, the amount of the
        sufficiently certain particular gain or loss will be a particular
        amount or at least a particular amount [Schedule 1, item 1,
        paragraphs 230-110(1)(a) and (b)].  Therefore, in working out
        whether, at a particular time, there is a sufficiently certain
        particular gain or loss, the taxpayer must have regard to the risk
        that a particular financial benefit which is not sufficiently
        certain at that time will reduce or eliminate the amount of the
        gain or loss [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-110(2)(a)].  For
        the same reasons as outlined in paragraph 4.75, this requirement
        ensures that taxpayers are not required to recognise gains or
        losses that may never be made, to the extent to which they are not
        sufficiently certain.


   505. Further, under this attribution process, a financial benefit is not
        to be taken into account more than once in determining the gain or
        loss that will arise from a single financial arrangement [Schedule
        1, item 1, paragraphs 230-110(2)(b) and (c)].  This means that, to
        the extent to which a financial benefit that the taxpayer has or
        will provide under the arrangement has been allocated to a
        financial benefit that is to be received, that financial benefit
        that has or will be provided (or that part of the financial benefit
        that has or will be provided) is not to be taken into account
        (apportioned) to another financial benefit that is to be received.
        To recognise a particular financial benefit (or part thereof) more
        than once in respect of a single financial arrangement would result
        in the taxpayer recognising the same gain or loss more than once.
        Such an outcome is inappropriate, since economically the taxpayer
        has only made the gain or loss once.


         Can there be more than one sufficiently certain gain or loss for a
         single financial arrangement?


   506. It is possible for there to be more than one sufficiently certain
        gain or loss that is to be brought to account in respect of a
        single financial arrangement.  Likewise, it is possible for there
        to be a number of separate sufficiently certain particular gains or
        losses under the same financial arrangement.  Both a sufficiently
        certain overall gain or loss and sufficiently certain particular
        gains or losses can arise from a single financial arrangement.


   507. This situation can arise because, despite the fact that some of the
        financial benefits under a financial arrangement are not
        sufficiently certain at the start of the arrangement, the financial
        benefits that are sufficiently certain at that time are such that
        they give rise to a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss (see
        discussion in paragraphs 4.71 to 4.81).  When the other financial
        benefits under the financial arrangement not taken into account in
        determining the sufficiently certain overall gain or loss become
        sufficiently certain before they are due to be paid or received, a
        separate sufficiently certain particular gain or loss may arise.
        This sufficiently certain particular gain or loss is separate and
        distinct from the overall gain or loss calculated at the start of
        the arrangement and will be accrued separately from that overall
        gain or loss.  The 'anti-overlap' provision in paragraphs 230-
        110(2)(b) and (c) - which requires that a particular financial
        benefit should not be taken into account more than once under a
        financial arrangement - operates to ensure that there is no double
        counting of gains or losses.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
        110(2)]


      1. :  A bond with contingent returns and guaranteed redemption value


                Investor Co acquires from Issuer Co a 10-year bond for
                $100,000.  The terms of the bond provide that Investor Co is
                entitled to annual interest payments of 8 per cent per
                annum, subject to Issuer Co agreeing to make the payment.
                At maturity, Investor Co is entitled to receive 120 per cent
                of the investment amount.  Both entities exceed the
                threshold test in section 230-455.


                Tax implications for Investor Co


                When Investor Co starts to hold the financial arrangement,
                it must determine if it has a sufficiently certain gain or
                loss that would be subject to the accruals method.  The
                relevant financial benefits are:


              . the payment of $120,000 at the end of 10 years (calculated
                with reference to the guaranteed payment of 120 per cent of
                the investment amount); and


              . each individual interest payment over the term of the bond
                (which is subject to Issuer Co agreeing to make the
                payment).


                As discussed below, a sufficiently certain gain or loss is
                determined only by reference to financial benefits that are
                sufficiently certain (subsection 230-115(1)).  A financial
                benefit is sufficiently certain if it is reasonably expected
                that the financial benefit will be received or provided
                (assuming the bond is held for its life - ie, until
                maturity) and that at least some of the amount or value of
                the financial benefit is fixed or determinable with
                reasonable accuracy (subsection 230-115(2)).  Applying these
                criteria, it can be said that only the financial benefit
                represented by the payment of $120,000 due to be paid at the
                end of the 10 years can be said to be sufficiently certain
                at the start of the arrangement.


                Hence, Investor Co has a sufficiently certain overall gain
                at the start of the arrangement because the financial
                benefit that it is sufficiently certain to receive exceeds
                the cost of the financial arrangement.  The cost of the
                financial arrangement is represented by the $100,000
                Investor Co paid to acquire the bond.  That financial
                benefit is integral to calculating the overall gain or loss
                and hence is taken to be a financial benefit provided under
                the financial arrangement (subsection 230-60(2)).  The
                amount of the difference between the sufficiently certain
                financial benefit provided and the financial benefit
                received is the sufficiently certain overall gain of $20,000
                (ie, $120,000 less $100,000).  The rights to the interest
                payments over the next 10 years, which are themselves
                subject to a contingency, such that it would not be
                reasonable to expect that those benefits will be received,
                will not have the effect of reducing this overall gain of
                $20,000.  In fact, the contingent interest payments, if
                received, will have the effect of increasing the amount of
                the gain made on the financial arrangement as a whole.
                Hence, the compounding accruals method will apply to bring
                the overall sufficiently certain gain of $20,000, which is
                calculated at the start of the arrangement, to account over
                the life of the bond (subsection 230-130(1)).


                If, some time after Investor Co acquires the bond, Issuer Co
                determines that it will make an interest payment two years
                before the payment is due, then once that determination is
                made, that financial benefit which represents the interest
                payment becomes sufficiently certain.  From Investor Co's
                perspective, the amount of the gain is equal to the value of
                the entire interest payment (the relevant financial benefit)
                (subsection 230-75(3)).  That gain is a sufficiently certain
                particular gain to which the compounding accruals method
                would apply to bring to account the amount of the gain over
                the next two years.


                Tax implications for Issuer Co


                From Issuer Co's perspective it has a sufficiently certain
                overall loss at the start of the arrangement of $20,000
                (represented by the shortfall between the proceeds received
                from the issue of the bond and the payment required on
                redemption of the bond).  The relevant financial benefits
                will be sufficiently certain at the start of the arrangement
                for the same reasons as outlined above.  Provided the
                requirements of section 230-15 are satisfied, that overall
                loss is to be accrued over the life of the bond.


                Further, on making the determination to pay interest, a
                sufficiently certain particular loss arises at the time of
                the determination.  Provided the particular loss satisfies
                the requirements of section 230-15, Issuer Co will apply the
                compounding accruals method to that loss to determine the
                amount of the deduction for each income year over the next
                two years.


                If Issuer Co were to make a further separate determination
                to pay interest, that determination may give rise to a
                third, and separate sufficiently particular certain gain
                (for Investor Co), or loss (for Issuer Co), that is taken to
                be made under the bond.  Depending on the circumstances
                surrounding this further determination, that gain or loss
                may be subject to either the accruals or realisation
                methods.


         Application of the accruals method to financial arrangements with a
         'notional' principal


   508. Subdivision 230-B applies so as to characterise and apply to
        notional principal arrangements in the following way.


   509. A notional principal arrangement is a financial arrangement under
        which financial benefits to be provided or received are calculated
        by reference to a notional, rather than actual, principal amount,
        whether that amount is actually paid or received or not.


   510. The notional principal amount, and the financial benefits that are
        calculated by reference to it, is referred to commercially as a
        'leg' of the arrangement.  There are two legs to such an
        arrangement.


   511. A note explains that a swap contract is an example of a notional
        principal arrangement.


   512. Subdivision 230-B applies to notional principal arrangements by
        calculating the gains and losses on each leg separately as if the
        notional principal amount is a financial benefit that is actually
        paid or received at a time, and in a manner, that properly reflects
        the way in which the other financial benefits in respect of that
        leg are calculated.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-120(1) and
        subparagraph 230-120(3)(c)(i)]


   513. A common example of a financial arrangement where sufficiently
        certain particular gains or losses may arise over the period of the
        arrangement is a swap.  In general terms, a swap is an agreement
        between two parties under which they exchange cash flows over time.
         It is this exchange, as reflected in the mutual and corresponding
        rights to receive financial benefits and obligations to provide
        financial benefits over time, that makes opposite the separate gain
        or loss calculation for each leg of a swap.  The value of the cash
        flows is often calculated based on a notional principal.  Basic or
        'plain vanilla' swaps will have no upfront or backend or other
        lumpy payments.  Such payments, where they are present in a
        notional principal arrangement, will not be treated as a leg of the
        arrangement.  Gains or losses in respect of these other things will
        also be calculated separately.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph
        230-120(3)(b)(i)]


   514. At a general level, as is the case with all financial arrangements,
        before it can be assessed which tax-timing method might apply to
        bring to account the relevant gain or loss under the swap, it is
        necessary to decide whether a taxpayer's rights and obligations
        under a swap constitutes a single, aggregate arrangement or two
        separate arrangements.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-55(4)]


   515. Whether a number of rights or obligations constitute one or more
        arrangements is a question of fact and degree (see Chapter 2 for
        further discussion).  Having regard to the factors outlined in
        subsection 230-55(4), a swap financial arrangement (comprising all
        of the taxpayer's rights and obligations) generally is to be
        considered as one arrangement.  This flows from the general nature,
        terms and conditions of the financial arrangement and the purpose
        of most swap arrangements.  The terms and conditions of many swap
        arrangements often require net settlement and, commercially, swaps
        generally derive their intended result when viewed as a whole
        arrangement - that is, considering both 'legs' in combination
        [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-55].  This conclusion is not,
        however, inconsistent with the notion of calculating the gains or
        losses from the two legs of a notional principal arrangement
        separately - in the same way that, as explained earlier, there can,
        at a particular time, be more than one sufficiently certain gain or
        loss in respect of the one financial arrangement.  Chapter 14
        contains a number of examples of swaps to illustrate how the
        separate calculation rules operate.


   516. In standard interest rate swaps, the relevant fixed and floating
        rates are determined at the reset dates which occur at the
        beginning of each of the calculation periods.  Commonly, the terms
        of 'standard' swap agreements require payment of the net difference
        between the fixed and floating payments at the end of the relevant
        period.  Assuming that none of the elective tax-timing methods
        under Division 230 have been chosen, the question arises as to
        whether the gains or losses on the swap should be subject to the
        compounding accruals method or the realisation method.


         When is a financial benefit sufficiently certain?


   517. The compounding accruals method only applies to bring to account a
        sufficiently certain overall gain or loss or a sufficiently certain
        particular gain or loss.  In deciding whether such a gain or loss
        is sufficiently certain at a particular time, the taxpayer can only
        have regard to those financial benefits that the taxpayer is
        sufficiently certain to receive or provide.  That particular time
        includes the time when the taxpayer starts to have the arrangement
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-115(1)].  In this sense, the
        borderline between the compounding accruals and realisation methods
        is encapsulated in the 'sufficiently certain' concept.


   518. A financial benefit that is to be received or provided will be
        treated as being sufficiently certain only if both of the following
        requirements are met:


                . it is reasonably expected that the taxpayer will receive
                  or provide the financial benefit.  This analysis is to be
                  done on the assumption that the taxpayer will have the
                  financial arrangement for the remaining term of its life,
                  or until maturity.  For discussion on what the relevant
                  life of a financial arrangement is, refer to paragraph
                  4.73 [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-115(2)(a)]; and


                . at least some of the amount or value of the financial
                  benefit is, at that time, fixed or determinable with
                  reasonable accuracy [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  115(2)(b)].


   519. Both parts of the test are intended to ensure that the taxpayer
        will only accrue an estimated gain or loss made under a financial
        arrangement where there is more than a mere expectation that the
        estimated gain or loss will actually be made - the expectation must
        be quite firm.


   520. Requiring the taxpayer to apply the accruals method would be
        inappropriate where a gain or loss can be estimated but there
        exists a real possibility that the taxpayer may never make the
        relevant estimated gain or loss because of the circumstances that
        may affect whether or not certain financial benefits will actually
        be received or provided.  In this sense, the manner in which
        contingencies may affect such receipts or payments will need to be
        considered.


   521. It would be equally inappropriate to require a taxpayer to accrue
        an estimated gain or loss where the payment of a particular
        financial benefit to be paid or received under the arrangement at a
        particular time was certain, but where none of the amount or the
        value of the financial benefit could not be estimated with
        reasonable accuracy.  Note that it is not sufficient that the
        amount or value of the financial benefit be fixed or determinable.
        It must be fixed and determinable with reasonable accuracy.


   522. Where all of the financial benefits under the financial arrangement
        are denominated in a particular foreign currency, the financial
        benefits are not to be translated into the taxpayer's functional
        currency (generally, the Australian dollar) for the purposes of
        applying the tests in subsection 230-120(2) [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-115(8)].  This requirement is to ensure that, in
        those particular circumstances, uncertainties in relation to
        exchange rate movements are to be ignored in determining whether
        the relevant financial benefits are sufficiently certain.  The
        special rule is required because the definition of 'special accrual
        amount' applies to amounts that are to be included in the
        taxpayer's assessable income or allowable as a deduction.  The test
        as to whether financial benefits are sufficiently certain is
        applied prior to determining whether an amount should be included
        in the taxpayer's assessable income.  Once a sufficiently certain
        gain or loss has been calculated, that amount is taken to be a
        special accrual amount for the purposes of applying the translation
        rules in Subdivision 960-C of the ITAA 1997 [Schedule 1, item 28,
        subsection 995-1(1), definition of 'special accrual amount'].


         When is it reasonable to expect that a taxpayer will receive or
         provide a financial benefit?


   523. The first limb of the sufficiently certain test is intended to
        encapsulate, in a principled way, the level of certainty of cash
        flows which are expected under the relevant financial arrangement.
        An analysis of this type involves an examination of the
        contingencies which particular financial benefits are subject to
        and the extent to which this may affect payment or receipt of these
        financial benefits under the arrangement.  The analysis is focused
        on the probability of whether such benefits will be received or
        provided (if at all).  This analysis will be different from the
        analysis of contingencies within the context of the debt/equity
        borderline.  The design of the accruals/realisation borderline
        under Division 230 is distinct from that of the debt/equity
        borderline in Division 974 of the ITAA 1997.  Illustrative of this,
        the accruals/realisation borderline addresses both derivatives and
        financing arrangements.


   524. The term 'reasonably expected' is not defined in the legislation,
        although its meaning has been contemplated in a number of tax law
        cases.  In FC of T v.  Peabody (1994) 181 CLR 359 the court stated
        at 385 that:


                'A reasonable expectation requires more than a possibility.
                It involves a prediction as to events which would have taken
                place if the relevant scheme had not been entered into or
                carried out and the prediction must be sufficiently reliable
                for it to be regarded as reasonable.'


   525. However, how much more likely than a 'possibility' is the
        expectation that a financial benefit will be provided or received
        is not clear from Peabody.  In the context of accruals tax
        treatment, one key objective is to not accrue significant
        unsystematic gains and losses on an unrealised basis.  Another
        objective is to prevent tax deferral.  In the light of the context
        of these joint objectives, there must be quite a firm expectation
        that the financial benefit will be provided or received.


   526. The basis on which this expectation is to be considered is not to
        be limited to the form of a particular financial arrangement.
        Rather, whether a particular financial benefit will be received or
        provided, based on the contingency which attaches to it or which it
        is subject to, is to be considered by reference to the
        circumstances surrounding the relevant financial arrangement.  In
        particular, the taxpayer is to have regard to:


                . the terms and conditions of the financial arrangement;


                . accepted pricing and valuation techniques;


                . the economic and commercial substance and effect of the
                  financial arrangement; and


                . contingencies that attach to other financial benefits that
                  are to be provided or received under the arrangement and
                  any interaction these contingencies may have with the
                  financial benefits under consideration.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-115(3)(a)]


   527. Further, the expectation test is to be applied on an objective
        basis (FC of T v Arklay (1989); 85 ALR 368; Eastern Nitrogen Ltd v
        FC of T (1999) FCA 1536).


   528. The terms and conditions of the financial arrangement provide
        information on whether the right or obligation in relation to the
        financial benefit is subject to a contingency.  The effect of the
        contingency, in relation to whether or not the financial benefit
        will actually be paid or received, can also be determined from an
        examination of the terms and conditions of the arrangement.  For
        example, the terms and conditions of a financial arrangement may
        require a particular outcome upon which the satisfaction of a
        contingency depends.  It may be argued that the terms and
        conditions of the financial arrangement constitute the 'legal form'
        of the arrangement.


   529. However, if the determination of whether it is reasonable to expect
        that a financial benefit is to be received or provided under the
        arrangement were limited to an analysis of the legal form of the
        arrangement, this could lead to different tax-timing treatments
        being applied to financial arrangements that are equivalent in
        economic substance.  This would encourage tax arbitrage and tax
        motivated practices.  To address this issue, the taxpayer must look
        at the substance and effect of the terms and conditions and also
        have regard to factors external to the terms and conditions of the
        arrangement.  Under paragraph 230-115(3)(a) this concept is to be
        applied on an objective basis.  For example, in this context, if
        the terms and conditions of the arrangement include a contingency
        that is, in substance, artificial or contrived, then on an
        objective basis those contingencies would be effectively
        disregarded in determining whether it is reasonable to expect that
        the financial benefit will be received or provided.


   530. Generally, subsection 230-115(2) requires that each financial
        benefit be individually tested to determine whether it is
        sufficiently certain.  The situation may arise where a particular
        financial benefit, when tested in isolation to the other financial
        benefits under the arrangement, would not be considered to be
        sufficiently certain.  However, when that financial benefit (the
        'test financial benefit') is considered together with other
        financial benefits (the 'group financial benefits') under the
        financial arrangement, contingencies attaching to the test
        financial benefit may be nullified by the effect of the group
        financial benefits.  Applying paragraph 230-115(3)(b), the combined
        effect of the financial benefits may be that a sufficiently certain
        gain or loss of at least a particular amount can be calculated in
        respect of the financial arrangement because the contingencies
        attaching to all the financial benefits under the financial
        arrangement may, in effect, create sufficiently certain rights to
        receive or obligations to provide.  Consistent with the requirement
        that the substance and effect of the terms and conditions of a
        financial arrangement be taken into account, the test financial
        benefit is to be treated in such circumstances as if there were no
        contingency attaching to it (see Example 4.4 for further
        discussion).  [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph 230-115(3)(a)(iv),
        paragraph 230-115(3)(b)]


   531. The economic or commercial substance and effect of the financial
        arrangement should also be taken into account [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subparagraph 230-115(3)(a)(iii)].  This analysis would include
        consideration of the circumstances surrounding the financial
        arrangement which may involve the in-substance existence of a
        contingency (which is not present in the form of the terms and
        conditions of the arrangement) which may affect whether a financial
        benefit will be received or provided.  In this context, regard
        could be had to a number of factors including:


                . prevailing market conditions at the time the financial
                  arrangement was entered into or at subsequent material
                  events;


                . the intended effect of the financial arrangement as
                  determined by reference to the intention of the parties
                  (determined objectively); and


                . the normal commercial understandings and practices in
                  relation to similar instruments in the market.


   532. Regard should also be had to generally accepted pricing and
        valuation techniques, and whether such techniques were used to
        establish the values (whether these be proceeds or cost) of the
        relevant financial benefits [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph 230-
        115(3)(a)(ii)].  This is a necessary consideration when determining
        whether a financial benefit can be reasonably expected to be
        received or provided because, where appropriate and accepted
        pricing or valuation techniques have been used, the pricing, or
        valuation, of a financial benefit may be indicative of the nature
        of a contingency that affects the right to receive or the
        obligation to provide the relevant financial benefit.


   533. For instance, where there is a right to receive, or the obligation
        to provide, a financial benefit, the existence or satisfaction of
        which is affected by a contingency (considered in the context of
        the other rights and obligations comprising the financial
        arrangement), and the cost of such a financial benefit is lower
        than may be expected for a comparable and certain financial
        benefit, this could indicate that a genuine contingency existed
        (the outcome of which was uncertain).  Hence, it may not be able to
        be said that on an objective basis there is a reasonable
        expectation that the financial benefit will be received or
        provided, such that it could be considered sufficiently certain.


         What is meant by 'fixed or determinable with reasonable accuracy'?


   534. A financial benefit will only be treated as being sufficiently
        certain where there is a reasonable expectation that the financial
        benefit will be received or provided and at least some of the
        amount or value of the financial benefit is fixed or determinable
        with reasonable accuracy [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
        115(2)(b)].  The extent to which the value of the financial benefit
        can be estimated, or can be said to be fixed or determinable with
        reasonable accuracy, depends on a number of factors.  Factors to
        which the taxpayer should have particular regard are:


                . the terms and conditions of the financial arrangement;


                . whether accepted pricing and valuation techniques were
                  used or are relevant in determining the value of the
                  financial benefits;


                . the economic or commercial substance and effect of the
                  financial arrangement; and


                . the contingencies that attach to the other financial
                  benefits that are to be provided or received under the
                  arrangement.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-115(3)]


   535. The considerations taken into account in determining whether there
        is a reasonable expectation that a financial benefit will be
        received or provided under a financial arrangement, as outlined in
        paragraphs 4.103 to 4.113, may also be relevant in determining if
        the financial benefit is fixed or determinable with reasonable
        accuracy.


   536. In an accounting context, a 'fixed or determinable' payment in
        respect of held-to-maturity instruments, and loans and receivables,
        means that a contractual arrangement defines the amounts and date
        of payments to the holder, such as interest and principal payments.
         Such payments would also be considered to be 'fixed or
        determinable with reasonable accuracy' for the purposes of Division
        230.


   537. Contingencies will not only affect whether it is sufficiently
        certain that a financial benefit will be received or provided - the
        amount or value of a financial benefit may also be the subject of a
        contingency or uncertainty.  A contingency only in respect of
        value, in itself, will not always preclude the value of a financial
        benefit from being fixed or determinable with reasonable accuracy
        (particularly due to the application of the assumptions in
        subsections 230-115(4) and (5)).  Additionally, if the value of a
        financial benefit is not specifically stated in the terms and
        conditions of the financial arrangement, but the taxpayer can
        nonetheless estimate with 'reasonable accuracy' the likely value of
        that financial benefit, (eg, by reference to other financial
        benefits) then the requirements of paragraph 230-115(2)(b) are
        satisfied.


         Holding certain variables constant


   538. In applying the 'sufficiently certain' test in subsection 230-
        115(2), certain assumptions are required to be made.  The
        assumption is relevant to the second part of the test only - that
        is, whether a financial benefit can be said to be fixed or
        determinable with reasonable accuracy.  Where calculation of a
        financial benefit relies on a certain type of variable (such as a
        floating interest rate) or a rate of change of a type of variable
        (such as a CPI), the taxpayer is required to assume that the
        variable will remain constant at the value it had at the particular
        time at which the test was applied.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsections 230-115(4) and (5)]


   539. The inception of the financial arrangement is not necessarily the
        only time at which the value of a particular variable should be
        tested to determine whether it is fixed or determinable with
        reasonable accuracy under paragraph 230-115(2)(b).  For instance,
        the relevant financial benefit may be subject to a contingency so
        that it is not reasonable to expect the financial benefit will be
        received or provided at the start of the arrangement - such a
        contingency may subsequently be resolved, so that at a later time,
        and by virtue of the assumptions in subsection 230-115(4) or (5),
        the financial benefit becomes sufficiently certain.  The value the
        variable has at the time the financial benefit becomes sufficiently
        certain is the value that should be held constant for the purposes
        of calculating the amount of the sufficiently certain overall or
        sufficiently certain particular gain or loss.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-115(6)]


   540. Further, if there is a material change in the variable which
        requires a re-estimation of the gain or loss previously estimated,
        the assumptions in relation to the variables to which subsections
        230-115(4) and (5) applied must be re-examined.  The value which is
        to be held constant for the purposes of a fresh determination of
        the gain or loss under the re-estimation provisions is the value of
        the variable at the time that the re-estimation is triggered.


   541. Only those variables referred to in subsections 230-115(4) and (5)
        are required to be held constant.  These variables should be held
        constant because:


                . the variables specifically referred to are considered to
                  be relatively 'stable', in that their values are less
                  likely to fluctuate over a large range, in the short to
                  medium term;


                . the variables are considered to be those which generally
                  increase over time, such that the value estimated at the
                  relevant test time would generally be the minimum value
                  for that variable over the life of the instrument; and


                . the variables can be reliably measured.


         Further examples of sufficiently certain gains or losses


   542. By way of further guidance, the following examples provide
        illustrations of the sufficiently certain overall gain or loss, and
        the sufficiently certain particular gain or loss, concepts and
        consider - for some of the more common type examples - whether the
        accruals or realisation methods are appropriate.


      1. :  Sufficiently certain overall gain or loss - CPI-linked bond


                On 1 July 2010, Hristina Co, a company with a turnover of $3
                billion, purchases a five-year security with a face value of
                $100,000 from Jen Co.  Hristina Co is entitled to receive an
                annual coupon of 7 per cent plus any percentage increase in
                the Australian CPI.  As well, Jen Co is obliged to pay
                Hristina Co the face value of the bond ($100,000) at the end
                of the five years.  The CPI increased by 2 per cent in 2010.
                 The historical volatility of the CPI is very low.  Based on
                history, and anticipated stable monetary policy settings,
                the CPI is expected to increase by between 2 and 3 per cent
                per annum over the next five years.


                It was illustrated in Example 2.3 that a CPI-linked bond
                (that was similar to the one purchased by Hristina Co), is
                taken to be one arrangement - which satisfies the definition
                of 'cash settlable' financial arrangement.  This is because
                the rights and obligations under an index-linked bond -
                being the right to receive the coupon payments, as adjusted
                for the index movement and the right to receive the face
                value of the bond on maturity - are all cash settlable
                (subsection 230-45(2)).


                The accruals method will apply to gains or losses from the
                bond if there is a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss
                or a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss, made from
                the financial arrangement (section 230-100).  The
                sufficiently certain gain or loss is calculated by reference
                only to financial benefits that are sufficiently certain
                (subsection 230-115(1)) (see paragraphs 4.97 to 4.102 for
                further discussion).


                A financial benefit is sufficiently certain if:


              . it is reasonably expected that Hristina Co will receive the
                financial benefit (assuming Hristina Co will continue to
                have the CPI-linked bond until redemption - that is, for the
                life of the arrangement) (paragraph 230-115(2)(a)); and


              . the amount, or value, of the financial benefit is fixed or
                determinable with reasonable accuracy (paragraph 230-
                115(2)(b)).


                Certain assumptions are required to be made in determining
                whether a particular financial benefit is sufficiently
                certain.  In particular, if the financial benefit depends on
                the change in a variable that is based on the CPI then the
                rate of change of that variable is taken to continue to be
                the rate of change for the life of the financial arrangement
                (subsection 230-115(5)).  Hence, for the purposes of
                determining if the coupon payments are financial benefits
                which are sufficiently certain, this assumption is applied
                to ensure that the coupons will satisfy the fixed or
                determinable with reasonable accuracy test in paragraph 230-
                115(2)(b).


                Taking into account the terms and conditions of the
                arrangement, and the economic or commercial substance and
                effect of the arrangement, each of the financial benefits to
                be received under the arrangement are sufficiently certain
                (subsection 230-115(2)).  This is because the financial
                benefit which is the coupon payment that is paid each year
                is taken to be 9 per cent - 7 per cent guaranteed, plus the
                2 per cent increase in the CPI, which is assumed to continue
                to have the same rate of increase that it had at the time at
                which it is determined whether the financial benefits are
                sufficiently certain, as per subsection 230-115(5) - and
                Hristina Co is guaranteed to receive the face value of the
                bond at maturity.  Hence, Hristina Co will make a
                sufficiently certain overall gain from the arrangement of at
                least a particular amount, under subsection 230-105(1).


      2. :  Sufficiently certain particular gain or loss - exchangeable note


                On 1 January 2011 Company A issues 2,000 exchangeable notes
                at par, each with a face value of $1,000, representing a
                total investment of $2 million to Company B.  The terms and
                conditions of the exchangeable note provide for interest to
                be paid annually, at a fixed rate of 6 per cent per annum.
                At the end of year three, at the holder's option, either the
                issuer will be required to redeem the notes for their face
                value plus 5 per cent (ie, $2.1 million), or the notes could
                be exchanged for a specified number of shares in a third
                party company, Company C.  Company C's shares are listed on
                the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX).


                Company A has an annual aggregated turnover of $200 million
                and Company B has an annual aggregated turnover of $300
                million.  Neither Company A, nor Company B, has the sole or
                dominant purpose of entering into the exchangeable notes to
                deliver or receive the shares.  Company B has not made any
                of the elections available under Division 230.


                For the purposes of the illustration, the commentary below
                will focus on the tax consequences for Company B.


                Is the exchangeable note a cash settlable financial
                arrangement?


                The characteristics of the exchangeable note are very
                similar to those of the convertible note in Example 2.2.  In
                that example, it was established that the convertible note
                was a single arrangement.  The same reasoning would apply in
                this case - such that the exchangeable notes are also each a
                single arrangement.  In particular:


              . the terms and conditions indicate that the arrangement,
                whilst having the same effect as its separate components,
                must be dealt with together, and contain no provision for
                the separate assignment of the various embedded rights and
                obligations (subsection 230-55(4));


              . the rights and obligations under the notes were created
                under the one arrangement, at the same time, and will
                extinguish together on maturity (subsection 230-55(4)); and


              . it would be reasonable to assume that Company B intends to
                deal with its rights and obligations under the note
                together, and not separately.  (For the holder of such an
                exchangeable note, objectively it may be concluded that the
                general and principal purpose of entering into the
                exchangeable note is to benefit from both the annual
                interest payments and from holding a right to shares, the
                value of which may appreciate in the future, after the right
                is exercised and the shares are acquired) (subsection 230-
                55(4)).


                Under this arrangement Company B has the right to receive
                cash coupon payments and, upon maturity, a right to the
                redemption amount - which is to be satisfied by receiving a
                payment of money.  Both of these rights are cash settlable
                (paragraph 230-45(2)(a)).  Company B also has a right to
                receive shares under the arrangement  - that right is still
                a relevant right even though it is subject to a contingency.
                 The right is the exercise of the option by Company B
                (paragraph 230-85(a)).  The right to receive shares is a
                cash settlable right, because there is a market for the
                shares which has a high degree of liquidity and the shares
                constitute the right to receive the financial benefit.
                Company B also did not have as its sole or dominant purpose
                for entering into the arrangement its purchase or usage
                requirements in the ordinary course of its business
                (subsection 230-45(1) and paragraph 230-45(2)(g)).


                Hence, each of the exchangeable notes is a cash settlable
                financial arrangement for the purposes of Division 230.


                Is there a sufficiently certain gain or loss?


                Given Company B has not made any of the elections under
                Division 230, the gains or losses from the exchangeable
                notes may be subject to either the accruals or realisation
                methods.  The accruals method will apply to gains or losses
                from the exchangeable note if there is a sufficiently
                certain overall gain or loss or a sufficiently certain
                particular gain or loss made from the arrangement
                (section 230-100).  The sufficiently certain gain or loss is
                calculated by reference only to financial benefits that are
                sufficiently certain (subsection 230-115(1)).


                A financial benefit is sufficiently certain if:


              . it is reasonable to expect that Company B will receive or
                provide the financial benefit (assuming Company B will
                continue to have the exchangeable notes until redemption -
                ie, for the estimated life of the arrangement)
                (paragraph 230-115(2)(a)); and


              . the amount or value of the financial benefit is fixed or
                determinable with reasonable accuracy (paragraph 230-
                115(2)(b)).


                Taking into account the terms and conditions of the
                arrangement, and the economic or commercial substance and
                effect of the arrangement, the interest payments can be said
                to be sufficiently certain (subsection 230-115(2)).  This is
                because at the start of the arrangement, it is reasonable to
                expect that Company B will receive an amount of interest
                that is determinable with reasonable accuracy - this is
                because the amount of interest is able to be calculated as
                6 per cent of the original amount invested.


                The financial benefits which are represented by the shares
                in Company C, and the redemption amount, are not
                sufficiently certain when taken on an individual basis.
                However, Company B is required to have regard to
                contingencies which attach to other financial benefits under
                the arrangement (subparagraph 230-115(3)(a)(iv)).  This
                means that, in determining whether the financial benefit
                represented by the redemption amount is sufficiently
                certain, Company B is required to take into account the
                effect of the right to the shares in Company C.  When the
                effect of the contingencies attaching to each of the
                financial benefits is taken into account, it could be
                objectively concluded that at the end of the arrangement
                Company B would make a gain of at least $100,000 - this is
                the gain made where the redemption amount, as opposed to the
                shares, is taken.


                This is because at the start of the arrangement, although
                the amount of the actual gain made by Company B cannot be
                calculated - because this would depend, amongst other
                things, on the value of Company C's shares at the time of
                redemption - Company B would not choose the shares if the
                market value of the shares gave rise to a gain that was less
                than $100,000.


                For the purposes of determining whether the right to the
                redemption amount is sufficiently certain, it is appropriate
                to treat that financial benefit as if it were not contingent
                (paragraph 230-115(3)(b)).  Therefore, it could be said, on
                the basis of this required assumption, that it is reasonable
                to expect that the redemption amount will be received at the
                end of the arrangement.


                It is also reasonable to attribute the cost of the
                exchangeable notes to the final redemption amount.  Hence,
                there will be a sufficiently certain overall gain made from
                the exchangeable notes of at least $100,000.


                Further, the rule in subsection 230-70(3) applies to the
                interest payments.  Under this rule, which applies in
                calculating a particular gain or loss under the accruals
                method, the receipt of an amount of, in the nature of, or in
                substitution for, interest, will represent a gain in its
                entirety (see Chapter 3 for further discussion of this
                rule).  Were there no sufficiently certain gain, the
                interest payments would still be accrued because of the
                operation of subsection 230-70(4).  However, in this
                situation as there is clearly an overall sufficiently
                certain gain the interest payments will form part of the
                overall sufficiently certain gain, which is required to be
                accrued.


                Both the sufficiently certain overall gain of $100,000 and
                the sufficiently certain interest payments are to be brought
                to account over the three-year term of the notes on a
                compounding accruals basis.


   543. Ordinary options and forwards over shares have relatively uncertain
        outcomes and a gain or loss in respect of them is not fixed or
        determinable with reasonable accuracy.  The financial benefits
        under the financial arrangement may be the subject of a material
        contingency.  Therefore, any gain or loss under the arrangement
        cannot be determined with sufficient certainty.  Rather, any gains
        or losses should be subject to the realisation method.


    544. Generally, for comparison and reference, consider the case of an
         ordinary share traded on a stock exchange.  (Note that ordinary
         shares are 'equity interests' and generally are not subject to
         Division 230 except where the fair value or financial reports
         election applies [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(e)].)
         Typically, an ordinary share is subject to relatively high price
         volatility, and the value of their expected future financial
         benefits is relatively uncertain; the gains or losses from holding
         the share are similarly uncertain.  Hence, a financial arrangement
         where the relevant financial benefits are directly linked to
         movements in an individual share price, or with returns (financial
         benefits) that are as uncertain as the returns on an ordinary share
         that is traded on the ASX, would ordinarily not be subject to the
         compounding accruals methodology.


   545. Furthermore, in the case of a financial arrangement where the
        relevant values of the financial benefits are directly linked to
        movements in a broad-based share price index (such as the ASX All
        Ordinaries Index), or are as uncertain as are the returns based on
        that index, such gains or losses would not ordinarily be subject to
        compounding accruals treatment, but would instead be brought to
        account on a realisation basis.


Calculation of a gain or loss


   546. As discussed in Chapter 3, to work out if there is a gain or loss
        arising from a financial arrangement, a taxpayer is generally
        required to compare:


                . the financial benefits which the taxpayer has provided, or
                  which are to be provided, or the rights to financial
                  benefits surrendered under the financial arrangement (the
                  'cost'); with


                . the financial benefits which are received, or which are to
                  be received, or the obligations to transfer financial
                  benefits under the financial arrangement (the 'proceeds').


   547. The comparison recognises that a gain or loss, for the purposes of
        Division 230, is a net concept.  As discussed in Chapter 3, there
        is a requirement that the taxpayer make a reasonable (in other
        words, an objectively supportable) allocation of costs to proceeds.
         In particular, subsection 230-115(1) requires that for the
        purposes of Division 230, to determine whether a gain or loss is
        sufficiently certain at a particular time, only those financial
        benefits that are sufficiently certain to be received or provided
        under the arrangement can be taken into account, unless gains or
        losses which are not sufficiently certain may lead to an over-
        accrual of a sufficiently certain gain or loss (see earlier
        discussion).  In this sense, the test in subsection 230-115(1) is
        focused on those financial benefits that are yet to be received or
        provided.  It does not necessarily preclude, in the calculation of
        the relevant gain or loss, the taxpayer from taking into account
        financial benefits already received or provided under the
        arrangement.  Such financial benefits are, by the very fact that
        they have been provided or received, taken to be certain for the
        purposes of determining whether a gain or loss is sufficiently
        certain at a particular time - although such financial benefits, or
        part thereof, should not be attributed or included in the
        calculation of a sufficiently certain gain or loss more than once.
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-115(9)]


   548. As noted in paragraph 4.72, the calculation of a sufficiently
        certain overall gain or loss requires that the entire value of the
        costs of the arrangement be attributed to those financial benefits
        that are sufficiently certain at the start of the arrangement.  The
        concept of a particular gain or loss necessarily requires that the
        financial benefits which represent the cost of the financial
        arrangement be reasonably attributed to the sufficiently certain
        financial benefit that will give rise to a gain or loss [Schedule
        1, item 1, sections 230-70 and 230-75].  Whether the attribution of
        those financial benefits provided is reasonable is determined by
        taking into account the factors listed in subsection 230-70(3).
        The attribution is to be calculated as at the time when a taxpayer
        respectively receives or provides the relevant financial benefit
        respectively.  Chapter 3 further discusses the attribution process.




   549. Financial benefits that have been taken into account in calculating
        a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss are required to be
        disregarded when calculating a sufficiently certain particular gain
        or loss [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-110(2)(b)].  Practically
        this will mean that where there is a sufficiently certain overall
        gain or loss calculated for a financial arrangement with reference
        to some, but not all, of the financial benefits which are to be
        received (because some of those financial benefits are not
        sufficiently certain at the start of the arrangement), then once
        those financial benefits become sufficiently certain, the amount of
        the gain or loss on that financial benefit will reflect the entire
        value of the financial benefit.  This is because all of the cost of
        the financial arrangement would have been attributed to the
        calculation of the sufficiently certain overall gain or loss.


The compounding accruals method


   550. The compounding accruals method spreads gains or losses that are
        sufficiently certain to occur [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-
        100].  In order to 'spread' the sufficiently certain gain or loss,
        the taxpayer needs to establish:


                . a period over which the gain or loss should be spread;


                . the method used to allocate the gain or loss to particular
                  intervals within the period established; and


                . how to work out an allocation of part of a gain or loss
                  that is allocated to an interval that straddles two income
                  years.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-125]


         Period over which the gain or loss is to be spread


         Relevant period for a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss


   551. If it is established that there is a sufficiently certain overall
        gain or loss from a financial arrangement, that gain or loss is to
        be spread (recognised) over a period that starts when the taxpayer
        starts to have the financial arrangement and ends when the taxpayer
        ceases to have the financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-130(1)]


   552. In some instances, the period over which the financial arrangement
        is held will not be known at the start of the arrangement - for
        example, in the case of financial arrangements that last in
        perpetuity.  For the purposes of determining the start and the end
        of the arrangement, the taxpayer must assume that they will
        continue to have the financial arrangement for the rest of the life
        of the financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
        130(1)].  Hence, the life of such a financial arrangement starts at
        the time the taxpayer acquires or creates the arrangement and ends
        in perpetuity.


   553. The period stated in paragraph 4.131 is the appropriate period over
        which the overall gain or loss should be spread because, consistent
        with the general policy underpinning the accruals method in
        Subdivision 230-B, this is the period to which that overall gain or
        loss relates.  This policy is encapsulated in the principles stated
        in the sufficiently certain particular gain or loss case in
        subsection 230-130(2).  However, where all financial benefits
        become sufficiently certain following the start of a financial
        arrangement, such that the overall gain or loss, or gain or loss of
        at least a particular amount, arising on the financial arrangement
        becomes known with sufficient certainty, that gain or loss should
        be treated as a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss
        and spread from the time at which it becomes certain to the
        time at which the arrangement matures, or for the rest of its life,
        as per paragraph 230-105(2)(a).


         The relevant period for a sufficiently certain particular gain or
         loss that arises from a financial benefit


   554. Where there is a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss that
        arises from a particular financial benefit, the relevant period
        over which that gain or loss is to be spread is the period to which
        the gain or loss relates.  In determining the period to which that
        gain or loss relates, regard must be had to the pricing, terms and
        conditions of the financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-130(3)].  The pricing, terms and conditions, amongst
        other considerations, will give an indication of what the financial
        benefit was provided for or received for, and hence a reference
        point to which period that financial benefit relates.  Under the
        sufficiently certain particular gain or loss method, the gain or
        loss is taken to arise from that particular financial benefit, and
        so, generally, the period to which the financial benefit relates
        would also be the period to which the particular gain or loss
        relates, except in cases of deferral of payment where the time
        value of money may not be fully reflected.


   555. Despite the general requirement to allocate the gain or loss to the
        period to which it relates, a specific boundary is placed on when
        that period can start and when that period can end.  The period
        over which the sufficiently certain gain or loss is to be spread
        must not start earlier than the time at which the taxpayer starts
        to have the financial arrangement nor earlier than the beginning of
        the income year in which the gain or loss becomes sufficiently
        certain [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-130(3)].  Additionally,
        the end of the period over which the gain or loss is to be spread
        must not end later than:


                . the time the taxpayer will cease to have the financial
                  arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-130(5)(a)];


                . the end of the income year in which the particular
                  financial benefit that gives rise to the gain or loss is
                  to be received or provided [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subparagraph 230-130(5)(b)(i)]; or


                . the end of the income year during which the right or
                  obligation (the cessation of which gives rise to the gain
                  or loss) is to cease [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph 230-
                  130(5)(b)(ii)].


      1. :  Calculation of relevant period for debt interest


                Spices Ltd invests $1,000 into a three-year debt interest on
                30 June 2011.  The terms provide that if the profits in Tech
                Co are at a certain level on 30 June 2013, then on 30 June
                2014, $2,000 is payable on redemption.


                Assume that the profits of Tech Co achieve the levels
                required on 30 June 2013.


                In the present case, there is a sufficiently certain gain
                for Spices Ltd under the financial arrangement determinable
                at 30 June 2013.  On 30 June 2013, it is reasonably expected
                that Spices Ltd will receive a fixed and determinable amount
                of $2,000.  This financial benefit is therefore sufficiently
                certain.  It is reasonable to attribute the entire cost of
                the debt interest to the financial benefit that becomes
                sufficiently certain on 30 June 2013.  Hence, at that time
                it is sufficiently certain that Spices Ltd will make a
                particular gain of $1,000.


                Consistent with the period specified in subsection 230-
                130(5), the period will end on 30 June 2014 - the time at
                which Spices Ltd will redeem the investment and hence the
                time at which Spices Ltd will receive the financial benefit.


                Having regard to the pricing, terms and conditions of the
                financial arrangement, the period over which the
                sufficiently certain particular gain of $1,000 is to be
                allocated will commence on 1 July 2012 (the start of the
                income year in which the gain becomes sufficiently certain
                (paragraph 230-130(4)(b)) and end on 30 June 2014
                (paragraph 230-130(5)(b)).


         Overall gain or loss may be spread in accordance with the
         particular gain or loss rule


   556. Where the sufficiently certain gains or losses from the financial
        arrangement in effect represent both an overall gain or loss and a
        particular gain or loss, the taxpayer may choose to spread gains or
        losses as if they were the latter [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
        230-130(2)].  The choice must be applied consistently [Schedule 1,
        item 1, subsection 230-80(3)].


   557. The purpose of this choice is to reduce complexity and compliance
        costs.


         How the gain or loss is spread


   558. Once the period over which the relevant gain or loss should be
        spread is determined, the method used to spread that gain or loss
        over that period must be established.  Where the accruals method
        applies to gains or losses the taxpayer makes from a financial
        arrangement, the gain or loss is spread using:


                . compounding accruals [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  135(2)(a)]; or


                . a different method, the results of which approximates
                  those obtained using compounding accruals [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, paragraph 230-135(2)(b)].


         Compounding accruals method


   559. Under compounding accruals, the gain or loss must be allocated to
        intervals that are the same length and do not exceed 12 months.
        However, the first and last interval may be shorter than the other
        intervals.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-135(4)]


         Fixing of amount and rate for interval


   560. In allocating the gain or loss to an interval it is necessary to
        determine the rate of return and the amount to which the rate of
        return is to be applied for a given interval.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-135(5)]


   561. The amount to which the rate of return is to be applied can be
        adjusted for reasons other than a fresh allocation of the gain or
        loss under paragraph 230-190(5)(a).  In determining the amount it
        is necessary to have regard to both the amount (or value) and
        timing of the financial benefits that are to be taken into account
        in working out the gain or loss that is to be allocated to each
        interval and were provided or received by you during the interval
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-135(6)].  An example of the
        application of this is rule is where a borrower has made an early
        repayment of part of the principal on a loan that has the effect of
        reducing the current outstanding amount to which the interest rate
        on the loan is to be applied in allocating the gain or loss for
        that interval.


   562. Whichever method is chosen, the method is to be applied to spread
        the gain or loss on the assumption that the taxpayer will continue
        to have the financial arrangement for the rest of the arrangement's
        life [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-135(7)].  An exception to
        this rule applies to 'portfolio fees' and 'portfolio premiums or
        discounts' as discussed in paragraphs 4.153 to 4.167.


   563. Generally, to apply the compounding accruals method, a taxpayer
        estimates the rate of return (the discount rate) that equates the
        net present value of all relevant cash flows (financial benefits)
        to zero.  A taxpayer applies that rate to the initial investment,
        to provide an estimated year-by-year gain which forms the basis for
        taxation.  Although the discount rate is determined by reference to
        net present values, Division 230 applies to gains or losses so that
        the total nominal gains or losses are brought to account [Schedule
        1, item 1, subsections 230-70(1) and 230-75(1)].  However, in
        making such an allocation of the gain or loss to the relevant
        intervals, regard must be had to the financial benefits that are to
        be provided or received in each of those intervals [Schedule 1,
        item 1, subsection 230-135(8)].  If there are a number of financial
        benefits that are to be provided at the start of the arrangement,
        and those financial benefits give rise to an overall gain, the
        allocation of parts of that overall gain to all of the relevant
        intervals should take into account the fact that these payments
        will be made in the intervals towards the start of the arrangement.




   564. For the purposes of applying the compounding accruals method, the
        length of a particular compounding interval is not prescribed, but
        it cannot exceed 12 months [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
        135(4)(a)].  Each of the intervals must be of the same length,
        except for the first and last interval which may be shorter than
        the other intervals used [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
        135(4)(b)].  The first and last interval may be shorter than the
        other intervals during the accrual period because the financial
        arrangement may have been created or acquired part way through the
        financial year of the taxpayer, and not at a designated interval.
        Equally, the relevant financial arrangement may cease part way
        through an interval period.  For example, a designated interval may
        be a three-month period, consistent with a financial quarter.  That
        is, an interval might have otherwise started on 1 July and ended on
        30 September.  However, the financial arrangement may have been
        acquired on 10 August.  The taxpayer could still use intervals that
        are consistent with a financial quarter, but the first interval
        will be from 10 August to 30 September - a lesser period that the
        other intervals in the accrual period.


      1. :  Application of the compounding accruals method - a bond without
         a periodic payment


                John Doe invests $100 in a zero coupon bond that will pay
                $120 at maturity in four years time.  The bond satisfies the
                definition of 'qualifying security' in Division 16E of the
                ITAA 1936.  The bond, by its terms, satisfies the definition
                of 'financial arrangement' for Division 230 purposes.


         Figure 4.1:  Zero coupon bond - representation of the holder's
         financial benefits






















                This is represented diagrammatically in Figure 4.1 by the
                return of the investment extending beyond the cost (shown as
                the small horizontal dash).


                This bond would be subject to the compounding accruals
                method because there is a sufficiently certain overall gain
                that arises at the time the bond starts to be held by John
                Doe.  The overall gain is sufficiently certain because it is
                reasonable to expect that, assuming John Doe holds the bond
                for its life (ie, until maturity) the financial benefits
                will be received under the arrangement and those benefits
                have a fixed value (section 230-115).  For the purposes of
                accruing the gain, John Doe has chosen a 12-month
                compounding period.


                To work out the part of the overall gain or loss that is to
                be recognised in each income year:


              . Estimate all cash flows as in column (c) of Table 4.1.


              . Calculate the discount rate at which the net present value
                of those cash flows is zero.  This discount rate is also
                known as the internal rate of return, or the effective
                interest rate.  In this example it is 4.66 per cent per
                year.


              . Apply the discount rate to the cost of the financial
                arrangement on a compounding basis to create column (b).


                This is the gain or loss from the compounding accruals
                method each year.  Effectively the gain of $20 is spread on
                a compounding accruals basis over the four-year period as
                shown in column (b).


      1.   Accrual of sufficiently certain overall gain

|Year |Amortise|Accrued|Cash   |Amortised cost|
|     |d cost  |interes|flows  |(year end)    |
|     |(year   |t due  |       |              |
|     |start)  |       |       |              |
|     |(a)     |(b)    |(c)    |(a)  +  (b)  -|
|     |        |       |       |(c)           |
|0    |$0.00   |$0.00  |-$100.0|$100.00       |
|     |        |       |0      |              |
|1    |$100.00 |$4.66  |$0.00  |$104.66       |
|2    |$104.66 |$4.88  |$0.00  |$109.54       |
|3    |$109.54 |$5.11  |$0.00  |$114.65       |
|4    |$114.65 |$5.35  |$120.00|$0.00         |


         Methods other than a compounding accruals method


   565. A method other than the prescribed compounding accruals method may
        be used to spread a sufficiently certain gain or loss where the
        outcome under that method approximates the outcome under the
        compounding accruals method.  The focus of the provision is in
        relation to the method used and not only the result from the
        application of that method.  This means that taxpayer will not have
        to do two separate calculations - one under the prescribed method,
        and one under the alternative method - as long as the alternative
        method can be shown to have approximated what would have been the
        outcome under the compounding accruals method.


   566. In determining whether a method gives rise to results which
        approximate those obtained under the compounding accruals method,
        regard must be had to the length of the period over which the gain
        or loss is to be spread.  For example, the straight-line spreading
        method could be used for short-term financial arrangements, such as
        90-day bills or arrangements which pay interest at least annually,
        and which have been acquired for face value.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        paragraph 230-135(2)(b)]


         Effective interest method


   567. For the purposes of a method of spreading gains and losses that
        approximates the compounding accruals method, the effective
        interest method described in AASB 139 (or a comparable standard)
        will satisfy this requirement provided the financial arrangement
        does not have significant deferral characteristics and it is
        appropriately determined and reported in the taxpayer's audited
        financial accounts [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-140].  This
        'safe harbour' method seeks to minimise compliance costs for
        taxpayers without opening up tax deferral opportunities.


   568. The 'effective interest rate' method is a method of calculating the
        amortised cost of a financial instrument and of allocating the
        interest income or interest expense over the relevant time period
        (often the term of the financial instrument).  In most cases, the
        financial instrument that is captured under AASB 139 will be the
        same as the financial arrangement that is subject to Division 230.


   569. The 'effective interest rate' is the rate that exactly discounts
        estimated future cash payments or receipts through the expected
        life of the financial arrangement, to the net carrying amount of
        the financial instrument.


   570. For the effective interest rate method under AASB 139 to satisfy
        paragraph 230-135(2)(b) for a particular financial arrangement it
        must satisfy these requirements:


                . when the taxpayer starts to have the arrangement, the
                  annually compounded rate of return applicable to any
                  discount or premium under the arrangement does not exceed
                  1 per cent [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-140(3)(a)];


                . neither the expected life nor the maximum life of the
                  arrangement is more than 30 years when the taxpayer
                  first starts to have the arrangement (or a different time
                  as prescribed by regulations) [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-140(3)(b)];


                . the financial benefits the taxpayer has an obligation to
                  provide or right to receive - that give rise to a gain or
                  loss from the arrangement not attributable to any discount
                  or premium - relates to a period not exceeding 12 months
                  and will be provided or received within that period
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-140(3)(c)]; and


                . the gains or losses under the financial arrangement are
                  spread in a way provided for under AASB 139 (or a
                  comparable standard) in audited financial accounts of the
                  taxpayer  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-140(3)(d) to
                  (f)].


   571. The taxpayer's accounts for the purposes of section 230-140 will be
        taken to be audited financial reports if they satisfy the
        requirement of subsection 230-210(2) in relation to, and in a way
        that is relevant to, the spreading.


   572. If the financial arrangement that would otherwise satisfy the
        requirements of section 230-140 has features that require the
        interest rate on the arrangement to be re-set at least annually and
        the new rate applies no later than the reset date, the re-
        estimation requirements in section 230-190 permits the re-
        estimation to be done at the re-set date.


         Election to spread portfolio fees/premium/discount


   573. Generally, if it is established that there is a sufficiently
        certain overall gain or loss from a financial arrangement, that
        gain or loss is to be spread over a period that commences when the
        taxpayer starts to have the financial arrangement and ends when the
        taxpayer ceases to have the financial arrangement (as discussed in
        paragraphs 4.71 to 4.73).  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-
        105(1) and 230-130(1)]


   574. However, this rule is modified by way of an irrevocable election in
        circumstances where the overall gain or loss from the financial
        arrangement arises in part from fees referred to as 'portfolio
        fees', or from a discount/premium, in respect of a portfolio of
        similar financial arrangements and the financial arrangement is
        part of a portfolio of similar financial arrangements.
        [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-150, 230-160 and 230-165]


   575. In these cases, the portfolio fees from, and any premium or
        discount, in respect of the financial arrangement are spread over
        the expected life of the portfolio rather than from the period the
        financial arrangement started and ceased to be held [Schedule 1,
        item 1, subsections 230-160(3) and (5) and 230-165(3) and (5)].  An
        example of a portfolio of similar financial arrangements is a
        portfolio of similar home loans held by a bank.  An application or
        establishment fee payable on the home loan is an example of a
        portfolio fee to which the modified accruals rule applies.  A
        portfolio of loans purchased for an amount less than its face value
        may represent a portfolio discount to which the modified accruals
        rule may also apply.  The election can only be made in the
        following circumstances:


                . where the taxpayer has prepared audited financial reports
                  in accordance with the accounting standards (or comparable
                  standards) [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-150(1)]; or


                . all the following criteria are satisfied:


                  - a connected entity of the taxpayer has prepared an
                    audited financial report;


                  - the report of the connected entity is a consolidated
                    financial report that deals with both the taxpayer's
                    affairs and the affairs of the connected entity; and


                  - the report properly reflects the taxpayer's affairs
                    (discussed below and in Chapter 5).


    576. The election applies to financial arrangements that the taxpayer
         starts to have in the year of the election or subsequent years
         following the election [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-
         160(1)(a) and (b) and 230-165(1)(a) and (b)].  Once made an
         election it is irrevocable (subsection 230-150(2)).


   577. The election applies only to portfolio fees or discount/premiums
        arising from a financial arrangement that is part of a portfolio of
        similar financial arrangements [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-
        160(3) and 230-165(3)].  What is meant by 'similar' in the context
        of a portfolio of financial arrangements is to be determined by
        reference to the terms, conditions such as tenure, pricing and risk
        profile of the financial arrangements.  An example could be a
        portfolio of similar home mortgages or credit card receivables held
        by a bank or financial institution.


   578. The 'portfolio fees' are those fees that (in the absence of the
        'portfolio fee' election) would form part of the gain or loss from
        the financial arrangement under subsection 230-105(1) [Schedule 1,
        item 1, paragraph 230-160(1)(c)].  The discount/premium is that
        part of the gain or loss that arises as a result of the
        discount/premium on the loan portfolio.  Specifically, for the
        purpose of the election, that part of the gain or loss arising from
        the fees, and the part relating to the discount/premium, are
        treated as separate gains or losses from the financial arrangement
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-160(2)].


   579. In the case of fees, in order for the election to apply they must
        play an integral role in determining the amount of the gain or loss
        from the financial arrangement.  What is integral is determined by
        the nature and role of the fee in relation to the financial
        arrangement that gives rise to the overall gain or loss.
        [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-160(1)(e)]


   580. The net amount of these fees should not be significant relative to
        the gain or loss on the arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph
        230-160(1)(f)].  In relation to the fee gain or loss, the net fee
        is used because portfolio fees include both fee (income) and costs
        (expenses).  Examples of typical fees that would be included in a
        portfolio of fees are establishment fees, legal fees, search fees,
        brokerage commission (costs), and valuation (costs).  In the case
        of discounts and premiums, the premium or discount should not be
        significant relative to the gain or loss on the portfolio of which
        the financial arrangement is a part [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph
        230-165(1)(e)].


   581. As the portfolio treatment of discounts/premiums will modify the
        general rule relating to the period over which the gain or loss is
        spread (in some cases shortening the 'spread' period) it is a
        requirement that the fees and the discount/premium must be
        insignificant relative to the gain or loss (that excludes the net
        portfolio fee) from the portfolio of which the financial
        arrangement is a part (which typically mainly consist of interest
        income).


   582. What is not significant is determined on an objective basis
        depending on the facts and circumstances, for example it could be
        said that net fees of $1000 on a home loan which gives rise to
        interest income of $100,000 would not be significant relative to
        the overall gain on the loan.  The testing time for determining
        whether the net fee is insignificant is at the start of the
        financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-
        160(1)(f) and 230-165(1)(e)]


      1.


                An entity acquires from a vendor a portfolio of loans that
                include a right to receive $120 in two years time.  However,
                the entity provided $110 to acquire this arrangement,
                notwithstanding that the market value of the right to
                receive $120 in two years time is $100.


                The gain on the arrangement is $10.  The gain of $10 is
                split into one gain and another loss.  The part of the gain
                which relates to the premium is a loss of $10, and the part
                not relating to the premium is a $20 gain.


                The entity spreads the $20 gain using the standard
                accruals/realisation method.


                The entity spreads the $10 loss in accordance with the
                determination referred to below.


         How is the expected life of the portfolio determined


   583. The period over which the fees are spread is the expected life of
        the portfolio.  In the case of fees, the period is to be determined
        before the fee is payable or receivable and must be reasonable and
        objective.  Further, the period is to be determined prior to the
        entity starting to have the arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1,
        paragraphs 230-165(3)(b) to (d) and 230-160(3)(b) to (d)].  What is
        considered reasonable and objective would depend on the facts and
        circumstances of each portfolio, and would include the assumptions
        made and methodology used to determine the average life of the
        portfolio, for example quantitative data or analysis (based on
        historical data) on the expected early repayment of similar
        financial arrangements.


   584. The basis of determining the period over which to spread the
        portfolio must accord with the spreading of the discount premium
        for the purposes of the profit and loss statement in the audited
        financial reports of the taxpayer [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs
        230-160(3)(a) and 230-165(3)(a)].  It would be considered that the
        basis of determining the period for spreading the portfolio
        discount premium accords with the audited financial reports if the
        basis determined does not result in a qualification to the audited
        report of the taxpayer with respect to the period determined.


   585. In the case of fees, the method of spreading the fee must also be
        reasonable and objective and be determined before the fee is
        payable or receivable [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-160(4)].
        In the case of portfolio premiums and discounts, the method of
        spreading the premium or discount must also be reasonable and
        objective and be determined before the entity starts to have the
        arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-165(4)].  Further,
        the method of spreading the portfolio fees discounts or premiums
        must accord with the spreading of the fees in the profit and loss
        statement in the audited financial reports.


   586. What is considered reasonable and objective would depend on the
        facts and circumstances of each type of fee, and would include the
        assumptions made or methodology used to determine what portion of
        the fee (income or expense) is to be spread.  For example, it may
        be that expenses that relate in part to unsuccessful loans such as
        legal or valuations expenses may be spread on a percentage basis as
        determined by historic loan success rate data.  It would be
        considered that the method of spreading of portfolio fee accords
        with the audited financial accounts if the method used does not
        result in a qualification of the audited accounts because of the
        manner in which the portfolio fees have been spread.


         Transitional election to apply Division 230 to existing financial
         arrangements - application of portfolio treatment to existing
         financial arrangements


   587. A taxpayer will not be prevented from applying the 'portfolio'
        treatment (to spread the fees) arising from a financial arrangement
        that existed prior to the first income year in which Division 230
        applies to the taxpayer, and that the taxpayer still has at the
        time the Division first applies to the taxpayer.  In these cases,
        the election in section 230-150 is able to be made despite the fact
        that the taxpayer started to have the financial arrangement before
        the first income year in which the Division applies to the
        taxpayer.  [Schedule 1, Part 3, subitem 104(7)]


         Allocating gain or loss to income years


   588. That part of a gain or loss that has been allocated, pursuant to
        the compounding accruals or other acceptable method, to a
        particular interval must be brought to account under section 230-15
        as:


                . assessable income; or


                . an allowable deduction, provided the loss requirements in
                  section 230-15 are satisfied,


         in the income year in which the interval falls.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-170(1)]


   589. If the relevant interval straddles an income year, such that it
        starts in one income year and ends in the subsequent income year,
        the part of the gain or loss that relates to that interval must be
        allocated between the income years on a reasonable basis.  The
        relevant amount that is brought to account under section 230-15 is
        so much of that part of the gain or loss that has been allocated to
        each income year.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-170(2)]


         Running balancing adjustment


   590. As noted above, the amount of a gain or loss that is subject to the
        compounding accruals provisions is calculated using sufficiently
        certain financial benefits, the values of which were fixed or
        determinable with reasonable accuracy at a particular point in
        time.  That is, the values of the relevant financial benefits were
        estimated.  Over time, the financial benefits that are to be
        received or provided under the financial arrangement will be
        received or paid.  At the time a financial benefit is received or
        provided (or the time comes for the financial benefit to be
        received or provided), a balancing adjustment may be required.


   591. The difference between the estimated value of a financial benefit
        and the amount that a taxpayer receives or provides will be brought
        to account by the application of the running balancing adjustment
        as either a gain or loss for the purposes of Division 230.  This
        means that the taxpayer will recognise an amount of assessable
        income or, where the relevant loss requirements are satisfied, an
        allowable deduction which is equal to the relevant excess or
        shortfall.  The excess or shortfall is brought to account for tax
        purposes in the income year in which the time for the financial
        benefit to be received or provided occurs, or at the time the
        financial benefit is actually received or provided if this is
        earlier.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-175]


   592. More specifically, by virtue of the running balancing adjustment,
        an amount of a loss may be recognised where the compounding
        accruals method applied to the financial arrangement at a
        particular time and the taxpayer:


                . was sufficiently certain that they would receive a
                  financial benefit of at least a particular amount and, at
                  the time when the financial benefit is received or is to
                  be received, the amount received is a nil amount or an
                  amount that was less than the estimated amount of the
                  financial benefit [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
                  175(1)]; or


                . was sufficiently certain that they would provide a
                  financial benefit of at least a particular amount and, at
                  the time when the financial benefit is provided or is to
                  be provided, the amount provided is more than the
                  estimated value of the financial benefit [Schedule 1, item
                  1, subsection 230-175(4)].


   593. Equally, the running balancing adjustment will apply in cases where
        an amount of a gain is recognised where the compounding accruals
        method applied to the financial arrangement and, at a particular
        time, the taxpayer:


                . was sufficiently certain that they would receive a
                  financial benefit of at least a particular amount and, at
                  the time when the financial benefit is received or is to
                  be received, the amount received is more than the
                  estimated amount of the financial benefit [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, subsection 230-175(2)]; or


                . was sufficiently certain that they would provide a
                  financial benefit of at least a particular amount and, at
                  the time when the financial benefit is provided or is to
                  be provided, the amount provided is nil or less than the
                  estimated value of the financial benefit [Schedule 1, item
                  1, subsection 230-175(3)].


         Re-estimation of gain or loss


   594. Whether a financial arrangement will be subject to the compounding
        accruals method is to be determined initially at the time when the
        taxpayer starts to have the financial arrangement or when specific
        financial benefits become sufficiently certain so as to give rise
        to a sufficiently certain particular gain or loss.  Generally, for
        many financial arrangements, the taxpayer will apply the
        compounding accruals method to the relevant gain or loss for the
        term of the financial arrangement.  However, some circumstances may
        arise where, during the term of the financial arrangement, the
        calculation of the gain or loss to be accrued must be re-estimated.
         For example, previously contingent amounts that are no longer
        contingent may affect the amount of the gain or loss that is
        sufficiently certain to occur under the financial arrangement.


         When is re-estimation necessary?


   595. A taxpayer is required to re-estimate a gain or loss from a
        financial arrangement if:


                . the compounding accruals method applies to that gain or
                  loss; and


                . there is a material change to the circumstances that
                  affect the estimate, in respect of an amount or value of a
                  financial benefit or the timing of the provision of a
                  financial benefit.


         The taxpayer is required to make that re-estimation as soon as
         practicable after they become aware of the relevant material
         changes to the circumstances.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         190(2)]


   596. Relevant circumstances which would require a re-estimation include,
        but are not limited to:


                . a material change in market conditions which is relevant
                  to the amount or value of financial benefits that are to
                  be received or provided under the financial arrangement
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-190(3)(a)];


                . the cash flow or flows which were previously estimated
                  become known [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  190(3)(b)];


                . the right to, or part of a right to, a financial benefit
                  under the financial arrangement is written off as a bad
                  debt [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-190(3)(c)]; and


                . a re-assessment of the gains or losses to which the
                  compounding accruals method should apply (pursuant to
                  section 230-185) being undertaken and it being determined
                  that the compounding accruals method was still the
                  appropriate method to apply to those gains or losses
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-190(3)(d)].


   597. A taxpayer is not required to re-estimate the amount of the gain or
        loss if the change in the value or amount of the financial benefit
        or the timing of the financial benefit is not significant.  The
        requirement is that a change to those circumstances affecting a
        financial benefit is a material change.  Whether there has been a
        material change is a question of fact which depends on the relevant
        circumstances of each situation.  An example is where there is a
        change to circumstances such that a cash flow which was previously
        estimated becomes known, but where the difference between the
        estimated value of the cash flow and the actual value of the cash
        flow is small or negligible in nominal terms.  In such an instance,
        the change would not be material.  Hence, a re-estimation is not
        required in such a situation and the taxpayer will continue to
        accrue the originally calculated sufficiently certain gain or loss.
         In such cases the small differences between the estimated values
        and the actual values of the relevant financial benefits will be
        brought to account by way of the running balancing adjustment in
        section 230-175.


   598. Under section 230-190, a re-estimation is only done where a change
        in the circumstances will materially affect the amount or value or
        timing of a financial benefit that was used to calculate a gain or
        loss made from the financial arrangement.  However, if, consistent
        with a taxpayer's accounting systems, a re-estimation is still
        required where there is a change in circumstances which gives rise
        to an insignificant difference between the value of estimated cash
        flows and the value when those cash flows become known, a taxpayer
        may still apply the re-estimation provisions to the relevant
        financial arrangement.  That re-estimation can be done where the
        method used in the taxpayer's accounting systems approximates the
        results under the compounding accruals method.  Generally, if the
        changes are insignificant, then it may be considered that the
        results are a reasonable approximation of the method under
        Subdivision 230-B.  Such a practice must be adopted consistently -
        that is, if a re-estimation is to be done for insignificant
        differences between estimated and actual values for financial
        benefits in relation to a particular financial arrangement, that re-
        estimation must be done for all similar financial arrangements.


   599. A re-estimation of a gain or loss is not done where there has been
        a change in the credit rating or creditworthiness of a party or
        parties to the financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-190(3)]


   600. The case of impairment is to be distinguished from cases where
        rights to financial benefits have been written-off as a bad debt.
        The taxpayer will re-estimate the relevant gain from the financial
        arrangement only where such rights have been written-off as a bad
        debt.  Taxation Ruling TR 92/18 provides guidance as to when a debt
        is a bad debt.  A debt will not be a bad debt if it is simply
        doubtful that the debt will be recovered [Schedule 1, item 1,
        paragraph 230-190(3)(c)].  Further, the amount of the loss that is
        available where a bad debt is written-off is limited to the extent
        provided for in the legislation.


         Annual or more frequent reset date


   601. Where the gain or loss qualifies for spreading under the above rule
        and:


                . the financial arrangement has an interest reset date or
                  dates which occur at least annually; and


                . a new interest rate (if any) applies to the arrangement
                  from no later than the date at which the rate is set,


        the re-estimation of the gain or loss may be done at the reset date
        instead of at the time at which the taxpayer becomes aware of the
        relevant change in circumstances referred to in paragraph 230-
        190(1)(b).  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-190(2)]


         Re-estimation where there is a partial disposal


   602. A re-estimation is also required where the accruals method applies
        to gains or losses made from the financial arrangement, and the
        balancing adjustment under Subdivision 230-G is made in relation to
        the same financial arrangement.  The re-estimation is made where
        the balancing adjustment in Subdivision 230-G applied because a
        proportionate share of the rights or obligations or particular
        rights or obligations under the arrangement were transferred to
        another person [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-200(1)].  In
        such a situation, only the method prescribed under section 230-200
        should be used to re-estimate the relevant gain or loss that will
        be made from the financial arrangement.


   603. The balancing adjustment under Subdivision 230-G should bring to
        account, at the time of disposal of the relevant rights and
        obligations, a gain or loss referable to those rights and
        obligations.  The re-estimation provisions are triggered because
        the transfer of one or more rights and/or obligations would be
        expected to materially affect the amount or value and timing of
        financial benefits that were taken into account in calculating the
        amount of the originally determined sufficiently certain gain or
        loss.  It would be inappropriate then to allow that same amount of
        gain or loss to be recognised under the re-estimation.  This would
        have been the outcome if the provisions in section 230-190 were to
        apply without adjustment.


   604. Further, where the part of the financial arrangement disposed of
        was a right to an interest stream, Subdivision 230-G will have
        appropriately allocated a cost to that interest income stream
        disposed of, and calculated a gain or loss with reference to that
        cost and the proceeds received for the disposal.  The requirement
        to disregard the special rules in relation to interest or things in
        the nature of interest in subsections 230-70(4) and 230-75(4) is
        intended to ensure that the remaining gain or loss to be accrued
        can appropriately take account of that part of the cost of the
        financial arrangement that has been attributed to the portion
        disposed of.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-200(2)]


         Nature of a re-estimation


   605. A re-estimation for the purposes of Division 230 involves two parts
        - first, a fresh determination of the amount of the gain or loss
        and a reallocation of the remaining part of that revised amount
        over the remaining part of the accrual period.  [Schedule 1, item
        1, subsection 230-190(5)]


   606. The calculation of the re-estimated gain or loss will require a
        comparison of the values of the relevant sufficiently certain
        financial benefits that are to be received and provided by the
        taxpayer using the re-estimated values where relevant (see
        paragraphs 4.126 to 4.129 for a discussion on the calculation of
        gains and losses).  A 'balancing adjustment' is recognised at the
        time the re-estimation is done if the method in subsection 230-
        195(5) is used.  This balancing adjustment will ensure that, at the
        time of re-estimation, there is a correction made such that only
        the value of the actual gain or loss which is made by the taxpayer
        is brought to account under Division 230 during the life of the
        arrangement, so that a large adjustment will not be required at the
        end of arrangement.


   607. In situations where there is a partial disposal of a financial
        arrangement by way of a transfer of one or more rights and/or
        obligations in relation to financial benefits, a fresh
        determination of the amount of the gain or loss is also required.
        In making a fresh determination, the taxpayer is required to
        disregard those financial benefits to the extent to which they are
        reasonably attributable to the proportionate share or right or
        obligation that were transferred [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subparagraph 230-200(2)(a)(i)].  The taxpayer is also required to
        disregard amounts of the gain or loss that have already been
        allocated to intervals ending before the re-estimation is made, to
        the extent to which that part of the gain or loss is reasonably
        attributable to the part of the financial arrangement that was
        transferred [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph 230-200(2)(a)(ii)].
        Disregarding such financial benefits and proportionate amounts of
        the relevant gain or loss will ensure that there is no double
        recognition of amounts in the recalculated gain or loss.


         Basis for re-estimation - method used for fresh allocation


   608. As noted in paragraph 4.185, the nature of a re-estimation involves
        two parts.  The first part is a fresh determination of the gain or
        loss that is estimated to be made under the financial arrangement.
        The second part of the re-estimation process requires that a
        taxpayer make a fresh allocation of the part of the recalculated
        gain or loss to the remaining part of the accrual period.  One of
        two methods can be used to make a fresh allocation:


                . the first method is to maintain the rate of return which
                  was used prior to the re-estimation and adjust the amount
                  to which that rate of return is applied; or


                . the second method is to maintain the amount to which the
                  rate of return was applied prior to the re-estimation and
                  adjust the rate of return that is applied to that amount.




         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-190(6)]


   609. The amount to which the rate of return is applied depends on the
        method used.  The first method involves adjusting the amount to
        which the rate of return is applied to equal the present value of
        the estimated future (revised) cash flows, discounted at the rate
        of return that is being maintained.  This adjusted amount becomes
        the amortised cost to which the maintained rate of return will be
        applied to calculate the amount of the remaining gain or loss that
        is to be accrued.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-190(6)(a)]


   610. The second method requires an adjustment of the rate of return and
        maintaining the amount to which that rate of return will be
        applied.  That amount is the amortised cost of the arrangement at
        the time of the re-estimation.  The adjusted rate of return is
        calculated by reference to the amortised cost and the present value
        of the (revised) estimated future cash flows at the time of re-
        estimation [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-190(6)(b)].  The
        application of these methods is demonstrated in Example 4.7.


   611. It is arguable that in accordance with paragraph 230-190(6)(b) -
        under which the fresh allocation can be made on the basis that the
        rate of return is adjusted while the amount to which that rate is
        to be applied is maintained - there is an implication that the
        amount cannot be changed other than under the alternative basis of
        fresh allocation found in paragraph 230-190(6)(a).  That will not
        be the case.


   612. The amount can be adjusted for reasons other than a fresh
        allocation under paragraph 230-190(6)(a)).  Indeed, this adjustment
        is often an essential element of working out, under section 230-
        135, the compounding accruals gain or loss for a given interval.
        Subsection 230-135(6) in particular clarifies that the amount to
        which the rate of return is applied should have regard to financial
        benefits provided or received during the interval.  Accordingly,
        this amount can change because of, for example, a partial repayment
        of a loan or the non-payment of interest during the interval.


   613. The object of the two methods is to bring the re-estimated gain or
        loss to account on an appropriate basis such that the gain or loss
        is properly accounted for over the whole period over which the gain
        or loss is spread.  Compliance cost issues would arise if the
        taxpayer is required to amend prior year's returns each time a re-
        estimation of an amount is required.  Hence, the object of the
        fresh allocation is to ensure that the remaining part of the re-
        estimated gain or loss is allocated to the remaining intervals
        under the financial arrangement.  That is, the fresh allocation of
        the remaining gain or loss applies from the income year in which
        the taxpayer makes the re-estimation until the end of the relevant
        accrual period.  A wash-up of over-accrued or under-accrued amounts
        is achieved by way of a specific balancing adjustment where the
        first method above is used [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-195].
        The balancing adjustment that is made on a re-estimation is to be
        distinguished from the running balancing adjustment, which applies
        during the life of the arrangement as financial benefits which were
        estimated become known (see discussion at paragraphs 4.170 to
        4.173).  Any amounts previously recognised under the running
        balancing adjustment rule in section 230-175 are taken to have been
        allocated to intervals ending before the re-estimation was done.


   614. Taxpayers who prepare audited financial reports in accordance with
        the Australian accounting standards, or comparable standards, may
        apply the methods under paragraph 230-190(6)(a) or (6)(b), so long
        as the taxpayer continually and consistently applies the methods in
        accordance with the accounting standards.  Taxpayers who do not
        prepare audited financial reports in accordance with the Australian
        accounting standards, or comparable standards, may only apply
        paragraph 230-190(6)(b).  However, where a taxpayer's application
        of paragraph 230-190(6)(b) - due to the rule for impaired financial
        arrangements in subsection 230-190(9) - is in conflict with the
        requirements of the accounting standards, this does not cause the
        taxpayer to fail to satisfy the requirements of subsection 230-
        190(7).  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-190(7)]


   615. The same consistency rule is not relevant where there has been a
        partial disposal of a financial arrangement by way of a transfer of
        one or more rights and/or obligations under the arrangement to
        another person.  In such situations, the taxpayer is required to re-
        allocate the remaining part of the recalculated gain or loss (that
        has not already been allocated to intervals occurring before the
        time of re-estimation) over the remaining part of the accrual
        period by maintaining the relevant rate of return and adjusting the
        amount to which that rate is applied.  The adjusted amount is equal
        to the present value of the estimated future cash flows discounted
        at the maintained rate of return.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
        230-200(3)]


   616. If there is an impairment (within the meaning of the accounting
        standards) of the financial arrangement or financial asset or
        financial liability that forms part of the financial arrangement, a
        re-estimation is required to be made in accordance with paragraph
        230-190(6)(b) [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-190(8) and (9)].
         A loss that arises because of the impairment is not deductible for
        that income year nor able to be accrued in a later interval
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-190(10)].


         Balancing adjustment if the rate of return maintained


   617. Where a taxpayer has chosen to make a fresh allocation of the re-
        estimated gain or loss by maintaining the original rate of return
        and adjusting the amount to which the rate of return is applied,
        other than in the case of a partial disposal, an amount is brought
        to account in the income year in which the re-estimation is made
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-195(1)].  The adjustment is
        intended to capture the amount of the difference between the amount
        of the re-estimated gain or loss which should have been brought to
        account up until the time of re-estimation and the amount of the
        previously estimated gain or loss which had been brought to
        account.  A similar adjustment is made under the accounting
        standard AASB 139, where a financial instrument is subject to the
        effective interest rate method (eg, see paragraph AG 8 of AASB
        139).


   618. On applying the balancing adjustment provisions, a gain will arise
        in the income year in which the re-estimation is made if:


                . the re-estimated amount is a gain and the amount to which
                  the maintained rate of return is applied increases in
                  value as a result of the re-estimation.  The amount of the
                  gain is equal to that increase [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-195(1)(a)]; or


                . the re-estimated amount is a loss and the amount to which
                  the maintained rate of return is applied decreases in
                  value as a result of the re-estimation.  The amount of the
                  gain is equal to that decrease [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-195(1)(d)].


   619. On applying the balancing adjustment provisions, a loss will arise
        in the income year in which the re-estimation is made if:


                . the re-estimated amount is a gain and the amount to which
                  the maintained rate of return is applied decreases in
                  value as a result of the re-estimation.  The amount of the
                  loss is equal to that decrease [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-195(1)(b)]; or


                . the re-estimated amount is a loss and the amount to which
                  the maintained rate of return is applied increases in
                  value as a result of the re-estimation.  The amount of the
                  loss is equal to that increase [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-195(1)(c)].


   620. The gain or loss that is made on applying the balancing adjustment
        provision in subsection 230-195(1) is brought to account as
        assessable income or an allowable deduction (provided the loss
        requirements of section 230-15 are satisfied) in the income year in
        which the re-estimation is made.


   621. Where there has been a partial disposal of some of the rights
        and/or obligations under the arrangement, no balancing adjustment,
        other than that under Subdivision 230-G, is available for the
        reasons provided in paragraph 4.182.


      1. :  Application of the re-estimation provisions:  income security
         with non-periodic cash flows


                FLD Finance Co buys a four-year security for $1,000 at the
                beginning of the income year (year 1).  FLD Finance Co has
                an annual turnover of $40 million and has not made any
                elections under Division 230.


                Under the security, FLD Finance Co is entitled to fixed cash
                flows at the end of years 1, 2, 3 and 4 as outlined in Table
                4.2.  FLD Finance Co is also entitled to additional
                contingent amounts payable at the end of each of these
                years; the contingency does not relate to credit risk.
                Assume that the contingent amounts are sufficiently certain
                (because despite the contingency, it is reasonable to expect
                that the financial benefits will be received) and that, as a
                result, the following amounts will be added to the fixed
                payments at the ends of years 1, 2, 3 and 4:  $20, $30, $60
                and $100.  A summary of expected cash flows from the
                arrangement are outlined in Table 4.2.


      1. :  Summary of cash flows

|Year      |Fixed cash  |Estimated   |Total cash |
|          |flows       |cash flows  |flow for   |
|          |            |            |the year   |
|0         |-$1,000.00  |$0.00       |-$1,000.00 |
|1         |$20.00      |$20.00      |$40.00     |
|2         |$20.00      |$30.00      |$50.00     |
|3         |$20.00      |$60.00      |$80.00     |
|4         |$1,000.00   |$100.00     |$1,100.00  |


                This will mean that FLD Finance Co will have an overall gain
                of $270 from the arrangement that must be accrued over the
                life of the arrangement.


                Based on the estimated values of the financial benefits, the
                internal rate of return of the security is 6.58 per cent per
                annum[1].


                Assume that in income years 1 and 2, FLD Finance Co receives
                the amounts that it estimated it would receive.  However, at
                the beginning of income year 3, FLD Finance Co determines
                that the contingent amounts in that year and income year 4
                will be fixed at $40 and $70 respectively because the
                contingency that relates to that part of those payments has
                been resolved.  Hence, for those years, the entire amount of
                the fixed cash flows will instead be $60 and $70
                respectively.


                This is a situation in which there would be a requirement to
                re-estimate the amount of gain that FLD Finance Co will make
                under the arrangement because the previously estimated cash
                flows have become known (paragraph 230-190(3)(b)).


                If there was no re-estimation during the term of the
                security, the tax calculations would have been as shown in
                Table 4.3.


      2. :  The amounts that would have been accrued if there was no re-
         estimation

|Year   |Amortised |Gain   |Cash     |Amortised   |
|       |cost (year|       |flows    |cost (year  |
|       |start)    |       |         |end)        |
|       |(a)       |(b)    |(c)      |(a)  +  (b) |
|       |          |       |         |-  (c)      |
|0      |$0.00     |$0.00  |-$1,000.0|$1,000.00   |
|       |          |       |0        |            |
|1      |$1,000.00 |$65.83 |$40.00   |$1,025.83   |
|2      |$1,025.83 |$67.53 |$50.00   |$1,043.36   |
|3      |$1,043.37 |$68.69 |$80.00   |$1,032.06   |
|4      |$1,032.06 |$67.94 |$1,100.00|$0.00       |


                Application of the re-estimation provisions


                Making a re-estimation in such circumstances involves:


              . a fresh determination of the amount of the gain
                (subsection 230-190(5)); and


              . a reapplication of the accruals method to the re-determined
                gain to make a fresh allocation of that re-determined gain.
                The reallocation of the re-determined gain applies only to
                that part of the gain that has not already been allocated to
                intervals ending before the re-estimation is made
                (subsection 230-190(5)).


                FLD Finance Co chooses to apply the first method -
                maintaining the original rate of return and adjusting the
                amount to which that rate is to be applied (paragraph 230-
                190(6)(a)).


                Making a fresh determination of the amount of the gain


                The fresh determination of the gain would be calculated with
                reference to the revised values of the financial benefits
                under the financial arrangement.  That amount would be:

                 -$1,000 principal paid at the start of the arrangement;
                 plus
                 $220 representing the value of cash flows over the period
                 of the arrangement;
                 plus
                 $1,000 return of the principal at the end of the
                 arrangement.

                The re-determined gain would therefore be $220.


                FLD Finance Co must reapply the accruals method to the gain
                or loss to make a fresh allocation of that part of the re-
                determined gain that has not already been allocated to
                intervals ending before the re-estimation is made.  An
                amount of $133.36 has already been brought to account in
                intervals ending before the re-estimation is made.  Hence
                the remaining amount of the re-determined gain is $86.64
                (ie, $220 less $133.36).


                FLD Finance Co makes that fresh allocation by maintaining
                the rate of return being used and adjusting the amount to
                which the rate of return is applied.  The adjusted amount
                comprises the present value of the estimated future cash
                flows, discounted at the maintained rate of return (ie, 6.58
                per cent per annum).  This results in an adjusted tax cost
                of $998.19.


                Assuming that there are no further re-estimations, and that
                FLD Finance Co receives the revised cash flows, the tax
                calculations for income years 3 and 4 would - based on
                applying the originally determined rate of return to the
                adjusted (amortised cost) amount - be as follows.


      3. :  Amounts to be accrued using the method in paragraph 230-
         190(6)(a)

|Year   |Amortised |Gain   |Cash     |Amortised   |
|       |cost (year|       |flows    |cost (year  |
|       |start)    |       |         |end)        |
|       |(a)       |(b)    |(c)      |(a)  +  (b) |
|       |          |       |         |-  (c)      |
|3      |$998.19   |$65.71 |$60.00   |$1,003.90   |
|4      |$1,003.91 |$66.09 |$1,070.00|$0.00       |


                Under this method, FLD Finance Co is also required to make a
                balancing adjustment at the time of the re-estimation
                (subsection 230-195(1)).  The amount of the balancing
                adjustment is equal to the difference between the amount
                which FLD Finance Co applied to the maintained rate of
                return, and the adjusted amount to which the maintained rate
                of return is to be applied.  The amount to which FLD Finance
                Co would have, instead, applied the original rate of return
                is $1,043.36.  The balancing adjustment that is to be
                applied in these circumstances will bring to account the
                difference between that amount and the adjusted tax cost of
                $998.19.  That difference, $45.18, is a loss that would be
                recognised in income year 3 - the income year in which the
                re-estimation is made (paragraph 230-195(1)(b)).


                Calculation required where method under paragraph 230-
                195(5)(b) is applied


                If, instead, FLD Finance Co had chosen to apply the second
                method of adjusting the rate of return and maintaining the
                amount to which that rate is to be applied, the following
                calculation would be done.  Firstly, the relevant gain or
                loss must be re-estimated.  This calculation would be no
                different from the method under paragraph 230-190(5)(a).
                Hence, the re-estimated gain will be $220.


                FLD Finance Co must reapply the accruals method to the gain
                or loss to make a fresh allocation of that part of the re-
                determined gain that has not already been allocated to
                intervals ending before the re-estimation is made.  Hence
                the remaining amount of the re-determined gain is $86.64.


                FLD Finance Co makes that fresh allocation by adjusting the
                rate of return and maintaining the amount to which the
                recalculated rate of return is applied.  FLD Finance Co does
                this by calculating a new internal rate of return, based on
                the amortised cost of $1,043.37, and the expected future
                cash flows of $60 in year 3 and $1,070 in year 4.
                The adjusted rate of return for these future cash flows will
                be 4.18 per cent[2].


                Assuming that there are no further re-estimations and that
                FLD Finance Co receives the revised cash flows, the tax
                calculations for income years 3 and 4 would, under the
                method in paragraph 230-190(6)(b), be:


      4. :  Amounts to be accrued using method in paragraph 230-190(6)(b)

|Year    |Amortised   |Gain   |Cash   |Amortised  |
|        |cost (year  |       |flows  |cost (year |
|        |start)      |       |       |end)       |
|        |(a)         |(b)    |(c)    |(a)  +  (b)|
|        |            |       |       |-  (c)     |
|3       |$1,043.37   |$43.65 |$60.00 |$1,027.02  |
|4       |$1,027.02   |$42.98 |$1,070 |$0.00      |


                The amount that is brought to account under this method over
                the remaining two years is equal to the amount of the
                remaining part of the re-determined gain - that is, a gain
                of $86.63.


         Limit on balancing adjustment amount where the re-estimation is
         triggered by a bad debt write-off

   622. The accruals method applies to gains or losses which are calculated
        on a net basis.  If a debt or part of the debt (which is a
        financial arrangement) goes bad, difficulties arise as to how to
        identify the effect that the financial benefits, which have become
        bad should have, in respect of the amount of the estimated gain
        which should now be accrued.  This is because the effect of some of
        the financial benefits going bad is that the overall or particular
        gain which was previously sufficiently certain would have been a
        lesser amount, had it been known at that time that the relevant
        financial benefits were going to go bad - hence, the value which
        should have been allocated to each of the intervals, in the entire
        accrual period, would have been a different amount.
   623. The policy intent of this provision is to provide a deduction, by
        way of a balancing adjustment, which is limited to an amount that
        is referable to that part of the gain or loss which was previously
        bought to account in respect of the financial arrangement and which
        is reasonably attributable to the right, or part of the right, to
        the financial benefit that has been written off as bad.  It is not
        intended that the balancing adjustment under section 230-195 apply
        to effectively allow a deduction for doubtful debts, or of an
        amount of capital (eg, the principal investment provided under the
        debt).  This policy intent is also reflected in the specific
        exclusion from the re-estimation provisions, where the re-
        estimation is triggered by an impairment of the financial
        arrangement (within the meaning of that term in the Australian
        accounting standards).  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
        190(8)(b)]
   624. A 'bad debt' for the purposes of Division 230 is intended to be the
        same concept as that encompassed in section 25-35 of the ITAA 1997.
         Where the re-estimation is triggered by a bad debt write-off, the
        amount of the balancing adjustment deduction, which would have
        otherwise been calculated under subsection 230-190(5), is instead
        limited to the amount of the gain that has already been assessed
        under Division 230, to the extent that the gain was reasonably
        attributable to the financial benefit which was written off as bad
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-195(3)].  The limit to the
        deduction allowed under subsection 230-195(1) applies where:
                . the taxpayer has written off, as a bad debt, a right to
                  receive a financial benefit or part of a financial
                  benefit.  Generally, provided a bona fide commercial
                  decision is taken by a taxpayer as to the likelihood of
                  the non-recovery of a debt, it will be accepted that the
                  debt is bad for these purposes (see Taxation Ruling TR
                  92/18 for guidelines); and
                . the right is not one of the following:
                  - a right in respect of money which the taxpayer lent in
                    the ordinary course of their business of lending money
                    (note that the term 'business' is defined in
                    subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997); or
                  - a right which is one that the taxpayer bought in the
                    ordinary course of their business of lending money.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-195(2)]

   625. In situations where the taxpayer has lent money in the course of
        their business of lending money, the full amount of the adjustment
        under subsection 230-195(1) is available.  Further, if the taxpayer
        has bought a right to receive a financial benefit in the ordinary
        course of their business of lending money (ie, the taxpayer bought
        a debt) the intention is to provide a deduction, limited to the
        cost of acquiring the right [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
        195(5)].  This reflects the policy in section 25-35 of the ITAA
        1997, which is intended to be replicated for the purposes of
        Subdivision 230-B.  Further, an exception to the anti-overlap rule
        in section 230-25 is specifically included - to allow a deduction
        for a bad debt write-off where the amount of a financial benefit
        was included in a taxpayer's assessable income under a provision
        outside of Division 230 (see Chapter 3 for further discussion).


   626. There are special rules contained in subsection 25-35(5) of the
        ITAA 1997 which affect a taxpayer's entitlement to a bad debt
        deduction under section 25-35 or which may result in deductions
        under that section being reversed.  It is intended that the same
        adjustments apply to bad debt deductions which are allowable under
        Division 230, as opposed to section 25-35.  The fact that the
        deduction for the bad debt is recognised under section 230-15,
        rather than section 25-35, should not result in such adjustments
        being ignored for the purposes of the ITAA 1997.  This is achieved
        by requiring that the deduction allowable under Division 230, in
        respect of the balancing adjustment, be treated as a deduction of a
        bad debt for the purposes of the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997.
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-195(6)]


When to use the realisation method


   627. The realisation tax-timing treatment applies to financial
        arrangements which are not the subject of the elective fair value
        method or where:


                . the taxpayer has elected to rely on their financial
                  accounts under Subdivision 230-F; or


                . the financial arrangement is an equity interest for the
                  purposes of Division 974 of the ITAA 1997.


   628. The realisation method may have residual application in relation to
        a financial arrangement, to the extent to which the following
        methods do not apply to that financial arrangement:


                . the compounding accruals method;


                . the elective fair value method;


                . the elective retranslation method - in respect of foreign
                  currency gains and losses;


                . the elective financial reports method; and


                . the elective hedging regime.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-40(4)]


   629. Generally, the realisation method will apply to those financial
        benefits where it is not sufficiently certain that they will occur
        because, for example, they are the subject of a contingency, or
        where the value or amount of the financial benefit is not fixed or
        determinable with reasonable accuracy.  A discussion as to whether
        a financial benefit will be sufficiently certain is contained in
        paragraphs 4.97 to 4.125.


   630. For example, the realisation method may apply to vanilla option and
        forward contracts that are entered into at market rates.  Under
        such arrangements it would be improbable to conclude that the
        financial benefits are sufficiently certain so as to give rise to a
        sufficiently certain gain or loss from the derivative.  This
        assumes that there are no payments fixed in advance for more than
        the normal settlement period for such contracts (approximately
        three days).


   631. The realisation method can be distinguished from the balancing
        adjustment provisions in Subdivision 230-G.  Under Subdivision 230-
        G a gain or loss is recognised only where the taxpayer either
        transfers some or all of the rights and obligations under the
        arrangement to another person, or all of the rights or obligations
        under the arrangement otherwise cease [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-435(1)].  In contrast, the realisation method
        applies where a financial benefit under a financial arrangement
        which is not sufficiently certain is paid, or received, or the time
        comes for it to be paid or received.  Although the payment or
        receipt of a financial benefit will result in the right or
        obligation to that financial benefit ceasing, other rights and/or
        obligations to financial benefits under the arrangement may still
        be held by the taxpayer.


         Realisation treatment and hybrid financial arrangements


   632. Generally, for the purposes of Division 230, hybrid financial
        arrangements will be assessed on a stand-alone (whole of hybrid)
        basis.  However, hybrid financial arrangements that are bifurcated
        by taxpayers applying the relevant accounting standards, where part
        of that hybrid is subject to a fair value tax-timing election, will
        also be bifurcated for tax purposes [Schedule 1, item 1, section
        230-235].  Further discussion in relation to this bifurcation rule
        is contained in Chapter 6.


   633. Therefore, gains or losses that are made under a hybrid financial
        arrangement which do not become sufficiently certain before they
        are due to be paid or received would be subject to the realisation
        method if none of the other elective methods apply.


   634. It should be noted that a hybrid financing arrangement which is an
        'equity interest' under Division 974 of the ITAA 1997 is excluded
        from the realisation method applied under Division 230.  [Schedule
        1, item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(e)]


How is a gain or loss calculated under the realisation method


   635. As was explained in Chapter 3, a gain or loss for the purposes of
        Division 230 is a net concept.  For the purposes of the realisation
        method, the gain or loss is calculated as the difference between
        the value of financial benefits received or that are to be received
        (the proceeds), and the financial benefits provided or which are to
        be provided which are attributable to those proceeds (the cost of
        the financial benefit).  Details, as to the application of the
        attribution rules in calculating a gain or loss, are contained in
        Chapter 3.  Further, if those financial benefits are denominated in
        a foreign currency, each element of the calculation (ie, each
        financial benefit that is integral to calculating the relevant gain
        or loss) is to be translated into the taxpayer's applicable
        functional currency - and then the gain or loss for realisation
        purposes is to be calculated.  The provisions in Subdivision 960-C
        of the ITAA 1997 will apply to determine the exchange rate at which
        to translate the relevant financial benefits.


When to recognise a gain or loss under the realisation method


   636. Where the realisation method applies to a gain or loss, that gain
        or loss is brought to account for tax purposes in the income year
        in which the gain or loss occurs [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-
        180].  For the purposes of applying the realisation method, a gain
        or loss 'occurs' at the time the last of the financial benefits
        which are to be taken into account in calculating a gain or loss
        from the arrangement:


                . are provided [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  180(2)(a)]; or


                . are due to be provided, if the financial benefit was not
                  provided at that time and it is reasonable to expect that
                  the financial benefit will be provided [Schedule 1, item
                  1, paragraph 230-180(2)(b)].  Similar considerations in
                  respect of the test in section 230-115, in respect of
                  whether a financial benefit is sufficiently certain are
                  relevant here.  In particular, whether it would be
                  reasonable to expect that the financial benefit will
                  actually be provided is determined on an objective basis.




   637. The time at which the last of the financial benefits is to be
        provided is based on an objective analysis of the timing of the
        rights and obligations under the financial arrangement, rather than
        an analysis from the point of view of a particular party to the
        arrangement.  This means that the time at which the last financial
        benefit is to be provided - regardless of which party to the
        arrangement is under an obligation to provide that benefit - is
        taken to be the time at which that gain or loss occurs.  This will
        ensure that the timing of the recognition of the gains by one party
        to the arrangement will correspond accordingly with the loss that
        will be made by the counterparty to the arrangement.


   638. Further, the rules in relation to the apportionment of financial
        benefits in sections 230-70 and 230-75 are relevant to determining
        whether a gain or loss occurs for realisation purposes.  In this
        sense, there could be several gains or losses that are made from a
        single financial arrangement - which could arise from a number of
        different payments or receipts made under the arrangement.  Such
        gains or losses might each separately represent a gain or loss
        which is subject to the realisation method.


         Deductions for bad debts


   639. The time at which a financial benefit is due to be provided may
        arise before that benefit is actually provided.  The realisation
        rule requires recognition for tax purposes of the gain or loss at
        the earlier time - where there is a reasonable expectation that the
        financial benefits will be provided [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
        230-180(3)].  Circumstances may arise where a financial benefit
        that was taken into account in calculating a gain or loss under the
        realisation method is not subsequently provided.  This may be due
        to a change of circumstances which happens after the gain or loss
        is taken to have occurred for Division 230 purposes - such that the
        relevant right to receive the financial benefit is written off as a
        bad debt.  In such cases, where certain requirements are met, the
        taxpayer is taken to have made a loss for Division 230 purposes.


   640. The realisation method principle is contained in subsection 230-
        180(1) - that is, a taxpayer is required to recognise a gain or
        loss under the realisation method, when that gain or loss occurs.
        Where the circumstances required for a deduction for a bad debt
        write-off are satisfied, the loss which arises is taken to occur
        when the taxpayer writes off the right to receive a financial
        benefit as a bad debt [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-180(6)].
        This is a separate and distinct rule as to the time a loss occurs
        for realisation purposes, when compared to the primary test
        contained in subsection 230-180(2).


   641. In order for such a loss to be recognised, the loss must be made
        from the writing off a right to receive a financial benefit as a
        bad debt:


                . where that benefit was taken into account in working out
                  the amount of a gain that was worked out under the
                  realisation method and has been included in the taxpayer's
                  assessable income under Division 230 [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-180(3)(a)].  The amount of the loss is equal
                  to so much of the gain which was attributable to the right
                  to the financial benefit which was written off as bad
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-180(5)(a)]; or


                . where the right is in respect of money lent in the
                  ordinary course of the taxpayer's business of lending
                  money [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-180(3)(b)].  The
                  amount of the loss is equal to the amount of the financial
                  benefit in respect of which the relevant right was written
                  off as bad [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-180(5)(b)];
                  or


                . where the right is one that the taxpayer bought in the
                  ordinary course of their business of lending money
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-180(3)(c)].  The amount
                  of the loss is equal to the cost, to the taxpayer, of the
                  right to the financial benefit [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-180(5)(c)].


   642. As was stated in paragraph 4.206, it is intended that the same
        adjustments, which are contained in subsection 25-35(5) of the
        ITAA 1997 apply to bad debt deductions as are allowable under
        Division 230 (rather than under section 25-35).  This is achieved
        by requiring that the deduction allowable under Division 230, in
        respect of the balancing adjustment, be treated as a deduction of a
        bad debt for the purposes of the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997
        [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-180(6)].  Further, an exception
        to the anti-overlap rule in section 230-25 is specifically included
        - to allow a deduction for a bad debt write-off where the amount of
        a financial benefit was included in the taxpayer's assessable
        income, under a provision outside of Division 230 (see Chapter 3
        for further discussion).


Reassessment of whether to apply an accruals or realisation method


   643. A gain or loss under a financial arrangement which is not subject
        to any of the elective methods under Division 230, must be assessed
        when the taxpayer starts to have the arrangement - to determine
        whether the gains or losses should be brought to account using the
        accruals or realisation method.  After that point, the taxpayer is
        only required to reassess whether the accruals or realisation
        method is appropriately applied to a gain or loss where there is a
        material change in the terms and conditions of the arrangement, or
        the circumstances affecting the arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
        subsection 230-185(1)]


         What constitutes a material change that triggers a reassessment?


   644. Whether a change is a material change depends on the facts and
        circumstances of the relevant arrangement.  A change to the
        circumstances external to the terms and conditions of the
        arrangement, but which nonetheless affect the gains or losses that
        arise under the arrangement, may trigger a reassessment.  Also, not
        every change to the terms and conditions, or the circumstances
        affecting the financial arrangement, will be of a material nature.
        The legislation specifically states a number of changes which are
        considered to be material changes and which trigger a reassessment.
         This is not an exclusive list, and other changes may constitute a
        relevant, material change sufficient to trigger a reassessment
        under section 230-185.


         However, a mere change in the fair value of the financial benefits
         under the financial arrangement will not, of itself, be considered
         to be a material change sufficient to require a reassessment.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-185(3)]


         Change to the terms or conditions that alters the essential nature
         of an interest


   645. A material change to the terms and conditions of the financial
        arrangement in a way which alters the essential nature of the
        arrangement will trigger a reassessment.  One example is where a
        debt interest becomes an equity interest for the purposes of
        Division 974 of the ITAA 1997 [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
        185(2)(a)].  The test for reassessment under section 230-185 is
        slightly different from the material change test under the debt and
        equity provisions in Division 974 - in particular the provisions in
        section 974-110 of the ITAA 1997.  Under section 974-110, the
        issuer of an interest is required to re-test the instrument every
        time there is a change to an existing scheme, to ensure it is not a
        material change that changes its classification under Division 974
        from debt to equity or vice versa.  In contrast, a material change
        under section 230-185 is one which has, in fact, affected the
        classification of an instrument and triggers a reassessment.


         Change to the terms and conditions that materially affects the
         contingencies in respect of significant rights or obligations


   646. A material change requiring reassessment would be a change to the
        terms and conditions of the arrangement in a way which materially
        affects the contingencies on which significant obligations, or
        rights, under the arrangement are dependent [Schedule 1, item 1,
        paragraph 230-185(2)(b)].  The relevant obligations or rights which
        are affected must be significant, in the context of the financial
        arrangement.


   647. The compounding accruals method only applies to gains or losses
        that are sufficiently certain.  A contingency may affect whether a
        financial benefit, in respect of which certain rights or
        obligations relate, is sufficiently certain.  If a contingency in
        relation to such a right or obligation is removed, or is resolved,
        then an amount of a gain or loss which was not previously
        sufficiently certain, and as a result subject to the realisation
        method, may become sufficiently certain, such that it would be more
        appropriate to apply the compounding accruals method.


   648. Likewise, if a financial benefit was taken into account in working
        out a sufficiently certain gain or loss, but the right or
        obligation to which it relates is made subject to a contingency,
        then that gain or loss may no longer be sufficiently certain and
        should be subject to the realisation provisions.


   649. A change in relation to a contingency may trigger a reassessment
        but the conclusion may be that the compounding accruals method
        should still apply to the relevant gain or loss.  However, the
        effect of the change in the contingency may be that the amount of
        the gain or loss will need to be re-estimated.  [Schedule 1, item
        1, paragraph 230-190(3)(d)]


         A change in circumstances that materially affects the contingencies
         in respect of significant rights or obligations


   650. A change that materially affects a pre-existing contingency
        does not necessarily have to be affected by a change to the terms
        and conditions of an arrangement.  A pre-existing contingency
        affecting significant rights or obligations under the arrangement
        may be removed by circumstances surrounding the financial
        arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-185(2)(c)].  An
        example of this may be that a number of contingencies may apply to
        a significant obligation, or right, and the obligation or right
        becomes no longer subject to the contingencies - or becomes
        effectively non-contingent - when only one of the contingencies is
        satisfied.


         A change to the terms on which credit is provided to a third party


   651. A reassessment is required where there is a change to the terms on
        which credit is to be provided to, or a change to the credit rating
        of, a person that is not a party to the arrangement, where
        significant obligations or rights under the arrangement depend on
        that other person's credit profile.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph
        230-185(2)(d)]


   652. In one sense, if the significant right or obligation is dependent
        on the other person's ability to obtain credit, or maintain a
        rating, a change to either of those circumstances will introduce
        contingencies which will affect whether the relevant financial
        benefits to which the significant rights and obligations relate
        will be sufficiently certain.


         A change to the terms or conditions or circumstances that are
         sufficient to treat a financial arrangement, or a part of the
         arrangement that is a financial asset or financial liability as
         impaired


   653. A reassessment is required if the financial arrangement is, or
        includes, a financial asset or financial liability and the taxpayer
        prepares financial reports in accordance with the Australian
        accounting standards, or comparable standards and there is a change
        to the terms and conditions or the circumstances affecting the
        financial arrangement - such that it would be treated as impaired
        for the purposes of those standards [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph
        230-185(2)(e)].  The outcome of the reassessment can result in
        either the accrual method no longer applying to the financial
        arrangement and instead the realisation method applying from the
        time of reassessment, or the impairment requiring a re-estimation
        of the gain from the financial arrangement.  However, a taxpayer
        cannot deduct a loss because of impairment when it occurs nor
        accrue a deduction for the loss in a later interval [Schedule 1,
        item 1, subsections 230-190(8) to (10)].


   654. This particular trigger for a reassessment will not apply to
        individuals or entities which satisfy the threshold test in section
        230-455.  It may apply to entities satisfying that threshold test
        which have made an election to have Division 230 apply to them, and
        who prepare financial reports in accordance with the Australian
        accounting standards.


   655. 'Impairment' for accounting purposes relates to financial assets
        where the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its estimated
        recoverable amount (see paragraphs 58 to 70 of the AASB 139).
        Objective evidence of impairment is required under AASB 139 before
        a financial asset is considered to be impaired.


   656. For tax purposes, under the current law, Taxation Ruling TR 94/32
        (Income Tax:  non-accrual loans) specifies what would constitute a
        non-accrual loan for tax purposes.  In particular, the taxation
        ruling refers to indicators which would provide support for a bona
        fide assessment based on sound commercial considerations, that
        interest which was previously accrued is not likely to be received
        (in particular refer to paragraph 47 of the TR 94/32).  Such
        indicators may be relevant in determining if impairment of a loan
        has occurred, for the purposes of the accounting standards.


   657. The effect of impairment for the purposes of the reassessment
        provisions would be that the future gains (represented by interest
        payments on the loan) would no longer be accrued but instead would
        be brought to account under the realisation method.



Chapter 5
Elective Subdivisions:  common requirements

Outline of chapter


    658. This chapter explains:


                . the requirements that are common to the elective tax-
                  timing elections and which need to be met for any of the
                  elective Subdivisions to apply:  these are referred to as
                  'common requirements';


                . how the elective Subdivisions apply to relevant financial
                  arrangements;


                . the circumstances under which an election under an
                  elective Subdivision will cease to apply and the
                  consequences of cessation in respect of gains or losses
                  made from the financial arrangements that were subject to
                  an elective methodology; and


                . the consequences of making a new election where an
                  election has ceased.


    659. The elections which are the subject of this chapter are those
         provided by Subdivisions 230-C (fair value election), 230-D
         (general foreign exchange retranslation election only), 230-E
         (hedging financial arrangement election) and 230-F (election to
         rely on financial reports).  In this chapter, these Subdivisions
         are referred to as the 'elective Subdivisions'.


Overview of common elective requirements


    660. There are four main elective tax timing methods under Division 230,
         namely:


                . the fair value method (Subdivision 230-C);


                . the foreign exchange retranslation method (Subdivision 230-
                  D);


                . the hedging financial arrangements method (Subdivision 230-
                  E); and


                . the reliance on financial reports method (Subdivision 230-
                  F).


    661. This chapter looks at the common features of each of the elective
         tax-timing methods including common requirements for making an
         election and outcomes.  In particular, it discusses the
         requirements that taxpayers must prepare audited financial reports
         before being able to elect to apply the elective Subdivisions.


    662. The chapter also discusses the practical implications of having to
         satisfy these requirements, such as who is to prepare the audited
         financial reports and the impact of not being required to prepare a
         financial report because of a Class Order.


Context of amendments


    663. The framework of Division 230 incorporates a number of elective
         Subdivisions which provide for different tax treatments (fair
         value, retranslation, hedging, and the financial reports method).
         Taxpayers are able to select among these elective regimes in order
         to obtain the tax treatment that best suits their commercial
         circumstances and the functions of the financial arrangements they
         hold or issue.


Summary of new law


    664. In order to rely on any of the elective Subdivisions, taxpayers
         must have prepared financial reports in accordance with relevant
         accounting standards and these reports must be audited in
         accordance with relevant auditing standards.  Taxpayers must
         continue to satisfy these requirements for these elections to
         continue to apply.


    665. Once an election has been made, the elective Subdivisions allow the
         gains and losses on relevant financial arrangements to be
         determined, in appropriate circumstances, in accordance with
         relevant accounting standards.  That is, in these circumstances
         taxpayers can effectively rely on amounts in their financial
         reports to determine gains and losses for tax purposes for relevant
         financial arrangements.


    666. Where the elective requirements cease to be satisfied, relevant
         financial arrangements will be deemed to have been disposed of and
         reacquired, and the election will cease to apply.  Taxpayers may
         make new elections where the requirements are once more satisfied.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|In order for taxpayers  |There is no basis under |
|to access the treatments|the current law for     |
|provided for in the     |electing to use         |
|elective Subdivisions,  |accounting standards    |
|they must meet          |concepts, methods and   |
|requirements common to  |valuations (as          |
|all the elective        |appropriate) to         |
|Subdivisions.  These    |calculate gains and     |
|requirements are that   |losses for tax purposes |
|financial reports be    |and, as a result, no    |
|prepared in accordance  |comparable common       |
|with relevant accounting|elective requirements.  |
|standards and           |                        |
|appropriately audited.  |                        |


Detailed explanation of new law


The elective Subdivisions


    667. There are four elective Subdivisions under which taxpayers may
         elect to apply a tax-timing method to relevant financial
         arrangements, subject to their meeting relevant requirements.
         These elective Subdivisions allow a taxpayer to bring gains and
         losses from their financial arrangements to account using the:


                . fair value method (Subdivision 230-C);


                . retranslation method (Subdivision 230-D) - (this chapter
                  discusses the general foreign exchange retranslation
                  election only);


                . method that is consistent with the tax treatment of the
                  hedged item (Subdivision 230-E); or


                . method which relies on the relevant accounting standards
                  more broadly (Subdivision 230-F).


    668. The operation of the elective Subdivisions will assist in reducing
         taxpayers' compliance costs as the elective treatments will, in
         effect, allow taxpayers to rely on their financial reports to
         determine the amount of the gain or loss from relevant financial
         arrangements that is, for income tax purposes, attributable to a
         particular income year.


    669. The common requirements and the outcomes under the elective
         Subdivisions are discussed within this chapter to avoid duplication
         in each relevant chapter.  Further details that are specific to
         each election are then discussed in Chapters 6 to 9.


Common requirements for making an election


         Accounting and auditing requirements


    670. In order for a taxpayer to make an election under one of the
         elective Subdivisions, they must have financial reports that are:


                . prepared in accordance with relevant accounting standards;
                  and


                . audited in accordance with relevant auditing standards.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-210(2), 230-255(2), 230-315(2)
         and 230-395(2)]


    671. In certain circumstances a taxpayer will be taken to have prepared
         an audited financial report even though it is in fact prepared by
         someone else.  The relevant circumstances that must be satisfied
         before this can occur are:


                . a connected entity of the taxpayer has prepared an audited
                  financial report;


                . the report of the connected entity is a consolidated
                  financial report that deals with both the taxpayer's
                  affairs and the affairs of the connected entity; and


                . the report properly reflects the taxpayer's affairs (see
                  discussion below on financial reports of a connected
                  entity).


         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-525]


    672. As listed under the elective Subdivisions the financial reports of
         a taxpayer may, in effect, be relied upon to determine the amount
         of the gains or losses made from a financial arrangement that are
         to be brought to account for income tax purposes.  Accordingly, the
         integrity of those reports is important.  The accounting and
         auditing requirements, which the taxpayer must meet to be able to
         make an election under any of the elective Subdivisions, provide a
         level of integrity and certainty in relation to processes and
         methodologies used to calculate the amount of the gains or losses
         from financial arrangements that are to be brought to account for
         tax purposes.  That integrity will work to ensure that
         opportunities for tax avoidance or tax deferral are minimised.


         Financial reports


    673. The term financial report is used in a number of provisions
         throughout Division 230.  This term is not defined and instead
         takes its meaning from ordinary commercial usage.  It would be
         expected that the contents of financial reports will generally be
         governed by the accounting standards applied in the relevant
         jurisdiction together with any relevant statutory requirements.
         For example, the Australian Accounting Standard AASB 101
         Presentation of Financial Statements (AASB 101) prescribes the
         documents which together constitute what will, from 1 July 2009, be
         called financial statements (before recent amendments to this
         standard the term used was financial reports).  The documents that
         constitute the financial statements for the taxpayer under AASB 101
         will therefore satisfy the meaning of the term financial reports
         where it is used in Division 230.  Paragraph 10 of AASB 101 sets
         out the documents that comprise a complete set of financial
         statements:


                . a statement of financial position (currently referred to
                  as a balance sheet);


                . a statement of comprehensive income (currently referred to
                  as a profit or loss statement);


                . a statement of changes in equity;


                . a cash flow statement; and


                . notes, comprising a summary of significant accounting
                  policies and other explanatory notes.


    674. The Corporations Act 2001 also has a definition in section 295 of
         financial reports which essentially mirrors the requirements of the
         accounting standards, but which also has certain additional
         requirements including a declaration of directors.  Compliance with
         that section would similarly meet the ordinary meaning of financial
         report, but it would not be necessary that the additional
         requirements over and above that required under the relevant
         accounting standards be satisfied.


         Prepared in accordance with accounting standards


    675. The requirement in the elective Subdivisions for the preparation of
         financial reports in accordance with accounting standards is a
         fundamental requirement which ensures that the timing and
         measurement of the gains and losses made from relevant financial
         arrangements are reliable and suitable for tax purposes.


    676. In the case of financial reports not prepared in accordance with
         the accounting standards, there may not be sufficient integrity
         associated with the preparation of such reports to allow them to be
         relied upon for tax purposes.


    677. In the context of the elective Subdivisions within Division 230,
         three of the most relevant accounting standards are:


                . Australian Accounting Standard AASB 139 Financial
                  Instruments:  Recognition and Measurement - which covers
                  recognition and measurement of financial assets and
                  liabilities;


                . Australian Accounting Standard AASB 121 The Effects of
                  Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates - which covers certain
                  gains and losses attributable to changes in foreign
                  exchange rates; and


                . Australian Accounting Standard AASB 127 Consolidated and
                  Separate Financial Statements (AASB 127) - which covers
                  the preparation and presentation of consolidated financial
                  statements for a group of entities under the control of a
                  parent.


    678. While these are the most relevant accounting standards for the
         methodologies contained within the elective Subdivisions, other
         Australian accounting standards may also be relevant (such as those
         Australian accounting standards mentioned in Chapter 1).


    679. Where an entity prepares a financial report using comparable
         accounting standards of a foreign jurisdiction, those financial
         reports will satisfy this accounting standards requirement.  (What
         constitutes a comparable standard is explained in paragraphs 5.46
         to 5.48.)


    680. Whether or not a taxpayer's financial reports have been prepared in
         accordance with relevant accounting standards is a question of
         fact.  However, where an entity purports to have prepared a
         financial report in accordance with relevant accounting standards
         and there is an unqualified auditor's report in respect of the
         financial report, the auditor's report will ordinarily be
         indicative of, but not necessarily conclusive of, the fact that the
         financial report has been prepared in accordance with the relevant
         accounting standards.


         Financial reports of a connected entity


    681. A financial report prepared by another entity is treated as though
         it is prepared by the taxpayer where the other entity is a
         connected entity of the taxpayer and the financial report is a
         consolidated financial report that properly reflects the affairs of
         both the taxpayer and the connected entity [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-525].  What is meant by the term 'properly reflects' is
         a question of fact and degree; the term seeks to underline the
         importance of the accounting and auditing requirements being
         substantively met in respect of the particular taxpayer.


    682. It may be possible that a taxpayer's affairs are reflected in more
         than one set of audited financial reports, for example in the
         context of a multiple entry consolidated group (MEC group) there
         could be more than one relevant audited financial report prepared
         for different levels of relevant interposed holding entities.


    683. There may also be circumstances where an entity that prepares a
         financial report (or for whom the report is prepared) may not make
         an election under any of the elective Subdivisions (because, for
         example, it is not an Australian resident taxpayer) while an entity
         it controls (in the corporations law sense) may make an election to
         apply one of the elective Subdivisions.  There is also the
         possibility that a controlled entity (in the corporations law
         sense) may seek to make the election in respect of itself because
         it is a separate taxpayer from the taxpayer that has prepared the
         financial report.


    684. In this regard, any entity that is a controlled entity (in the
         corporations law sense) is eligible to make an election under the
         elective Subdivisions where a financial report properly reflects
         the affairs of the taxpayer making the election, that is, the
         controlled entity.  The availability of this election is on the
         proviso that the audited financial report is a consolidated
         financial report for the reporting group of which the controller
         and the controlled entity are members.


    685. This provision allows an entity to make an election under the
         elective Subdivisions where the entity's financial arrangements are
         dealt with in a set of audited financial reports of an accounting
         consolidated group of which it is not the parent entity.  For
         example, the entity could be the head company of a tax
         consolidated/MEC group or a subsidiary of an accounting
         consolidated group.


         More than one financial report


    686. It is expected that taxpayers who are able to rely on one set of
         financial reports for the purpose of calculating their Division 230
         gains and losses will have significantly reduced compliance costs.
         This will be the ordinary case where the taxpayer's accounting year
         and income year align.


    687. However, in cases where accounting and income years do not align,
         taxpayers will still be able to rely on financial reports to
         calculate their Division 230 gains and losses.  In those
         circumstances it will be possible for taxpayers to rely on more
         than one set of financial reports.  Where this arises, taxpayers
         will need to reasonably and properly allocate gains and losses from
         their financial reports to the income year in which those gains and
         losses are properly referable.


    688. It must be noted, however, that the operation of Division 230, and
         the application of this exception where accounting and income years
         do not align, does not, of itself, provide a rationale for changing
         income years to align with accounting years.


    689. If the taxpayer's accounting and income tax years do not align, it
         will be necessary to determine whether more than one set of audited
         financial reports will satisfy the requirements for making an
         election under the respective elective Subdivisions.


    690. In order to satisfy those requirements, the taxpayer must be able
         to identify and use two or more sets of financial reports, each of
         which:


                . covers at least part of the income year for which the
                  election is being made;


                . is prepared in accordance with relevant accounting
                  standards;


                . is audited in accordance with relevant auditing standards;
                  and


                . is unqualified by the auditor.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-215(1), 230-260(1), 230-320(1)
         and 230-400(1)]


    691. Where a taxpayer can demonstrate that they have multiple audited
         financial reports that cover the relevant income year, they are
         able to treat themselves as eligible to make an election under the
         elective Subdivisions.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-
         215(2), 230-260(2), 230-320(2) and 230-400(2)]


    692. The reports that are relied upon must also cover at least the
         entire income year.  As with financial reports for accounting and
         income years that align, the financial reports of a connected
         entity can, in certain circumstances, be relied on (see above).


    693. Examples of where non-alignment of accounting and income years may
         occur, and the relevant financial reports that may be used include:


                . the accounting year is to 31 December and the income year
                  is to 30 June - the taxpayer may use an audited interim
                  financial report prepared in accordance with Australian
                  Accounting Standard AASB 134 Interim Financial Reporting
                  and an audited full year financial report prepared in
                  accordance with AASB 101; and


                . the accounting year is for 52 weeks - the taxpayer may use
                  the audited full year financial reports prepared in
                  accordance with AASB 101 for two years.


         Reasonably attributing the gain or loss


    694. Where more than one financial report satisfies the requirements for
         making a valid election under the elective Subdivisions for an
         income year (and in fact the election is then made), it will be
         necessary to determine how much of each gain or loss worked out
         under the relevant accounting standards in each of the reporting
         periods for relevant financial arrangements is attributable to the
         income year.  Where multiple financial reports are used, it may be
         the entire gain or loss for a period worked out under the standard
         that is attributable to the relevant income year (eg, where the
         reporting period is for six months), and for other periods (eg,
         where the reporting period is for 12 months) only part of the gain
         or loss will be attributable to the relevant income year.


    695. When undertaking this attribution process it is important to note
         that it will not always be acceptable to simply attribute gains or
         losses for a reporting period on a pro-rated time basis.  This is
         especially so in respect of gains and losses that arise on an
         unsystematic basis.  In addition, it is expected that taxpayers
         will use the same basis for attributing gains and losses in
         relation to one period as they do for other periods that relate to
         an income year.  Further, that basis should be consistent with that
         used under the relevant accounting standards.  For example, it will
         be inappropriate to apply an accruals type calculation to a
         financial arrangement that is being fair valued for accounting
         purposes.


      1. :  Attribution process


                ABC Co has an income tax year that ends on 30 September and
                an accounting year that ends on 30 June.  ABC Co has made a
                valid election under Subdivision 230-C (using more than one
                financial report) and wishes to determine the amount of its
                assessable income and deductions under Division 230 for
                relevant financial arrangements.  The following example
                illustrates how ABC Co should attribute gains and losses on
                a financial arrangement that is subject to an election under
                Subdivision 230-C:


                  Financial arrangement - variable rate bond.


                  1 February 2013 - acquire bond for $1,000,000 (its fair
                  value).


                  Its fair value over time is as follows:


                  30 June 2013[3]       $987,500


                  30 September 2013     $876,900


                  30 December 2013 $870, 000


                  31 March 2014         $913,500


                  30 June 2014          $978,400


                For the accounting period ending 30 June 2013 the change in
                fair value on the bond worked out in accordance with the
                accounting standards is a loss of $12,500 and is wholly
                attributable to the income year ended 30 September 2013.


                For the accounting period ending 30 June 2014 the change in
                fair value on the bond worked out in accordance with the
                accounting standards is a loss of $9,100.  If ABC Co were to
                allocate this loss to the 2013 income year on a pro-rated
                time basis it would allocate the loss as follows:


                  $9,100  ×  273/365  =  $9,100  ×  0.7479  =  $6,806.30


                However, this is an inappropriate attribution because the
                actual change in fair value that occurred during the
                relevant part of the income year, (ie, from 1 July 2013 to
                30 September 2013), is:


                  Value at 1 July 2013  $987,500


                  Value at 30 September 2013  $876,900


                  Change in fair value  ($110,600)


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-215(3) to (5), 230-260(3) to
         (5) and 230-400(3) to (5)]






         Class Orders


    696. Some entities within an accounting consolidated group may not be
         required to prepare financial reports because of, for example, an
         Australian Securities and Investment Commission Class Order.
         However, if a particular financial asset or liability is held by
         such an entity and that financial asset or liability is reflected
         in a set of audited financial reports of another entity within the
         accounting consolidated group - typically the consolidated
         financial reports - then the elective Subdivisions may still be
         able to apply to that financial asset or liability - provided it is
         a financial arrangement which is subject to Division 230.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-220(1)(b), 230-265(1)(b), 230-
         335(1)(c) and 230-410(1)(c)]


         Audited in accordance with auditing standards


    697. It is a requirement of the elective Subdivisions that the financial
         reports of the taxpayer be audited in accordance with the
         Australian auditing standards or comparable foreign standards.
         This audit requirement provides additional integrity in respect of
         the amounts which are in effect relied upon for income tax
         purposes.


    698. Under section 336 of the Corporations Act 2001, an auditing
         standard is defined as a standard that is made by the Auditing
         Standards Board for the purposes of the Corporations Act 2001.  An
         auditor will be required to follow those auditing standards in the
         audit of a financial report.


    699. For the purposes of the Australian Auditing Standards, Auditing
         Standard ASA 700 - The Auditor's Report on a General Purpose
         Financial Report states, in paragraph 39, that:


                'The auditor's report shall state that the audit was
                conducted in accordance with Australian Auditing Standards.'


         Auditing Standard ASA 700 is operative for financial reporting
         periods commencing on or after 1 July 2006.


    700. Where the preparation or audit of the relevant financial report is
         carried out in a foreign jurisdiction, then comparable auditing
         standards will be seen to provide integrity in the same manner as
         the Australian auditing standards.  For further discussion on what
         would be required for an accounting or auditing standard to be
         considered comparable, see paragraphs 5.46 to 5.48.


    701. Not all entities are required by Australian law to have their
         financial reports audited in accordance with the auditing standards
         (or by comparable foreign law and auditing standards made under a
         foreign law).  An entity that falls into this category is not
         precluded from making an election under any of the elective
         Subdivisions provided the financial reports of that entity are in
         fact audited in accordance with the relevant auditing standards.


    702. The auditing requirement in the elective Subdivisions is such that
         either of the following election eligibility conditions must be
         satisfied prior to making an election:


                . the financial reports are audited in accordance with the
                  relevant Australian auditing standards; or


                . the financial reports are audited in accordance with
                  relevant comparable foreign auditing standards.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-210(2)(b), 230-255(2)(b), 230-
         315(2)(b) and 230-395(2)(b)]


         Comparable accounting and auditing standards


    703. In having regard to what is a comparable accounting or auditing
         standard, consideration is to be given to whether the foreign
         accounting or auditing standard, when compared to the Australian
         accounting or auditing standard, results in a particular financial
         asset or liability being:


                . recognised, classified and treated in the same way in the
                  financial reports of the entity;


                . measured in the same way in the financial reports of the
                  entity.  That is, the methods by which the changes in
                  value, or gains and losses are calculated, is the same or
                  is substantially the same; and


                . subject to the same level of scrutiny as required under
                  the Australian auditing standards.


    704. Comparable accounting standards include United States of America
         Financial Accounting Standards and those standards that are
         compliant with International Financial Reporting Standards in the
         broad sense of the term (ie, compliance with the entire body of
         International Accounting Standards Board pronouncements).
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraphs 230-210(2)(a)(ii) and (b)(ii),
         230-255(2)(a)(ii) and (b)(ii), 230-315(2)(a)(ii) and (b)(ii) and
         230-395(2)(a)(ii) and (b)(ii)]


    705. Regulations may be made to specify whether a particular foreign
         accounting or auditing standard is to be treated as comparable with
         the Australian accounting and auditing standards for the purposes
         of Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-500]


    706. As previously mentioned, in addition to the generic requirements
         mentioned in this chapter, there are additional requirements that
         are specific to particular elective Subdivisions which also need to
         be met for the elective Subdivisions to apply.  For discussion on
         these specific requirements for elections, see each of the relevant
         chapters - Chapter 6 (fair value election), Chapter 7 (the foreign
         exchange retranslation election), Chapter 8 (hedging financial
         arrangements election) and Chapter 9 (financial reports election).


         Effect of change of accounting standards


    707. Generally, the elective methods apply by relying on figures that
         are included in the profit or loss statement in the financial
         report.  However, there are circumstances where, as a result of a
         change in the application of an accounting standard, an amount that
         would otherwise be recorded in profit or loss may be taken directly
         to equity.  From a Division 230 perspective this amount may be a
         gain or a loss made from a financial arrangement but for the change
         in accounting standard.  Given this, there is a requirement that
         amounts that go directly to equity, as a result of the change in
         application of an accounting standard, are to be included as
         Division 230 gains or losses in the year of the restatement.


    708. These provisions ensure that taxpayers are not required to amend
         prior year tax returns when such an accounting change is made.
         That is, these amendments are designed to reduce compliance and
         administration costs by providing that the restated amount is a
         gain or loss that is made in the year in which the restatement
         occurs.


         Australian Accounting Standard AASB 108


    709. Where there is a change in either the relevant accounting standard
         or its application, accounting standard Australian Accounting
         Standard AASB 108 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting
         Estimates and Errors (AASB 108) requires that certain restated
         amounts (gain or loss amounts) go directly and permanently to
         equity instead of going through the profit or loss statement.  The
         adjustment amount, reflecting amounts not brought to account in
         previous years (which, based on the changes to the accounting
         standard, would have been brought to account in profit or loss had
         the new approach applied since the inception of the financial
         arrangement), will go directly to equity.  As a result, the amount
         cumulatively returned from an accounting perspective through profit
         or loss will no longer align with the amount returned for tax
         purposes (if the accounting change had not been made).


    710. Paragraph 22 of AASB 108 states that:


                'Subject to paragraph 23, when a change in accounting policy
                is applied retrospectively in accordance with paragraph
                19(a) or (b), the entity shall adjust the opening balance of
                each affected component of equity for the earliest prior
                period presented and the other comparative amounts disclosed
                for each prior period presented as if the new accounting
                policy had always been applied.'


    711. Paragraph 42 states that, subject to paragraph 43, an entity shall
         correct material prior period errors retrospectively in the first
         financial report authorised for issue after their discovery by:


                'restating the comparative amounts for the prior period(s)
                presented in which the error occurred; or...'


    712. Finally, paragraph 46 states that the correction of a prior period
         error is excluded from profit or loss for the period in which the
         error is discovered.


    713. As can be seen from the AASB 108 extracts, the accounting standards
         do not include the restated amount in profit or loss.  In a
         Division 230 context, the restated amount is to be considered as a
         relevant gain or loss notwithstanding that the amount is not
         included in profit or loss.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-495]


Making an election under the elective Subdivisions


         Who may make an election


    714. Generally, entities that are subject to Division 230 may make an
         election under one or more of the elective Subdivisions (see
         Chapter 1 for discussion of the hierarchy of elective treatments).


    715. However, individuals and entities that fall below the relevant
         threshold tests specified in subsections 230-455(2) to (4), are
         generally excluded from the operation of Division 230 (except in
         relation to certain qualifying securities they hold).  For such
         taxpayers an election under one of the elective Subdivisions will
         only have effect if the taxpayer has also made the election under
         subsection 230-455(7) to have Division 230 apply to all of their
         financial arrangements (apart from those excluded in
         Subdivision 230-H).


      1. :  Individual excluded


                Nik is an individual who is in the business of trading
                securities.  As Nik has not made an election under
                subsection 230-455(7) for Division 230 to apply to all of
                his financial arrangements any election(s) Nik may make
                under any of the elective Subdivisions will be invalid (see
                subsections 230-225(2), 230-270(2), 230-330(3) and 230-
                415(2)).


         Elections where a consolidated or MEC group contains a life
         insurance company


    716. In the case of a consolidated group or a MEC group, elections are
         made by the head company of the group.  Generally, an election
         under Division 230 will apply to all the relevant transactions of
         all members of the consolidated group or MEC group.  This is
         discussed in detail in Chapter 12.


    717. However, there is an exception to this where a consolidated group
         or MEC group includes a member that carries on a 'life insurance
         business' (as defined in subsection 995-1(1) of the Income Tax
         Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997).  The member running the life
         insurance business will be a life insurance company that is
         registered under the Life Insurance Act 1995.


    718. A financial arrangement relates to life insurance business carried
         on by a life insurance company that is a member of a consolidated
         group or MEC group if the financial arrangement is held directly or
         indirectly by the life insurance company.  Therefore, a financial
         arrangement that is held by a wholly-owned subsidiary of the life
         insurance company relates to the life insurance business carried on
         by the life insurance company member and therefore is covered by
         the exception.


    719. Consolidated groups and MEC groups may wish to elect to apply one
         of the elective Subdivisions.  However, for consolidated or MEC
         groups which contain, for example, both a financial institution
         member and a life insurance company member, bringing to account
         gains or losses which arise on an unsystematic, unrealised basis
         may provide a competitive disadvantage to the life insurance
         company of the consolidated group or MEC group.  For this reason
         the head company of a consolidated group or MEC group which
         contains a member that carries on a life insurance business may
         elect to:


                . have an election under one of the elective Subdivisions
                  apply to all of their relevant financial arrangements; or


                . specify that an election under one of the elective
                  Subdivisions is to only apply to all of their relevant
                  financial arrangements excluding those related to the life
                  insurance business carried on by a member of the group.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-225(3), 230-270(3), 230-330(4)
         and 230-415(3)]


         Remaking an election - life insurance company as a joining entity

    720. The amendments to subsection 715-660(1) of the ITAA 1997 (discussed
         in Chapter 12) ensure that the elections under Division 230 are
         subject to the operation of Subdivision 715-J of the ITAA 1997.
         Broadly, Subdivision 715-J operates to override the entry history
         rule in relation to certain choices by an entity that joins a
         consolidated group or MEC group (including the absence of a choice)
         and to extend the time for the head company of the group to make a
         new choice.
    721. Therefore, the head company of an existing consolidated or
         MEC group is able to remake its Division 230 election in respect of
         the group if:
                . a life insurance company joins the group;
                . the life insurance company has made an election under
                  Division 230 prior to its entry into the group; and
                . the life insurance company's election is inconsistent with
                  the existing Division 230 election of the head company.
    722. In these circumstances, the head company has until the later of the
         following times to make a new election under Division 230:
                . the last time the head company may make an election under
                  Division 230 (ie, by the end of the relevant income year);
                  and
                . the end of 90 days after the Commissioner of Taxation
                  (Commissioner) is given notice under Division 703 of the
                  ITAA 1997 that the life insurance company has become a
                  member of the group or such later time as the Commissioner
                  allows.
    723. Consequently, if a life insurance company joins an existing
         consolidated group or MEC group, the head company will be able to
         make an election under Division 230 in relation to its life
         insurance business that is different to the election that applies
         to its other business.
    724. However, if a life insurance company that joins an existing
         consolidated group or MEC group has made an election under
         Division 230 prior to joining the group that is consistent with the
         existing election of the head company, then the head company is
         precluded from making a new election under Division 230.  This
         includes a situation where the group already carries on life
         insurance business and has made an election under Division 230 in
         respect of that business which is consistent with the Division 230
         election of the joining life insurance company.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsections 230-225(3), 230-270(3), 230-330(4) and 230-415(3)]

         The manner in which elections are to be made


    725. The form by which the taxpayer makes an election available under
         the elective Subdivisions is not prescribed in Division 230.
         However, the election will need to be made in a manner that clearly
         reflects that the election has been made and also the time when the
         election is made.  That election will need to form part of the tax
         records of the entity.


         Elections are irrevocable


    726. An election made under one of the elective Subdivisions is
         irrevocable.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-210(3), 230-
         255(5), 230-315(3) and 230-395(4)]


Financial arrangements that are subject to the election, and the effect of
the election


         Financial arrangements to which the elective Subdivisions apply


    727. Elections made under the elective Subdivisions apply to relevant
         Division 230 financial arrangements to the extent that:


                . the relevant financial arrangement starts to be held in
                  the income year in which the election is made, or the
                  relevant financial arrangement starts to be held in income
                  years following the income year in which the election is
                  made; and


                . the gain or loss on the relevant financial arrangement is
                  recognised or recorded in the taxpayer's audited financial
                  reports.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-220(1), 230-265(1) and 230-
         410(1), section 230-325]


    728. An election under the elective Subdivisions does not apply to
         financial arrangements that are held by a taxpayer prior to the
         income year in which the election is made.  An exception applies
         where the taxpayer makes a transitional year election for existing
         financial arrangements (discussed in Chapter 13).


         Financial arrangements to which the elective Subdivisions do not
         apply


    729. If the taxpayer makes an election under Subdivisions 230-C or 230-
         F, the election does not apply in respect of:


                . a financial arrangement that is an equity interest that:


                  - is not classified or designated as at fair value through
                    profit or loss; or


                  - is issued by the taxpayer [Schedule 1, item 1,
                    subsections 230-225(1) and 230-415(1)]; and


                . franked distributions.  The assessability of these
                  distributions, to the degree that they are franked, will
                  remain outside Division 230.  For example, dividends, to
                  the degree that they are franked, will remain assessable
                  in accordance with section 44 of the Income Tax Assessment
                  Act 1936 [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-225(1) and
                  230-480].


         Refer to Chapters 2, 3, 6 and 9 for more information on these
         exceptions.


    730. Where the head company of a consolidated or MEC group chooses not
         to make elections in respect of its life insurance business,
         Subdivision 230-C, 230-D, 230-E or 230-F will not apply to
         financial arrangements of that member of the consolidated group to
         the extent that the financial arrangement relates to the life
         insurance business.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-225(3),
         230-270(3), 230-330(4) and 230-415(3)]


    731. Regulations may also exclude other financial arrangements
         associated with a business of a specified kind.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsections 230-225(4), 230-270(4), 230-330(5) and 230-415(4)]


    732. Note that although individuals and other entities not subject to
         Division 230 under the threshold tests contained in section 230-455
         can elect to apply the elective Subdivisions, the election will be
         invalid unless the taxpayer has also made an election under
         subsection 230-455(7) - refer to paragraph 5.58.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsections 230-220(1), 230-265(1), 230-325(3) and 230-410(1)]


Effect of relying on elective Subdivisions


    733. Where an election made under the elective Subdivisions applies to a
         financial arrangement, the gain or loss that is made from that
         financial arrangement is equal to the amount that is required by
         the relevant accounting standards to be recognised for that
         financial arrangement in the entity's profit and loss statement of
         its financial reports.


    734. Generally, the effect of making an election under the elective
         Subdivisions is that the taxpayer relies on their financial reports
         to determine the amount of any gain or loss that is taken to have
         been made from a relevant financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsections 230-230(1), 230-280(1) and 230-420(1)]


    735. With respect to specific elective Subdivisions:


                . financial arrangements or assets or liabilities that fall
                  within the definition of 'financial arrangement',
                  including those arrangements that fall within the
                  additional operation of the Division as set out in
                  Subdivision 230-J, which are fair valued for the purpose
                  of the profit or loss account, can be fair valued for tax
                  purposes [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-230(1)];


                . amounts that are recognised in taxpayers' profit or loss
                  statements of their financial reports that are
                  attributable to the change in currency exchange rates are
                  recognised as gains and losses for tax purposes [Schedule
                  1, item 1, subsection 230-280(1)]; and


                . amounts that are recognised in the profit or loss
                  statement of the financial reports, in effect, determine
                  whether, and the amount of, a gain or loss from a relevant
                  financial arrangement is regarded as arising.  Financial
                  reports also determine when the gain or loss is regarded
                  as arising [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-420(1)].


         Intra-group transaction for the purposes of AASB 127


    736. Where an election is made by a member of an accounting consolidated
         group or of a MEC group, and a financial arrangement is not
         recognised in an audited financial report only because the
         arrangement is an intra-group transaction under AASB 127, the
         requirement that the financial arrangement be recognised in the
         financial reports is deemed to have been satisfied in relation to
         that financial arrangement.  Financial arrangements between members
         of a consolidated group or MEC group are not covered by this
         subsection because the single entity rule in subsection 701-1(1) of
         the ITAA 1997 operates to treat them as not being financial
         arrangements for all income tax purposes.


    737. This provision is intended to allow taxpayers to rely on entity
         accounts for the purposes of satisfying this requirement.  To the
         extent that the arrangement is recognised for tax purposes, the
         taxpayer is able to rely on the relevant entity accounts for the
         purpose of determining the amount of relevant gains and losses.
         That is, this provision only extends to transactions that occur
         between two tax entities but within the one accounting consolidated
         group.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-220(2), 230-265(2) and
         230-410(3), paragraphs 230-230(1)(b) and 230-420(1)(b),
         subparagraph 230-280(1)(b)(ii)]


    738. For a discussion of the application of elective Subdivisions to
         intra-group transactions of foreign bank branches and offshore
         banking units, see Chapter 11.


         Financial arrangement leaving a consolidated group


    739. The elective Subdivisions may apply in a modified manner where an
         entity joins or leaves a consolidated group.  For details about the
         application of elective Subdivisions in relation to the
         consolidation regime, see Chapter 12.


         The order in which the elections under the elective Subdivisions
         apply


    740. It is important to note that, where more than one election has been
         made under the elective Subdivisions, only one elective method may
         apply to an eligible financial arrangement.  For further discussion
         of the hierarchy of tax treatments refer to Chapter 1.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, section 230-40]


Where requirements for an election are no longer satisfied

    741. Although an election under the elective Subdivisions is
         irrevocable, the election may cease to apply, depending on the
         circumstances applying to either:
                . all of a taxpayer's financial arrangements; or
                . one or more particular financial arrangements of the
                  taxpayer.

         When an election ceases to apply to all existing financial
         arrangements

    742. The elections, other than (in certain circumstances) an election
         under Subdivision 230-E, will cease to apply to all of the relevant
         financial arrangements in the following circumstances:
                . the accounting requirement is no longer satisfied;
                . the auditing requirement is no longer satisfied; or
                . a requirement particular to an elective Subdivision is no
                  longer satisfied.
    743. If the taxpayer relies on more than once financial report for an
         income year (because the financial and income years do not align),
         then ceasing to satisfy the accounting or auditing requirements in
         relation to any one of the financial reports relied on will result
         in the election ceasing to apply.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections
         230-240(1), 230-285(1), 230-370(1) and 230-425(1)]

         Where an election ceases to apply to particular financial
         arrangements


    744. The elections will cease to apply to one or more particular
         financial arrangements in the following circumstances:


                . it is no longer recognised in audited financial reports;


                . it is recognised in financial reports which are not
                  audited; or


                . the taxpayer ceases to meet a particular requirement of an
                  elective Subdivision.


    745. As with an election ceasing to apply to all financial arrangements,
         it will similarly cease to apply to a particular financial
         arrangement if the taxpayer relies on more than one financial
         report for an income year (because the financial and income years
         do not align), and the particular financial arrangement is no
         longer recognised in any one of the audited financial reports
         relied on.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-240(3), 230-285(3)
         and 230-425(3)]


         When does the election cease to apply?


    746. Where an election made under the elective Subdivisions ceases to
         apply to a financial arrangement, that election ceases to apply
         from the start of the income year in which the circumstances
         described above occur.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-240(1)
         and (3), 230-285(1) and (3), 230-370(1) and 230-425(1) and (3)]


    747. If an election under any of the elective Subdivisions ceases to a
         financial arrangement, that election cannot subsequently apply to
         it again.  Further, even if a subsequent election under the
         relevant elective Subdivision is made, that election cannot apply
         to any financial arrangement to which the prior election applied.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-240(2) and (4), 230-285(2) and
         (4), 230-370(2) and 230-425(1) and (4)]


A balancing adjustment if an election ceases to apply


    748. Where an election made under an elective Subdivision ceases to have
         effect, a balancing adjustment must be made in respect of all the
         financial arrangements to which the election ceases to apply.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-245(1), 230-290(1) and 230-
         430(1)]


    749. Where an election made under an elective Subdivision ceases to
         apply to a particular financial arrangement, a balancing adjustment
         must be made in respect of that arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-245(3), 230-290(3) and 230-430(3)]


    750. The balancing adjustment rules deem the taxpayer to have disposed
         of the relevant financial arrangement(s) at the time the election
         ceases to apply (ie, at the start of the relevant income year).
         The disposal is deemed to be for the financial arrangement's fair
         value at that time, and any balancing adjustment gain or loss is
         brought to account accordingly.  The balancing adjustment gain or
         loss is calculated as if it were a balancing adjustment made under
         Subdivision 230-G.  Further, the taxpayer is taken to have
         immediately reacquired the financial arrangement for its fair
         value.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-245(2), (4) and (5),
         230-290(2), (4) and (5) and 230-430(2), (5) and (6)]


    751. Note that, for those financial arrangements subject to
         Subdivision 230-D (the general foreign exchange retranslation
         election) the balancing adjustment will only apply in respect of
         those gains or losses attributable to foreign currency exchange
         rate fluctuations.  Further, this balancing adjustment does not
         apply to Subdivision 230-E (hedging financial arrangements method).
          Subdivision 230-E has specific provisions dealing with the
         consequences if an election ceases to have effect (see Chapter 8).


    752. Chapter 10 provides a comprehensive outline of the operation of the
         balancing adjustment rules contained in Subdivision 230-G.


The making of a new election


    753. Where an election made by a taxpayer ceases to have effect because
         one or more of the requirements for making the election is no
         longer being met, they may subsequently make a new election where
         the requirements for making the election are once more satisfied
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-240(2), 230-285(2), 230-370(2)
         and 230-425(2)].  For each of the elective methods, other than
         Subdivision 230-E, only financial arrangements that are entered
         into after the new election is made can be subject to that
         election.  This means that those financial arrangements that were
         held at the time the election ceases to have effect cannot then be
         subject to a subsequent election that is made [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-240(4), 230-285(4), 230-325(1), 230-425(4) and the
         note to subsection 230-370(2)].








    754. Chapter 6
The elective fair value method

Outline of chapter


    755. This chapter outlines how the elective fair value method operates.
         The chapter explains:


                . when the taxpayer can apply the elective fair value tax-
                  timing method;


                . the effect of the elective fair value tax-timing method;
                  and


                . what valuations are used for the purposes of the elective
                  fair value tax-timing method.


Overview of the elective fair value method


The fair value tax-timing method


    756. The elective fair value method is a tax-timing method that measures
         gain or loss as the change in the value of a financial arrangement
         between two points in time.  Under this tax-timing method the gain
         or loss from a financial arrangement for a particular period is the
         increase or decrease in its fair value between the beginning and
         end of the period, adjusted for amounts paid or received during the
         period.  For example, assuming there are no amounts paid or
         received during the period, if the value of a financial arrangement
         is $100 on 1 July 2010 and $125 on 30 June 2011, there is a fair
         value gain of $25 for that particular period.


    757. Where a fair value election applies, the gains or losses for an
         income year will be determined by relevant accounting standards.
         Accordingly, where the Australian accounting standards, or
         comparable foreign accounting standards, require that a fair value
         measurement through profit or loss be used to determine accounting
         profits or losses on financial arrangements for an income year,
         these gains and losses shall be used to determine the taxpayer's
         gain or loss for an income year from those financial arrangements.


    758. Distributions, to the degree that they are franked (received either
         directly by the taxpayer or indirectly through a partnership or
         trust), and rights to receive distributions, to the degree that
         they are franked (either directly or indirectly), are not to be
         included as a gain or loss under the fair value method.


Valuations


    759. The term fair value is defined in Australian Accounting Standard
         AASB 139 Financial Instruments:  Recognition and Measurement (AASB
         139) as '...the amount for which an asset could be exchanged or a
         liability settled, between knowledgeable, willing parties in arm's
         length transactions'.  The valuation methods used for the elective
         fair value method ought to generally be the same as those used for
         the fair value valuation in relevant accounting standards.


Election to apply fair value tax-timing method


    760. Broadly, the fair value tax-timing method will apply to a financial
         arrangement where a taxpayer makes a valid election to use the fair
         value election in respect of a Division 230 financial arrangement.


    761. Generally, for a taxpayer to make a valid election to apply the
         fair value tax-timing method, the taxpayer must prepare financial
         reports in accordance with relevant accounting standards and have
         those financial reports audited in accordance with relevant
         auditing standards.


    762. The taxpayer must also:


                . classify the financial arrangement in the financial report
                  as an asset or liability at fair value through profit or
                  loss, except for intra-group financial arrangements not
                  required to be recognised in the financial reports
                  referred to above because of the application of the
                  relevant accounting standard dealing with consolidated and
                  separate financial statements; and


                . treat the asset or liability (or that part of the asset or
                  liability) that is classified at fair value through profit
                  or loss as if it is the whole of the relevant financial
                  arrangement (with any balance being treated as a separate
                  financial arrangement).


    763. Once the fair value election is made a taxpayer must apply the fair
         value tax-timing method to financial arrangements described in the
         previous paragraph that start to be held in that income year and
         any subsequent income year.


Balancing adjustment if a fair value election ceases to apply


    764. Where a fair value election ceases to have effect, or ceases to
         apply to a particular financial arrangement, a balancing adjustment
         is made in respect of any financial arrangement that is no longer
         subject to the election.  This balancing adjustment has the effect
         of a disposal of that financial arrangement for its fair value at
         the start of the income year in which the election ceases to apply,
         followed by an immediate reacquisition for that fair value.


Context of amendments


    765. The current income tax law does not specifically provide for gains
         and losses to be recognised using a fair value tax-timing method.
         The current trading stock provisions provide the closest proxy by
         allowing taxpayers to revalue trading stock on-hand by reference to
         changes in market value.  However, these provisions have limited
         application to many financial arrangements.


    766. The absence of an elective fair value method for the recognition of
         gains and losses from a trading portfolio of financial arrangements
         could mean that, while the portfolio is largely hedged in value
         terms, the tax-timing method applying to the individual financial
         arrangements may produce significant gains or losses that do not
         reflect the manner in which those portfolio gains or losses are
         earned.  This tax result is inconsistent with the way that the
         gains and losses from the portfolio are recognised for financial
         accounting purposes and managed for risk management purposes.
         Where the portfolio is integral to the price-making function in a
         financial market, the potentially significant difference between
         the tax and financial accounting results would be distortionary.


    767. The elective fair value method is a tax-timing methodology that
         measures gain or loss for tax purposes as the change in the value
         of a financial arrangement between two points in time.  Under fair
         value tax accounting the gain or loss from a financial arrangement
         for a particular period is the increase or decrease in its fair
         value between the beginning and end of the period, adjusted for
         amounts paid or received during the period.


    768. While the elective fair value method has a number of potential
         advantages, mandatory application to all financial arrangements and
         all taxpayers could potentially result in excessive volatility in
         reported profits/losses and tax liabilities, creating adverse cash
         flow and liquidity issues for some taxpayers.  Imposing the
         elective fair value method could also create substantial compliance
         costs for taxpayers where they are not required to use the fair
         value method for accounting purposes.  For these reasons the fair
         value tax treatment is elective.


    769. The elective fair value method requires integrity measures to
         ensure that the elective treatment is not tax motivated.  It is
         against this background that the accounting and auditing
         requirements are necessary.  That is, the accounting and auditing
         requirements, which the taxpayer must meet to make the fair value
         election and apply it to the financial arrangements which they
         have, provide a level of integrity around facilitating the elective
         fair value method in the appropriate circumstances and minimising
         tax motivated accounting or selection practices.  These
         requirements, with other common requirements and conditions, are
         discussed in more detail in Chapter 5.


Summary of new law


    770. Relevant taxpayers may irrevocably elect to use the elective fair
         value method to determine gains and losses on financial
         arrangements including equity interests (other than equity
         interests that they issue) for the income year.  The fair value
         gain or loss for an income year will be the same as that recorded
         on a fair value basis in the entity's audited profit or loss
         account under relevant Australian accounting standards or their
         comparable foreign equivalents.


    771. When the requirements for making the election cease to be
         satisfied, the fair value election ceases to have effect and a
         balancing adjustment is required to be made.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|Taxpayers who prepare   |Only limited fair value |
|financial reports in    |tax treatment is        |
|accordance with the     |available for financial |
|relevant financial      |arrangements.           |
|accounting standards and|                        |
|have audited financial  |                        |
|accounts can elect to   |                        |
|have financial          |                        |
|arrangements (other than|                        |
|equity interests of     |                        |
|which they are the      |                        |
|issuers) taxed annually |                        |
|under the fair value    |                        |
|method, if those        |                        |
|financial arrangements  |                        |
|are accorded fair value |                        |
|treatment in their      |                        |
|profit or loss          |                        |
|statement.              |                        |
|If a taxpayer adopts the|                        |
|elective fair value     |                        |
|method it applies to all|                        |
|assets and liabilities  |                        |
|that are financial      |                        |
|arrangements which are  |                        |
|fair valued through     |                        |
|their audited profit or |                        |
|loss account for        |                        |
|accounting purposes.    |                        |
|The election is         |                        |
|irrevocable and once    |                        |
|elected it applies on a |                        |
|mandatory basis to all  |                        |
|financial arrangements  |                        |
|that are accorded fair  |                        |
|value treatment in the  |                        |
|audited profit or loss  |                        |
|account.  The fair value|                        |
|election applies for the|                        |
|income year in which the|                        |
|election is made and for|                        |
|all future income years,|                        |
|unless one or more of   |                        |
|the requirements        |                        |
|associated with that    |                        |
|election ceases to be   |                        |
|satisfied.              |                        |


Detailed explanation of new law


    772. To apply the elective fair value method to a financial arrangement,
         the taxpayer must:


                . elect the method [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
                  210(1)];


                . meet the common requirements for a valid election - that
                  is, prepare financial reports in accordance with the
                  relevant accounting standards and have those financial
                  reports audited in accordance with the relevant auditing
                  standards (for more detail on the common requirements for
                  the elective Subdivisions refer to Chapter 5) [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, subsection 230-210(2)];


                . classify the financial arrangement in the financial
                  report, pursuant to the operation of the relevant
                  accounting standards, as an asset or liability at fair
                  value through profit or loss - noting the exception for
                  financial arrangements that are not recognised in a set of
                  financial reports because of the application of accounting
                  standard Australian Accounting Standard AASB 127
                  Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements (AASB 127)
                  (or comparable) [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  220(1)(c) and subsection 230-220(2)];


                . treat the asset or liability that is classified at fair
                  value through profit or loss (or that part of the asset or
                  liability) as comprising the whole of the relevant
                  financial arrangement (with any balance of the 'financial
                  arrangement' as defined in Division 230 being treated as a
                  separate financial arrangement) [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  section 230-235]; and


                . apply the fair value tax-timing election to the financial
                  arrangement if:


                  - it starts to be held in the income year in which the
                    election is made or any subsequent income year
                    [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-220(1)(d)]; and


                  - it is not subject to certain exceptions [Schedule 1,
                    item 1, section 230-225].


Which entities can elect the fair value tax-timing method?


    773. Any entity that prepares audited financial reports is able to make
         a fair value election [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-210].
         However, only certain taxpayers may want to elect to use the fair
         value tax-timing method.  For instance, traders holding instruments
         or commodities for relatively short times, and buying and selling
         commodities or financial instruments primarily for market-making
         purposes, might elect fair value tax treatment.  'Traders'
         generally have fully or largely hedged exposures.


    774. Traders are often financial institutions that have separate trading
         books.  These institutions usually have large portfolios of
         financial arrangements which are fair valued through profit or loss
         for financial accounting purposes.  If such institutions are able
         to elect fair value tax treatment for such financial arrangements
         both their accounting and tax treatments would be on the same fair
         value basis, and they would benefit from substantial economies in
         record-keeping and data management.  Overall compliance costs are
         expected to be reduced as a result.


    775. Some other entities, outside the financial sector, may also have
         relatively sophisticated risk management systems which would allow
         them to cope with any price risk and tax volatility that may arise
         from using the fair value tax-timing method.  Such entities may
         also want to elect fair value tax treatment.  Furthermore, entities
         that record gains and losses on a fair value basis in their audited
         profit or loss accounts may also want to elect fair value tax
         treatment to reduce overall compliance costs.


         Making the election


    776. Broadly speaking, a taxpayer whose financial arrangement gains and
         losses Division 230 applies to may make a fair value election, but
         an election will only be valid for those taxpayers who meet the
         requirements of Subdivision 230-C.


    777. In the case of a tax consolidated group or a multiple entry
         consolidated group (MEC group), elections are made by the head
         company of the group.  Generally, an election under Division 230
         will apply to all the relevant transactions of all members of the
         consolidated group or MEC group.  However, there is an exception to
         this where a tax consolidated group or MEC group includes a member
         that carries on a 'life insurance business'.  Where a member of the
         group carries on a life insurance business the head company can
         specify whether or not the election will apply to the life
         insurance business carried on by that member of the group.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-225(3)]


    778. A regulation-making power allows for regulations to be made
         specifying other types of businesses for which a fair value
         election made by the head company of a consolidated group or MEC
         group will not apply.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-225(4)]


    779. The making of a valid election and its application to a member of a
         consolidated group that carries on life insurance business is
         discussed in more detail in Chapter 5.


The elective fair value tax-timing requirements


    780. For the elective fair value method to apply to the financial
         arrangements of a taxpayer for the bringing to account of gains and
         losses, a taxpayer must elect that the elective fair value method
         apply.  An election will only be valid if the accounting and audit
         requirements listed in subsection 230-210(2) are met.  There are
         elective requirements common to the elective Subdivisions
         (Subdivisions 230-C, 230-D, 230-E and 230-F).  These accounting and
         audit elective requirements are discussed in detail in Chapter 5.
         There are also a number of requirements which a particular
         financial arrangement must meet in order for the election to
         validly apply, which are discussed below.


Financial arrangements fair valued through profit or loss


    781. Once a fair value election has been made, the election applies to
         all financial arrangements which are first held in the income year
         in which the election is made and in later income years and which
         are fair valued through profit or loss [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraphs 230-220(1)(c) and (d)].  In addition, a transitional
         election may be made to apply the elective fair value method to
         financial arrangements being fair valued through profit or loss
         that existed at the time of commencement of the Division [Schedule
         1, Part 3, subitems 104(8) and (11)].  The transitional election
         requirements are discussed in Chapter 13.


    782. Where a financial arrangement is an intra-group transaction for the
         purposes of accounting standard AASB 127 (or comparable), the
         financial arrangement is deemed to be an arrangement that is
         recognised in a set of audited financial reports and classified as
         at fair value through profit or loss [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-220(2)].  For further discussion of this, see
         Chapter 5.


    783. Arrangements that fall within the extended operation of
         Division 230, as set out in section 230-530 (eg, foreign currency,
         non-equity shares, and commodities and offsetting commodity
         contracts held by traders), which are fair valued for the purpose
         of the profit or loss statement can also be fair valued for tax
         purposes.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-530]


    784. Financial arrangements which are fair valued, and which are not
         classified as at fair value through profit or loss because the
         change in fair value is initially taken to equity, cannot be fair
         valued for the purposes of Division 230.  This means that a company
         cannot apply the fair value method to an equity issued by that
         company.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-220(1)]


Financial assets and liabilities that comprise the whole or part of the
financial arrangement


    785. The application of the elective fair value tax method is limited to
         those financial arrangements which, in whole or in part, comprise
         assets or liabilities classified in the relevant accounts as at
         fair value through profit or loss [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph
         230-220(1)(c)].  Where only part of a financial arrangement is
         subject to fair value (eg, the financial arrangement may comprise a
         financial asset or liability that is fair valued through the profit
         or loss and another financial asset or liability which is not),
         that part of the arrangement is treated as a separate financial
         arrangement that is subject to this Subdivision.  The remaining
         part of the financial arrangement will be treated as a separate
         financial arrangement and will be subject to the other provisions
         of the Division [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-235].


    786. Where a hybrid financial arrangement (comprising a host instrument
         and an embedded derivative) is bifurcated (separated) under the
         relevant accounting standards (Australian Accounting Standard
         AASB 132 Financial Instruments:  Disclosure and Presentation and
         AASB 139) the derivative may be fair valued for accounting
         purposes.  However, such a hybrid arrangement may be a single
         arrangement for the purpose of Division 230 [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-55].  If the taxpayer has made a fair value tax-timing
         election in relation to such a hybrid arrangement that is a
         financial arrangement, it is the intention that such derivatives,
         which are part of the hybrid arrangement, would be fair valued for
         tax purposes [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-235].


Consequences of making a fair value election


    787. A fair value tax-timing election requires the taxpayer to apply the
         elective fair value method to all financial arrangements that are
         required by the relevant accounting standards to be fair valued
         through profit or loss, and that are not subject to an exception.
         The fair value election, once made, applies from the beginning of
         the income year in which the election is made.  The election will
         apply to all financial arrangements which start to be held in the
         income year in which the election is made (including arrangements
         subject to a transitional election - see Chapter 13) or a later
         income year so long as the election remains valid and continues to
         apply.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-220(1)(d)]


    788. An election will continue to be valid as long as the requirements
         which a taxpayer must meet in order to make the election, including
         the accounting and auditing requirements, continue to be met
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-240(1)].  Chapter 5 discusses
         these common requirements and the making of an election.  In the
         income year in which one or more of these requirements ceases to be
         met, the election will cease to be valid and the elective fair
         value method may not be applied to financial arrangements then held
         by the taxpayer (see paragraphs 6.43 to 6.45).  For those financial
         arrangements which were previously being fair valued, a balancing
         adjustment is required to be made (see paragraphs 6.46 to 6.49 and
         Chapter 10) when the election ceases to be valid.


The application of fair value to financial arrangements that are equity
interests


    789. The elective fair value method may apply to all financial
         arrangements, including financial arrangements which are equity
         interests under Division 974 of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997,
         subject to the satisfaction of the fair value tax-timing
         requirements and the exclusion set out below.


    790. A taxpayer that has issued its own equity interests is not
         permitted to fair value those equity interests [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-225(1)].  This rule is directed at ensuring, for
         example, that an entity does not obtain a tax deduction for
         dividends paid.


Gains and losses taken into account where a fair value election is made


    791. Where a fair value election applies to a financial arrangement, the
         gains or losses for an income year will be determined by relevant
         accounting standards.  Where the Australian accounting standards,
         or comparable foreign accounting standards, require that a fair
         value measurement through profit or loss be used to determine
         accounting profits or losses on financial arrangements for an
         income year, these gains and losses shall be used to determine the
         taxpayer's gain or loss for an income year from those financial
         arrangements, should the taxpayer make the fair value election that
         validly applies to those financial arrangements.  Chapter 11
         explains how this applies in respect of fair value gains or losses
         that are made from a financial arrangement arising from intra-
         entity/group dealings that are recognised by Part IIIB (foreign
         bank branches) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (ITAA 1936) or
         Division 9A of the ITAA 1936 (offshore banking units).  [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsection 230-230(1)]


         Franked distributions


    792. Franked distributions (received either directly by the taxpayer or
         indirectly through a partnership or trust) and rights to receive
         franked distributions (either directly or indirectly) are not to be
         included as a gain or loss that is brought to account in accordance
         with Subdivision 230-C.  The effect of excluding franked
         distributions from the scope of the fair value election is to
         ensure that these distributions will remain assessable in
         accordance with section 44 of the ITAA 1936.  Assessing the
         distribution under section 44 of the ITAA 1936 rather than under
         Division 230 will ensure that the imputation system works
         appropriately in respect of distributions such that franking
         credits allocated to such distributions are available to the
         recipient in the income year in which the distribution is taxed to
         the recipient.


    793. Without a specific rule, a dividend (distribution) may be declared
         in favour of a shareholder and the accounting standards
         (eg, Australian Accounting Standard AASB 118 Revenue) would have
         required the taxpayer to recognise revenue (ie, a gain) in respect
         of the declared distribution based on the individual facts and
         circumstances relating to that dividend declaration.  At this time,
         however, the dividend could not be franked.  Later, when the
         dividend is actually paid, that payment would not be assessed to
         the taxpayer because of the operation of the anti-overlap rule
         (section 230-20) and, accordingly, franking benefits would not be
         allowed to the shareholder.


    794. The exclusion of distributions to the extent that they are franked
         will apply equally to distributions received directly by the
         taxpayer from a corporate tax entity or received indirectly by the
         taxpayer as a beneficiary of a trust or through a partnership.  In
         these cases, a beneficiary of a trust (and equally a taxpayer that
         will receive franked distributions through a partnership) will only
         recognise a dividend either when it is received through the trust
         or when the dividend is declared but not paid and the beneficiary
         knows how much it will actually receive.  If this cannot be
         determined by the beneficiary, then the exclusion will not apply.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-480]


      1. :  Dividend payment


                On 1 July 2010 Company A acquires ordinary shares in Company
                B for $50 million and makes the fair value election in
                respect of all its financial arrangements.  At 30 June 2011
                the shares in Company B have a market value of $65 million.
                On 1 May 2011 Company B pays dividends of $6 million.
                Company A's taxable income for the 2010-11 year includes the
                fair value gain of $15 million ($65 million  -  $50 million)
                and a dividend of $6 million (ignoring grossing-up for
                franking credits).  However, Division 230 will only assess
                the fair value gain of $15 million.  The dividend paid by
                Company B will be assessed under section 44 of the
                ITAA 1936.


                At 30 June 2012 the shares in Company B have a market value
                of $90 million.  No dividends have been paid for this income
                year.  Company A's taxable income for the 2010-12 income
                year includes the fair value gain of $25 million
                ($90 million  -  $65 million).


Valuation issues


    795. The term fair value is not defined in Division 230.  The term
         should take its ordinary commercial meaning.  In this regard, AASB
         139 defines fair value as '...the amount for which an asset could
         be exchanged or a liability settled, between knowledgeable, willing
         parties in arm's length transactions'.


    796. The valuation methods used, and the guidance, definitions and
         requirements for the elective fair value method ought to generally
         be the same as those used for the fair value valuation in relevant
         accounting standards.  Therefore, if taxpayers use fair value
         estimates in their profit or loss accounts that accord with
         commercially acceptable valuation techniques, they can generally
         use the same estimates for the purpose of the elective fair value
         method.


Where requirements for election are no longer satisfied


    797. Although an election under the elective Subdivisions is
         irrevocable, the election may cease to apply, depending on the
         circumstances of either:


                . all of a taxpayer's financial arrangements; or


                . one or more particular financial arrangements of the
                  taxpayer.


    798. If an election under any of the elective Subdivisions ceases to
         apply to a particular financial arrangement, that election cannot
         subsequently apply to it again.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
         230-240(4)]


    799. Refer to Chapter 5 for further information as to when an election
         will cease to apply.


Balancing adjustment if election ceases to apply


    800. Where an election made under an elective Subdivision ceases to have
         effect, or ceases to apply to a particular financial arrangement,
         from the start of a particular income year, a balancing adjustment
         is made at that time in respect of any financial arrangement that
         is no longer subject to the election.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-245(1) and (3)]


    801. The balancing adjustment is to be made in accordance with the
         balancing adjustment requirements set out in Subdivision 230-G
         (see Chapter 10).  The balancing adjustment when applied to a
         financial arrangement has the effect of a disposal of that
         financial arrangement - for its market value at the start of the
         income year in which the election ceases to apply - followed by an
         immediate reacquisition for that market value.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, section 230-245]


    802. Chapter 5, in respect of the elective Subdivisions, and Chapter 10
         more generally, provide further detail as to the operation of the
         balancing adjustment rules contained in Subdivision 230-G.


      1. :  Balancing adjustment when fair value ends


                On 22 April 2010 Spice Co makes a fair value election under
                section 230-210.  Assume Spice Co has a balance date for tax
                purposes of 30 June.


                After the financial year ending 30 June 2011, Spice Co
                ceases to have its financial reports audited.


                From the financial year beginning 1 July 2013, Spice Co
                again satisfies all the requirements for making a fair value
                election (including the requirement that its accounts are
                audited).  Spice Co makes a new fair value election under
                section 230-210.


                The consequences of Spice Co ceasing to maintain audited
                financial reports from 1 July 2011 results in Spice Co not
                being able to apply the elective fair value method to the
                financial arrangements it holds at 1 July 2011, as its
                election ceases to apply from this time.  A balancing
                adjustment will be required to be made on 1 July 2011 for
                those financial arrangements which were being fair valued
                through profit or loss subject to the fair value election.


                On 1 July 2013, Spice Co again makes a valid fair value tax-
                timing election.  From this time, the elective fair value
                method will apply to any new assets and liabilities that
                comprise a financial arrangement (or part thereof) that
                start to be held on or after this time by Spice Co, which
                are fair valued through profit or loss in accordance with
                the relevant accounting standards.


    803. Once a financial arrangement is taken to be reacquired and no
         longer subject to the elective fair value method, a taxpayer will
         need to assess which other relevant tax-timing method under
         Division 230, is to be applied to the financial arrangement.  For
         example, where the taxpayer ceases to have financial reports
         prepared in accordance with Australian accounting standards, the
         default tax-timing methods under Division 230 (accruals or
         realisation) will typically apply.


Making a new election


    804. Where a taxpayer has made an election which ceases to have effect,
         they may later make a new election where the conditions for making
         an election are once more satisfied (refer Chapter 5).  [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsection 230-240(2)]



    805. Chapter 7
The elective foreign exchange retranslation method

Outline of chapter


    806. This chapter outlines how the elective foreign exchange
         retranslation election (retranslation method) rules operate.  The
         chapter explains:


                . when the retranslation method may be applied;


                . the effect of the retranslation method;


                . the difference between a general retranslation election
                  and an election in relation to qualifying forex accounts;
                  and


                . the interaction of the retranslation method with the other
                  elective methods under Division 230.


Overview of the foreign exchange retranslation method


Application of the retranslation method


    807. Taxpayers who prepare audited financial reports in accordance with
         Australian accounting standards or comparable foreign accounting
         standards may make:


                . an election to apply the retranslation method to all
                  'financial arrangements' under Division 230 and those
                  arrangements subject to Subdivision 775-F of the Income
                  Tax Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997) (general retranslation
                  election); or


                . an election to only apply the foreign exchange
                  retranslation method to one or more of their financial
                  arrangements that meet the definition of a 'qualifying
                  forex account' (qualifying forex account election).


    808. Once made, an election is irrevocable.


    809. Where the retranslation method applies, any gain or loss due to
         changes in currency exchange rates will be generally determined by
         the amount which is required under Australian Accounting Standard
         AASB 121 The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates
         (AASB 121) (or a comparable foreign accounting standard) to be
         recognised in profit or loss in the financial reports.


    810. Broadly, where a general retranslation election is made, all gains
         and losses attributable to changes in currency exchange rates
         arising from financial arrangements will be brought to account
         under Subdivision 230-D.


    811. The retranslation method is similar to the fair value method in
         recognising unrealised gains and losses in the period in which they
         occur.  However, the retranslation method only recognises gains and
         losses that are attributable to movements in foreign currency
         exchange rates.  Fair value, on the other hand, recognises gains
         and losses attributable to changes in other variables such as
         interest rates and creditworthiness in addition to any gains and
         losses that are attributable to movements in foreign currency
         exchange rates.


    812. The retranslation method will not apply to a financial arrangement
         if any of the following elections have been made in relation to
         that financial arrangement:


                . a fair value election under Subdivision 230-C;


                . a financial reports election under Subdivision 230-F; or


                . a hedging financial arrangement election under
                  Subdivision 230-E to the extent it applies to that
                  financial arrangement.


    813. Where the retranslation method applies to a financial arrangement,
         any gains and losses not attributable to changes in currency
         exchange rates will be brought to account under the accruals and/or
         realisation methods.


    814. If none of the elective tax-timing methods (including the
         retranslation method) apply to a financial arrangement, gains and
         losses including those attributable to changes in currency exchange
         rates will be brought to account under the accruals and/or
         realisation methods.


    815. A qualifying forex account election can only be made where a
         general retranslation election has not already been made.


Context of amendments


    816. The retranslation method measures the gain or the loss arising from
         different prevailing exchange rates at different points in time, on
         translating a given number of units of one currency into another
         currency.The retranslation tax-timing method will only be relevant
         to those taxpayers with arrangements denominated in, or determined
         by reference to, a foreign currency or, in the case of taxpayers
         who have made an election under Subdivision 960-D of the ITAA 1997,
         a non-functional currency.


    817. The scope of the retranslation method is determined by the two
         foreign exchange retranslation elections available.  A taxpayer can
         make either:


                . a general election to use the retranslation method, the
                  scope of which is determined by the amounts required by
                  AASB 121 to be recognised in the profit or loss statement
                  in a taxpayer's set of financial reports.  A general
                  election is made in respect of all financial arrangements
                  and other arrangements where those amounts have not
                  previously been recognised in the taxpayer's set of
                  financial reports; or


                . a qualifying forex account election to use the
                  retranslation method only in respect of one or more
                  financial arrangements that meet the definition of a
                  'qualifying forex account'.  A qualifying forex account is
                  defined in the ITAA 1997 as an account denominated in
                  foreign currency which is used for the primary purpose of
                  facilitating transactions or is a credit card account.


    818. Under AASB 121, certain annual gains and losses attributable to
         changes in foreign exchange rates are required to be recognised in
         profit or loss in an entity's financial reports.  The retranslation
         method is intended to apply only to these gains and losses.


    819. These gains and losses, referred to in AASB 121 as exchange
         differences, are the differences resulting from translating a given
         number of units of one currency into another currency at different
         exchange rates.  An initial translation is made when the relevant
         item is first recognised for financial accounting purposes.  At
         subsequent reporting dates, another translation, sometimes referred
         to as 'retranslation', is made.  The difference between these
         amounts is recognised for accounting purpose in profit or loss,
         despite typically being unrealised.


    820. Gains and losses attributable to changes in currency exchange rates
         may also arise under AASB 121 on the settlement or maturity of the
         relevant item.


    821. Where the retranslation method applies it may result in the
         recognition of unrealised gains and losses attributable to changes
         in currency exchange rates.  If an entity continues to hold a
         financial arrangement under Division 230 or an arrangement subject
         to Subdivision 775-F of the ITAA 1997, the taxation of any
         unrealised foreign exchange gains or losses as a result of applying
         the retranslation method may, like the fair value tax-timing
         method, cause volatility in an entity's taxable income.  Taxpayers
         will need to determine whether this method is suitable for
         determining these gains and losses for tax purposes.


    822. For some taxpayers, recognising gains and losses in a manner
         consistent with what is required under AASB 121 may be beneficial
         from a compliance perspective.  Their foreign exchange exposures
         are likely to be such that the retranslation method in AASB 121
         does not impose significant volatility in earnings, and therefore
         alignment between the financial accounting and tax outcomes would
         also not impose any significant volatility in taxable income.


    823. Other taxpayers may see benefits in recognising for tax purposes
         foreign exchange gains and losses as determined under AASB 121 only
         in respect of one or more of their 'qualifying forex accounts'.


    824. To a limited extent, the election to use the retranslation method
         for qualifying forex accounts is similar to the retranslation
         election currently available under Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA
         1997.  Under Subdivision 775-E, a retranslation election that
         operates to imitate the retranslation method in AASB 121 is
         available for certain transactional foreign currency denominated
         accounts maintained with a bank or similar financial institution.


    825. Retranslation is different to fair value in that it only recognises
         gains and losses attributable to movements in foreign currency
         exchange rates.  Fair value, on the other hand, recognises gains
         and losses attributable to changes in other variables such as
         interest rates and creditworthiness in addition to any gains or
         losses attributable to movements in foreign currency exchange
         rates.  Consistent with the approach relating to the fair value tax
         rules, Division 230 does not mandate retranslation tax treatment.


Summary of new law


    826. Where audited financial reports are prepared in accordance with
         Australian accounting standards or comparable foreign accounting
         standards, a taxpayer may elect to use the retranslation method to
         determine gains and losses from financial arrangements to the
         extent they are attributable to changes in currency exchange rates.


    827. If made, the general retranslation election will also bring to
         account gains and losses attributable to changes in currency
         exchange rates made from arrangements which are subject to
         Subdivision 775-F of the ITAA 1997.


    828. The general retranslation election will apply to all relevant
         arrangements which are first held in the income year in which the
         election is made.  In subsequent income years, it will apply to all
         arrangements in respect of which the relevant accounting standards
         recognise in profit or loss, an amount attributable to foreign
         currency exchange rate changes.  This includes intra-group
         transactions that are financial arrangements which would not
         normally be recognised by the Australian Accounting Standard AASB
         127 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements (AASB 127), or a
         comparable foreign accounting standard.


    829. The head company of a consolidated group may choose that the
         general retranslation election will not apply to the financial
         arrangements or arrangements subject to Subdivision 775-F of the
         ITAA 1997 in relation to the life insurance business of the head
         company of a consolidated group or a MEC group.  Regulations may
         also be made to allow the head company of a consolidated or MEC
         group to choose to elect to exclude these financial arrangements in
         relation to other businesses of the group.


    830. Taxpayers who do not make a general retranslation election may make
         an election in respect of one or more of their qualifying forex
         accounts, essentially any transactional account.  In certain
         circumstances they will be able to elect their qualifying forex
         accounts with effect from 1 July 2003.


    831. The gain or loss recognised for an income year under the
         retranslation method will generally be the same as that which is
         required to be recognised under AASB 121 or its foreign equivalent
         in an entity's profit or loss.  However, the retranslation method
         will not recognise an amount in an entity's profit or loss if that
         amount has previously been recognised in equity.


    832. Both the general retranslation election and the qualifying forex
         account election are irrevocable.


    833. Where the requirements for making either election cease to be
         satisfied, the election ceases to have effect and a balancing
         adjustment is required to be made.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|Taxpayers that adopt    |There is no general     |
|relevant accounting     |retranslation tax       |
|standards and have      |treatment available for |
|audited financial       |financial arrangements  |
|accounts are able to    |under the existing      |
|elect to have gains and |tax law except for      |
|losses from all relevant|certain qualifying forex|
|arrangements which are  |accounts under          |
|attributable to changes |Subdivision 775-E of the|
|in currency exchange    |ITAA 1997.              |
|rates taxed under the   |Under the current law a |
|retranslation method.   |qualifying forex account|
|Alternatively, taxpayers|is limited to an account|
|may elect to use the    |held with, broadly, a   |
|retranslation method    |financial institution in|
|only in relation to one |Australia or overseas.  |
|or more of their        |                        |
|qualifying forex        |                        |
|accounts.               |                        |
|The definition of a     |                        |
|'qualifying forex       |                        |
|account' has been       |                        |
|extended by             |                        |
|retrospectively removing|                        |
|the requirement that it |                        |
|must be held with a     |                        |
|financial institution in|                        |
|Australia or overseas.  |                        |


Detailed explanation of new law


When can the foreign exchange method be used?


    834. The retranslation method will only apply in respect of an
         arrangement if a foreign exchange retranslation election validly
         applies to that arrangement.


    835. A foreign exchange retranslation election may apply in two
         circumstances:


                . at the taxpayer's election, to all relevant arrangements,
                  where the specified accounting and auditing requirements
                  are satisfied (general retranslation election) [Schedule
                  1, item 1, subsections 230-255(1) and (2), item 6, section
                  775-295]; or


                . to financial arrangements that are qualifying forex
                  accounts, in respect of which an election has been made
                  (qualifying forex account election) [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsections 230-255(3) and (4)].


General retranslation election


         Election requirements


    836. Only taxpayers whose financial reports are prepared and audited in
         accordance with Australian accounting and auditing standards or
         comparable foreign accounting and auditing standards can make the
         general retranslation election.  This includes taxpayers whose
         results are properly reflected in a set of audited financial
         reports of a connected entity.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         255(2)]


    837. Chapter 5 explains what is meant by financial reports, financial
         reporting requirements, accounting standards and auditing standards
         (including comparable foreign accounting and auditing standards).


         Scope of general retranslation election


    838. If the general retranslation election is made, the retranslation
         method will apply to determine all gains and losses attributable to
         currency exchange rate changes which arise from all arrangements to
         which the election applies.


    839. A general retranslation election will apply to all arrangements:


                . that the taxpayer starts to have in the income year in
                  which the election is made or in a later income year
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-265(1)(d), item 6,
                  paragraph 775-295(1)(a)];


                . that are recognised in a financial report in respect of
                  which the accounting and auditing requirements are
                  satisfied [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-265(1)(b),
                  item 6, paragraph 775-295(1)(b)];


                . in respect of which an amount attributable to changes in
                  currency exchange rates is required to be recognised in
                  profit or loss in the financial reports pursuant to
                  AASB 121 (or another standard prescribed in the
                  regulations) or a comparable foreign accounting standard
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-265(1)(c), item 6,
                  paragraph 775-295(1)(c)];


                . where the amount attributable to changes in currency
                  exchange rates is recognised in profit or loss in the
                  taxpayer's financial reports and which has not previously
                  been recognised in the equity reserves in the taxpayer's
                  financial reports [Schedule 1, item 6, subsection 775-
                  305(4)]; and


                . including intra group transactions that are financial
                  arrangements which have not been recognised in the
                  financial reports because they have been disregarded for
                  financial accounting purposes under AASB 127 or a
                  comparable foreign accounting standard [Schedule 1, item
                  1, subsection 230-265(2)].


    840. Under AASB 121 (or comparable foreign accounting standards) certain
         gains and losses attributable to changes in currency exchange rates
         are recognised in profit or loss in an entity's financial reports.
         For the general retranslation election to apply to an arrangement,
         AASB 121 or a comparable foreign accounting standard must require
         the recognition in profit or loss of gains and losses (if any) from
         the arrangement in the year in which the gain or loss arises.  The
         requirement that a gain or loss must be recognised in profit or
         loss will not be satisfied where it has earlier been recognised in
         equity.


    841. In respect of this requirement, the regulations may prescribe that
         gains and losses attributable to changes in currency exchange rate
         fluctuations may be required to be recognised under accounting
         standards other than AASB 121.  For example, if AASB 121 is
         replaced subsequent to the enactment of Division 230, and the
         replacement standard provides for retranslation, such a replacement
         standard would be expected to be prescribed by the regulations as
         being a relevant accounting standard.  Gains and losses
         attributable to changes in currency exchange rates which arise from
         relevant arrangements will be required to be recognised under such
         a replacement standard.  To the extent to which comparable foreign
         accounting standards require these gains and losses from financial
         arrangements to be recognised in profit or loss, and those amounts
         have not previously been recognised in an equity reserve, this
         requirement will also be satisfied.


    842. Where a general retranslation election applies to an arrangement,
         gains and losses from that arrangement which are attributable to
         changes in currency exchange rates will be recognised under either
         Subdivision 230-D or 775-F of the ITAA 1997.


    843. Whilst Division 775 of the ITAA 1997 could potentially
         apply whenever there is a cessation of an obligation to pay or
         receive foreign currency (or right to receive or pay foreign
         currency), subsection 230-20(2) has the effect of disregarding
         gains and losses arising under Division 775 to the extent they are,
         or will be, included in assessable income or allowable as a
         deduction under Division 230.  A note, following subsections 775-
         15(4) and 775-30(4), clarifies this point.  [Schedule 1, items 2
         and 3]


         Division 230 retranslation arrangements


    844. Where a general retranslation election applies to a financial
         arrangement, its gains and losses attributable to currency exchange
         rate changes will be subject to Division 230 unless:


                . the financial arrangement is subject to an exception that
                  provides that its gains and losses are not subject to
                  Division 230 (discussed in Chapter 2); or


                . the financial arrangement is specifically excluded by
                  subsection 230-270(3) or (4), from having the general
                  retranslation method under Division 230 apply to it.


    845. Where a general retranslation election applies to a relevant
         financial arrangement, the amount taken to be a gain or loss for
         the purposes of Division 230 is determined by AASB 121 or a
         comparable foreign accounting standard.  That gain or loss is the
         amount which AASB 121 or a comparable foreign accounting standard
         requires to be recognised in profit or loss for that financial
         arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-280(1)]


         Retranslation method under Division 775 of the ITAA 1997


    846. An arrangement to which the general retranslation election applies
         will have those gains and losses attributable to currency exchange
         rate changes subject to Subdivision 775-F of the ITAA 1997 if it
         is:


                . a financial arrangement whose gains and losses are not
                  subject to Division 230 (as set out in Subdivision 230-H
                  and explained in Chapter 2); or


                . an arrangement, which constitutes a right and/or an
                  obligation to receive or provide foreign currency, which
                  is not a financial arrangement.


         [Schedule 1, item 6, Subdivision 775-F]


    847. Where Subdivision 775-F of the ITAA 1997 applies to an arrangement
         to which the general retranslation election applies, the amount
         taken to be a forex realisation gain or loss for the purposes of
         that Division is also determined by AASB 121 or a comparable
         foreign accounting standard.  The gain or loss taken to be made is
         the amount attributable to changes in currency exchange rates in
         respect of that arrangement which is required by AASB 121 (or a
         comparable foreign accounting standard) to be recognised in profit
         or loss for that arrangement.  This gain or loss will be recognised
         under new forex realisation event 9 contained in Subdivision 775-F
         of the ITAA 1997.  [Schedule 1, item 6, section 775-305]


The general retranslation election ceases to apply


         Cease to meet eligibility requirements


    848. The general retranslation election ceases to have effect in respect
         of all relevant arrangements from the start of any income year
         during which the taxpayer ceases to be eligible under subsection
         230-220(2) to make the election.  This may occur if, for example,
         the taxpayer no longer prepares its reports in accordance with the
         relevant accounting standards, or it no longer satisfies the
         requirement that the reports are audited (see Chapter 5).
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-285(1)]


    849. The cessation of the general retranslation election in these
         circumstances does not prevent a fresh election being made should
         the eligibility requirements once again be satisfied.  However, a
         subsequent general retranslation election will apply only to those
         relevant arrangements the taxpayer starts to have in the year the
         election is remade, or in subsequent income years.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-285(2)]


         Cease to meet recognition requirements


    850. The general retranslation election will cease to apply to a
         particular arrangement from the start of any income year where:


                . the arrangement is no longer recognised in financial
                  reports that meet the relevant accounting and auditing
                  requirements discussed in Chapter 5; or


                . in relation to the arrangement, amounts attributable to
                  changes in currency exchange rates are no longer required
                  by the relevant accounting standard to be recognised in
                  profit or loss in the financial reports.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-285(3), item 6, subsection 775-
         310(1)]


    851. Where the general retranslation election ceases to apply to an
         arrangement, the election cannot subsequently reapply to such an
         arrangement, even where the arrangement later satisfies the
         relevant recognition requirements.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
         230-285(4), item 6, subsection 775-310(2)]


      1. :  A financial arrangement ceases to be recognised in a relevant
         financial report


                Yvee Imports Ltd (Yvee) is a large Australian company that
                imports forensic tools and equipment from various foreign
                sources for law enforcement organisations.  Yvee prepares
                accounts in accordance with Australian accounting standards,
                and has its accounts audited in accordance with the
                Australian auditing standards.


                Yvee has various foreign currency denominated financial
                arrangements in respect of which it is required to recognise
                amounts in profit or loss in its financial reports, in
                accordance with AASB 121.


                Over time, an arrangement that has previously had amounts in
                respect of currency exchange changes recognised under AASB
                121 diminished in value such that it was no longer
                recognised in the financial reports, under the accounting
                practice regarding materiality.


                From the start of the income year in which the financial
                arrangement was no longer recognised in the financial
                reports, the elective retranslation method ceased to apply
                to this particular arrangement of Yvee.  Although the
                retranslation method no longer applies to this arrangement,
                any gains and losses attributable to currency exchange rate
                changes will be recognised under the accruals or realisation
                methods.


                Note:  Yvee will continue to apply the retranslation method
                to the remainder of its arrangements that satisfy the
                relevant criteria.


         Balancing adjustment under Division 230 where the general
         retranslation election ceases to apply


    852. When the general retranslation election ceases to apply to a
         Division 230 financial arrangement, a balancing adjustment is
         required to be made in respect of that financial arrangement.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-290(1) and (3)]


    853. The balancing adjustment is to be made in accordance with the
         balancing adjustment requirements set out in Subdivision 230-G
         (see Chapter 10).  The balancing adjustment is:


                . calculated on the assumption that the financial
                  arrangement is disposed of when the general retranslation
                  method ceases to apply (at the start of the income year in
                  which the relevant requirements are failed) for its fair
                  value at that time; and


                . is limited to the extent to which the balancing adjustment
                  so calculated is reasonably attributable to a 'currency
                  exchange rate effect'.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-290(2) and (4)]


    854. The relevant financial arrangement is taken to be reacquired for
         its fair value at the time the election ceased to apply.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsection 230-290(5)]


    855. A currency exchange rate effect is defined in the ITAA 1997 to mean
         any currency exchange rate fluctuations or the difference between
         an agreed currency exchange rate for a future time and the
         applicable currency exchange rate at that time.  This ensures that
         only gains and losses attributable to changes in currency exchange
         rates are taken into account at the time of the deemed disposal
         when the general retranslation election ceases to apply to the
         relevant financial arrangement.


    856. As the retranslation method will no longer apply to such a
         financial arrangement, the other tax-timing methods need to be
         considered in respect of that arrangement.


         Consequences under Division 775 of the ITAA 1997 where the general
         retranslation method ceases to apply


    857. When the general retranslation method ceases to apply to an
         arrangement that is being retranslated under Subdivision 775-F of
         the ITAA 1997, the taxpayer will be taken to have:


                . disposed of the relevant arrangement immediately prior to
                  the time the general retranslation election is taken to
                  cease to have effect or ceases to apply to that
                  arrangement for its fair value at that time; and


                . reacquired the arrangement immediately after the time the
                  general retranslation election is taken to cease to have
                  effect or ceases to apply to it for that same value.


         [Schedule 1, item 6, section 775-315]


    858. Any difference between the retranslated value of the arrangement at
         the time it was last retranslated and the time immediately prior to
         the election ceasing, will be recognised as a gain or a loss under
         'forex realisation event 9'.  [Schedule 1, item 6, sections 775-305
         and 775-315]


    859. For the purposes of Division 775 of the ITAA 1997, any future forex
         realisation gains or losses arising from the reacquired arrangement
         will be determined under the general provisions of Division 775.


Qualifying forex account election


         Election requirements


    860. Instead of making a general retranslation election, a taxpayer may
         elect to apply the retranslation method to one or more of its
         financial arrangements that meet the definition of a qualifying
         forex account.  This qualifying forex account election can only be
         made where a general retranslation election does not apply to that
         financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-255(3)]


    861. Existing elections that apply to qualifying forex accounts under
         Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA 1997 will cease to apply to any
         account to which a general retranslation election or a qualifying
         forex account election applies.  [Schedule 1, item 5, subsection
         775-270(1A)]


         Qualifying forex account


    862. A qualifying forex account is a foreign currency denominated
         account which has the primary purpose of facilitating transactions
         or is a credit card account.  [Schedule 1, item 112, definition of
         'qualifying forex account' in subsection 995-1(1)]


    863. The current restriction which limits 'qualifying forex accounts' to
         accounts held with an 'ADI' (authorised deposit-taking institution)
         as defined in the ITAA 1997 will be removed [Schedule 1, item 112,
         definition of 'qualifying forex account' in subsection 995-1(1)].
         In a general sense, the limitation in the existing law has meant
         that only accounts held with banks and financial institutions were
         able to be retranslated under Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA 1997.


    864. The effect of this change, which is to have effect (in certain
         circumstances) from 1 July 2003, is to broaden the category of
         accounts which may be subject to foreign exchange retranslation
         treatment under Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA 1997 and under the
         new provisions contained in Subdivision 230-D.  Refer to Chapter 11
         for more detail on the changed application of the retranslation
         election under Division 775.


         The scope of the qualifying forex account election


    865. Where a qualifying forex account election is made in respect of a
         financial arrangement that is a 'qualifying forex account', it will
         apply to determine all gains and losses attributable to changes in
         currency exchange rates from that account.


    866. If a taxpayer makes a qualifying forex account election before they
         start to have the financial arrangement that is a qualifying forex
         account, then the retranslation method applies from the time the
         taxpayer starts to hold that account.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-255(4)(a)]


    867. If the taxpayer already held the financial arrangement prior to
         making the election, the retranslation method will apply from the
         start of the year in which the taxpayer made that election
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-255(4)(b)].  In these
         circumstances, the taxpayer will be required to make a balancing
         adjustment in accordance with Subdivision 230-G calculated as if
         the taxpayer had ceased to have the arrangement for its fair value
         at the time when the election started to apply to the arrangement.
         However, the balancing adjustment will only recognise an amount to
         the extent it is reasonably attributable to a currency exchange
         rate effect [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-275].


         Qualifying forex accounts which are held prior to the commencement
         of Division 230


    868. Until the lodgment date of the first income year in which Division
         230 first applies, a taxpayer can elect to have Division 230 apply
         to all existing financial arrangements.  For more information on
         this refer to Chapter 13.  [Schedule 1, Part 3, subitem 104(2)]


    869. A balancing adjustment is required for all existing financial
         arrangements where this transactional election is made.  This
         includes existing financial arrangements which meet the definition
         of a qualifying forex account.  [Schedule 1, Part 3, subitem
         104(12)]


    870. Generally, there will be only a small (if any) balancing adjustment
         required for most taxpayers already retranslating their existing
         qualifying forex accounts under Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA 1997.
          This is because the retranslation calculation under Subdivision
         775-E should have already brought to account gains and losses
         attributable to changes in currency exchange rates arising from the
         account up until the end of the immediately preceding income year.


    871. A balancing adjustment for an existing qualifying forex account
         that has not been subject to the retranslation election under
         Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA 1997 may consist of an amount which
         is due to currency exchange rate changes as these gains and losses
         may not have been previously recognised under Division 775 of the
         ITAA 1997.  [Schedule 1, Part 3, subitem 104(12)]


         When a qualifying forex account election will cease to apply


    872. A qualifying forex account election will cease to apply to a
         financial arrangement from the start of an income year during
         which:


                . the financial arrangement stops being a qualifying forex
                  account; or


                . the taxpayer makes a general retranslation election under
                  subsection 230-255(1) that applies to that account.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-285(5)]


    873. Where a qualifying forex account election ceases to apply to a
         particular financial arrangement, it cannot subsequently reapply to
         that arrangement even if the relevant requirements begin to be
         satisfied once more in relation to that arrangement.  (Refer to
         Chapter 5 for further discussion of this point.)  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-285(6)]


         A balancing adjustment under Division 230 where the qualifying
         forex account election ceases to apply


    874. When a qualifying forex account election ceases to apply, a
         balancing adjustment is required to be made in the same manner and
         with the same consequences as for those financial arrangements for
         which a general retranslation election ceases to apply under
         Division 230 (see paragraphs 7.47 to 7.51).  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-290(3) to (5)]


Foreign exchange retranslation elections are irrevocable


    875. A general retranslation election or qualifying forex account
         election cannot be revoked.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         255(5)]


    876. However, a general retranslation election may cease to apply (as
         discussed in paragraphs 7.43 and 7.46).  Where this happens, a
         taxpayer may make a new election when the conditions for making a
         general retranslation election are subsequently satisfied.  The new
         election will only apply to those arrangements the taxpayer starts
         to have in, or after, the year in which the election is remade that
         were not previously subject to such an election (see Chapter 5).
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-285(2)]


    877. Once a qualifying forex account election ceases to apply to a
         financial arrangement, it cannot subsequently reapply to that
         arrangement.


Interaction with other tax-timing methods in Division 230


    878. If a financial arrangement is subject to a fair value election, any
         gains or losses attributable to changes in currency exchange rates
         will be brought to account under that method [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-40(6)(a)].  The retranslation method will not apply
         (despite any election that has been made) because the fair value
         method recognises changes in fair value between two points in time.
          Any changes attributable to currency exchange rate movements are
         also recognised under the fair value method.


    879. To the extent to which a hedging financial arrangement election
         applies to a financial arrangement (see Chapter 8), the
         retranslation method has no application [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-40(6)(b)].  Gains and losses from that financial
         arrangement will be determined under the hedging financial
         arrangements method.


    880. If an election to rely on financial reports applies to a financial
         arrangement, the retranslation method does not apply [Schedule 1,
         item 1, paragraph 230-40(6)(c)].  The financial reports method
         broadly recognises gains and losses from financial arrangements
         based on the method used in an entity's financial reports to
         recognise those amounts.  To the extent to which AASB 121 applies
         to a financial arrangement, gains and losses required to be
         recognised under that standard will be recognised under the
         financial reports method.  As a result the retranslation method
         will have no application.


    881. In a hierarchical sense, these are the most fundamental exclusions
         from the retranslation method, other than the exceptions specified
         within the method itself which have been detailed above.


    882. In the absence of any elective tax-timing method (including the
         retranslation method) applying to a financial arrangement, any gain
         or loss attributable to changes in currency exchange rates will be
         brought to account under the accruals or realisation methods.  This
         result will be achieved through the combined operation of the
         accruals and realisation rules in Division 230, and the translation
         rules in Subdivisions 960-C and 960-D of the ITAA 1997.


    883. Where the accruals method applies, financial benefits provided or
         received under a financial arrangement which are denominated in a
         particular foreign currency are not translated into Australian
         currency before calculating the sufficiently certain overall gain
         or loss from the arrangement.  This is because the rule that
         ordinarily requires elements in a calculation to be first
         translated to Australian currency (or the relevant functional
         currency) before the calculation is conducted (in subsections 960-
         50(4) and 960-80(4) of the ITAA 1997), does not apply to amounts
         worked out under the accruals method in Division 230.  Therefore,
         any amounts attributable to changes in currency exchange rates will
         be included in the running balance adjustment under section 230-175
         or the balancing adjustment under section 230-445.  For further
         discussion see Chapter 11.  [Schedule 1, item 28, definition of
         'special accrual amount' in subsection 995-1(1)]


    884. The retranslation method is intended to work in tandem with the
         accruals and realisation methods.  The retranslation method
         operates to recognise gains and losses attributable to changes in
         currency exchange rates.  The accruals and realisation methods will
         apply to recognise those gains and losses that may arise from the
         financial arrangement which are not due to currency exchange rate
         fluctuations.  See Examples 7.2 and 7.3.


      1. :  No foreign exchange retranslation election


                A Co acquires a US dollar (US$) denominated promissory note
                with a face value of US$100,000 for a cost of US$98,550.
                Assume the note is acquired on the first day of A Co's
                income year and that the promissory note matures in three
                years time.


                A Co has not made a foreign exchange retranslation election,
                hedging financial arrangement election, fair value election
                or election to rely on financial reports under Division 230
                in relation to the promissory note.  A Co has also not made
                a functional currency election under Subdivision 960-D of
                the ITAA 1997.


                The provisions in Subdivision 960-C of the ITAA 1997 which
                require foreign currency amounts to be translated into
                Australian dollars will apply for the US$ denominated
                amounts.


                The relevant US$/A$ exchange rate prevailing:

                . at the time the promissory note is acquired, is 0.75;
                . at the end of year 1, is 0.73;
                . at the end of year 2, is 0.76; and

              . at the end of year 3, is 0.78.


                The promissory note is a financial arrangement, as the only
                rights and obligations A Co has under the promissory note is
                its right to receive US$100,000, thus satisfying the test
                for a cash-settlable financial arrangement (section 230-45).


                A Co pays the US$98,550 when the promissory note is
                acquired.


                The discount to the face value of the promissory note will
                be brought to account under the accrual rules in Subdivision
                230-B.  The accrual calculation undertaken to determine the
                amount of the relevant gain or loss on the financial
                arrangement to be accrued each year, is to be undertaken in
                the relevant foreign currency (definition of 'special
                accrual amount' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997).


                The gain to be accrued is the US$1,450 discount, as this is
                a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss from the
                financial arrangement (the promissory note) that is known at
                the start time (subsections 230-100(2) and 230-105(1)).  The
                period over which this gain is to be spread, on a
                compounding accruals basis, is the three-year period from
                when A Co acquired the promissory note, to when it matures
                (subsection 230-130(1) and section 230-135).


                Over this three-year arrangement the internal rate of return
                calculates to 0.488 per cent.  This means the gain taken to
                be made from the financial arrangement in each year under
                the accrual rules (subsection 230-140(1)) is as follows:


              . year 1 - US$481;


              . year 2 - US$483; and


              . year 3 - US$486.


                These gains are included in the assessable income of A Co
                (subsection 230-15(1)).  A Co must translate these
                assessable amounts into Australian currency, using the
                translation rules in Subdivision 960-C of the ITAA 1997.
                Assuming A Co does not choose to use any alternate
                translation rules allowed in Schedule 2 to the ITAA 1997,
                (such as a relevant average exchange rate), these amounts
                translate to:


              . A$659 in year 1 (US$481/0.73);


              . A$636 in year 2 (US$483/0.76); and


              . A$623 in year 3 (US$486/0.78).


                However, as the arrangement has come to an end in year 3 (as
                on receipt of the US$100,000, all of A Co's rights and
                obligations under the financial arrangement have ceased), a
                balancing adjustment is made (paragraph 230-435(1)(b)).


                The balancing adjustment broadly involves comparing the
                financial benefits and consideration received and paid under
                the financial arrangement, with the gains and losses from
                the financial arrangement assessable or allowable as
                deductions (subsection 230-445(1)).


                Even though the US$98,550 A Co paid, not being an obligation
                persisting when the promissory note is acquired, is not part
                of the financial arrangement, it plays an integral role in
                determining whether A Co has a gain or loss from the
                arrangement and therefore is considered to be a financial
                benefit A Co provided under the financial arrangement
                (subsection 230-60(1)).


                As such, under the balancing adjustment, A Co compares (in
                Australian dollar terms, pursuant to subsection 960-50(4) of
                the ITAA 1997), the US$100,000 received (step 1), with the
                US$98,550 paid plus any assessable gains made from the
                financial arrangement, (ie, the accrual amounts) (step 2)
                (subsection 230-445(1)).

|                                   |      |Exchang|      |
|Balancing adjustment (section      |US$   |e rate |A$    |
|230-445)                           |      |US$/A$ |      |
|step 1    |Financial benefit       |100,00|0.78   |128,20|
|          |received under          |0     |       |5     |
|          |arrangement (face value |      |       |      |
|          |of note).               |      |       |      |
|step 2    |Financial benefit taken |98,550|0.75   |131,40|
|          |to be provided under    |      |       |0     |
|          |arrangement (cost of    |      |       |      |
|          |note)                   |      |       |      |
|          |plus                    |      |       |      |
|          |assessable gains from   |      |       |      |
|          |arrangement (accrual    |      |       |      |
|          |gains)                  |      |       |      |
|          |year 1                  |      |       |659   |
|          |year 2                  |      |       |636   |
|          |                        |      |       |      |
|          |                        |      |       |132,69|
|          |                        |      |       |5     |
|step 3    |Excess of step 2 over   |      |       |(4,490|
|          |step 1 is a loss made   |      |       |)     |
|          |from the financial      |      |       |      |
|          |arrangement.            |      |       |      |


                This loss of A$4,490, calculated under the balancing
                adjustment, is taken to be a loss made from the financial
                arrangement, and deductible in year 3 (subsections 230-
                445(1) and 230-15(2)).


                Accordingly, the tax treatment of A Co's gains and losses
                from its promissory note in total is:


              . year 1 - A$659 assessable gain;


              . year 2 - A$636 assessable gain;


              . year 3 -  A$4,490 allowable deduction;


                            comprised of:


                            A$623 assessable gain and A$5,113 allowable
                            deduction.


              . NET - A$3,195 deductible loss.


                A Co's net position is a deductible loss of A$3,195.  This
                is equal to the difference, in Australian dollar terms, of
                the amount paid for the promissory note (A$131,400), and the
                amount received on its maturity (A$128,205).


      2. :  Foreign exchange retranslation election


                Assume the facts are the same as for Example 7.2, but that A
                Co has made a valid retranslation election.


                The calculation of the gain or loss to be accrued will be
                the same.


                In addition, any foreign exchange gains and losses will be
                calculated each year under the retranslation method.  Under
                AASB 121, the carrying amount of A Co's promissory note will
                be translated into Australian dollar currency at the date it
                was acquired, and at subsequent recording dates, with any
                exchange differences required to be recognised in profit or
                loss.  Under the retranslation method, these amounts will be
                taken to be gains or losses made from the financial
                arrangement (subsection 230-280(1)).


                It is assumed that A Co has been discounting its promissory
                note for financial accounting purposes using the effective
                interest rate method, on the same basis as the accrual
                calculations discussed in Example 7.2.


                In the relevant years, the amount required by AASB 121 to be
                recognised in profit or loss is therefore:

|       |                        |Foreign exchange       |
|Year   |Carrying value (US$)    |retranslation gain /   |
|       |                        |(loss) (A$)            |
|       |                        |(difference between    |
|       |                        |carrying value at      |
|       |                        |closing and opening    |
|       |                        |rates)                 |
|1      |98,550                  |3,600                  |
|       |                        |(US$98,550  ×  (1/0.73 |
|       |                        |-  1/0.75))            |
|2      |99,031                  |(5,355)                |
|       |(98,550 plus 481 accrual|(US$99,031  ×  (1/0.76 |
|       |gain from year 1 - see  |-  1/0.73))            |
|       |Example 7.2)            |                       |
|3      |99,514                  |(3,357)                |
|       |(99,031 plus 483 accrual|(US$99,514  ×  (1/0.78 |
|       |gain from year 2 - see  |-  1/0.76))            |
|       |Example 7.2)            |                       |


                Therefore, under the retranslation method, a gain of A$3,600
                will be assessable in year 1, and losses of A$5,355 and
                A$3,357 will be deductible in years 2 and 3 respectively
                (subsections 230-280(1) and 230-15(1) and (2)).


                In addition, as with Example 7.2, a balancing adjustment is
                required in year 3, as at the end of year 3 the financial
                arrangement is realised.  Under the balancing adjustment,
                compare (in Australian dollar terms, pursuant to subsection
                960-50(4) of the ITAA 1997), the US$100,000 received plus
                any deductible losses made from the financial arrangement
                (ie, any foreign exchange retranslation losses) (step 1),
                with the US$98,550 paid plus any assessable gains made from
                the financial arrangement, (ie, any accrual gains plus any
                foreign exchange retranslation gains) (step 2)
                (subsection 230-445(1)).

|       |                           |      |Exchange|      |
|Step   |Balancing adjustment       |US$   |rate    |A$    |
|       |(section 230-445)          |      |US$/A$  |      |
|step 1 |Financial benefit received |100,00|0.78    |128,20|
|       |under arrangement (face    |0     |        |5     |
|       |value of note)             |      |        |      |
|       |plus                       |      |        |      |
|       |Deductible losses from     |      |        |      |
|       |arrangement:               |      |        |      |
|       |year 2 retranslation loss  |      |        |5,355 |
|       |Total of step 1            |      |        |133,56|
|       |                           |      |        |0     |
|       |                           |      |        |      |
|step 2 |Financial benefit taken to |98,550|0.75    |131,40|
|       |be provided under          |      |        |0     |
|       |arrangement (cost of note) |      |        |      |
|       |plus                       |      |        |      |
|       |Assessable gains from      |      |        |      |
|       |arrangement                |      |        |      |
|       |year 1 retranslation gain  |      |        |3600  |
|       |year 1 accrual gain (per   |      |        |659   |
|       |Example 7.2)               |      |        |      |
|       |year 2 accrual gain (per   |      |        |636   |
|       |Example 7.2)               |      |        |      |
|       |Total of step 2            |      |        |136,29|
|       |                           |      |        |5     |
|step 3 |Excess of step 2 over step |      |        |(2,735|
|       |1 is a loss made from the  |      |        |)     |
|       |arrangement                |      |        |      |


                The A$2,735 is deductible to A Co in year 3 (subsections 230-
                445(1) and 15(2)).

                The combined effect for A Co of an application of both the
                accrual and retranslation methodologies, and the balancing
                adjustment is that the total gain or loss calculated in the
                relevant years from the promissory note is:

              . year 1 - A$4,259 gain
                (comprised of a A$3600 retranslation gain, plus A$659
                accrual gain, per Example 7.2);

              . year 2 - A$4,719 loss
                (comprised of a A$5,355 retranslation loss, plus A$636
                accrual gain, per Example 7.2);

              . year 3 - A$2,735 loss
                (comprised of a A$3,357 notional retranslation loss, plus
                A$623 notional accrual gain, per Example 7.2, plus A$1
                balancing adjustment loss);

              . NET - A$3,195 deductible loss.

                As in Example 7.2, A Co's net position is a deductible loss
                of A$3,195.



    885. Chapter 8
The elective hedging financial arrangements method

Outline of chapter


    886. This chapter outlines the elective tax-hedge rules.  The chapter
         explains:


                . the eligibility requirements that entities need to satisfy
                  if they wish to make use of the elective tax-hedge rules;
                  and


                . the rationale, structure and operation of the tax-hedge
                  rules.


Overview of the elective hedging method


    887. Broadly, a financial arrangement is hedged to offset an adverse
         financial impact arising out of a movement in a price or other
         financial variable.


    888. The hedging financial arrangements method is intended to
         facilitate, subject to safeguarding requirements, pre-tax hedging
         decisions.


    889. The approach used to achieve this is to more closely align the tax
         treatment of the hedging financial arrangement with that of the
         item it hedges, thereby improving the degree of post-tax matching
         compared to that under the current tax law.


    890. The elective hedging method seeks to remove distorting tax mismatch
         effects on pre-tax hedging activity by changing the tax-timing and
         tax-status of the hedging financial arrangement and more closely
         matching it with that of the hedged item.


    891. Broadly, the tax hedge rules reduce post-tax mismatch by ensuring
         that gains and losses from hedging financial arrangements are
         included in taxable income at the same time that the gains or
         losses made from the hedged item or items are included in taxable
         income.


    892. Similarly, the tax classification or status of a hedging financial
         arrangement gain or loss is matched to that of the hedged item.
         For example, if the hedged item is subject to capital gains tax
         (CGT) the hedging financial arrangement will also be subject to CGT
         rather than being on revenue account.


Context of amendments


    893. Hedging activity is ordinarily conducted by businesses on a pre-tax
         basis and is designed to manage, reduce or eliminate risk and
         uncertainty associated with the taxpayer's financial exposures
         created when anticipating the purchase, sale or production of
         commodities and other items, or when having financial assets or
         liabilities.  Derivative instruments (such as swaps, options or
         forward contracts) are often the means used to hedge such
         exposures.


    894. A hedging transaction undertaken in respect of the financial risk
         arising from an underlying item is effective to the extent that it
         offsets the movements in an underlying transaction.  Generally, a
         hedging transaction will offset an adverse financial impact, in
         respect of a hedged item, arising out of a movement in a price or
         other financial variable.


    895. Subdivision 230-E (hedging financial arrangements method) seeks to
         appropriately facilitate, subject to safeguarding requirements, pre-
         tax hedging decisions.  The approach used to achieve this is to
         more closely align the tax treatment of the hedging financial
         arrangement with that of the items they hedge, thereby improving
         the degree of post-tax matching.  Under current tax law,
         comprehensive tax-hedge rules do not exist, and there has been
         considerable uncertainty about when gains and losses from specific
         hedging instruments are recognised.  For instance, uncertainty
         occurs in situations where rolling hedges are used as hedging
         instruments.  In such situations, taxpayers have not known whether
         the point of termination of one hedging instrument is, or is not,
         to be regarded as a taxing point for the gain or loss on that
         particular hedging instrument.


    896. The tax system is differentiated as to tax treatments.  For
         instance, some financial arrangements are taxed on a realisation
         basis and some are taxed on an accruals basis.  If a financial
         arrangement that is subject to the former basis is used to hedge a
         risk in relation to an arrangement that is subject to the latter, a
         tax mismatch may arise.  A tax mismatch could also occur where a
         gain or loss in respect of the financial arrangement is brought to
         account as assessable income or an allowable deduction (ie, taxed
         on 'revenue account') but the gain or loss on the underlying item
         (referred to as a 'hedged item') is brought to account as a capital
         gain or a capital loss (ie, taxed on capital account).


    897. The outcome of a tax mismatch is that the effectiveness of pre-tax
         hedging activity is reduced on an after-tax basis.  Such mismatches
         may produce anomalous tax outcomes, distort decision-making,
         disrupt the ability of taxpayers to reduce or manage risk and, in
         general, impede efficiency of risk allocation and management.


    898. In appropriate circumstances, tax-hedge rules remove distorting tax
         mismatch effects on pre-tax hedging activity by changing the way
         that the hedging financial arrangement would have been taxed, to a
         way that is consistent with the tax treatment of the hedged item.
         That is, reducing the post-tax mismatch is achieved by altering the
         tax-timing and tax-status of the hedging financial arrangement and
         more closely matching it with that of the hedged item.


    899. The tax-hedge rules broadly align with the purpose of the hedging
         activity.  At the same time, if the tax treatment of a hedging
         financial arrangement depends only on the purpose of the taxpayer
         without safeguards, there is the potential for an inappropriate
         level of selectivity of tax treatment.  It appears that the
         rigorous hedge criteria set out in Australian Accounting Standard
         AASB 139 Financial Instruments:  Recognition and Measurement (AASB
         139) also reflect a concern about selectivity.  Similarly, tax-
         hedge rules based solely on purpose have the potential to create
         administrative difficulties.  Without adequate safeguards, the
         ability to administer tax-hedge rules would be severely
         constrained.


    900. Tax-hedge rules that draw heavily on financial accounting concepts
         will provide greater clarity and neutrality for the taxation of
         gains or losses arising from arrangements that are part of hedging
         relationships and will contribute to lower overall compliance
         costs.  Existing uncertainties over relevant tax treatments will be
         reduced, risk management will be enhanced, and there will be less
         scope for deferral possibilities arising from adverse selection.


    901. Greater matching between the taxation of the hedging financial
         arrangement and the underlying or hedged item may, however, not
         always lead to greater consistency between the taxation and
         financial accounting treatment of the hedging financial
         arrangement.  The reason is that taxation treatment of the hedged
         item may be different to the financial accounting treatment of the
         item.  In this circumstance, the matching process may give rise to
         a different tax allocation of hedge gains and losses over time, to
         the financial accounting allocation.


    902. Further, financial accounting does not have some of the
         distinctions found in the income tax law, such as:


                . the different treatment of capital and revenue gains and
                  losses;


                . income which is assessable in some cases and not in
                  others; and


                . expenses which are deductible in some cases and not in
                  others.


    903. The tax-hedge provisions nevertheless are designed to reduce the
         degree of tax mismatches which might otherwise occur in a tax,
         albeit not in a financial accounting, context.  Reducing tax
         mismatches that go beyond what financial accounting does (ie,
         principally matching the time at which the hedging instrument and
         hedged item are recognised), increases the amount of rules, the
         level of complexity and the need for integrity requirements.  The
         proposed tax-hedge rules represent a balancing of these factors.


Summary of new law


    904. The proposed tax-hedge rules are designed to facilitate efficient
         management of financial risk by reducing post-tax mismatches where
         hedging takes place.  At the same time, the rules seek to minimise
         tax deferral and tax motivated practices.


    905. These objectives are given effect by allowing entities, subject to
         proposed Division 230, to elect tax-hedge treatment in respect of
         all their financial arrangements whose purpose is to hedge against
         risk.  The election can be made if certain requirements are met.
         In broad terms these requirements are that:


                . each financial arrangement must either be a 'derivative
                  financial arrangement' or a 'foreign currency hedge' (as
                  defined);


                . the entity must satisfy documentation requirements that
                  build on those contained in AASB 139;


                . the entity prepares a financial report in accordance with
                  appropriate accounting standards and the report is
                  appropriately audited;


                . the hedging of the relevant risk must meet specified tests
                  of effectiveness; and


                . subject to the satisfaction of certain additional
                  requirements, the taxpayer can adopt hedge tax treatment
                  in respect of a limited number of specific hedging
                  financial arrangements that do not meet the financial
                  accounting standard hedge requirements.


    906. Once a valid hedging financial arrangement election is made, an
         entity is generally able to allocate gains and losses from a
         hedging financial arrangement on an objective, fair and reasonable
         basis.  The allocation must correspond with the basis on which
         gains, losses or other amounts in relation to the hedged item or
         items are allocated for tax purposes (referred to as 'tax-timing
         matching').  The entity will, in many cases, also be able to align
         the tax classification of the hedging financial arrangement with
         that of the hedged item (referred to as 'tax-status matching').


    907. The tax-hedge rules also provide that, under certain circumstances,
         the hedging financial arrangement ceases to be held and is
         reacquired for its then fair value.  Proposed Division 230, other
         than the tax-hedge rules, is then applied to bring to account gains
         or losses made from the reacquired financial arrangement.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|Elective tax-hedge rules|There are no            |
|will potentially be     |comprehensive tax-hedge |
|available to all        |rules in the existing   |
|entities that adopt and |law.                    |
|comply with the         |                        |
|requirements of relevant|                        |
|accounting standards and|                        |
|have audited financial  |                        |
|accounts.               |                        |
|The election applies to |                        |
|all hedging financial   |                        |
|arrangements of the     |                        |
|entity that meet        |                        |
|specified tests.        |                        |


Detailed explanation of new law


    908. Tax-hedge treatment is limited to 'hedging financial arrangements'
         to which the hedging financial arrangement election apply [Schedule
         1, item 1, sections 230-300 and 230-325].  A 'hedging financial
         arrangement' is defined as a financial arrangement that is a
         'derivative financial arrangement' or a 'foreign currency hedge'
         and meets certain purposive and other tests [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsections 230-335(1) and (3)].


    909. Generally, to be a hedging financial arrangement, the arrangement
         must be a hedging instrument for financial accounting purposes
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(1)].  However, a hedging
         financial arrangement can exist, in limited circumstances, even if
         particular aspects of the financial accounting tests are not
         satisfied [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(3)], provided
         that the taxpayer meets certain record-keeping requirements
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-355(5)] or, in limited
         circumstances, where the Commissioner of Taxation (Commissioner)
         exercises a discretion to treat a financial arrangement as a
         hedging financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-345]
         or to treat certain requirements as having been met [Schedule 1,
         item 1, section 230-380].


    910. The hedged item does not have to be a financial arrangement.
         Neither does it have to be a current transaction.  It can be an
         existing asset or liability, a firm commitment, a highly probable
         future transaction or a net investment in a foreign operation.  It
         can also be a part of one of these things.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-335(10)]


    911. In addition, an anticipated dividend from a connected entity
         that is non-assessable non-exempt income under section 23AJ of the
         Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (ITAA 1936), can be a hedged item
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(11)] and the regulations
         may prescribe something to be a hedged item [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-335(10)(f)].


    912. Tax-hedge treatment is obtained by making a 'hedging financial
         arrangement election' which will apply to all the entity's hedging
         financial arrangements [Schedule 1, item 1, sections 230-315 and
         230-325].  As the election requirements are common to various
         elective regimes in Division 230, Chapter 5 explains these
         requirements in more detail.


    913. As a major objective for tax-hedge rules is to reduce tax
         mismatches, there may be numerous hedging financial arrangements
         for which entities seek tax-hedge treatment.  The 'one-in, all-in'
         election means that an entity does not have to make a separate
         election for each of the arrangements.  It also means that there is
         less opportunity for picking and choosing the situations in which
         the tax-hedge rules will be applied (so as to access the changed
         tax treatment that hedge tax rules allow); without the requirement
         to apply the tax-hedge rules on a one-in, all-in basis,
         administration of the rules would potentially be more difficult.


         Accounting and auditing requirement


    914. There are two basic requirements that have to be satisfied before
         being able to make a valid hedging financial arrangement election
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-315(2)]:


                . the entity, or a connected entity of that entity, must
                  prepare a financial report for the relevant income year in
                  accordance with Australian or comparable accounting
                  standards; and


                . the report is either required by Australian or comparable
                  foreign law to be audited in accordance with relevant
                  auditing standards or, where there is no requirement to
                  apply the auditing standards, the report is in fact
                  audited in accordance with those standards.


         These requirements are common to all elective regimes in Division
         230.  Chapter 5 explains in more detail the generic requirements
         and operation of the hedging financial arrangement election and
         other elections that may be made under Division 230.


         Arrangements to which the election applies


    915. Once a valid hedging financial arrangement election has been made,
         it applies to relevant hedging financial arrangements which are
         first held in the income year in which the election is made or in
         later income years.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-325]


    916. For the hedging financial arrangement method to apply, the hedging
         financial arrangement must also satisfy requirements in relation to
         the following three matters:


                . documentation of the hedging relationship [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, section 230-355];


                . determining the basis of the tax allocation of the gains
                  and losses from the hedging financial arrangement
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-360]; and


                . effectiveness of the hedge [Schedule 1, item 1, section
                  230-365].


         Arrangements to which the election does not apply


    917. Generally, the election will not apply to financial arrangements
         that are equity interests or rights to receive or provide such
         equity interests [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-330(1)].
         However, there is an exception to this rule, namely where the
         taxpayer is the issuer of a hedging financial arrangement that is
         an equity interest and a foreign currency hedge [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-330(2)].


    918. Further, if no election is made under subsection 230-455(7) (about
         electing to have Division 230 apply to all the taxpayer's financial
         arrangements), the hedging financial arrangement election will not
         apply to a financial arrangement if the taxpayer is an individual
         or an entity that satisfies the relevant threshold test in
         subsections 230-455(2), (3) or (4) and the arrangement is a
         qualifying security that has a remaining term, after acquisition,
         of more than 12 months [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-330(3)].




    919. Where a hedging financial arrangement election is made by a head
         company of a consolidated group or multiple entry consolidated
         group (MEC group), the election can specify that it does not apply
         to financial arrangements in relation to the life insurance
         business carried on by a member of the consolidated or MEC group
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-330(4)].  Nor will the election
         apply to financial arrangements associated with a business of a
         kind which may be specified by regulation [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-330(5)].  See Chapter 5 for further discussion on
         this.


         Allocating gains or losses


    920. If the hedging financial arrangement election applies, the gain or
         loss from the hedging financial arrangement is (subject to any
         disqualifying condition) recognised for income tax purposes on the
         following basis:


                . the gain or loss is allocated over income years according
                  to the basis determined and set out in the record
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-300(3), 230-360(1)
                  and (2)]; and


                . where the tax classification of the hedged item is listed
                  in the table in subsection 230-310(4), the gain or loss is
                  treated in accordance with that table [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-310(4)].


    921. This tax allocation and tax classification is subject to certain
         exceptions.  In particular, the treatment specified above may not
         continue to apply where there is an event within the allocation
         period that has the effect of treating the hedging financial
         arrangement as ceasing to be held and being reacquired for its then
         fair value.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-300(5) and section
         230-305]


         Transitional election


    922. Transitional election rules are explained in Chapter 13.
         Essentially, the elective hedging financial arrangements method is
         only available for hedging arrangements that the taxpayer has at
         the time of commencement of Division 230 where a transitional
         election is made and where specific record-keeping requirements are
         met.  However, tax-status matching is not available to hedging
         arrangements that the taxpayer has at the time of commencement of
         Division 230.  What this means is that section 230-310 does not
         apply to hedging financial arrangements that exist at the time the
         taxpayer first commences to apply the Division.  [Schedule 1,
         subitems 104(9) and (10)]


    923. The rest of this chapter explains the tax-hedge method in more
         detail.


Hedging financial arrangements


    924. To be a 'hedging financial arrangement', the arrangement has to be
         either a 'derivative financial arrangement' or a 'foreign currency
         hedge'.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-335]


What is a derivative financial arrangement?


    925. A derivative financial arrangement is a financial arrangement that
         has the following characteristics:


                . its value changes in response to changes in a specified
                  variable or variables; and


                . it requires no net investment, or it requires a subsequent
                  net investment that is smaller than would be required for
                  other types of financial arrangements that would be
                  expected to have a similar response to changes in market
                  factors.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-350(1)]


    926. The note to paragraph 230-350(1)(a) includes as specified variables
         (without limiting the term) an interest rate, credit rating, a
         financial instrument or commodity price, a foreign exchange rate
         and an index.


    927. The Division 230 definition of a derivative financial arrangement
         is very similar to the definition of 'derivative' in AASB 139.
         However, the tax definition of 'derivative financial arrangement'
         also explicitly caters for the situation where there is a
         subsequent net investment in relation to the financial arrangement.
          If there is a substantial net investment after the financial
         arrangement has been entered into, it will not be a derivative
         financial arrangement for the purposes of Division 230.  This is
         different to the AASB 139 definition of a derivative where a
         subsequent (substantial) investment made after the start of the
         arrangement is not a disentitling matter.  The accounting
         definition of derivative focuses on whether there is an initial net
         investment that is of a particular magnitude, rather than any
         subsequent investments.


    928. Where there is a requirement for a net investment, the financial
         arrangement will be a derivative financial arrangement only where
         the amount of the net investment is smaller than that required for
         other types of financial arrangements that are expected to have
         similar responses to changes in market forces.  This means that the
         particular comparison is to be done in relation to the financial
         arrangement being tested under the definition in subsection 230-
         350(1) and contracts or arrangements of a type other than
         derivative financial arrangements.


    929. Typical derivative financial arrangements that are used as hedging
         financial arrangements are swaps, options, futures and forward
         contracts.


What is a foreign currency hedge?


    930. A foreign currency hedge for the purposes of Division 230 is a
         financial arrangement:


                . whose value changes in response to changes in a specified
                  variable or variables;


                . in respect of which there is a requirement for a net
                  investment (whether this be an initial or subsequent net
                  investment) that is not smaller than would be required for
                  other types of financial arrangement that would be
                  expected to have a similar response to changes in market
                  factors (ie, paragraph 230-350(1)(b) is not satisfied);
                  and


                . that hedges a risk in relation to movements in currency
                  exchange rates.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-350(2)]


    931. To be a hedging financial arrangement, a foreign currency hedge,
         amongst other requirements, must have been created, acquired or
         applied for the purpose of hedging a risk or risks in relation to a
         hedged item.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-335(1)(a)]


    932. However, the financial arrangement is not disqualified from being a
         hedging financial arrangement if it is also used for an investment
         or borrowing purpose (ie, for the purpose of financing).  Thus,
         unlike derivative financial arrangements, a foreign currency hedge
         can be a financing arrangement and, reflecting AASB 139, represents
         an exception to the general position that only derivatives can
         obtain hedge tax treatment.


When will a derivative financial arrangement or foreign currency hedge be
treated as a hedging financial arrangement?


    933. There are two ways in which a derivative financial arrangement or
         foreign currency hedge can be a hedging financial arrangement.  The
         first is by the financial accounting route, that is, essentially by
         being a hedging instrument for financial accounting purposes
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(1)].  The second is where
         the financial arrangement is not a hedging instrument for financial
         accounting purposes but meets certain other requirements [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsection 230-335(3)] (explained in paragraphs 8.72 to
         8.78).


    934. A derivative financial arrangement or foreign currency hedge is to
         be treated as a hedging financial arrangement if, in the income
         year in which the rights and/or obligations that comprise the
         relevant financial arrangement are created, acquired or applied:


                . the financial arrangement is created, acquired or applied
                  for the purpose of hedging a risk or risks in relation to
                  all or part of an existing asset or liability or, in terms
                  of the accounting standards, a firm commitment, a highly
                  probable forecast transaction or a net investment in a
                  foreign operation  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  335(1)(a)];


                . at the time it is created, acquired or applied the
                  financial arrangement satisfies the requirements of a
                  hedging instrument for the purposes of Australian
                  accounting standards or applicable comparable foreign
                  financial accounting standards [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-335(1)(b)]; and


                . it is recorded as a hedging instrument in the financial
                  report of the entity unless it is a foreign currency
                  hedge, in which case it is recorded in the financial
                  report of a financial accounting consolidated entity in
                  which the entity is included [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-335(1)(c)].


    935. The requirement that a financial arrangement must have been
         created, acquired or applied for the purpose of hedging a risk, or
         risks, in relation to a hedged item, or items, in order to be a
         hedging financial arrangement underpins the hedging relationship
         and the link between the financial arrangement and the hedged item
         or items.  At the same time, this purpose test may be met
         notwithstanding that there is a more important purpose for the
         entity in entering into the arrangement, for example, to manage
         risk at the entity level.


    936. It is also important to note that the link between the hedging
         financial arrangement and the hedged item is at the centre of
         determining effectiveness and the basis of the allocation of the
         hedge gain or loss, as well as of the integrity of hedge accounting
         for tax purposes (and perhaps financial accounting purposes as
         well).


    937. Where, in terms of paragraph 230-335(1)(b) or (c) (or both), the
         accounting requirements relating to a hedging financial arrangement
         are not satisfied through an honest mistake or inadvertence, the
         Commissioner may nevertheless exercise a discretion to treat the
         arrangement as a hedging financial arrangement.  In deciding
         whether to exercise the discretion, the Commissioner shall have
         regard to the entity's documented risk management practices and
         policies, its record-keeping practices, its accounting systems and
         controls, its internal governance processes, the circumstances
         surrounding the mistake or inadvertence, the extent to which the
         accounting standards and the recording requirements are met, and
         the objects of Subdivision 230-E.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-
         345]


    938. Because the scope of this discretion is limited to circumstances
         where there an honest mistake or inadvertence, if a financial
         arrangement is not a hedging instrument for financial accounting
         purposes it can only obtain tax-hedge treatment if it falls within
         the list set out in subsection 230-335(3) (including the
         possibility of inclusion by regulation).


What constitutes the hedging financial arrangement?


    939. Generally, it is the whole of a derivative financial arrangement,
         or a foreign currency hedge, considered in its entirety, that must
         satisfy the requirements for an arrangement to be a hedging
         financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-340].
         However, reflecting various hedging relationships that can be
         designated for the purposes of AASB 139, Subdivision 230-E permits
         a number of variations to this general rule.  In broad terms, to
         the extent that parts of the hedging financial arrangement
         (represented by the relevant financial benefits) satisfy the
         requirements in subsections 230-335(1) or (3), the variations are:


                . the intrinsic value of an options contract can be
                  designated as the hedging financial arrangement ('partial
                  hedges') [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-340(2)];


                . the spot price element of a forward contract that also has
                  an interest element can be designated as the hedging
                  financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
                  340(3)]; or


                . a specified proportion of a financial arrangement can be
                  designated as the hedging financial arrangement
                  ('proportionate hedges') [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-340(4)].


    940. Where one of the above variations leads to a part or a proportion
         of a financial arrangement being treated as a hedging financial
         arrangement, it is taken to be a separate financial arrangement for
         the purposes of Division 230 and the remaining part or proportion
         is also taken to be a separate financial arrangement [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsections 230-335(5) and (6)].  It is therefore possible,
         for example, for the remaining proportion itself to be a hedging
         financial arrangement that hedges a hedged item that is separate
         and distinct to the hedged item being hedged by the other
         proportion.


      1. :  Proportion of a hedging financial arrangement


                Serendipity Co has a highly probable forecast transaction
                under which it is to borrow $90 million in five months.
                Serendipity Co also has a forward rate agreement that would
                be highly effective in offsetting its exposure to an
                increase in interest rates in the next five months.
                However, the notional principal on the forward rate
                agreement is $120 million.


                Serendipity Co may treat $90 million or 75 per cent of the
                forward rate agreement as a hedging financial arrangement in
                relation to the anticipated borrowing, provided that that
                proportion meets the requirements of subsection 230-335(1)
                or (3) in accordance with subsection 230-340(4).  In the
                event that that proportion of the forward rate agreement is
                a hedging financial arrangement, the remaining proportion
                (ie, $30 million or 25 per cent) of the agreement is taken
                to be a separate financial arrangement for the purposes of
                Division 230 (subsection 230-340(5)).


                Further, the remaining proportion could qualify as a hedging
                financial arrangement in relation to another hedged item,
                provided it satisfied the necessary tax-hedge criteria.


    941. It is possible for a financial arrangement to hedge more than one
         type of risk.  However, for Subdivision 230-E purposes, it can only
         qualify as a hedging financial arrangement if the applicable
         financial accounting standards allow the arrangement to be
         designated as a hedge of those risks.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-335(8)]


    942. It is also possible for two or more financial arrangements to hedge
         the same risk or risks.  However, for Subdivision 230-E purposes,
         they may only qualify as hedging financial arrangements if the
         applicable financial accounting standards allow them to be viewed
         in combination and jointly designated as hedging that risk or those
         risks.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(9)]


    943. It should be noted that the conditions in subsections 230-335(8)
         and (9) must be satisfied whether the financial arrangement is one
         that satisfies the financial accounting hedge requirements or is
         one which satisfies the extended rules in subsection 230-335(3).
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-335(8) and (9)]


The hedged item


    944. The hedged item may be an existing asset or liability, a firm
         commitment, a highly probable future transaction or a net
         investment in a foreign operation whose risk is being hedged by the
         particular hedging financial arrangement.  It can also be a part of
         one of these things.  A hedged item can also be prescribed by
         regulations.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(10)]


    945. The terms 'firm commitment', 'highly probable forecast transaction'
         and 'net investment in a foreign operation' all take their meaning
         from the equivalent terms in the Australian accounting standards.
         A firm commitment or highly probable future transaction might, for
         example, be in regard to prospective crops (eg, in future crop
         years) or prospective resources or output (eg, expected gold
         production in a future year).


    946. An anticipated dividend from a connected entity that is non-
         assessable non-exempt income under section 23AJ of the ITAA 1936
         can also be a hedged item.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         335(11)]


Record-keeping requirements


    947. The following are record-keeping requirements that the taxpayer
         must meet in order for a hedging financial arrangement to be
         eligible for tax-hedge treatment:


                . There is a formal designation and documentation of the
                  hedging relationship.  The documentation must include
                  designation of the hedging financial arrangement in
                  respect of which the hedging financial arrangement
                  election applies, and identification of the hedged item or
                  items.  It must also set out the nature of the risk or
                  risks being hedged and how the entity will assess the
                  hedging financial arrangement's effectiveness in
                  offsetting the exposure to changes in the hedged item's
                  fair value, cash flows or foreign currency exposure
                  attributable to the hedged risk or risks.  Further, the
                  record must state the risk management objective and
                  strategy to be followed in acquiring, creating or applying
                  the hedging financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-355(1)].


                . In addition, the record must contain any details that the
                  accounting standards require, by way of documentation, for
                  an arrangement to be recorded in the financial report as a
                  hedging instrument [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                  355(1)(b)].  This is irrespective of whether the hedging
                  financial arrangement is in fact recorded in the financial
                  report as a hedging instrument [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-355(1)].  An example is where a hedging
                  arrangement occurs within a financial reporting period and
                  which is not captured in the financial reports as a
                  hedging arrangement.  The record must contain details for
                  that arrangement that would be required had it been
                  recorded in the financial reports for the relevant period
                  as a hedging arrangement.


                . The record must set out the terms of the determination
                  made about the allocation of the hedging financial
                  arrangement gain or loss over income years [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, paragraph 230-355(1)(c)].  This determination
                  forms the basis of the tax-timing and tax classification
                  of the hedging financial arrangement gains and losses, as
                  discussed in further detail below.


                . The record must set out the risk in respect of the hedged
                  item with sufficient precision and detail that it is
                  clear:


                  - that the risk was hedged by the particular hedging
                    financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
                    355(4)(a)];


                  - the extent to which the risk was hedged [Schedule 1,
                    item 1, paragraph 230-355(4)(b)]; and


                  - that the rights and/or obligations that comprise the
                    hedging financial arrangement were in fact created,
                    acquired or applied for the purpose of hedging the risk
                    [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-355(4)(c)].


    948. This record must be made or be in place at, or soon after, the time
         that the entity creates, acquires or applies the hedging financial
         arrangement  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-355(3)] unless
         regulations provide otherwise [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         355(3)(b)].  For the integrity of the tax-hedge rules, it is
         important that the relevant record in relation to a hedging
         relationship either be in place at the inception of the
         relationship or be made in a reasonably contemporaneous manner.
         Subsection 230-355(3) permits the record to be made soon after the
         relationship starts.  The reason for this short period is to take
         into account administrative and systems processes of the particular
         entity and not to allow designation of the financial arrangement to
         be determined, with the benefit of hindsight, by reference to
         whether it creates a favourable outcome.


    949. The record may consist of one or more documents [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-355(2)].  One of those documents may have been
         brought into existence before the hedging financial arrangement is
         created, acquired or applied.  This allows the record to be based
         on an amalgamation of a hedging policy document that covers a
         number of the details of a type of class of hedging financial
         arrangements that have similar characteristics (eg, swap contracts
         relating to interest rate risk in relation to housing loans) and an
         associated document that contains details of the specific
         arrangement (eg, date, notional principal, currency, term,
         counterparty, transaction number, and hedged item details).  It is
         likely that such an amalgamation would be consistent with record-
         keeping practices with respect to routine or high volume hedges.
         The policy document and associated specific document must together
         meet the record-keeping requirements in section 230-355.


Hedge effectiveness requirement


    950. To maintain tax-hedge treatment while the derivative financial
         arrangement or foreign currency hedge (in relation to a non-
         derivative financial arrangement) is held, the following conditions
         must be met:


                . for the period the hedging financial arrangement is
                  expected to be held, the entity must expect the
                  arrangement to be highly effective (within the meaning of
                  the relevant accounting standards) in achieving offsetting
                  changes in fair value or cash flows attributable to the
                  hedged risk [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-365(a)];


                . the effectiveness of the hedge can be reliably measured,
                  that is, the fair value or cash flows of the hedged item
                  that are attributable to the hedged risk and the fair
                  value of the hedging instrument can be reliably measured
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-365(b)]; and


                . the hedge is assessed on a regular basis in accordance
                  with the relevant accounting standards - at least once in
                  each 12-month period.  The assessment is directed at
                  determining that the hedge will be highly effective in
                  reducing fair value or cash flow exposure in respect of
                  the hedged item or items attributable to the hedged risk
                  for the remainder of the period for which the entity
                  expects to have the hedging financial arrangement
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-365(c)].


    951. The last test does not preclude risk management in relation to a
         particular item or particular portfolio of items.  However, it does
         require an assessment of effective risk reduction in relation to an
         identified item or items for the purposes of helping to establish
         upfront the basis of allocation of gains or losses from the hedging
         financial arrangement.


    952. Where a hedging financial arrangement ceases to be a highly
         effective hedging financial arrangement then, consistent with
         paragraph AG113 of AASB 139, the taxpayer will discontinue hedging
         the hedged item from the last date on which compliance with hedge
         effectiveness was last demonstrated.  Consistent with paragraph
         AG113, in circumstances where a taxpayer is able to identify an
         event or change in circumstance that caused the hedging
         relationship to fail the effectiveness test, and demonstrate that
         the hedge was effective before the event or change in circumstance
         occurred, the taxpayer may discontinue hedging the hedged item from
         the date of the event or change in circumstance.


    953. What is 'highly effective' for the purposes of section 230-365
         depends on the meaning of this term in AASB 139.  Thus, the hedge
         effectiveness must be within the range of 80 per cent to 125 per
         cent, as set out in paragraph AG105 of AASB 139.


    954. If the hedge is not highly effective, item 1(c) in the table in
         section 230-305 will operate in conjunction with section 230-300 to
         provide that:


                . the arrangement ceases to be held for its fair value when
                  the taxpayer makes the assessment that the effectiveness
                  requirement is no longer met;


                . the gain or loss is allocated over income years according
                  to the basis set out in the determination required by
                  subsection 230-360(1); and


                . Division 230 is re-applied to any future gain or loss made
                  from the arrangement as if it had been acquired for its
                  fair value at that time.


    955. Note, however, that if the hedge is highly effective but not
         100 per cent effective, the ineffective portion is not treated
         differently by Subdivision 230-E.  That is, unlike financial
         accounting, the ineffective portion of an otherwise highly
         effective hedging financial arrangement is not disqualified from
         hedge tax treatment under Subdivision 230-E.


    956. Although the effectiveness test can be satisfied for tax purposes
         by reference to compliance with the effectiveness test in the
         relevant accounting standards, there will be times when this will
         not be sufficient.  One example is where the taxpayer accounting
         and income tax years do not align.  Where this is the case
         taxpayers will be required to undertake additional effectiveness
         testing so as to satisfy the effectiveness test in section 230-365.


Can a financial arrangement be a hedging financial arrangement if it is not
an accounting hedging instrument?


    957. The purposive nature of hedging rules and the volume of hedging
         transactions makes the administration of the rules relatively
         difficult.  As indicated above, the existing income tax law does
         not contain comprehensive tax-hedge rules.  Further, the tax-hedge
         rules will cover not just commodity hedging (as recommended by the
         Review of Business Taxation (the Ralph Review)) but all sectors of
         the economy.  Also, they extend beyond tax-timing hedging to tax-
         status hedging.  Thus, the introduction of tax-hedge rules raises
         potentially significant administrative implications.


    958. Against this background, the requirements that the derivative
         financial arrangement satisfies the hedging requirements of the
         financial accounting standards, and is recorded as a hedging
         instrument for the purposes of the standards, represents an
         important administrative safeguard.


    959. At the same time, it is understood that some entities' hedging
         practices will not satisfy the financial accounting hedge rules in
         AASB 139 because of some technical aspect of those rules and
         notwithstanding that the substance of the requirements -
         particularly the risk management purpose, the nature of the hedge
         transaction and appropriate record-keeping and other safeguards -
         is met.


    960. Accordingly, Subdivision 230-E contains a list of situations in
         which those practices may, subject to certain requirements,
         nevertheless attract tax-hedge treatment.  In particular, a
         derivative financial arrangement or foreign currency hedge may, in
         the circumstances listed below, qualify as a hedging financial
         arrangement even though it does not qualify, or it is not recorded,
         as a hedging instrument under the applicable financial accounting
         standards.  In these circumstances, certain additional record-
         keeping requirements have to be met (see paragraphs 8.79 and 8.80).




    961. The only circumstances in which the tax-hedge rules may apply,
         despite such financial arrangements being denied hedging instrument
         status for accounting purposes are:


                . the hedging of a foreign currency risk relating to an
                  anticipated dividend from a connected entity where the
                  dividend is non-assessable non-exempt income under
                  section 23AJ of the ITAA 1936 [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-335(4)];


                . entering into a financial arrangement with a connected
                  entity that is not part of the same tax consolidated group
                  but is part of the same financial accounting consolidated
                  group for which the accounting standards require a
                  consolidated financial report (even though that report
                  ignores the arrangement), provided that the arrangement is
                  created, applied or acquired for the purpose of hedging a
                  risk or risks in relation to a hedged item and would
                  satisfy the accounting hedge requirements but for the
                  consolidated financial report ignoring it [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, subsection 230-335(5)]; and


                . the period for which the risk or risks are hedged does not
                  straddle two or more income years, that is, the hedge is
                  an intra-income year hedge, provided that the arrangement
                  is created, applied or acquired for the purpose of hedging
                  a risk or risks in relation to a hedged item and would be
                  recorded as a hedging instrument in a relevant financial
                  report if it had straddled two or more income years
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(6)].


    962. The list of circumstances in which a financial arrangement may be
         treated as a hedging financial arrangement - and thus potentially
         be able to attract tax-hedge treatment - even though it does not
         qualify as a hedging instrument, or is not recorded as a hedging
         instrument for financial accounting purposes, can be added to by
         regulations [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-335(7)].  Those
         regulations can require that particular conditions be met before
         the financial arrangement can qualify as a hedging financial
         arrangement.


    963. Where the derivative financial arrangement or foreign currency
         hedge is not an accounting hedging instrument, neither the
         financial accounting nor external audit systems provide a platform
         for recognition of the financial arrangements as hedges for tax
         purposes.  The tax system therefore has to provide a separate
         platform, with its separate requirements.  These are that:


                . meeting the requirements of accounting standards for
                  obtaining hedge treatment, or the recording as a hedging
                  instrument for accounting purposes, is not possible due to
                  requirements of the relevant accounting standards, rather
                  than any act or omission on the entity's part to
                  deliberately fail these requirements [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-335(3)(c)];


                . certain additional record-keeping requirements are met
                  (see paragraphs 8.79 and 8.80) [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-355(5)]; and


                . any requirements prescribed by the regulations are met
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-335(3)(e)].


         Additional record-keeping requirements if a financial arrangement
         is not an accounting hedging instrument


    964. As noted above, there are circumstances in which a financial
         arrangement can qualify as a hedging financial arrangement even
         where the arrangement cannot be a hedging instrument for financial
         accounting purposes or is not classified as a hedging instrument in
         the entity's financial report.  Because there is no requirement to
         create a financial accounting record of the arrangement as a
         hedging instrument, the entity's financial records cannot be relied
         upon to demonstrate, for example, the purpose of the arrangement.
         Accordingly, separate tax requirements need to be met.  The
         requirements, which are important administrative safeguards, are in
         addition to those in respect of financial arrangements that are
         hedging instruments for financial accounting purposes.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-335 and subsection 230-355(5)]


    965. The additional requirements are:


                . that the entity make or have in place at, or soon before
                  or after, the time that it creates, acquires or applies
                  the hedging financial arrangement, a 'record' (as defined
                  in the Acts Interpretation Act 1901) that explains why and
                  how the financial arrangement operates commercially or
                  economically, as a hedge of the hedged item or items
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph 230-355(5)(a)(i)].  This
                  requirement has regard to those situations in which it
                  appears that the strict requirements of AASB 139 prevent a
                  derivative (or non-derivative hedging a foreign currency
                  risk) from being classified as a hedging instrument, even
                  though commercially or economically the instrument reduces
                  the entity's exposure to financial risk;


                . that the entity make a record of the reasons why the
                  financial arrangement cannot qualify as a hedging
                  instrument for financial accounting purposes [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, subparagraph 230-355(5)(a)(ii)].  It is envisaged
                  that the normal situation in which a financial arrangement
                  is a hedging financial arrangement is when it is a hedging
                  instrument for financial accounting purposes.  The
                  financial accounting record may provide support in
                  establishing the purpose of the financial arrangement in
                  question.  It is important that, when the arrangement is
                  not a hedging instrument for financial accounting
                  purposes, hedge tax treatment is only applied when there
                  are sound and appropriate reasons why such financial
                  accounting treatment could not be obtained.  A purpose of
                  this requirement, in conjunction with the requirements in
                  paragraph 230-355(3)(a), is to establish that there are
                  such reasons.  For example, as indicated above, it should
                  not be because the entity deliberately failed to meet the
                  requirements of AASB 139;


                . that the entity have a record that sets out its risk
                  management policies and practices at the time the
                  financial arrangement in question is created, acquired or
                  applied [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-355(5)(c)];


                . that, at the time the entity creates, acquires or applies
                  the financial arrangement, it has in place internal risk
                  management systems and controls that record the
                  arrangement and the hedged item or items.  This additional
                  requirement is intended to link the arrangement and the
                  hedged item or items together in terms of the former
                  hedging the risk in respect of the latter.  It will assist
                  in confirming that the financial arrangement is created,
                  acquired or applied for commercial risk management
                  purposes and not for tax reasons [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-355(5)(d)]; and


                . that where a financial arrangement that qualifies for tax-
                  hedge treatment under subsection 230-335(3), the taxpayer
                  keeps a record of the accumulated hedge gain or loss that
                  is yet to be allocated in accordance with that of the
                  hedged item(s).  This requirement is intended to be an
                  analogue of the financial accounting equity reserve.  This
                  is in the sense that, for financial accounting purposes,
                  even though the hedge gain or loss may not be reflected in
                  that period in the income statement, there is a record in
                  an equity reserve of the balance sheet of an amount that
                  has been deferred and is yet to be recognised in profit or
                  loss.  It also reflects the fact that the matching of a
                  gain or loss on a hedged item can mean that a gain or loss
                  from a hedging financial arrangement can be deferred for a
                  long time.  The requirement is for an ongoing record of
                  the accumulated gain or loss, whether realised or
                  unrealised, that is yet to be matched for income tax
                  purposes to a hedged item or items [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  paragraph 230-355(5)(b)].  When recording the accumulated
                  gains and losses at the end of each income year, taxpayers
                  must assume that all gains from the hedging financial
                  arrangement would be assessable income and that all losses
                  from the hedging financial arrangement would be allowable
                  deductions [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-355(6)].


      1. :  Accumulation of gains and losses


                Gold Coast Co, which has an Australian dollar functional
                currency, has a firm commitment to sell a fixed quantity of
                gold in four years for a fixed amount of United States of
                America (US) dollars.  To hedge its exposure to unfavourable
                movements in the A$/US$ currency exchange rate, Gold Coast
                Co enters into a series of four rolling one year forward
                foreign currency contracts.  Gold Coast Co has made a valid
                hedging financial arrangement election under subsection 230-
                315(1).


                Assume that the forward foreign currency contracts qualify
                as hedging financial arrangements to which the hedging
                financial arrangement election applies.  The hedging
                financial arrangements hedge the foreign currency risks in
                relation to the firm commitment to sell gold in four years
                time.  Accordingly, Gold Coast Co is able to defer the gains
                and/or losses from the arrangements until the sale of gold
                is due to take place.


                Assume that the gains or losses that are made on a year-by-
                year basis in relation to each of the forward contracts are
                as set out in Table 8.1.


      1. :  Gains and losses made on a year-by-year basis

|Year         |A$ gain/(loss)            |
|1            |150,000                   |
|2            |(200,000)                 |
|3            |70,000                    |
|4            |(50,000)                  |


                For the purposes of paragraph 230-355(5)(b), Gold Coast Co
                must make a record of the accumulated gains/losses as at the
                end of each income year from each of the arrangements
                relating to the hedged item, namely the firm commitment to
                sell the gold.  Thus the record would be along the lines of
                that in Table 8.2.


      2. :  Accumulated gain/loss

|Year       |A$ accumulated gain/(loss)  |
|1          |150,000                     |
|2          |(50,000)                    |
|3          |20,000                      |
|4          |(30,000)                    |


Allocation of gains and losses from hedging financial arrangements


    966. Tax-hedge rules reduce post-tax mismatch by allocating gains and
         losses from hedging financial arrangements on a timing basis that
         is consistent with the tax recognition time for the gains or losses
         made from the hedged item or items.  The way that Subdivision 230-E
         does this is to require the entity to determine the basis of
         allocation when the various hedging requirements are met.


    967. The allocation basis must be objective.  That is, the basis cannot
         be subjective.  Objectivity should be read to be consistent with
         the matching objective of hedging.


    968. The basis must also fairly and reasonably correspond with the basis
         on which the gains, losses or other amounts from the hedged item or
         items are allocated or recognised for income tax purposes [Schedule
         1, item 1, paragraph 230-360(2)(a)].  Further, the basis must be
         sufficiently precise and detailed so that it can be determined from
         the record the taxpayer makes under section 230-355 the time at
         which the gain or loss from the hedging financial arrangement is
         to be taken into account for the purposes of Division 230, and the
         way in which the gain or loss will be classified for tax purposes
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-360(2)(c)].  These requirements
         are designed to be both consistent with the commercial purpose of
         hedging and to support the integrity of the recording process.


      1. :  A forward foreign currency contract hedging forward purchase


                Assume that Southern Exposure Co, which has an Australian
                dollar functional currency, has a firm commitment to buy an
                item of machinery for US$10 million, which at that time is
                equal to A$14 million.  The company wants to hedge against
                the US$/A$ exchange rate by buying under a forward contract
                US$10 million.  The forward contract will be delivered at
                the settlement date for the machinery which is six months
                hence.


                The effective life of the machinery is 10 years.  When
                Southern Exposure Co enters into the forward foreign
                currency contract, in relation to the timing of when the
                relevant gains or losses from that contract will be
                recognised, it records that it determines that the gain or
                loss on the contract is to be allocated over 10 years.  This
                allocation fairly and reasonably corresponds with the basis
                on which the cost of the machinery is to be recognised for
                income tax purposes.  It is also an objective basis of
                allocation which, from the record, clearly and precisely
                determines how the hedging gain or loss is to be treated for
                income tax purposes.


                If Southern Exposure Co makes an A$1 million gain on the
                forward foreign currency contract and the machinery is
                acquired as planned, it could allocate the gain over 10
                years on a basis that effectively meant that the cost of the
                machinery was A$13 million.  This outcome enables the gain
                on the hedging financial arrangement to be allocated on a
                similar timing basis as that used for capital allowances
                purposes.  It should be noted that the gain itself is not
                part of the cost of the machinery for capital allowance
                purposes; however, the outcome of the allocation of the
                hedge gain under section 230-360 effectively achieves this.


      2. :  Basis of the allocation:  re-estimation of the effective life


                Assume that in Example 8.3 the hedging arrangement is in
                respect of machinery that is not subject to accelerated
                depreciation rates.  Accordingly, its effective life is able
                to be re-estimated for income tax purposes (section 40-110
                of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997)).


                Is it permissible, if Southern Exposure Co anticipates that
                it may re-estimate the effective life of the machinery, for
                it to provide in the record for the allocation of the
                hedging financial arrangement gain or loss to be either 10
                years, or the period corresponding to the effective life of
                the machinery as re-estimated in terms of section 40-110 of
                the ITAA 1997?


                The allocation on the basis of the re-estimation of the
                effective life would be fair, objective and reasonable if
                its purpose is to continue to effectively integrate the
                hedging financial arrangement gain or loss into the cost of
                the machinery for capital allowance purposes.


                However, paragraph 230-355(1)(c) and section 230-360 require
                that the record must contain a determination of the
                allocation basis which is precise and detailed enough that,
                when the gain or loss or other amount from the hedged item
                is taken into account for tax purposes, it will be clear
                from the record the time at which the hedging financial
                arrangement gain or loss is to be taken into account under
                Division 230.  To satisfy this requirement, there must be a
                mechanism for the hedge record to be appropriately linked to
                the choice Southern Exposure Co makes to re-estimate the
                effective life of the machinery.  In this regard, it would
                be permissible for the company to append, at the time it
                makes this choice, a record of the choice to the hedge
                record.


      3. :  Hedging future mineral production


                Cienna Co uses sold futures contracts to hedge against
                future sales of the mineral it produces (a highly probable
                forecast transaction).  However, because the futures
                contracts are for a shorter period than the period to the
                projected sale date, a series of futures contracts are used
                as part of a 'rollover strategy'.


                Provided the futures contracts are otherwise the subject of
                a hedging financial arrangement election - which includes
                the documentation of an objective, fair and reasonable basis
                for allocating the gains and losses from the particular
                hedging financial arrangement, and sufficient linking
                between the contracts and the hedged item(s) - the gains and
                losses from each contract can be deferred and allocated to
                the income year in which the underlying mineral sale is
                made.


      4. :  Hedging the forward purchase of trading stock


                On 1 May 2010, Green Co enters into a firm commitment to
                acquire solar panels worth US$1 million for delivery on 1
                June 2010.  The solar panels to be acquired by Green Co will
                be trading stock from the time of acquisition.


                On 1 May 2010, Green Co enters into a forward exchange
                contract to hedge its foreign currency risk exposure.  The
                terms of the forward contract provide that Green Co will
                purchase US$1 million in exchange for Australian dollars on
                1 June 2010 at an agreed forward rate.


                Green Co is eligible to make a hedging financial arrangement
                election and has complied with all hedging and documentation
                requirements under Subdivision 230-E.  Green Co designates
                the forward contract as the hedging financial arrangement in
                respect of the firm commitment to acquire the solar panels.
                The hedged item is the firm commitment to acquire the solar
                panels (paragraph 230-335(10)(c)).


                Green Co determines at the inception of the hedge to
                allocate any gain or loss on the hedging financial
                arrangement to the time of sale of the solar panels.  The
                gain or loss should be allocated equally over the solar
                panels acquired by Green Co.  Any gain or loss on the
                forward contract will be aligned with the treatment of the
                trading stock.  While the gain or loss is not integrated
                into the cost of the trading stock for tax purposes (ie,
                Division 70 of the ITAA 1997), this basis of allocation
                effectively enables the gains or losses on the hedge to be
                allocated so as to achieve the same tax outcome as if the
                gain was integrated into the tax cost of the panels sold.


                On 1 June 2010 Green Co receives and pays for the solar
                panels in full.  On that day it realises a US$43,000 loss on
                the forward contract.  Despite the fact that the forward
                contract is settled on that day, the loss on the arrangement
                will be deferred and allocated for tax purposes to the
                income year in which the solar panels are sold.


    969. The allocation will not be fair and reasonable unless, in terms of
         the overall nominal gain or loss, it produces the same outcome as,
         for example, the accruals/realisation Subdivision and the balancing
         adjustment Subdivision of Division 230 would produce.  This is
         particularly important as the other Subdivisions of Division 230 do
         not apply to the extent that the hedging Subdivision does.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-300(1) and (2)]


    970. The treatment of the overall gain or loss discussed in the
         preceding paragraph is subject to the situations covered by
         subsections 230-300(4) and (7).  The first situation is with
         respect to a hedging financial arrangement that is a foreign
         currency hedge that is a debt interest.  In this situation, only
         that part of the gain or loss from the arrangement - that
         represents a currency exchange rate effect attributable to the
         outstanding balance in respect of a debt interest - can be
         allocated under the hedging financial arrangement Subdivision
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-300(4)(a)].  Therefore, the
         difference between this amount and the entire gain or loss made
         from the financial arrangement is to be brought to account under
         other provisions of Division 230 - namely, the accruals or
         realisation method, the election to rely on financial reports or
         the balancing adjustment under Subdivision 230-G [Schedule 1, item
         1, paragraph 230-300(4)(b)].


    971. The second situation is with respect to a hedging financial
         arrangement that is an equity interest issued by the taxpayer, is
         covered by section 230-50, and is a foreign currency hedge.  Only
         that part of the gain or loss from the arrangement that represents
         a currency exchange rate effect can be allocated under the hedging
         financial arrangement Subdivision.  The remainder will not be dealt
         with under Division 230 as none of the Subdivisions apply to equity
         interests of which the taxpayer is the issuer.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-300(7)]


Tax classification of a hedging financial arrangement


    972. As well as determining the basis on which gains and losses from a
         hedging financial arrangement are allocated on a timing basis, in
         certain circumstances Subdivision 230-E provides for the gain or
         loss to be classified in a way for income tax purposes that
         corresponds with the way that the hedged item is classified for tax
         purposes.  In this situation, the tax classification (or status) of
         the hedging financial arrangement gain or loss is matched to that
         of the associated hedged item.  Tax classification matching is
         available only for hedging financial arrangements to which a
         hedging financial arrangement election applies [Schedule 1, item 1,
         sections 230-300 and 230-310].  It is not possible to obtain tax
         classification matching without tax-timing matching.  While tax-
         status matching is available under section 230-310 (subject to
         meeting the requirements of the section) the allocation of the
         hedging financial arrangement gain or loss to an income year or
         years is determined by reference to section 230-300.


    973. To facilitate tax classification matching, the table in section 230-
         310 sets out the treatment of a gain or loss on a hedging financial
         arrangement.  To the extent the gain or loss is reasonably
         attributable to a hedged item referred to in the table, it is
         broadly given the same classification.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-310(4)]


    974. In the absence of tax-status matching, there may be a mismatch
         between the treatment of the hedging financial arrangement and the
         hedged item.  For example, a hedged item may be a CGT asset in
         relation to which there is a CGT event and, if it turns out that
         there is a net capital gain in respect of the asset, the net gain
         would be assessable under Parts 3-1 and 3-3 of the ITAA 1997.
         Without tax-status matching, it is possible that a tax mismatch
         will arise because the gain or loss on a hedging financial
         arrangement, which hedges the asset will be on revenue account.
         Based on the table in subsection 230-310(4), the gain or loss on
         the hedging financial arrangement may be treated as a capital gain
         or capital loss respectively, where the requisite conditions are
         met.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 1 in the
         table]


    975. Similarly, a hedged item may produce non-assessable non-exempt
         income.  If the tax-hedge criteria are met, a gain on a
         hedging financial arrangement hedging that item would also be
         treated as non-assessable non-exempt income.  Any loss would not be
         deductible.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 5 in
         the table]


    976. Other items in the table in subsection 230-310(4) facilitate tax
         classification matching by setting out the tax classification of a
         gain or loss on a hedging financial arrangement which is reasonably
         attributable to a hedged item that is, or that produces:


                . a CGT asset that is a taxable Australian property
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 2 in the
                  table];


                . a CGT asset in respect of which the capital gains and
                  losses are disregarded, or reduced by a particular
                  percentage under Division 855 of the ITAA 1997 [Schedule
                  1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 3 in the table];


                . exempt income [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4),
                  item 4 in the table];


                . non-assessable non-exempt income of an Australian resident
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 5 in the
                  table];


                . a share in a company that is a foreign resident if the
                  capital gain or loss made from a CGT event that happens to
                  the share is reduced by a particular percentage under
                  Subdivision 768-G of the ITAA 1997 [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subsection 230-310(4), item 6 in the table];


                . ordinary or statutory income from an Australian source,
                  and losses or outgoings incurred in earning that income
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), items 7 and 10
                  in the table];


                . ordinary income or statutory income from a source out of
                  Australia, and a loss or outgoing incurred in gaining or
                  producing that income from a source out of Australia
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), items 8 and 9
                  in the table];


                . a loss or outgoing that is not allowed as a deduction
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 11 in the
                  table];


                . a net investment in a foreign operation (within the
                  meaning of the accounting standards) that is not carried
                  on through a subsidiary or a company in which the taxpayer
                  has shares (ie, a foreign branch or permanent
                  establishment), but only to the extent that the hedge gain
                  or loss does not relate to a hedged item covered by
                  another item in the table [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
                  230-310(4), item 12 in the table]; and


                . a net investment in a foreign operation (within the
                  meaning in the accounting standards) that is carried on
                  through a subsidiary or a company in which the taxpayer
                  has shares.  (This item arises because the hedged item
                  will be taken to be (or deemed to be) the interest the
                  taxpayer has in the shares of the foreign subsidiary or
                  company for the purpose of applying the table in
                  subsection 230-310(4) only [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
                  230-310(5)].  This does not, however, affect hedge
                  effectiveness testing of the net investment in the foreign
                  operation being in respect of the underlying carrying
                  value of the net assets in the subsidiary.  Typically, the
                  relevant item in the table will be item 6, but this will
                  depend on the particular circumstances.


    977. The items in the table relate to both the type of gain or loss made
         (ie, a capital gain or loss or an amount of assessable income or an
         allowable deduction) and the source of the gain or loss.
         Accordingly, more than one item in the table may be relevant to the
         hedged item identified in the record.


    978. Where alternative items in the table can apply to the hedging
         financial arrangement, the taxpayer must apply that item to which
         the gain or loss on the hedging financial arrangement is most
         relevant.


    979. Where no item in the table applies, subsection 230-310(3), together
         with subsection 230-15(1), has the effect of including any gain on
         the hedge in assessable income.  Any loss may be deductible in
         accordance with subsections 230-15(2) and (3).


    980. Unlike the situation with respect to tax-timing matching, a
         determination is not required for tax classification matching that
         pre-specifies the tax classification treatment of the hedging
         financial arrangement.  Importantly, though, the record must still
         show, at inception of the hedging financial arrangement, the
         relevant hedged item in respect of which the hedging financial
         arrangement relates.  An up-front specification of the tax
         classification of gains or losses from the hedging financial
         arrangement is not required because the tax classification
         treatment of gains or losses made from the hedged item may change
         between the time that the hedging relationship starts and the time
         that those gains or losses from the hedged item are recognised for
         income tax purposes.  Accordingly, where a hedging financial
         arrangement election applies, a gain or loss made from the hedging
         financial arrangement, to the extent to which it is reasonably
         attributable to a hedged item listed in the table in subsection 230-
         310(4), is dealt with in the way indicated by that table.


    981. At the same time, the recorded determination must be sufficiently
         precise and detailed such that, when the hedged item is recognised
         for income tax purposes, it will be clear from the record how the
         hedge gain or loss will be dealt with under section 230-310
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph 230-360(2)(c)(ii)].  The purpose
         of this requirement, like that of the tax-timing aspect of the
         recorded determination, is to prevent determination of the tax
         treatment of the hedging financial arrangement gains and losses in
         hindsight.  It is therefore a central requirement of the tax-hedge
         rules.  Establishing the tax classification of the hedging gains or
         losses with the benefit of hindsight is prevented by requiring that
         the hedged item, to which the hedging financial arrangement
         relates, be specified in the record up-front.  Hence, the tax
         classification of the hedged item will then automatically apply to
         the gains or losses made from the hedging financial arrangement.
         Hence, if the tax classification of the former changes, so too will
         the latter.


      1. :  Cross currency interest rate swap


                AGM Co uses a cross currency interest rate swap to hedge its
                exposure to currency exchange rates in respect of a net
                investment in a foreign operation consisting of shares in a
                foreign subsidiary (SA Co).  Assume that all the hedge tax
                criteria are met.  AGM Co designates the notional principal
                on the swap, which is exchanged at the beginning and end of
                the arrangement, as the hedge of the foreign currency risk
                in respect of the capital value of the shares.


                AGM Co determines that an objective, fair and reasonable
                basis on which  to allocate any gain or loss on the hedge is
                to allocate the gain or loss to the time when it ceases to
                have the net investment in SA Co.  AGM Co also sets out in
                the record at the inception of the hedging relationship that
                the interest in the shares in SA Co is the relevant hedged
                item (subsection 230-310(5)).


                Assume that AGM Co sells the shares in SA Co in three years
                and at that time the gain or loss on the sale of the shares
                turns out to be subject to Subdivision 768-G of the ITAA
                1997; accordingly item 6 in the table would govern the tax
                classification of the hedge gain or loss on the notional
                principal on the swap.


      2. :  Net investment in a foreign operation


                Oz Co has a New Zealand subsidiary, Fern Co.  At 1 January
                2012, Oz Co has a net investment of NZ$20 million in Fern Co
                and Oz Co expects that the value of the investment will not
                fall below that amount.  The net investment satisfies the
                definition of 'net investment in a foreign operation' as per
                the accounting standards.  On that date, Oz Co borrows NZ$20
                million and designates the borrowing as a hedge of the net
                investment in Fern Co.  The borrowing satisfies the
                definition of a 'foreign currency hedge'.


                Oz Co determines that the basis on which it seeks to
                allocate any gain or loss on the hedge of the principal
                component of the borrowing is to allocate the gain or loss
                to the time when it ceases to have the net investment in
                Fern Co.  Oz Co sets out in the record at the inception of
                the hedging relationship that the interest in the shares in
                Fern Co is the relevant hedged item (subsection 230-310(5)).




                Assume that Oz Co meets all the tax-hedge tests required by
                Division 230, that subsection 230-335(1) is satisfied and
                that Oz Co's shares in Fern Co are CGT assets subject to
                Subdivision 768-G of the ITAA 1997.


                The tax deductibility of the interest on the borrowing,
                together with any foreign currency gains and losses
                attributable to that interest, is determined by section 230-
                15 and Division 960 of the ITAA 1997 and not under the
                hedging tax rules (subsection 230-300(4)).


                The taxation of any accumulated foreign currency gain or
                loss attributable to the principal component of the
                borrowing is deferred until Oz Co ceases to have its net
                investment in Fern Co (whether by, for example, disposal of
                the shares in Fern Co or disposal of the assets and
                liabilities comprising the net investment in Fern Co).  This
                deferral would occur even if the borrowing was repaid before
                then.


                Oz Co disposes of the shares on 1 January 2013.  At that
                time (for the purposes of determining the tax classification
                of any accumulated foreign currency gain or loss
                attributable to the principal component of the borrowing) Oz
                Co will have regard to the tax treatment of the shares it
                holds in Fern Co.  At the time of disposal the shares are
                CGT assets subject to Subdivision 768-G of the ITAA 1997.
                Therefore the gains or losses on the hedging financial
                arrangement are treated (ie, classified) as a capital gain
                or a capital loss made from a CGT event to the extent to
                which the gain or loss is reasonably attributable to the CGT
                event that would have happened in respect of its shares in
                Fern Co (subsection 230-310(4), item 1 in the table).
                Further, pursuant to item 6 in the table in subsection 230-
                310(4), that capital gain or capital loss (on the hedging
                financial arrangement) that was made on the borrowing is
                reduced by the same percentage which the capital gain or
                capital loss on net investment is reduced.


The Commissioner's discretion in relation to 'tax tests'


    982. The Commissioner can make a determination to treat the record-
         keeping requirements in section 230-355, the requirements in
         section 230-360 about tax allocation of the gains and losses, and
         the requirements about hedge effectiveness in section 230-365, as
         having been met notwithstanding that the hedging financial
         arrangement does not meet the tests.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-380]


    983. In deciding whether the Commissioner should exercise this
         discretion to make this determination, he or she must have regard
         to the respects in which the requirements would not be met, the
         extent to which they would not be met, the reasons why they would
         not be met, and the objects of Subdivision 230-E.  As indicated,
         the objects are to facilitate the efficient management of financial
         risk by reducing after-tax mismatches where hedging takes place,
         and to minimise tax deferral.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-
         295]


    984. The requirements in sections 230-355 to 230-365 seek to
         prevent after-the-event selectivity of tax allocation and/or tax
         classification of gains and losses from hedging
         financial arrangements.  The requirements are particularly
         important given the potentially wide differences in timing and tax-
         status for the particular hedging financial arrangement.  The
         requirements promote robust audit trails and hedging activity that
         is objectively consistent with the aim of reducing after-tax
         mismatches.  The discretion should be considered against this
         background.


    985. The Commissioner can make the determination that the requirements
         of sections 230-355 to 230-365 have been met, conditional on the
         taxpayer keeping records in addition to those required by
         section 230-355 [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-380(2)].  If
         those further record-keeping requirements are breached, the
         determination ceases to have effect.  The Commissioner can, in
         certain circumstances, make a further determination that has the
         effect that the original determination is reinstated, by
         determining that the cessation provision not apply.  In making the
         further determination, the Commissioner is to have regard to the
         taxpayer's record-keeping practices, compliance history, changes to
         the taxpayer's record-keeping and governance procedures, and other
         relevant matters [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-380(3) to
         (5)].


    986. Where the Commissioner does make a determination under subsection
         230-355(1), the basis for allocating the gains or losses from the
         hedging financial arrangement may be determined by the taxpayer.
         However, if the taxpayer fails to do this, or if the basis on which
         the taxpayer determines the gains or losses are to be allocated is
         not in accordance with the requirements of subsection 230-360(2),
         the Commissioner may make a further determination as to that
         matter.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-380(6)]


The relevant entity


    987. In a tax consolidation context, the tax-hedge rules are intended to
         be limited to the risk of the tax consolidated group of which the
         entity carrying out the hedging activity is part.  This is
         consistent with the single entity rule in section 701-1 of the ITAA
         1997, where all the subsidiaries of the consolidated tax group are
         taken to be parts of the one entity - the head company of the tax
         consolidated group.  That is, the tax-hedge rules do not extend to
         financial arrangements entered into between members of the same
         consolidated tax group.  At the same time, the head entity of a tax
         consolidated group can enter into a hedging financial arrangement
         with an external party to the consolidated tax group in relation to
         the risks of another entity within the same tax consolidated group.


Consequences if the hedging financial arrangement is disposed of early


    988. To the extent that the hedging financial arrangement is disposed
         of, or ceases, before the gains and losses in respect of the hedged
         item or items are recognised for income tax purposes, the gains or
         losses on the hedging financial arrangement should be allocated to
         the income year in which the gains or losses on the hedged item or
         items are recognised [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-300(5)].
         The fact that the hedging financial arrangement ceases before the
         gains or losses on the hedged item are recognised does not prevent
         a deferral of the recognition of the gains or losses made from the
         hedging financial arrangement until a later time.


Consequences if the hedged item is disposed of before the hedging financial
arrangement is disposed of, or is not likely to occur


    989. To the extent that the hedged item or one or more of the hedged
         items are disposed of before the hedging financial arrangement is
         disposed of, or there is a forecast transaction that is no longer
         expected to occur, or the entity ceases to expect that it will have
         the hedged item(s), the hedging financial arrangement is deemed to
         have been disposed of at that time for its then fair value and, to
         the extent that it would otherwise not have been disposed of, is
         deemed to have been reacquired or re-entered into at that fair
         value.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-300(5) and section 230-
         305, item 2 in the table]


Consequences if the entity revokes the designation of, redesignates or
disposes of, the hedging financial arrangement


    990. After an entity has a hedging financial arrangement to which the
         hedging financial arrangement election applies, the entity may
         decide that it should no longer be treated as such (ie, a
         revocation occurs), but the entity does not actually terminate or
         otherwise dispose of the financial arrangement.  One reason for
         this may be that the entity wants to classify the financial
         arrangement as a hedge of another hedged item.


    991. Where there is a revocation or redesignation of a hedging financial
         arrangement, any realised or unrealised gain or loss on the hedging
         financial arrangement, as at the time of revocation or
         redesignation, is allocated to the income year or years in which
         the gains or losses on the hedged item are recognised.


    992. Any gain or loss on the hedging financial arrangement from the time
         of revocation or redesignation is to be treated in accordance with
         the classification of the financial arrangement.  For example, if
         it meets the hedge tax criteria in respect of another hedged item
         or transaction, there should be a corresponding allocation.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-305, subitems 1(a) and (b) in the
         table]


    993. A bona fide revocation of a hedging financial arrangement will not
         constitute a deliberate failure to meet a record-keeping
         requirement or allocation determination under subsection 230-
         385(1).


      1. :  Firm commitment to purchase trading stock on deferred settlement


                On 1 July 2009, Green Co enters into a firm commitment to
                acquire solar panels worth US$1.5 million for delivery on 1
                August 2009 with full payment deferred until 1 September
                2009.  The solar panels to be acquired by Green Co will
                represent trading stock from the time of delivery.


                On 1 July 2009, Green Co enters into a forward contract to
                hedge its foreign currency US dollar exposure.  The terms of
                the forward contract provide that Green Co will purchase
                US$1.5 million in exchange for A$2 million on 1 September
                2009.


                For accounting purposes Green Co designates the forward
                contract as a hedge of the firm commitment to acquire the
                solar panels and the resulting accounts payable of US$1.5
                million.


                Assume that for the scenarios discussed below, Green Co
                complies with all hedging and documentation requirements in
                Subdivision 230-E.


                It determines at the inception of the hedging relationship
                to allocate any gains or losses from the hedging financial
                arrangement (the forward contract) measured at the time the
                solar panels are delivered to the income year in which the
                panels are sold.  Any subsequent gain or loss on the forward
                contract will be brought to account on settlement of the
                accounts payable.


                The solar panels are delivered on 1 August 2009.  At that
                date, the fair value of the forward contract is $5,000.  The
                gain will be allocated to the income year in which the solar
                panels are sold.  The gain should be allocated equally over
                the acquired panels.  The effect of this allocation is to
                effectively 'integrate' the hedge gain into the cost of the
                panels sold.


                Green Co makes full payment for the trade liability on
                1 September 2009 and realises the forward contract.  At that
                time, it has made a gain on the contract of $15,000.  The
                gain that is assessable to Green Co at that time is $10,000.
                 The gain at that time is calculated by deducting $5,000,
                being the value of the forward contract at the time of
                delivery of the trading stock, from the gain of $15,000 at
                settlement of the accounts payable.  The gain brought to
                account for tax purposes on settlement of the accounts
                payable reflects the gain arising from the change in value
                of the forward contract following delivery of the solar
                panels.


                Note that if the trade liability were a financial
                arrangement - the gains or losses in respect of which
                Division 230 applied on a fair value basis - Green Co could
                determine that the gains or losses in respect of the forward
                contract from the time of delivery of the solar panels could
                also be allocated on a fair value basis for Division 230
                purposes.


                As an alternative to the above separate allocation in
                respect of delivery and accounts payable, Green Co may
                determine that the manner in which the gain or loss on the
                hedging financial arrangement is to be determined and
                allocated as at the accounts payable date with deferral
                until the solar panels are sold.


                Whichever manner Green Co chooses, it must apply it
                consistently to all of its arrangements that hedge the
                purchase of its trading stock (section 230-80).


Consequences if the hedging financial arrangement no longer meets the hedge
tax criteria even though it was originally met


    994. The outcome where a hedging financial arrangement no longer meets
         the hedge tax criteria (eg, if the revenue hedge becomes
         ineffective) is similar to that of a revocation of a designation or
         a redesignation of the hedging financial arrangement.


    995. That is, any gain or loss on the hedging financial arrangement up
         to the time of the non-compliance (in the case of tax-hedge
         ineffectiveness) or the event (in the case of a revocation of the
         designation or redesignation) is allocated to the income year (or
         years) in which the hedged item's gains or losses are recognised.
         Any gain or loss on the hedging financial arrangement from the time
         of non-compliance or event is to be treated in accordance with the
         classification of the financial arrangement at that time.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-305, item 1 in the table]


Consequences if the hedged item(s) or risk arising from the hedged item(s)
ceases to exist


    996. In certain circumstances cessation of a hedging relationship may
         occur where the entity ceases to have the hedged item, or one or
         more of the hedged items, or the risk that was being hedged in
         relation to the hedged item or items (eg, terms of a variable rate
         loan are altered to a fixed rate loan) no longer exists or you no
         longer expect to hold the hedged item.  In these circumstances as
         the hedged item or items or hedged risk no longer exist, hedging
         from that time would not be appropriate.  As a result gains and
         losses on the hedging financial arrangement are to be bought to
         account at that time [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-305, items
         2(a) to (c) and (3) in the table].  Regulations may also be made to
         determine the treatment of gains and losses up to the time that the
         taxpayer ceases to have some, but not all, of the hedged items or
         item under a hedging financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-300(6)].


Where requirements for election are no longer satisfied


    997. Although an election under the hedging financial arrangement
         election is irrevocable [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         315(3)], the election will cease to apply from the start of the
         income year in which the taxpayer ceases to meet the eligibility
         requirements under subsection 230-315(2) [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-370(1)].


The making of a new election


    998. The taxpayer is not prevented from making a new election at a later
         time if the conditions in subsection 230-315(2) are satisfied for
         an income year.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-370(2)]


    999. The new election, however, will only apply to new financial
         arrangements you start to have after the start of the income year
         in which the new election is made.  Refer to Chapter 5 for further
         discussion as to when an election will cease to apply.


Balancing adjustment if an election ceases to apply


   1000. Where a hedging financial arrangement election ceases to apply the
         taxpayer is taken to have disposed of each hedging financial
         arrangement for its fair value, immediately before an election
         ceases to apply (ie, at the start of the relevant income year) and
         to have been reacquired for its fair value immediately after the
         election ceases to have effect [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-
         375].  The gain or loss arising from the disposal (ie, the
         'balancing adjustment') is brought to account in the year of income
         according to the record made under section 230-375 and not under
         Subdivision 230-G [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-375(3), 230-
         300(1), 230-300(2) and 230-440(2)].


Consequences of deliberate failure to meet the hedge tax requirements


   1001. Tax-hedge treatment introduces the potential for considerable
         selectivity of tax-timing and/or tax classification if the
         requirements relating to the making of determinations or recording
         are not met.  For example, the hedging financial arrangement method
         could effectively become an arrangement-by-arrangement election,
         making the administration of the hedging rules more difficult, if
         there was a deliberate failure - perhaps of a minor or technical
         nature - to meet one or more of the requirements.


   1002. Accordingly, a deliberate failure to meet one of these requirements
         leads to the result that hedge tax treatment does not apply to
         hedging financial arrangements that start to be held after the
         failure.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-385(2)]


   1003. Despite subsection 230-385(2), the Commissioner may determine that,
         after a specified date, this cessation no longer applies, that is
         that the hedging financial arrangements Subdivision reapplies to
         the particular entity [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-385(3)].
         To make this determination, the Commissioner must be satisfied that
         the taxpayer is unlikely to deliberately fail again to meet the
         abovementioned requirements [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         385(4)] and must take into account various factors.  Specific
         factors relate to the entity's record-keeping practices, its
         compliance history and whether there have been appropriate changes
         to its accounting systems, controls and governance processes
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-385(5)].


Hedging requirements process


   1004. Diagram 8.1 summaries in schematic form the hedging financial
         arrangement election.


         Diagram 8.1













































Chapter 9
The elective financial reports method

Outline of chapter


   1005. This chapter outlines how the election to rely on financial reports
         operates.  The chapter explains:


                . when the taxpayer may make the election;


                . the effect of the election;


                . the timing and quantum of gains and losses that are
                  brought to account for tax purposes from financial
                  arrangements to which the election applies;


                . the circumstances where an election ceases to apply; and


                . the effect of an election ceasing to apply.


Overview of the elective financial reports method


Financial reports method


   1006. The financial reports method allows taxpayers to calculate the
         gains and losses from financial arrangements by reference to
         relevant accounting standards.  Accordingly, a taxpayer who makes a
         valid financial reports election can effectively rely on their
         financial reports (to the extent that they are in accordance with
         relevant aspects of accounting standards) for the purposes of
         complying with their tax obligations in respect of relevant
         Division 230 financial arrangements.


   1007. The purpose of this election is to reduce administration and
         compliance costs relating to the taxation of financial
         arrangements.


Election to rely on financial reports


   1008. The requirements that a taxpayer must satisfy in order to make an
         election to rely on financial reports include:


                . accounting and auditing requirements discussed in Chapter
                  5;


                . unqualified financial reports - the financial reports
                  which the taxpayer relies upon must not have been subject
                  to a relevant qualification in the auditor's report in the
                  current year or in any of the previous four financial
                  years; and


                . accounting systems - a taxpayer should have robust
                  accounting systems in place which are reliable.
                  Accounting systems with reliable controls and internal
                  governance processes help to ensure compliance with
                  accounting and (other) tax obligations.  In the tax
                  context, therefore, the systems, controls and processes
                  must be reliable for the purpose of preparing the entity's
                  tax return.


         Commissioner's discretion


   1009. Both the audit and accounting requirements are subject to the
         Commissioner of Taxation's (Commissioner) discretion that allows
         the Commissioner to disregard a relevant qualified audit report, or
         relevant adverse audit or review relating to the accounting
         systems, for the purpose of determining whether a taxpayer is
         eligible to make the financial reports election.


Gains and losses from financial arrangements using financial reports


   1010. A taxpayer who makes a valid election to rely on financial reports
         will be able to calculate the gains and losses from financial
         arrangements by reference to relevant accounting standards.  In
         other words, a taxpayer who makes a valid financial reports
         election can rely on their financial reports for the purposes of
         complying with their tax obligations in respect of relevant
         Division 230 financial arrangements.


Election ceases to apply


   1011. An election will cease to apply to a financial arrangement if any
         of the requirements for making the election are no longer
         satisfied.  The election will cease to apply from the start of the
         income year in which this occurs.  Where this happens the taxpayer
         will make a balancing adjustment gain or loss amount for the
         financial arrangement.


Context of amendments


   1012. Compared to the current tax law, the other tax-timing methods in
         Division 230 closely correspond with the financial accounting
         treatment of financial arrangements.  This close correspondence
         provides opportunities for compliance cost savings.  Subdivision
         230-F (the elective financial reports method) provides further
         opportunities to lower compliance costs by, in effect, allowing
         taxpayers, in certain circumstances, to rely on their financial
         reports to determine the tax outcomes from their financial
         arrangements to which Division 230 applies.


Summary of new law


   1013. This chapter is to be read in conjunction with Chapter 5.  Chapter
         5 outlines a number of the common requirements and criteria that
         apply to various elective regimes in Division 230, including the
         regime in Subdivision 230-F, the subject of this chapter.


   1014. Before a taxpayer is able to make an election to rely on their
         financial reports, the taxpayer must satisfy a number of criteria
         in addition to the common criteria referred to in Chapter 5.  These
         criteria are designed to ensure a high degree of integrity in the
         systems, controls and procedures behind the financial reports that
         the taxpayer seeks to rely on for tax purposes.


   1015. An intention of Subdivision 230-F is to further reduce
         administration and compliance costs.  This is achieved by allowing
         taxpayers to calculate the gains and losses from financial
         arrangements by reference to relevant accounting standards.  In
         effect, a taxpayer who makes a valid financial reports election can
         rely on their financial reports for the purposes of complying with
         their tax obligations in respect of relevant Division 230 financial
         arrangements.


   1016. The main requirements that a taxpayer must satisfy in order to make
         an election to rely on financial reports are:


                . accounting and auditing requirements - discussed as common
                  requirements (common to all elective methods) in Chapter
                  5; and


                . unqualified financial reports - the financial reports
                  which the taxpayer relies upon must not have been subject
                  to a relevant qualification in the auditor's report in the
                  current year or in any of the previous four financial
                  years.  This requirement, which is specific to the
                  elective financial reports method, is discussed later in
                  this chapter.  Where this requirement is not satisfied,
                  the Commissioner may waive the audit requirement for
                  specific income years after consideration of certain
                  factors.


   1017. Once an election has been made by a taxpayer, their financial
         arrangements will be subject to Subdivision 230-F if:


                . the financial arrangement is one to which Division 230
                  applies;


                . the taxpayer's financial reports recognise the financial
                  arrangement;


                . it is reasonably expected that the overall gain or loss
                  made on the financial arrangement is the same, using the
                  financial reports election, as it would have been had the
                  gain or loss been calculated under the provisions of
                  Division 230 with the exception of Subdivision 230-F;


                . it is reasonably expected that the gain or loss will be
                  recognised at approximately the same time as it would have
                  been recognised had Subdivision 230-F not applied; and


                . it is a financial arrangement which the taxpayer starts to
                  have in the income year in which the election is made or a
                  later income year (or that is subject to a transitional
                  election which is discussed in Chapter 13).


   1018. Where the financial reports election is made, Subdivision 230-F
         will determine the tax treatment of relevant financial arrangements
         except where Subdivision 230-E (hedging) applies.  Hedging is
         excluded from Subdivision 230-F because the tax classification of
         gains and losses on hedges cannot be ascertained from the
         taxpayer's financial reports.


   1019. An election made under this Subdivision has effect from the income
         year in which it is made and to all future income years.  It is
         irrevocable.


   1020. An election will, however, cease to apply to a financial
         arrangement if any of the requirements for making the election are
         no longer satisfied.  The election will cease to apply from the
         start of the income year in which this occurs.  In these
         circumstances, the taxpayer will be required to calculate a
         balancing adjustment gain or loss amount for each financial
         arrangement that is subject to the election.


   1021. Where an election ceases to apply, the taxpayer is able to make a
         new election when the requirements for making the election are once
         more satisfied, but this election will only apply to those
         arrangements the taxpayer starts to have in, or after, the year in
         which the election is remade.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|Subdivision 230-F       |Under the current law,  |
|effectively allows a    |there is no basis for   |
|taxpayer to use the     |electing to use         |
|amounts in their        |financial reports to    |
|financial reports for   |calculate gains and     |
|the purposes of         |losses from financial   |
|calculating their       |arrangements for tax    |
|assessable income and   |purposes.               |
|allowable deductions    |                        |
|under Division 230.     |                        |
|Taxpayers are able to   |                        |
|elect to calculate their|                        |
|income and deductions   |                        |
|using this method       |                        |
|subject to satisfying   |                        |
|certain criteria.       |                        |
|The election under this |                        |
|Subdivision is          |                        |
|irrevocable.  Where     |                        |
|certain criteria are no |                        |
|longer satisfied the    |                        |
|election may cease or it|                        |
|may cease to apply to a |                        |
|financial arrangement.  |                        |
|In certain circumstances|                        |
|the Commissioner may    |                        |
|waive the audit         |                        |
|requirement.  Where an  |                        |
|election ceases, a new  |                        |
|election may be made in |                        |
|relation to new         |                        |
|financial arrangements  |                        |
|if the requirements for |                        |
|making the election are |                        |
|met.                    |                        |


Detailed explanation of new law


Conditions for making an election


   1022. Subdivision 230-F contains a number of specific requirements
         relevant to the financial reports election that are in addition to
         those requirements outlined in the 'common requirements chapter'
         (Chapter 5).  Both the generic and specific requirements must be
         satisfied prior to making an election.  This chapter outlines the
         particular requirements that are specific to Subdivision 230-F.


   1023. For a discussion of the accounting and auditing requirements, refer
         to Chapter 5.  Chapter 5 also discusses which taxpayers are
         eligible to make a valid election.


         Unqualified audit report


   1024. The requirement to have unqualified auditor reports for the current
         and four previous income years is unique to Subdivision 230-F.  An
         auditor's report in this context is the year end report of an
         external auditor.


   1025. For an auditor's report to affect eligibility to make a financial
         reports election, the qualification must be in a respect that is
         relevant to the taxation treatment of financial arrangements.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(c)]


   1026. Thus, it is possible for a taxpayer to have an auditor's report on
         the taxpayer's financial reports that is qualified, but still be
         able to elect to rely on the financial reports so long as the
         qualification is not relevant to the taxation treatment of a
         financial arrangement.


   1027. Relevance in this context is, however, not confined to a
         qualification made about the timing and quantification of gains and
         losses.  For example, a relevant qualification may relate to the
         reliability of the recording of financial arrangements.  This, in
         turn, can affect what is reported in profit or loss, which the
         financial reports election relies upon for the purpose of
         determining the taxation treatment of financial arrangements.


      1. :  Qualified accounts


                The auditor's report on the financial reports of Scruffy Ltd
                has been qualified in relation to the amount of directors'
                fees that have been recognised.  As these fees have no
                impact on the recognition and measurement of gains or losses
                on relevant financial arrangements, the qualification will
                not prevent Scruffy Ltd from electing to rely on its
                financial reports for the purposes of Subdivision 230-F.


   1028. Where an auditor's report is qualified in a relevant respect in the
         current or four prior income years, the taxpayer cannot make the
         election to rely on their financial reports.


         Accounting systems


   1029. The degree of integrity of a taxpayer's accounting systems and
         controls is relevant in determining the appropriateness of making
         an election under this Subdivision.  The election under this
         Subdivision is designed to assist taxpayers in reducing their
         compliance costs without inappropriate tax outcomes being obtained.
          As such, there is a requirement that, in order to make a valid
         election, a taxpayer should have robust accounting systems in place
         which are reliable.  Accounting systems with reliable controls and
         internal governance processes help to ensure compliance with
         accounting and tax obligations.  In the tax context, therefore, the
         systems, controls and processes must be reliable for the purpose of
         preparing the entity's tax return.  Remedial action that has been
         taken in relation to processes that do not impinge on matters
         relevant to the preparation of the tax return would, for example,
         typically not lead to the conclusion that the processes are not
         reliable.  Overall, reliance on such systems, controls and
         processes will reduce tax compliance costs and provide amounts for
         tax purposes which do not provide an inappropriate tax benefit.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(d)]


   1030. External auditors or a regulatory authority or agency may provide
         opinions on the quality of the accounting systems used by a
         taxpayer in an audit.  Where an adverse assessment has been
         provided by an external auditor or a regulatory authority or agency
         on the quality of the accounting systems, this could indicate a
         system deficiency which may impact on the reliability of the gains
         or losses brought to tax under Subdivision 230-F.  Accordingly,
         where an external audit, or a review, conducted in the financial
         year in which the election is proposed to be made or any of the
         four financial years prior to that year, has included such an
         adverse assessment of the taxpayer's accounting systems, the
         taxpayer cannot make the election to rely on their financial
         reports.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(e)]


   1031. It should be noted that internal audits and reviews (or an audit or
         review of a kind prescribed by regulation) are to be disregarded
         for this purpose.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-395(3)]


   1032. In determining whether accounting systems, controls and internal
         governance processes are reliable, regard should be had to the
         current accounting definition of 'reliable'.  The Framework for the
         Preparation and Presentation of Financial Statements issued by the
         Australian Accounting Standards Board states, in paragraph 31,
         that:


                'To be useful, information must also be reliable.
                Information has the quality of reliability when it is free
                from material error and bias and can be depended upon by
                users to represent faithfully that which it either purports
                to represent or could reasonably be expected to represent.'


         Commissioner discretion


   1033. Subsection 230-405(1) provides the Commissioner with a discretion
         to disregard a relevant qualified audit report, or relevant adverse
         audit or review relating to the accounting systems, for the purpose
         of determining whether a taxpayer is eligible to make the financial
         reports election.  In exercising this discretion, the Commissioner
         must take account of the following factors:


                . the reason for non-compliance with the particular
                  accounting standard;


                . what remedial action (such as changes to accounting
                  systems and controls and internal processes) has been
                  undertaken to address the non-compliance with the
                  accounting standards;


                . whether the taxpayer is subject to any regulatory
                  oversight (eg, by the Australian Securities and Investment
                  Commission or the Australian Prudential Regulatory
                  Authority) and, if so, any opinions prepared by those
                  regulators in respect of changes to accounting systems and
                  controls, or to internal governance processes; and


                . any other relevant matter.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-405(1) and (2)]


   1034. While Subdivision 230-F provides the Commissioner with a discretion
         to disregard paragraphs 230-395(2)(c) and (e), the purpose of the
         discretion is not to reduce the level of integrity and reliability
         of financial reports which are required for the purposes of
         Subdivision 230-F.  Rather, the discretion is designed to provide a
         basis to ensure that the compliance cost saving in Subdivision 230-
         F will be available to a taxpayer despite not technically being
         able to satisfy paragraphs 230-395(2)(c) and (e) - refer to Chapter
         5 for discussion of these factors.


   1035. Particular emphasis is to be placed on what, if any, external
         regulation or review the taxpayer is subject to.  That is,
         independent verification by an external regulator as to the quality
         of the accounting systems and any remedial action undertaken will
         be an important factor.


   1036. Where a relevant qualification is in respect of a minor matter in
         an auditor's report, it will be possible for the Commissioner to
         determine that the audit requirements under paragraphs 230-
         395(2)(c) and (e) have been satisfied in the income year in which
         an auditor's report is qualified.  What is minor will depend on the
         context and the circumstances of the particular case.  Depending on
         the circumstances, it may be important for the Commissioner to be
         satisfied that appropriate remedial action has been undertaken by
         the taxpayer.


         Overall gain or loss requirement


   1037. Once an election has been made to apply Subdivision 230-F, it only
         applies to those financial arrangements where, over the life of the
         financial arrangement, it could reasonably be expected that the
         same overall gain or loss is recognised for tax purposes as would
         have been recognised if Subdivision 230-F did not apply, but the
         other relevant methods under the provisions of Division 230
         (including, where appropriate, the elective methods) had been
         chosen and had applied.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         410(1)(e) and subsection 230-410(2)]


         Substantially the same methods


   1038. A further requirement for an election under Subdivision 230-F to
         apply is that the results of the method used to determine the gain
         or loss on a financial arrangement for each income year in the
         financial reports is substantially the same as the results from the
         methods that would have applied under the provisions of Division
         230, assuming the relevant methods (including, where appropriate,
         the elective methods) except for Subdivision 230-F had been chosen
         and had applied [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-410(1)(f) and
         subsection 230-410(2)].  The results from each of these methods
         would be expected to be substantially the same if the financial
         reports method spreads the gains or losses arising on the financial
         arrangement in the financial report in such a way that the gains or
         losses brought to account in each income year were similar to the
         spread of gains and losses brought to account under the other
         Subdivisions of Division 230 (assuming that the other relevant
         elective methods had been chosen and had applied).


   1039. In determining whether the results of the method are substantially
         the same, taxpayers are (in respect of financial arrangements that
         are not fair valued) to disregard the impact of impairment testing
         (ie, the possibility of making a provision for doubtful debts) from
         an accounting perspective, when they first start to hold the
         relevant financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-410(2)]


         Assume other elections made


   1040. For the purposes of determining whether an entity reasonably
         expects to make the same overall gain or loss on a financial
         arrangement, and for determining whether the differences in methods
         applied under Division 230 (other than Subdivision 230-F), an
         entity is able to assume that a fair value election under
         Subdivision 230-C and a general foreign exchange retranslation
         election under Subdivision 230-D have been made.  This prevents
         taxpayers from having to have valid elections in place solely for
         the purpose of being able to make a valid election under
         Subdivision 230-F.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-410(7)]


Which entities can elect the financial reports method?


   1041. Any entity that prepares audited financial reports and that
         satisfies the preconditions discussed above is able to make a
         financial reports election.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-395]


         Making the election


   1042. Any taxpayer may make a financial reports election, but it will
         only be valid for those taxpayers which meet the entry
         requirements.


   1043. In the case of a tax consolidated group or a multiple entry
         consolidated group (MEC group), elections are made by the head
         company of the group.  Generally, an election under Division 230
         will apply to all the relevant transactions of all members of the
         consolidated group or MEC group.  However, there is an exception to
         this where a tax consolidated group or MEC group includes a member
         that carries on a 'life insurance business'.  Where a member of the
         group carries on a life insurance business, the head company can
         specify whether or not the election will apply to the life
         insurance business carried on by that member of the group.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-415(3)]


   1044. A regulation-making power allows for regulations to be made
         specifying other types of businesses for which the fair value
         election in respect of financial arrangements will not apply.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-415(4)]


   1045. The making of a valid election and its application to a member of a
         consolidated group that carries on life insurance business is
         discussed in more detail in Chapter 5.


   1046. It is important to note, however, that an election under
         Subdivision 230-F does not in fact result in elections being made
         under Subdivisions 230-C and 230-D.


Financial arrangements subject to the election to adopt the financial
reports method, and the effect of that election


         To what financial arrangements does the election to adopt the
         financial reports method apply?


   1047. For a discussion of the common application of this election to
         financial arrangements, refer to Chapter 5.


   1048. An election under Subdivision 230-F applies to all financial
         arrangements first held in the income year in which the election is
         made and all future income years, providing they each satisfy the
         relevant conditions in subsection 230-410(1).  For example, the
         overall gain or loss in the financial reports must reasonably be
         expected to be equivalent to that which would otherwise arise under
         Division 230 (apart from Subdivision 230-F).


   1049. Where a financial arrangement is an intra-group transaction for the
         purposes of Australian Accounting Standard AASB 127 Consolidated
         and Separate Financial Statements (or comparable), the financial
         arrangement is deemed to be an arrangement that is recognised in a
         set of audited financial reports and classified as at fair value
         through profit or loss [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-410(3)].
          For further discussion of this, refer to Chapter 5.


   1050. An election under this Subdivision does not apply to financial
         arrangements that are held by a taxpayer in any income year prior
         to the making of the election under this Subdivision, except where
         a further election is made under the transitional arrangements
         (refer to Chapter 13).  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-
         410(1)(b)]


   1051. Where a taxpayer has made an election under Subdivision 230-F,
         separate fair value and retranslation elections are not necessary
         for any financial arrangement which is subject to the election
         (though they can still be made and will apply if a financial
         reports election ceases to apply in circumstances where the
         requirements for those other elections continue to be satisfied).
         Where a taxpayer is unable to, or does not want to, make an
         election under Subdivision 230-F, they may still be able to make
         separate elections under Subdivisions 230-C and 230-D as
         appropriate.


         Financial arrangements to which the elective Subdivisions do not
         apply


   1052. An election under Subdivision 230-F cannot apply to a financial
         arrangement where the arrangement is an equity interest and where:


                . the taxpayer is the issuer of the equity interest
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-415(1)]; or


                . the equity interest is not classified or designated as at
                  fair value through profit or loss, that is, the exclusion
                  carves out equity interests that are fair valued through
                  equity [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-410(1)(d)].


         For these purposes an 'equity interest' includes an interest in a
         trust or a partnership that satisfies the requirements of
         subsection 820-930(1).  [Schedule 1, item 7, subsection 820-930(1)]


   1053. Where a member of a tax consolidated group or MEC group carries on
         a life insurance business, the head company is able to specify that
         an election under Subdivision 230-F will not apply to financial
         arrangements of the member of the consolidated group or MEC group
         to the extent that the financial arrangement relates to the life
         insurance business, as discussed in Chapter 5.  [Schedule 1, item
         1, subsection 230-415(3)]


   1054. An election under Subdivision 230-F does not apply to transactions
         that are subject to Subdivision 230-E (hedging).  The reason for
         this is that the tax hedge rules allow for tax classification
         hedging, which is not reflected in financial reports.  To preserve
         the after-tax symmetry in respect of hedging financial
         arrangements, it is essential that Subdivision 230-E take
         precedence over Subdivision 230-F.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
         230-40(7)]


         Effect of relying on financial reports


   1055. For a discussion of the common application of this election to
         financial arrangements refer to Chapter 5.


   1056. Where an election made under Subdivision 230-F applies to a
         financial arrangement, the gain or loss required by the relevant
         accounting standard to be included in profit or loss in the
         financial report for that financial arrangement will represent the
         gain or loss for income tax purposes.


   1057. In particular, the effect of making an election under this
         Subdivision is that the taxpayer relies on their financial reports
         to determine whether they have, and the amount of, a gain or loss
         from a relevant financial arrangement and when the gain or loss is
         regarded as arising.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-420]


   1058. However, some specific adjustments are made to the amount of the
         gain or loss that is recognised for Division 230 purposes.  The
         first of these adjustments relate to franked distributions and the
         second relates to amounts arising on impairment of certain
         financial arrangements.


         Adjustment for franked distributions


   1059. Division 230 will not apply to franked distributions (received
         either directly or indirectly) and rights to receive franked
         distributions (either directly or indirectly).  The effect of
         excluding franked distributions from the scope of the financial
         reports election is to ensure that these distributions will remain
         assessable in accordance with section 44 of the Income Tax
         Assessment Act 1936 (ITAA 1936).  Assessing the distribution under
         section 44 of the ITAA 1936 rather than under Division 230 will
         ensure that the imputation system works appropriately in respect of
         distributions such that franking credits allocated to such
         distributions are available to the recipient in the income year in
         which the distribution is taxed to the recipient.


   1060. Absent a specific rule, a dividend (distribution) may be declared
         in favour of a shareholder and the accounting standards
         (eg, Australian Accounting Standard AASB 118 Revenue) would have
         required the taxpayer to recognise revenue (ie, a gain) in respect
         of the declared distribution based on the individual facts and
         circumstances relating to that dividend declaration.  At this time,
         however, the dividend could not be franked.  Later when the
         dividend is actually paid, that payment would not be assessed to
         the taxpayer because of the operation of the anti-overlap rule
         (section 230-20) and, accordingly, franking benefits would not be
         allowed to the shareholder.


   1061.  The exclusion of distributions to the extent that they are franked
         will apply equally to distributions received directly by the
         taxpayer from a corporate tax entity or received indirectly by the
         taxpayer as a beneficiary of a trust or through a partnership.  In
         these cases, a beneficiary of a trust (and equally a taxpayer that
         will receive franked distributions through a partnership) will only
         recognise a dividend either when it is received through the trust
         or when the dividend is declared but not paid and the beneficiary
         knows how much it will actually receive.  If this cannot be
         determined by the beneficiary, then the exclusion will not apply.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-480]


      1. :  Dividend payment


                On 1 July 2010 Barri Co acquires ordinary shares in UE Co
                for $50 million and makes the financial reports election in
                respect of all its financial arrangements.  At 30 June 2011
                the shares in UE Co have a market value of $65 million.  On
                1 May 2011 UE Co pays fully franked dividends of $6 million.
                 Barri Co's taxable income for the 2010-11 year includes the
                fair value gain of $15 million ($65 million - $50 million)
                and a dividend of $6 million (ignoring grossing-up for
                franking credits).  However, Division 230 will only assess
                the fair value gain of $15 million.  The dividend paid by UE
                Co will be assessed under section 44 of the ITAA 1936.


                At 30 June 2012 the shares in UE Co have a market value of
                $90 million.  No dividends have been paid for this income
                year.  Barri Co's taxable income for the 2011-12 income year
                includes the fair value gain of $25 million ($90 million -
                $65 million).


         Adjustment for impairment of financial arrangement


   1062. Where a debt arrangement that is subject to the financial reports
         election subsequently becomes impaired (as determined under the
         Accounting Standards), the arrangement ceases to be subject to
         Subdivision 230-F, except where the arrangement is fair valued.
         This is because the arrangement ceases to satisfy the requirements
         of paragraph 230-410(1)(f) - that is, it cannot be said that the
         differences in the results of the accounting method and the
         compounding accruals method in Subdivision 230-B are reasonably
         expected to be not substantial.  The reason for this is that the
         compounding accruals method does not recognise a provision for
         doubtful debts.  Hence, the relevant financial arrangement will
         become subject to the remainder of Division 230, that is to a
         Subdivision of Division 230 other than Subdivision 230-F.  If the
         financial arrangement falls within the scope of Subdivision 230-B
         (accruals and realisation method) and the impairment is later
         written-off as a bad debt, the provisions within Subdivision 230-B
         will apply to allow a deduction for amounts previously recognised
         as gains from the arrangement.  Also, if at some future time, the
         debt arrangement ceases to be impaired, it cannot be subject to
         Subdivision 230-F again.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         425(4)]


   1063. Where a debt arrangement that is subject to Subdivision 230-F
         becomes impaired, and the financial reports election ceases to
         apply to it, the arrangement is specifically precluded from being
         subject to a balancing adjustment [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection
         230-430(4)].  The reason for this is that if a balancing adjustment
         were applied at the time the financial arrangement becomes
         impaired, the taxpayer would receive an immediate deduction for the
         impairment of the debt arrangement.  Such a result is contrary to
         the general policy in relation to doubtful debts for financial
         arrangements that are not subject to the fair value election (as
         described in Chapter 4).


         Interaction with other tax-timing elections under Division 230


   1064. Where a taxpayer has made elections under Subdivision 230-C and/or
         Subdivision 230-D, and subsequently elects to apply Subdivision 230-
         F, the Subdivision 230-F election will apply to all financial
         arrangements entered into in the income year in which this election
         was made or a later income year, even if they would otherwise have
         been subject to Subdivision 230-C and/or Subdivision 230-D.


Where requirements for election are no longer satisfied


   1065. Although an election to rely on financial reports is irrevocable,
         the election may cease to apply, depending on the circumstances, to
         either:


                . all of a taxpayer's financial arrangements; or


                . one or more particular financial arrangements of the
                  taxpayer.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-425]


   1066. If an election to rely on financial reports ceases to apply to a
         particular financial arrangement, that election cannot subsequently
         reapply to it.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-425(4)]


   1067. Refer to Chapter 5 for further information as to when an election
         to rely on financial reports will cease to apply.


Balancing adjustment if an election ceases to apply


   1068. Where an election to rely on financial reports ceases to have
         effect in relation to, or ceases to apply to, a particular
         financial arrangement, from the start of a particular income year,
         a balancing adjustment is made at that time in respect of the
         arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-430(1) and (3)].
         A balancing adjustment does not apply to a financial arrangement
         where it becomes impaired (see paragraphs 9.58 and 9.59) [Schedule
         1, item 1, subsection 230-430(4)].


   1069. The balancing adjustment is to be made in accordance with the
         balancing adjustment requirements as set out in Subdivision 230-G
         (see Chapter 10).  The balancing adjustment made is the balancing
         adjustment the taxpayer would have made if the taxpayer disposed of
         each relevant arrangement at the start of the income year in which
         the election ceased to apply for its fair value and immediately
         reacquired it at that time for that value.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         section 230-430]


   1070. In some limited circumstances, it is possible that no amount will
         be bought to account as a result of the application of the
         balancing adjustment where a financial arrangement ceases to be
         subject to Subdivision 230-F.


      1. :  Hierarchy of elections and balancing adjustment


                Bill Co has made valid elections under Subdivisions 230-C,
                230-D and 230-F that apply to its income year that commences
                on 1 July 2008.  As a result of the operation of Division
                230, Bill Co relies on the operation of Subdivision 230-F to
                quantify its fair value and foreign exchange retranslation
                gains and losses - as opposed to relying on Subdivisions 230-
                C and 230-D.


                In respect of the financial reports for the year ended 30
                June 2011, the auditor's report is relevantly qualified such
                that Bill Co can no longer rely on Subdivision 230-F to
                determine its gains and losses.  As the qualification is in
                respect of the accounting systems and controls, Bill Co is
                able to rely on Subdivisions 230-C and 230-D to determine
                the value of its relevant gains and losses in respect of
                relevant financial arrangements.

                As a result of this, and the fact that Subdivision 230-F
                ceases to apply from the start of the income year, the
                balancing adjustment would be calculated as follows for a
                financial arrangement that is being fair valued.
                Assume the following:
                . Acquired financial arrangement for $200 at 1 September
                  2009.
                . Fair value as at 30 June 2010 is $250.
                . Amount included in assessable income for year ended
                  30 June 2010 is $50.
                Step 1 - the total of financial benefits received under the
                financial arrangement.
                $250
                Step 2 - the total of the financial benefits provided under
                the financial arrangement (ie, $200 for the acquisition) and
                the total of the amounts that have been included in
                assessable income before the transfer or cessation, as gains
                from the arrangement ($50 gain attributable to the change in
                fair value).
                $250
                Step 3 - compare the step 1 amount with the step 2 amount.
                If the amounts are equal, as they are in this example, no
                balancing adjustment is made.
   1071. Chapter 5, in respect of the elective Subdivisions, and Chapter 10
         more generally, provide further detail as to the operation of the
         balancing adjustment rules contained in Subdivision 230-G.

Making of a new election


   1072. Where a taxpayer has made an election which ceases to have effect,
         they may later make a new election where the conditions for making
         an election are once more satisfied (refer Chapter 5).  With
         respect to an election under Subdivision 230-F, if it ceased to
         have effect because of a qualified audit in respect of the
         treatment of a financial arrangement or an adverse assessment of
         the taxpayer's accounting systems in a report of an audit or
         review, the election can only be remade four years following the
         income year in which these particular requirements were first
         failed.  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(c) and
         subsection 230-425(2)]

Chapter 10
Balancing adjustment on disposing of financial arrangements

Outline of chapter


   1073. This chapter explains when a financial arrangement (or part of a
         financial arrangement) is transferred or otherwise ceases to be
         held, and the consequences following these events.


   1074. For convenience, the expression 'disposal' is used to refer to a
         financial arrangement (or part of a financial arrangement), ceasing
         to be held or being transferred.


Overview of balancing adjustments on disposal


A balancing adjustment


   1075. A balancing adjustment is an additional amount of gain or loss
         brought to account on the disposal of a financial arrangement to
         ensure the correct amount of gain or loss is brought to account
         from holding and disposing of the financial arrangement.  Amounts
         recognised prior to disposal are taken into account in working out
         any gain or loss on disposal.  This corrects any previous under-
         allocation or over-allocation of a gain or loss before disposal.


Gains and losses from disposal of a financial arrangement


   1076. Gains and losses from disposing of a financial arrangement (or a
         part of it) may arise from a transfer to another person of relevant
         rights and/or obligations under the arrangement.  Gains and losses
         from disposing of a financial arrangement can also be made when all
         the rights and/or obligations which exist under the arrangement
         cease.  Both gains and losses from either transfer or cessation
         require a balancing adjustment.


Disposal of a financial arrangement


         General rule - disposal of all rights and obligations


   1077. The general rule is that disposal of a whole financial arrangement,
         that is, a disposal of all the rights and/or obligations under the
         financial arrangement, occurs if those rights and/or
         obligations end or are transferred to another entity.


   1078. The ending of the relevant rights and/or obligations can occur in
         different ways, for example, through their discharge (of
         obligations) or satisfaction, expiry, close out, forfeiture or
         maturity.


   1079. A transfer of a right or obligation (which is a form of a right or
         obligation ceasing) can also occur in different ways, for example,
         as a result of a sale, under a legal defeasance of obligations, or
         an assignment of rights.


   1080. Where a financial arrangement is an asset, a transfer is
         effectively taken not to have occurred unless the effect of the
         transfer is to transfer substantially all the risks and rewards of
         ownership of the asset to another entity.


         Partial disposal


   1081. A partial disposal of a financial arrangement can occur only if
         there is a transfer of one of the following types:


                . a proportionate share of all the rights and/or obligations
                  under the financial arrangement;


                . a right or obligation under the financial arrangement to a
                  specifically identified financial benefit; or


                . a proportionate share of a right or obligation under the
                  financial arrangement to a specifically identified
                  financial benefit.


         Special rules or exceptions to the general rule


   1082. The general rules outlined above are overridden by special rules
         and exceptions dealing with equity interests, hedging, margining,
         historical rate roll-over, conversion or exchange and commercial
         debt forgiveness.


         Equity interests


   1083. A balancing adjustment is not made if the financial arrangement is
         an equity financial arrangement and neither the fair value method
         nor the elective financial reports method applies to it.  Such a
         financial arrangement will be outside the scope of Division 230;
         rather any disposal may be subject to the capital gains tax (CGT)
         measures (where the asset is not held on revenue account).


         Hedging


   1084. The tax hedging provisions provide tax matching between the hedging
         financial arrangement and the hedged item or items.  To allow this
         matching, it may be necessary to defer a gain or loss on the
         hedging financial arrangement past the time of its disposal.


         Bad debts


   1085. The writing off of a bad debt is taken not to be a disposal of a
         financial arrangement.  Therefore, a balancing adjustment is not
         made when a financial arrangement is written off as a bad debt.


         Margining


   1086. A balancing adjustment is not required for exchange traded
         derivatives that are subject to margining.


         Historic rate roll-over


   1087. A specific rule provides that an historic rate roll-over of a
         derivative financial arrangement is taken to be a disposal of all
         the rights and/or obligations under the arrangement.  Accordingly,
         a balancing adjustment may be required on disposal.


   1088. However, this will be subject to the operation of the tax hedging
         rules.  Accordingly, the gain or loss on disposal of an historic
         rate roll-over derivative contract (used in a hedging context) may
         be deferred and matched to the timing and treatment of the gain or
         loss on a hedged item for tax purposes.


         Conversion or exchange


   1089. A balancing adjustment will not be required by a conversion or
         exchange of a traditional security into ordinary shares if it was
         issued on the basis that it will, or may:


                . convert into ordinary shares of the issuer or a connected
                  entity of the issuer, and the ceasing of the rights or
                  obligations under the financial arrangement that is the
                  security, is because it is converted into such shares; or


                . exchange into the ordinary shares of an entity other than
                  the issuer or a connected entity of the issuer, and:


                  - it is exchanged for such shares; and


                  - if the ceasing of the rights or obligations occurs
                    because of a disposal, the disposal is to the issuer or
                    a connected entity of the issuer.


         Subsidiary member leaving a consolidated group


   1090. A balancing adjustment is not made in relation to the financial
         arrangement of a subsidiary member which ceases to be a member of a
         consolidated group, or a multiple entry consolidated group as a
         result of ceasing to be a member of that group.


         Commercial debt forgiveness


   1091. A cancellation or other discharge of obligations under a financial
         arrangement which qualifies as commercial debt forgiveness will be
         subject to the commercial debt forgiveness provisions.  The gain
         which would be subject to Division 230 is reduced to the extent
         that the gain is covered by the commercial debt forgiveness
         provisions.  Accordingly, to the extent that the commercial debt
         forgiveness provisions apply no balancing adjustment is required.


What amount is recognised as a result of the disposal?


   1092. The amount to be recognised as a result of a disposal (ie, the
         disposal balancing adjustment amount), is that amount which ensures
         that the entity's overall gain or loss from having the financial
         arrangement (or the relevant part of it) is recognised.


   1093. To ensure this outcome amounts recognised prior to the disposal are
         taken into account in working out the amount of any disposal gain
         or loss.


   1094. In order to work out the gain or loss, relevant costs must be taken
         into account.  So, the gain or loss in respect of the disposal of
         rights and/or obligations comprising the whole or part of a
         financial arrangement must factor in the costs (if any) in respect
         of the arrangement or the relevant part of the arrangement, at the
         time of disposal.


         Complete cessation or transfer


   1095. In broad terms, the balancing adjustment on disposal of a whole
         financial arrangement is worked out as (a  +  b  +  c)  -  (d  +  e
          +  f) where:


                a  =  the total of the financial benefits received;


                b  =  the total of amounts that have been allowed as
                deductions and would have been allowable deductions before
                the disposal;


                c  =  the total of amounts that will be allowed as
                deductions (such as deductions due to the transitional
                balancing adjustment);


                d  =  the total of all financial benefits provided;


                e  =  the total of amounts that would have been included in
                assessable income and have been included in assessable
                income before the disposal; and


                f  =  the total of amounts that will be included in
                assessable income (such as income due to the transitional
                balancing adjustment).


   1096. If the disposal balancing adjustment is positive (ie, the sum of a,
         b and c exceeds the sum of d, e and f) the amount is a gain made
         from the financial arrangement and is included in assessable
         income.  Conversely, if the disposal balancing adjustment is
         negative, the amount is a loss made from the arrangement and may be
         an allowable deduction.


   1097. If a balancing adjustment is required for a partial disposal in
         certain circumstances the variables in the balancing adjustment
         formula are adjusted to take into account the nature of the partial
         disposal.


Disposal balancing adjustment made in year of disposal


   1098. The gain or loss produced by the disposal balancing adjustment is
         made in the year in which the disposal occurs.


Context of amendments


   1099. Under the current income tax law, there are several provisions
         dealing with the tax consequences of disposing of financial
         arrangements which would qualify as financial arrangements under
         Division 230.  They include both general and specific provisions
         such as:


                . sections 26BB and 70B of the Income Tax Assessment
                  Act 1936 (ITAA 1936);


                . section 159GS of the ITAA 1936;


                . sections 6-5 and 8-1 of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997
                  (ITAA 1997); and


                . Part 3-1 of the ITAA 1997.


   1100. These provisions apply in different circumstances and in different
         ways.  For example:


                . sections 26BB and 70B of the ITAA 1936 generally operate
                  when an 'arrangement' is 'redeemed' or 'disposed of'.
                  While 'redeemed' is not defined, 'dispose' is defined in
                  subsections 26BB(1) and 70B(1);


                . section 159GS of the ITAA 1936 operates when an
                  arrangement is 'transferred'.  The definition of
                  'transfer' (in subsection 159GP(1) of the ITAA 1936) is
                  similar to, but not the same as, the definition of
                  'dispose' in subsections 26BB(1) and 70B(1);


                . sections 6-5 and 8-1 of the ITAA 1997 generally rely on
                  the concept of realisation to bring to account gains and
                  losses on disposal; and


                . Part 3-1 of the ITAA 1997 relies on the concept of CGT
                  events.


   1101. Thus, there is an amalgam of general and specific provisions
         without any common or uniform treatment applicable to the disposal
         of financial arrangements.  There is no express framework for
         considering what is disposed of, when it is disposed of, and how to
         quantify the amount to be recognised for tax purposes as a result
         of the disposal.


   1102. More specifically, the current law does not contain a comprehensive
         provision dealing with the tax consequences of disposing of
         financial arrangements that are liabilities in a non-forgiveness
         context.  This means, for example, that it is not clear whether the
         tax treatment of the defeasance of debt instruments falls under the
         general deduction and income provisions, under the CGT provisions
         or under a specific provision.  In addition, it is not clear to
         what extent gains and losses on such defeasances are recognised
         under the current income tax law.


   1103. In specifying how much gain or loss is to be brought to account at
         the time of disposal, it is necessary to determine how much has
         already been brought to account, in respect of the financial
         arrangement or relevant part of it.  Any allocation of gain or loss
         from the financial arrangement prior to that time (eg, under the
         accruals provisions), is taken into account to ensure that only the
         actual net gain or loss from the whole, or part, of the financial
         arrangement is recognised for income tax purposes.  That is, an
         adjustment calculation is made at the time of the disposal to take
         account of any previous under-allocation or over-allocation.  This
         calculation is referred to as a 'balancing adjustment'.


Summary of new law


   1104. Subdivision 230-G provides that a balancing adjustment is made when
         all the rights and/or obligations under a financial arrangement
         cease or are transferred to another person.  In certain
         circumstances, a balancing adjustment is also made when there is a
         partial transfer.


   1105. In broad terms, the balancing adjustment gain or loss is calculated
         by netting the financial benefits received and provided under the
         arrangement - including the consideration received or provided in
         relation to the cessation or transfer - and any amounts that have
         been (or would have been) brought to account for income tax
         purposes from the arrangement until the cessation or transfer.


   1106. This balancing adjustment gain or loss is made in the income year
         in which the cessation or transfer occurs.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|The new law contains a  |A number of separate and|
|single provision        |ad hoc provisions govern|
|covering the tax        |the tax consequences of |
|consequences (including |the disposal of         |
|the balancing           |different types of      |
|adjustment) arising from|financial arrangements. |
|the disposal of         |                        |
|different types of      |                        |
|financial arrangements  |                        |
|other than arrangements |                        |
|to which the hedging    |                        |
|rules apply.            |                        |
|The provision covers    |It is not clear to what |
|gains and losses from   |extent gains and losses |
|the disposal of         |from the disposal of    |
|liabilities in a        |liabilities (in a       |
|non-forgiveness context.|non-forgiveness context)|
|                        |are recognised for tax  |
|                        |purposes.               |
|Specific rules clarify  |It is not clear how     |
|the tax treatment of    |margining and historic  |
|margining and historic  |rate roll-over          |
|rate roll-over          |arrangements for        |
|arrangements for        |derivatives are treated |
|derivatives.            |for tax purposes.       |


Detailed explanation of new law


   1107. In broad terms, gains and losses from financial arrangements can be
         made in one of two ways:


                . having a financial arrangement; or


                . disposing of a financial arrangement.


   1108. Gains from having a financial arrangement can flow from, for
         example, the right to receive interest or an amount represented by
         discount, while losses from having a financial arrangement can flow
         from, for example, the obligation to provide interest or an amount
         represented by discount.  The interest is paid or received under
         the arrangement in question.  Guidance on how the taxpayer should
         treat these gains and losses is not addressed in this chapter.
         Relevant guidance on these gains and losses, and other gains and
         losses which arise from the expiry or performance of rights and/or
         obligations while the financial arrangement continues in operation,
         is set out in other Subdivisions of Division 230 and in other
         relevant chapters of this explanatory memorandum.


   1109. Gains and losses from disposing of a financial arrangement (or a
         part of it) may, however, arise from a transfer to another person
         of relevant rights and/or obligations under the arrangement.  Gains
         and losses from disposing of a financial arrangement can also be
         made when all the rights and/or obligations which exist under the
         arrangement cease.  Both of these types of gains and losses (ie,
         from transfer or disposal) are the gains and losses that
         Subdivision 230-G apply to.


   1110. The design of the disposal provisions in Subdivision 230-G takes
         into account the derecognition criteria adopted by Accounting
         Standard AASB 139 Financial Instruments:  Recognition and
         Measurement.


What constitutes a disposal?


         General rule


   1111. The general rule is that a disposal of a whole financial
         arrangement, that is, a disposal of all the rights and/or
         obligations under the financial arrangement, occurs if those rights
         and/or obligations cease or are transferred to another person.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-435(1)(a) and (b)]


   1112. A cessation of the relevant rights and/or obligations can occur in
         different ways, for example, through their discharge of obligations
         or satisfaction, expiry, close out, forfeiture or maturity.


   1113. A transfer of a right or obligation (which is a form of cessation)
         can itself occur in different ways, for example, as a result of a
         sale, under a legal defeasance of obligations, or an assignment of
         rights.  If a financial arrangement is an asset, however, a
         transfer is effectively taken not to have occurred unless its
         effect is to transfer to another entity substantially all the risks
         and rewards of ownership of the asset [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-435(3)].  For example, the security subject of the
         'repo' in Example 2.5 would be treated as having not been
         transferred for Subdivision 230-G purposes.


   1114. A partial disposal of a financial arrangement can occur only if
         there is a transfer of one of the following types:


                . a proportionate share of all the rights and/or obligations
                  under the financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1,
                  subparagraph 230-435(1)(c)(i)];


                . a right or obligation under the financial arrangement to a
                  specifically identified financial benefit [Schedule 1,
                  item 1, subparagraph 230-435(1)(c)(ii)]; or


                . a proportionate share of a right or obligation under the
                  financial arrangement to a specifically identified
                  financial benefit [Schedule 1, item 1, subparagraph 230-
                  435(1)(c)(iii)].


         Special rules or exceptions


   1115. The general rules outlined above are overridden by special rules
         and exceptions dealing with equity interests, hedging, margining,
         historical rate roll-over, conversion or exchange and commercial
         debt forgiveness.


         Equity interests


   1116. A balancing adjustment is not made if the financial arrangement is
         an equity financial arrangement (as described in Chapter 2) - and
         neither Subdivision 230-C nor Subdivision 230-F apply to the
         financial arrangement [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-440(1)].
         The effect of this is that, unless the elective fair value method
         or the election to rely on financial reports applies to an equity
         financial arrangement, the disposal gain or loss in respect of that
         equity financial arrangement will not be calculated under
         Subdivision 230-G, but rather will be determined by provisions
         outside of Division 230.


         Hedging


   1117. As explained in Chapter 8, the tax hedging provisions are designed
         to provide appropriate tax matching between the hedging financial
         arrangement and the hedged item or items.  To establish this
         matching, it may be necessary to defer a gain or loss on the
         hedging financial arrangement past the time at which it would
         otherwise be recognised for income tax purposes, due to its
         disposal.  In addition, an equity interest which is designated as a
         hedging financial arrangement may have that part of the gain or
         loss which is attributable to a currency exchange rate effect
         calculated under the hedging provisions.  Hence, the balancing
         adjustments otherwise required by Subdivision 230-G operates
         subject to the tax hedging provisions in Subdivision 230-E.


         Bad debts


   1118. Although the writing off of a bad debt would not constitute a
         transfer or cessation of a financial arrangement, Subdivision 230-G
         makes it clear that a balancing adjustment is not made when a
         financial arrangement, in part or whole, is written off as a bad
         debt [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-440(3)(a)].  Specific rules
         for bad debt deductions are included in the accruals method and
         realisation method.  To permit the ongoing operation of the bad
         debt provision in section 25-35 of the ITAA 1997, there is an
         exception to the anti-overlap rule in section 230-25 [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-25(3)].


         Margining


   1119. Exchange traded derivatives typically are subject to margining
         requirements.  Thus, on a daily basis, the party carrying a loss on
         the contract is required to settle it by making a payment.  It is
         arguable that the settlement of the contract means that the rights
         and obligations under it come to an end because they are satisfied
         and that there is therefore a disposal.


   1120. It appears that upon payment (under the margining requirements) a
         new contract equivalent to the settled contract (other than as to
         price) is created to replace the settled contract.  The effect,
         therefore, is that the parties to the contract are in the same
         economic position as before the settlement but for the margin
         payment and the new price.


   1121. Except for the margining requirement, there would not have been a
         settlement of the old contract.  In these circumstances, it is
         appropriate for the settlement of the exchange traded derivative,
         due to any margining requirements, not to give rise to a balancing
         adjustment.  This is what paragraph 230-440(3)(b) gives effect to,
         although the provision is not limited to exchange traded
         derivatives.  This exclusion from having the balancing adjustment
         apply extends to any financial arrangement that is a derivative
         financial arrangement that is settled or closed out for margining
         purposes.


   1122. As explained in Chapter 8, derivative financial arrangements are
         financial arrangements that:


                . change in value in response to a change in a specified
                  variable or variables; and


                . require little or no net investment, in that the net
                  investment is smaller than that required for other types
                  of financial arrangements - that is, other than derivative
                  financial arrangements - which would be expected to have
                  similar results to changes in market factors.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-350(1)]


   1123. It should be noted that the margining process is different to the
         process which occurs when an entity does not wish to maintain its
         exposure under the derivative contract.  In this case, under
         clearing house rules there is a close-out, but no creation of an
         equivalent contract (but for price).  A close-out in this
         situation, which is not for margining purposes, would constitute a
         disposal because the rights and obligations under the contract are
         extinguished and there is no exception which provides otherwise.


         Historic rate roll-over


   1124. The term of a derivative financial arrangement may be able to be
         extended or 'rolled over' at a non-market or 'off market' rate
         which reflects the original or 'historic' rate at which the
         financial arrangement was entered into, and the extension of credit
         by the party that has a gain in relation to the financial
         arrangement, at that time, to the other party.  This is commonly
         referred to as an 'historic rate roll-over'.


   1125. In substance, at the roll-over date, there is a cessation by way of
         expiry of the rights and/or obligations under the derivative
         financial arrangement.  Whether there is an expiry as a matter of
         contract law is unclear.  Accordingly, to avoid doubt, there is a
         specific rule in Subdivision 230-G to provide that an historic rate
         roll-over of a derivative financial arrangement is taken to be a
         ceasing of all the rights and/or obligations under the arrangement.
          [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-435(5)]


   1126. As mentioned above, this and other disposal situations are subject
         to the operation of the tax hedging rules in Subdivision 230-E.
         Accordingly, the gain or loss on disposal of an historic rate roll-
         over derivative contract (used in a hedging context) may be able to
         be deferred and matched to the timing and treatment of the gain or
         loss on a hedged item for tax purposes.  This depends on the
         application of the tax hedging rules (see Chapter 8).


         Conversion or exchange


   1127. A balancing adjustment will not arise by virtue of the conversion
         or exchange, as the case may be, of a traditional security into
         ordinary shares if it was issued on the basis that it will, or may:


                . convert into ordinary shares of the issuer of the security
                  or a connected entity of the issuer, and the ceasing of
                  the rights or obligations under the financial arrangement
                  that is the security, is because it is converted into such
                  shares [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-440(3)(c)]; and


                . exchange into the ordinary shares of an entity other than
                  the issuer of the security or a connected entity; and


                . it is exchanged for such shares; and


                . if the ceasing of the rights or obligations occurs because
                  of a disposal, the disposal is to the issuer of the
                  traditional security or a connected entity of the issuer
                  [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraph 230-440(3)(d)].


         Commercial debt forgiveness


   1128. A cancellation, or other discharge of obligations under a financial
         arrangement, which qualifies as commercial debt forgiveness is
         considered under Division 245 of Schedule 2C to the ITAA 1936.  The
         gain which would be subject to Division 230 is reduced to the
         extent that the gain is captured by Division 245 (see discussion in
         Chapter 2 also).  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-470]


What amount is recognised for income tax purposes as a result of the
disposal?


   1129. The amount to be recognised for income tax purposes, as a result of
         a disposal (ie, the disposal balancing adjustment), is that amount
         which ensures that the entity's overall gain or loss from having
         the financial arrangement (or the relevant part of it) is
         recognised.


   1130. Thus, amounts recognised prior to the disposal are taken into
         account in working out the amount of any disposal gain or loss.
         This process corrects for any under-allocation or over-allocation
         prior to the disposal point.


   1131. As explained in Chapter 3, which deals with gains and losses from
         financial arrangements, the concept of a gain or loss is a net
         concept.  In order to work out the gain or loss, relevant costs
         must be taken into account.  So, the gain or loss in respect of the
         disposal of rights and/or obligations comprising the whole or part
         of a financial arrangement must factor in the costs (if any) in
         respect of the arrangement or the relevant part of the arrangement,
         at the time of disposal.



         Complete cessation or transfer


   1132. In broad terms, the way in which the balancing adjustment for
         cessation or transfer of the whole financial arrangement is worked
         out for a financial arrangement can be summarised in a formula,
         thus:


         Disposal balancing adjustment  =  (a  +  b  +  c)  -  (d  +  e  +
         f)  where:

|a  |total of all financial benefits received under |
|=  |the financial arrangement (subsection          |
|   |230-445(1), step 1(a) in the method statement).|
|   |                                               |
|   |The note to step 1(a) states that financial    |
|   |benefits received  on cessation or transfer (of|
|   |the financial arrangement) that play an        |
|   |integral role in determining whether a gain or |
|   |loss (or the amount) are also to be included at|
|   |this step (as per paragraph 230-60(2)(c)).     |
|b  |total of amounts that, because of circumstances|
|=  |which occurred before the transfer or          |
|   |cessation, have been allowed as deductions for |
|   |losses from the financial arrangement, or would|
|   |have been allowed as deductions, if all the    |
|   |losses from the arrangement were allowable as  |
|   |deductions (subsection 230-445(1), steps 1(b)  |
|   |and (c) in the method statement).              |
|c =|total of amounts that, because of circumstances|
|   |that occurred after the transfer or cessation, |
|   |will be allowed as deductions to the entity    |
|   |because of the transitional balancing          |
|   |adjustment (refer to Chapter 13) or the        |
|   |portfolio treatment of fees, discounts and     |
|   |premiums to the extent to which those amounts  |
|   |are attributable to the financial arrangement  |
|   |(subsection 230-445(1), steps 1(d) and (e) in  |
|   |the method statement).                         |
|d  |total of all financial benefits provided under |
|=  |the financial arrangement (subsection          |
|   |230-445(1), step 2(a) in the method statement).|
|   |                                               |
|   |The note to step 2(a) states that financial    |
|   |benefits provided on cessation or transfer (of |
|   |the financial arrangement) that play an        |
|   |integral role in determining whether a gain or |
|   |loss (or the amount) are also to be included at|
|   |this step (as per paragraph 230-60(1)(c)).     |
|e  |total of amounts that, because of circumstances|
|=  |which occurred before the transfer or          |
|   |cessation, have been included in the entity's  |
|   |assessable income as gains from the financial  |
|   |arrangement, or would have been included in    |
|   |assessable income if all the gains from the    |
|   |arrangement were amounts of assessable income  |
|   |(subsection 230-445(1), steps 2(b) and (c) in  |
|   |the method statement).                         |
|f  |total of amounts that, because of circumstances|
|=  |which occurred after the transfer or cessation,|
|   |will be included in the entity's assessable    |
|   |income because of the transitional balancing   |
|   |adjustment (refer Chapter 13), or the portfolio|
|   |treatment of fees, discounts and premiums to   |
|   |the extent to which those amounts are          |
|   |attributable to the arrangement                |
|   |(subsection 230-445(1), step 2(d) and (e) in   |
|   |the method statement).                         |






   1133. The notes to step 1(a) and step 2(a) of the method statement for
         balancing adjustments at section 230-445 make clear that financial
         benefits that are taken to be provided or received under the
         financial arrangement (because of the operation of section 230-65)
         are to be included in the balancing adjustment calculation.  These
         are financial benefits that play an integral role in determining
         whether a gain or loss (or the amount) is made from the financial
         arrangement within the meaning of paragraphs 230-60(1)(c) and 230-
         60(2)(c).  To illustrate the application of this rule in the
         context of the balancing adjustment, consider a loan between two
         parties.  If the amount owed under the loan is 'waived' by the
         creditor then it could be said that the debtor has received a
         benefit in the form a 'waiver' being the release from payment under
         the loan.  However, in applying the balancing adjustment
         calculation to this simple example the 'waiver' benefit itself
         would not be considered integral (in the context of section 230-60)
         to working out whether the debtor has made a gain or loss on the
         financial arrangement.  The amount included in the balancing
         adjustment calculation in this situation would be the actual loan
         proceeds received by the debtor which is compared to any amounts
         provided by the debtor which in this example would be nil.


   1134. It is intended that, where running balancing adjustments (generally
         relevant for gains or losses subject to the accruals method) have
         been made over the period before disposal, these adjustments are
         taken into consideration when calculating the disposal balancing
         adjustment under the method statement for the disposal balancing
         adjustment.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-445(1), steps 1(b)
         and (c) and 2(b) and (c) in the method statement]


   1135. If the disposal balancing adjustment is positive (ie, when the
         total of the step 1 amount exceeds the step 2 amount), the amount
         is a gain made from the financial arrangement.  If the disposal
         balancing adjustment is negative (ie, when the total of the step 2
         amount exceeds the step 1 amount), the amount is a loss made from
         the arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-445(1), step
         3 in the method statement]


      1. :  Sale of a fixed interest bond


                Investor Co buys a five-year bond carrying a fixed annual
                coupon of 10 per cent per annum.  The bond is bought for
                $1,000 and is to be redeemed for $1,000 in five years.


                Assume that, after receiving two $100 coupons that were
                included in its assessable income $200, Investor Co sells
                the bond for $1,050.


                Investor Co's overall gain from having the bond is:


                $250  =  $1,050  +  (2  ×  $100)  -  $1,000


                Given that $200 has already been included in Investor Co's
                assessable income, only $50 has to be included as a disposal
                gain.


                Under the balancing adjustment formula, (a  +  b  +  c) less
                (d  +  e +  f), set out in paragraph 10.60 (though c and f
                are not relevant in this circumstance), the gain or loss is
                determined as follows:


                ($1,250 (per section 230-65, the $1,050 received on disposal
                is taken to have been received under the financial
                arrangement that is the bond)  +  $0  +  $0)  =  $1,250


                less


                ($1,000 (per section 230-60, the $1,000 is taken to have
                been provided under the financial arrangement that is the
                bond)  +  $200  +  $0)  =  $1,200


                =  $50 gain on disposal.


         Partial transfer


   1136. As mentioned in paragraph 10.9, there are circumstances where a
         balancing adjustment arises in respect of a partial disposal in
         certain circumstances.  In these circumstances, the variables in
         the above formula are adjusted to take into account the nature of
         the partial disposal, as discussed in the following paragraphs.


   1137. Where there is a disposal of a proportionate share of all the
         rights and/or obligations under a financial arrangement, all the
         variables are reduced by that proportion.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-445(2)]


   1138. Where there is a disposal of a right or obligation under a
         financial arrangement of a specifically identified financial
         benefit, it is necessary to determine what has happened in relation
         to that right or obligation - for example, in terms of the cost
         already allocated - in order to determine the gain or loss to be
         brought to account as a balancing adjustment.  This is done by
         determining, in relation to the particular variable, what is
         reasonably attributable to the right or obligation.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-445(3)]


   1139. The attribution of a right to receive or obligation to provide, or
         a proportion of such a right or obligation, a financial benefit to
         a particular financial benefit, must reflect appropriate and
         commercially accepted valuation principles.  These principles must
         take into account the nature of the rights and obligations under
         the financial arrangement, the risks associated with each of the
         financial benefits, rights and obligations under the arrangement,
         and the time value of money.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         445(5)]


   1140. Where there is a disposal of a proportionate share of a right to
         receive or obligation to provide to a financial benefit under the
         financial arrangement, to a specifically identified financial
         benefit, the two types of adjustment discussed above both apply.
         That is, the starting point for each of the variables in the
         formula is the amount reasonably attributable to the particular
         right or obligation.  These amounts are then reduced, by the
         disposal proportion, to arrive at the amounts actually used for
         the variables in the formula [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         445(4)].  This attribution must reflect the valuation principles
         discussed in paragraph 10.67 [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-
         445(5)].


      1. :  Assignment of rights to future amounts


                Assignor Co makes a 10-year loan of $5 million to Borrower
                Co.  The loan pays a fixed annual coupon.  The rate is
                8 per cent per annum.  Assume that this is also the
                prevailing market interest rate.


                Assignor Co immediately assigns the right to all the
                interest payments to Assignee Co for $2,684,033.  This
                payment is the present value of the future interest payments
                discounted at 8 per cent per annum.


                While the assigned payments are equal in amount to the
                interest on the loan, the assignment gives rise to a partial
                disposal of the asset, being the right to a stream of future
                payments.  In Assignee Co's hands, economically, each
                payment is equivalent to 'principal' and 'interest' (ie,
                each payment economically has a portion of Assignor Co's
                $5 million cost attributed to it - see discussion in Chapter
                3).  The rules in section 230-70 requiring no attribution of
                a cost to interest payments, do not apply for the purpose of
                Subdivision 230-G.


                To calculate the gain or loss on the partial disposal of the
                loan, it is necessary to determine the cost of assigned
                interest payments at that time.  Commercially, this is done
                by allocating an amount, sometimes referred to as the
                'carrying amount', to the part which is disposed of.  The
                partial disposal is done by allocating the carrying amount
                of the whole financial arrangement between the part disposed
                of, and the part retained, on the basis of the fair value of
                the part disposed of, relative to the fair value of the
                whole thing.


                The fair value, at the time of the partial disposal, of the
                part disposed of is $2,684,033 and the fair value of the
                whole loan, is $5 million.  The carrying amount of the whole
                loan is $5 million.


                Therefore, the carrying amount of the part disposed of is
                $2,684,033, which is the cost of the right to the 10 future
                annual payments of $400,000.  Since $2,684,033 is also the
                amount of proceeds from the assignment, there is no gain or
                loss.


                Under the balancing adjustment formula, (a  +  b  +  c) less

                (d  +  e  +  f) (though b, c, e and f are not relevant in
                this circumstance), set out in paragraph 10.60, this is
                determined as follows:


                ($2,684,033 (per section 230-65, this amount received on
                disposal is taken to have been received under the financial
                arrangement that is the loan, and it is entirely
                attributable to the portion of the arrangement, the interest
                income stream, disposed of)  +  $0  +  $0)  =  $2,684,033


                less


                ($2,684,033 (per section 230-65, the $5 million lent is
                taken to be an amount Assignor Co had an obligation to
                provide, and did provide under its financial arrangement,
                and $2,684,033 of this cost is attributable to its right to
                receive interest payments that were disposed of)  +  $0  +
                $0)  =  $2,684,033


                = $0 gain or loss on disposal.


                Alternatively, if, for example, Assignor Co assigns these
                payments for $3 million, it would make a gain of $315,967
                (step 1(a) in the above calculation would be $3 million).


When does the disposal occur?


   1141. The gain or loss produced by the disposal discussed in this chapter
         is made in the year in which the relevant cessation or transfer
         occurs.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-445(6)]


   1142. So, for example, if there is a disposal because of an assignment of
         certain rights under a financial arrangement, the gain or loss is
         made under the balancing adjustment when the assignment occurs.


   1143. In another case, when a financial arrangement is sold, a disposal
         occurs (and the balancing adjustment gain or loss is made) when the
         relevant rights and obligations are given up or transferred.


Arm's length value adjustment for financial benefits received or provided
where the parties are not dealing at arm's length


   1144. To preserve the integrity of Division 230, the amount of a
         financial benefit received or provided under certain non-arm's
         length financial arrangement dealings is to be substituted for the
         amount of the financial benefit that would reasonably be expected
         to be received or provided had the parties been dealing at arm's
         length.  Without such a rule, parties not dealing at arm's length
         could, as a result of those dealings, obtain inappropriate tax
         advantages.


   1145. Under various provisions of the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997, where
         a financial asset or liability ceases to be held as a result of a
         non-arm's length dealing those provisions generally require the
         Commissioner of Taxation to substitute an arm's length value if the
         amounts provided for the acquisition, transfer or cessation are not
         at arm's length.  Examples include:


                . subsections 26BB(3) and 70B(3) of the ITAA 1936 dealing
                  with gains and losses arising from the disposal or
                  redemption of traditional securities; and


                . section 775-120 of the ITAA 1997 dealing with the
                  calculation of foreign exchange gains and losses.


   1146. In addition, there are a number of provisions in the ITAA 1936 and
         the ITAA 1997 that either reduce the holding costs of a financial
         arrangement (eg, excessive interest payments claimed as a
         deduction) where the parties are not dealing at arm's length or,
         alternatively, require the substitution of a market value
         regardless of whether or not the parties are dealing at arm's
         length.  Examples include:


                . section 52A of the ITAA 1936, which limits a deduction to
                  the arm's length  amount on monies borrowed and used to
                  acquire 'prescribed property' where the parties are not
                  dealing at arm's length;


                . subsection 73B(31) of the ITAA 1936 which limits excessive
                  interest payments associated with research and development
                  activities  to their arm's length amount where there is a
                  non-arm's length dealing;


                . subsection 159GZZZQ(2) of Division 16K of the ITAA 1936
                  which deems the market value to have been received for the
                  disposal of a share in an off-market share buy-back
                  arrangement;


                . section 775-40 of the ITAA 1997 which deems a market value
                  where the proceeds from the disposal of foreign currency
                  is more or less than market value;  and


                . subsection 245-65(2) of Subdivision 245-C, Schedule 2C to
                  the ITAA 1936 which substitutes the market value as the
                  consideration provided by a debtor in respect of debt
                  forgiveness where no consideration is provided or the
                  consideration (in whole or part) cannot be valued.


   1147. To ensure that the intention of the above mentioned provisions is
         preserved, Division 230 contains corresponding integrity measures.
         Ensuring symmetry in the operation of these integrity measures
         between arrangements subject to Division 230 and those not subject
         to Division 230 would also operate to prevent inappropriate tax
         arbitrage opportunities.


   1148. The paragraphs below set out the situations when the non-arm's
         length dealing rule in Division 230 will apply to financial
         arrangements.


Non-arm's length dealings in relation to the complete or partial transfer,
cessation or from starting to have a financial arrangement


   1149. Consistent with the existing tax rules dealing with the disposal or
         redemption of traditional securities contained in sections 26BB and
         70B of the ITAA 1936, the intent of section 230-510 is to ensure
         that, upon the cessation or transfer of a financial arrangement,
         arm's length values are used to calculate the balancing adjustment
         if there has been a non-arm's length dealing in relation to the
         cessation or transfer, or the starting to hold the arrangement, or
         the holding of the arrangement.  This prevents the creation of a
         loss, a greater loss or reduction of a gain as a result of the
         parties not dealing at arm's length.


   1150. Also consistent with the application of the existing tax law
         dealing with the taxation of traditional securities, section 230-
         510 does not apply to non-arm's length cessations or non-arm's
         length dealings that arose prior to the cessation of loan-like
         financial arrangements (eg, when the taxpayer started to hold the
         financial arrangement).  This prevents a time-value-of-money
         financial benefit (eg, interest) being deemed to have been received
         or provided as a result of those dealings.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         paragraph 230-510(1)(b)]


   1151. Accordingly, subject to the exception discussed below, the non-
         arm's length dealing rule would apply where:


                . a balancing adjustment is made under section 230-435 in
                  respect of the financial arrangement;


                . the parties to the financial arrangement did not deal at
                  arm's length in relation to the cessation or complete or
                  partial transfer of the financial arrangement, or in
                  relation to an earlier time (including starting to have
                  the financial arrangement);  and


                . the amount of the financial benefit received or provided
                  under the financial arrangement at any time from (and
                  including) starting to hold the financial arrangement
                  until (and including) a complete or partial transfer or
                  cessation is more or less than the financial benefit that
                  might be reasonably expected to have been received or
                  provided if the parties were dealing at arm's length.


   1152. In such circumstances, unless a specific exception applies (see
         below), the amount of the financial benefit received or provided
         (including where it is nil) is taken, for the purposes of Division
         230, to be the amount of the financial benefit that would have been
         received or provided if the parties were dealing at arm's length.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-510]


      1. :  Non-arm's length dealing


                Hamish Co and Lucky Co entered into a financial arrangement
                on 1 July 2010 whereby Hamish Co agreed to provide Lucky Co
                with a financial benefit of $100 in return for Lucky Co
                providing periodic financial benefits based on arm's length
                rates of interest of 10 per cent per annum and a repayment
                of the original $100 financial benefit in five years from
                the date the financial benefit was provided.  Hamish Co
                disposes of the rights to receive the financial benefits
                under the financial arrangement to a related entity, Bert
                Co, for $90 when its arm's length value is $100.


                Having regard to the relationship between the parties to the
                transfer and the fact that Hamish Co transferred the
                financial arrangement to Bert Co, a related entity, for a
                non-arm's length amount, it would be concluded that Hamish
                Co and Bert Co are not dealing at arm's length in relation
                to the transfer.


                In these circumstances, Hamish Co would be taken to have
                received a financial benefit equal to the arm's length value
                of $100 as a result of the disposal.


                Bert Co will be taken to have acquired the financial
                arrangement for $100.


Exception for non-arm's length dealings arising from the cessation of
financial arrangements that are debt interests or loans


   1153. In certain circumstances, applying an arm's length rule as a result
         of a cessation event may give rise to inappropriate tax outcomes
         and impute a time-value-of-money financial benefit where no
         financial benefit is to be paid.  Therefore the measures exclude
         from the operation of the arm's length rule, non-arm's length
         dealings arising in respect of debt interests and loans (whether
         they are loans in legal form or economic substance) that cease to
         be held other than by transfer (eg, by repayment).  This outcome is
         achieved, in part, by excluding non-arm's length dealings in
         respect of commencing to hold or the cessation of a 'debt interest'
         as defined for the purposes of the debt/equity rules in Division
         974 of the ITAA 1997 and other financial arrangements that are
         loans.  Financial arrangements that are loans would include, for
         the purposes of Division 230, those financial arrangements that
         would normally be considered to have debt-like features such as the
         existence of debtor and creditor relationship.  One such example
         would be an interest-free loan with a term greater than 10 years.


   1154. Without such an exclusion, a cessation event in relation to a debt
         interest or loan would result in the imputing of a gain to the
         lender and a loss to the issuer because the financial benefit
         amount repaid by a related party borrower would be less than the
         arm's length value (which would be the loan amount and the time-
         value-of-money as compensation for use of funds).


      1. :  Acquisition and cessation of a non-arm's length dealing
         financial arrangement


                Hamish Co and a related entity, Lucky Co, entered into an
                arrangement on 1 July 2010 whereby, Hamish Co agreed to
                provide Lucky Co with a financial benefit of $100 (interest-
                free) repayable in full in 15 years from the date the
                financial benefit was provided.  On 1 July 2010 the market
                value of the right to receive the $100 financial benefit in
                15 years time is $70.


                On entering into the arrangement Hamish Co has a financial
                arrangement being the right to receive a cash settlable
                financial benefit of $100 in 15 years time.  Lucky Co also
                has a financial arrangement being the obligation to provide
                a cash settlable financial benefit of $100 in 15 years time.


                Having regard to the relationship between the parties to the
                financial arrangement and the fact that, had Hamish Co
                provided the financial benefit of $100 to a non-related
                entity the financial benefits or benefits that Hamish Co
                would have been entitled to would have included a financial
                benefit or benefits calculated by reference to the 15 years
                that the $100 cash has been provided for, it would be
                concluded that the parties are not dealing at arm's length.


                The financial arrangement would be treated as a loan for the
                purposes of Division 230 given that there is an obligation
                to repay the amount after 15 years.


                If the non-arm's length rule applied to this situation,
                Hamish Co would make a $30 gain on the cessation of the
                financial arrangement which would have had the effect of
                imputing or deeming a time-value-of-money gain on the
                financial arrangement.  Paragraph 230-510(1)(b) operates so
                as to prevent the application of the arm's length rule to
                these circumstances and hence no gain or loss arising from
                the non-arm's length dealing would be bought to account.


                From Lucky Co's perspective, when it commences to hold the
                non-arm's length financial arrangement its market value
                would be $70, which, if it had been substituted for the
                actual amount received, would have resulted in a loss on
                providing the financial benefit for Lucky Co at the end of
                the term of the financial arrangement (because Lucky Co is
                required to provide $100 at the end of the term of the
                financial arrangement).  Consistent with the tax treatment
                of Hamish Co, the loss from the related party non-arm's
                length dealing would not be recognised by not requiring the
                arm's length value to be substituted in the calculation of
                Lucky Co's balancing adjustment.  On cessation of the loan,
                Lucky Co's financial benefits provided would be taken to be
                $100 rather than the market value of $70.


Exception for the transfer of non-arm's length debt interests or loan-like
arrangements


   1155. In certain circumstances, the measures operate where there is a
         complete or partial transfer of a debt interest or loan and a loss,
         or gain, arises under the method statement as set out in
         subsection 230-445(1).  In such a case, the loss or the gain is
         adjusted by the difference between the amount of any financial
         benefits provided under the financial arrangement and the amount
         that would have been provided if the parties were dealing at arm's
         length.  That is, the loss or the gain is adjusted only to the
         extent that it is attributable to the non-arm's length dealing as
         distinct from other factors.


      1. :  Transfer of a non-arm's length financial arrangement


                Tony Co enters into an arrangement with related entity
                Teresa Co on 1 July 2012 whereby Tony Co agrees to provide
                Teresa Co with a financial benefit of $100.  Teresa Co is
                required to repay the $100 in five years time.  At the time
                the arrangement is entered into, market interest rates are
                at 6 per cent per annum resulting in arm's length value for
                the arrangement of $74.73.


                On 1 July 2013, Tony Co transfers the right to receive the
                financial benefit of $100 in three years' time (being five
                years from the original date of the arrangement) for its
                market value of $72 (interest rates have risen).


                On entering into the arrangement, Tony Co has a financial
                arrangement, being the right to receive a cash settlable
                financial benefit of $100 in five years' time.  Teresa Co
                also has a financial arrangement, being the obligation to
                provide a cash settlable financial benefit of $100 in five
                years' time.  The financial arrangement is a debt interest
                as defined in Division 974 of the ITAA 1997.


                Having regard to the relationship between the parties to the
                financial arrangement and the fact that, had Tony Co
                provided the financial benefit of $100 to a non-related
                entity the financial benefits that would have been received
                by Tony Co would have included a financial benefit or a
                series of financial benefits for the use of the $100 cash
                provided for a term of five years, it would be concluded
                that the parties are not dealing at arm's length.


                Upon transfer of the financial arrangement, a loss of $25.27
                would ordinarily arise under the balancing adjustment method
                statement contained in subsection 230-445(1) (total of all
                financial benefits received under the financial arrangement
                of $74.73 less the total of all financial benefits provided
                under the financial arrangement of $100).


                However, had the parties been dealing at arm's length in
                relation to the original acquisition, the loss would have
                been limited to $2.73 (the difference between $74.73 and
                $72).  Subsection 230-510(3) operates to reduce the loss on
                transfer of the financial arrangement to this amount.


Arm's length dealings in relation to certain financial arrangements

   1156. As mentioned above, in certain circumstances the existing tax law
         under the ITAA 1936 or the ITAA 1997 operates to:
                . substitute an arm's length amount where the parties are
                  not dealing with each other at arm's length and excessive
                  deductions are claimed under a financial arrangement to
                  amounts; or
                . substitute a market value for the relevant financial
                  benefit where the parties are dealing with each other at
                  arm's length but the relevant financial benefit is not at
                  market value.
   1157. To ensure symmetry and prevent opportunities for tax arbitrage
         between those provisions in the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997 that
         require the use of an arm's length or market value rule, the
         Division 230 arm's length rules will, where the circumstances
         specified in the relevant provisions apply, operate to substitute
         an arm's length value or market value for the relevant financial
         benefit.  The provisions in subsection 230-442(2) are provisions in
         the income tax law that effectively provide a market value
         substitution rule irrespective of whether or not the relevant
         transaction is at arm's length, namely:
                . section 52A of the ITAA 1936;
                . section 73B of the ITAA 1936;
                . Division 16J of the ITAA 1936;
                . Division 16K of the ITAA 1936;
                . subsection 245-65(2) of Subdivision 245-C, Schedule 2C to
                  the  ITAA 1936; and
                . section 775-40 of the ITAA 1997.

   1158. In certain circumstances, both the arm's length dealing rules in
         section 230-510 and section 230-442 can have application in respect
         of a financial arrangement.  In such cases, section 230-510 will
         operate to specify the amount of the financial benefit that is to
         be substituted for the purposes of Division 230 in a non-arm's
         length dealing.



Chapter 11
Interaction and consequential amendments (other than consolidation)

Outline of chapter


   1159. This chapter explains various amendments made to provisions of the:


                . Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (ITAA 1936);


                . Income Tax Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA 1997);


                . Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997;


                . New Business Tax System (Taxation of Financial
                  Arrangements) Act 2003 (NBTS (TOFA) 2003); and


                . Taxation Administration Act 1953 (TAA 1953),


         which are required as a result of the introduction of Division 230
         into the ITAA 1997.


Context of amendments


   1160. Several provisions in the ITAA 1936, the ITAA 1997 and the TAA 1953
         currently deal with the taxation of arrangements that may satisfy
         the definition of 'financial arrangement'.  The intended operation
         of those provisions may be affected by the introduction of Division
         230 into the ITAA 1997.  Amendments to the other provisions of the
         tax laws were required to ensure that they operate as intended in
         the context of the introduction of Division 230.  These are the
         'consequential amendments' which are required to adjust the
         operation of the current provisions of the tax laws as a
         consequence of the introduction of Division 230.


   1161. Further, a number of provisions were included in Division 230 which
         will affect the operation of other provisions of the Act.
         Generally, these amendments will affect the amount or value of a
         financial benefit for the purposes of the other provisions of the
         tax laws (eg, capital gains tax (CGT) or capital allowance
         purposes) or the amount or value of a financial benefit for the
         purposes of calculating a gain or loss for Division 230 purposes.
         These types of amendments are the 'interaction amendments' as they
         provide rules which deal with the interaction of the other
         provisions of the tax laws with Division 230.


Summary of new law


   1162. Generally, the consequential and interaction amendments that are
         explained in this chapter fall into six categories:


                . ordering rules:  a financial arrangement may fall within
                  the scope of provisions of the tax laws other than
                  Division 230.  This category of amendment ensures that it
                  is clear which provision will prevail in such
                  circumstances;


                . value setting rules:  financial benefits are recognised in
                  Division 230 for a number of purposes.  One such purpose
                  is to calculate a gain or loss that will then be brought
                  to account under Division 230.  Those financial benefits
                  may also be relevant for other purposes of the tax laws.
                  This category of amendments operates to provide rules
                  which set the values of those financial benefits for the
                  purposes of the tax laws (including Division 230);


                . recognition of gains and losses:  this category of
                  amendments provides rules which go to whether an amount is
                  assessable or deductible where a Division 230 financial
                  arrangement is involved;


                . definitional:  this category of amendments is required
                  because certain definitions in the tax laws may change as
                  a result of the introduction of Division 230;


                . referencing:  this category of amendments comprises
                  technical changes which either introduces signposts to
                  Division 230 in other provisions of the tax laws or
                  updates the relevant finding tables in the ITAA 1997; and


                . record-keeping:  this section outlines how the record-
                  keeping requirements have been modified as a result of the
                  introduction of Division 230.


   1163. Further, amendments have been made to ensure that Division 775 of
         the ITAA 1997 (foreign currency gains and losses) will start to
         apply to authorised deposit-taking institutions (ADIs), non-ADI
         financial institutions and securitisation vehicles.  The intention
         to have Division 775 apply to those types of taxpayers when the
         retranslation module of the taxation of financial arrangements
         reforms comes into effect was stated in the explanatory memorandum
         to the NBTS (TOFA) 2003.  The retranslation module of the taxation
         of financial arrangements reforms is contained in Subdivision 230-D
         of this Bill.


   1164. As a result of the Division 775 amendments, some amendments were
         required to the NBTS (TOFA) 2003.  Those amendments were announced
         in the then Minister for Revenue and Assistant Treasurer's Press
         Release No. 073 of 2 September 2005 (Securitisation vehicles and
         foreign currency rules).


Detailed explanation of new law


   1165. As outlined above, the consequential and interaction amendments can
         be grouped into six categories.  Each of the amendments that fit
         into a particular category is explained below.


Ordering rules


   1166. In situations where a number of different provisions may apply to
         an arrangement that is also a 'financial arrangement' for Division
         230 purposes, these amendments provide rules which determine which
         provision should take precedence over the other.


         12-month prepayment rule


   1167. Subdivision 3 of Division H of Part III of the ITAA 1936 sets out
         the timing of the deduction that may be allowable when such
         expenditure is prepaid.  These rules alter the normal effect of
         section 8-1 of the ITAA 1997, which otherwise may have allowed a
         deduction in full in the year in which the expenditure is incurred.


   1168. Division 230 does not apply to gains or losses made from short-term
         financial arrangements that arise in respect of the prepayments for
         goods, property or services [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-450].
         Subdivision 3 of Division H generally applies to certain prepaid
         expenditure where that expenditure relates to a period which
         extends beyond the income year in which the expenditure is
         incurred.  That period may be less than 12 months.  In such
         situations, Division 230 will not apply to the gain or loss that
         arises under the same set of facts.  However, the relevant
         prepayment period may be more than 12 months - where this is the
         case, there may still be situations where the rules in
         Subdivision 3 of Division H of the ITAA 1936 and Division 230
         overlap.


   1169. Where the rules do overlap, Division 230 will take precedence over
         Subdivision 3 of Division H of the ITAA 1936.  [Schedule 1, item
         33, paragraph 82KZLA(a) of the ITAA 1936]


         Qualifying securities


         Deferred interest and discounted securities


   1170. Division 16E of Part III of the ITAA 1936 taxes gains and losses on
         certain discounted and deferred interest securities on an accruals
         basis.


   1171. Provisions throughout the ITAA 1936, the ITAA 1997, the Income Tax
         (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 and the TAA 1953 rely on or
         build on the taxing outcomes and concepts of Division 16E in order
         to achieve their intent.


   1172. Division 230 of the ITAA 1997 will provide the tax treatment for
         most of the gains and losses on discounted and deferred interest
         securities that are acquired or issued on or after 1 July 2010, or
         1 July 2009 should the taxpayer so elect, that would otherwise have
         been taxed under Division 16E.


   1173. To ensure the appropriate operation of provisions that rely or
         build on the taxing outcomes and concepts in Division 16E where a
         taxpayer holds a Division 230 financial arrangement, particularly
         one taxed under the accruals method in Subdivision 230-B, the
         consequential amendments discussed below are necessary.


         Tainted interest income


   1174. The ITAA 1936 deals with the attributable income of controlled
         foreign companies.  The definition of tainted interest income,
         relies on the taxing outcome under Division 16E of the ITAA 1936.
         In particular under paragraph 317(1)(b) tainted interest income
         includes amounts that would have been assessable income under
         Division 16E had the controlled foreign company been a resident.
         To ensure that Division 230 does not expand the scope of tainted
         interest income before it is decided whether Division 230 should be
         applied in calculating attributable income as part of the Board of
         Tax's 'review of foreign source income, the definition is amended
         to include amounts that would have been assessable under Division
         16E had Division 230 not been introduced.


         Land transport facilities offset


   1175. Division 396 allows a lender a tax offset for certain interest
         (land transport facilities interest) it derives on approved
         borrowings for the construction of land transport facilities.
         'Land transport facilities interest' is defined by paragraphs 396-
         30(1)(b) and 396-30(2)(b) of the ITAA 1997 to include amounts that
         would either be assessable income or allowable deductions under
         Division 16E.  To ensure that Division 230 does not expand the
         scope of what is land transport facilities interest, the amendments
         to paragraphs 396-30(1)(b) and 396-30(2)(b) ensure that only those
         amounts assessable or deductible under Division 230 that would also
         have been assessable or deductible under Division 16E, had it
         applied, are land transport facilities interest.


         Fixed interest complying approved deposit fund


   1176. Subsection 295-390(5) of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions)
         Act 1997 defines what a fixed interest complying approved deposit
         fund is.  A complying approved deposit fund will be a fixed
         interest complying approved deposit fund if 90 per cent or more of
         its income is comprised of amounts which, amongst other things, are
         included in its assessable income under Division 16E of the ITAA
         1997.  In order to preserve the existing scope of these measures,
         the amendment ensures that where Division 230 financial
         arrangements are required to be taken into account in determining
         whether an approved deposit fund is a complying fixed interest
         fund, only those amounts that would have been bought to account
         under Division 16E, had it applied, are taken into account.


         Special accrual amount


   1177. Under section 960 of the ITAA 1997, amounts that are denominated in
         a foreign currency are required to be translated into Australian
         currency.  Generally where these amounts are used in calculating
         another amount, subsection 960-50(4) of the ITAA 1997 requires each
         of those amounts to be translated from a foreign currency to
         Australian currency before the calculation is done.  The exception
         to this is where the amount is a 'special accrual amount' as
         defined in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997.


   1178. Where an amount is a 'special accrual amount' it is calculated
         without translating the amounts used to calculate it.  The special
         accrual amount is then translated into Australian currency.  The
         definition of 'special accrual amount' includes the accruals
         taxation of Division 16E securities.


   1179. To ensure that 'special accrual amount' includes amounts calculated
         under Division 230 that are consistent with its intent, the
         definition has been amended to ensure that only those gains and
         losses under Subdivision 230-B that would be accounted for under
         Division 16E are subject to the 'special accrual amount' rules.


         Subsection 57-25(6) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936


   1180. Division 57 of Schedule 2D of the ITAA 1936 sets out the income tax
         treatment of an entity that ceases to be wholly exempt from income
         tax.  In particular, subsection 57-25(2) of the ITAA 1936 treats
         assets to which section 57-25 applies to have been sold by the
         taxpayer immediately before the transition time and re-acquired by
         the taxpayer at the transition time for an amount equal to the
         asset's adjusted market value for the purposes of determining
         future tax consequences.  However, the deemed re-acquisition rule
         does not invoke the operation of certain provisions of the ITAA
         1936 and the ITAA 1997 if the asset was acquired prior to the
         commencement of certain provisions listed in subsection 57-25(6).


   1181. To ensure that there is no inadvertent retrospective application of
         Division 230 to assets acquired prior to the commencement of
         Division 230 in the circumstances described above, subsection 57-
         25(6) includes it in its listed provisions Division 230.


         Consideration from the transfer of a right to receive income from
         property


   1182. Section 102CA of the ITAA 1936 includes any consideration received
         from the transfer of a right to receive income from property in the
         transferor's assessable income in the income year in which the
         right is transferred.  The consideration is included in the
         transferor's income in the year in which the right is transferred
         even if the consideration is, in whole or in part, not actually
         received until a later income year.


   1183. Such a result is inconsistent with the intended operation of
         Division 230 in respect of such transactions - that is to bring to
         account gains (or losses) where there is a delay in time between
         the disposal of an asset and actual payment of the consideration.
         This amendment will ensure that section 102CA of the ITAA 1936 will
         not apply where the right to receive income from property comprises
         a financial arrangement to which Division 230 also applies.  In
         such situations, the relevant gain or loss that arises from the
         transfer of such rights is instead brought to account under
         Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 35, paragraph 102CA(2)(c) of the
         ITAA 1936]


         Complying superannuation funds, complying approved deposit funds
         and pooled superannuation trusts


   1184. As part of the re-write of the provisions contained in Part IX of
         the ITAA 1936, Part 3-30 was introduced into the ITAA 1997.  In
         particular, section 295-85 was introduced to ensure that only the
         CGT provisions (and not the general income provisions) apply if a
         CGT event happens involving a CGT asset owned by a complying
         superannuation fund, a complying approved deposit fund or a pooled
         superannuation trust.  Paragraph 295-85(2)(a) of the ITAA 1997 will
         be amended to add a reference to Division 230 to ensure that where
         a CGT event happens to a CGT asset that is also a financial
         arrangement, the relevant gain or loss is brought to account under
         the CGT provisions and not Division 230.  However, the exceptions
         to the rule in subsection 295-85(2) that are contained in
         subsection 295-85(3) will still operate to apply Division 230 where
         there is a gain or loss made in respect of foreign currency
         fluctuations or there is a disposal of certain types of securities.
          [Schedule 1, item 80, paragraph 295-85(2)(a)]


         Life insurance companies


   1185. Section 320-45 operates to apply the same treatment for CGT assets
         that are a virtual pooled superannuation trust asset of a life
         insurance company, as that described above, for those entities
         subject to section 295-85.  A subsection is proposed to be added to
         section 320-45 of the ITAA 1997 to ensure that, where relevant,
         section 320-45 will apply rather than Division 230 to bring to
         account gains or losses from financial arrangements that are also a
         virtual pooled superannuation trust asset of a life insurance
         company.  [Schedule 1, item 82, subsection 320-45(2)]


         Foreign trusts, controlled foreign companies and foreign investment
         funds


   1186. The Board of Tax's 'review of foreign source income anti-tax
         deferral rules' is currently considering the operation of the tax
         law in relation to interests held in controlled foreign companies
         as well as foreign investment funds and non-resident trusts more
         widely.  Consequently, how Division 230 should apply in relation to
         interests in controlled foreign companies, foreign investment funds
         and non-resident trusts will receive further consideration in the
         light of the outcomes of that review.


   1187. Pending the finalisation of that review, instead of Division 230
         applying, the current provisions of the tax laws will apply to
         bring to account gains or losses made from arrangements that would
         otherwise be classified as 'financial arrangements' for the
         purposes of the Division.  More specifically, in relation to each
         of these entities:


                . for non-resident trusts:  will be made to ensure Division
                  230 is disregarded in working out the net income of a non-
                  resident trust estate for certain purposes.  This
                  amendment is relevant for the purposes of both Division 6
                  of Part III of the ITAA 1936 and Division 6AAA of Part III
                  of the ITAA 1936 in calculating the amount to be
                  attributed to a transferor [Schedule 1, item 34, paragraph
                  96C(5A)(aa) of the ITAA 1936];


                . for controlled foreign companies:  an amendment to
                  section 389 of the ITAA 1936 will be made to ensure
                  Division 230 is disregarded in working out the
                  attributable income of an eligible controlled foreign
                  company.  This amendment will ensure that attributable
                  income is calculated with reference to the current law
                  (including Division 775 (foreign currency gains and
                  losses), Subdivision 960-C (translation of foreign
                  currency) and Subdivision 960-D (functional currency) of
                  the ITAA 1997) [Schedule 1, item 49, paragraph 389(ba) of
                  the ITAA 1936]; and


                . for foreign investment funds:  an amendment to section
                  557A of the ITAA 1936 will be made to ensure Division 230
                  is disregarded in working out calculated profit or
                  calculated loss of a foreign investment fund.  The
                  amendment will ensure that foreign investment fund income
                  is calculated under the current law [Schedule 1, item 50,
                  paragraph 557A(c) of the ITAA 1936].


         Deductions for returns on debt interests


   1188. To avoid doubt, where a debt interest (as per Division 974 of the
         ITAA 1997) is also a financial arrangement for the purposes of
         Division 230, the gains or losses on those debt interests are
         brought to account or allowable as a deduction under Division 230.
         [Schedule 1, item 59, subsection 25-85(4A)]


   1189. To avoid doubt, a note has been added to section 25-90 which deals
         with deductions relating to foreign non-assessable non-exempt
         income to provide a signpost for the reader that the provisions of
         Division 230 prevail over section 25-90 when the relevant loss is
         made in respect of a financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 60,
         note to section 29-90]


         Withholding tax


   1190. Where a financial arrangement is held (as an asset) by a foreign
         resident, any gain or part thereof from the financial arrangement
         that is income (eg, interest) to which section 128B of the ITAA
         1936 applies is not to be assessable under Division 230.  Those
         gains are to be subject to withholding tax as per Division 11A of
         Part III of the ITAA 1936.  Any other gain/loss made from the
         financial arrangement, including a balancing adjustment gain/loss,
         is to be dealt with in accordance with Division 230.  This policy
         approach leads to two conclusions in the extreme cases.  First,
         where the only gains that have been or can be made from the
         financial arrangement are amounts to which section 128B applies or
         will apply (or would apply but for certain exceptions in that
         section that are discussed in the next paragraph) and no loss can
         be made, Division 230 will effectively not apply at all to those
         gains while the financial arrangement is held by, or when it ceases
         to be held by, a foreign resident.  Second, if no such payments are
         made/are to be made to a foreign resident in respect of a financial
         arrangement it holds, Division 230 will apply to determine what
         gain/loss is made and whether it is assessable or deductible.


   1191. The gains to be disregarded for the purposes of section 230-15 are
         amounts that are income to which section 128B applies, or would
         apply but for the exclusions in Division 11A, other than exclusions
         that deal with situations where the income is intended to be taxed
         by assessment (if it has an Australian source) rather than by
         withholding tax.  In the current law these latter exclusions are
         those in paragraphs 128B(3)(d), (e), (gb), and (j), subparagraph
         128B(3)(h)(ii) and subsection 128B(3E) or in section 17A of the
         International Tax Agreements Act 1953.  The disregarded gains, or
         more correctly the payments by which the gains are realised, are to
         be subject to withholding tax or in some cases (eg, amounts covered
         by paragraph 128B(3)(jb) or section 128F) exempt from withholding
         tax.  These gains are hereafter referred to as 'Division 11A
         payments'.


   1192. Normally, section 128D would result in these Division 11A payments
         being non-assessable non-exempt income.  However, in many cases
         where the gains from a financial arrangement are dealt with by
         Division 230 the amount otherwise assessable under that Division
         will be different from that which is dealt with by Division 11A and
         so section 128D may not apply.  A similar issue arises under the
         existing law in relation to the eligible return on a qualifying
         security where some or all of the payments are interest.  In that
         case, an exemption from treatment under Division 16E of Part III of
         the ITAA 1936 for non-residents is provided by subsection 159GW(1)
         of the ITAA 1936.


   1193. A payment that is subject to withholding tax is non-assessable non-
         exempt income and so to that extent a gain from the financial
         arrangement that would otherwise be assessable will not be
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-30(1)].  To the extent that
         gains reflect payments that are exempt from withholding tax but are
         nevertheless non-assessable non-exempt income under section 128D
         (eg, interest that is exempt from withholding tax by section 128F)
         they also will not be assessable under Division 230.  Clearly,
         these amounts are not intended to be taxed in Australia.  However,
         in relation to amounts that are exempt from withholding tax but are
         not made non-assessable non-exempt income by section 128D (eg,
         interest paid to an Australian permanent establishment of a foreign
         resident), gains will still be determined in accordance with
         Division 230 and they will be assessable if they have an Australian
         source.


      1. :  Withholding tax and accruals

                In Example 4.2 assume that Hristina Co, the holder of the
                bond, is a foreign resident and that all the payments are
                interest to which section 128B applies and on which
                withholding tax would be payable.  In that example, it is
                determined that the accruals method would apply to the
                overall gain from the bond.  However, because all the gain
                reflects amounts that will be subject to withholding tax and
                so are non-assessable non-exempt income (on the assumption
                that Hristina Co is a foreign resident), each annual gain
                calculated using the accruals method would be non-assessable
                non-exempt income.  In practice, Hristina Co would probably
                not even calculate the annual accrual amounts.
                Nevertheless, Division 230 may still be used by the issuer
                to calculate its annual losses from the bond and to
                determine whether they are deductible or not.
   1194. Unlike Division 16E, Division 230 could still apply to other gains
         or losses from the financial arrangement held by a foreign
         resident.  In particular, any retranslation gain/loss would still
         be dealt with under Division 230 (if a retranslation election
         applies to the financial arrangement).  If the financial
         arrangement were subject to a fair value or financial reports
         election and not all gains are Division 11A payments, the amount
         recognised in the accounts which would otherwise be used for these
         methods would be reduced by the amounts of the Division 11A
         payments.  If a loss would otherwise arise for an income year under
         either method (due to changing interest rates and therefore prices
         for the financial arrangement), the adjustment for the Division 11A
         payments would increase that loss.
      1. :  Withholding tax and forex loss
                In Example 7.2 assume that A Co, the holder of the note, is
                a foreign resident and that the gain on maturity is subject
                to withholding tax.  The amount on which withholding tax
                would be payable is A$1,859 (  =  US$1,450/0.78).  Because
                that amount is therefore non-assessable non-exempt income,
                to that extent the annual gains calculated using the accrual
                method are non-assessable non-exempt income (or are
                disregarded).  That leaves only the foreign exchange loss
                caused by the change in A$/US$ exchange rate over the three
                years.  In the absence of a retranslation election, the
                balancing adjustment calculation on maturity picks up this
                foreign exchange loss.  The balancing adjustment loss would
                be as calculated in the same manner as in that example
                except the interest amount captured in step 2 would be
                A$1,859 rather than the annual assessable gains totalling
                A$1,295, resulting in a loss of A$5,054.  Deductibility
                would be determined according to section 230-15.
   1195. When it comes to calculating a balancing adjustment under
         Subdivision 230-G, these Division 11A amounts fall within step 2(c)
         in the method statement in section 230-395.  This is illustrated in
         the preceding example with the deduction of the interest amount
         received on maturity of the note.  It includes gains that are
         exempt or non-assessable non-exempt income.  This would effectively
         extend to gains of a foreign resident that are not assessable
         because they do not have an Australian source or because they are
         payments that are dealt with by Division 11A.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         note to paragraph (c) of step 2 in the method statement in
         subsection 230-445(1)]

         Trading stock


   1196. Division 70 of the ITAA 1997, which deals with the taxation of
         trading stock, will not apply to trading stock that is a financial
         arrangement to which Division 230 applies.  Rather, all financial
         arrangements that are subject to Division 230 should have the gains
         or losses made on those arrangements recognised under Division 230.
          In some situations this will allow taxpayers to align the tax
         treatment of the gains or losses made on their financial
         arrangement, that otherwise satisfy the definition of 'trading
         stock', with their financial accounting treatment.


   1197. To avoid doubt, an amendment is made to the definition of 'trading
         stock' such that financial arrangements that are subject to
         Division 230 cannot be trading stock for the purposes of Division
         70.  This means, for example that, while the cost of trading stock
         which is a financial arrangement will not be an allowable deduction
         under section 8-1 of the ITAA 1997, that amount will be taken into
         account in calculating a gain or a loss that may be an allowable
         deduction under subsection 230-15(2).  [Schedule 1, item 68,
         section 70-10 of the ITAA 1997]


         Capital gains tax - anti-overlap rule


   1198. Section 118-27 provides that, where Division 230 applies to a
         financial arrangement, a capital gain or a capital loss that is
         made:


                . from a CGT asset;


                . in creating a CGT asset; or


                . from the discharge of a liability,


         is disregarded if, at the time of the CGT event from which the gain
         or loss is made, the asset or liability is, or is part of, a
         'Division 230 financial arrangement' [Schedule 1, item 76,
         subsection 118-27(1)].  A Division 230 financial arrangement is one
         where the gains or losses from the arrangement are brought to
         account under Division 230 [Schedule 1, item 11, definition of
         'Division 230 financial arrangement' in subsection 995-1(1) of the
         ITAA 1997].


   1199. Where Division 230 applies to gains and losses from a financial
         arrangement that is a CGT asset (or where a CGT asset forms part of
         that arrangement), a capital gain or a capital loss that is made
         from CGT events that happen to that CGT asset is disregarded.
         However, where a foreign resident makes a gain or loss from a CGT
         event happening in relation to taxable Australian property but the
         gain is not assessable or the loss is not deductible under Division
         230, the capital gain or loss will still be counted in determining
         the foreign resident's net capital gain/loss for the year [Schedule
         1, item 76, subsection 118-27(3)].


   1200. The further references to creating a CGT asset and discharging a
         liability are intended to reflect the fact that a gain or loss from
         a financial arrangement:


                . that is or includes a CGT asset, may arise in respect of
                  the creation of that CGT asset, in circumstances that
                  would also give rise to a capital gain or loss; and


                . that is or includes a liability, may arise on the
                  discharging or extinguishment of that liability in
                  circumstances that would also give rise to a capital gain
                  or loss.


         This may be relevant for a CGT asset that forms part of a
         taxpayer's financial arrangement that the taxpayer has created in
         another entity, giving rise to CGT event D1; or where a discharge
         of a liability that forms part of a financial arrangement also
         gives rise to CGT event L7.  [Schedule 1, item 76, subsection 118-
         27(1)]


  1201. It is intended that the introduction of section 118-27 will
        significantly reduce compliance costs by removing the requirement
        for a CGT calculation to be made for transactions that are wholly
        covered by Division 230.  Such a calculation would still have been
        required under section 118-20, because that provision requires that
        any capital gain or capital loss be reduced to the extent to which
        a gain or loss is brought to account under another provision of the
        ITAA 1936 or the ITAA 1997, because of the CGT event.


      1. :  Where CGT provisions are not applicable


                On 30 June 2011, Scruffy Co acquires a zero coupon bond from
                Nik Co for its net present value as at that date of
                $8,944.32.


                Nik Co acquired the bond when it was originally issued on
                1 July 2009.  The terms of the bond are:


              . Issue price:  $8,000.


              . Maturity date:  1 July 2012.


              . Amount payable at maturity:  $10,000.


              . Internal rate of return:  11.804 per cent.


                When it acquired the bond, Nik Co determined that it would
                make an overall gain on the financial arrangement and was
                required to return that gain on an accruals basis in
                accordance with Subdivision 230-B.


                A gain of $944.32 has been accrued up until the time of
                disposal and is required to be included in assessable income
                in accordance with Division 230.


                For CGT purposes, the bond is a CGT asset which has been
                subject to CGT event A1 upon its disposal.  Section 118-27
                provides that any capital gain or loss from this CGT event
                is disregarded.  Accordingly, Nik Co is not required to
                undertake a separate calculation to determine whether there
                was an amount of any capital gain or capital loss that would
                otherwise have to have been calculated on the disposal of
                the financial arrangement.  Without section 118-27, the
                capital gain or capital loss would have been calculated and
                then reduced under section 118-20 of the ITAA 1997 to the
                extent to which that gain or loss was brought to account
                under Division 230.


   1202. Where a taxpayer has elected to align the tax characterisation of a
         gain or loss from a hedging financial arrangement with the tax
         characterisation of the hedged item, then the rule in subsection
         118-27(1) that disregards relevant capital gains or losses is
         switched off.  This ensures that taxpayers are able to better align
         their after tax hedging position.  [Schedule 1, item 76,
         paragraph 118-27(2)(a)]


   1203. Paragraph 118-27(2)(b) also provides an exception to subsection 118-
         27(1) in circumstances where a capital loss is made from ceasing to
         have a financial arrangement that is a marketable security (within
         the meaning of section 70B of the ITAA 1936).  The rationale for
         this is because where subsection 230-415(1) applies, a deduction is
         not allowable under Division 230 to the extent that the loss is of
         a capital nature.  This loss is a capital loss for the purposes of
         the CGT provisions.


         Foreign currency gains and losses - anti-overlap rule


   1204. A note, following subsections 775-15(4) and 775-30(4), inserted by
         this Schedule, clarifies that where foreign currency gains and
         losses are brought to account under either Division 230 or
         Subdivision 775-F of the ITAA 1997, subsection 230-20(2) has the
         effect of disregarding gains and losses from such arrangements
         under Division 775 to the extent they are, or will be, included in
         assessable income or allowable as a deduction under Division 230.


Value setting rules


   1205. This category of amendments operates to provide rules which set the
         values of financial benefits in certain situations where a
         Division 230 financial arrangement is involved.


         Section 230-505 and its interaction with Divisions 40, 104, 110 and
         112 of the ITAA 1997


   1206. In a general sense, financial arrangements may be acquired or
         disposed of as a consideration for the acquisition or disposal of
         an asset or some other thing.  Where this occurs, Division 230
         changes the ordinary operation of the provisions of the ITAA 1936
         and the ITAA 1997, broadly to ensure that this other thing is taken
         to have been acquired or disposed of for the market value of the
         financial arrangement that is used as consideration.


   1207. Where a taxpayer provides or acquires a tax relevant thing in
         consideration for the creation, acquisition, or cessation of a
         financial arrangement, Division 230 will operate to determine the
         amount for which that tax relevant thing is taken to have been
         acquired or disposed of.  For example, where the tax relevant thing
         used as consideration for starting or ceasing to have a financial
         arrangement is a CGT asset, Division 230 will operate to determine
         the cost base or capital proceeds of the CGT asset as relevant.
         Where it is a depreciating asset, Division 230 will operate to work
         out the termination value and cost of the depreciating asset.


   1208. The object of section 230-505 is to provide appropriate proceeds
         and cost base interaction rules between the provisions of Division
         230 and the rest of the ITAA 1997 and the ITAA 1936 where:


                . Division 230 applies to a taxpayer's gains and losses from
                  a financial arrangement (ie, none of the exceptions
                  discussed in Chapter 2 apply in respect of that
                  arrangement); and


                . that financial arrangement is either received or provided,
                  or the taxpayer otherwise starts or ceases to have it (it
                  is dealt with) as consideration for something else that is
                  either provided or received (dealt with) in return.


   1209. Dealing with a financial arrangement as consideration for dealing
         with something else may or may not take place as part of a larger
         transaction.  In addition, the taxpayer may deal with only part of
         the relevant financial arrangement as consideration for dealing
         with something else, and still be subject to the operation of
         section 230-505.  [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-505]


   1210. For the purposes of section 230-505, the relevant thing used as
         consideration for starting or ceasing to have the financial
         arrangement is not limited to tangible things and may include
         services, the conferring of a right, incurring an obligation or
         extinguishing a right or obligation.


         Examples of a 'thing' subject to section 230-505


   1211. For the purposes of section 230-505, the relevant thing that a
         taxpayer may deal with as consideration for starting or ceasing to
         have all or part of a financial arrangement may include:


                . assuming the obligation of another party to make payments
                  on a loan (acquiring a thing that is an obligation);


                . assuming the right to receive interest payments on a loan
                  (acquiring a thing that is a right);


                . receiving a right to exercise a right to acquire shares,
                  for example, an option (acquiring a thing that is a
                  right);


                . receipt or disposal of property (acquiring or providing a
                  thing that is property including CGT assets, depreciating
                  assets or trading stock);


                . assuming the right of another to deliver equity interests
                  under a forward contract (acquiring a thing that is a
                  right);


                . receiving services (acquiring a thing that is the
                  provision of services); and


                . having a liability waived or otherwise extinguished
                  (acquiring something that is a financial benefit, being
                  the waiver or extinguishment of a liability).


   1212. The relevant thing that the taxpayer deals with as consideration
         for starting or ceasing to have the financial arrangement may or
         may not itself be, or form part of, another financial arrangement.
         However, where the thing dealt with is a tax relevant thing that is
         not, and does not form part of, a financial arrangement that has
         its gains and losses subject to Division 230, section 230-505 will
         have implications for other relevant provisions of the ITAA 1997
         outside of Division 230 and of the ITAA 1936.  [Schedule 1, item 1,
         subsection 230-505(1)]


         Impact of section 230-505 on certain elements of capital proceeds,
         cost base, cost of a depreciating asset and termination values


   1213. Section 230-505 operates in relation to certain elements of capital
         proceeds, cost base, cost of a depreciating asset and termination
         values.  However, it does not in general affect the modification
         rules, special rules and specific rules in the capital gains and
         capital allowance regimes (eg, the market value substitution
         rules).


   1214. You might start or cease to have a Division 230 financial
         arrangement (or part of such an arrangement) as consideration for
         providing or acquiring a CGT asset.  You might also do this as
         consideration for providing or obtaining a thing relevant to that
         asset (eg, obtaining services resulting in capital improvements to
         the asset).  In such situations, section 230-505 may apply.  The
         key interactions of section 230-505 with the CGT provisions and the
         capital allowance provisions are as follows:


                . Section 230-505 generally operates so that the first
                  element of the cost base and reduced cost base for the CGT
                  asset includes the market value of the thing acquired at
                  the time it is acquired.  Section 230-505 can also affect
                  the other elements of the cost base to the extent that the
                  financial arrangement represents consideration for
                  something obtained which is relevant to those elements.
                  For example, if a Division 230 financial arrangement is
                  provided as consideration for something acquired that
                  increases an asset's value for the purposes of the fourth
                  element of the cost base (see subsection 110-25(5) of the
                  ITAA 1997), then the market value of the thing acquired at
                  the time it is acquired will be used to calculate that
                  element of the cost base.


                . Section 230-505 generally operates so that the capital
                  proceeds include the market value of the thing provided at
                  the time it is disposed of.  The capital proceeds may be
                  from CGT events that involve providing a CGT asset or the
                  creation of rights, for example, CGT event D1 (creating
                  contractual or other rights).


                . Section 230-505 does not change the time at which a
                  CGT event happens under the CGT provisions.  The time
                  section 230-505 is satisfied (when you start or cease to
                  have the financial arrangement) may be different from the
                  timing of the CGT event.  However, once section 230-505 is
                  satisfied, then the amount determined as the market value
                  for the thing provided (at the time it is provided) will
                  be brought to account in determining the capital proceeds
                  for the CGT event.


                . Section 230-505 generally operates so that the cost of a
                  depreciating asset includes the market value of the
                  depreciating asset that starts to be held.  This may come
                  about either because the financial arrangement is started
                  or ceased as consideration to acquire - or to hold - the
                  asset (relevant to the first element of cost), or as
                  consideration for something acquired that goes to the
                  second element of cost (eg, capital improvements).


                . Section 230-505 generally operates so that the termination
                  value or the amount you are taken to have received under a
                  balancing adjustment event includes the market value of
                  the depreciating asset that is disposed of or that is no
                  longer held.


         Consideration is taken to be received or provided for the 'thing'


   1215. Where you start to have a financial arrangement that has its gains
         and losses subject to Division 230 (a Division 230 financial
         arrangement), or a part of such an arrangement, as consideration
         for:


                . providing (giving) something to someone else (including by
                  transferring it to someone else, someone else starting to
                  have it, or by its extinguishment); or


                . acquiring (receiving) something from someone else
                  (including by acquiring it from someone else, someone else
                  ceasing to have it, or by creating it),


         then the value of the benefit that you give or receive for
         providing or acquiring that thing is taken to be the market value
         of the thing at the time you provide or acquire it.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-505(2)]

   1216. Where you cease to have a Division 230 financial arrangement (or
         part of such an arrangement) in consideration for:
                . acquiring (receiving) something from someone else
                  (including by acquiring it from someone else or by
                  creating it); or
                . providing (giving) something to someone else (including by
                  transferring it to someone else or by its extinguishment),


         then the value of the benefit that you give or receive for
         providing or acquiring that thing is taken to be the market value
         of the thing at the time you provide or acquire it.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-505(2)]

         Interaction with capital gains tax provisions

   1217. To the extent that Division 230 and Parts 3-1 and 3-3 interact,
         section 230-505 will operate to ensure that there is alignment
         between the cost base and proceeds rules that are used for the
         purposes of this Division and those Parts.
      1. :  Disposal of a capital asset with a deferred delivery and
         settlement - the consideration received/provided for the asset
                Buddy Co enters into a contract on 1 July 2010 to sell a CGT
                asset (which is not a depreciating asset and not a financial
                arrangement) to Fee Co.  The terms of the contract are:
              . delivery of the asset in six months (ie, on 1 January 2011);
                and
              . the sale price of $120,000 is to be paid 24 months after the
                contract date on 1 July 2012 (ie, 18 months after delivery
                of the asset).
                Background and assumptions
              . Buddy Co acquired the CGT asset for $80,000.
              . The market value of the CGT asset as at 1 January 2011 is
                $105,000.
              . Both Buddy Co and Fee Co hold the CGT asset on capital
                account.
              . Both Buddy Co and Fee Co are subject to Division 230.

                Buddy Co - disposal of a CGT asset


                On 1 January 2011 when Buddy Co delivers the asset to Fee
                Co, it will start to have a financial arrangement.  This is
                because at the time of delivery, the only rights and/or
                obligations Buddy Co has remaining under its arrangement to
                dispose of its CGT asset to Fee Co, is its right to receive
                $120,000 in 18 months time from Fee Co.  This right is a
                cash settlable right to receive a financial benefit, as it
                is a right to receive a financial benefit that is money.
                Buddy Co's financial arrangement is constituted by this cash
                settlable right (subsection 230-45(1) and paragraph 230-
                45(2)(a)).


                Under subsection 230-60(1) the market value of the CGT asset
                (financial benefit provided) is taken to be provided under
                the financial arrangement started, and is effectively its
                cost.


                Buddy Co therefore starts to have a financial arrangement as
                consideration for ceasing to have its CGT asset.


                Subsection 230-505(2) provides that for the purpose of
                applying the income tax law to the CGT asset Buddy Co is
                taken to have obtained the market value of the CGT asset at
                the time it is provided.  This means that for the purpose of
                Parts 3-1 and 3-3 of the ITAA 1997, Buddy Co is taken to
                have received capital proceeds on disposal of its CGT asset
                equal to the market value of the CGT asset at the time it is
                provided.  That is, Buddy Co is taken to have received the
                market value of its CGT asset from Fee Co, as determined
                under section 230-505 at 1 January 2011.  This value is
                $105,000 (subsection 230-505(2)).


                Pursuant to section 104-10 of the ITAA 1997, CGT event A1
                occurs in respect of Buddy Co's CGT asset, on 1 July 2010.
                From the facts, the cost base of the CGT asset is $80,000.
                As Buddy Co will be taken to have received capital proceeds
                of $105,000 (as set out above), it will make a capital gain
                of $25,000 on disposal of its CGT asset, (being $105,000
                less $80,000).


                The general financial arrangement cost and proceeds
                principles apply to the tax treatment of Buddy Co's
                financial arrangement constituted by its right to receive
                $120,000 from Fee Co.  The cost of the financial arrangement
                will be the market value of the CGT asset at the time it is
                provided.  The difference between this cost ($105,000) and
                the proceeds Buddy Co receives from the financial
                arrangement ($120,000), a $15,000 gain, will be taken into
                account under Division 230.


                Fee Co - acquisition of a CGT asset


                On 1 January 2011 when Fee Co receives the CGT asset from
                Buddy Co, it will start to have a financial arrangement.
                This is because after the time of delivery, the only rights
                and/or obligations Fee Co has remaining under its
                arrangement to acquire the CGT asset from Buddy Co, is its
                obligation to pay $120,000 in 18 months time to Buddy Co.
                This obligation is a cash settlable obligation to provide a
                financial benefit, as it is an obligation to pay a financial
                benefit that is money.  Fee Co's financial arrangement is
                entirely constituted by this cash settlable obligation
                (subsection 230-45(1) and paragraph 230-45(2)(a)).


                Under subsection 230-60(2) the market value of the CGT asset
                (financial benefit received) is taken to be received under
                the financial arrangement started, and effectively
                constitutes the proceeds from the financial arrangement.


                Fee Co therefore starts to have a financial arrangement as
                consideration for starting to have the CGT asset.


                Subsection 230-505(1) provides that for the purposes of
                applying the income tax law to the CGT asset Fee Co is taken
                to have provided the market value of the CGT asset at the
                time it is acquired.  This means that for the purpose of
                Parts 3-1 and 3-3 of the ITAA 1997, Fee Co's cost of the CGT
                asset is taken to be equal to the market value of the CGT
                asset, at the time is acquired.  That is, Fee Co is taken to
                have provided the market value of the CGT asset being
                $105,000.


                This $105,000 cost will form part of Fee Co's cost base of
                the CGT asset (depending on any subsequent facts, it may be
                the only element in Fee Co's cost base for this asset).


                The general financial arrangement cost and proceeds
                principles apply to the tax treatment of Fee Co's financial
                arrangement constituted by its obligation to provide
                $120,000 to Buddy Co.  The proceeds of the financial
                arrangement will be the market value of the CGT asset at the
                time it is acquired.  The difference between these proceeds
                ($105,000) and the cost Fee Co provides for the financial
                arrangement ($120,000), a $15,000 loss, will be taken into
                account under Division 230.


                Note - the time of valuation of the thing


                Apart from the operation of Division 230, the capital
                proceeds from a CGT event include the market value of
                property that is received in respect of the event,
                calculated as at the time of the event.  Where the relevant
                property is a financial arrangement to which Division 230
                applies which is started or ceased as consideration for the
                CGT asset, the amount that would otherwise be calculated for
                the purposes of working out the capital gain or loss from
                the CGT event is replaced by the market value of the asset
                on the date the taxpayer provides the asset.  This date will
                not always coincide with the date of the CGT event.  This
                may mean that the taxpayer will be required to amend what
                otherwise may have been taken into account for the purposes
                of the CGT event.


         Division 230 interaction with capital allowance provisions


   1218. To the extent that Divisions 230 and 40 of the ITAA 1997 interact,
         section 230-505 will operate to ensure that there is alignment
         between the general financial arrangement cost and proceeds
         principles that are used for the purposes of Division 230, on the
         one hand, and the cost and termination value rules that are used in
         the uniform capital allowances provisions in Division 40 of the
         ITAA 1997, on the other.


   1219. The interaction of the capital allowance provisions and the
         Division 230 measures is similar to that for CGT, in that where a
         financial arrangement is used as consideration for acquiring or
         providing a depreciating asset, the market value of the
         depreciating asset must first be determined before the cost and
         termination value of the depreciating asset (as relevant) can be
         worked out.


      1. :  Disposal of a depreciating asset with a deferred delivery and
         settlement - the consideration received/provided for the asset


                Smith Co enters into a contract on 1 September 2009 to sell
                its depreciating asset (which is not a Division 230
                financial arrangement) to Jones Co.  The terms of the
                contract are:


              . delivery of the asset in 12 months (ie, on 1 September
                2010);


              . the sale price of $250,000 is to be paid 27 months after the
                contract date, on 1 January 2012 (ie, 15 months after
                delivery of the depreciating asset); and


              . notwithstanding the application of section 230-505, Division
                40 of the ITAA 1997 would operate such that the liability to
                pay the sale price does not arise until delivery of the
                depreciating asset.


                Background and assumptions


              . Smith Co used the depreciating asset wholly for a taxable
                purpose and claimed decline in value deductions for it in
                accordance with Division 40.


              . The adjustable value of the depreciating asset in the hands
                of Smith Co at the time of delivery was $100,000.


              . The market value of the depreciating asset as at 1 September
                2010 is $150,000.


              . Both Smith Co and Jones Co are subject to Division 230.


                Smith Co - disposal of the depreciating asset


                On 1 September 2010 when Smith Co delivers the depreciating
                asset to Jones Co, Smith Co will start to have a financial
                arrangement.  This is because, after the time of delivery,
                the only rights and/or obligations Smith Co has remaining
                under its arrangement to dispose of its depreciating asset
                to Jones Co is its right to receive $250,000 in 15 months
                time from Jones Co.  This right is a cash settlable right to
                receive a financial benefit, as it is a right to receive a
                financial benefit that is money.  Smith Co's financial
                arrangement is entirely constituted by this cash settlable
                right (subsection 230-45(1) and paragraph 230-45(2)(a)).


                Under subsection 230-60(1) the market value of the
                depreciating asset (financial benefit provided) is taken to
                be provided under the financial arrangement started, and
                effectively constitutes the cost of the financial
                arrangement.


                Smith Co therefore starts to have a financial arrangement as
                consideration for ceasing to hold its depreciating asset.


                Under the terms of the contract, Smith Co will stop holding
                the depreciating asset on 1 September 2010 when it delivers
                the asset to Jones Co.  A balancing adjustment event will
                occur for the asset at that time and Smith Co will need to
                work out a balancing adjustment amount for it.


                Subsection 230-505(2) provides that for the purposes of
                applying the income tax law to the depreciating asset Smith
                Co is taken to have obtained the market value of the
                depreciating asset at the time it is provided.  This means
                that for the purpose of working out the balancing adjustment
                amount for the depreciating asset, Smith Co is taken to have
                received an amount equal to the market value of the
                depreciating asset, at the time it is provided.  As this
                value is $150,000, under the provisions of Division 40 of
                the ITAA 1997 Smith Co is taken to have a termination value
                of $150,000 for its depreciating asset (subsection 230-
                505(2)).


                Smith Co's adjustable value for its depreciating asset was,
                as set out in the facts, $100,000 just before the time of
                the balancing adjustment event (1 September 2010).  As Smith
                Co's termination value of its depreciating asset will be
                taken to be $150,000 (as set out above), its assessable
                balancing adjustment amount under Division 40 will be
                $50,000 (being $150,000 less $100,000).


                The general financial arrangement cost and proceeds
                principles apply to the tax treatment of Smith Co's
                financial arrangement constituted by its right to receive
                $250,000 from Jones Co.  The difference between the cost of
                the financial arrangement, being the market value of the
                depreciating asset ($150,000), and the proceeds Smith Co
                receives from the financial arrangement ($250,000), a
                $100,000 gain, will be taken into account under Division
                230.


                Jones Co - acquisition of the depreciating asset


                On 1 September 2010 when Jones Co receives the depreciating
                asset from Smith Co, Jones Co will start to have a financial
                arrangement.  This is because at the time of delivery, the
                only rights and/or obligations Jones Co has remaining under
                its arrangement to acquire the depreciating asset from Smith
                Co, is its obligation to pay $250,000 in 15 months time to
                Smith Co.  This obligation is a cash settlable obligation to
                provide a financial benefit, as it is an obligation to pay a
                financial benefit that is money.  Jones Co's financial
                arrangement is entirely constituted by this cash settlable
                obligation (subsection 230-45(1) and paragraph 230-
                45(2)(a)).


                Jones Co therefore starts to have a financial arrangement as
                consideration for starting to hold the depreciating asset.


                Subsection 230-505(1) provides that, for the purposes of
                applying the income tax law to the depreciating asset  Jones
                Co is taken to have provided the market value of the
                depreciating asset at the time it is acquired.  This means
                that for the purpose of Division 40 of the ITAA 1997, Jones
                Co's cost of the depreciating asset is taken to be equal to
                the market value of the depreciating asset, at the time it
                is acquired.  As this value is $150,000, Jones Co is taken
                to have paid $150,000 to acquire this depreciating asset,
                for all purposes of the ITAA 1936 and the ITAA 1997
                (subsection 230-505(2)).


                The normal cost and proceeds rules apply to the tax
                treatment of Jones Co's financial arrangement constituted by
                its obligation to pay $250,000 to Smith Co.  The difference
                between the proceeds of the financial arrangement, being the
                market value of the depreciating asset ($150,000), and the
                cost Jones Co provides for the financial arrangement
                ($250,000), a $100,000 loss will be taken into account under
                Division 230.


         Financial arrangements of consolidated groups


   1220. Division 230 applies to consolidated groups and multiple entry
         consolidated groups (MEC groups) as if the head company of the
         group is the relevant taxpayer.  Chapter 12 contains a detailed
         discussion of the application of Division 230 to the consolidation
         regime, and specific consolidation-related amendments.


         Financial arrangements denominated in a foreign currency


   1221. For the purposes of the ITAA 1997 and the ITAA 1936, subsection 960-
         50(1) requires that any amount or value that is denominated in a
         foreign currency be translated (converted) into Australian
         currency.  In particular, if there are amounts that are elements in
         the calculation of other amounts those elements are to be
         translated into Australian currency first and then the other
         amounts are calculated.  An exception to this general rule applies
         where those other amounts are a 'special accrual amount'.  Amounts
         under Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 were such 'special accrual
         amounts' (see definition of 'special accrual amount' in subsection
         995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997).


   1222. A similar exception to the general translation rule is required for
         gains or losses that are subject to the accruals method under
         Subdivision 230-B.  An amendment is made to the definition of
         'special accrual amount' to include a reference to gains or losses
         that are subject to the accruals method in Subdivision 230-B where
         all the financial benefits that are provided and received under the
         financial arrangement are denominated in a particular foreign
         currency [Schedule 1, item 28, definition of 'special accrual
         amount' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997].  If the financial
         arrangement is comprised of financial benefits that are denominated
         in more than one currency, the exception for special accrual
         amounts will not apply to calculating the gains or losses from that
         arrangement.


   1223. The application of the special accrual amount rule means that the
         sufficiently certain overall or particular gain or loss that is
         made from the financial arrangements in the circumstances specified
         is to be calculated in the foreign currency.  Further, the
         spreading of that overall or particular gain or loss over the
         relevant accrual period is to be done in the foreign currency.
         Only the amounts allocated to the relevant accruals intervals are
         to be translated using the relevant table in subsection 960-50(6)
         of the ITAA 1997.


Recognition of gains and losses


   1224. The following amendments relate to the manner in which gains or
         losses are recognised for tax purposes where a Division 230
         financial arrangement is involved.


         Foreign bank branches and offshore banking units


   1225. Part IIIB of the ITAA 1936 establishes a regime for recognising
         transactions between foreign banks and their Australian branches.
         Under section 160ZZW of Part IIIB, the branch is effectively
         treated as a separate legal entity for certain financial dealings
         (such as the notional payment of interest by the branch to the
         bank, notional derivative transactions and notional foreign
         exchange transactions between the branch and the bank - see
         sections 160ZZZA, 160ZZZE and 160ZZZF of Part IIIB, respectively).
         These sections apply where the foreign bank applies Part IIIB in
         calculating that part of its taxable income that is referable to
         certain activities of its Australian branch (see section 160ZZVB of
         the ITAA 1936).


   1226. Section 160ZZZK of Part IIIB extends the application of Part IIIB
         to foreign financial entities and their Australian permanent
         establishments.  For convenience, the following discussion refers
         only to foreign banks and their Australian branches, but it should
         be borne in mind that the amendments will apply more broadly.


   1227. Generally, Division 230 will apply to include gains or losses made
         on financial arrangements held by the Australian branch of a
         foreign bank in the calculation of its taxable income, including
         any gains or losses arising from intra-bank dealings between the
         Australian branch and the rest of the bank.  To avoid doubt, an
         amendment is made to section 160ZZW of Part IIIB, to provide that
         gains or losses from financial arrangements entered into between
         the foreign bank and its Australian branch will be brought to
         account under Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 43, subsection
         160ZZW(1A)]


   1228. Section 160ZZZA, relating to the notional payment of interest by
         the branch to the bank, provides that the rate of interest may not
         exceed the London Inter Bank Offered Rate.  The amendment to
         section 160ZZW is not intended to affect the operation of this
         requirement.


   1229. Further, an amendment will be made to section 160ZZX of Part IIIB
         to specify that gains made through the Australian branch of a
         foreign bank, from financial arrangements to which Division 230
         applies, are taken to be sourced in Australia.  This will treat
         these gains in the same way as income from other transactions of
         the branch.  [Schedule 1, Part 2, items 44 and 45, subsection
         160ZZX(2) of the ITAA 1936]


   1230. In addition, the permanent establishments in Australia of an
         offshore banking unit at or through which the offshore banking unit
         carries on offshore banking activities, are treated as one person
         for the purpose of the definition of a 'financial arrangement'.
         The other permanent establishments of the offshore banking unit
         (either in or outside of Australia) are treated as separate
         persons.  This means that financial arrangements between permanent
         establishments of an offshore banking unit can be subject to
         Division 230 [Schedule 1, item 37, subsection 121EB(3)].  This
         reflects the treatment of permanent establishments of an offshore
         banking unit under Division 9A of Part III of the ITAA 1936.  In
         the absence of making any election made by the foreign financial
         entity (foreign banks and other financial entities covered by Part
         IIIB of the ITAA 1936) the default provisions of Division 230 (ie,
         Subdivision 230-B) will apply to applicable Part IIIB and Division
         9A transactions that are financial arrangements.


   1231. The amendments are not intended to change how Division 9A applies
         to consolidated/MEC groups which contain an offshore banking unit,
         either as the head company or as a subsidiary member, nor the scope
         of transactions that are recognised for the purposes of Division
         9A.  But they will mean that Division 230 will apply to financial
         arrangements related to the transactions or dealings that are
         counted as offshore banking activities by Division 9A.


         Application of elections to foreign bank branches and offshore
         banking units


   1232. Foreign financial entities with one or more permanent
         establishments in Australia (foreign banks and other financial
         entities covered by Part IIIB of the ITAA 1936) may be eligible to
         make the various elections.  Part IIIB recognises certain intra-
         entity transactions or arrangements in calculating the taxable
         income of the foreign financial entity (see sections 160ZZW,
         160ZZZ, 160ZZZA, 160ZZZE and 160ZZZF of the ITAA 1936).  Where the
         foreign financial entity makes an election, the election should
         apply to financial arrangements that are/represent these notional
         borrowings, notional derivative transactions or notional foreign
         exchange transactions, in addition to any other financial
         arrangements that the entity has entered into with other entities.
         However, the separate-entity rules contained in section 160ZZW does
         not lead to the result that a separate set of elections can be made
         by the Australian permanent establishments.  Nor should the
         election apply to any other intra-entity arrangements that are not
         recognised under Part IIIB (eg, an arrangement between two
         Australian permanent establishments).


   1233. There is also a separate entity rule in section 121EB of the
         ITAA 1936 for offshore banking units.  Again, this rule is not to
         be taken to imply that a separate set of elections can be made by
         the Australian permanent establishments of the entity that carry on
         offshore banking business or by a subsidiary member of a
         consolidated/MEC group that is an offshore banking unit.  The
         taxable entity is the entity that makes the election (or does not
         as the case may be), including the head company of a group where
         section 717-710 applies.  The election applies to all relevant
         financial arrangements, including those arrangements that arise in
         the course of carrying on offshore banking business.  Because the
         separate entity rule in section 121EB is only for the purpose of
         identifying offshore banking activities, the additional financial
         arrangements to which an election might apply should only be those
         arising from those offshore banking activities as defined in
         Division 9A.


   1234. The financial arrangements that are recognised only because of Part
         IIIB or Division 9A which the accounting standards would have
         required be classified or designated in financial reports as at
         fair value through profit or loss if the arrangements had been
         between separate legal entities are to be the subject of any
         election made by the taxpayer.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections
         230-220(3), 230-265(3), 230-335(2) and 230-410(8)]


   1235. The gain or loss that is made from a financial arrangement arising
         from dealings that are recognised by Part IIIB or Division 9A and
         that is covered by an election is the gain or loss that the
         standards would have required to be recognised in the profit and
         loss report if they had recognised the arrangement.  This will
         require some departures from the audited financial reports but they
         should be no different in scope to the departures that were
         previously required because of the additional 'transactions' that
         are recognised for tax purposes by Part IIIB and/or Division 9A.
         Adequate records of these departures should be maintained in
         accordance with the relevant record-keeping provisions.  [Schedule
         1, item 1, paragraphs 230-230(1)(c) and 230-420(1)(c),
         subparagraph 230-280(1)(b)(iii)]


         Deductions for expenditure incurred for capital gain


   1236. Section 51AAA of the ITAA 1936 denies certain deductions where,
         broadly, the deduction would otherwise only be allowable because of
         its connection to a capital gain.


   1237. With the introduction of Division 230, subsection 230-15(2) will
         allow a deduction for a loss from a financial arrangement where the
         loss is made in gaining or producing assessable income or is
         necessarily made in carrying on a business for the purpose of
         gaining or producing assessable income.


   1238. Section 51AAA is amended to deny a deduction that would otherwise
         be allowable under subsection 230-15(2) only because it was
         incurred in making a capital gain.  [Schedule 1, item 32,
         subsection 51AAA(2) of the ITAA 1936]


         Pay as you go instalments - Taxation Administration Act 1953


   1239. Subsection 45-120(1) of the TAA 1953 states that instalment income
         for a period includes amounts of ordinary income that are derived
         during that period, but only to the extent that it is assessable
         income in the income year.  Ordinary income in this sense takes its
         meaning from section 6-5 of the ITAA 1997.


   1240. Subsection 45-120(2B) operates to include additional amounts within
         the definition of 'instalment income' by including a new category
         of statutory income within the definition of 'instalment income'.
         To the extent that an amount of income is both ordinary income and
         statutory income, it will only be included as instalment income
         once.  That is, the amount of income will not be double counted.


   1241. Generally, gains made on certain financial arrangements that are
         subject to Division 230 will be subject to the pay as you go (PAYG)
         instalments system.  The amendment made in this Bill ensures that
         the PAYG instalment system recognises the gain or loss, or the part
         of the gain or loss, on a financial arrangement that is
         attributable to each income year.  This is achieved by including
         gains and losses made from Division 230 financial arrangements
         within the definition of 'instalment income'.


   1242. The amendment further provides that only the net result of the
         relevant gains and losses made on financial arrangements, that are
         subject to Division 230 for a particular income year, will be
         included as the instalment income amount.  That is, the net result
         of the gains must exceed the losses made in an income year in
         respect of financial arrangements under Division 230 to be
         recognised for PAYG purposes.  [Schedule 1, item 100, subsection 45-
         120(2B) in Schedule 1 to the TAA 1953]


   1243. Where the amount of losses exceeds the amount of gains made in an
         income year in respect of Division 230 financial arrangements, no
         amount is included in the entity's instalment income under
         subsection 45-120(2B).


   1244. Taxpayers are to calculate their instalment income having regard to
         what, if any, of the elective Subdivisions (see Chapter 5) apply to
         them at the end of the instalment period.  Where a taxpayer makes
         an election to apply any or all of the elective Subdivisions part
         way through an income year, the taxpayer is expected to calculate
         their instalment income having regard to elections that have in
         fact been made by the end of the relevant instalment period.


   1245. The practical consequence of such an approach is that a taxpayer
         may have to include an amount in their activity statement that
         would have otherwise been included in an earlier activity statement
         had an election been made in an earlier instalment period.


The effect of a change of residence of the taxpayer


   1246. If a taxpayer changes from being an Australian resident to a
         foreign resident (or vice-versa) during an income year, special
         rules apply to determine the relevant amount of any gain and/or
         loss for that year from the taxpayer's financial arrangements.  The
         general effect of the rules is to calculate any gain or loss from
         the financial arrangement for the income year by specifically
         taking into account the change of residence during the income year,
         and appropriately apportioning the gain or loss to the periods of
         different residency [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-485(1)].
         The specifics of how this is done depend on the method that would
         otherwise be used to determine the taxpayer's gain or loss for the
         income year.  While theoretically the gain or loss made for the
         part of the year while a foreign resident has to be calculated, in
         practice it may not need to be done in many cases because a gain
         made while a foreign resident would not be assessable or a loss
         would not be deductible.


   1247. For financial arrangements subject to the realisation method, the
         rule is more prescriptive as it deems a disposal and immediate
         reacquisition of the arrangement at the time of the change of
         residence.  This approach has been adopted because this method
         relies on when the relevant financial benefits are due to be
         provided, which may not in fact occur in the income year, and
         therefore not otherwise result in any gain or loss for the income
         year.  Deeming these arrangements to be disposed of at the time of
         the residence change deals with the tax consequences of the change
         of residence in the income year in which it occurs (as is the case
         for all other methods).  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-
         485(3) and (4)]


   1248. Each gain or loss determined in accordance with these rules is
         taken to be made for the income year in which residence changes,
         and can therefore be appropriately handled under section 230-15.


   1249. If the change of residence occurs at the end or beginning of an
         income year the proposed rules for calculating any gain or loss
         will only have practical relevance for financial arrangements
         subject to the realisation method.  For other methods the rules,
         although technically applying, will not alter the calculation of
         the gain or loss.


         When the accruals method is used


   1250. Where a change of residence occurs during the income year, a
         taxpayer that has a financial arrangement subject to the accruals
         method should apportion any gain or loss on the arrangement for the
         year across each period the taxpayer is an Australian resident and
         each period the taxpayer is a foreign resident during the income
         year.  The gain or loss must be apportioned on a reasonable basis
         as between each of those periods which, under the accruals method,
         should be determined based on the number of days of each period of
         different residency.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-485(6)]


   1251. Whether the gain (or loss) for each of these periods is assessable
         (or deductible) is determined by applying Division 6 (or 8) to
         these periods as if they were separate income years.


         When the fair value, foreign exchange retranslation or financial
         reports method is used


   1252. A different approach applies for financial arrangements for which
         the fair value, foreign exchange retranslation or financial reports
         method has been chosen.  The taxpayer must work out a gain (or
         loss) for both the period of foreign residency and the period of
         Australian residency.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-485(8)]


   1253. This rule treats these periods as if they were separate income
         years and therefore will require the taxpayer to have recourse to
         its financial reports.  The taxpayer will have to make appropriate
         adjustments to the amounts shown in the relevant accounts for the
         relevant accounting periods (those that overlap the deemed income
         years).  This is consistent with the general rule that applies for
         these methods where the accounts are not prepared for the income
         year.  In those cases the taxpayer can make appropriate adjustments
         to the accounts for the overlapping accounting periods.


   1254. Treating the periods of residency as if they were separate income
         years more accurately determines, in accordance with the specific
         methods, a gain or loss for each period of different residency.


   1255. Again, whether the gain (or loss) for each of these periods is
         assessable (or deductible) is determined by applying Division 6 (or
         8) to these periods as if they were separate income years.


   1256. The application of this rule may result in a gain for the period of
         Australian residency and a loss for the period of foreign residency
         (or vice-versa), or other combinations of gain and loss.  Further,
         the gain may be assessable (eg, a foreign source gain made while an
         Australian resident) but the loss not deductible (eg, while a
         foreign resident a loss is not made in deriving assessable
         Australian source income).  To calculate the gain or loss using the
         same general apportionment rule that applies to the accruals method
         would provide an incorrect outcome as the starting point would be a
         gain or loss for the entire income year (rather than allowing for a
         gain or loss for each period of residency).  Therefore, a daily
         apportionment of the gain or loss for the income year would not be
         acceptable when these methods are used.


         When the realisation method is used


   1257. There is also a separate rule for financial arrangements to which
         the realisation method applies.  If the taxpayer changes residence
         during the income year, or at the end of an income year, each such
         financial arrangement is deemed to be disposed of and immediately
         reacquired at the residence-change time for its fair value at that
         time.  A gain or loss will accumulate (or be realised throughout
         the period) up until the residence-change time (where there is a
         deemed disposal and a balancing adjustment gain or loss would be
         calculated according to Subdivision 230-G).  Similarly, a gain or
         loss will accumulate (or be realised throughout the period) from
         the residence-change time until the time of actual disposal
         (whenever that occurs) or other payments may be made.  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-485(4)]


   1258. Although the deemed disposal treatment may not seem to be strictly
         in accordance with the realisation method, its objective is similar
         to the treatment provided under the other methods (in that it
         effectively divides an overall gain or loss on realisation into two
         parts) and is also similar to treatment under the CGT rules where
         there is a change of residence.


   1259. As there are two times when a gain and/or loss on disposal would be
         determined, this rule can advance the recognition of a gain or loss
         in situations where the actual disposal of the financial
         arrangement is in an income year later than the income year in
         which the residence change occurs.


   1260. The purpose of dividing the overall gain or loss into component
         gains and/or losses before and after the change of residence is to
         enable each component to be treated according to residence
         immediately before the change of residence and at the time of
         actual realisation.  The assessability and/or deductibility of each
         component gain and/or loss can be determined separately based on
         the residency of the taxpayer, the source of any gain and/or the
         purpose for which any loss is made.


   1261. Further, the rule for deeming a disposal and reacquisition at the
         residence-change time avoids the risk of not collecting tax upon
         ultimate disposal (or the risk that the taxpayer will not claim a
         deductible loss that would otherwise have been allowed).


   1262. An example where this rule may apply is to a gain or loss that
         arises due to movements in the exchange rate (foreign exchange
         gains or losses) on a financial arrangement (where no other
         elective method applies).  Any realisation gains or losses that
         accrue over time will be subject to this rule.


         When the hedging financial arrangements method is used


   1263. If the hedging financial arrangements method applies to the
         financial arrangement, the taxpayer will need to apply the specific
         change of residence rules that are relevant to the hedged item
         itself.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-485(5)]


   1264. If the hedged item is itself a financial arrangement, the specific
         change of residence rules applicable for the method used for that
         financial arrangement will determine the relevant change of
         residence rules that are relevant for the hedging financial
         arrangement (see paragraphs 11.92 to 11.104).  If the hedged item
         is not a financial arrangement (but some other capital asset) then
         (in cases where a gain or loss is relevant) the specific change of
         residence rules for the realisation method will apply (see
         paragraphs 11.99 to 11.104).


         When there is a disposal of the financial arrangement in the same
         income year


   1265. If the financial arrangement is disposed of after the change of
         residence, but before the end of the income year, these rules will
         still apply to calculate a gain or loss using the appropriate
         method up until the change of residence.  This is because
         subsection 230-40(2) is disregarded in determining if the change of
         residence rules apply [Schedule 1, item 1, paragraphs 230-485(5)(a)
         and (7)(a)].  Subsection 230-40(2) gives precedence to taking into
         account a gain or loss under the balancing adjustment method over
         all other methods, where one of those other methods might otherwise
         also apply in an income year.  Turning off this rule allows the
         change of residence rules to continue to apply for that particular
         income year.  However, the gain or loss for the second part of the
         income year should be calculated using Subdivision 230-G
         (ie, subsection 230-40(2) is applied at that stage).  That
         calculation would take account of the gain or loss calculated for
         the first part of the year using the relevant method whether it has
         been included in taxable income or not.  If the realisation method
         otherwise applied to the arrangement, there would be two
         applications of the balancing adjustment calculation in
         Subdivision 230-G in the income year:  one for the change of
         residence and one for the actual disposal of the financial
         arrangement.  Because there is a deemed reacquisition of the
         arrangement at the residence-change time in this case, the second
         calculation of a balancing adjustment gain or loss should measure
         only the gain or loss arising since the residence-change time.


         Special rule where a taxpayer ceases to be an Australian resident


   1266. When a taxpayer ceases to be an Australian resident and the
         financial arrangement has no further connection with Australia
         there will be, for the purposes of Division 230 (regardless of the
         method used):


                . a deemed disposal of the interest in the financial
                  arrangement immediately before the taxpayer ceases to be
                  an Australian resident (which may be at the end of an
                  income year or some time during an income year) for its
                  fair value at that time; and


                . a deemed reacquisition of the financial arrangement
                  immediately after the change of residence for its fair
                  value at that time.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-490(2)]


   1267. The rule only applies if, immediately after the taxpayer ceases to
         be an Australian resident, gains and losses that could be made in
         relation to the financial arrangement while the taxpayer remains a
         foreign resident are neither assessable nor deductible [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-490(1)].  The deemed disposal and
         reacquisition is a special case and is an exception to the general
         rule in section 230-485.  Its aim is twofold - to ensure that:


                . the effective movement of the financial arrangement out of
                  the application of Division 230 is adequately dealt with;
                  and


                . there is a relevant cost of acquisition for the financial
                  arrangement should Division 230 apply to any gains and/or
                  losses on the financial arrangement some time after the
                  taxpayer ceases to be an Australian resident (eg, if the
                  taxpayer again becomes an Australian resident).


   1268. Where this rule applies, effectively Division 230 will no longer
         apply to the financial arrangement and the specific rules in
         section 230-485 will have no application to this particular change
         of residence.  This is because those specific rules only apply if
         the taxpayer would, once a foreign resident, otherwise apply a
         particular method under Division 230 to determine a gain or loss.
         While in practical terms Division 230 will no longer apply in
         relation to this financial arrangement, if the taxpayer once again
         becomes an Australian resident this section will once more be
         triggered.


   1269. The deemed disposal rule may result in a balancing adjustment gain
         or loss under Subdivision 230-G (which is discussed in Chapter 10).


   1270. In other cases where a taxpayer ceases to be an Australian
         resident, Division 11A of Part III of the ITAA 1936 (interest
         withholding tax) may apply exclusively while the taxpayer is a
         foreign resident.  The taxpayer would need to know how much gain or
         loss was made for the part of the year in which it was an
         Australian resident (in accordance with section 230-485).  The
         assessability and deductibility would be determined according to
         Division 230.  If Division 11A did not deal with all gains while a
         foreign resident (eg, gains that are not interest), or if there
         were any losses, the taxpayer would still need to determine the
         gain or loss made while a foreign resident (by applying section 230-
         485) and then determine the assessability or deductibility of any
         gain or loss.


         Interaction with withholding tax rules


   1271. There is a possible overlap between taxation under Division 230 and
         the imposition of withholding tax under Division 11A of Part III of
         the ITAA 1936 (see paragraphs 11.32 to 11.37) where the holder of a
         financial arrangement changes from an Australian resident to a
         foreign resident and an interest payment is subsequently made.


   1272. If no withholding tax is payable (eg, if there is an exemption from
         withholding tax) then there is no possible overlap and therefore no
         adjustment is required.  However, in cases where withholding tax is
         otherwise payable, there is an overlap and therefore the amount of
         withholding tax is reduced by the amount notionally payable on the
         net amount that was assessable under Division 230.  [Schedule 1,
         items 38 to 40, section 128NBA of the ITAA 1936]


      1. :  Refund of withholding tax when no interest is paid while an
         Australian resident


                Assume the facts in Example 4.5 but also assume that John
                Doe is an Australian resident when he invests $100 in a zero
                coupon bond that will pay $120 at maturity in four years
                time.  Also, the bond is issued by an Australian resident.
                At the beginning of year 4 John Doe becomes a resident of
                the United States.


                The interest (totalling $14.65) that accrues (on a
                compounding basis) in years 1, 2 and 3 is included each year
                as a gain calculated under the accruals method.  John Doe is
                paid $120 ($20 of this is interest) at the end of year 4, at
                which time he is a foreign resident.  Withholding tax of $2
                is payable on the $20 interest payment.  As $14.65 has
                already been included in assessable income under
                Division 230 while John Doe was an Australian resident,
                section 128NBA will credit, on application, an amount of
                $1.47 (withholding tax of 10 per cent payable on the net
                Division 230 amount of $14.65).  This will mean that
                withholding tax is effectively only payable on $5.35 which
                is the gain that would have otherwise accrued in year 4.


                The gain that would otherwise have been included in
                assessable income in year 4 is disregarded because it is
                part of an amount that is (or is anticipated will be)
                treated as non-assessable non-exempt income under
                section 128D of the ITAA 1936.


   1273. Further, this rule in section 128NBA to prevent double taxation
         also applies to cases where there are periodic interest payments to
         the taxpayer over the life of the financial arrangement.  [Schedule
         1, item 40, subparagraph 128NBA(5)(d)(9)(ii) of the ITAA 1936]


      1. :  Refund of withholding tax when interest has been paid while an
         Australian resident


                Assume the facts in Example 4.7 but also assume FLD Finance
                Co is an Australian resident when purchasing the security
                for $1,000.  Also assume the security is issued by an
                Australian resident.  At the beginning of year 3 FLD Finance
                Co becomes a foreign resident.


                Although FLD Finance Co changes residence, the deemed
                disposal and reacquisition rules in section 230-490 will not
                apply because immediately after FLD Finance Co ceases to be
                an Australian resident the gains (Australian sourced) remain
                assessable.  However, rather than Division 230 applying to
                assess the gain, any gain that would have otherwise been
                included in assessable income in years 3 and 4 is
                disregarded because it is part of an amount or amounts (the
                interest payments) that will be treated as non-assessable
                non-exempt income under section 128D of the ITAA 1936.


                At the beginning of year 3, $133.36 has previously been
                included in FLD Finance Co's assessable income (as accrual
                amounts) under Division 230.  Withholding tax is payable on
                the interest payment in year 3 of $80.  However, by the end
                of year 3 the withholding tax payable is reduced to the
                amount that would otherwise have been payable on the total
                interest paid over the three years ($40  +  $50  +  $80  =
                $170) less the net amount included in assessable income
                under Division 230 ($133).  The withholding tax payable on
                $43 (=  $133  -  $40  -  $50) of the $80 interest payment
                would be credited under subsection 128NBA(1).  Therefore, of
                the $80 interest payment in year 3 withholding tax is
                effectively only payable on $37 of that payment.  In
                practice, withholding tax is payable on the $80 and once the
                withholding tax is paid the taxpayer can apply (in the
                approved form) to the Commissioner of Taxation for a credit
                of the withholding tax payable on the $43.


                When the subsequent $100 interest payment is made in year 4,
                withholding tax would be payable on that amount.  In total,
                of the overall gain of $270, $133 would be included in
                assessable income (under Division 230) and $137 would be
                subject to withholding tax (under Division 11A of the
                ITAA 1936).


                If, in this example, the difference between the total amount
                included in assessable income under Division 230 in the
                first two years and the first two interest payments had been
                greater than the amount of interest paid in year 3, a credit
                for the full amount of withholding tax paid in year 3 could
                be claimed and the residual could be claimed after year 4.
                Alternatively, the claim for the withholding tax credit
                could be delayed until after year 4.  On the other hand, if
                the first two interest payments had been greater than the
                total amount included in assessable income under
                Division 230 in the first two years, there would be no
                withholding tax credit to be claimed.  Instead, the excess
                would be recognised as a gain (either on disposal or
                maturity of the security, under Subdivision 230-G).


         When a taxpayer becomes an Australian resident


   1274. Where the holder of the financial arrangement changes from being a
         foreign resident to being an Australian resident, it is not
         intended that the gains that accrued while that holder was a
         foreign resident would be assessable as soon as a payment is made
         when the holder is an Australian resident.  This is what is done in
         relation to qualifying securities covered by Division 16E of
         Part III of the ITAA 1936 under subsection 159GW(2) of the
         ITAA 1936.  Instead, any such gain would be included in assessable
         income as a balancing adjustment when the financial arrangement
         ceases to be held.


         Application of change of residence rules to partnerships and trusts


   1275. Where Division 230 applies to a financial arrangement of a
         partnership or trust, a change of residence is irrelevant in
         determining the net income of the partnership or trust because of
         the assumption of residency of the partnership and trust (section
         90 and subsection 95(1), respectively, of the ITAA 1936).


   1276. However, if a partner, or a beneficiary that is presently entitled
         to a share of the trust income, changes residence during the income
         year, sections 92 and 97, respectively, of the ITAA 1936 require a
         disaggregation of the net income into its Australian and foreign
         source components.  It is expected that the partner, or
         beneficiary, would do that by applying the change of residence
         provisions as if it, and not the partnership or trust, were the
         entity which held the financial arrangement.


   1277. Similarly, in situations where the trustee may be assessed in
         respect of some or all of the net income under section 98 of the
         ITAA 1936 (eg, the beneficiary is under a legal disability or is a
         foreign resident at the end of the income year) any change in the
         beneficiary's residence during the year should be taken into
         account in determining the trustee's liability to tax.


   1278. In situations where the trustee may be assessed in respect of some
         or all of the net income under section 99 or 99A of the ITAA 1936,
         and the trustee changes residence during the income year, the
         change of residence may or may not affect the tax liability of the
         trustee.  If the trustee ceases to be an Australian resident during
         the income year, there will be no effect because the trust is still
         held to be a resident trust estate.  If the trust becomes a
         resident trust because a trustee becomes an Australian resident
         during the income year, it will be treated as a resident trust for
         the whole income year.  In either case, there is no need to
         determine how much gain or loss was made on the trust's financial
         arrangements for the part of the year in which the trustee was an
         Australian resident and how much was made while a foreign resident.
          Therefore, there is no need to apply the change of residence
         provisions in this case.


Interaction with value shifting rules


   1279. Section 230-520 applies such that gains and losses on financial
         arrangements that are attributable to a value shift that would have
         consequences under the General Value Shifting Regime are
         disregarded under Division 230.  Similarly, gains and losses in
         respect of financial arrangements are disregarded to the extent
         that any of the former value shifting rules would have applied in
         respect of a financial arrangement.


   1280. Broadly, the value shifting rules prevent inappropriate tax
         consequences from arising (eg, a tax loss or a reduction in
         assessable income) where, under a scheme, value is shifted from
         equity or loan interests.  Generally, these rules prevent
         inappropriate tax outcomes from arising by either requiring the tax
         values of the 'losing' interest to be reduced by the same magnitude
         of the value shift (note that the tax value of a 'gaining' interest
         may be revised upwards to the same extent) or, alternatively,
         losses may be denied when the equity or loan interests are finally
         realised.  Under either approach, correcting the tax outcomes of a
         value shift generally occurs upon realisation of the interests -
         that is, the value shifting rules effectively correct the result
         upon realisation of such interests.


   1281. On the other hand, in many cases Division 230 operates to bring to
         account gains and losses in respect of a financial arrangement
         prior to realisation, for example as the gains or losses accrue.
         Consequently, in the absence of special value shifting rules that
         apply to Division 230 financial arrangements, where a value
         shifting arrangement reduces the value of a financial arrangement
         or the expected future cash flows on a financial arrangement,
         inappropriate tax consequences from the arrangement could arise in
         the income year in which the value shift occurs.


   1282. This may occur, for example, where an entity purchases a security
         that provides for relatively certain fixed cash flows over several
         years and the entity recognises the gains on the security by
         applying the accruals method in Subdivision 230-B.  During the term
         of the arrangement a value shift could result in a reduction in the
         estimated cash flows and consequently a reduction in the overall
         gain on the arrangement.  Without special integrity rules the
         entity holding the financial arrangement might, for example, re-
         estimate the gain or loss on the arrangement and the subsequent tax
         consequences would reflect the re-estimated gain or loss.


   1283. Similarly, where an entity holds an asset that is subject to fair
         value measurement under Subdivision 230-C, changes in the fair
         value of such assets recognised in the financial accounts of the
         entity are brought to account for tax purposes.  Absent special
         integrity rules, if a value shift occurs which causes the fair
         value of such an asset to decrease, the holder would recognise a
         loss or reduced gain on that asset in the income year in which the
         value shift occurs.


   1284. Where a financial arrangement is not subject to Division 230, the
         value shifting rules would ordinarily prevent the taxpayer from
         recognising a reduced gain or a tax loss on an arrangement that
         would trigger the application of specific provisions within the
         value shifting regime (eg, in the case of indirect value shifting,
         Division 727-B).  As a consequence, a reduction of the adjustable
         values (eg, cost base) of the financial arrangement would occur in
         respect of the interests from which value has been shifted.  A
         corresponding adjustment might also be made in respect of the
         interests to which value has been shifted.  Alternatively, losses
         that would otherwise arise on realisation of the financial
         arrangement might have been denied to the holder.


   1285. The inclusion of section 230-520 is intended to ensure that
         inappropriate value shifts that would ordinarily have consequences
         under Divisions 723, 725, and 727 of the ITAA 1997 are disregarded
         in determining tax outcomes for financial arrangements that are
         subject to Division 230.  This is accomplished by assuming that a
         realisation event is taken to have happened in the income year in
         which the value shift is occurred.  Given that this realisation
         event is assumed to have occurred, consequences are taken to arise
         under Divisions 723, 725 and 727.  It is the gains or losses on
         shifts in value that are taken to have consequences under Divisions
         723, 725 and 727 that are disregarded for the purposes of Division
         230.  In other words the entity applies Division 230 as if the
         gains or losses attributable to the value shift never happened.


   1286. Where an entity holds financial arrangements before the
         commencement of Division 230, Division 230 allows taxpayers to, for
         example, apply the elective methods such as fair value to those pre-
         existing financial arrangements subject to certain requirements.
         Where such an election is made, the taxpayer must make a balancing
         adjustment which brings about assessable income or an allowable
         deduction which is to be spread over the first applicable income
         year and the next three income years.  Essentially the balancing
         adjustment brings to account the difference between what would have
         been the tax result had Division 230 applied to the pre-
         commencement financial arrangements from the time the taxpayer
         started to hold it and the actual tax results in respect of the
         financial arrangements.


   1287. If a value shift occurred prior to the commencement of Division 230
         in respect of a pre-existing financial arrangement causing the
         value of a financial arrangement to be reduced then, absent special
         integrity rules, the taxpayer may be able to obtain a tax saving
         from that value shift through the balancing adjustment.  In these
         circumstances, section 230-520 applies such that where a balancing
         adjustment is made in respect of existing financial arrangements,
         any value shifts that would ordinarily have consequences under
         Divisions 723, 725 and 727 of the ITAA 1997 are disregarded in
         determining gain or loss determined under the balancing adjustment.


   1288. Value shifts that would have had consequences under repealed value
         shifting provisions (eg, former Divisions 138, 139 and 140 of the
         ITAA 1997) are disregarded in determining gains and losses under
         Division 230 - including for the purposes of any balancing
         adjustment made in respect of existing financial arrangements.


Definitional and referencing changes


   1289. These amendments are required because the existing definitions
         contained in the tax laws have been affected by the introduction of
         Division 230.  Further, some amendments have been included to
         update checklists in the legislation.


         Exchangeable interests


   1290. The effect of Subdivision 130-E of the ITAA 1997 is that any
         capital gain or capital loss from the disposal or redemption of an
         exchangeable interest to the issuer of the interest or to a
         connected entity of the issuer, will be disregarded.  Subdivision
         130-E of the ITAA 1997 also modifies the cost base of the shares
         acquired as a result of the exchange or redemption.


   1291. Section 130-100 of the ITAA 1997 previously defined an exchangeable
         interest as a traditional security issued on the basis that it will
         or may be:


                . disposed to the issuer of the traditional security or a
                  connected entity of the issuer; or


                . redeemed,


         in exchange for shares in a company that is neither the issuer of
         the traditional security or in a connected entity of the issuer.


   1292. Broadly, a traditional security, as defined in subsection 26BB(1)
         of the ITAA 1936, is a security that is not issued at a deep
         discount, does not bear significant deferred interest and is not
         capital indexed.  A traditional security may be, for example, a
         bond, a debenture, a deposit with a financial institution or a
         secured or unsecured loan.


   1293. Amendments to section 130-100 broaden the application of this
         provision such that an exchangeable interest will now extend to
         'qualifying securities' within the meaning of that term in Division
         16E of the ITAA 1936.


   1294. As a result of this amendment, the CGT treatment of exchangeable
         interests will apply equally to exchangeable interests that are
         traditional securities and exchangeable interests that are
         qualifying securities.  This is similar to the treatment currently
         afforded to convertible interests under section 130-60.  [Schedule
         1, items 77 and 78, section 130-100]


         Offshore banking units and foreign bank branches


         Hedging activities of offshore banking units


   1295. Financial arrangements of an offshore banking unit are tested in
         order to determine if they qualify as offshore banking activities.
         One of those tests determines whether the activity, as represented
         by a financial arrangement, is a hedging activity.  In order to
         reduce compliance costs, the definition of 'hedging activity' in
         subsection 121D(8) of the ITAA 1936 will be amended to use the
         concept of a 'financial arrangement'.


   1296. The phrase 'financial arrangement' will replace the term 'contract'
         that is currently used in the definition.  The Division 230 term
         'hedging financial arrangement' has not been adopted because the
         accounting requirements involved in that concept could have limited
         the meaning of 'hedging activity'.  [Schedule 1, Part 2, item 37,
         definition of 'hedging activity' in subsection 121D(8) of the ITAA
         1936]


         Derivative transaction for foreign bank branches


   1297. An amendment will also be made to the definition of 'derivative
         transaction' in section 160ZZV of Part IIIB, so that it refers to
         financial arrangements to which Division 230 applies.  [Schedule 1,
         items 41 and 42, definition of 'derivative transaction' in section
         160ZZV of the ITAA 1936]


         Qualifying forex accounts


   1298. An amendment will be made to the definition of a 'qualifying forex
         account' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997 to extend its
         application by repealing the requirement that it must be maintained
         with an ADI or a financial institution similar to an ADI in
         Australia or overseas.  [Schedule 1, Part 4, item 111, definition
         of a 'qualifying forex account' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA
         1997].


   1299. This change will allow inter-company accounts, that are
         transactional accounts, to satisfy the definition of qualifying
         forex account.


         Checklists


   1300. The checklists in sections 10-5 and 12-5 of the ITAA 1997 will be
         amended to include references to 'gains from financial
         arrangements' and 'losses from financial arrangements'.  [Schedule
         1, items 53 and 57, sections 10-5 and 12-5]]


         Signposts


   1301. The operation of the value setting rules in section 230-505 have
         been described in paragraphs 11.26 to 11.59.  Signposts in the form
         of notes to provisions have been included in capital allowances
         [Schedule 1, items 62 to 68, subsections 40-180(1), 40-185(1), 40-
         300(1) and 40-305(1)] and CGT provisions [Schedule 1, items 70 to
         75, subsections 110-25(1) and 116-10(7) and sections 104-5 and 112-
         5] of the ITAA 1997 to highlight the possible application of
         section 230-505 to the relevant assets that are subject to those
         provisions.  A note has been added to the bad debt provisions to
         explain that in certain circumstances a loss in relation to a
         financial arrangement under subsections 230-150(3), (5) and (6) and
         230-165(3), (5) and (6) will be treated as a bad debt [Schedule 1,
         item 58, subsection 25-35(5)].


   1302. Signposts have also been added to some CGT provisions to highlight
         the effect of the hedging provisions in certain situations.
         [Schedule 1, items 69 and 70, sections 102-20 and 104-5]


   1303. Finally, subsection 6(1) of the ITAA 1936 defines a Division 230
         financial arrangement to mean a financial arrangement to which
         Division 230 applies in relation to your gains and losses from the
         arrangement, that is, the definition takes on the same meaning as
         contained in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997.  [Schedule 1,
         item 31, subsection 6(1)]


Record-keeping


   1304. A number of amendments are being made to section 262A of the ITAA
         1936.  These amendments will modify the application of section 262A
         so as to preserve its intended application in a Division 230
         context.


   1305. The first amendment modifies subsection 262A(1) so that it applies
         to all taxpayers that have Division 230 financial arrangements (ie,
         a financial arrangement to which Division 230 applies).  This
         amendment overcomes the requirement in subsection 262A(1) that a
         person be carrying on a business before the subsection has
         application.  [Schedule 1, item 46, subsection 262A(2AAC)]


   1306. The second amendment clarifies the application of
         subsection 262A(4).  The provision ensures that records relevant to
         the calculation of gains and losses from Division 230 financial
         arrangements must be kept for at least five years after the
         taxpayer includes an amount as assessable income or is entitled to
         a deduction in accordance with Division 230.


   1307. This amendment does not modify the time at which records must first
         be held (or in place).  Accordingly, Division 230 will be relevant
         when determining the time at which a record must be created or
         first held.  [Schedule 1, item 46, subsection 262A(2AAD)]


   1308. More specifically, in respect of hedging financial arrangements
         paragraph 262A(3)(ca) operates to ensure the record must be in
         place at, or soon after, the time when a taxpayer creates, acquires
         or applies the hedging financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item
         47, paragraph 262A(3)(ca)]


      1. :  Documentation requirements for a hedging financial arrangement


                Jimmy Co, an Australian resident company, enters into a
                hedging financial arrangement to hedge against foreign
                currency movements on the principal amount of loan that is
                denominated in $US.  The loan has a 15-year term and has a
                nominal value of US$1,000,000.


                Jimmy Co enters into a series of six-month forward rate
                agreements to hedge the foreign currency movements on the
                principal amount of the loan.


                Section 230-310 requires that Jimmy Co has the relevant
                hedging documentation in place at or soon after the time
                when the hedging financial arrangement is entered into.


                The modifications to section 262A of the ITAA 1936 operate
                to ensure that all documentation relating to the hedging
                financial arrangement, including each forward rate
                agreement, is retained for at least five years after either
                the:


              . gain on the hedging financial arrangement is included as an
                amount of assessable income; or


              . loss is claimed as a deduction in accordance with Division
                230.


                If the loan is structured such that it is an interest only
                loan throughout its term, then all gains and losses from the
                hedging financial arrangements will be bought to account at
                the end of the loan arrangement as this is the time at which
                the principal amount of the loan is repaid.


                In this example Jimmy Co will be required to retain certain
                records for a period of 20 years, that is, for the 15 years
                of the loan plus five years to comply with section 262A of
                the ITAA 1936.


   1309. Finally, for the purposes of subsection 262A(6), a Division 230
         financial arrangement is taken to mean a financial arrangement to
         which Division 230 applies in relation to your gains and losses
         from the arrangement, that is, the definition takes on the same
         meaning as contained in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997.
         [Schedule 1, item 31, subsection 6(1)]


Foreign currency gains and losses - Division 775 and Subdivisions 960-C and
960-D


   1310. Amendments to ensure that certain types of securitisation vehicles
         and special purpose vehicles were exempt from Division 775 with
         effect from 1 July 2003 were announced by the then Minister for
         Revenue and Assistant Treasurer in Press Release No. 073 of
         2 September 2005.  That exemption was provided until the
         commencement of the retranslation and hedging regimes as part of
         the taxation of financial arrangements legislative framework.
         Those regimes are to be introduced by this Bill.


   1311. In order to ensure that the law operates as intended in relation to
         these types of taxpayers the amendments (as described above) are
         included in this Bill.


   1312. The amendments to Division 775 will apply to 'securitisation
         vehicles' as defined in section 820-942 of the ITAA 1997 and
         special purpose vehicles that meet the requirements of subsection
         820-39(3) of the ITAA 1997.  Generally, those provisions identify
         certain entities that are eligible for special treatment as
         securitisation vehicles under the thin capitalisation rules in the
         income tax law.  In particular the following amendments will be
         made:


                . section 775-170 of the ITAA 1997 will be amended to
                  provide an exemption from Division 775 in respect of
                  foreign exchange realisation gains and foreign exchange
                  realisation losses made by the relevant securitisation
                  vehicles [Schedule 1, items 106 and 107, subsection 775-
                  170(2)];


                . section 775-195 of the ITAA 1997 will be amended to
                  exclude the relevant securitisation vehicles from being
                  eligible to make a choice for roll-over relief for
                  facility agreements held by such entities [Schedule 1,
                  item 108, subsection 775-195(9)];


                . section 960-55 of the ITAA 1997 will be amended to ensure
                  that the translation rules contained in Subdivision 960-C
                  will not apply to relevant securitisation vehicles for the
                  purposes of working out its assessable income, deductions
                  or tax offsets [Schedule 1, item 110, subsection 960-
                  55(4)]; and


                . section 960-60 of the ITAA 1997 will be amended to exclude
                  relevant securitisation vehicles from being eligible to
                  make a choice to apply a functional currency [Schedule 1,
                  item 110, subsection 960-60(6)].


   1313. Each of these amendments will take effect from 1 July 2003 - the
         date of commencement of Division 775 and Subdivisions 960-C and 960-
         D of the ITAA 1997.


   1314. It has been intended policy that once the retranslation and hedging
         regimes under the taxation of financial arrangements legislative
         framework commence, those entities that have been excluded from the
         operation of Division 775 and Subdivisions 960-C and 960-D of the
         ITAA 1997 were to become subject to those provisions.  The entities
         affected will be ADIs, non-ADI financial institutions and
         securitisation vehicles.  Amendments are made to ensure that on
         commencement of Division 230, those entities will also be subject
         to Division 775 and Subdivisions 960-C and 960-D of the ITAA 1997.
         [Schedule 1, items 107, 108, 110, 111 and 113]


         New Business Tax System (Taxation of Financial Arrangements)
         Act (No. 1) 2003


   1315. Section 77 of Schedule 4 to the NBTS (TOFA) 2003 is a transitional
         provision that allowed Division 3B of the ITAA 1936 to continue to
         apply:


                . to an eligible contract entered into by a taxpayer before
                  the taxpayer's 'applicable commencement date' for
                  Division 775 of the ITAA 1997 (see section 775-155 of the
                  ITAA 1997); and


                . for the purposes of working out the assessable income or
                  allowable deductions of an ADI or a non-ADI financial
                  institution.


   1316. Paragraph 77(1)(b) will be amended to extend the transitional
         provision as it relates to ADIs and non-ADI financial institutions
         to those securitisation vehicles referred to in paragraph 11.154.
         [Schedule 1, item 113, paragraph 77(1)(b) of the NBTS (TOFA) 2003]


   1317. Consistent with the policy outlined in paragraph 11.98, the
         transitional provisions which allow Division 3B of the ITAA 1936 to
         have continued operation in relation to ADIs, non-ADI financial
         institutions and relevant securitisation vehicles will be removed
         on commencement of Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 100]


         Retranslation for qualifying forex accounts


   1318. As a result of the change to the definition of qualifying forex
         account an amendment has been made to the retranslation election
         contained in Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA 1997 - see
         paragraph 11.140 for a discussion of the change.  The change
         provides for the making of a retranslation election in respect of
         qualifying forex accounts, as modified, with effect:


                . from 17 December 2003; or


                . where you make a choice within 90 days after the
                  commencement of Part 1 of Schedule 1 to the Tax Laws
                  Amendment (Taxation of Financial arrangements) Bill 2008
                  once enacted, from 1 July 2003.


         [Schedule 1, Part 4, item 109, subparagraph 775-270(2A)(a)(ii)]


   1319. Any existing retranslation election that applies to qualifying
         forex accounts under Subdivision 775-E of the ITAA 1997 will cease
         to apply to any account to which a general retranslation election
         or a qualifying forex account election applies.  [Schedule 1, item
         5, subsection 775-270(1A)]


   1320. Other changes to Division 775 relating to the retranslation
         election have been explained in Chapter 7.



Chapter 12
Consolidation interactions

Outline of chapter


   1321. This chapter explains:


                . amendments to the income tax consolidation regime to
                  ensure appropriate interactions with Division 230; and


                . how the existing law in relation to consolidation will
                  apply to entities that are taken to hold or cease to hold
                  a financial arrangement.


Context of amendments


   1322. Under the consolidation regime a group of eligible wholly-owned
         entities is treated as a single entity for income tax purposes.
         When an entity becomes a subsidiary member of a consolidated group
         or multiple entry consolidated group (MEC group), the membership
         interests held by the group in the joining entity are ignored and
         the entity's assets are treated for tax purposes as the assets of
         the head company.  The tax costs of those assets are reset at an
         amount that reflects the group's cost of acquiring the joining
         entity.


   1323. This chapter outlines the operation of the consolidation regime if
         an entity that holds Division 230 financial arrangements joins or
         leaves a consolidated group or MEC group.  To a large extent, the
         existing consolidation provisions will operate appropriately in
         these circumstances.  However, modifications are required to:


                . enhance the interaction between the consolidation regime
                  and Division 230; and


                . reduce compliance costs.


   1324. In this chapter, references to assets or liabilities being
         financial arrangements include assets or liabilities that form part
         of financial arrangements.


Summary of new law

   1325. There are four basic propositions outlined in this chapter.
   1326. First, where an entity joins a consolidated group or MEC group, the
         joining entity will apply Division 230 as if the joining time was
         the end of an income year.
   1327. Second, the head company will apply the consolidation rules and
         Division 230 (depending on whether it is required or has elected to
         apply Division 230) as if the head company had directly acquired
         assets or assumed liabilities that are, or form part of, financial
         arrangements from the joining entity.  Certain amendments are made
         to this proposition to reduce compliance costs specifically related
         to Division 230 interactions.
   1328. Third, where an entity leaves a consolidated group or MEC group,
         the head company will apply Division 230 as if the leaving time was
         the end of an income year.
   1329. Finally, a leaving entity which applies Division 230 in relation to
         its financial arrangement gains and losses will apply the Division
         as if the leaving entity took the financial arrangements with it at
         the leaving time.

Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                  |Current law              |
|If an asset that is a    |When an entity joins a   |
|financial arrangement    |consolidated group, the  |
|held by a joining entity |tax costs of the joining |
|is subject to the        |entity's assets are reset|
|accruals, realisation or |under the tax cost       |
|hedging methods, the tax |setting rules.           |
|cost setting rules will  |                         |
|apply to determine the   |                         |
|head company's tax cost  |                         |
|for the financial        |                         |
|arrangement.             |                         |
|If an asset that is a    |                         |
|financial arrangement    |                         |
|held by a joining entity |                         |
|is subject to the fair   |                         |
|value, financial reports |                         |
|or retranslation         |                         |
|elections, the head      |                         |
|company's tax cost for   |                         |
|the financial arrangement|                         |
|will be, broadly, its    |                         |
|accounting value.  Any   |                         |
|difference between the   |                         |
|accounting value and the |                         |
|tax cost setting amount  |                         |
|will be included in the  |                         |
|head company's assessable|                         |
|income, or allowed as a  |                         |
|deduction, over four     |                         |
|years.                   |                         |
|If a liability that is a |When an entity joins a   |
|financial arrangement    |consolidated group, the  |
|held by a joining entity |value of the liabilities |
|is subject to the        |the head company assumes |
|accruals, realisation or |from the joining entity  |
|hedging methods, the     |is given by the entry    |
|entry history rule will  |history rule.            |
|apply to determine the   |                         |
|value of any liabilities |                         |
|a head company assumes   |                         |
|from a joining entity.   |                         |
|If a liability that is a |                         |
|financial arrangement    |                         |
|held by a joining entity |                         |
|is subject to the fair   |                         |
|value, financial reports |                         |
|or retranslation         |                         |
|elections, the head      |                         |
|company will apply       |                         |
|Division 230 on the basis|                         |
|that it assumed the      |                         |
|liability at the joining |                         |
|time for an amount equal |                         |
|to its Division 230      |                         |
|starting value.          |                         |
|The terminating value of |When an entity leaves a  |
|a financial arrangement  |consolidated group, the  |
|will be the amount of    |tax cost setting amount  |
|consideration that the   |of the membership        |
|head company would need  |interests the head       |
|to receive if it were to |company holds in the     |
|dispose of the financial |leaving entity is worked |
|arrangement just before  |out by reference to,     |
|the leaving time without |among other things, the  |
|an amount being included |terminating value of     |
|in assessable income, or |assets that the leaving  |
|being allowed as a       |entity takes with it.    |
|deduction, under         |                         |
|Division 230.            |                         |


Detailed explanation of new law


   1330. This chapter outlines how the amendments and existing consolidation
         provisions will apply:


                . if a joining entity holds financial arrangements and
                  Division 230 applies to work out gains or losses on those
                  financial arrangements, in relation to:


                  - the joining entity; and


                  - the head company at the joining time; or


                . if a leaving entity takes financial arrangements with it
                  and Division 230 applies to work out gains or losses on
                  those financial arrangements, in relation to:


                  - the leaving entity; and


                  - the head company at the leaving time.


   1331. This chapter will also outline other consolidation and Division 230
         interaction amendments relating to:


                . the eligibility of MEC groups to make Division 230
                  elections; and


                . the Division 230 transitional measures.


Treatment of joining entities


   1332. Subsection 701-30(3) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997 (ITAA
         1997) requires a joining entity to work out its taxable income for
         the period prior to the joining time as if the joining time were
         the end of an income year.


   1333. Therefore, a joining entity will apply Division 230 (depending on
         whether it is required or has elected to apply Division 230) as it
         ordinarily would on the basis that the joining time is the end of
         its income year.


   1334. There is no Subdivision 230-G balancing adjustment at the end of
         this income year as a consequence of the joining event because the
         joining entity is not taken by the consolidation rules to have
         transferred the financial arrangement or otherwise ceased to have
         it.


      1.


                Joining Co holds a financial arrangement whose gains or
                losses are worked out using the compounding accruals method.
                 The effect of the compounding accruals method is that $333
                must be included in the entity's assessable income in 2010-
                11, 2011-12, and 2012-13.  The intervals to which this gain
                is being allocated exactly equate to Joining Co's income
                year, which starts on 1 July and ends on 30 June.


                On 1 January 2011, Joining Co joins a consolidated group.


                Therefore, Joining Co has an end of income year of
                31 December 2010.  Joining Co will be taken to have made a
                gain equal to so much of that part of the gain as is
                allocated to the income year 1 July 2010 to 31 December 2010
                on a reasonable basis.


                For example, a reasonable basis for calculating the part of
                the gain to be allocated to the 1 July 2010 to 31 December
                2010 period may be to simply divide $333 by two.  However,
                whether this is a reasonable basis to allocate the gain
                entirely depends on the facts and circumstances of the
                financial arrangement.


      2.


                Joining Co holds a financial arrangement whose gains or
                losses are worked out using the fair value method.


                On 1 July 2010, the fair value of the financial arrangement
                according to Joining Co's financial reports is $100.


                On 1 January 2011, Joining Co joins a consolidated group.
                The market value of the financial arrangement at this time
                is $120.


                Joining Co will apply the fair value method on the basis
                that 31 December 2010 is the end of its income year.


                Joining Co makes a gain from this financial arrangement for
                the income year 1 July 2010 to 31 December 2010 of $20.


         Subdivision 716-A of the ITAA 1997 does not apply even where a
         Division 230 spreading method is being used


   1335. Subdivision 716-A applies if an entity is a subsidiary member of a
         consolidated group for part of an income year and a provision of
         the income tax law spreads an amount of assessable income, or the
         amount of a deduction, over two or more income years by including
         part of the original amount in the same entity's assessable income,
         or by allowing the same entity to deduct part of the amount, for
         each of those income years.


   1336. Under Division 230, gains and losses from a financial arrangement
         are recognised over its life.  If a Division 230 spreading method
         applies to the financial arrangement, the gain or loss that is
         recognised in each income year is determined at the end of that
         income year.  If an entity joins a consolidated group part way
         through an income year, the entity applies the Division 230
         spreading method to determine its taxable income at the joining
         time.  Similarly, if an entity leaves a consolidated group part way
         through an income year, the head company applies the Division 230
         spreading method to the financial arrangement up to the leaving
         time to determine its taxable income for that income year.  The
         Division 230 spreading methods do not spread a pre-determined
         amount of assessable income, or the pre-determined amount of a
         deduction, between income years.  Therefore, if an entity that
         holds a financial arrangement is a subsidiary member of a
         consolidated group for part of an income year, Subdivision 716-A
         does not apply to allocate the gain or loss on that financial
         arrangement in that income year between the head company and the
         subsidiary member.


Treatment of head companies at the joining time


   1337. A head company which commences to hold an asset or liability that
         is a financial arrangement will apply Division 230 as if the head
         company directly acquired the asset or liability.  There are two
         implications of this:


                . the tax cost of any asset that is a financial arrangement
                  that the head company is taken to have acquired is equal
                  to the asset's tax cost setting amount; and


                . any election the head company has made in relation to its
                  existing financial arrangements will apply to the
                  financial arrangements it has taken to have acquired as a
                  result of the joining entity becoming a member of the
                  consolidated group.


         [Schedule 1, items 85 and 89, subsections 701-55(5A) and 715-
         375(2)]


         Setting the tax costs of assets


   1338. If a joining entity holds assets that are a financial arrangement,
         Division 705 of the ITAA 1997 will apply to set the tax costs of
         those assets at their tax cost setting amounts.


   1339. Where the asset is a reset cost base asset, section 705-40 of the
         ITAA 1997 may apply such that the asset's tax cost setting amount
         must not exceed the greater of the asset's market value, or the
         joining entity's terminating value for the asset.  The section will
         apply where the asset that is a financial arrangement is a revenue
         asset (as defined in section 977-50 of the ITAA 1997).


   1340. Section 701-55 of the ITAA 1997 sets out how the tax cost setting
         amount is used as the basis for applying other provisions in the
         income tax law.  For the purpose of applying Division 230, the use
         of the tax cost setting amount for assets that are financial
         arrangements varies depending on the method the head company is
         applying to work out its gains or losses under Division 230.


         Where the head company is using the accrual/realisation method


   1341. In relation to assets that are financial arrangements on which
         gains or losses are being worked out using the compounding accruals
         or realisation method, the effect of the asset's tax cost being set
         is that Division 230 will apply as if the financial benefits
         provided to acquire the asset were equal to the asset's tax cost
         setting amount.  [Schedule 1, item 85, paragraph 701-55(5A)(a)]


   1342. Consequently, the financial benefits the head company is taken to
         have provided for the purposes of step 2(a) in the method statement
         in the table at subsection 230-445(1) includes the asset's tax cost
         setting amount (rather than its original cost).  The asset's tax
         cost setting amount will also be relevant in determining whether an
         entity has a sufficiently certain gain or loss from the financial
         arrangement.


   1343. However, the tax cost resetting process will not necessarily cause
         a re-estimation to arise.  A re-estimation arises in circumstances
         that materially affect the amount or value of financial benefits
         that were taken into account in working out the amount of a gain or
         loss.  The reason no re-estimation arises is because the head
         company is required to apply Division 230 as though it had acquired
         the asset at the joining time for its tax cost setting amount.  In
         other words, the gain or loss the head company makes from an asset
         that is a financial arrangement is worked out on the basis of the
         head company's tax cost setting amount for the asset.


      1.


                Joining Co has an asset that is a financial arrangement
                whose gains are worked out using the realisation method.
                The market value of the financial arrangement is $100.  This
                is the only asset or liability held by Joining Co.


                Head Co acquires Joining Co for $80.  The asset is a reset
                cost base asset.


                Head Co subsequently sells the financial arrangement for its
                market value of $100.  As a result, Head Co has a balancing
                adjustment under step 2(a) in the method statement in the
                table at subsection 230-445(1).


                The financial benefits received by Head Co in relation to
                the disposal of the financial arrangement are $100, and the
                benefits taken to have been provided are $80 (as a result of
                the tax cost setting process).


                As a result, Head Co is taken to have made a gain from the
                financial arrangement for the purposes of Division 230 equal
                to $20.


      2.


                Joining Co has a zero-coupon bond with the right to receive
                a financial benefit equal to $200 on 1 July 2021.  Joining
                Co provided a financial benefit equal to $100 in relation to
                the acquisition of the bond on 1 July 2011.


                Head Co acquires Joining Co on 1 July 2016 for $150
                (representing the market value of the right to receive $200
                in five years time).  Head Co's allocable cost amount for
                Joining Co is therefore $150.


                Given that the amount to be received on 1 July 2021
                represents a right to receive a specified amount of
                Australian currency, the asset is a retained cost base asset
                and a qualifying security.  Therefore, the tax cost setting
                amount of the asset is $150.  As the tax cost setting amount
                exactly equals the allocable cost amount for Joining Co, CGT
                event L3 will not occur.


                However, Head Co will take the tax cost setting amount of
                $150 into account when working out whether it has a
                sufficiently certain overall gain or loss under the accruals
                method.  Given that the tax cost setting amount is $50 less
                than the amount of $200 due to be received on 1 July 2021,
                Head Co will make a $50 Division 230 gain from the
                arrangement.  This gain will be spread in accordance with
                the rules in Division 230.


         Where the head company has elected to use the hedging method


   1344. In relation to assets that are financial arrangements on which
         gains or losses are being worked out using the hedging method, the
         effect of the asset's tax cost being set is that Division 230 will
         apply as if the financial benefits provided to acquire the asset
         are equal to the asset's tax cost setting amount.  [Schedule 1,
         item 96, paragraph 701-55(5A)(a)]


   1345. However, this will not affect whether the hedge effectiveness test
         in section 230-365 is satisfied, even though the hedge
         effectiveness test is in part based on the value of the underlying
         asset.  The tax cost resetting process only applies to reset the
         tax cost of the asset, and not its accounting value.  Given that
         the hedge effectiveness test relies on the accounting standards to
         determine whether it is satisfied, the fact that the tax value of
         the hedged item is reset is not relevant.


      1.


                Joining Co has $1,000 worth of Australian currency and a
                hedging financial arrangement with a fair value of $50 and a
                hedged item worth $100.  The hedging financial arrangement
                was initially entered into for a fair value of $0.  In
                accordance with the hedging documentation, the fair value of
                the hedging financial arrangement represents a gain and will
                be included in the entity's assessable income when the
                hedged item is disposed of.


                Head Co acquires the membership interests in Joining Co for
                $1,150 (being the $1,000 cash, the fair value $50 hedging
                financial arrangement, and the hedged item worth $100).
                Head Co's allocable cost amount for the joining entity is
                therefore $1,150.


                The Australian currency is given a tax cost setting amount
                of $1,000.  Similarly, the hedging financial arrangement has
                a tax cost setting amount of $50 and the hedged item has a
                tax cost setting amount of $100.


                Head Co applies Division 230 on the basis that it acquired
                the financial arrangement for $50.  If the Head Co chooses
                to apply hedging financial arrangement election in relation
                to the arrangement and it is eligible to do so, the method
                applies on the basis that the Head Co acquired the hedging
                financial arrangement for $50 and the hedged item for $100.


                If the Head Co were to immediately dispose of the hedging
                financial arrangement after the joining time for its fair
                value of $50, it would make a $0 gain from the hedging
                financial arrangement.


         Where the head company has elected to use the fair value,
         retranslation or financial reports method


   1346. If the gains or losses in relation to an asset that is a financial
         arrangement are calculated using the fair value, retranslation or
         financial reports method, the asset's tax cost setting amount is
         the asset's Division 230 starting value at the time of joining.
         [Schedule 1, item 85, paragraph 701-55(5A)(b)]


   1347. Consequently, the financial benefits the head company has taken to
         have provided includes the asset's Division 230 starting value
         (rather than its original cost) for the purposes of step 2(a) in
         the method statement in the table at subsection 230-445(1).


   1348. Gains or losses under the fair value, retranslation or reliance on
         financial reports methods will be worked out applying the
         principles set out in those methods.


         What is the Division 230 starting value?


   1349. The Division 230 starting value of an asset that is a financial
         arrangement depends on which elective method is chosen in relation
         to the arrangement.


   1350. If the fair value method applies in relation to the arrangement,
         the Division 230 starting value is the value of that asset
         according to the relevant standards mentioned in section 230-230
         that apply in relation to the arrangement.  [Schedule 1, item 96,
         paragraph (a) of the definition of 'Division 230 starting value' in
         subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997]


   1351. If the foreign exchange retranslation method applies in relation to
         the arrangement, the Division 230 starting value is the value of
         the asset according to the relevant standards mentioned in
         section 230-280 that apply in relation to the arrangement.
         [Schedule 1, item 96, paragraph (b) of the definition of
         'Division 230 starting value' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA
         1997]


   1352. If the reliance on financial reports method is chosen in relation
         to the arrangement, the Division 230 starting value is the value of
         the asset according to the relevant standards mentioned in
         section 230-420 that apply in relation to the arrangement.
         [Schedule 1, item 96, paragraph (c) of the definition of
         'Division 230 starting value' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA
         1997]


      1.


                Joining Co holds an asset that is a financial arrangement
                and joins Head Co's consolidated group.  Head Co has chosen
                to apply the fair value method in relation to its financial
                arrangements.


                The value of the asset according to the relevant standards
                mentioned in section 230-230 is $100.  However, Head Co's
                tax cost setting amount for the asset is $80.


                For the purposes of applying Division 230, the value of the
                financial benefits Head Co provided to acquire the financial
                benefit will be $100.  In applying step 2(a) of the
                Division 230 balancing adjustment provisions, the financial
                benefits provided in relation to the acquisition of the
                financial arrangement is $100.


                Under the fair value method, the value of the financial
                arrangement is also equal to $100.


         What happens when there is a difference between an asset's tax cost
         setting amount and the Division 230 starting value


   1353. The sum of the tax cost setting amounts of the assets of a joining
         entity that are financial arrangements may differ from the sum of
         the Division 230 starting values for those assets.


   1354. If the sum of the Division 230 starting values exceeds the sum of
         the tax cost setting amounts, an amount equal to 25 per cent of
         that excess is included in the head company's assessable income for
         the income year in which the single entity rule commenced to apply,
         and each of the subsequent three income years.  [Schedule 1,
         item 87, subsections 701-61(1) to (3)]


   1355. If the sum of the Division 230 starting values is less than the sum
         of the tax cost setting amounts, an amount equal to 25 per cent of
         that shortfall is allowed to the head company as a deduction for
         the income year in which the single entity rule commenced to apply,
         and each of the subsequent three income years.  [Schedule 1,
         item 87, subsections 701-61(1), (2) and (4)]


   1356. The rationale for including these amounts in assessable income, or
         allowing a deduction for them, is that the head company has
         effectively obtained an increase or decrease in the value of the
         financial benefits it provided to acquire the financial
         arrangement.  If a Subdivision 230-G balancing adjustment
         subsequently occurs in relation to the financial arrangement, the
         step 2(a) amount in the method statement at section 230-445 would
         be higher or lower, resulting in the head company having a higher
         or lower balancing adjustment that is included in assessable income
         or allowed as a deduction under step 3 in that method statement.
         Therefore, this difference is appropriately included in assessable
         income, or allowed as a deduction, under section 701-61.


      1.


                Following on from the facts in Example 12.6, the Division
                230 starting value of $100 of the asset exceeds its tax cost
                setting amount of $80 by $20.


                Therefore, Head Co will include $5 in its assessable income
                in the year in which it was taken to have acquired the
                financial arrangement from the Joining Co, and in each of
                the three subsequent income years.


         Elections made by the head company apply to financial arrangements
         a head company is taken to have acquired


   1357. If a joining entity holds financial arrangements, Division 230 will
         apply as if the head company had directly acquired those financial
         arrangements.


         What happens if the joining entity had made a Division 230
         election?


   1358. If a joining entity had made a Division 230 election in relation to
         its financial arrangements prior to the joining time, that election
         will not bind the head company.  In other words, the entry history
         rule does not operate to require the head company to use the
         elections the joining entity made in relation to its financial
         arrangements.  [Schedule 1, items 90 and 91, item 3A in the table
         in subsection 715-660(1) and item 1A in the table in subsection 715-
         665(1)]


         What happens if the head company made a Division 230 election prior
         to the joining time?


   1359. If a head company had made a Division 230 election prior to the
         joining time, the head company applies Division 230 on the basis
         that the financial arrangements that it acquired from the joining
         entity were directly acquired from the joining entity.  Therefore,
         the head company must apply any Division 230 election it had made
         to the financial arrangements acquired from the joining entity
         (assuming the gains or losses on those financial arrangements are
         still eligible to be worked out under those elective methods).


   1360. Further, the head company will continue to apply any Division 230
         election it had made in relation to the financial arrangements it
         had prior to the joining time.  The head company is not entitled to
         make a fresh election in relation to those financial arrangements
         because it has acquired additional financial arrangements from the
         joining entity.


         What happens if the head company had not made a Division 230
         election prior to joining time?


   1361. If no election has been made by the head company prior to joining
         time, the accruals/realisation method will apply to all of the head
         company's financial arrangements.  This includes both the
         arrangements the head company had prior to the joining time, as
         well as the arrangements it acquired from the joining entity.


   1362. The head company will also be eligible to make a Division 230
         election in relation to all of its financial arrangements after the
         joining time, unencumbered by any elections that may or may not
         have been made by the joining entity.  [Schedule 1, items 90 and
         91, item 3A in the table in subsection 715-660(1) and item 1A in
         the table in subsection 715-665(1)]


      1.


                Joining Co has 10 financial arrangements, and is applying
                the accruals/realisation method in relation to them.


                Joining Co becomes a member of Head Co's consolidated group.
                 Head Co has previously elected to apply the fair value
                method to its financial arrangements.


                Head Co must apply the fair value method to Joining Co's
                financial arrangements (assuming it continues to be eligible
                to use the fair value method, and the fair value method
                applies in relation to the financial arrangements).


         Financial arrangements consisting of liabilities


   1363. For liabilities that are or form part of financial arrangements
         that are to be subject to the accruals/realisation or hedging
         financial arrangement method, the entry history rule will apply to
         determine the value of any liabilities a head company assumes from
         a joining entity.  Generally this will be the original value of the
         liability, taking into account such things as repayments of
         principal that may have been made in relation to the liability
         prior to the joining time.


   1364. For liabilities that are or form part of financial arrangements
         that are to be subject to the fair value, foreign exchange
         retranslation, or reliance on financial reports method, the head
         company will apply Division 230 as if the liability were assumed at
         the time of joining for an amount equal to the liability's Division
         230 starting value (see above for a discussion on Division 230
         starting value in the context of assets).  [Schedule 1, item 89,
         subsections 715-375(3) and (4)]


         Financial arrangements consisting of both an asset and a liability


   1365. Some financial arrangements may consist of both assets and
         liabilities.  In this circumstance, the consolidation provisions
         may apply separately to these assets and liabilities, depending on
         the facts and circumstances of the particular financial arrangement
         (section 705-58 of the ITAA 1997).  However, if a financial
         arrangement contains assets and liabilities that are linked,
         section 705-59 of the ITAA 1997 may apply to the financial
         arrangement.


Treatment of head companies at the leaving time


   1366. If a head company is applying one of the Division 230 spreading
         methods to gains and losses for a financial arrangement, the head
         company would apply Division 230 as it ordinarily would on the
         basis that the leaving time is the end of its income year.
         [Schedule 1, item 1, subsections 230-170(3), 230-230(3), 230-
         280(4), 230-300(10) and 230-420(3)]


         Allocation of gains or losses where the head company ceases to have
         a hedging financial arrangement


   1367. If a leaving entity takes a financial arrangement with it that was
         subject to the hedging financial arrangement election and also
         takes the hedged item (or as a result of leaving the head company
         ceases to expect that it will have the hedged item), the gain or
         loss from the hedging financial arrangement the head company
         allocates to the income year in which leaving time occurs is the
         amount determined under subsection 230-360(1).  [Schedule 1,
         item 1, subsection 230-300(10)]


   1368. The entire gain or loss is not allocated to the income year in
         which leaving occurs, notwithstanding item 2 in the table in
         section 230-305.  [Schedule 1, item 1, subsection 230-300(11)]


   1369. However, where the leaving entity takes the hedged item but not the
         hedging financial arrangement with it, section 230-305 will apply
         to ensure that any gain or loss is allocated to the income year in
         which leaving occurs.


   1370. Where the leaving entity takes the hedging financial arrangement
         with it but not the hedged item, the head company includes any gain
         or loss on that hedging financial arrangement in accordance with
         the determination under subsection 230-360(1).


      1.


                Head Co has $1,000 cash and a hedging financial arrangement
                with a fair value of $50 and a hedged item worth $100.  The
                hedging financial arrangement was initially entered into for
                a fair value of $0.  In accordance with the hedging
                documentation, the fair value of the hedging financial
                arrangement represents a gain and will be included in the
                entity's assessable income when the hedged item is disposed
                of.


                On 30 June an entity leaves the consolidated group taking
                with it $500 in cash as well as the hedging financial
                arrangement and the hedged item.  The cost base of the
                membership interests the head company holds in the leaving
                entity would be $600 (being $500 for the terminating value
                of the cash, $100 for the hedged item and $0 for the hedging
                financial arrangement).  The membership interests in the
                leaving entity are sold for $650, taking into account the
                hedging financial arrangement with a fair value of $50.  In
                effect, the $50 fair value gain on the financial arrangement
                is brought to tax for the head company in the form of a $50
                capital gain from the sale of the membership interests in
                the leaving entity.


                Subsections 230-300(10) and (11) ensure that the single gain
                is only brought to account once for the head company.
                Therefore, no Division 230 gain will arise in respect of the
                arrangement.


         Setting the tax cost of the head company's membership interests in
         the leaving entity


   1371. Under subsection 701-15(3) of the ITAA 1997, if an entity ceases to
         be a subsidiary member of a consolidated group, the membership
         interests that the head company holds in that entity has a tax cost
         that is set just before the leaving time at the interest's tax cost
         setting amount.  The tax cost setting amount for these membership
         interests is set at an amount based on the old group's allocable
         cost amount in the leaving entity and the market value of the
         membership interests.


   1372. In working out the old group's allocable cost amount for the
         leaving entity, the head company must work out the terminating
         values of all the assets held by the leaving entity (subsection 711-
         25(1) of the ITAA 1997).


   1373. If an asset of the head company is a financial arrangement, the
         head company's terminating value for the asset is equal to the
         amount of consideration that the head company would need to
         receive, if it were to dispose of the asset just before the leaving
         time without an amount being assessable income of, or deductible
         to, the head company under Division 230.  [Schedule 1, item 88,
         subsection 705-30(3B)]


   1374. In other words, the terminating value is the amount of
         consideration the head company would need to receive if:


                . where the hedging financial arrangement election does not
                  apply in relation to the asset - a Subdivision 230-G
                  balancing adjustment occurred just before leaving time in
                  order for the result in step 3 in the method statement in
                  subsection 230-445(1) to be nil; or


                . where the hedging financial arrangement election does
                  apply in relation to the asset - the amount of
                  consideration the head company would need to receive if it
                  had disposed of the asset just before the leaving time
                  that would result in no gain or loss arising in respect of
                  the disposal under the hedging financial arrangement
                  election in the income year in which leaving occurs or any
                  subsequent income year.


      1.


                Head Co has an asset that is a financial arrangement.
                Leaving Co is leaving the consolidated group and is taking
                the financial arrangement with it.  Therefore, the
                terminating value of the asset must be worked out for the
                purposes of determining the old group's allocable cost
                amount.


                Head Co provided $100 to acquire the arrangement.  It also
                received $20 under the arrangement by way of repayment of
                principal.


                Therefore, the terminating value of the asset is the amount
                of consideration that Head Co would need to receive if it
                were to dispose of the asset just before the leaving time
                without a balancing adjustment arising under section 230-445
                - that is, $80.  In this regard, applying the method
                statement in subsection 230-445(1):


              . the step 1(a) amounts would be $20 (being amounts received
                under the arrangement) and $80 (being the amount needed to
                be received in relation to the disposal of the arrangement
                so that there is no balancing adjustment); and


              . the step 2(a) amount would be $100 (being the financial
                benefits provided in relation to the acquisition of the
                arrangement).


      2.


                Head Co has an asset that is a hedging financial arrangement
                that is a forward currency contract to which the hedging
                financial arrangement election applies.  In accordance with
                a determination in subsection 230-360(1), Head Co includes
                any gain on the financial arrangement in the income year in
                which the hedged item is disposed of.


                Head Co provided $0 to acquire the arrangement, and the
                current fair value of the arrangement is $50.  However, in
                accordance with the determination, the $50 gain on the
                hedging financial arrangement will only be included in Head
                Co's assessable income when the hedged item is disposed of.


                Head Co's terminating value of the hedging financial
                arrangement is the amount of consideration it would need to
                receive if it had disposed of the arrangement just before
                the leaving time that would result in no gain or loss
                arising in respect of the disposal under the hedging
                financial arrangement election in the income year in which
                leaving occurs or any subsequent income year.


                In this case, Head Co's terminating value for the hedging
                financial arrangement would be $0.


         Exit history rule not to apply in relation to certain amounts


   1375. If a head company includes amounts in its assessable income, or is
         entitled to a deduction, as a result of an election for the
         portfolio treatment of fees, discounts or premiums under section
         230-160, the amounts of assessable income or allowable deductions
         will continue to attach to the head company.  That is, the exit
         history rule does not apply to transfer these amounts to the
         leaving entity.  [Schedule 1, item 89, subsections 715-380(1) and
         (2)]


   1376. In addition, if a head company includes amounts in its assessable
         income, or is entitled to a deduction, over a four-year period
         under section 701-61 and an entity leaves the consolidated group
         before the end of the four-year period, the amounts of assessable
         income or allowable deductions will continue to attach to the head
         company.  That is, the exit history rule does not apply to transfer
         these amounts to the leaving entity.  [Schedule 1, item 89,
         subsections 715-380(3) and (4)]


   1377. Finally, if a head company includes amounts in its assessable
         income, or is entitled to a deduction, over a four-year period as a
         result of a transitional balancing adjustment election under item
         121 of Schedule 1 to the Tax Laws Amendment (Taxation of Financial
         Arrangements) Bill 2008 the amounts of assessable income or
         allowable deductions will continue to attach to the head company.
         That is, the exit history rule does not apply to transfer these
         amounts to the leaving entity.  [Schedule 1, item 99, section 715-
         380 of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997]


Treatment of leaving entities


   1378. A leaving entity which commences to hold an asset or liability that
         is a financial arrangement after the single entity rule ceases to
         apply will apply Division 230 as if the leaving entity takes the
         financial arrangements with it.  As a result:


                . the tax cost of an asset that is a financial arrangement
                  that the leaving entity takes with it will be the asset's
                  terminating value;


                . the value of a liability that is a financial arrangement
                  that the leaving entity takes with it will be the value of
                  the liability just before the leaving time; and


                . the leaving entity will inherit any election the head
                  company made to apply Division 230.


         Tax cost of the leaving entity's assets


   1379. The exit history rule (section 701-40 of the ITAA 1997) will apply
         to set the tax cost of an asset that is a financial arrangement
         that a leaving entity takes with it at the asset's terminating
         value.  The leaving entity's terminating value for the asset is the
         same as the head company's terminating value.


   1380. The leaving entity's tax cost of the asset is not reset to the
         Division 230 starting value.


      1.


                In Example 12.10, Head Co's terminating value for the asset
                was worked out to be $80.


                Similarly, for the leaving entity the tax cost of the asset
                will also be $80.  If a Subdivision 230-G balancing
                adjustment subsequently occurs in relation to the asset, the
                amount provided in relation to the acquisition of the asset
                for the purposes of step 2(a) in the method statement in
                subsection 230-445(1) will be $80.


         Value of liabilities assumed by the leaving entity


   1381. The exit history rule in section 701-40 of the ITAA 1997 will apply
         to set the value of any liability that is a financial arrangement
         that a leaving entity takes with it.  As a result, anything that
         happened in relation to the liability is taken to have happened to
         the liability as if it had been a liability of the leaving entity.


         Liabilities and assets that are hedging financial arrangements that
         the leaving entity takes with it


   1382. Where a leaving entity takes with it an asset or a liability that
         is a hedging financial arrangement, and the hedged item, the head
         company will apply the hedging financial arrangement election as if
         the leaving time is an end of income year.  Furthermore, where this
         occurs the head company will not be taken to have ceased to have
         the hedged item under item 2 in the table in subsection 230-305(1).
          Instead, the head company makes a gain or loss on the hedging
         financial arrangement equal to the gain or loss the head company
         would have made under the hedging financial arrangement Subdivision
         had item 2 in the table in subsection 230-305(1) not been
         triggered.  The tax cost of the asset and the value of the
         liability are therefore provided by the exit history rule in
         accordance with the discussion above.


         Leaving entity may make fresh elections in relation to the elective
         methods


   1383. An entity that leaves a consolidated group or MEC group can make a
         fresh election under Division 230 in relation to the elective
         methods (but cannot override an election to apply Division 230).
         This is achieved under sections 715-700 and 715-705 of the ITAA
         1997.  [Schedule 1, items 90 and 91, item 3A in the table in
         subsection 715-660(1) and item 1A in the table in subsection 715-
         665(1)]


   1384. Hence, provided the requirements of the relevant provisions are
         met, a leaving entity may be able to make a fresh election that
         will apply from the leaving time or, if the election relates to an
         income year, the income year in which the leaving time occurs.


   1385. If the entity makes such a fresh election, the leaving entity does
         not need to satisfy the requirement that the entity started to have
         the financial arrangement in the income year in which the election
         is made or in a later income year.  [Schedule 1, item 89, section
         715-385]


   1386. But for section 715-385, under the exit history rule the leaving
         entity would be taken to have started to have the financial
         arrangement in the income year in which the head company started to
         have it.  Therefore, if the leaving entity were to make a fresh
         election under sections 715-700 and 715-705 of the ITAA 1997, the
         elective methods could not apply in relation to the financial
         arrangements the leaving entity took with it because the leaving
         entity will be taken to have started to have those arrangements in
         an income year prior to the income year in which the election was
         made.


         Leaving entity inherits head company's election to apply Division
         230


   1387. If the head company of a consolidated group or MEC group elects to
         apply Division 230, the exit history rule will apply such that any
         leaving entity that was a subsidiary member of the consolidated
         group when the head company made that election will be taken to
         have been made by the leaving entity.


Consolidated groups and the elective requirements to rely on financial
reports


   1388. An entity will satisfy a requirement that it prepare a financial
         report (such as for the purposes of making an election under the
         elective Subdivisions) if:


                . a financial report is prepared by another entity and that
                  other entity is a connected entity of the entity; and


                . the report is a consolidated financial report that deals
                  with both the entity and connected entity's affairs; and


                . the report properly reflects the entity's affairs.


         [Schedule 1, item 1, section 230-525]


   1389. If a top company of a MEC group prepares consolidated financial
         reports that deals with the affairs of the head company and the top
         company, and that report properly reflects the affairs of the head
         company, the requirement that the head company prepare a financial
         report are satisfied.  This is because a top company is a connected
         entity of the head company because both are members of the same
         wholly-owned group.


   1390. A report may properly reflect the affairs of the head company even
         where many of the financial arrangements the head company has are
         not actually reflected in the financial reports of the top company.
          This may occur where the top company and the head company are
         members of the same accounting consolidated group and most of the
         arrangements the head company has is with the top company.


   1391. Financial arrangements the head company holds with entities outside
         of an accounting consolidated group will need to be properly
         reflected in the top company's consolidated financial reports.


Interactions with the Division 230 transitional measures


         Application of Subdivision 716-A to transitional balancing
         adjustment amounts


   1392. Subitem 104(2) provides for a transitional balancing adjustment for
         financial arrangements that are in existence at the time Division
         230 commences.  Subitem 104(14) provides that a transitional
         balancing adjustment is to be spread evenly over four income years
         where an entity has made the transitional balancing adjustment
         election.


   1393. Given that this amount is spread over two or more income years by
         including part of the original amount in the same entity's
         assessable income, or allowing part of the original amount as a
         deduction to the same entity, Subdivision 716-A of the ITAA 1997
         may apply in relation to these transitional balancing adjustment
         amounts.


      1.


                Joining Co has made a transitional balancing adjustment
                election which would include $250 in that entity's
                assessable income every income year from 2010-11 to 2013-14.


                On 1 January 2011 Joining Co joins a consolidated group.


                Subdivision 716-A of the ITAA 1997 applies in relation to
                the $250 to be included in the entity's assessable income
                over the current income year.  For the purposes of section
                716-15 of the ITAA 1997, the spreading period is the period
                from 1 July 2010 to 30 June 2011, or 365 days.  Joining Co's
                non-membership period is 1 July 2010 to 31 December 2010, or
                184 days.  Joining Co is a subsidiary member of the
                consolidated group for the remaining 181 days of the
                spreading period.


                Joining Co's assessable income for the non-membership period
                includes:


                $250  ×  184/365  =  $126.03.


                Head Co's assessable income for the 2010-11 income year
                includes:


                $250  ×  181/365  =  $123.97.


         Exit history rule and the transitional balancing adjustment
         election


   1394. If a head company makes an election under subitem 104(2) relating
         to financial arrangements, the exit history rule will apply such
         that any leaving entity that was a subsidiary member of the
         consolidated group when the head company made that election will be
         taken to have been made by the leaving entity.  Where this occurs,
         in order to reduce compliance costs, any transitional balancing
         adjustment amount will remain with the head company.  [Schedule 1,
         item 99, section 715-380 of the Income Tax (Transitional
         Provisions) Act 1997]



Chapter 13
Commencement, transitional and implementation issues

Outline of chapter


   1395. This chapter explains:


                . when the provisions of Division 230 begin to have effect;


                . how financial arrangements that a taxpayer has at the time
                  Division 230 begins to have effect may be treated under
                  this Division; and


                . how relevant arrangements that are not Division 230
                  financial arrangements that a taxpayer has at the time
                  Division 230 first applies may be treated under
                  Subdivision 775-F.


Overview of commencement, transitional and implementation issues


Application of Division 230


   1396. Division 230 will apply to all financial arrangements that a
         taxpayer starts to have during income years commencing on or after
         1 July 2010.


   1397. The general rule is Division 230 will not apply to financial
         arrangements a taxpayer starts to have in an income year prior to
         one commencing on or after 1 July 2010 and the arrangement is still
         on hand on commencement of Division 230.  However, under a
         transitional election, a taxpayer can choose that Division 230
         applies to their existing financial arrangements.


   1398. Taxpayers are also able to elect to apply Division 230 early, that
         is to income years commencing on or after 1 July 2009.  In this
         situation, they will also be able to make the transitional election
         in relation to their existing financial arrangements.


Application of Subdivision 775-F


   1399. Where a foreign exchange retranslation election (the
         'general retranslation election') has been made under
         Subdivision 230-D to apply the retranslation method to relevant
         financial arrangements, the election also applies to those
         arrangements subject to Subdivision 775-F of the ITAA 1997.
         Subdivision 775-F will apply to relevant arrangements (Subdivision
         775-F arrangements) in the same way that Subdivision 230-D applies
         to financial arrangements.  This similar treatment extends to
         allowing existing arrangements to be brought within the scope of
         Subdivision 775-F where a transitional election is made.  For
         further information on what arrangements are subject to
         Subdivision 775-F, refer to Chapter 7.


Consequences of making transitional election


   1400. Where a taxpayer makes an election to bring in their existing
         financial arrangements (the transitional election) a transitional
         balancing adjustment is made.  The transitional balancing
         adjustment compares the amounts already subject to tax under the
         existing tax law with amounts that would have been brought to
         account under Division 230.


   1401. Similarly, the transitional election may also apply to
         Subdivision 775-F arrangements that are not Division 230 financial
         arrangements.


   1402. If the transitional balancing adjustment is positive, a quarter of
         this amount will be included in the taxpayer's assessable income
         for the first income year that Division 230 applies and each of the
         next three income years.  Conversely, if the transitional balancing
         adjustment is negative, a quarter of this amount may be allowed as
         a deduction for the first income year that Division 230 applies and
         each of the next three income years.


         Deferred tax liabilities and deferred tax assets


   1403. Where a taxpayer has:


                . elected to rely on their financial reports for Division
                  230 purposes; and


                . has a deferred tax asset or tax liability amount in
                  respect of a Division 230 financial arrangement to which
                  the financial reports method applies,


         the amount, as determined immediately before the start of the first
         income year that Division 230 applies, is to be used for the
         purposes of determining the transitional balancing adjustment
         amount.  This is to reduce compliance costs compared to undertaking
         individual calculations for all existing financial arrangements.


   1404. A deferred tax asset or a deferred tax liability is recorded in a
         taxpayer's financial reports where the financial year in which a
         taxpayer recognises an amount of income or an expense for tax
         purposes is different to the year in which the taxpayer entity
         recognises the income or expense for financial accounting purposes.


         PAYG transitionals


   1405. Where the taxpayer has a balancing adjustment amount, the amount
         must be spread evenly over the first four income years for
         instalment income purposes.  During each instalment quarter they
         will be taken to have made a gain or loss that is equal to one
         quarter of the annual balancing adjustment amount, that is, one
         sixteenth of the total balancing adjustment amount.


         Offshore banking units


   1406. An offshore banking unit will not be taken to have breached the
         rule limiting its use of non-offshore banking money where it has
         made a transitional election to have Division 230 apply to all of
         the financial arrangements it has at the start of the first
         applicable income year and a balancing adjustment arises under
         those provisions.


Context of amendments


   1407. Division 230 will apply to income years commencing on or after 1
         July 2010.  Taxpayers are also able to elect to apply Division 230
         to income years commencing on or after 1 July 2009.


   1408. At the time Division 230 first applies, taxpayers may have
         financial arrangements on hand which in earlier years were subject
         to the existing law.  Generally, financial arrangements which a
         taxpayer has prior to the commencement of Division 230 will
         continue to be subject to the current law (and not be subject to
         the provisions of the Division).  An exception to this general rule
         is where a taxpayer elects to have Division 230 apply to all
         financial arrangements (and, where relevant, to have Subdivision
         775-F apply to Subdivision 775-F arrangements) they have at the
         time the Division commences.


Summary of new law


   1409. Division 230 will apply to income years commencing on or after 1
         July 2010.  Taxpayers are also able to elect to apply Division 230
         to income years commencing on or after 1 July 2009.


   1410. Division 230 will apply to financial arrangements a taxpayer first
         starts to have in an income year commencing on or after 1 July 2010
         or, on an elective basis, to financial arrangements first held in
         income years commencing on or after 1 July 2009.


   1411. A taxpayer may elect to have Division 230 apply to financial
         arrangements that would otherwise be the subject of the Division,
         that were entered into prior to the first income year in which the
         Division applies, and that the taxpayer holds at the start of that
         year.  In respect of such existing arrangements, a transitional
         'balancing adjustment' will be calculated and spread evenly over
         the first applicable income year (the taxpayer's first income year
         commencing on or after 1 July 2010 - or on or after 1 July 2009 as
         appropriate) and the following three income years.


   1412. Similarly, where a general retranslation election has been made on
         or before the first lodgment date that occurs in the first
         applicable income year, Subdivision 775-F will apply to existing
         Subdivision 775-F arrangements.


Comparison of key features of new law and current law

|New law                 |Current law             |
|Division 230 applies to |No equivalent.          |
|income years commencing |                        |
|on or after 1 July 2010.|                        |
|Taxpayers are able to   |                        |
|elect to apply Division |                        |
|230 to income years     |                        |
|commencing on or after 1|                        |
|July 2009.              |                        |
|Taxpayers may elect that|                        |
|Division 230 apply to   |                        |
|relevant financial      |                        |
|arrangements entered    |                        |
|into in earlier periods.|                        |
|In this case a          |                        |
|transitional balancing  |                        |
|adjustment must be made |                        |
|by the taxpayer.        |                        |
|The transitional        |                        |
|election may also apply |                        |
|to bring existing       |                        |
|arrangements that are   |                        |
|not Division 230        |                        |
|financial arrangements  |                        |
|within the scope of     |                        |
|Subdivision 775-F.      |                        |


Detailed explanation of new law


Commencement date


   1413. Division 230 will apply on a mandatory basis to all income years
         commencing on or after 1 July 2010 [Schedule 1, subitem 103(1)].
         This means that for a taxpayer with a substituted accounting period
         ending on 31 December, Division 230 will apply on a mandatory basis
         for the substituted accounting period commencing on 1 January 2011.


   1414. Taxpayers are also able to elect to apply Division 230 to income
         years commencing on or after 1 July 2009.  This means that a
         taxpayer with a substituted accounting period ending on 31 December
         will be able to elect to apply Division 230 for the substituted
         accounting period starting on 1 January 2010.  For consolidated
         groups it is the head company that makes this election.  Where a
         taxpayer makes this election, they must do so on or before the
         first lodgment date that occurs on or after 1 July 2009.  [Schedule
         1, subitems 103(2) and (3)]


   1415. In respect of taxpayers with a substituted accounting period ending
         on 31 December, the income year to which Division 230 will first
         apply will be to income years beginning on 1 January 2011, that is,
         to the 2011-12 income year.


   1416. Where an election is made under subitem 103(2), Division 230 will
         apply to income years beginning on 1 January 2010, that is, to the
         2010-11 income year.


      1. :  Commencement date


                BJ Investments Co is an investment company whose income year
                ends on 31 December in lieu of 30 June.  As Division 230
                applies to income years commencing on or after 1 July 2010
                (or 1 July 2009 where an election is made under subitem
                103(2)), the first income year to which BJ Investments Co
                will be required to apply Division 230 will commence on 1
                January 2011 (or 1 January 2010 if an election is made under
                subitem 103(2)).


Application to new financial arrangements


   1417. Division 230 applies to all financial arrangements (that are
         subject to the Division) that the taxpayer starts to have in the
         income year in which the Division first applies to the taxpayer,
         and to financial arrangements the taxpayer starts to have in any
         subsequent income year.  [Schedule 1, subitem 103(1)]


Application to existing financial arrangements


   1418. A taxpayer may elect that Division 230 also apply to all financial
         arrangements that they started to have prior to the first income
         year in which the Division applies to the taxpayer, and which the
         taxpayer still has at the time the Division first applies to the
         taxpayer ('existing financial arrangements') [Schedule 1, subitem
         104(2)].  Similarly, the transitional election may also apply to
         existing arrangements that are not Division 230 financial
         arrangements.


   1419. The election to bring existing financial arrangements within the
         scope of Division 230:


                . will apply to all financial arrangements a taxpayer starts
                  to have prior to the time the Division first applies to
                  the taxpayer and which the taxpayer still has at that
                  time, other than financial arrangements (typically a
                  deferred settlement) which are in existence at that time
                  and arose from a disposal of property, including a
                  disposal of a capital asset, revenue asset, depreciating
                  asset or trading stock [Schedule 1, subitems 104(2) and
                  (3)]; and


                . must be made by the taxpayer and notified to the
                  Commissioner of Taxation (Commissioner) on or before the
                  first date for lodgment of an income tax return of the
                  taxpayer (lodgment date) that occurs on or after the start
                  of the first applicable income year to which the
                  Division applies  [Schedule 1, sub-subitems 104(5)(a) and
                  (b)].


   1420. Taxpayers who are excluded from Division 230 as a result of the
         application of subsections 230-455(1) to (5) are able to elect to
         have Division 230 apply to all their financial arrangements
         (subsection 230-455(7)).  Where a valid election is made under
         subsection 230-455(7) the taxpayer is also able to elect to have
         Division 230 apply to all their existing financial arrangements.
         [Schedule 1, subitem 104(6)]


   1421. Financial arrangements which are brought within the scope of
         Division 230 through the transitional election will be subject to
         the various tax-timing methods within the Division (including the
         elective methods of fair value, foreign exchange retranslation and
         relying on financial reports) where the taxpayer has made the
         necessary elections by the first lodgment date that occurs on or
         after the start of the first income year that Division 230 applies
         to the taxpayer [Schedule 1, subitem 104(8)].  In such situations
         it is intended that before taxpayers can have any of the elective
         tax-timing methods apply to these 'existing arrangements', they
         must have made the transitional election.  It is only by making a
         transitional election that the taxpayer can bring their 'existing
         financial arrangements' within the scope of an elective tax-timing
         treatment [Schedule 1, subitem 104(2)].


   1422. Similarly, where a taxpayer has made an election for portfolio
         treatment of premiums, discounts and fees in accordance with
         section 230-150 by the first lodgment date that occurs on or after
         the applicable income year, the portfolio treatment will extend to
         existing financial arrangements that are part of a portfolio of
         similar financial arrangements.  [Schedule 1, Part 3, subitem
         104(7)]


   1423. Taxpayers can also elect to apply the hedging financial
         arrangements election method (in Subdivision 230-E) to certain
         financial arrangements ('existing hedges') if:


                . the hedging financial arrangements election is made by the
                  first lodgment date that occurs after the start of the
                  first income year that Division 230 applies to the
                  taxpayer [Schedule 1, sub-subitem 104(9)(a)];


                . at the time the existing hedge was created, acquired or
                  applied, it satisfied the definition of a 'hedging
                  financial arrangement' in section 230-335 (as explained in
                  Chapter 8) [Schedule 1, sub-subitem 104(9)(b)];


                . at, or soon after the time when Division 230 commences,
                  the taxpayer's records in relation to the existing hedge
                  satisfy the relevant record-keeping requirements in
                  sections 230-355 and 230-360 (ignoring subparagraph 230-
                  360(2)(c)(ii)) explained in Chapter 8 [Schedule 1, sub-
                  subitem 104(9)(c)]; and


                . all the effectiveness requirements set out in section 230-
                  365 (explained in Chapter 8) have been met at all times
                  since the existing hedge was first created, acquired or
                  applied for the purpose of hedging a risk in relation to a
                  hedged item [Schedule 1, sub-subitem 104(9)(d)].


   1424. However, for existing hedges, the hedging election will only extend
         to tax-timing matching.  Tax-status matching cannot, as a result of
         the transitional election, extend to existing hedges.  That is to
         say, tax-status matching (contained in subsection 230-310(4)) can
         only apply to new hedging matching arrangements entered into in the
         income year, or later income years, in which Division 230 first
         applies to the taxpayer.


   1425. The result of a taxpayer making an election in accordance with
         subitem 103(2) in respect of hedging financial arrangements, and
         given that subsection 230-310(4) will not apply to existing
         financial arrangements, is that gains and losses from these hedging
         financial arrangements will be recognised as 'revenue gains' and
         'revenue losses'.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(10)]


   1426. Where an election has been made to bring existing financial
         arrangements within the scope of Division 230 and where a valid
         election have been made under any of the elective Subdivisions (as
         explained in Chapter 5), the elective Subdivision(s) will apply to
         the taxpayer's existing financial arrangements notwithstanding the
         fact that the election under the elective Subdivisions was not made
         in the income year in which the taxpayer first started to hold the
         existing financial arrangement.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(11)]


   1427. Where a taxpayer has financial arrangements that were in existence
         at the time the Division first commences to apply, and does not
         make a transitional election, then those financial arrangements
         will continue to be brought to account under the other provisions
         of the tax law.


         Transitional balancing adjustment


   1428. Where a taxpayer makes an election to bring existing arrangements
         into Division 230, a transitional 'balancing adjustment' is
         calculated using the 'method statement' contained in subitem
         104(13), at the time the election takes effect (the time when
         Division 230 first applies to the taxpayer) [Schedule 1,
         subitem 104(12)].  The balancing adjustment, which is designed to
         compare the amounts which have been brought to account under the
         existing law with amounts that would have been brought to account
         under Division 230 if it had applied, is calculated as follows:


                . a notional assessable amount (the total of all the amounts
                  relating to the financial arrangements that would be
                  assessable under Division 230, if it (and any relevant
                  elections) applied from the time the taxpayer started to
                  have the arrangements) [Schedule 1, subitem 104(13), step
                  1 and subitem 104(18)];


                . a notional deductible amount (the total of all the amounts
                  relating to the financial arrangements that would be
                  allowable as deductions under Division 230 if it (and any
                  relevant elections) applied from the time the taxpayer
                  started to have the arrangements) [Schedule 1,
                  subitem 104(13), step 2 and subitem 104(18)];


                . an actual assessed amount (the total of all the amounts
                  relating to the financial arrangements that have been
                  included in assessable income from the time the taxpayer
                  started to have the arrangements) [Schedule 1, subitem
                  104(13), step 3];


                . an actual deducted amount (the total of all the amounts
                  relating to the financial arrangements that have been
                  allowed as deductions from the time the taxpayer started
                  to have the arrangements) [Schedule 1, subitem 104(13),
                  step 4];


                . the step 5 amount (add the notional assessable amount to
                  the actual deducted amount) [Schedule 1, subitem 104(13),
                  step 5]; and


                . the step 6 amount (add the actual assessed amount to the
                  notional deductible amount) [Schedule 1, subitem 104(13),
                  step 6].


   1429. The final calculation involves a comparison between the step 5
         amount and the step 6 amount.  A positive amount, which will occur
         if the step 5 amount exceeds the step 6 amount, is included in
         assessable income as a balancing adjustment while a negative
         amount, which will occur if the step 6 amount exceeds the step 5
         amount, is allowable as a deduction as a balancing adjustment.
         Where the step 5 amount and the step 6 amount are equal, there is
         no balancing adjustment, that is, no amount is included in
         assessable income and no amount is allowable as a deduction.
         [Schedule 1, subitem 104(13), step 7]


   1430. The result from the calculation above (which must take into account
         all 'pre-existing financial arrangements' to which the transitional
         election applies) will be brought to account (as either assessable
         income where there is a positive amount or as an allowable
         deduction where there is a negative amount) in equal instalments
         over the first income year to which Division 230 applies to the
         taxpayer and the following three income years.  That is, one
         quarter of the balancing adjustment is brought to account in each
         of these four years.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(17)]


   1431. The transitional election may also apply to existing arrangements
         that are not Division 230 financial arrangements.  Where the
         transitional election applies to existing arrangements that are not
         Division 230 financial arrangements, the method statement in
         subitem 104(13) is modified (see paragraphs 13.56 to 13.58).


Application of the transitional balancing adjustment to financial
arrangements


   1432. When undertaking a balancing adjustment in respect of existing
         financial arrangements, it is important to note that the values
         that are included at each step are positive numbers.  That is, an
         amount that is included at steps 2 and 4 is not a negative amount
         because it is, or would be, allowable as a deduction.


   1433. Example 13.2 illustrates how a transitional balancing adjustment
         should be calculated.


      1. :  Calculating a transitional balancing adjustment


                Background


                BJ Investments Co is an investment company whose tax and
                accounting year ends on 30 June.  It holds two portfolios of
                shares, details of which are:


              . Portfolio No. 1 contains 1,000 shares in Johnny Co.  The
                shares were acquired for $5 per share, that is, the cost of
                this portfolio was $5,000.  This portfolio of shares was
                acquired on 30 January 2007; and


              . Portfolio No. 2 contains 2,000 shares in Buddy Co.  The
                shares were acquired for $10 per share, that is, the cost of
                this portfolio was $20,000.  This portfolio of shares was
                acquired on 30 March 2005.


                Assumptions


              . The shares are held on revenue account.


              . No dividends are paid during the period in which
                BJ Investments Co holds the shares.


              . Division 230 applies to BJ Investments Co from 1 July 2009.


              . On 30 June 2009:


              - BJ Investments Co makes an election under Subdivision 230-C
                to fair value Division 230 financial arrangements that are
                fair valued in its financial reports with effect from 1 July
                2009;


              - BJ Investments Co also makes an election to apply Division
                230 to all existing financial arrangements that it has at
                the start of the income year in which Division 230 first
                applies to it;


              - BJ Investments Co always satisfies the requirements of
                Subdivision 230-C to allow it to continue to apply the fair
                value election to relevant financial arrangements;


              - the shares in Portfolio No. 1 and Portfolio No. 2 are fair
                valued in the financial reports of BJ Investments Co;


              - the fair value of Portfolio No. 1 had increased to $7,500 -
                that is, $7.50 per share; and


              - the fair value of Portfolio No. 2 had decreased to $8,000 -
                that is, $4 per share.


              . On 20 June 2010 BJ Investments Co disposes of all shares in:




              - Portfolio No. 1 for $8,000 - that is, $8 per share; and


              - Portfolio No. 2 for $10,000 - that is, $5 per share.


                Transitional balancing adjustment calculation


                In light of the above facts, the balancing adjustment would
                be calculated as follows:


                Step 1 - Amounts that would be included if Division 230 had
                applied from the time Portfolio No. 1 was acquired - that
                is, the fair value gain on Portfolio No. 1 as at 30 June
                2008 (notional assessable amount).


                  $2,500


                Step 2 - Amounts that would be deductible if Division 230
                applied from the time Portfolio No. 2 was acquired - that
                is, the fair value loss on Portfolio No. 2 as at 30 June
                2008 (notional deductible amount).


                  $12,000


                Step 3 - Amounts that have been included in assessable
                income from the time the taxpayer started to have the
                financial arrangement (actual assessed amount).


                  $0


                Step 4 - Amounts that have been allowable as deductions from
                the time the taxpayer started to have the financial
                arrangement (actual deducted amount).


                  $0


                Step 5 - Add the notional assessable amount to the actual
                deductible amount.


                  ($2,500  +  $0)  =  $2,500


                Step 6 - Add the actual assessed amount to the notional
                deductible amount.


                  ($0  +  $12,000)  =  $12,000


                Step 7 - Compare the step 5 amount with the step 6 amount.


                As the step 6 amount exceeds the step 5 amount, the excess
                ($9,500) is allowable as a deduction as a balancing
                adjustment.  The balancing adjustment is spread evenly over
                the first applicable income year and the next three years.


   1434. The effect of undertaking a balancing adjustment calculation in
         respect of financial arrangements held at the commencement of
         Division 230 is to place those financial arrangements in the same
         position that they would have been had they been subject to
         Division 230 from the time the taxpayer first held the financial
         arrangement.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(13)]


   1435. In Example 13.2 when BJ Investments Co disposes of the shares that
         comprise Portfolios No. 1 and 2 they make:


                . an overall gain of $3,000 in respect of Portfolio No. 1.
                  The gain is comprised of the $2,500 that was included in
                  the transitional balancing adjustment and a further $500
                  that is the difference between the proceeds on disposal
                  and the fair value of the portfolio at the start of the
                  income year in which the disposal occurred; and


                . an overall loss of $10,000 is respect of Portfolio No. 2.
                  The loss is comprised of the $12,000 that was included in
                  the transitional balancing adjustment and a $2,000 gain
                  that is the difference between the proceeds on disposal
                  and the fair value of the portfolio at the start of the
                  income year in which the disposal occurred.


         Deferred tax liabilities and deferred tax assets


   1436. Where the financial year in which an entity recognises an amount of
         income or an expense for tax purposes is different to the year in
         which the entity recognises the income or expense for financial
         accounting purposes, the entity will record in its financial
         reports a deferred tax asset or a deferred tax liability in
         accordance with Australian Accounting Standard AASB 112 Income
         Taxes (AASB 112).


   1437. Where:


                . a taxpayer has made an election to rely on their financial
                  reports (under Subdivision 230-F); and


                . an amount in a deferred tax asset account or a deferred
                  tax liability account is in respect of a Division 230
                  financial arrangement that is subject to Subdivision 230-
                  F,


         the taxpayer must, in respect of financial arrangements that are
         subject to the election in Subdivision 230-F, disregard steps 1 to
         4 in the method statement in subitem 104(13) for the purposes of
         determining the balancing adjustment amount that is attributable to
         that financial arrangement and instead rely on the amount recorded
         in the financial reports, immediately before the first applicable
         income year, as a deferred tax asset or a deferred tax liability
         (and grossed up) in respect of those financial arrangements that
         are subject to Subdivision 230-F.  [Schedule 1, subitems 104(14)
         and (15)]


   1438. Subitems 104(14) and (15) are designed to reduce the compliance
         costs of otherwise having to undertake individual calculations for
         all existing financial arrangements.  The net deferred tax asset
         and deferred tax liability position of a taxpayer, adjusted for
         those financial arrangements not subject to Subdivision 230-F, is
         considered to provide a reasonable approximation of the amount that
         would be calculated as a result of the application of the
         transitional balancing adjustment method statement to all existing
         financial arrangements.


   1439. Under AASB 112:


                . deferred tax assets are the amounts of income tax
                  recoverable in future periods in respect of deductible
                  temporary differences, the carry forward of unused tax
                  losses, and the carry forward of unused tax credits;


                . deferred tax liabilities are the amounts of income tax
                  payable in future periods in respect of taxable temporary
                  differences.


   1440. When identifying the relevant amounts of deferred tax assets and
         deferred tax liabilities, taxpayers are to have regard to their
         financial reports immediately before Division 230 is to apply to
         them, that is, immediately before their first application income
         year.


   1441. An amount that is recorded in a deferred tax asset account that is
         attributable to an existing financial arrangement is the
         attributable assessable amount [Schedule 1, subitem 104(14)].
         Conversely, an amount that is recorded in a deferred tax liability
         account that is attributable to an existing financial arrangement
         is the attributable deductible amount [Schedule 1, subitem
         104(15)].


   1442. Deferred tax asset and deferred tax liability amounts are recorded
         in the financial reports as the amount of the tax liability (or tax
         saving) and not as the amount of the gain or loss that is relevant
         for Division 230 purposes.  Accordingly, the balancing adjustment
         operates such that it is the grossed up amount that is recorded in
         a deferred tax asset account or deferred tax liability account in
         the taxpayer's financial records which is relevant for the purposes
         of this provision.  [Schedule 1, subitems 104(14) and (15)]


   1443. In respect of a financial arrangement that has an attributable
         assessable amount recorded in a deferred tax asset account, the
         attributable assessable amount is reduced to the extent that it
         represents unused tax credits and is then grossed up in accordance
         with subitem 104(13).  The grossed up amount is to be added to the
         step 6 amount.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(11)]


   1444. In respect of a financial arrangement that has an attributable
         deductible amount recorded in a deferred tax liability account, the
         attributable deductible amount is reduced to the extent that it
         represents unused tax credits and is then grossed up in accordance
         with subitem 104(16).  The grossed up amount is to be added to the
         step 5 amount.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(15)]


   1445. In calculating the grossed up amount under subitem 104(16), the tax
         rate taken into account in working out the attributable assessable
         amount or attributable deductible amount (the relevant tax rate),
         would usually be the tax rate prevailing on the day that the
         amounts in the deferred tax asset or deferred tax liability were
         calculated or subsequently adjusted because of a change in tax
         rates.  Example 2 in Appendix B of AASB 112 illustrates how a
         change in tax rate is recorded in the deferred tax asset account or
         deferred tax liability account.  Any calculations or adjustments
         made to these accounts are considered to have been made in working
         out the attributable assessable amount or attributable deductible
         amount.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(16)]


   1446. Where no amount of the deferred tax asset or deferred tax liability
         is in respect of a financial arrangement, the taxpayer must rely on
         the method statement to determine whether there is a notional
         assessable amount or a notional deductible amount.  [Schedule 1,
         subitem 104(13)]


PAYG - transitional and application


   1447. The result from the calculation above (which must take into account
         all 'pre-existing financial arrangements' to which the transitional
         election applies) will be brought to account (as either assessable
         income where there is a positive amount or an allowable deduction
         where there is a negative amount) in equal instalments over the
         first income year to which Division 230 applies to the taxpayer and
         the following three income years.  That is, one quarter of the
         balancing adjustment is brought to account in each of these four
         years.


   1448. Where the taxpayer has calculated the amount of the balancing
         adjustment that is to be included in their taxable income for an
         income year, they must spread this amount evenly over the relevant
         income year for instalment income purposes.  That is, during each
         instalment quarter they are taken to have made a gain or loss that
         is equal to one quarter of the annual balancing adjustment amount -
         that is, equal to one sixteenth of the total balancing adjustment
         amount.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(17)]


Impact of the transitional balancing adjustment on offshore banking units


   1449. An offshore banking unit will not be taken to have breached the
         rule limiting its use of non-offshore banking money in section
         121EH of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 where it has made a
         transitional election under subitem 104(2).  Where the offshore
         banking unit makes this election, the balancing adjustment amount
         is brought to account as assessable income or an allowable
         deduction over the first four years of Division 230 applying to the
         offshore banking unit.  Such additional assessable income could, in
         the absence of this special transitional rule, in various ways
         cause the offshore banking unit to breach the 10 per cent limit set
         in section 121EH.  Any balancing adjustment is not to be taken into
         account in determining the effects of breaching the limit nor
         should it mean that the offshore banking unit would not breach the
         limit when it would otherwise do so.  [Schedule 1, subitem 104(19)]


Application of transitional election to existing arrangements that are not
Division 230 financial arrangements


   1450. If an election has been made to apply the general retranslation
         method to Division 230 financial arrangements and to those
         arrangements subject to Subdivision 775-F of the ITAA 1997, the
         transitional election also applies to existing arrangements that
         are not Division 230 financial arrangements in the same way as it
         applies to Division 230 financial arrangements.  [Schedule 1,
         subitem 105(1)]


   1451. In working out the balancing adjustment where the transitional
         election has been made, the method statement applies to
         Subdivision 775-F arrangements as if the reference in step 1 in the
         method statement to 'Division 230' were a reference to 'Subdivision
         775-F'.  Also, the reference in step 2 in the method statement to
         'Division' applies as if it is a reference to 'Subdivision'.
         [Schedule 1, subitem 105(2)]


   1452. The effect of this is that where the transitional election extends
         to Subdivision 775-F arrangements, the transitional balancing
         adjustment requires the taxpayer to also compare amounts which have
         been brought to account under the existing tax law with amounts
         that would have been brought to account if Subdivision 775-F of the
         ITAA 1997 had instead applied.



Chapter 14
Case studies

Outline of chapter


   1453. This chapter includes case studies which illustrate how
         Division 230 will apply to:


                . a deferred settlement;


                . a financial arrangement where the retranslation method has
                  been elected;


                . financial arrangements over which the parties have agreed
                  to a forward swap;


                . a securitisation arrangement;


                . a basic interest rate swap;


                . an interest rate swap with an upfront payment;


                . a cross currency swap; and


                . a total return swap.


         Case study 1:  A deferred settlement


                Deferred settlement scenario


                Go Co is a transport company with an aggregated turnover of
                over $100 million.  Go Co has not made any of the elections
                available under Subdivision 230-C, 230-D, 230-E or 230-F.


                Big Rig Co is a heavy vehicle retail company with an
                aggregated turnover of over $100 million.  Big Rig Co has
                not made any of the elections available under Subdivision
                230-C, 230-D, 230-E or 230-F.


                On 1 May 2011, Go Co enters into an agreement with
                Big Rig Co to purchase a refrigerated truck for its fleet,
                with the payment of $100,000 for the vehicle to occur on
                30 June 2014.  Under the arrangement, Go Co will take
                delivery of the vehicle from Big Rig Co on 1 June 2011.


                1.  Application of Division 230 to Go Co


                Does Go Co have a financial arrangement under the agreement
                to purchase the truck?


                Under the agreement to purchase the truck Go Co has a right
                to receive a financial benefit (the truck) on 1 June 2011
                and an obligation to provide a financial benefit (the
                payment of $100,000) on 30 June 2014.  For the purpose of
                Division 230 the right and the obligation are one
                arrangement (subsection 230-55(4)).


                At the inception of the arrangement (1 May 2011), Go Co does
                not have a financial arrangement as:


              . although the $100,000 payment is a cash settlable financial
                benefit (paragraph 230-45(2)(a)) and an obligation to
                provide such a benefit can constitute a financial
                arrangement (paragraph 230-45(1)(b));


              . the right to receive the truck, which is under the same
                arrangement, is:


              - not a cash settlable financial benefit; and


              - not insignificant in comparison with the obligation to pay
                the $100,000 (paragraphs 230-45(1)(d) to (f)).


                However, from 1 June 2011, assuming the vehicle is delivered
                on time, Go Co will have a financial arrangement as the only
                right or obligation existing under the arrangement from that
                time is to a cash settlable financial benefit, that is the
                obligation to provide $100,000 on 30 June 2014 (paragraph
                230-45(1)(b) and section 230-45, note 1).


                What are the gains and losses under the financial
                arrangement?


                For the purposes of Division 230 Go Co is taken to have
                received financial benefits equal to the market value of the
                truck when it is delivered.  This financial benefit which
                Go Co is taken to have received under the financial
                arrangement is taken into account in calculating any gain or
                loss from the financial arrangement.  Suppose the truck has
                a market value of $73,561 at 1 June 2011.  This amount is
                the value of the financial benefit taken to be received by
                Go Co.


                Taking into account the financial benefit of $73,561 which
                is taken to be received and the financial benefit of
                $100,000 which is to be provided under the financial
                arrangement, Go Co will have a loss of $26,439 from the
                financial arrangement.


                As it is reasonable to expect that Go Co will provide a
                financial benefit on 30 June 2014 (paragraph 230-115(2)(a))
                and the amount of that financial benefit is fixed at
                $100,000 (paragraph 230-115(2)(b)), there is a sufficiently
                certain overall loss (subsection 230-105(1)) which is
                required to be accrued (subsection 230-100(2)).


                As the loss of $26,439 is required to be accrued, the loss
                will be spread:


              . over the period starting when Go Co starts to have the
                financial arrangement, that is 1 June 2011, and ending when
                Go Co will cease to have the arrangement assuming that it
                will be held for the rest of its life, that is, until
                30 June 2014 (subsection 230-130(1)); and


              . using a compounding accruals method with compounding
                intervals of not more than 12 months (subsections 230-135(2)
                and (3)).


                In spreading the loss Go Co uses compounding periods (or
                intervals) of one month.


                As each of the compounding intervals fall wholly within one
                income year the accrued loss from each interval is taken to
                have been made in the income year in which the interval
                falls (section 230-170).


      1. :  Loss for each compounding interval

|Year      |Amortise|Accrued |Cash     |Amortised  |
|ending    |d cost  |loss for|flows    |cost       |
|          |(year   |tax     |         |(year end) |
|          |start)  |purposes|         |           |
|          |(a)     |(b)     |(c)      |(a) + (b) -|
|          |        |        |         |(c)        |
|30 June   |$0.00   |-$613   |$73,561  |-$74,174   |
|2011      |        |        |         |           |
|30 June   |-$74,174|-$7,767 |$0.00    |-$81,941   |
|2012      |        |        |         |           |
|30 June   |-$81,941|-$8,580 |$0.00    |-$90,521   |
|2013      |        |        |         |           |
|30 June   |-$90,521|-$9,479 |-$100,000|$0.00      |
|2014      |        |        |         |           |


                What is the cost of the truck?


                In addition to the loss on the financial arrangement, and on
                the assumption that Go Co uses the truck for the purpose of
                producing assessable income, the company is also entitled to
                claim a deduction for the decline in value on the truck
                acquired under the agreement.


                Although Go Co pays $100,000 under the purchase contract,
                the cost of the truck for the purposes of calculating the
                deduction under Division 40 of the Income Tax Assessment Act
                1997 (ITAA 1997) is the market value of the truck (the
                'thing' in terms of section 230-505) at the time it is
                acquired (paragraph 230-505(2)(b)).  Therefore, the cost of
                the truck is $73,561.


                2.  Application of Division 230 to Big Rig Co


                Does Big Rig Co have a financial arrangement under the
                agreement to purchase the truck?


                Under the agreement to sell the truck, Big Rig Co has an
                obligation to provide a financial benefit (the truck) and a
                right to receive a financial benefit (the payment of
                $100,000).  For the purpose of Division 230, the right and
                the obligation are one arrangement (subsection 230-55(4)).


                At the inception of the arrangement (1 May 2011), Big Rig Co
                does not have a financial arrangement as:


              . although the $100,000 payment is a cash settlable financial
                benefit (paragraph 230-45(2)(a)) and a right to receive such
                a benefit can constitute a financial arrangement
                (paragraph 230-45(1)(a)); and


              . the obligation to provide the vehicle which is under the
                same arrangement is:


              - not a cash settlable financial benefit; and


              - not insignificant in comparison with the right to receive
                the $100,000 (paragraphs 230-45(1)(d) to (f)).


                However, from 1 June 2011 when the vehicle is delivered,
                Big Rig Co will have a financial arrangement as the only
                right or obligation existing under the arrangement from that
                time is to a cash settlable financial benefit, that is the
                right to receive $100,000 on 30 June 2014 (paragraph 230-
                45(1)(a) and section 230-45, note 1).


                What are the gains and losses under the financial
                arrangement?


                As Big Rig Co has started to have a financial arrangement at
                1 July 2011 in relation to the delayed consideration for
                providing the vehicle, for the purposes of Division 230
                Big Rig Co is taken to have provided financial benefits
                equal to the market value of the truck (the 'thing') at the
                time when Big Rig Co provided it (1 July 2011) (subsection
                230-505(2)).  This financial benefit which Big Rig Co has
                provided under the financial arrangement is taken into
                account in calculating any gain or loss from the financial
                arrangement.  As stated above, the market value of the truck
                is $73,561 at 1 June 2011.  This amount is the value of the
                financial benefit taken to have been provided by Big Rig Co.


                Taking into account the financial benefit of $73,561 which
                is taken to be provided and the financial benefit of
                $100,000 which is to be received under the financial
                arrangement, Big Rig Co will have a gain of $26,439 from the
                financial arrangement.


                As it is reasonable to expect that Big Rig Co will receive a
                financial benefit on 30 June 2014 (paragraph 230-115(2)(a))
                and the amount of that financial benefit is fixed (at
                $100,000) (paragraph 230-115(2)(b)), there is a sufficiently
                certain overall gain (subsection 230-105(1)) which is
                required to be accrued (subsection 230-100(2)).


                As the gain of $26,439 is required to be accrued, the gain
                will be spread:


              . over the period starting when Big Rig Co starts to have the
                arrangement, that is 1 June 2011, and ending when Big Rig Co
                will cease to have the arrangement assuming that it will be
                held until maturity, that is 30 June 2014 (subsection 230-
                130(1));


              . using a compounding accruals method with compounding
                intervals of not more than 12 months (subsections 230-135(2)
                and (3)).


                In spreading the gain Big Rig Co uses compounding periods
                (or intervals) of one month.


                As each of the remaining compounding intervals fall wholly
                within one income year the accrued gain from each interval
                is taken to have been made in the income year in which the
                interval falls (section 230-170).


                What are the proceeds of the sale of the truck?


                In addition to the gain on the financial arrangement, Big
                Rig Co has also sold a truck.  Although Big Rig Co is
                entitled to $100,000 under the sale contract, the amount of
                the benefit that Big Rig Co is taken to have obtained for
                the truck is the market value of the truck (the 'thing' in
                terms of section 230-505) at the time it started to have the
                financial arrangement (paragraph 230-505(2)(a)).


                Accordingly, if the truck is trading stock in Big Rig Co's
                hands, the amount for which it is treated as having sold
                trading stock is $73,561.


      2. :  The gain for each compounding interval

|Year      |Amortis|Accrued  |Cash     |Amortised  |
|ending    |ed cost|gain for |flows    |cost       |
|          |(year  |tax      |         |(year end) |
|          |start) |purposes |         |           |
|          |(a)    |(b)      |(c)      |(a) + (b) -|
|          |       |         |         |(c)        |
|30 June   |$0.00  |$613     |$73,561  |$74,174    |
|2011      |       |         |         |           |
|30 June   |$74,174|$7,767   |$0.00    |$81,941    |
|2012      |       |         |         |           |
|30 June   |$81,941|$8,580   |$0.00    |$90,521    |
|2013      |       |         |         |           |
|30 June   |$90,521|$9,479   |$100,000 |$0.00      |
|2014      |       |         |         |           |


         Case study 2:  Balancing adjustment for the qualifying foreign
         exchange account


                Qualifying foreign exchange account scenario


                Kwala Co is a toy company, with an annual turnover of over
                $100 million.  Kwala Co is subject to Division 230 on an
                elective basis from 1 July 2009 and chooses not to make a
                transitional election to bring existing financial
                arrangements which it holds within the operation of
                Division 230.


                Kwala Co has an account denominated in US dollars (US$)
                which it elects to retranslate under the qualifying foreign
                exchange accounts election (subsection 230-255(5)).  Kwala
                Co does not elect to make the general retranslation
                election.  If it had, Kwala Co would not have been able to
                make a separate qualifying foreign exchange accounts
                election because the relevant qualifying foreign exchange
                account is a foreign currency denominated financial
                arrangement and would have been subject to the operation of
                the general election.  The qualifying foreign exchange
                accounts election applies from 1 July 2009, the beginning of
                the income year in which the election is made.  The account
                was opened on 7 July 2008.


                In order for the qualifying foreign exchange accounts
                election to apply, Kwala Co must apply a balancing
                adjustment calculation under Subdivision 230-G to capture
                the foreign exchange gain or loss not already brought to
                account under another method available in the Income Tax
                Assessment Act 1936 or the ITAA 1997 for bringing to account
                foreign exchange gains and losses.  Prior to making the
                qualifying foreign exchange accounts election, Kwala Co was
                bringing foreign exchange gains and losses to account under
                Division 775 of the ITAA 1997.  Kwala Co was using the
                weighted average rate to determine the foreign currency gain
                or loss.


      3. :  Qualifying foreign exchange account in US$

|Date        |Transaction |Debit  |Credit |Balance  |
|7 July 2008 |Open account|       |380.00 |380.00 CR|
|            |with Deposit|       |       |         |
|20 July 2008|Deposit     |       |250.00 |630.00 CR|
|30 August   |Interest    |       |9.45   |639.45 CR|
|2008        |            |       |       |         |
|7 September |Withdrawal  |75.00  |       |564.45 CR|
|2008        |            |       |       |         |
|15 October  |Withdrawal  |50.00  |       |514.45 CR|
|2008        |            |       |       |         |
|2 December  |Deposit     |       |234.00 |748.45 CR|
|2008        |            |       |       |         |
|14 January  |Deposit     |       |1,693.4|2,441.85 |
|2009        |            |       |0      |CR       |
|30 June 2009|Interest    |       |36.63  |2,478.48 |
|            |            |       |       |CR       |
|30 June 2009|Closing     |       |       |2,478.48 |
|            |balance     |       |       |CR       |
|11 July 2009|Deposit     |       |360.00 |2,838.48 |
|            |            |       |       |CR       |
|12 August   |Withdrawal  |240.00 |       |2,598.48 |
|2009        |            |       |       |CR       |
|30 October  |Deposit     |       |38.98  |2,637.46 |
|2009        |            |       |       |CR       |
|15 March    |Deposit     |       |456.00 |3,093.46 |
|2010        |            |       |       |CR       |
|30 June 2010|Interest    |       |46.40  |3,139.86 |
|            |            |       |       |CR       |


      4. :  US$/AUD exchange rates

|Date        |Exchange rate       |
|7 July 2008 |0.755               |
|7 July 2008 |0.760               |
|20 July 2008|0.706               |
|30 August   |0.740               |
|2008        |                    |
|7 September |0.752               |
|2008        |                    |
|15 October  |0.760               |
|2008        |                    |
|2 December  |0.789               |
|2008        |                    |
|14 January  |0.770               |
|2009        |                    |
|30 June 2009|0.740               |
|30 June 2009|0.740               |
|11 July 2009|0.720               |
|12 August   |0.751               |
|2009        |                    |
|30 October  |0.770               |
|2009        |                    |
|15 March    |0.766               |
|2010        |                    |
|30 June 2010|0.780               |


      5. :  Division 775 weighted average

|Date        |Weighted |Debit |Credit |Balance  |Foreign  |
|            |average  |      |AUD    |AUD[4]   |exchange |
|            |         |AUD   |       |         |gain or  |
|            |         |      |       |         |loss     |
|7 July 2008 |0.760    |      |500.00 |500.00 CR|         |
|20 July 2008|0.7376119|      |338.93 |854.11 CR|         |
|            |40       |      |       |         |         |
|30 August   |0.7376471|      |12.81  |866.88 CR|         |
|2008        |20       |      |       |         |         |
|7 September |0.7376471|101.67|       |765.20 CR|-1.94    |
|2008        |20       |      |       |         |         |
|15 October  |0.7376471|67.78 |       |697.42 CR|-1.99    |
|2008        |20       |      |       |         |         |
|2 December  |0.7529692|      |310.77 |994.00 CR|         |
|2008        |12       |      |       |         |         |
|14 January  |0.7646985|      |2,214.4|3,193.22 |         |
|2009        |87       |      |7      |CR       |         |
|30 June 2009|0.7643215|      |47.92  |3,242.72 |         |
|            |64       |      |       |CR       |         |
|30 June 2009|         |      |       |3,349.30 |         |
|            |         |      |       |CR       |         |
|11 July 2009|0.7584005|      |474.68 |3,742.72 |         |
|            |26       |      |       |CR       |         |
|12 August   |0.7584005|316.46|       |3,426.26 |3.12     |
|2009        |26       |      |       |CR       |         |
|30 October  |0.7585694|      |51.39  |3,476.89 |         |
|2009        |14       |      |       |CR       |         |
|15 March    |0.7596556|      |600.27 |4,072.19 |         |
|2010        |68       |      |       |CR       |         |
|30 June 2010|0.7599485|      |61.06  |4,131.67 |         |
|            |82       |      |       |CR       |         |


                Using the weighted average method available under the
                Division 775 income tax regulations, Kwala Co brings to
                account a foreign currency loss of $3.93 for the 2008-09
                income year.


      6. :  Subdivision 775-E foreign exchange gain or loss (retranslation
         election)

|Closing balance             |$3,349.30                  |
|Less opening balance        |0                          |
|Less deposits               |-$3,412.18                 |
|Add withdrawals             |$165.52                    |
|Foreign exchange gain       |$102.64                    |


                The foreign currency gain or loss which would have been
                brought to account using a retranslation method would have
                been $102.64.


      7. :  Balancing adjustment required on qualifying foreign exchange
         election commencement

|Division 775 foreign exchange   |-$3.93             |
|gain/loss                       |                   |
|Division 230 foreign exchange   |$102.64            |
|gain/loss (retranslation        |                   |
|balancing adjustment)           |                   |
|Balancing adjustment            |$106.57            |


                The additional foreign currency gain required to be brought
                to account under the balancing adjustment provisions in
                Subdivision 230-G (section 230-445) is therefore $106.57.


         Case study 3:  Forward contract to swap bonds


         Forward contract scenario


                PV Enterprises is an Australian resident company with an
                annual aggregated turnover in excess of $100 million.  It
                has not made any elections under Division 230.  It currently
                holds a number of bonds which, due to its business
                practices, it typically accrues gains and losses over
                intervals equal to its income years.


                For both taxation and accounting purposes, the functional
                currency for PV Enterprises is Australian dollars.


                PV Enterprises enters into the following transactions.


                Acquisition of an Aussie bond


                On 1 July 2010 PV Enterprises acquires a zero coupon bond
                with a face value of $1,600 on the secondary market for
                $1,000 (the Aussie bond).  At the time of acquisition, the
                Aussie bond has five years remaining of its term (ie, it is
                due to mature on 30 June 2015).


                Forward contract to swap the Aussie bond for a US bond


                On 1 July 2011 PV Enterprises enters into a forward contract
                under which it agrees to exchange its Aussie bond on
                1 July 2014 for a bond with a face value of US$1,300 due to
                mature on 30 June 2016 (the US bond).


                At the time of entering into this contract, prevailing
                market rates have fallen somewhat so the value of the Aussie
                bond is $1,164.


                A US bond carrying a right to receive US$1,300 on
                30 June 2016 has a market value at 1 July 2011 of US$850.
                Also at this time, the prevailing US$/AUD exchange rate is
                0.73, so that in Australian dollar terms the US bond has a
                market value of $1,164.


                Settlement of the forward contract


                On 1 July 2014 PV Enterprises disposes of its Aussie bond
                under the forward contract in exchange for receiving the
                US bond.


                At this time its Aussie bond is worth AUD 1,500.


                The US bond at this time is worth US$1,100.  The US$/AUD
                exchange rate prevailing at this time is 0.80.  Accordingly,
                at this time the US bond has a market value of AUD 1,375.


                Redemption of the US bond


                On 30 June 2015 PV Enterprises is still holding the US bond.
                 The prevailing US$/AUD exchange rate at this time is 0.625.


                On 30 June 2016 PV Enterprises redeems the US bond for its
                face value of US$1,300.  At this time the US$/AUD exchange
                rate has fallen to 0.75, so PV Enterprises is taken to have
                received AUD 2,080 on redemption of the US bond.


                Economic summary


                Under the entirety of this arrangement, PV Enterprises has
                paid out $1,000 for the Aussie bond and is taken to have
                received AUD 2,080 under the US bond, making an overall
                economic gain of AUD 1,080.


                PV Enterprises' Aussie bond


                Financial arrangement


                The Aussie bond held by PV Enterprises is a financial
                arrangement consisting of a cash settlable right to receive
                a financial benefit (the AUD 1,600 on redemption) (section
                230-45).  Moreover, as the amount PV Enterprises paid for
                the bond (AUD 1,000) is integral to calculating any gain or
                loss on the financial arrangement, it is taken to be an
                amount PV Enterprises provided under its Aussie bond
                financial arrangement (subsection 230-60(1)).


                Application of accruals methodology


                As outlined above, the only financial benefits under the
                arrangement are PV Enterprises' $1,000 payment for the
                Aussie bond (taken to be provided under the arrangement
                pursuant to section 230-60), and the $1,600 it has a right
                to receive on maturity.  The $1,000 acquisition cost, having
                already been provided by PV Enterprises, and the right to
                receive $1,600 on maturity, being reasonably expected and
                for a fixed amount, are both sufficiently certain
                (subsections 230-115(2) and (9)).  Therefore,
                PV Enterprises has, from the time it acquires the
                Aussie bond, a sufficiently certain overall gain from the
                financial arrangement of $600 (subsection 230-105(1) and
                paragraph 230-105(2)(a)).  This $600 overall gain is subject
                to the accruals method in Subdivision 230-B (subsection 230-
                100(2)).


                Under the accruals method, PV Enterprises will spread the
                $600 over the entire five-year remaining term of the bond
                using a compounding accruals method, or a method whose
                results reasonably approximate this method (subsection 230-
                80(1) and section 230-135).


                Because of the circumstances of its business and how it
                treats its other bonds for tax purposes, PV Enterprises will
                accrue any gains and losses it makes on its Aussie bond over
                12-month intervals ending on 30 June each year (subsections
                230-80(3) and 230-135(3)).


                The gain or loss from PV Enterprises' Aussie bond under a
                compounding accruals method can therefore be calculated as
                follows (this calculation reveals a 9.86 per cent effective
                interest rate for the Aussie bond).


      8. :  Gain for each compounding interval

|Year      |Amortised|Accrued   |Cash   |Amortised  |
|ending    |cost     |gain for  |flows  |cost (year |
|          |(year    |tax       |       |end)       |
|          |start)   |purposes  |       |           |
|          |(a)      |(b)       |(c)    |(a) + (b) -|
|          |         |          |       |(c)        |
|30 June   |$0.00    |$98.56    |-$1,000|$1,098.56  |
|2011      |         |          |       |           |
|30 June   |$1,098.56|$108.27   |-      |$1,206.83  |
|2012      |         |          |       |           |
|30 June   |$1,206.83|$118.95   |-      |$1,325.78  |
|2013      |         |          |       |           |
|30 June   |$1,325.78|$130.67   |-      |$1,456.45  |
|2014      |         |          |       |           |
|30 June   |$1,456.45|$143.55   |$1,600 |$0.00      |
|2015      |         |          |       |           |


                The accrual amounts will be assessable to PV Enterprises
                under section 230-15 in the year they are accrued (sections
                230-15 and 230-170).


                Year ended 30 June 2011


                Based on the accrual calculation in Table 13.19, on
                30 June 2011, PV Enterprises will accrue a $98.56 gain in
                respect of the Aussie bond.


                Year ended 30 June 2012


                At the start of the year ending 30 June 2012 PV Enterprises
                entered into the forward contract to dispose of the Aussie
                bond (on 1 July 2011).


                On 1 July 2011, the elements of subsection 230-505(1) are
                satisfied because PV Enterprises starts to have part of a
                financial arrangement (being the right to receive the US
                bond under the forward contract) as consideration for the
                Aussie bond to be provided.


                Therefore subsection 230-505(2) will apply to deem the
                benefit obtained for providing the Aussie bond to be the
                market value of the Aussie bond when it is provided (ie, 1
                July 2014).


                Also on 1 July 2011, PV Enterprises now knows it will only
                hold the Aussie bond until 1 July 2014.  However, it will
                continue to accrue the overall gain it has calculated on the
                Aussie bond (as set out in Table 13.19) as if it will
                continue to hold the Aussie bond for the rest of its life,
                that is, until 30 June 2015 (subsection 230-135(4)).


                At the time of entering into the forward contract,
                PV Enterprises' outstanding rights and obligations under the
                Aussie bond are still the same.  That is, entering into the
                forward contract has not changed the terms and conditions of
                the Aussie bond.


                Further, the fact that PV Enterprises has entered into the
                forward contract does not of itself necessarily cause a
                material change to the circumstances affecting the
                Aussie bond at the time the forward contract is entered
                into.  Although subsection 230-185(2) does not limit the
                scope of what is considered to be a material change in these
                circumstances, it provides further context as to the types
                of changes that would be considered to be material.
                Entering into the forward contract does not, for example,
                (taking into account the requirement under paragraph 230-
                115(2)(a) for PV Enterprises to assume it will hold the
                Aussie bond for the rest of its life) cause a contingency to
                arise in respect of the financial benefits under the
                Aussie bond, such that would cause those financial benefits
                to cease to be sufficiently certain.


                Because of this, it is also relevant to note that even if
                entering into the forward contract was to be considered to
                materially alter the circumstances affecting the
                Aussie bond, and materially affect the amount and timing of
                the financial benefits PV Enterprises will receive under the
                Aussie bond (thus triggering a reassessment under
                section 230-185 and, assuming the Aussie bond is still
                subject to accruals, a re-estimation of the gain or loss to
                be accrued under section 230-190), there will be no
                difference in outcome.  As mentioned above, the rights and
                obligations under the Aussie bond have not changed.  In
                determining whether the financial benefits under such rights
                and obligations are sufficiently certain to be received or
                provided, PV Enterprises must continue to assume that it
                will have the Aussie bond for the rest of its life, that is,
                until 30 June 2015 (paragraph 230-115(2)(a)).  This means
                that following entry into the forward contract,
                PV Enterprises is still sufficiently certain to receive AUD
                1,600 on 30 June 2015.  The same gain or loss, even
                following a re-estimation, would continue to have to be
                accrued (subsection 230-190(4)).


                This means that based on the accrual calculation in Table
                13.19, on 30 June 2012, PV Enterprises will still accrue a
                $108.27 gain in respect of the Aussie bond.


                Year ended 30 June 2013


                Based on the accrual calculation in Table 13.19, on
                30 June 2013, PV Enterprises will accrue a $118.95 gain in
                respect of the Aussie bond.


                Year ended 30 June 2014


                Based on the accrual calculation in Table 13.19, on
                30 June 2014, PV Enterprises will accrue a $130.67 gain in
                respect of the Aussie bond.


                Year ended 30 June 2015


                The balancing adjustment on disposal of the Aussie bond


                Upon settlement of the forward contract on 1 July 2014,
                PV Enterprises transfers the Aussie bond to the counterparty
                in exchange for receiving the US bond.  As a result of this
                transfer, the balancing adjustment in Subdivision 230-G
                applies (paragraph 230-435(1)(a)).


                The method statement in section 230-445 results in the
                following balancing adjustment (under the relevant steps):


              . step 1 (a) (amounts received):  PV Enterprises is taken to
                have obtained for disposing of its Aussie bond AUD 1,500
                (its market value when it is provided) (paragraph 230-
                505(2)(a));


                less the sum of


              . step 2 (a) (amounts paid):  PV Enterprises is taken to have
                provided the $1,000 cost of the Aussie bond under the
                Aussie bond (subsection 230-65(1));


                and


              . step 2 (b) (amounts previously taken into account):  the
                amounts previously accrued and included in PV Enterprises'
                assessable income in respect of the reacquired Aussie bond
                total $456.45 ($98.56  +  $108.27  +  $118.95  +  $130.67)
                (subsection 230-445(1), sections 230-15 and 230-170),


                which results in a balancing adjustment of a $43.55 gain
                being made from the Aussie bond (paid $1,456.45 and received
                $1,500).


                Note:  On 1 July 2014 the elements of subsection 230-505(1)
                are satisfied again because PV Enterprises starts to have
                the US bond as consideration for ceasing to have the Aussie
                bond.  However, this will give rise to the same outcome,
                being an amount deemed to have been obtained for providing
                the Aussie bond equal to the market value of the Aussie bond
                at the time this bond was provided.


                Total gains and losses made by PV Enterprises from the
                Aussie bond


                Under the Aussie bond, the following amounts will be
                assessable under Division 230:


              . $456.45 accrued over the years ended 30 June 2011 to
                30 June 2014 ($98.56  +  $108.27  +  $118.95  +  $130.67)
                (accrual amount); and


              . $43.55 gain assessable in the year ended 30 June 2015 (gain
                on actual disposal).


                This amounts to a total gain on the Aussie bond of exactly
                $500.


                PV Enterprises' forward contract


                Financial arrangement


                The forward contract is a financial arrangement in the hands
                of PV Enterprises consisting of a cash settlable right to
                receive the US bond (being a right to receive a 'money
                equivalent' as defined), and a cash settlable obligation to
                provide the Aussie bond (being an obligation to provide a
                'money equivalent' as defined) (section 230-45, definition
                of 'money equivalent' in subsection 995-1(1) of the
                ITAA 1997).


                Application of accruals methodology


                The US bond that PV Enterprises has a right to receive under
                the forward contract arrangement is not a financial benefit
                that it is sufficiently certain to receive for the purpose
                of applying the accruals methodology.  This is because,
                whilst PV Enterprises may reasonably expect to receive the
                US bond under the forward contract, the amount or value of
                the US bond is not fixed or determinable with reasonable
                accuracy (paragraph 230-115(2)(b)).


                The reason for this is because the financial benefits to be
                provided and received under the forward contract are not all
                denominated in the same currency - the value of the US bond
                must be translated into Australian dollars using the rules
                in section 960-50 of the ITAA 1997 (subsection 230-115(8)
                and paragraph (aa) of the definition of 'special accrual
                amount' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997).  The value
                of the US bond in Australian dollar terms, determined at the
                time it is to be translated, cannot be known until such time
                as it is received.  As such, it is not sufficiently certain
                that PV Enterprises will make either an overall or a
                particular gain or loss under the forward contract, so it
                does not have a sufficiently certain gain or loss under its
                forward contract that can be subject to the accruals
                methodology (sections 230-100, 230-105, 230-110 and 230-
                115).


                Balancing adjustment on settlement


                In the year a financial arrangement ceases to be held, a
                gain or loss made in that year can only be determined under
                Subdivision 230-G (subsection 230-40(1)).  On settlement of
                the forward contract, a balancing adjustment will therefore
                be made (paragraph 230-435(1)(b)).


                The method statement in section 230-445 results in the
                following balancing adjustment (under the relevant steps):


              . step 1 (a) (amounts received):  PV Enterprises received the
                US bond, worth AUD 1,375, under its financial arrangement
                comprising its cash settlable rights and obligations under
                the forward contract;


                less


              . step 2 (a) (amounts paid):  PV Enterprises paid the
                Aussie bond, worth AUD 1,500 under its forward contract
                financial arrangement,


                which results in a balancing adjustment of a $125 loss being
                made by PV Enterprises from the forward contract (paid
                $1,500 and received $1,375).


                This loss will be deductible to PV Enterprises in the income
                year ended 30 June 2013.


                PV Enterprises' US bond


                Financial arrangement


                The US bond is a financial arrangement consisting of a cash
                settlable right to receive a financial benefit (the US$1,300
                on redemption) (section 230-45).


                In addition, the amount PV Enterprises paid for the US bond
                is integral to calculating the gain or loss on the financial
                arrangement, and thus is taken to be an amount
                PV Enterprises provided under the arrangement (subsection
                230-60(1)).


                On 1 July 2011, the elements of subsection 230-505(1) are
                satisfied because PV Enterprises starts to have a part of a
                financial arrangement (being the obligation to provide
                Aussie bond under the forward contract) as consideration for
                the US bond to be acquired.


                Therefore subsection 230-505(2) will apply to deem the
                benefit obtained for acquiring US bond to be the market
                value of the US bond when it is acquired.


                Upon settlement of the forward contract on 1 July 2014,
                PV Enterprises transfers the Aussie bond to the counterparty
                in exchange for receiving the US bond.  Because of the
                operation of subsection 230-505(2), PV Enterprises will be
                taken to have paid US$1,100 (or AUD 1,375) for the US bond,
                being its market value on 1 July 2014.


                Note:  On 1 July 2012 the elements of subsection 230-505(1)
                are satisfied again because PV Enterprises ceases to have
                the Aussie bond as consideration for acquiring the US bond.
                However, this will give rise to the same outcome, being an
                amount deemed to have been provided for acquiring the US
                bond equal to the market value of the US bond at the time
                this bond is acquired.


                Application of the accruals methodology


                PV Enterprises' financial benefits under its US bond
                financial arrangement are known.  As they are all in a
                particular foreign currency (US$), they are not to be
                translated into Australian currency before the relevant gain
                or loss is determined for the purpose of applying the
                accruals methodology (subsection 230-115(8) and paragraph
                (aa) of the definition of 'special accrual amount' in
                subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997).


                As outlined above, the only financial benefits under the
                US bond arrangement are the US$1,100 PV Enterprises' is
                taken to have paid to start to have the US bond on
                1 July 2014 (subsection 230-60(1) and section 230-505), and
                the US$1,300 it has a right to receive on maturity.  The
                acquisition cost, having been provided by PV Enterprises,
                and the right to receive payment on maturity,
                being reasonably expected and for a fixed amount (in the
                relevant particular foreign currency), are both sufficiently
                certain (subsections 230-115(2), (8) and (9)).  Therefore,
                PV Enterprises has, from the time it acquires the US bond, a
                sufficiently certain overall gain from the financial
                arrangement of US$200 (subsection 230-105(1) and paragraph
                230-105(2)(a)).  This US$200 overall gain is subject to the
                accruals method in Subdivision 230-B (subsection 230-
                100(2)).


                Under the accruals method, PV Enterprises will spread the
                US$200 over the two-year remaining term of the US bond using
                a compounding accruals method, or a method whose results
                reasonably approximate this method (subsection 230-130(1)
                and section 230-135).


                Because of the circumstances of its business and how it
                treats its other bonds for tax purposes, PV Enterprises will
                accrue any gains and losses it makes on its US bond over
                12 month intervals ending on 30 June each year (subsections
                230-80(3) and 230-135(3)).


                The gain or loss from PV Enterprises' US bond under a
                compounding accruals method can therefore be calculated as
                follows (this calculation reveals a 8.71 per cent annually
                compounded effective interest rate for the US bond).


      9. :  Gain for each compounding interval

|Year      |Amortised |Accrued  |Cash     |Amortised |
|ending    |cost (year|gain for |flows    |cost (year|
|          |start)    |tax      |         |end)      |
|          |          |purposes |         |          |
|          |(a)       |(b)      |(c)      |(a) + (b) |
|          |          |         |         |- (c)     |
|30 June   |$0.00     |$95.83   |-$1,100.0|$1,195.83 |
|2015      |          |         |0        |          |
|30 June   |$1,195.83 |$104.17  |$1,300.00|$0.00     |
|2016      |          |         |         |          |


                The accrual amounts will be assessable to PV Enterprises
                under section 230-15 in the year they are accrued, and
                translated into Australian dollars at that time (sections
                230-15 and 230-170 and paragraph (aa) of the definition of
                'special accrual amount' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA
                1997).


                Year ended 30 June 2015


                Based on the accrual calculation in Table 13.20, on
                30 June 2015, PV Enterprises will accrue a US$95.83 gain in
                respect of the Aussie bond.  Based on prevailing exchange
                rates, the gain that is included in PV Enterprises'
                assessable income under section 230-15, will be AUD 153.33.


                Year ending 30 June 2016


                Balancing adjustment


                On maturity of the US bond, PV Enterprises will be paid
                US$1,300 and all of its rights and obligations under this
                arrangement will cease.  This will trigger a balancing
                adjustment under Subdivision 230-G (paragraph 230-
                435(1)(b)).  The method statement in section 230-445 results
                in the following balancing adjustment (under the relevant
                steps):


              . step 1 (a) (amounts received):  PV Enterprises will receive
                US$1,300 under the bond, which translates under the
                translation rules in section 960-50 (and as set out in the
                facts) to AUD 2,080;


                less the sum of


              . step 2 (a) (amounts paid):  as set out in the analysis for
                the financial arrangement that is the US bond,
                PV Enterprises is taken to have paid AUD 1,375 to acquire
                the US bond (paragraph  230-505(2)(b));


                and


              . step 2 (b) (amounts previously taken into account):
                the AUD 153.33 previously accrued and included in
                PV Enterprises' assessable income (subsection 230-445(1),
                sections 230-15 and 230-170 and the definition of 'special
                accrual amount' in paragraph (aa) of the definition of
                'special accrual amount' in subsection 995-1(1) of the
                ITAA 1997),


                which results in a balancing adjustment of a $551.67 gain
                being made from the US bond (paid $1,375, assessed on
                $153.33 and received $2,080).


                Total amount brought to tax from the US bond


                The total amount brought to tax from the US bond is a $705
                gain ($153.33 accrual amount and $551.67 gain on maturity).


                Summary of gains and losses for PV Enterprises under its
                arrangement to swap bonds


                Under the entirety of this arrangement, PV Enterprises has
                made the following gains and losses under Division 230:


              . a $500 gain made from the Aussie bond ($456.45 accrued over
                the years ended 30 June 2009 to 30 June 2014, and a $43.55
                gain on disposal, assessable in the year ended
                30 June 2015);


              . a $125 loss made from the forward contract (deductible in
                the year ended 30 June 2015); and


              . a $705 gain made from the US bond ($153.33 accrual gain at
                30 June 2015 and $551.67 gain on maturity in the year ended
                30 June 2016).


                This amounts to a total overall gain on the entirety of the
                arrangements of $1,080.  This equals the overall economic
                gain PV Enterprises made on the entirety of these
                arrangements.


         Case Study 4:  Securitisation


                The purpose of this case study is to consider issues related
                to the application of Division 230 to a residential mortgage-
                backed securitisation (RMBS) structure.  The Division 230
                treatment will depend on the facts and circumstances of the
                particular securitisation structure.


                In this case study, the Originator consolidates the special
                purpose entity (SPE) into the Originator's consolidated
                financial accounts; the assets in the form of the mortgages
                are recognised in the financial statements of the
                Originator's accounts and for tax purposes the Originator
                and the SPE do not form part of the same consolidated tax
                group.  In this case study, the term 'Originator' refers to
                the Head Co and its subsidiaries.


                The securitisation structure can be illustrated
                diagrammatically as follows.


                                                                       [pic]


         Securitisation fact pattern


                An authorised deposit-taking institution (the 'Originator')
                provides fixed and variable rate residential home loans to
                Australian borrowers backed by mortgages over residential
                properties.


                On 1 July 2011, to fund its on-going lending activities the
                Originator equitably assigns the mortgages and rights to
                cash flows from the mortgages to an SPE.  The SPE issues
                securities to finance the transfer of these mortgages from
                the Originator to the SPE.  Specifically, the SPE issues a
                series of securities (featuring senior and subordinated
                tranches) with a total face value of AUD 5 billion to
                investors backed by the pool of residential mortgages.


                The SPE is in the form of a trust (the 'Trust').  The
                residual income unit in the Trust is issued to the
                Originator.  This entitles the Originator to income of the
                Trust that is in excess of what is paid to the holders of
                the Securities of the Trust and other parties.  In this
                particular securitisation arrangement the residual capital
                units are issued to the Originator and Charitable Trust.
                The Originator is appointed manager of the securitisation.
                A floating charge is attached to the assets of the Trust and
                administered by a Security Trustee.


                A series of credit enhancements are put in place including
                subscription by the Originator in the subordinated tranche
                of the notes, external mortgage insurance and mortgage
                insurance policies (effected via an equitable assignment of
                its interest in mortgage insurance policies to the Trust).


                Servicing is provided by the Originator whose role is to
                collect interest and principal payments and any other
                amounts to which the investors are entitled from the
                borrowing pool, pass those amounts on to the investors and
                pursue collection of delinquent accounts.  Liquidity support
                is also provided by the Originator.


                The Trust enters into a range of hedging arrangements
                including interest rate swaps with the Originator.


                The structure is a revolving one where the mortgage pool of
                AUD 5 billion is topped up with substitute mortgages funded
                through repayments of principal.


                The Trust issues clean-up call options to the Originator to
                facilitate winding up the securitisation structure when an
                agreed trigger event occurs.


                Securitisation assumptions


                Accounting


                The Trust is consolidated with the Originator in accordance
                with Australian Accounting Standard AASB 127 Consolidation
                and Separate Financial Statements and Urgent Issues Group
                112 Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities.  There is no
                de-recognition of the transferred mortgages under Australian
                Accounting Standard AASB 139 Financial Instruments:
                Recognition and Measurement (AASB 139) as the Originator has
                retained, notwithstanding the transfer, substantially all of
                the risk and rewards of the home loans through the holding
                of the residual income unit and the Originator's exposure
                (incorporating features such as credit enhancement
                mechanisms, liquidity support and interest rate swaps) to
                expected variability in the future net cash flows from the
                home loans.


                Tax


                The Originator and the Trust are not tax consolidated.


                The Originator's aggregated turnover for the 2011 year is in
                excess of AUD 20 million.


                The Originator has not chosen to use any of the elective tax-
                timing methods under Division 230.


                1.  Application of Division 230


                Securitisation agreements


                The securitisation shown above comprises a number of
                agreements including those entered into by the Originator:


              . equitable assignment of home loans;


              . equitable assignment of home loan mortgage insurance;


              . issuance of RMBS securities;


              . residual income unit subscription;


              . residual capital unit subscription;


              . management agreement;


              . service agreement;


              . subordinated note subscription;


              . liquidity facility;


              . interest rate swaps; and


              . management of the trust.


                Does the Originator have one or more arrangements under the
                securitisation?


                Under the securitisation the Originator has a number of
                rights to receive, and/or obligations to provide, financial
                benefits by virtue of the agreements listed above.


                The question that arises is whether the Originator's rights
                and/or obligations under each agreement constitute a single,
                aggregate arrangement or two or more separate arrangements.


                In accordance with subsection 230-55(4) the answer to this
                question is a matter of fact and degree that is determined
                having regard to the:


              . nature of the rights and/or obligations;


              . terms and conditions of the rights and/or obligations;


              . circumstances surrounding the creation of the rights and/or
                obligations and their proposed exercise or performance
                (including the purpose of the relevant parties);


              . rights and obligations and whether the rights and/or
                obligations must be dealt with separately or together;


              . normal commercial understandings and practices in relation
                to the rights and obligations (including whether they are
                viewed commercially as separate things or as a group or as a
                whole); and


              . objects of Division 230.


                Depending on the particular structure, all or a majority of
                the rights and obligations under the separate agreements
                could be interdependent and related to each other.


                The creation of these rights and obligations and their
                proposed exercise or performance predominantly occur at the
                same time.


                The common purpose of the Originator and the Trust is to
                raise and provide cost-effective finance for the Originator
                with the timing and pricing of the rights, obligations and
                consideration all structured to meet that objective.


                Commercial practice indicates that such a securitisation, or
                at least most of the components of such a securitisation, is
                treated as one arrangement.  Depending on the particular
                situation, the service agreement could be treated as part of
                a loan or treated on a stand-alone basis.


                The position under AASB 139 regarding grouping of financial
                instruments is not clear.  However, specific implementation
                guidance provided in item B6 in Implementation Guidance IAS
                39 indicates that separate instruments may be bundled into
                one transaction provided that they meet certain criteria.


                In the context of this particular case study, where the
                Trust is consolidated and assets recognised for accounting
                purposes, it appears that for accounting purposes this type
                of securitisation structure is treated as equivalent to that
                of a loan to the Originator from the note holders.


                Taking these factors into account indicates that at least a
                majority of the rights and obligations that arise from this
                type of structure could, in particular circumstances, be
                viewed in combination as constituting one arrangement.


                Is the securitisation arrangement a 'financial arrangement'?


                The Originator will have a financial arrangement if, under
                the securitisation, there is a combination of one or more
                cash settlable rights to receive and cash settlable
                obligations to provide financial benefits.  However, in
                accordance with subsection 230-45(1), the securitisation
                will not be a financial arrangement if there are rights and
                obligations that are not cash settable and those rights and
                obligations are not insignificant in comparison with the
                cash settlable rights and obligations.


                A right to receive, or an obligation to provide, a financial
                benefit is cash settlable if one of the requirements in
                subsection 230-45(2) is satisfied.  In the case of this
                securitisation most, if not all, of the rights and
                obligations are in relation to benefits that are money or a
                money equivalent (rights and/or obligations under a service
                agreement may not be cash settlable, and may therefore not
                be part of the financial arrangement).  Hence, at least a
                majority of the various agreements comprising the relevant
                securitisation arrangement could satisfy the definition of
                'financial arrangement' for the purposes of Division 230.


                Is a balancing adjustment required?


                Whether there would be a balancing adjustment under
                Subdivision 230-G for securitisation structures of this type
                will depend on the particular facts and circumstances of the
                particular structure.


                Nevertheless, subsection 230-435(3), by design, provides
                that a transfer for the purposes of this Subdivision does
                not arise unless there is, in effect, a transfer of
                substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of the
                interest in question.  Thus, it would be possible, depending
                on factors such as the nature of the holding of the residual
                income unit and the credit enhancements, for there not to be
                a Subdivision 230-G transfer in respect of typical
                securitisation arrangements.


         Case study 5:  A basic interest rate swap


                Vanilla Co enters into a five-year interest rate swap
                contract with a counterparty on 7 March 2010.  Vanilla is to
                receive annual floating rate payments, set one year in
                advance of the date due for payment, based on the Bank Bill
                Swap Rate (BBSW) and is to make annual payments at the fixed
                rate of 8 per cent per annum, also set one year in advance
                of the due date for payment.  Accordingly, the first
                floating and fixed rate payments are to be made on 7 March
                2011.  Payments are calculated by reference to a notional
                principal of $100 million.


                Vanilla Co has a 30 June income year and makes an election
                to have Division 230 apply from 1 July 2009.  However, it
                does not make any of the Division 230 tax-timing elections.


                Assume that the swap contract is a financial arrangement.
                This arrangement consists of a floating rate leg and a fixed
                rate leg.  Further, the financial benefits to be provided or
                received in respect of each leg of the arrangement are
                calculated by reference to a notional principal amount
                (which, in this case, is not paid or received).  The value
                of the notional principal in relation to both legs is $100
                million, that is, they are equal in value.  When viewed
                separately, the substance, effect and pricing of each leg of
                the swap (particularly having regard to the financial
                benefits to be provided or received in respect of it) is
                such that the notional principal in relation to it is
                provided or received at a time.  Accordingly, the swap
                contract is a financial arrangement to which section 230-120
                applies.


                In accordance with subsection 230-120(3), the financial
                benefits and gains or losses from the swap contract are to
                be worked out separately for each leg.  Then the gains or
                losses from the swap contract are worked out by calculating
                them in respect of the floating rate leg separately to those
                in respect of the fixed rate leg, before combining them to
                work out the gains or losses from the arrangement.


                In the case of the fixed rate leg, the fixed rate payments
                are calculated as if the notional principal amount of $100
                million is received by Vanilla Co on 7 March 2010, and is to
                be repaid by Vanilla Co on 7 March 2015.  The fixed rate
                payments are calculated thus:


                  $100m  ×  8% per annum  =  $8m


                Similarly, in the case of the floating rate leg, the
                floating rate payments are calculated as if the notional
                principal amount of $100 million is paid by Vanilla Co on 7
                March 2010, and is to be received by Vanilla Co on 7 March
                2015.  Assume that BBSW on 7 March 2010 is 7.7 per cent
                per annum.  Then the first floating rate payment, to be made
                on 7 March 2011, is calculated thus:


                  $100m  ×  7.7% per annum  =  $7.7m


                Assume the following BBSW rates:


            10. :  BBSW rates over the term of the interest rate swap

|Date                 |BBSW rate per annum   |
|7 March 2010         |7.7%                  |
|7 March 2011         |8.2%                  |
|7 March 2012         |8.1%                  |
|7 March 2013         |7.9%                  |
|7 March 2014         |7.6%                  |


                Based on the above BBSW rates, Vanilla Co's financial
                benefits (cash flows) including notional financial benefits
                (cash flows) for the notional principal in respect of each
                leg are as follows, bearing in mind that the notional
                principal in respect of the two legs of the swap is viewed
                as having been provided or received, and that these rates
                are set one year in advance.


            11. :  Vanilla Co's cash flows under the interest rate swap

|Date      |Floating |Floating   |Fixed leg  |
|          |rate     |leg cash   |cash flows |
|          |(p.a.)   |flows ($)  |($)        |
|7 March   |Not      |-100,000,00|100,000,000|
|2010      |applicabl|0          |           |
|          |e        |           |           |
|7 March   |7.7%     |7,700,000  |-8,000,000 |
|2011      |         |           |           |
|7 March   |8.2%     |8,200,000  |-8,000,000 |
|2012      |         |           |           |
|7 March   |8.1%     |8,100,000  |-8,000,000 |
|2013      |         |           |           |
|7 March   |7.9%     |7,900,000  |-8,000,000 |
|2014      |         |           |           |
|7 March   |7.6%     |107,600,000|-108,000,00|
|2015      |         |           |0          |


                The negative sign for the cash flows signifies a cash
                outflow while the remaining figures signify a cash inflow.


                As at 7 March 2010, Vanilla Co has a sufficiently certain:


                . particular gain in respect of the floating leg of $7.7
                  million, which relates to the period 7 March 2010 to 7
                  March 2011; and


                . particular loss in respect of the fixed leg of $8 million,
                  which also relates to the period 7 March 2010 to 7 March
                  2011.


                Vanilla Co applies the accruals method under on a
                compounding accruals basis to this and subsequent
                gains/losses in respect of the two legs of the swap contract
                using a 12-month compounding period and yearly intervals
                starting from 7 March 2010.  Each interval straddles more
                than one income year, so Vanilla Co uses fractional
                compounding to allocate gains and losses from intervals to
                income years:  this is a reasonable allocation for the
                purposes of subsection 230-170(2).  The results of this
                application of the accruals method are as follows:


            12. :  Fractional compounding to allocate gains and losses

|Income   |$ Gain     |$ Loss (pay|$ Net gain|
|year     |(receive   |fixed leg) |or loss   |
|ending   |floating   |           |          |
|         |leg)       |           |          |
|30 June  |2,385,491  |-2,476,042 |-90,552   |
|2010     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |7,843,808  |-7,993,152 |-149,344  |
|2011     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |8,176,890  |-8,006,848 |170,042   |
|2012     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |8,039,689  |-8,000,000 |39,689    |
|2013     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |7,809,391  |-8,000,000 |-190,609  |
|2014     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |5,244,732  |-5,523,958 |-279,226  |
|2015     |           |           |          |
|Total    |39,500,000 |-40,000,000|-500,000  |


                Straight line accruals for this swap would have produced the
                following results:


            13. :  Straight line accruals to allocate gains and losses

|Income   |$ Gain     |$ Loss (pay|$ Net gain|
|year     |(receive   |fixed leg) |or loss   |
|ending   |floating   |           |          |
|         |leg)       |           |          |
|30 June  |2,447,123  |-2,542,466 |-95,342   |
|2010     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |7,851,784  |-7,993,053 |-141,270  |
|2011     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |8,175,339  |-8,006,947 |168,393   |
|2012     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |8,036,438  |-8,000,000 |36,438    |
|2013     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |7,804,658  |-8,000,000 |-195,342  |
|2014     |           |           |          |
|30 June  |5,184,658  |-5,457,534 |-272,877  |
|2015     |           |           |          |
|Total    |39,500,000 |-40,000,000|-500,000  |


                Comparing the compounding accruals result with the straight
                line accruals result on a year-by-year basis illustrates
                that, in this swap, the difference is relatively small:  see
                Table 14.14.  Vanilla Co could have used straight line
                accruals (as long as it applied this on a consistent basis)
                to spread the swap gains and losses because in this
                situation it provides a result that approximates the
                compounding accruals result.


                In this situation, it is to be noted that the notional
                principal for the two legs of the swap are the same, do not
                change during the term of the swap, there are no upfront or
                backend or other lumpy payments under the swap, and the swap
                payments are periodic in nature.


            14. :  Compounding accruals versus straight line accruals[5]

|Income    |$           |$ Straight|$         |
|year      |Compounding |line      |Difference|
|ending    |accruals    |accruals  |[6]       |
|          |gain or loss|gain or   |          |
|          |            |loss      |          |
|30 June   |-90,552     |-95,342   |4,791     |
|2010      |            |          |          |
|30 June   |-149,344    |-141,270  |-8,075    |
|2011      |            |          |          |
|30 June   |170,042     |168,393   |1,649     |
|2012      |            |          |          |
|30 June   |39,689      |36,438    |3,251     |
|2013      |            |          |          |
|30 June   |-190,609    |-195,342  |4,733     |
|2014      |            |          |          |
|30 June   |-279,226    |-272,877  |-6,349    |
|2015      |            |          |          |
|Total     |-500,000    |-500,000  |0         |


         Case study 6:  An interest rate swap with upfront payment


                Neapolitan Co enters into a swap contract on the same terms
                and conditions as those entered into by Vanilla Co (and
                based on the same assumptions) except that Neapolitan Co
                prepays its obligation to make fixed rate payments under the
                contract.  This upfront payment, assumed to be $31,941,680,
                is the present value of all the payments that Neapolitan Co
                would otherwise have had to make under the fixed leg of the
                swap contract.


                The upfront payment is not a leg or part of the leg of the
                swap.  Subsection 230-120(1) is designed on the basis of a
                notional principal arrangement with two legs of equal value
                when the entity starts to have the arrangement, with the
                possibility of one or more other things.  Further, there is
                a requirement for the financial benefits to be provided or
                received in respect of each leg of the arrangement to be
                calculated by reference to, or to be reasonably related to,
                a notional principal.  However, the upfront payment has the
                characteristics of actual rather than notional principal as
                it serves a financing function, namely to finance the
                financial benefits that would otherwise have had to be
                provided by Neapolitan Co under the swap contract.


                In these circumstances, the upfront payment is, instead,
                another thing: see subparagraph 230-120(1)(a)(iii).
                Accordingly, the $31,941,680 payment needs to be taken into
                account in working out the gain or loss from that thing
                (subparagraph 230-120(3)(b)(i)) which, in turn, is used to
                work out the gain or loss from the financial arrangement
                comprising the swap contract (subparagraph 230-
                120(3)(b)(ii)).


                The role of the subparagraph 230-120(1)(a)(iii) thing is to
                provide a mechanism for reconciling the actual financial
                benefit profile of the financial arrangement with its
                economic and commercial substance, including the time value
                of money.  Thus, for the Neapolitan Co swap:


                . The financial benefits from the financial arrangement are
                 worked out by working out the financial benefits of each
                 thing separately, namely:


              - the two legs of the swap as if there were no other thing;
                and


              - the other thing, namely the upfront payment.


                . The gain or loss from the financial arrangement is worked
                 out by working out the gains or losses from each of the
                 three things separately:


              - The gains and losses from each of the two legs are worked
                out in the way described in the previous (Vanilla Co)
                example.


              - Working out the gains and losses from the upfront payment
                needs to take into account the fact that it is calculated to
                finance the annual $8 million amounts which Neapolitan Co,
                by making the upfront payment, is discharged from having to
                make to meet its mutual obligations under the swap contract.
                 In effect, Neapolitan Co makes the $31,941,680 payment as
                an investment at 8 per cent per annum annually compounded,
                receiving $8 million annually in arrears.  The gains from
                this, which are set out below, are part of the gains and
                losses from the swap financial arrangement (subparagraph 230-
                120(3)(b)(ii)).


     15. :  Gains and losses allocated using compounding accruals

|Income year |$ Gain     |$ Loss   |$ Gain |$ Net  |
|ending      |(receive   |(pay     |or loss|gain or|
|            |floating   |fixed    |from   |loss   |
|            |leg)       |leg)     |upfront|       |
|            |           |         |payment|       |
|30 June 2010|2,385,491  |-2,476,04|790,890|700,338|
|            |           |2        |       |       |
|30 June 2011|7,843,808  |-7,993,15|2,418,7|2,269,3|
|            |           |2        |08     |63     |
|30 June 2012|8,176,890  |-8,006,84|1,975,9|2,146,0|
|            |           |8        |78     |20     |
|30 June 2013|8,039,689  |-8,000,00|1,492,0|1,531,7|
|            |           |0        |97     |86     |
|30 June 2014|7,809,391  |-8,000,00|971,465|780,856|
|            |           |0        |       |       |
|30 June 2015|5,244,732  |-5,523,95|409,182|129,956|
|            |           |8        |       |       |
|Total       |39,500,000 |-40,000,0|8,058,3|7,558,3|
|            |           |00       |20     |20     |


                If straight line accruals were used for this swap, it would
                produce the following results:


     16. : Straight line accruals to allocate gains and losses

|Income year     |$ Gain     |$ Loss (pay|$ Net gain |
|ending          |(receive   |fixed leg) |or loss    |
|                |floating   |           |           |
|                |leg)       |           |           |
|30 June 2010    |2,447,123  |-2,029,154 |417,969    |
|30 June 2011    |7,851,784  |-6,384,838 |1,466,946  |
|30 June 2012    |8,175,339  |-6,402,330 |1,773,009  |
|30 June 2013    |8,036,438  |-6,384,838 |1,651,601  |
|30 June 2014    |7,804,658  |-6,384,838 |1,419,820  |
|30 June 2015    |5,184,658  |-4,355,684 |828,974    |
|Total           |39,500,000 |-31,941,680|7,558,320  |


                In this case, a comparison between the results of
                compounding accruals and straight line accruals shows that
                there is a relatively large year-by-year difference.
                Neapolitan Co could not use straight line accruals for all
                of the things in respect of this swap, although it could use
                straight line accruals solely for the two legs.  The upfront
                payment would have to be accrued as a sufficiently certain
                particular gain or loss using compounding accruals.


     17. :  Compounding accruals versus straight line accruals

|Income year   |$ Compounding|$ Straight  |$        |
|ending        |accruals gain|line        |Differenc|
|              |or loss      |accruals    |e        |
|              |             |gain or loss|         |
|30 June 2010  |700,338      |417,969     |282,368  |
|30 June 2011  |2,269,363    |1,466,946   |802,417  |
|30 June 2012  |2,146,020    |1,773,009   |373,011  |
|30 June 2013  |1,531,786    |1,651,601   |-119,814 |
|30 June 2014  |780,856      |1,419,820   |-38,964  |
|30 June 2015  |129,956      |828,974     |-699,018 |
|Total         |7,558,320    |7,558,320   |0        |


         Case study 7:  A cross currency interest rate swap


                Gelato Co, which has an Australian dollar functional
                currency and a 30 June end of income year, enters into a
                three-year cross currency interest rate swap under which:


              . it will pay a counterparty annual Australian dollar fixed
                amounts calculated by reference to a notional principal of
                AUD 10 million (6 per cent per annum);


              . it will receive from the counterparty annual foreign
                currency (FC) fixed amounts calculated by reference to a
                notional principal of FC 8 million (5 per cent per annum);


              . on 1 January 2012, it will exchange (by receiving) AUD 10
                million for (by paying) FC 8 million (at the time AUD 1 = FC
                0.8 and the two amounts are equivalent in value to each
                other); and


              . on 1 January 2015, it will reverse the above exchange by
                paying AUD 10 million and receiving FC 8 million.


                Assuming that this swap is on arm's length terms, and having
                regard to the swap contract as a whole being the relevant
                financial arrangement, the exchange and re-exchange amounts
                are notional principal rather than actual principal.  The
                exchange of amounts of equivalent value at 1 January 2012 do
                not involve financing, given that each leg is not a separate
                financial arrangement (even though each is viewed separately
                to work out the gains and losses on the whole swap
                contract).


                Gelato Co has not made the hedging financial arrangement
                election, the retranslation election or the fair value
                election.  Assume that it has decided to use spot exchange
                rates to translate foreign currency amounts into Australian
                dollars for the purposes of Subdivision 960-C.


                Assume that the periodic swap payments are made on 1 January
                2013, 1 January 2014 and 1 January 2015 and that the
                exchange rates on those dates and 30 June 2012, 30 June 2013
                and 30 June 2014 are as follows:


            18. :  Assumed exchange rates

|Date                  |AUD 1 =  FC           |
|1 January 2012        |0.80                  |
|30 June 2012          |0.92                  |
|1 January 2013        |0.86                  |
|30 June 2013          |0.75                  |
|1 January 2014        |0.82                  |
|30 June 2014          |0.70                  |
|1 January 2015        |0.78                  |


                In terms of section 230-120, the swap contract consists of
                two legs only:


              . There is a foreign currency denominated leg which consists
                of paying FC 8 million on 1 January 2012 and being entitled
                to receive that same amount on 1 January 2015; and being
                entitled to receive FC 400,000 on 1 January 2013, 1 January
                2014 and 1 January 2015.


              . There is an Australian dollar denominated leg which consists
                of receiving AUD 10 million on 1 January 2012 and having to
                pay that same amount on 1 January 2015; and having to pay
                AUD 600,000 on 1 January 2013, 1 January 2014 and 1 January
                2015.


                The gains and losses from the swap contract are to be worked
                out by working out the gains and losses from each of these
                legs separately and then aggregating them (paragraph 230-
                120(3)(b)).  In effect, the gains and losses from this swap
                contract are worked out by treating the foreign currency
                denominated leg as a foreign currency denominated bond and
                the Australian dollar denominated leg as an Australian
                dollar denominated bond, and then combining these results.


                The application of the compounding accruals rules to each of
                the legs of the swap - using annual compounding, annual
                intervals commencing 1 January 2012 and fractional
                compounding to spread gains and losses over intervals that
                straddle the end of the income year - is worked out in the
                following way.


                Foreign currency denominated leg


                In respect of the first receipt under the foreign currency
                denominated leg:


              . At 30 June 2012, the accrued gain is FC 197,561.  Under
                Subdivision 960-C, this is translated using the spot rate of
                AUD 1  =  FC 0.92 to give an accrued gain of AUD 214,740
                (see the definition of 'special accrual amount') (Schedule
                1, item 28, section 995-1 of the ITAA 1997).


              . The accrued gain for the 2013 income year up to the date of
                receipt (1 January 2013) of the FC 400,000 is FC 202,439.
                Translated at the spot rate of AUD 1  =  FC 0.86 produces an
                accrued gain of AUD 235,394.


              . Because the exchange rate changed between 30 June 2012 and
                1 January 2013, the amount accrued up until 30 June 2012 may
                be different to the amount actually received.  In this case,
                there is an under-accrual of AUD 14,982 (reflecting the fact
                that FC 197,561 at an exchange rate of AUD 1  =  FC 0.92 is
                worth less than that amount at an exchange rate of AUD 1  =
                FC 0.86).  Under subsection 230-175(2), this underestimate
                is a gain made by Gelato Co in the 2013 income year.


              . On 1 January 2013, Gelato Co receives FC 400,000.
                Translated at the spot rate of AUD 1  =  FC 0.86 produces an
                Australian dollar equivalent of AUD 465,116.  Note that this
                is the sum of the accrued amounts for the period that the FC
                400,000 relates to (1 January 2012 to 31 December 2013) and
                the subsection 230-175(2) running balance adjustment
                (AUD 214,740  +  AUD 235,394  +  AUD 14,982).


                The gains and losses in respect of the other periodic
                payments under the foreign currency leg of the swap contract
                are worked out in a similar way.


                On 1 January 2015, Gelato Co receives FC 8 million from the
                counterparty, being the re-exchange of the notional
                principal.  The exchange rate at this date is AUD 1  =  FC
                0.78.  Therefore, the foreign currency has an Australian
                dollar value of AUD 10,256,410.  In the circumstances of
                this swap contract, this amount is attributable to the FC 8
                million Gelato Co paid on 1 January 2012 (which had an
                Australian dollar value of AUD 10 million) and it could not
                be said that the gain of AUD 256,410 was sufficiently
                certain at the time the swap contract was entered into.
                Accordingly, Gelato Co makes a realisation gain of AUD
                256,410 in the income year ended 30 June 2015 in relation to
                the notional principal exchange.


                Accordingly, the Australian dollar compounding accruals
                gains and losses in respect of the foreign currency leg of
                the swap contract are as follows:


     19. :  Compounding accruals gains and losses on the foreign currency
         denominated leg

|Period      |FC       |Spot     |AUD      |AUD     |
|ending      |denominat|currency |translate|running |
|            |ed       |exchange |d        |balance |
|            |gain/loss|rate     |gain/loss|adjustme|
|            |         |         |         |nt      |
|30 June 2012|197,561  |0.92     |214,740  |        |
|1 January   |202,439  |0.86     |235,394  |14,982[7|
|2013        |         |         |         |]       |
|30 June 2013|197,561  |0.75     |263,414  |        |
|1 January   |202,439  |0.82     |246,877  |-22,486 |
|2014        |         |         |         |        |
|30 June 2014|197,561  |0.70     |282,229  |        |
|1 January   |202,439  |0.78     |259,537  |-28,945 |
|2015        |         |         |+        |        |
|            |         |         |256,410[8|        |
|            |         |         |]        |        |


                Australian dollar denominated leg


                In respect of the first payment under the Australian dollar
                denominated leg:


              . At 30 June 2012, the accrued loss is AUD 295,630.


              . The accrued loss for the 2013 income year up to the date of
                payment (1 January 2013) of the AUD 400,000 is AUD 304,370.




              . No translation under Subdivision 960-C is necessary given
                that payments are denominated in Australian dollars and
                Gelato Co's functional currency is Australian dollars.


                There is no gain or loss in relation to the notional
                principal exchange on the Australian dollar denominated leg,
                as there was a receipt of AUD 10 million and repayment of
                AUD 10 million.


                Accordingly, application of the compounding accruals rules
                to the swap contract is as follows:


     20. :  Compounding accruals gains and losses on the Australian dollar
         denominated leg

|Period ending           |AUD gain/loss             |
|30 June 2012            |-295,630                  |
|1 January 2013          |-304,370                  |
|30 June 2013            |-295,630                  |
|1 January 2014          |-304,370                  |
|30 June 2014            |-295,630                  |
|1 January 2015          |-304,370                  |


                Working out the compounding accruals gains and losses from
                the swap contract produces the following results:


     21. :  Compounding accruals gains and losses for the swap financial
         arrangement

|Income year   |Foreign     |Australian |AUD        |
|ending 30 June|currency leg|dollar leg |gain/loss[9|
|              |(AUD        |(AUD)      |]          |
|              |equivalent) |           |           |
|2012          |214,740     |-295,630   |-80,890    |
|2013          |513,790[10] |-600,000   |-86,210    |
|2014          |506,620     |-600,000   |-93,380    |
|2015          |487,002[11] |-304,370   |182,632    |


                Straight line accruals


                For a swap contract of this nature, would straight line
                accruals approximate compounding accruals for the purposes
                of paragraph 230-135(2)(b)?  The answer to this should
                generally disregard differences in the results of the two
                methods attributable to unexpected foreign currency
                movements.


                If, however, there was a significant interest rate
                differential between the two currencies or there was, as in
                Case study 6 above, a significant non-periodic payment under
                the swap arrangement, it would be difficult to say that the
                results of straight line accruals would approximate
                compounding accruals.  However, neither of these elements
                are present here, there are periodic payments and receipts
                under the swap contract, and the notional principal does not
                change during the term of the arrangement.  Straight line
                accruals would, in terms of paragraph 230-135(2)(b), provide
                a result that approximates compounding accruals, as
                illustrated by a comparison between the compounding accruals
                and straight line accruals for this swap.  Table 14.25
                demonstrates that there is, in the circumstances, only a
                relatively small difference between the two types of accrual
                on a year-by-year basis.


     22. :  Straight line accruals gains and losses on foreign currency
         denominated leg

|Period     |FC        |Spot   |AUD      |AUD      |
|ending     |denominate|currenc|translate|running  |
|           |d         |y      |d        |balance  |
|           |gain/loss |exchang|gain/loss|adjustmen|
|           |          |e rate |[12]     |t        |
|30 June    |200,000   |0.92   |217,391  |         |
|2012       |          |       |         |         |
|1 January  |200,000   |0.86   |232,558  |15,167[13|
|2013       |          |       |         |]        |
|30 June    |200,000   |0.75   |266,667  |         |
|2013       |          |       |         |         |
|1 January  |200,000   |0.82   |243,902  |-22,764[1|
|2014       |          |       |         |4]       |
|30 June    |200,000   |0.70   |285,714  |         |
|2014       |          |       |         |         |
|1 January  |200,000   |0.78   |256,410  |-29,303[1|
|2015       |          |       |+        |6]       |
|           |          |       |256,410[1|         |
|           |          |       |5]       |         |


     23. :  Straight line accruals gains and losses on the Australian dollar
         denominated leg

|Period ending               |AUD gain/loss         |
|30 June 2012                |-300,000              |
|1 January 2013              |-300,000              |
|30 June 2013                |-300,000              |
|1 January 2014              |-300,000              |
|30 June 2014                |-300,000              |
|1 January 2015              |-300,000              |


                Working out the straight line accruals gains and losses from
                the swap contract produces the following results:


     24. :  Straight line accruals gains and losses for the swap financial
         arrangement

|Income year    |Foreign       |Australian|AUD      |
|ending 30 June |currency leg  |dollar leg|gain/loss|
|               |(AUD          |(AUD)     |[17]     |
|               |equivalent)   |          |         |
|2012           |217,391       |-300,000  |-82,609  |
|2013           |514,392[18]   |-600,000  |-85,608  |
|2014           |506,852       |-600,000  |-93,148  |
|2015           |483,517       |-300,000  |183,517  |


     25. :  Comparison between compounding and straight line accruals

|Income year    |Compounding |Straight   |Difference|
|ending 30 June |accruals    |line       |(AUD)     |
|               |(AUD)       |accruals   |          |
|               |            |(AUD)      |          |
|2012           |-80,890     |-82,609    |1,719     |
|2013           |-86,210     |-85,608    |-602      |
|2014           |-93,380     |-93,148    |-232      |
|2015           |182,632     |183,517    |-885      |


         Case study 8:  A total return swap


                Party A enters into a three-year swap arrangement with Party
                B.  Assume that it is a notional principal arrangement to
                which section 230-120 applies.  Under the terms of the swap
                arrangement, Party A and Party B are required to make
                periodic payments to each other.  Party A's periodic
                payments are calculated by reference to the amount of
                interest payable if the leg under which the payments are to
                be made were a bond that it issued.  Party B's periodic
                payments are calculated by reference to the dividends paid
                on a reference share whose value at the time of entering
                into the swap arrangement is the same as the value of
                Party's A bond leg at that time.


                As well, Party B is either required to make, or entitled to
                receive, a single payment at the end of the swap
                arrangement.  The amount or value of Party B's end payment
                or receipt is calculated by reference to the movement of the
                price of the reference share over the three-year life of the
                swap.  Such swaps are sometimes referred to as a 'total
                return swap'.


                Any gains or losses on Party B's share-based leg would have
                to take into account financial benefits, the value of which
                are dependent on dividends on the reference share, and the
                movement in the share price.  Under the terms of the swap
                arrangement, these amounts will not be known until the time
                the relevant payments are due.


                No sufficiently certain gain or loss can be calculated on
                Party B's leg of this swap at the start of, or during, the
                arrangement.  This assumes that financial benefits in
                respect of this leg are not calculated and set in advance of
                when they are payable.  Accordingly, gains or losses in
                respect of this leg are made on a realisation basis for the
                whole term of the swap arrangement.


                On the other hand, a sufficiently certain gain or loss can
                be calculated in respect of the bond leg.  In terms of
                working out the gains or losses in respect of this leg for
                the purposes of subparagraph 230-120(3)(b)(i), accruals
                treatment would therefore apply.








Chapter 15
Regulation impact statement

Background


   1454. In August 1998, the then Government announced the Review of
         Business Taxation (Ralph Review) as part of the broader New Tax
         System.  The major objective of the Ralph Review was to design a
         taxation system that would best contribute to economic growth.  The
         backdrop for the review featured issues including the impact of
         globalisation on the Australian economy, the increasing
         sophistication of financial dealings, and the ability of the
         Australian Government to raise revenue in the face of the future
         impact of an aging population and increasing costs of health care:


                . Review chairman John Ralph AO noted:  'Meeting the demands
                  upon it [the tax system] in the decades immediately ahead
                  poses significant challenges for the Australian Government
                  and the Australian community.  Increased globalisation
                  will translate into an increasingly competitive
                  environment for Australian business.  The impact of the
                  telecommunications revolution and associated technologies,
                  in diminishing the significance of national boundaries,
                  will make more businesses feel the chill wind of stiff
                  competition.  We may remain an island geographically but
                  we will not be able to hide from the forces generated by
                  globalisation.'


   1455. Among the recommendations arising from the Ralph Review was a
         series of reforms to the taxation of financial arrangements.  The
         final stages of these reforms, Taxation of Financial Arrangements
         (TOFA) Stages 3 and 4, broadly give effect to the recommendations
         contained in Chapter 9 of the Review of Business Taxation:  A Tax
         System Redesigned (Ralph Report).  The recommendations seek to
         address the tax issues associated with the increasing
         sophistication of financial markets and transactions:


                . The then Treasurer announced the Government's broad
                  support for the recommendations in the Ralph Report in
                  Press Release No. 074 of 11 November 1999.


   1456. TOFA Stages 3 and 4 will implement the final stages of reforms to
         the taxation of financial arrangements.  Stages 1 and 2 of TOFA
         have already been implemented:


                . Stage 1 of TOFA (debt/equity reforms) was legislated in
                  2001 as Division 974 of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997
                  (ITAA 1997).


                . Stage 2 (foreign currency reforms) was legislated in 2003
                  as Division 775 of the ITAA 1997.


   1457. Stages 3 and 4 of the TOFA reforms will be introduced into
         Parliament as Division 230 of the ITAA 1997.  These stages of the
         TOFA reforms cover tax-timing treatments of financial arrangements.




Policy objective


   1458. The objectives of the proposed legislation are to increase clarity
         of the tax treatment of financial arrangements, to reduce
         uncertainties and anomalies in the current law, to reduce tax-
         induced distortions to investment and financing, to facilitate
         efficient risk management, and to reduce compliance and
         administration costs.


   1459. The context of these objectives is that the current taxation of
         financial arrangements is largely based on standard income tax
         concepts that give significant weight to legal form rather than
         economic substance.  Two aspects are particularly important.
         First, the current law often focuses on particular cash flows,
         makes a distinction on a legal basis between capital and revenue,
         and largely taxes financial arrangements on a realisation basis.
         This often leads to effective tax rates in present value terms
         differing across economically similar transactions.  This is
         particularly important in the financial sector where the timing of
         cash flows is a key driver of profitability.  It is also important
         because economically similar financial arrangements can take
         different forms or have different cash flow profiles.  Second, the
         current law may inhibit appropriate risk management and risk
         transfer.


   1460. Despite extensive consultation on TOFA Stages 3 and 4
         (see paragraphs 15.64 to 15.75), the principles underpinning the
         Ralph recommendations have been largely unchallenged.  The
         particular point of discussion during the consultation process has
         been the best way to articulate the policy objectives of TOFA
         Stages 3 and 4.


Implementation options


   1461. Three options are considered in this regulation impact statement
         for meeting the policy objectives of TOFA:


                . Option 1:  Financial accounting concepts.  Under this
                  option, the measure will have a common theme of
                  incorporating relevant financial accounting concepts where
                  possible into the relevant income tax law principles
                  relating to financial arrangements and applying economic
                  gain and loss concepts otherwise.


                . Option 2:  Direct link.  This option allows taxpayers to
                  determine their income tax liability in relation to
                  financial assets and liabilities as determined by their
                  financial accounting treatment, subject to specified
                  income tax law adjustments.


                . Option 3:  Maintain current arrangements.


Option 1:  Financial accounting concepts


   1462. Option 1 has a number of elements.  Under this option the key
         concept is the calculation of gains and losses.  The default
         position is that all gains and losses are treated on revenue
         account, meaning that there is (with some exceptions) no longer a
         revenue/capital distinction in Division 230.  In addition, gains
         and losses are assessed in terms of all the cash flows associated
         with one financial arrangement, rather than focussing on each
         individual cash flow.  The identification of a financial
         arrangement takes account of normal commercial understandings.


   1463. Once gains or losses have been identified, the default methodology
         is to apply an accruals regime to economic gains and losses.  The
         accruals regime (Subdivision 230-B) will ensure that any gain or
         loss that is sufficiently certain to occur is allocated on a time
         value of money basis.  This will reduce tax-induced distortions by
         reducing the ability of taxpayers to gain tax advantage through
         income deferral.  Where sufficiently certain gains and losses vary
         from previous estimates, a balancing adjustment may be applied to
         over- or under-taxation of the actual gain or loss (Subdivision 230-
         G).


   1464. Where the amount of a gain or loss on a financial arrangement is
         considered to lack sufficient certainty, the gain or loss will be
         taxed on a realisation basis (Subdivision 230-B) as long as no
         elective regime applies.  The realisation regime will bring a gain
         or loss to account in the income year in which it occurs.  This
         approach reduces the compliance costs that might occur if the
         accruals regime were more extensive and there were consequent
         frequent re-estimation of gains and losses with resulting balancing
         adjustments.


   1465. In addition to the default arrangements, the new regime allows a
         number of options.  The options fall into two different groups, one
         that has the effect of expanding accruals treatment, and one that
         further enhances risk management by better dealing with volatility.
          The fair value, financial reports and foreign exchange
         retranslation elections allow taxpayers to adopt a closer link to
         financial accounting.  These options result in non-realisations tax
         treatment for an even broader class of transactions than would be
         the case under the core rules of Division 230.  The hedging
         election allows taxpayers to reduce their post-tax volatility.  All
         four elections are on a voluntary basis due to the potentially
         adverse consequences that may arise for taxpayers with particular
         affairs.


   1466. The elective fair value regime (Subdivision 230-C) will permit the
         taxpayers, who make the election to be taxed on the basis of the
         gains and losses arising from changes in the fair value of
         financial arrangements.  The fair value regime provides improved
         price neutrality for financial arrangements and compliance cost
         savings to taxpayers who make the election.  The compliance cost
         savings are due to the fact that some taxpayers already fair value
         financial transactions for accounting purposes, reducing the
         necessity of making separate tax calculations.  The fair value
         election is likely to only appeal to taxpayers which are able to
         avoid liquidity problems associated with taxing unrealised gains
         under the fair value taxation.


   1467. Subdivision 230-F allows taxpayers to elect to rely on their
         financial reports for the purposes of calculating their tax
         liability with respect to financial arrangements.  This option will
         reduce compliance costs for taxpayers, particularly those with
         complex financial arrangements that already must be recorded and
         audited for accounting purposes.


   1468. Taxpayers which elect to apply the foreign exchange retranslation
         regime (Subdivision 230-D) to their financial arrangements may
         bring to account changes in value attributable to foreign currency
         movements.  The retranslation election will provide compliance cost
         savings to taxpayers who are not concerned with dealing with
         potential tax payment volatility associated with foreign exchange
         movements and who make the election.


   1469. Finally, taxpayers may also elect to make use of the tax-timing
         hedging regime (Subdivision 230-E).  The new rules will allow after-
         tax-timing matching to occur, removing the tax distortions caused
         by tax-timing mismatches under the current tax law.  Taxpayers who
         make the hedging election will also be permitted to match the
         character of their hedges with the revenue/capital designation of
         the hedged item, removing distortions arising from character
         mismatches.


Option 2:  Direct link


   1470. A significant element of the discussions during the consultation
         process is the debate regarding the appropriateness of accounting
         standards as a basis for tax law.


   1471. Option 2 (referred to as the direct link or formal link approach)
         involves relying comprehensively on Australian accounting standards
         to determine the scope and benchmark for taxation of financial
         arrangements.  For example, Australian Accounting Standard AASB 132
         Financial Instruments:  Disclosure and Presentation (AASB 132) and
         Australian Accounting Standard AASB 139 Financial Instruments:
         Recognition and Measurement (AASB 139) describe 'financial
         instruments' which are similar in nature to the arrangements
         intended to be covered by TOFA Stages 3 and 4.  Under option 2,
         Division 230 would refer to the relevant sections of AASB 132 and
         AASB 139 in order to define the arrangements to which the TOFA
         Stages 3 and 4 rules will apply (with additions and subtractions as
         necessary).  This regulation impact statement analyses a mandatory
         direct link.


Option 3:  Maintain current arrangements


   1472. Option 3 is the current tax law with respect to financial
         arrangements.  With a few exceptions this relies on the normal
         rules of the income tax system, in particular the distinction
         (under income tax law) between revenue and capital and income and
         deductions.  In general, tax is paid on a realisation rather than
         an accruals basis and the timing of tax can differ substantially
         from the timing of commercial gain, resulting in tax planning and
         arbitrage opportunities and potentially biasing the allocation of
         resources to financial instruments that are relatively tax-
         favoured.  In other circumstances, the tax disadvantaged treatment
         may either inhibit the use of a particular financial arrangement or
         interfere, in a non-neutral way, with its pre-tax pricing.


   1473. As noted above, the current tax law may also inhibit efficient risk
         management practices in the financial sector and the corporate
         sector more broadly.  For example, a fund manager may invest in an
         offshore investment and hedge the foreign currency exposure to
         reduce earnings volatility.  Under the current law the earnings of
         the investment may be exempt from income tax, but the gains or
         losses of the hedge may be subject to tax.  Accordingly, even
         though the hedge may be effective in pre-tax terms, it may not be
         effective in post-tax terms.


Assessment of impacts


Impact group identification


         Taxpayers


   1474. TOFA Stages 3 and 4 is intended to apply to financial arrangements
         held by sophisticated taxpayers with systems in place to meet tax
         and accounting requirements.  Unsophisticated taxpayers will not
         generally be expected to apply the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules.


   1475. With this taxpayer coverage in mind, Division 230 will apply to the
         financial arrangements of all entities with aggregated turnover of
         $100 million or more, and to the financial arrangements of all
         authorised deposit-taking institutions (ADIs), securitisation
         vehicles or entities which are required (or would be required if
         the entity were a corporation) to register under the Financial
         Sector (Collection of Data) Act 2001 with aggregated turnover of
         $20 million or more:


                . The Australian Taxation Office (ATO) estimates that there
                  are approximately 1,800 businesses with aggregated
                  turnover of $100 million or more.


                . The ATO estimates that there are a further 6,200
                  businesses with aggregated turnover between $20 million
                  and $100 million, although not all of these businesses
                  will meet the registration requirement.


                . Although no estimates are available, it is possible that
                  other taxpayers may opt into the regime to benefit from
                  the compliance cost savings and utilise some of the
                  elective regimes for other reasons (eg, by using the
                  hedging regime to preserve true economic hedges).


   1476. The Division will not apply to the financial arrangements of
         individuals or to entities which fall below the turnover thresholds
         unless those taxpayers hold financial arrangements which allow
         significant deferral of income.


   1477. Public consultation in October 2008 identified some anomalous and
         unintended outcomes of the aggregated turnover tests described
         above.  The tests look to a taxpayer's ordinary income derived in
         the ordinary course of business, but some taxpayers do not account
         for ordinary income separately from statutory income (notably
         superannuation funds and investment vehicles) and some do not
         'carry on a business' for tax purposes.  To ensure the TOFA Stages
         3 and 4 rules apply to the taxpayers intended, the following
         additional threshold tests will apply:


                . Division 230 will apply to superannuation funds and
                  investment vehicles with assets valued at $100 million or
                  more.


                . Division 230 will apply to taxpayers applying the
                  $100 million turnover test with assets valued at $300
                  million or more, or financial assets of $100 million or
                  more.


         Tax advisors


   1478. The tax advisors employed by entities which hold financial
         arrangements have been heavily involved in the design of the TOFA
         Stages 3 and 4 rules and will be similarly involved in the
         implementation and application of the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules.
         As the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules affect sophisticated taxpayers, it
         is expected that larger tax advice and accounting firms will mainly
         be affected.


   1479. It is also anticipated that tax advisors will initially bear much
         of the transitional costs associated with the introduction of
         Division 230.  Whether they ultimately bear these costs will depend
         on their capacity to charge their clients fully for the time and
         effort associated with learning the new regime.  The Division
         contains a number of irrevocable elections which taxpayers are
         expected to seek advice on:


                . The ATO anticipates that first and second tier advisory
                  firms will be affected by TOFA Stages 3 and 4.  There are
                  approximately 400 such firms.


         Systems developers


   1480. The TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules will necessitate some changes to the
         accounting and taxation reporting systems used by taxpayers which
         hold financial arrangements.  Systems developers employed by these
         taxpayers will be involved in developing new systems and refining
         the interactions between existing accounting and tax reporting
         systems, and operating and maintaining these reporting systems from
         year to year.  It is anticipated that systems developers will also
         be heavily involved during the transitional phase associated with
         the introduction of Division 230:


                . The ATO estimate that up to 150 commercial software
                  developers may be involved with TOFA Stages 3 and 4.


         Australian Taxation Office


   1481. The ATO will be responsible for the administration of the TOFA
         Stages 3 and 4 rules.  Collection of tax revenue under Division 230
         will occur through the pay as you go (PAYG) system.  As well as
         revenue collection under Division 230, the ATO may also be required
         to provide tax rulings, practice statements and interpretive
         decisions to interested taxpayers.


Analysis of costs/benefits


   1482. This section outlines the costs and benefits of the three options.
         The analysis indicates that option 1 is the superior option.  To
         ensure that the discussion is as succinct as possible the
         regulation impact statement compares all three options at the same
         time.  As a guide to the reader it should be noted that the
         analysis indicates that option 1 is superior to option 2.  The
         relative merits of option 2 compared to option 3 are less clear as
         the impact on different groups of taxpayers is quite different.
         For some taxpayers it is anticipated that option 1 and option 2
         will lead to very similar practical outcomes.  For these parties,
         the major differences between the two options are largely confined
         to the impact on compliance costs.  Consequently, particular
         attention is paid to the compliance savings and costs, both
         transitional and ongoing, of the two options.  However, for some
         taxpayers, option 1 will have quite different effects, mainly due
         to the treatment of unrealised gains and losses.


   1483. The revenue impact of the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules is
         unquantifiable.


Benefits


         General


   1484. The core rules of option 1 are based on accruals where possible,
         and realisation otherwise.  Unless taxpayers opt for one of the
         relevant elections they will not be exposed to taxation of
         uncertain unrealised gains.


   1485. This contrasts with option 2 which would have this outcome due to
         the construction of financial accounting.  The reason for this
         divergence is that tax and accounting rules are designed for
         different purposes.  Financial accounting is designed to provide
         relevant stakeholders information about the performance of the
         entity.  Whilst this is relevant for tax, it is not the only
         consideration.  For example, the ability to pay concept underlying
         the equity principle of tax policy has been interpreted in practice
         to have regard to liquidity considerations.


   1486. In addition, option 1 is designed to incorporate relevant financial
         accounting concepts into tax law principles while retaining
         taxation terminology and phraseology.  In essence, this option is a
         translation of appropriate accounting principles into tax
         principles.  Option 1 offers greater tax revenue integrity compared
         to option 2:


                . Tax terminology:  importing, defining and comprehension of
                  accounting terminology and phraseology will not be
                  necessary under this option.


                . Principle based outcomes:  option 1 will be based on a
                  principled tax framework and may also permit single
                  outcomes, rather than multiple outcomes which may be
                  possible under accounting standards.


                . Objective:  the accounting standards are designed to
                  provide a particular quality of financial reporting, an
                  objective which does not always align with the goals of
                  the tax law.  Option 1 can avoid any conflict arising from
                  this difference.


                . Control:  the international accounting standards are
                  sometimes amended to achieve superior accounting outcomes.
                   The interpretations and applications of these standards
                  may be different to that of a separate tax law.  Option 1
                  may reduce or remove the impact of these decisions on tax
                  revenue.


   1487. A substantial benefit of options 1 and 2 is that they align more
         closely the tax-timing of transactions with their underlying
         commercial substance compared to option 3.  This has benefits for
         resource allocation in the economy.  First, it improves the
         likelihood that the appropriate level of resources are allocated to
         the financial sector (and financial activities within the non-
         financial sector) than under the current rules compared to the non-
         financial sector.  Second, it improves the likelihood that
         resources within the financial sector are allocated to the highest
         value uses.


   1488. Whether option 1 or option 2 improves resource allocation more than
         the other depends on the particular treatment of individual
         transactions under the two options.  Where a taxpayer elects to use
         financial reports under option 1, then there would be little
         difference between the two options.  Similarly, the differences
         under fair value are likely to be small.


   1489. Where the core rules are in operation, option 1 may result in
         poorer resource allocation than under option 2.  For example,
         transactions treated on a realisation basis may have a tax
         treatment that diverges from underlying commercial values further
         than would be the case under the accounting treatment (which is
         often fair valued or at least accrued).


   1490. The capacity to hedge for tax purposes under option 1 is a
         significant economic benefit.  Hedging allows economic agents to
         reduce volatility with associated benefits.  Under current law
         (option 3) an economically effective pre-tax hedge may not be an
         effective post-tax hedge where the tax-timing or tax character of
         the hedged item and the hedging instrument differ.  In addition,
         option 1 is superior to option 3 for two reasons.  First, option 1
         allows all hedges for accounting purposes to be hedges for tax
         purposes.  It also allows some other hedges to be recognised.  The
         broader scope of hedges covered increases the economic benefits
         from hedging.  Second, option 1 allows character matching in
         addition to timing matching.  Option 2 does not allow this as
         accounting does not deal with tax character.  Without tax character
         matching post-tax hedges are not effective.


   1491. A substantial benefit for taxpayers under option 1 is that a number
         of the elections which have the potential to tax uncertain
         unrealised gains are optional.  This recognises that tax policy has
         always been mindful of liquidity constraints and has been reluctant
         to require involuntary disposals of assets.


   1492. Another consideration between option 1 and 2 is the issue of
         'reverse pollution'.  Accounting bodies have expressed concern that
         a direct link between financial reports and tax would result in
         pressure to amend the accounting standards to ensure more
         favourable tax outcomes.  This may reduce the quality of
         information available to investors which may in turn result in
         capital not being directed to the most productive sectors of the
         economy.  Adoption of option 1 limits the extent of reverse
         pollution.  Option 3 would not involve any reverse pollution.


         Taxpayers


   1493. In terms of transitional compliance benefits, there are not
         expected to be any specific benefits for taxpayers under option 1.
         This would also be true of the direct link approach (option 2).
         While there are no compliance benefits from option 3, the cost
         would be zero.


   1494. In terms of ongoing compliance benefits, there is not expected to
         be any noticeable difference between option 1 and option 2.  If
         anything, there may be a marginal compliance cost benefit in favour
         of option 2 as option 1 contains elections that will require
         taxpayers to consider whether one approach is better than the other
         for their particular circumstances (noting of course that the lack
         of choice under the direct link may have non-compliance costs for
         taxpayers).  The extent of these additional compliance costs is
         limited by the fact that most elections in option 1 are
         irrevocable.


   1495. However, the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules themselves should allow
         significant compliance cost savings for taxpayers in terms of
         policy coherency, legislative complexity, record-keeping, and
         enquiries and rulings compared with the current rules (option 3).
         Division 230 will effectively replace Division 16E of the Income
         Tax Assessment Act 1936 (ITAA 1936) and require accruals taxation
         on a less frequent basis, and will partially replace the tax
         treatment under Division 775 of the ITAA 1997.  Tax compliance
         costs should be reduced through the relatively close alignment with
         accounting for the fair value, retranslation and hedging regimes:


                . The ATO estimate that taxpayers affected by TOFA Stages 3
                  and 4 will experience a medium decrease in compliance
                  costs during the ongoing stage.


                . The reduction in compliance costs is expected to be
                  particularly important for large financial institutions
                  which, if they elect to, will be able to rely on their
                  financial accounting systems without the need to build and
                  maintain duplicate tax systems.


         Tax advisors


   1496. In terms of transitional compliance benefits, there are not
         expected to be any specific benefits for tax advisors under option
         1.


   1497. In terms of ongoing compliance benefits for tax advisors, there is
         not expected to be any noticeable difference between option 1 and
         option 2.  As for taxpayers, there may be a marginal compliance
         cost benefit in favour of option 2 as option 1 contains elections
         that will require taxpayers to consider whether one approach is
         better than the other for their particular circumstances (noting of
         course that the lack of choice under the direct link may have non-
         compliance costs for taxpayers).


   1498. However, as for taxpayers, the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules may
         provide some compliance cost relief for tax advisors relative to
         option 3 on an ongoing basis through the effective replacement of
         Division 16E of the ITAA 1936 and partial replacement of
         Division 775 of the ITAA 1997:


                . The ATO estimate that tax advisors affected by TOFA
                  Stages 3 and 4 will have nil or minimal change in
                  compliance costs during the ongoing stage compared with
                  option 2.


         Systems developers


   1499. In terms of transitional compliance benefits, there are not
         expected to be any specific benefits for systems developers under
         option 1.


   1500. In terms of ongoing compliance benefits for systems developers,
         there is not expected to be any noticeable difference between
         option 1 and option 2.  There is expected to be a significant
         compliance cost benefit compared with option 3 as the need to build
         and maintain tax specific systems will be reduced for those
         taxpayers who make the fair value or financial reports election:


                . The ATO estimate that systems developers affected by TOFA
                  Stages 3 and 4 will have nil or minimal compliance costs
                  during the ongoing stage.


         Australian Taxation Office


   1501. In terms of transitional administrative benefits, there are not
         expected to be any specific benefits for the ATO under option 1.


   1502. In terms of ongoing administrative benefits for the ATO, there is
         not expected to be any noticeable difference between option 1 and
         option 2.  There will be ongoing compliance benefits for the ATO
         compared with option 3 due to the fact that the ATO may in part be
         able to rely on taxpayers' financial accounting systems and
         controls.


Costs


         General


   1503. Option 1 is expected to be more difficult, initially, to relate to
         accounting outcomes, and higher compliance costs compared to option
         2 are expected for stakeholders for the transitional period.  Both
         options 1 and 2 will provide greater ongoing certainty than option
         3.


         Taxpayers


   1504. The TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules will create significant transitional
         compliance costs for sophisticated taxpayers subject to the rules.
         The new rules will expand accruals taxation and introduce
         sophisticated taxation treatments to many financial arrangements
         which were previously taxed simplistically.  Particular areas where
         transitional compliance costs are expected to be realised are
         formal training of staff, comprehension of new obligations,
         enquiries and rulings, and review of tax planning strategies.  It
         should be noted that the compliance impact will differ for
         specialists involved in the process.  Tax specialists will face
         costs in understanding the new concepts.  This will be less of an
         issue for finance and accounting specialists as the new approach
         uses concepts familiar to them:


                . The ATO estimate that taxpayers affected by TOFA Stages 3
                  and 4 will incur a medium increase in compliance costs
                  during the transitional stage.


   1505. The transitional costs for taxpayers are expected to be relatively
         higher under option 1 compared to option 2.  The concepts and
         principles articulated under option 1 are expected to take more
         time for taxpayers to unravel compared to the direct reference to
         accounting under option 2:


                . The ATO anticipates that option 1 will result in more
                  rulings and disputes than option 2, and consequentially
                  has a higher transitional compliance cost for taxpayers.


   1506. Although the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules are expected to provide
         overall ongoing compliance cost savings for taxpayers, some
         taxpayers are likely to bear increased ongoing compliance costs.
         Under the current tax law, a limited number of taxpayers may be
         required to tax financial arrangements on an accruals basis under
         Division 16E.  The introduction of Division 230 is expected to
         significantly expand the number of taxpayers who are required to
         apply accruals taxation.  While taxpayers who were previously
         subject to accruals taxation under Division 16E will enjoy
         compliance cost savings due to the simplification of the accruals
         calculations under TOFA Stages 3 and 4, taxpayers forced to shift
         from realisation to accruals taxation can expect increased
         compliance costs, due to the relative complexity of accruals tax
         calculations.


   1507. In terms of ongoing compliance costs for taxpayers, there is not
         expected to be any noticeable difference between option 1 and
         option 2.


   1508. Option 2 would have significantly higher costs in terms of
         potential tax liabilities and tax volatility than either option 1
         or option 2 due to the mandatory use of financial accounts.  Some
         taxpayers would be required to bring to account unrealised gains
         under the direct link approach.  Option 2 also provides less
         flexibility than option 1, reducing the capacity of taxpayers to
         match their tax and accounting needs.


         Tax advisors


   1509. The TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules will create significant transitional
         compliance costs for tax advisors.  As with taxpayers, the general
         areas where transitional compliance costs are expected to be
         realised for tax advisors are formal training of staff and
         comprehension of new obligations.  A particular cost on tax
         advisors will be to advise individual clients on the various
         elections available under Division 230:


                . The ATO estimate that tax advisors affected by TOFA
                  Stages 3 and 4 will incur a medium increase in compliance
                  costs during the transitional stage.


   1510. The transitional costs for tax advisors are expected to be higher
         under option 1 compared to option 2.  Transitional costs are higher
         under both option 1 and option 2 than option 3.  While the concepts
         and principles articulated under option 1 are expected to provide
         similar outcomes, tax advisors may have greater difficulty in
         confirming this compared to option 2:


                . The ATO anticipates that option 1 will result in more
                  rulings and disputes than option 2, and consequentially
                  has a higher transitional compliance cost for tax
                  advisors.


   1511. In terms of ongoing compliance costs for tax advisors, there is not
         expected to be any noticeable difference between option 1 and
         option 2.


         Systems developers


   1512. Systems developers employed by taxpayers affected by TOFA Stages 3
         and 4 are expected to bear the costs of reviewing tax reporting
         systems and processes during the transitional period.  However,
         these transitional costs are expected to be lower than those
         associated with the design/implementation of brand new reporting
         systems as the process should require refinement and alignment
         between existing accounting and tax reporting systems:


                . The ATO estimate that systems developers affected by TOFA
                  Stages 3 and 4 will incur a medium increase in compliance
                  costs during the transitional stage.


   1513. The transitional costs for systems developers are expected to be
         higher under option 1 compared to option 2.  The principled and
         conceptual nature of the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules when articulated
         under option 1 may not, initially, be easily translated into
         linkages between accounting and tax reporting systems:


                . The ATO anticipates that option 1 will result in more
                  rulings and disputes than option 2, but has not suggested
                  that this will necessarily result in higher transitional
                  compliance costs for systems developers.


   1514. In terms of ongoing compliance costs for systems developers, there
         is not expected to be any noticeable difference between option 1
         and option 2.


         Australian Taxation Office


   1515. The transitional administrative costs for the ATO are expected to
         be relatively higher under option 1 compared to option 2.  These
         higher costs are expected to be in the form of increased rulings,
         disputes and litigation between the tax office and taxpayers.


   1516. In terms of ongoing administrative costs for the ATO, there is not
         expected to be any noticeable difference between option 1 and
         option 2.  The ongoing administrative costs of option 1 are
         expected to be higher as there is a greater degree of uncertainty
         regarding the treatment of financial arrangements due to the
         mismatch between underlying commercial concepts and tax concepts.


Consultation


   1517. The Ralph Review, comprising Mr John Ralph AO, Mr Bob Joss and Mr
         Rick Allert AM who were assisted by a secretariat consisting of
         officers from the Treasury, the ATO and the then Department of
         Industry, Science and Resources, and external advisers, was
         undertaken between August 1998 and September 1999.  Chapter 9 of
         the Ralph Report, released on 21 September 1999, recommended new
         rules and regimes for the taxation of financial arrangements.
         These recommendations included the introduction of an accruals and
         realisation regime, elective regimes for fair value and
         retranslation taxation, and recognition of hedging arrangements for
         tax purposes:


                . The then Treasurer announced the then Government's broad
                  support for the recommendations in the Ralph Report in
                  Press Release No. 074 of 11 November 1999.


   1518. Following requests by interested taxpayers for a formal update on
         progress in TOFA Stages 3 and 4, Treasury released the
         TOFA Stages 3 and 4 Information Paper on a confidential basis in
         December 2004.  The information paper detailed the broad policy
         proposals for TOFA Stages 3 and 4.  In response to the information
         paper, 13 submissions were received from industry, taxpayers, peak
         bodies and tax advisors.


   1519. On 16 December 2005, the then Minister for Revenue and Assistant
         Treasurer announced the public release of exposure draft
         legislation for TOFA Stages 3 and 4 (Press Release No. 107 of
         2005).  In response to the exposure draft, a total of 32
         submissions were received, including public submissions from the
         following industry, taxpayers, peak bodies and tax advisors:


                . Association of Superannuation Funds of Australia;


                . Australian Bankers' Association;


                . Australian Equipment Lessors Association;


                . Australian Financial Markets Association;


                . Australian Petroleum Production and Exploration
                  Association;


                . Australian Securitisation Forum;


                . Blake Dawson Waldron;


                . Corporate Tax Association and Certified Practicing
                  Accountants Australia (joint submission);


                . Ernst & Young;


                . Fini Villages;


                . Insurance Council of Australia;


                . Institute of Chartered Accountants in Australia;


                . Investment and Financial Services Association;


                . Law Council of Australia;


                . Minerals Council of Australia;


                . Minter Ellison;


                . Namoi Cotton;


                . OneSteel;


                . PEET & Co;


                . Pitcher Partners;


                . Property Council of Australia;


                . Pricewaterhouse Coopers;


                . Retirement Village Association;


                . Sydney Futures Exchange;


                . Shaddick & Spence;


                . Tax Institute of Australia; and


                . Walker Group Holding.


   1520. The main issues raised in submissions were:


                . The scope of arrangement:  Submissions considered that the
                  scope of the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules in the 2005
                  exposure draft was too wide.  This judgment was accepted
                  and the scope was narrowed by removing the main
                  contentious element; namely, rights to receive non-
                  monetary assets.


                . The accruals/realisation borderline:  Submissions argued
                  that the test for distinguishing accruals/realisation
                  treatments set the borderline too low.  A different test
                  was incorporated in the 2007 public exposure draft to
                  achieve the appropriate and intended threshold.


                . A direct link election:  Some submissions continued to
                  call for a 'direct link' with relevant accounting
                  standards.  One suggestion was that the proposed
                  discretion in the 2005 exposure draft (to accept the
                  accounting treatment in particular circumstances) could be
                  replaced with an election.  This option was considered in
                  the 2007 public exposure draft.


                . Hedging rules:  While welcoming the 'tax-timing' hedging
                  rules, submissions requested an extension to allow for
                  'character' matching.  A character matching regime was
                  included in the 2007 public exposure draft.


   1521. Following the consideration of responses to the December 2005
         exposure draft, Treasury released policy papers covering seven
         areas of concern raised by the respondents.  These papers were
         released on a confidential basis in May and June 2006.  In response
         to the policy papers, a total of 19 submissions were received from
         industry, taxpayers, peak bodies and tax advisors.


   1522. On 3 January 2007, the then Minister for Revenue and Assistant
         Treasurer announced the public release of a second exposure draft
         in Press Release No. 001 of 2007.  In response to the exposure
         draft, a total of 22 submissions were received, including public
         submissions from the following industry, taxpayers, peak bodies and
         tax advisors:


                . Australian Bankers' Association;


                . Australian Chamber of Commerce and Industry;


                . Australian Financial Markets Association;


                . Blake Dawson Waldron;


                . Certified Practicing Accountants Australia;


                . Corporate Tax Association;


                . Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu;


                . Ernst & Young;


                . General Electric;


                . Insurance Council of Australia;


                . Institute of Chartered Accountants in Australia;


                . Investment and Financial Services Association;


                . Minerals Council of Australia;


                . Pitcher Partners;


                . Property Council of Australia;


                . Pricewaterhouse Coopers; and


                . Tax Institute of Australia.


   1523. In general, submissions were positive about the 2007 public
         exposure draft, and much of the feedback was of a technical nature.
          The main policy issues raised in submissions were:


                . The tax treatment of finance leases:  A number of taxpayer
                  expressed a preference that finance leases not be treated
                  under the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules.  The Government has
                  since determined that the tax treatment of finance leases
                  will remain unchanged.


                . The threshold for mandatory application of the TOFA
                  Stages 3 and 4 rules to businesses:  A number of tax
                  advisory firms which service medium sized enterprises have
                  contended that the taxpayer thresholds should be raised as
                  smaller taxpayers subject to the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 rules
                  will be the least well equipped to adapt to the new rules,
                  and would be particularly burdened by the application of
                  accruals taxation.  This proposition has been accepted in
                  part, with the aggregated turnover test being raised to
                  $100 million from $20 million for general taxpayers, but
                  the $20 million threshold has been retained for financial
                  entities.


   1524. On 6 August 2007, an exposure draft was released on a confidential
         basis to parties involved in previous consultation process.  In
         response to the confidential exposure draft, a total of 19
         submissions were received from industry, taxpayers, peak bodies and
         tax advisors.


   1525. In general, submissions were positive about the 2007 confidential
         exposure draft, and much of the feedback was of a technical nature.
          The main policy issues raised in submissions were:


                . The application date of the legislation:  A number of
                  submissions requested that the start date be delayed until
                  1 July 2008 (optional) and 1 July 2009 (compulsory).  This
                  proposition was accepted for the 2007 TOFA Bill.


                . The inclusion of TOFA-specific integrity measures:  A
                  number of submissions felt that these integrity rules
                  created unnecessary compliance costs.  This proposition
                  was accepted for the 2007 TOFA Bill.


   1526. Following the calling of the 2007 Federal election, Parliament was
         prorogued and the 2007 TOFA Bill consequently lapsed.  As part of
         the 2008 Budget, the Treasurer announced on 13 May 2008 that the
         TOFA Stages 3 and 4 measures would be re-introduced into Parliament
         with a start date of 1 July 2009 and that consultation would occur
         on the technical aspects of the measures (Media Release No. 054 of
         2008).  Subsequently, the Assistant Treasurer and Minister for
         Competition Policy and Consumer Affairs announced a 1 July 2009
         optional start date and 1 July 2010 compulsory start date.


   1527. On 1 October 2008, the Assistant Treasurer and Minister for
         Competition Policy and Consumer Affairs announced the release of
         exposure draft material for TOFA Stages 3 and 4 (Media Release No.
         082 of 1 October 2008).  In response to the public exposure draft,
         a total of 10 submissions were received from the following
         industry, taxpayers, peak bodies and tax advisors:


                . Australian Accounting Standards Board;


                . Australian Bankers' Association;


                . Blake Dawson;


                . Institute of Chartered Accountants Australia;


                . Investment and Financial Services Association;


                . Namoi Cotton;


                . Property Council of Australia;


                . Pitcher Partners;


                . Pricewaterhouse Coopers; and


                . Tax Institute of Australia.


   1528. Submissions were generally positive about the 2008 public exposure
         draft, and much of the feedback was of a technical nature, relating
         in particular to consolidations interactions.  The main policy
         issues raised in submissions were:


                . A limit in the scope of the aggregated turnover test.
                  This may have prevented application of the TOFA rules to
                  superannuation funds and entities which do not 'carry on a
                  business'.  This was corrected in the 2008 TOFA Bill.


                . The level of the general aggregated turnover test:  it was
                  proposed that the turnover test for general taxpayers be
                  raised to $250 million.  This proposal was not accepted in
                  the 2008 TOFA Bill because of the potential for increased
                  tax arbitrage between taxpayers subject to the TOFA rules
                  and those outside the TOFA rules.


                . Making the TOFA rules elective:  it was proposed that the
                  TOFA rules only be applied by taxpayers who elect for the
                  rules to apply to them.  This proposal was not accepted in
                  the 2008 TOFA Bill because the potential for tax arbitrage
                  is even greater than for the $250 million aggregated
                  turnover proposal.


Conclusion and recommended option


   1529. The Government has decided to implement option 1 in order to
         achieve the TOFA Stages 3 and 4 objectives.  Option 1 was preferred
         over option 2 and the current tax law (option 3) because:


                . the current law includes a mismatch between the underlying
                  commercial substance of transactions and the tax treatment
                  which leads to the misallocation of resources;


                . the current law inhibits the efficient management of risk
                  by limiting the capacity to achieve post-tax effective
                  hedging;


                . the direct link approach achieves some of these objectives
                  (although not all due to the lack of tax-character
                  hedging), but would impose costs and raise liquidity
                  issues for taxpayers due to the taxation of unrealised
                  gains and losses;


                . compliance costs for taxpayers will be reduced under
                  option 1 compared to the current law due to the greater
                  certainty and the capacity for some taxpayers to rely on
                  their financial reports;


                . under option 1, the tax treatment of financial
                  arrangements will not automatically change without
                  Government consideration as it would under the direct link
                  approach;


                . the legislation could apply to a broad range of taxpayers,
                  not just the relative few (but large taxpayers) who apply
                  all the relevant accounting standards; and


                . option 1 reduces the potential for financial accounting
                  principles to be influenced by tax considerations (so
                  called 'reverse pollution').


   1530. The Government has also decided to provide an election (the
         financial accounts election (Subdivision 230-F)) to allow certain
         taxpayers to rely on the outcomes of their financial reports.  This
         effectively permits some elements of an elective direct link for
         taxpayers who make the election.  The financial accounts election
         was included in Division 230 because:


                . the election will provide transitional compliance cost
                  savings for the taxpayers who make the election;


                . eligible taxpayers will be free to weigh the costs and
                  benefits of the financial accounts election and determine
                  whether making the election is in their interests, rather
                  than having the option imposed on certain taxpayers or
                  taxpayer groups; and


                . the application of a direct link to accounting via an
                  election will not force smaller taxpayers to apply
                  accounting standards that they have not previously been
                  required to apply.


   1531. The Treasury and the ATO will monitor these taxation measures, as
         part of the whole system, on an ongoing basis.






Index

Schedule 1:  Amendments

|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, Subdivision 230-B                   |1.53          |
|Item 1, Subdivision 230-C                   |1.53, 1.57    |
|Item 1, Subdivision 230-D                   |1.53, 1.59    |
|Item 1, Subdivision 230-E                   |1.53, 1.64    |
|Item 1, Subdivision 230-F                   |1.53, 1.69    |
|Item 1, Subdivision 230-G                   |1.53, 1.55    |
|Item 1, Subdivision 230-J                   |1.47          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-5(1) and 230-45(1)  |1.42          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-5(2)(a) and section   |1.49          |
|230-455                                     |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-5(2)(b) and section   |1.44          |
|230-50                                      |              |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-5(2)(b) and          |2.107         |
|230-40(4)(e)                                |              |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-10(b)(ii)          |3.71          |
|Item 1, section 230-15                      |1.38          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-15(1)                |3.68          |
|Item 1, note to subsections 230-15(1) and   |3.90          |
|(2)                                         |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-15(2)                |3.70          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-15(3)                |3.78          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-15(4)                |3.74          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-15(5)                |3.75          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-15(6)                |3.75          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-15(7)                |3.69          |
|Item 1, section 230-20                      |3.101         |
|Item 1, sections 230-20 and 230-25          |3.99          |
|Item 1, sections 230-20 and 230-25, item 76,|3.100         |
|section 118-27                              |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-20(2)                |3.104         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-20(5) and 230-25(4) |3.111         |
|Item 1, section 230-25                      |3.106         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-25(2)                |3.103         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-25(3)                |3.108, 10.46  |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-25(3)(a)              |3.108         |
|Item 1, section 230-30                      |3.76          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-30(1)                |11.35         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-30(3)                |3.77          |
|Item 1, section 230-35                      |3.80, 3.81,   |
|                                            |3.85          |
|Item 1, section 230-40                      |1.56, 3.30,   |
|                                            |3.31, 5.83    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-40(1)                |1.81          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-40(1),               |1.80          |
|Subdivision 230-G                           |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-40(2) and (7)       |1.82          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-40(4)                |1.86, 4.61,   |
|                                            |4.208         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-40(4) and 230-100(5)|1.78          |
|and section 230-180                         |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(b)              |4.62          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(c)              |4.63          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(e)              |1.44, 4.124,  |
|                                            |4.214         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-40(4)(e) and          |1.87          |
|sections 230-270 and 230-330                |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-40(5)                |1.83          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-40(6)                |1.85          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-40(6)(a)              |7.73          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-40(6)(b)              |7.74          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-40(6)(c)              |7.75          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-40(7)                |9.50          |
|Item 1, section 230-45                      |1.41, 1.57,   |
|                                            |6.47          |
|Item 1, sections 230-45 and 230-50          |2.42, 2.52    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-45(1)                |2.61          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-45(1) and            |2.91          |
|section 230-60                              |              |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-45(1)(d) to (f)      |2.90, 2.92    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-45(2)                |1.42          |
|Item 1, note to subsection 230-45(2)        |2.82          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(a)              |2.69          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(b)              |2.75          |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-45(2)(b) and (c)     |2.76          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(c)              |2.74          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(d)              |2.78          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(e)              |2.80          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(f) and          |2.83          |
|subsection 230-45(3)                        |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-45(2)(g)              |2.87, 2.88    |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-45(3)(a) and (b)     |2.84          |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-45(3)(c)(i)        |2.86          |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-45(3)(c)(ii)       |2.85          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-50(1)                |2.99, 2.101   |
|Item 1, subsection 230-50(2)                |2.103         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-50(2) and section    |2.105         |
|230-60                                      |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-50(2)(b)              |2.104         |
|Item 1, section 230-55                      |1.41, 4.95,   |
|                                            |6.32          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-55(1)                |2.186         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-55(1) and (2)       |2.51          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-55(4)                |2.45, 2.50,   |
|                                            |4.94          |
|Item 1, section 230-60                      |2.63, 3.37,   |
|                                            |3.38          |
|Item 1, sections 230-60, 230-70 and 230-75  |3.33          |
|Item 1, section 230-65                      |3.39, 3.40    |
|Item 1, section 230-70                      |3.67          |
|Item 1, sections 230-70 and 230-75          |3.32, 3.58,   |
|                                            |3.65, 4.128   |
|Item 1, sections 230-70, 230-75, 230-200 and|3.66          |
|230-445                                     |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-70(1) and 230-75(1) |4.143         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-70(3) and 230-75(3) |3.57          |
|Item 1, section 230-80                      |1.36, 1.90    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-80(3)                |4.136         |
|Item 1, section 230-85                      |1.41, 2.65    |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-95(a)                 |4.53, 4.70    |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-95(a) and (c)        |4.82          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-95(b)                 |4.53          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-95(c)                 |4.54          |
|Item 1, section 230-100                     |4.130         |
|Item 1, sections 230-100, 230-105, 230-115  |1.73          |
|and 230-135                                 |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-100(2)               |4.71          |
|Item 1, note to paragraph 230-100(2)(b)     |4.71          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-100(3)               |4.78, 4.82    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-100(4)               |4.57          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-100(4)(c)             |4.60          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-100(5)               |1.88, 4.59,   |
|                                            |4.78          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-105(1)               |4.57, 4.58,   |
|                                            |4.67          |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, note to subsection 230-105(1)       |4.72          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-105(1) and          |4.153         |
|230-130(1)                                  |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-105(2)(a)             |4.73, 4.84    |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-105(2)(b)             |4.75          |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-110(1)(a) and (b)    |4.84          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-110(1)(c)             |4.83          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-110(1)(d)             |4.83          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-110(2)               |4.87          |
|Item 1, note to subsection 230-110(2)       |4.83          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-110(2)(b)             |4.129         |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-110(2)(b) and (c)    |4.85          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-115(1)               |4.97          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-115(2)(a)             |4.98          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-115(2)(b)             |4.98, 4.114   |
|Item 1, subsection 230-115(3)               |4.114         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-115(3)(a)             |4.106         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-115(3)(a)(ii)      |4.112         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-115(3)(a)(iii)     |4.111         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-115(3)(a)(iv),     |4.110         |
|paragraph 230-115(3)(b)                     |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-115(4) and (5)      |4.80, 4.118   |
|Item 1, subsection 230-115(6)               |4.119         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-115(8)               |4.102         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-115(9)               |4.127         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-120(1) and           |4.92          |
|subparagraph 230-120(3)(c)(i)               |              |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-120(3)(b)(i)       |4.93          |
|Item 1, section 230-125                     |4.130         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-130(1)               |4.67, 4.131,  |
|                                            |4.132         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-130(2)               |4.136         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-130(3)               |4.134, 4.135  |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-130(5)(a)             |4.135         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-130(5)(b)(i)       |4.135         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-130(5)(b)(ii)      |4.135         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-135(2)(a)             |4.138         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-135(2)(b)             |4.138, 4.146  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-135(4)               |4.139         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-135(4)(a)             |4.144         |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-135(4)(b)             |4.144         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-135(5)               |4.140         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-135(6)               |4.141         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-135(7)               |4.142         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-135(8)               |4.143         |
|Item 1, section 230-140                     |4.147         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-140(3)(a)             |4.150         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-140(3)(b)             |4.150         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-140(3)(c)             |4.150         |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-140(3)(d) to (f)     |4.150         |
|Item 1, sections 230-150 and 230-155        |4.74          |
|Item 1, sections 230-150, 230-160 and       |1.75, 4.154   |
|230-165                                     |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-150(1)               |4.155         |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-160(1)(a) and (b) and|4.156         |
|230-165(1)(a) and (b)                       |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-160(1)(c)             |4.158         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-160(1)(e)             |4.159, 4.160  |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-160(1)(f)             |4.160         |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-160(1)(f) and        |4.162         |
|230-165(1)(e)                               |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-160(2)               |4.158         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-160(3) to (5) and   |4.74          |
|230-165(3) to (5)                           |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-160(3) and (5) and  |4.155         |
|230-165(3) and (5)                          |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-160(3) and          |4.157         |
|230-165(3)                                  |              |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-160(3)(a) and        |4.164         |
|230-165(3)(a)                               |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-160(4)               |4.165         |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-165(3)(b) to (d) and |4.163         |
|230-160(3)(b) to (d)                        |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-165(4)               |4.165         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-170(1)               |4.168         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-170(2)               |4.169         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-170(3), 230-230(3), |12.46         |
|230-280(4), 230-300(10) and 230-420(3)      |              |
|Item 1, section 230-175                     |1.76, 4.171   |
|Item 1, subsection 230-175(1)               |4.172         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-175(2)               |4.173         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-175(3)               |4.173         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-175(4)               |4.172         |
|Item 1, section 230-180                     |4.216         |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(2)(a)             |4.216         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(2)(b)             |4.216         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-180(3)               |4.219         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(3)(a)             |4.221         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(3)(b)             |4.221         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(3)(c)             |4.221         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(5)(a)             |4.221         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(5)(b)             |4.221         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-180(5)(c)             |4.221         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-180(6)               |4.220, 4.222  |
|Item 1, sections 230-185 and 230-190        |1.74          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-185(1)               |4.223         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-185(2)(a)             |4.225         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-185(2)(b)             |4.226         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-185(2)(c)             |4.230         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-185(2)(d)             |4.231         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-185(2)(e)             |4.233         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-185(3)               |4.224         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-190(2)               |4.175, 4.181  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-190(3)               |4.179         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-190(3)(a)             |4.176         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-190(3)(b)             |4.176         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-190(3)(c)             |4.176, 4.180  |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-190(3)(d)             |4.176, 4.229  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-190(5)               |4.185         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-190(6)               |4.188         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-190(6)(a)             |4.189         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-190(6)(b)             |4.190         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-190(7)               |4.194         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-190(8) and (9)      |4.196         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-190(8) to (10)      |4.233         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-190(8)(b)             |4.203         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-190(10)              |4.196         |
|Item 1, section 230-195                     |4.193         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-195(1)               |4.197         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-195(1)(a)             |4.198         |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-195(1)(b)             |4.199         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-195(1)(c)             |4.199         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-195(1)(d)             |4.198         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-195(2)               |4.204         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-195(3)               |4.204         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-195(5)               |4.205         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-195(6)               |4.206         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-200(1)               |4.182         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-200(2)               |4.184         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-200(2)(a)(i)       |4.187         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-200(2)(a)(ii)      |4.187         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-200(3)               |4.195         |
|Item 1, section 230-210                     |6.19          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-210(1)               |6.18          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-210(2)               |6.18          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-210(2), 230-255(2), |5.13          |
|230-315(2) and 230-395(2)                   |              |
|Item 1, subparagraphs 230-210(2)(a)(ii) and |5.47          |
|(b)(ii), 230-255(2)(a)(ii) and (b)(ii),     |              |
|230-315(2)(a)(ii) and (b)(ii) and           |              |
|230-395(2)(a)(ii) and (b)(ii)               |              |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-210(2)(b),           |5.45          |
|230-255(2)(b), 230-315(2)(b) and            |              |
|230-395(2)(b)                               |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-210(3), 230-255(5), |5.69          |
|230-315(3) and 230-395(4)                   |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-215(1), 230-260(1), |5.33          |
|230-320(1) and 230-400(1)                   |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-215(2), 230-260(2), |5.34          |
|230-320(2) and 230-400(2)                   |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-215(3) to (5),      |Example 5.1   |
|230-260(3) to (5) and 230-400(3) to (5)     |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-220(1)               |6.30          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-220(1), 230-265(1), |5.75          |
|230-325(3) and 230-410(1)                   |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-220(1), 230-265(1)  |5.70          |
|and 230-410(1), section 230-325             |              |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-220(1)(b),           |5.39          |
|230-265(1)(b), 230-335(1)(c) and            |              |
|230-410(1)(c)                               |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-220(1)(c)             |6.31          |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-220(1)(c) and (d)    |6.27          |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-220(1)(c) and        |2.108         |
|230-410(1)(d), subsections 230-225(1),      |              |
|230-300(7) and (8) and 230-415(1)           |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-220(1)(c) and         |6.18          |
|subsection 230-220(2)                       |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-220(1)(d)             |6.18, 6.33    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-220(2)               |6.28          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-220(2), 230-265(2)  |5.80          |
|and 230-410(3), paragraphs 230-230(1)(b) and|              |
|230-420(1)(b),                              |              |
|subparagraph 230-280(1)(b)(ii)              |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-220(3), 230-265(3), |11.76         |
|230-335(2) and 230-410(8)                   |              |
|Item 1, section 230-225                     |6.18          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-225(1)               |6.36          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-225(1) and          |1.84, 5.72,   |
|230-415(1)                                  |2.115, 4.212, |
|                                            |6.31, 6.32    |
|Item 1, subsections 230-225(1) and 230-480  |1.55, 5.72    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-225(3)               |6.23          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-225(3), 230-270(3), |5.62, 5.67,   |
|230-330(4) and 230-415(3)                   |5.73          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-225(4)               |6.24          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-225(4), 230-270(4), |5.74          |
|230-330(5) and 230-415(4)                   |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-230(1)               |5.78          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-230(1), 230-280(1)  |5.77          |
|and 230-420(1)                              |              |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-230(1)(c) and        |11.77         |
|230-420(1)(c),                              |              |
|subparagraph 230-280(1)(b)(iii)             |              |
|Item 1, section 230-235                     |6.18          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-240(1)               |6.34          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-240(1), 230-285(1), |5.86          |
|230-370(1) and 230-425(1)                   |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-240(1) and (3),     |5.89          |
|230-285(1) and (3), 230-370(1) and          |              |
|230-425(1) and (3)                          |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-240(2)               |6.50          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-240(2), 230-285(2), |5.96          |
|230-370(2) and 230-425(2)                   |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-240(2) and (4),     |5.90          |
|230-285(2) and (4), 230-370(2) and          |              |
|230-425(1) and (4)                          |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-240(3), 230-285(3)  |5.88          |
|and 230-425(3)                              |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-240(4)               |6.44          |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, subsections 230-240(4), 230-285(4), |5.96          |
|230-325(1), 230-425(4) and the note to      |              |
|subsection 230-370(2)                       |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-245(1), 230-290(1)  |5.91          |
|and 230-430(1)                              |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-245(1) and (3)      |6.46          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-245(2), (4) and (5),|5.93          |
|230-290(2), (4) and (5) and 230-430(2), (5) |              |
|and (6)                                     |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-245(3), 230-290(3)  |5.92          |
|and 230-430(3)                              |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-255(1) and (2), item|7.30          |
|6, section 775-295                          |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-255(2)               |7.31          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-255(3)               |7.55          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-255(3) and (4)      |7.30          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-255(4)(a)             |7.61          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-255(4)(b)             |7.62          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-255(5)               |7.70          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-265(1)(b), item 6,    |7.34          |
|paragraph 775-295(1)(b)                     |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-265(1)(c), item 6,    |7.34          |
|paragraph 775-295(1)(c)                     |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-265(1)(d), item 6,    |7.34          |
|paragraph 775-295(1)(a)                     |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-265(2)               |7.34          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-270(1), paragraph    |2.107         |
|230-5(2)(b))                                |              |
|Item 1, section 230-275                     |7.62          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-280(1)               |5.78, 7.40    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-285(1)               |7.43          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-285(2)               |7.44, 7.71    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-285(3), item 6,      |7.45          |
|subsection 775-310(1)                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-285(4), item 6,      |7.46          |
|subsection 775-310(2)                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-285(5)               |7.67          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-285(6)               |7.68          |
|Item 1, section 230-290                     |1.62          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-290(1) and (3)      |7.47          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-290(2) and (4)      |7.48          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-290(3) to (5)       |7.69          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-290(5)               |7.49          |
|Item 1, section 230-295                     |8.98          |
|Item 1, sections 230-300 and 230-310        |8.87          |
|Item 1, sections 230-300 and 230-325        |8.23          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-300(1) and (2)      |8.84          |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, subsections 230-300(1) and          |3.96          |
|230-310(3), section 230-40                  |              |
|Item 1, subsections 230-300(3), 230-360(1)  |8.35          |
|and (2)                                     |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-300(4)(a)             |8.85          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-300(4)(b)             |8.85          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-300(5)               |8.103         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-300(5) and section   |8.36          |
|230-305                                     |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-300(5) and section   |8.104         |
|230-305, item 2 in the table                |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-300(6)               |8.111         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-300(7)               |8.86          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-300(7) and (8)      |4.63          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-300(7) and (8) and  |2.107         |
|230-330(1), paragraph 230-5(2)(b)           |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-300(10)              |12.47         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-300(11)              |12.48         |
|Item 1, section 230-305, item 1 in the table|8.110         |
|Item 1, section 230-305, items 2(a) to (c)  |8.111         |
|and (3) in the table                        |              |
|Item 1, section 230-305, subitems 1(a) and  |8.107         |
|(b) in the table                            |              |
|Item 1, section 230-310                     |3.95          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4)               |8.35, 8.88    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 1 in the|8.89          |
|table                                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 2 in the|8.91          |
|table                                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 3 in the|8.91          |
|table                                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 4 in the|8.91          |
|table                                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 5 in the|8.90, 8.91    |
|table                                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 6 in the|8.91          |
|table                                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), items 7 and  |8.91          |
|10 in the table                             |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), items 8 and 9|8.91          |
|in the table                                |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 11 in   |8.91          |
|the table                                   |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(4), item 12 in   |8.91          |
|the table                                   |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-310(5)               |8.91          |
|Item 1, sections 230-315 and 230-325        |8.27          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-315(2)               |8.29          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-315(3)               |8.112         |
|Item 1, section 230-325                     |8.30          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-330(1)               |8.32          |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, subsection 230-330(2)               |8.32          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-330(3)               |8.33          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-330(4)               |8.34          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-330(5)               |8.34          |
|Item 1, section 230-335                     |8.39          |
|Item 1, section 230-335 and subsection      |8.79          |
|230-355(5)                                  |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(1)               |8.24, 8.48    |
|Item 1, subsections 230-335(1) and (3)      |8.23          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-335(1)(a)             |8.46, 8.49    |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-335(1)(b)             |8.49          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-335(1)(c)             |8.49          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(3)               |8.24, 8.48    |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-335(3)(c)             |8.78          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-335(3)(e)             |8.78          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(4)               |8.76          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(5)               |8.76          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-335(5) and (6)      |8.55          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(6)               |8.76          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(7)               |8.77          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(8)               |8.56          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-335(8) and (9)      |8.58          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(9)               |8.57          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(10)              |8.25, 8.59    |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-335(10)(f)            |8.26          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-335(11)              |8.26, 8.61    |
|Item 1, section 230-340                     |8.54          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-340(2)               |8.54          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-340(3)               |8.54          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-340(4)               |8.54          |
|Item 1, section 230-345                     |8.24, 8.52    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-350(1)               |2.120, 3.87,  |
|                                            |8.40, 10.50   |
|Item 1, subsection 230-350(2)               |8.45          |
|Item 1, section 230-355                     |8.31          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-355(1)               |8.62          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(1)(b)             |8.62          |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(1)(c)             |8.62          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-355(2)               |8.64          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-355(3)               |8.63          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(3)(b)             |8.63          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(4)(a)             |8.62          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(4)(b)             |8.62          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(4)(c)             |8.62          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-355(5)               |8.24, 8.78    |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-355(5)(a)(i)       |8.80          |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-355(5)(a)(ii)      |8.80          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(5)(b)             |8.80          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(5)(c)             |8.80          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-355(5)(d)             |8.80          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-355(6)               |8.80          |
|Item 1, section 230-360                     |8.31          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-360(2)(a)             |8.83          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-360(2)(c)             |8.83          |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-360(2)(c)(ii)      |8.96          |
|Item 1, section 230-365                     |8.31          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-365(a)                |8.65          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-365(b)                |8.65          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-365(c)                |8.65          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-370(1)               |8.112         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-370(2)               |8.113         |
|Item 1, section 230-375                     |8.115         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-375(3), 230-300(1), |8.115         |
|230-300(2) and 230-440(2)                   |              |
|Item 1, section 230-380                     |8.24, 8.97    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-380(2)               |8.100         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-380(3) to (5)       |8.100         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-380(6)               |8.101         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-385(2)               |8.117         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-385(3)               |8.118         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-385(4)               |8.118         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-385(5)               |8.118         |
|Item 1, section 230-395                     |9.37          |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(c)             |9.21          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(c) and         |9.68          |
|subsection 230-425(2)                       |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(d)             |9.25          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-395(2)(e)             |9.26          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-395(3)               |9.27          |
|Item 1, subsections 230-405(1) and (2)      |9.29          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-410(1)(b)             |9.46          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-410(1)(d)             |9.48          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-410(1)(e) and         |9.33          |
|subsection 230-410(2)                       |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-410(1)(f) and         |9.34          |
|subsection 230-410(2)                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-410(2)               |9.35          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-410(3)               |9.45          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-410(7)               |9.36          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-415(1)               |9.48          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-415(3)               |9.39, 9.49    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-415(4)               |9.40          |
|Item 1, section 230-420                     |9.53          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-420(1)               |5.78          |
|Item 1, section 230-425                     |9.61          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-425(4)               |9.58, 9.62    |
|Item 1, section 230-430                     |1.70, 9.65    |
|Item 1, subsections 230-430(1) and (3)      |9.64          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-430(4)               |9.59, 9.64    |
|Item 1, section 230-435 and subsection      |1.89          |
|230-40(1)                                   |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-435(1)               |4.211         |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-435(1)(a) and (b)    |10.39         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-435(1)(c)(i)       |10.42         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-435(1)(c)(ii)      |10.42         |
|Item 1, subparagraph 230-435(1)(c)(iii)     |10.42         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-435(3)               |10.41         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-435(5)               |10.53         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-440(1)               |2.109, 10.44  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-440(2)               |1.65          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-440(3)(a)             |10.46         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-440(3)(c)             |10.55         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-440(3)(d)             |10.55         |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(1), steps 1(b)   |10.62         |
|and (c) and 2(b) and (c) in the method      |              |
|statement                                   |              |
|Item 1, note to paragraph (c) of step 2 in  |11.37         |
|the method statement in                     |              |
|subsection 230-445(1)                       |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(1), step 3 in the|10.63         |
|method statement                            |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(2)               |10.65         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(3)               |10.66         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(4)               |10.68         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(5)               |10.67, 10.68  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(6)               |10.69         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-445(7)               |3.110         |
|Item 1, section 230-450                     |1.45, 1.49,   |
|                                            |11.10         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-450(b)                |2.118         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-450(c)                |2.119         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-450(d)                |2.120         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-450(e)                |2.121         |
|Part 1, section 230-455                     |2.124, 2.133, |
|                                            |2.135, 2.136  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-455(1)               |4.56          |
|Part 1, subparagraph 230-455(1)(a)(ii),     |2.128         |
|paragraph 230-455(1)(b), subsection         |              |
|230-455(2)                                  |              |
|Part 1, subparagraph 230-455(1)(a)(iii),    |2.130         |
|paragraph 230-455(1)(c), subsection         |              |
|230-455(3)                                  |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-455(1)(e)             |2.137, 2.139  |
|Item 1, subsections 230-455(6) to (8)       |2.140         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-455(7)               |3.86, 4.56    |
|Part 1, subsection 230-455(9)               |2.141         |
|Item 1, section 230-460 and subsections     |1.50          |
|230-475(3) and (4)                          |              |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(2)(a)             |2.143         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(2)(b)             |2.143         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(2)(c)             |2.143         |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-460(2)(d) and (e)    |2.143         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(3)               |2.149         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(3)(c)             |2.151         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(4)               |2.152         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(5)               |2.157         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-460(5) and (6)      |2.153         |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(6)               |2.161         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(7)               |2.165         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(8)(a)             |2.167         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(8)(b)             |2.167         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(8)(c)             |2.167, 2.169  |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(9)(a)             |2.171         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(9)(b)             |2.172         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(9)(c)             |2.173         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(9)(d)             |2.174         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(9)(e)             |2.176         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-460(9)(f)             |2.178         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(10)              |2.177         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(11)              |2.179         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(12)              |2.181         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(13)              |2.184         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(14)              |2.191         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(15)              |2.192         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(16)              |2.195         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(17)              |2.197         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-460(18)              |2.198         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-465(1)               |2.200         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-465(2)               |2.203         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-465(3)               |2.202         |
|Item 1, section 230-470                     |1.49, 10.56,  |
|                                            |2.204         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-475(1), paragraph    |2.209         |
|230-475(3)(b)                               |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-475(1),              |2.210         |
|paragraph 230-475(3)(c)                     |              |
|Item 1, subsection 230-475(3)               |2.205         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-475(3)(a)             |2.207         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-475(4)(a)             |2.208         |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-475(4)(b)             |2.209         |
|Item 1, section 230-480                     |2.212, 3.89,  |
|                                            |6.40, 9.57    |
|Item 1, subsection 230-485(1)               |11.88         |
|Item 1, subsections 230-485(3) and (4)      |11.89         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-485(4)               |11.99         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-485(5)               |11.105        |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 1, paragraphs 230-485(5)(a) and (7)(a) |11.107        |
|Item 1, subsection 230-485(6)               |11.92         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-485(8)               |11.94         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-490(1)               |11.109        |
|Item 1, subsection 230-490(2)               |11.108        |
|Item 1, section 230-495                     |5.56          |
|Item 1, section 230-500                     |5.48          |
|Item 1, section 230-505                     |3.43, 11.51   |
|Item 1, subsection 230-505(1)               |3.44, 11.54   |
|Item 1, subsection 230-505(2)               |3.48, 3.50,   |
|                                            |11.57, 11.58  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-505(3)               |3.52          |
|Item 1, section 230-510                     |10.80         |
|Item 1, sections 230-510 and 230-515        |1.92          |
|Item 1, paragraph 230-510(1)(b)             |10.78         |
|Item 1, section 230-520                     |1.91          |
|Item 1, section 230-525                     |5.14, 5.24,   |
|                                            |12.68         |
|Item 1, section 230-530                     |6.29          |
|Item 1, subsection 230-530(1)               |6.37, 2.111,  |
|                                            |2.113         |
|Item 1, subsection 230-530(2)               |2.111, 2.113  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-530(3)               |2.111, 2.113  |
|Item 1, subsection 230-530(4)               |2.111, 2.114  |
|Items 2 and 3                               |7.38          |
|Part 2, item 37, definition of 'hedging     |11.138        |
|activity' in subsection 121D(8) of the ITAA |              |
|1936                                        |              |
|Part 2, items 44 and 45, subsection         |11.71         |
|160ZZX(2) of the ITAA 1936                  |              |
|Part 3, items 102 to 105                    |1.94          |
|Part 3, subitem 104(2)                      |7.63          |
|Part 3, subitem 104(7)                      |4.167, 13.28  |
|Part 3, subitems 104(8) and (11)            |6.27          |
|Part 3, subitem 104(10)                     |1.94          |
|Part 3, subitem 104(12)                     |7.64, 7.66    |
|Part 4, item 109, subparagraph              |11.160        |
|775-270(2A)(a)(ii)                          |              |
|Part 4, item 111, definition of a           |11.140        |
|'qualifying forex account' in               |              |
|subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997        |              |
|Item 5, subsection 775-270(1A)              |7.56, 11.161  |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 6, Subdivision 775-F                   |7.41          |
|Item 6, section 775-305                     |7.42          |
|Item 6, sections 775-305 and 775-315        |7.53          |
|Item 6, subsection 775-305(4)               |7.34          |
|Item 6, section 775-315                     |7.52          |
|Item 7, subsection 820-930(1)               |2.100, 9.48   |
|Item 11, definition of 'Division 230        |11.40         |
|financial arrangement' in subsection        |              |
|995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997                   |              |
|Item 21, subsection 995-1(1)                |2.70          |
|Item 28, definition of 'special accrual     |4.102, 7.78,  |
|amount' in subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA  |11.64         |
|1997                                        |              |
|Item 31, subsection 6(1)                    |11.145, 11.151|
|Item 32, subsection 51AAA(2) of the ITAA    |11.80         |
|1936                                        |              |
|Item 33, paragraph 82KZLA(a) of the ITAA    |11.11         |
|1936                                        |              |
|Item 34, paragraph 96C(5A)(aa) of the       |11.29         |
|ITAA 1936                                   |              |
|Item 35, paragraph 102CA(2)(c) of the ITAA  |11.25         |
|1936                                        |              |
|Item 37, subsection 121EB(3)                |11.72         |
|Items 38 to 40, section 128NBA of the ITAA  |11.114        |
|1936                                        |              |
|Item 40, subparagraph 128NBA(5)(d)(9)(ii) of|11.115        |
|the ITAA 1936                               |              |
|Items 41 and 42, definition of 'derivative  |11.139        |
|transaction' in section 160ZZV of the ITAA  |              |
|1936                                        |              |
|Item 43, subsection 160ZZW(1A)              |11.69         |
|Item 46, subsection 262A(2AAC)              |11.147        |
|Item 46, subsection 262A(2AAD)              |11.149        |
|Item 47, paragraph 262A(3)(ca)              |11.150        |
|Item 49, paragraph 389(ba) of the ITAA 1936 |11.29         |
|Item 50, paragraph 557A(c) of the ITAA 1936 |11.29         |
|Items 53 and 57, sections 10-5 and 12-5     |11.142        |
|Item 58, subsection 25-35(5)                |11.143        |
|Item 59, subsection 25-85(4A)               |11.30         |
|Item 60, note to section 29-90              |11.31         |
|Items 62 to 68, subsections 40-180(1),      |11.143        |
|40-185(1), 40-300(1) and 40-305(1)          |              |
|Item 68, section 70-10 of the ITAA 1997     |11.39         |
|Items 69 and 70, sections 102-20 and 104-5  |11.144        |
|Items 70 to 75, subsections 110-25(1) and   |11.143        |
|116-10(7) and sections 104-5 and 112-5      |              |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Item 76, subsection 118-27(1)               |11.40, 11.42  |
|Item 76, paragraph 118-27(2)(a)             |11.44         |
|Item 76, subsection 118-27(3)               |11.41         |
|Items 77 and 78, section 130-100            |11.136        |
|Item 80, paragraph 295-85(2)(a)             |11.26         |
|Item 82, subsection 320-45(2)               |11.27         |
|Item 85, paragraph 701-55(5A)(a)            |12.21         |
|Items 85 and 89, subsections 701-55(5A) and |12.17         |
|715-375(2)                                  |              |
|Item 87, subsections 701-61(1), (2) and (4) |12.35         |
|Item 87, subsections 701-61(1) to (3)       |12.34         |
|Item 88, subsection 705-30(3B)              |12.53         |
|Item 89, subsections 715-375(3) and (4)     |12.44         |
|Item 89, subsections 715-380(1) and (2)     |12.55         |
|Item 89, subsections 715-380(3) and (4)     |12.56         |
|Item 89, section 715-385                    |12.65         |
|Items 90 and 91, item 3A in the table in    |12.38, 12.42, |
|subsection 715-660(1) and item 1A in the    |12.63         |
|table in subsection 715-665(1)              |              |
|Item 96, paragraph 701-55(5A)(a)            |12.24         |
|Item 96, paragraph (a) of the definition of |12.30, 12.31  |
|'Division 230 starting value' in            |              |
|subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997        |              |
|Item 96, paragraph (c) of the definition of |12.32         |
|'Division 230 starting value' in            |              |
|subsection 995-1(1) of the ITAA 1997        |              |
|Item 99, section 715-380 of the Income Tax  |12.57, 12.74  |
|(Transitional Provisions) Act 1997          |              |
|Item 100                                    |11.159        |
|Item 100, subsection 45-120(2B) in Schedule |11.84         |
|1 to the TAA 1953                           |              |
|Subitem 103(1)                              |13.19, 13.23  |
|Subitems 103(2) and (3)                     |13.20         |
|Subitem 104(2)                              |13.24, 13.27  |
|Subitems 104(2) and (3)                     |13.25         |
|Sub-subitems 104(5)(a) and (b)              |13.25         |
|Subitem 104(6)                              |13.26         |
|Subitem 104(8)                              |13.27         |
|Subitems 104(9) and (10)                    |8.37          |
|Sub-subitem 104(9)(a)                       |13.29         |
|Sub-subitem 104(9)(b)                       |13.29         |
|Sub-subitem 104(9)(c)                       |13.29         |
|Bill reference                              |Paragraph     |
|                                            |number        |
|Sub-subitem 104(9)(d)                       |13.29         |
|Subitem 104(10)                             |13.31         |
|Subitem 104(11)                             |13.32, 13.49  |
|Subitem 104(12)                             |13.34         |
|Subitem 104(13)                             |13.40, 13.52  |
|Subitem 104(13), step 1 and subitem 104(18) |13.34         |
|Subitem 104(13), step 2 and subitem 104(18) |13.34         |
|Subitem 104(13), step 3                     |13.34         |
|Subitem 104(13), step 4                     |13.34         |
|Subitem 104(13), step 5                     |13.34         |
|Subitem 104(13), step 6                     |13.34         |
|Subitem 104(13), step 7                     |13.35         |
|Subitems 104(14) and (15)                   |13.43, 13.48  |
|Subitem 104(14)                             |13.47         |
|Subitem 104(15)                             |13.47, 13.50  |
|Subitem 104(16)                             |13.51         |
|Subitem 104(17)                             |13.36, 13.54  |
|Subitem 104(19)                             |13.55         |
|Subitem 105(1)                              |13.56         |
|Subitem 105(2)                              |13.57         |
|Items 106 and 107, subsection 775-170(2)    |11.154        |
|Items 107, 108, 110, 111 and 113            |11.156        |
|Item 108, subsection 775-195(9)             |11.154        |
|Item 110, subsection 960-55(4)              |11.154        |
|Item 110, subsection 960-60(6)              |11.154        |
|Item 112, definition of 'qualifying forex   |7.57, 7.58    |
|account' in subsection 995-1(1)             |              |
|Item 113, paragraph 77(1)(b) of the NBTS    |11.158        |
|(TOFA) 2003                                 |              |


-----------------------
[1]         This is the interest rate (r) that satisfies the following
  equation:
      0  =  -$1,000  +  40/(1  +  r)1  +  $50/(1  +  r)2  +  $80/1  +  r)3
  +  $1,100/(1  +  r)4.
[2]         This is the interest rate (r) that satisfies the following
  equation:
  0  =  -$1,043.37  +  $60/(1  +  r)1  +  $1070/(1  +  r)2.
[3]   It is assumed that the fair values as at 30 June, 30 September, 31
  December and 31 March are the same as at 1 July, 1 October, 1 January and
  1 April respectively.
[4]   The AUD equivalents in Table 14.5 have been calculated on the basis
of the weighted  average costs for each deposit and withdrawal.
[5]   The numbers may not add up exactly due to rounding.
[6]   This number is calculated by deducting the number in the third column
  from the number in   the second column.
[7]   The section 230-175 running balance adjustment for the 1 January 2013
  financial benefit    is calculated as follows:  AUD 400,000/0.86  -  AUD
  214,740  +  AUD 235, 394  =     AUD 14,982.
[8]    AUD 256,410 is attributable to the re-exchange of the notional
  principal, as explained   above.
[9]   The AUD gain or loss is calculated by adding the gains and losses
  from the foreign     currency leg (second column) and the gains and
  losses from the Australian dollar leg (third     column).
[10]  These figures include running balance adjustment.
[11]  These figures include running balance adjustment and AUD realisation
  gain on the    exchange of notional principal ($256,410).
[12]  The numbers in this column are calculated by dividing the number in
  the first column by  the number in the second column.
[13]  AUD15,167 = AUD 232,558  -  AUD 217,391.
[14]  - AUD 22,764  =  AUD243,902  -  AUD 266,667.
[15]  AUD 256,410 is attributable to the re-exchange of the notional
  principal, as explained   above.
[16]  -AUD 29,303  =  AUD256,410  -  AUD 285,714.
[17]  The AUD gain/loss is calculated by adding together the foreign
  currency leg gains and    losses (column 2) and the Australian dollar leg
  gains and losses (column 3).
[18]  AUD 514,392  =  AUD 266,667 (AUD translated gain 30 June 2013)  +
  AUD 232,558    (AUD translated gain 1 January 2013)  +  AUD 15,617 (AUD
  running balancing    adjustment 1 January 2013).



-----------------------
                              Elective hedging



                                  Accruals



                           Elective retranslation



                             Elective fair value



                         Elective financial reports



                                 Realisation



                              Elective methods



                            Non-elective  methods










Step 1:  You have a financial arrangement





          None of the financial benefits are sufficiently certain.











    At a particular time, some of the financial benefits are sufficiently
  certain and some of the financial benefits are not sufficiently certain.





   Bundle of cash settlable rights and obligations to financial benefits.





                                     Yes

















Step 2:  What is the classification of the cash flows at this point in
time?





                                     No





                                     No





              All financial benefits are sufficiently certain.





                                     Yes





                                     Yes





                                     Yes





                                     Yes





               There is no sufficiently certain gain or loss.



 There may be sufficiently certain particular gains or losses in addition to
               the sufficiently certain overall gain or loss.
                                     OR
     There may only be sufficiently certain particular gains or losses.




       A sufficiently certain overall gain or loss can be calculated.

    It is the difference between the total sufficiently certain financial
                  benefits and the cost of the arrangement.




            There is a sufficiently certain overall gain or loss.

  It is the difference between the financial benefits that are received and
     the financial benefit that are provided (cost) under the financial
                                arrangement.




Step 3:  Is the gain or loss sufficiently certain or not? What is the gain
or loss?











Step 4:  What is the period over which the gain or loss is allocated?





Step 5:  What is the basis of allocation?





 The sufficiently certain overall gain or loss is allocated over the life of
                              the arrangement.




 The sufficiently certain overall gain or loss is allocated over the life of
                              the arrangement.
     The gains and losses from the other financial benefits that are not
       sufficiently certain may be recognised on a realisation basis.





    The gains and losses arising from the financial benefits that become
 sufficiently certain (ie, sufficiently certain particular gains and losses)
             are allocated over the period to which they relate.





    The gains or losses arising from the financial benefits which are not
     sufficiently certain before they become due and payable or due and
              receivable are recognised on a realisation basis.





     Divide the period into equal intervals not greater than 12 months.

    Allocate gain or loss to those intervals using a compounding accruals
   method or another method that approximates the result from that method.

 Parts of gains or losses so allocated are brought to account in the income
                      year in which the interval falls.




     Divide the period into equal intervals not greater than 12 months.

    Allocate gain or loss to those intervals using a compounding accruals
   method or another method that approximates the result from that method.

 Parts of gains or losses so allocated are brought to account in the income
                      year in which the interval falls.



   Divide the period to which the gain or loss relates into intervals not
                           greater than 12 months.

  Allocate gains or losses to those intervals using a compounding accruals
   method or another method that approximates the result from that method.

 Gains for losses so allocated are brought to account in the income year in
                          which the interval falls.




     There is no accrual treatment for gains and losses recognised on a
                             realisation basis.

 Gains or losses are taken into account under the realisation method in the
               income year in which the gain or loss occurred.




$





Time





$




Has the taxpayer made a hedging financial election?
(section 230-315)



                                     No




                                     Yes




Is the financial arrangement a hedging financial arrangement?

(sections 230-325, 230-330 and 230-335)




U-The rules for hedging financial arrangements do not apply.



                                     No




                                     Yes




The gain or loss on the hedging financial arrangement is worked out under
sections 230-300 and 230-310.















 


[Index] [Search] [Download] [Bill] [Help]